i *""    ?'^^^i^E^^^
United States
Environmental Protection
Aser


          Report
                             •.yigptsF--

                             U H-k:. visa
                                  £Sfe«8:

                         oh  the

                                             ^liaSit'aaifci^^tsL-.. ^^.^L,i^^l,^^ys^:^^f^^'^fS^:^^^,,J^-^i/^^id^l^ ]
                                                            -^".-"--Sa^:^*L*;".,.'~'«Tf-111-.-'

-------

-------

-------
                                      EPA 600-R-03-050
                                      June 2003
                    EPAV
Draft  Report on the Environment
         Technical Document
          United States Environmental Protection Agency
           Office of Research and Development and the
              Office of Environmental Information
                 Washington, DC 20460
                 www.epa.gov/indicators/
                                        Recycled/Recyclable
                                    Printed with vegetable oil-based ink on 100%
                                     processed chlorine free recycled paper
 Tarticipants
IX

-------

                                                                           JiiS&s


                                                                                                 m
              Visibility - Category
 This indicator presents visibility trends for U.S. national parks and
 wilderness areas in the eastern and western U.S. by mean visual
 range, as measured in km for 1992 to 1999 and 1990 to 1999,
 respectively, by worst, mid-range, and best visibility. Under the
 Clean Air Act, a Class I area is one in which visibility is protected
 more stringently than under the NAAQS, including national parks,
 wilderness areas, monuments, and other areas of special national
 and cultural significance.

 What the  Data Show

 Data collected by the IMPROVE network show that visibility for
 the worst visibility days in the West is similar to days with the best
 visibility in the East (Exhibit 1-13). In 1999, the mean visual range
 for the worst days in the East was only 24 km (14.9 miles) com-
 pared to 84 km (52.2 miles) for the best visibility. In the West,
 visibility impairment for the worst days remained relatively
 unchanged over the 1990s, with the mean visual range for 1999
 (80 km or 49.7 miles) nearly the  same as the 1990 level (86 km
 or S3.4 miles). Without the effects of pollution, a  natural visual
 range in the U.S. is approximately 75 to 150  km (47 to 93 miles)
 in the East and 200 to 300 km (124 to 186  miles) in the West
 (EPA, OAQPS, September 2002).
                                         Indicator Caps and Limitations

                                         Limitations of this indicator include the following:
                                         • The indicator compares trends within visibility range categories,
                                           but it would also be useful to indicate how often visibility falls
                                           into each range during a year.
                                         • The data represent only a sampling of national park and
                                           wilderness areas; nevertheless, this indicator provides a good
                                           picture of the impact of air pollution on the nation's parks and
                                           protected areas. As of 2001, the network monitored 110 sites.

                                         Data Source

                                         The data source for this indicator was Latest Findings on National
                                         Air Quality: 2007 Status and Trends,  EPA, 2002. (See Appendix B,
                                         page B-4, for more information.)
                                                                               .
                                     Exhibit 1-13: Visibility trends for U.S. Class I areas
               Western U.S., 1990-1999
                                                    (Eastern U.S., 1 992-1 999
^bU
1- 200
&
tiso
1
1 100
$
so

Best Visibility
"fr * •
Mid -Range
" M m , m — "- — H 	 m. — m — s

Worst Visibility
i i i t i i i i
                                                Best visibility
                                                range is 1 77-208 km

                                                Mid-range visibility
                                                is 11 8-1 33 km

                                                Worst visibility
                                                range is 73-85 km
         90   91   92  93
94  95
 Year
                                  96  97  98  99
200
150
100
50;
0
9
Best Visibility
_ Mid-Range __ —
' i i A -A- JL
k * * Worst Visibility
4J 1 1 1 .'I
2 93 94 95 96 97

— m—
.

i
98 9
                                                                                     Best visibility
                                                                                     range is 79-90 km
                                                                                     Mid-range visibility
                                                                                     is 42-48 km
                                                                                     Worst visibility
                                                                                     range is 20-23 km
                                                                                            Year
     Note: Under the Clean Air Act, a Class I area is one in which visibility is protected more stringently than undd r the National Air Quality Standards (NAAQS),,including national parks,
     wiMorncssareas,monuments,andotherareasofspecialnationalandculturalsignificance.             ,                                  ",      ",,.„,..;
     Source:EPA,OfficeofAlrQualityPlanningandStandards.tfllestRndmgsoiiNflt/ona/A'i:Qua%200r Status'find Trends. September 2002.                          	;;
1-16
                                                     1,1  Outdoor Air Quality
                                                                            C-napter I  - CJeaner /\ir

-------
This report is dedicated to the memory of our friend and colleague, Dr. Felicity (Kim) Devonald.
Kim was a tireless advocate for the development and use of environmental indicators at EPA, pioneering
our efforts to provide useful and reliable descriptions of environmental status and trends.

Kim joined EPA in1984. Since the early 1990s, she was instrumental in Agency explorations of the
concept of environmental indicators. Her efforts led to the Agency's first published proposals  of fully
developed environmentally based indicators (from public workshops) in the mid-1990s. She was
working on material related to the  state of science of these indicators almost to the moment of her
death, and much of that material has been incorporated into this Technical Document.

Without Kim's example and her early efforts, this report would be far less than it is.

-------

-------
                                         Table  of  Contents
  Preface 	 	
                                   	•	v
  List of Participants	
                r                	•	vn
  Introduction  	
                                	xi
  Chapter!:  Cleaner Air
     1.0  Introduction	                                           ..

     1.1   Outdoor Air Quality	                              16

          1.1.1   What is the quality of outdoor air in the United States? 	  	.                        -] .7
          1.1.2   What contributes to outdoor air pollution?	                      i 10
          1.1.3   What human health effects are associated with outdoor air pollution? 	                1-23
          1.1.4   What ecological effects are associated with outdoor air pollution? 	     1.24
     1.2   Acid Deposition	                                         .  -  _ ,.

          1.2.1   What are the deposition rates of pollutants that cause acid rain? 	     1 _25
          1.2.2   What are the emissions of pollutants that form acid rain?	         -| _28
          1.2.3   What ecological effects are associated with acid deposition?	            -] .29
     1.3   Indoor Air Quality ...	.		                                   ,  7q

          1.3.1    What is the quality of the air in buildings in the United States?	1 _29
          1.3.2   What contributes to indoor air pollution?	                      1-31
          1.3.3   What human health effects are associated with indoor air pollution?	     1 _31
    1.4  Stratospheric Ozone	                                     1  ,~
         1.4.1    What are the trends in  the Earth's ozone layer?	      ^ _32
         1.4.2   What is causing changes to the ozone layer?	    .    1.34
         1.4.3    What human health effects are associated with stratospheric ozone depletion?	1.37
         1.4.4   What ecological effects are associated with stratospheric ozone depletion?	1-38
    1.5  Climate Change	                                           1^8

    1.6  Challenges and Data Gaps  	                                -, ™



 Chapter 2:  Purer Water
    2.0  Introduction	                                            _ ,

    2.1   Extent and  Use of Water Resources  	                      2-6

    2.2 Waters and Watersheds	                                                              -, a
                                                        	Z.-O
        2.2.1    What is. the condition of fresh surface waters and watersheds in the U.S.?	        2-8
        2.2.2    What are the extent and condition of wetlands?	  	2-13
        2.2.3    What is the condition of coastal waters?	                               2-18
        2.2.4    What are pressures to water quality?	                 	2 24
        2.2.5    What ecological effects  are associated with impaired waters?  	                 2-49
   2.3  Drinking Water	                 	2 5Q
        2.3.1   What is the quality of drinking water?	           2-50
        2.3.2   What are sources of drinking water contamination? 	              2-52
        2.3.3   What human health effects are associated with drinking contaminated water?	2-52


Table of Contents                                                                                              .

-------
_ .- „ ........... .. ........... ................... ..... 1 ....... .in, ..... iii... ... . ..I ......... i .......... .,) ....... .1 .......... . .'„, ........ ... M. ... ..... ............ ^»*:'?i$j .jg*fe • ^- ™J


    2.4  Recreation in and on the Water	• •	••	•     "   "   ;
         2.4.1   What is the condition of waters supporting recreational use?	r •;	• '    3 ,
         2.4.2   What are sources of recreational water pollution?  	;	• •	    A
         2.4.3   What human health effects are associated with recreation in contaminated waters? ?	.2-54
    2.5  Consumption of Fish and Shellfish 	\	-\-\	''  '   ;
         2.5.1   What is the condition of waters that support consumption offish and shellfish? ...;..;	2-56
         2.5.2   What are contaminants in fish and shellfish, and where do they originate?	;.	•	2-62
         2.5.3   What human health effects are associated with consuming contaminated fish and  shellfish?  	2-62
    2.6  Challenges and Data Gaps 	• •;	:2~  3



  Chapter 3:  Better Protected Land
    3.0   Introduction	•'	

    3.1   Land Use 	'	3"7
          3.1.1    What is the extent of developed lands?  	j	•3"^;
          3.1.2   What is the extent of farmlands?	•	•; • \	f/12.
          3.1.3   What is the extent of grasslands and shrublands?	>	" '    J^
          3.1.4   What is the extent of forest lands?  	r	• • >	' ^71
          3.1.5   What human health effects are associated with land use?  	\	3'21;
          3.1.6   What ecological effects are associated with land use? 		• -\	-y'21
     3.2  Chemicals in the Landscape  	•	 J. i	
          3.2.1   How much and what types of toxic substances are released into the environment?  .1	;	3-24
          3.2.2   What is the volume, distribution, and extent of pesticide use?	-	3-27
          3.2.3   What is the volume, distribution, and extent of fertilizer use?	3'29
           3.2.4   What is the potential disposition of chemicals from land?	i • f • •'	3~30
           3.2.5   What human health effects are associated with pesticides, fertilizers, and toxic substances?	3-37
           i.2.6   What ecological effects are associated with pesticides, fertilizers, and toxic substances?	3-38
     3.3  Waste and Contaminated Lands	• •;	' "3"39
           3.3.1    How much and what types of waste are generated and managed?	;	 .3-40
           3.3.2    What is the extent of land used for,waste management? ..,		• •;	• • -3"45
           3.3.3    What is the extent of contaminated lands?	'> •'•	....'.. .3-47
           3.3.4    What human health effects are associated with waste management and contaminated lands?  	3-50
           3.3.5    What ecological effects are associated with waste management and contaminated lands?   	3-51
     3.4  Challenges and Data Gaps	• •'	3"52



   Chapter 4:  Human Health                                                             . ,
     4.0  Introduction	H		4"3
     4.1   Environmental Pollution and Disease: Links Between Exposure and Health Outcomes	4-7

     4.2  Health Status of the U.S. Compared to the Rest of the World  	t	4-l1

     4.3  Health Status of the U.S.: Indicators and Trends of Health and Disease	,	 .4-17
           4.3.1    What are the trends for life expectancy?  	•! • r	• •'•' '^"^
           4.3.2   What are the trends for cancer, cardiovascular disease, chronic obstructive pulmonary disease, and asthma?4-19
           4.3.3   What are the trends for gastrointestinal illness?	:	- -	:•}••••	.• • A'25
           4.3.4   What are the trends for children's environmental health issues?	:. i.	• • -4-31
           4.3.5   What are the trends for emerging health effects?	;	' • I	• • • -4-38
                                                                                                   TaDle of Contents

-------
    4.4  Measuring Exposure to Environmental Pollution: Indicators and Trends	4-42
         4.4.1   Biomonitoring indicators	;	             4-42
         4.4.2   Data sources for biomonitoring indicators	4.43
         4.4.3   What is the level of exposure to heavy metals?	4-44
         4.4.4   What is the level of exposure to cotinine?	       4.59
         4.4.5   What is the level of exposure to volatile organic compounds?	4-5T
         4.4.6   What is the level of exposure to pesticides?	'.	4.51
         4.4.7   What is the level of exposure to persistent organic pollutants?	4.53
         4.4.8   What are the trends in exposure to environmental pollutants for children?	4.55
         4.4.9   Pollutants for which biomonitoring data are not available	4.57
         4.4.10  Endocrine disruptors-an emerging issue 	4.59
    4.5   Assessing the Environmental Burden of Disease	4_60

    4.6   Challenges and Data Gaps	 „	    4-62



 Chapter 5:   Ecological Condition
    5.0   Introduction	                      5_3

    5.1   Links Between Stressors and Ecological Outcome: A Framework for Measuring Ecological Condition	5-7

    5.2   What is the Ecological Condition of Forests?	5.9

    5.3   What is the Ecological Condition of Farmlands?	5_25

    5.4   What is the Ecological Condition of Grasslands and Shrublands?	5.32

    5.5  What is the Ecological Condition of Urban and Suburban Areas?	5.37

    5.6  What is the Ecological Condition of Fresh Waters?	    .5.41

    5.7  What is the Ecological Condition of Coasts and Oceans?	5.53

   5.8  What is the Ecological Condition of the Entire Nation?	5.54

   5.9  Challenges and Data Gaps	5.74



APPENDIX A:  Databases and Reports Supporting Major Clusters of Indicators Used in the Report with Links for
   Additional Information	A_1

APPENDIX B:  Indicator Metadata	 .B.-|

APPENDIX C:  Acronyms and Abbreviations	C_q

APPENDIX D:  Glossary of Terms	               D_i

APPENDIX E: References	            .E-1

APPENDIX F: Background and Chronology	F_1

APPENDIX G:  Indicator Quality Review Form	G-1

APPENDIX H:  EPA Draft Report on the Environment Expert Review Workshop Evaluation Form	H-l

APPENDIX I: Summary Tables of Questions and Indicators	|_1
Table of Contents
                                                                                                          in

-------
IV

-------
      Fref.
ace
      from trAs Science Advisor and

      Chief Information Officer

      The Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) has been a world
      leader in developing and implementing solutions to the environ-
      mental problems in our air, water and land. Through the years,
      working together with other Federal Agencies we have built a
      significant body of science and knowledge that has influenced
      national and international public policy, and has raised our
      awareness of the value of our environment. Yet, even with the
      enormous wealth of understanding and information that we
      have today, there are still gaps in our ability to adequately mon-
      itor many key indicators in the cascades of events that link our
      efforts to protect the environment to the ultimate outcomes
      we seek: cleaner air, purer water, better protected land, and
      improved human health and ecological condition. To close
      that gap, we need both scientifically sound indicators and the
      national data to support them.

      With the publication of the EPA  Draft Report on the
      Environment, including this comprehensive Technical Document,
      EPA has launched a multi-year effort to improve the state of the
      science and  our knowledge of the state of the environment.
      This effort addresses indicators, monitoring data and models
      for better tracking the impacts of our activities on the environ-
      ment. This document includes indicators that EPA has moni-
      tored for many years, including ambient levels of pollutants in
      air, water and land. However, we recognize that protecting the
      environment ultimately is achieved in terms of human health
      and ecological condition, and these two chapters serve as
      anchors for the entire report.

      The last sections of each chapter of this report describe chal-
      lenges and data gaps associated with its particular subject area.
      Several general issues have emerged that we will address in the
      coming months and years.
     Shifting to an  Outcomes  Framework

     Identifying environmental "outcomes" such as better human
     health and ecological condition requires a significant shift in
     how the Agency frames questions and issues about environ-
                                                       mental quality. The first three chapters of this report; Cleaner
                                                       Air, Purer Water, and  Better Protected Land, ask questions that
                                                       tend to fo.llow traditional Agency efforts to prevent, control, or
                                                       remediate the effects of pollution.  For example:

                                                       H What is the quality of outdoor air in the United States?
                                                       II What are pressures to water quality?

                                                       H What is the extent of developed land?


                                                       The final two chapters on human health and ecological condi-
                                                       tion, ask questions about outcomes, for example:
                                                       II What are the trends for cancer?

                                                       HI What is the ecological condition of coasts and oceans?


                                                       To understand how EPA's mission affects these outcomes, both
                                                       directly and indirectly, requires indicators not only of pollutant
                                                       releases and ambient conditions, but indicators that span the
                                                       chain of events between the release of a pollutant, exposure of
                                                       people, plants and animals, and the chain of events from dose
                                                       to effects.  In the case of human health, factors such  as level of
                                                       health care, natural disease rates, and actual human exposures
                                                       must be factored into an indicator strategy.  For ecological
                                                       systems, indicators are needed that better track hydrology,
                                                       features of the landscape, natural disturbances, ecological.  ,
                                                       processes, and other factors that interact with pollutants to
                                                       ultimately determine  ecosystem condition.
                                                      Availability of Indicators
                                                      For a few of the questions in the report, indicators were
                                                      identified that are available at the national level.  More
                                                      frequently, however, we found that promising indicators have
                                                      been developed and measured for limited geographic areas, or
                                                      for a part of the causal chain.  Further exploration of the
                                                      relationship between measurements used for assessments and
                                                      measurements used for diagnosis of causal factors also is
                                                      needed. Development and testing of national indicators  has
                                                      been a high research priority for EPA's Office of Research and
                                                      Development.
Frefc
   •ace

-------

                                                                            ecnnica
                          fiaXak
                                                                         _1
    Availability of Data
     For each of the indicators, we attempted to gather data of
     sufficient qualify and coverage to support national reporting,
     both within and outside the Agency. Generally, the available
     data were too limited in place and time to describe national
     trends, or even to provide a national snapshot of conditions.
     Because the data from different organizations often serve a
     broad range of purposes, even when data are available
     nationally, gaps remain in the spatial, temporal and
     phenomenological coverage needed to track the outcomes
     of many of EPA's programs. Monitoring networks
     established to address specific issues must be better
     integrated through common definitions, designs, methods,
     and information systems.
(—ollaborating for the Future       ;
                                  I
With this draft as a starting point, we IpOk forward to
collaborating with federal and state agencies to promote
integrated and coherent approaches  ahd| mechanisms for
reporting on the state of the environment. Following the release
of this report, we will be working closely with scientists from
other federal and state agencies and  thejacademic community
to explore how best to improve our ability to measure and
assess environmental conditions.     ]  ;

We  invite all of our stakeholders to lend ;their creativity and
commitment in the months and years ahpd as they join us in
meeting Administrator Whitman's challenge to focus our
resources on the  areas of greatest concern and to manage our
work to achieve measurable results.   '  j                :
     Paul Gilman, Ph.D.
     Science Advisor and Assistant Administrator for Research and
     Development
Kimberly T. Nelson
Chief Information Officer and Assistant Administrator for
Environmental Information             !
VI
                                                                                                                      trerac

-------
 "Participant
 EPA's Science Advisor sincerely acknowledges the help and advice of all the individuals who assisted in developing the Report on the
 Environment Technical Document (TD) 2003 and the Report on the Environment (RQE) 2003.  In particular, the following individuals
 provided critical support:
 ROE Technical Document Leads
 Peter Preuss - ORD
 Denice Shaw - ORD
 Vivian Turner - ORD

 ROE Leads
 Michael Flynn - OEI
 Heather Case - OEI
 Reggie Cheatham - OEI

 EPA Contributors
 Susan Absher - OECA
 Suzanne Annand - OEI
 Tom Armitage - OW
 Deveraux Barnes - OSWER
 Thomas Barnwell (ORD) - Land TD Lead
 David Bayliss - ORD
 Joseph Bergstein - Region 2
 Eric Burman - OSWER
 Paul Bertram - Region 5
 Jeff Bigler - OW
 Patricia Bradley - ORD
 Barry Burgan - OW
 Rebecca Calderon (ORD) - Human Health TD Co-Lead
 Arden Calvert - OCFO
 Pat Childers - OAR
 Ed Chu - OA
 Paul Cocca - OW
 Mark Corbin - OPPTS
 Elizabeth Corr - OW
 Larry Cupitt - ORD
 Denise Cunningham - ORD
 llan Davidovici - OAR
 Wayne Davis - OEI
 Kathleen Deener - ORD
 Tom DeMoss - Region 3
 Fred Dimmick - OAR
 Ron Evans - OAR
 Elissa Feldman - OAR
 Elaine Francis - ORD
 Herman Gibb - ORD
 Chris Cillis - OPPTS
 Eric Ginsburg - OAR-
John Girman - OAR
Anne Grambsch - ORD
 Dave Guinnup - OAR
 Richard Haeuber - OAR
 Michael Hadrick (OAR) - Air TD Lead
 Christine Hartless - OPPTS
 Tom Helms - OAR
 James Hemby - OAR
 Brian Hill - ORD
.Michelle Hiller - OCIR
 Melanie Hoff-OSWER
 Rick Hoffman - OW
 Karen Hogan - ORD
 Joe Hogue - OPPTS
 David Hockey - OSWER
 Scott Ireland - OW
 Elizabeth Jackson - (OEI) ROE Water Lead
 Steve Jarboe - OPPTS
 Taylor Jarnigan-  ORD
 Jennifer Jinot - ORD
 Bruce Jones - ORD
 Marjorie Jones  (OW) - Water TD Lead
 Catherine Joseph - OPPTS
 D'nise Kaalund - OEI
 Karen  Keller - OSWER
 William Kepner - ORD              '
 Aparna Koppikar - ORD
 Charles Kovatch - OW
 Rashmi Lai - OE1
James Lazorchak - ORD
Jane Leggett - OAR
 Fred Leutner - OW
 Barbara Levinson - ORD
 Rick Linthurst - OEI
 Maricruz MaGowan - OSWER
 Deborah Mangis - ORD
 Karen Martin - OAR
Michael McDonald (ORD) - Ecological Condition TD Co-Lead
 Ron McHugh - OPPTS
 Dave McKee - OAR
 Hugh McKinnon - ORD
Dan Melamed - OSWER
Jay Messer (ORD) - Ecological Condition TD Co-Lead
Jennifer McLain - OW
Margree McRae - ORD
Lee Mulkey - ORD
Cindy Sonich-Mullen - ORD
Patricia Murphy - ORD
Tarticipants
                                                     VII

-------

Susan Offerdal - OECA
Tony Olsen - ORD
Jennifer Orme-Zaveleta - ORD
Betty Overton - ORD
Cynthia No!t-Helms - ORD
Dale Pahl - ORD
Doris Price - OAR
Steve Paulsen - ORD
Pasky Pascual- ORD
Jim Pendergast - OW
Dan Petersen - ORD
Jeff Peterson-OW
Michael Plastino - OW
liana Preuss - OPEI
Bruce Pumphrey - OECA
Ravi Rao - Region 4
Stig Regli - OW
Harvey Richmond - OAR
Mary Ross - OAR
Kevin Rosseel - OAR
William Russo - ORD
Vicki Sandiford - OAR
Keith Sargent- OPEI
Joel Scheraga - ORD
Dina Schreinemachers - ORD
                                      Henry Schuver - OSW
                                      Velu Senthill - OEI
                                      Ronald Shafer - (OEI) ROE Air Lead
                                      Heather Shoven- OPPT
                                      Terry Slonecker - ORD            \
                                      Ron Slotkin - ORD                  :
                                      Deborah Srnegal - (OEI) ROE Human Health Lead
                                      Jonathan Smith - ORD
                                      Elizabeth Smith - ORD              j
                                      Chuck Spooner - OW               ;'
                                      Susan Stone' - OAR                 j
                                      James T. Sullivan - OAR
                                      Kevin Summers - ORD
                                      Carol Terris - OPPTS              ;
                                      Sylvia Thomas - OEI
                                      Tim Torma - OPEI                ,  \
                                      Amy Vasu - OAR                 ,
                                      Doreen Vetter - OW
                                      David Vogler - Region 6
                                      James White - OAR
                                      Jim Wickharti -  ORD
                                      Mary Wigginton - ORD
                                      Glenn Williams - OPPTS
                                      Darrell Winner - ORD
                                      Louise Wise - OW                  !
                                      Hal Zenick (ORD) - Human Health TD Co-Lead
 El A  Regional Support
 Thomas Davanzo
 Alice Yeh
 John Armstead
 Cory Berish
 Cynthia Curtis
 William Rhea
 Richard Sumpter
 Gerard Bulanowski
 Nora McGee
 Jon Schweiss
Region-!
Region-2
Region-3
Region-4
Region-5
Region-6
Region-7
Region-8
Region-9
Region-10
 Viii
                                                                                 Tarticipants

-------
   External  Experts
  Peer Review of Indicators  (June 10-12,
  2002)
  Thomas Burke - The Johns Hopkins University, School of Public
    Health; Pew Commission Report
  Keith Harrison - Michigan Environmental Science Board
  Anthony Janetos - The H. John Heinz III Center for Science,
    Economics and the Environment
  Patrick Kinney -  Mailman School of Public Health/ Div Environ
    Health Sciences /Columbia University
  James Listorti - formerly The World Bank
  Robin O'Malley - The H. John Heinz III Center for Science,
    Economics and the Environment
  Ed Rankin  - Ohio University: formerly Ohio EPA
  Phil Singer - University of North Carolina
  William Steen - University of Georgia
  Roger Tankersley - Tennessee Valley Authority
  Robert VanDolah - Marine Resources Research Institute/ South
    Carolina Department of Natural Resources
  Bailus Walker - Howard University Hospital
  Chris Yoder - Ohio University: formerly Ohio EPA

  External Consultation (May 10, 2002)
  Thomas Burke - The Johns Hopkins University, School of Public
    Health
 John Godleski - Harvard School of Public Health
 Anthony Janetos  - World Resources Institute; currently with The H.
   John Heinz III Center for Science, Economics and the Environment
  Daniel Markowitz - Malcolm Pirnie
 Robin O'Malley -  The H. John Heinz III Center for Science,
   Economics and the Environment
 Jonathan Patz - The Johns Hopkins University, School of Public
   Health
 James Pratt - Portland State University
 Thomas Sinks - Department of Health and Human Services/Centers
   for Disease Control and Prevention
 Terry Young - Environmental Defense .Fund

 NRC Consultation  (March 2002)
 David Policansky
 James Reisa
 Members of the Board on Environmental Studies and Toxicology
   Environmental Council of States (ECOS)
   State Indicators Workgroup
   Karen Atkinson - Texas
   Steve Brown - ECOS Executive Director
   Wendy Caperton - Oklahoma
   Christine Epstein - ECOS
   Joe Francis - Nebraska
   Keith Harrison - Michigan
   Linda Haynie - Texas
   Roger Kanerva - Illinois
   Edwin Levine - Florida
   Linda Mazur - California
   Linda McCarty - Missouri
   Leslie McCeorge - New Jersey
   George Meyer - Wisconsin
  Tim Mulholland - Wisconsin
  Arleen O'Donnell - Massachusetts
  Laura Pasquale - Florida
  Greg Pettit - Oregon
  Eileen Pierce - Wisconsin
  Dee Ragsdale - Washington
  Jon Sandoval - Idaho
  Jacqueline Schafer - Arizona
  Barbara Sexton - Pennsylvania
  Val Siebal - California
  Beth Vaughan - California
  Gordon Wegwart - Minnesota
  Clinton Whitney - California
  Bob Zimmerman - Delaware

  Federal  Agency Workgroup
  Alan Hecht - CEQ Lead
  Margot Anderson - Department of Energy
  Aclela Backiel - Department of Agriculture
  Ralph Cantral - National Oceanic and Atmospheric Administration
  Mark Delfs - Department of Agriculture
  George Dunlop - Department of Defense
_  Tyler Duvall - Department of Transportation
  Bill Effland  - Department of Agriculture/Natural Resources
   Conservation Service
 Beverly Getzen - Army Corps of Engineers
 Jimmy Glotfelty - Department of Energy
 James Hanson - Department of the Interior
 Theodore Heintz - Department of the Interior
 Woody Kessel - Department of Health and Human Services
 Linda Lawson - Department of Transportation
 Camille Mittleholtz - Department of Transportation
 Melinda Moore - Department of Health and Human Services/Centers
   for Disease Control and Prevention
Tarticipants
                                                                                                                  IX

-------

Contractor Technical jupport



Technology Planning and Management
Corporation (TPMC) & Perot Systems
Government Services (PSGS)


Ross and Associates Environmental

Consulting, Ltd.

Science Applications International

Corporation


FTN & Associates, Ltd.

Environmental Management Consulting


Eastern Research Group, Inc.


WESTAT

Independent Consultants and Editors
- Ellen Chu
- Anne Ruffner Edwards
- Barbara Shapiro
- June Taylor
                                                                     Participants

-------
  Introduction
  "When I leave office, I want to be able to say that America's air is cleaner,
  its water is purer, and its land better protected than it was when I arrived.
  As we seek to achieve this goal, EPA needs to be accountable for our
  stewardship."
  Christine Todd Whitman, Administrator, U.S. Environmental
  Protection Agency

  In November 2001, EPA Administrator Christine Todd Whitman
  directed the Agency to bring together its national, regional and
  program office data to produce a report on the "state of the
  environment." The report would represent the first step of the
  Environmental Indicators Initiative, a multi-year process that would
  ultimately allow future EPA administrators to better measure and
  report on progress toward environmental and human health goals
  and to ensure the Agency's accountability to the public.

 To produce this report, EPA's Office of Research and Development
  (ORD) and Office of Environmental Information (OEI) led a
 collaborative effort to identify the key questions to be answered by
 the report, to identify an initial set of indicators, and to develop a
 process for reviewing and selecting the indicators and supporting
 data to be included in the final report. This task was accomplished
 thanks to the efforts of numerous EPA staff, representatives from
 other federal agencies, representatives from the states and tribes,
 and external advisors and reviewers. The indicators and supporting
 data used in this report were generated by EPA and other federal,
 state, tribal, regional, local, and non-governmental organizations. The
 Council on Environmental Quality in the Executive Office of the
 President was helpful throughout in coordinating interagency
 contributions to the project.

 EPA's Draft Report on the Environment (ROE) consists of this Technical
 Document and a version of the report for general reading. These
 reports pose national questions about the environment and human
 health  and answer those questions wherever scientifically sound
 indicators and high-quality supporting data are available. The reports
 both pose questions and present indicators related  to:
 • Cleaner Air
 • Purer Water
 • Better Protected Land                  :
 • Human Health
 • Ecological Condition

 This Draft Technical Document discusses the limitations of the
 currently available indicators and data, and the gaps and challenges
 that must be overcome to provide better answers in the future.

 For a few indicators, data are available that are truly representative of
the entire nation. For other indicators,  data currently are available for
only one region (such as the East Coast or the Northwest), but the
 indicator could obviously be applied nationally if the data were
 available. Based on the availability of supporting data, indicators
 that were selected and  included in this report were assigned to one
 of two categories:
 •I Category 1 -The indicator has been peer reviewed and is
   supported by national level data coverage for more than one time
   period.  The supporting data are comparable across the nation
   and are characterized by sound collection methodologies, data
   management systems, and quality assurance procedures.
 • Category 2 -The indicator has been peer reviewed, but the
   supporting data are available only for part of the nation (e.g.,
   multi-state regions or ecoregions), or the indicator has not been
   measured for more than one time period, or not all the parameters
   of the indicator have been measured (e.g., data has been collected
   for birds, but not for plants or insects). The supporting data are
   comparable across the areas covered, and are characterized by
   sound collection methodologies, data management systems, and
   quality assurance procedures.

 This report is part of EPA's continuing effort to identify, improve,
 and utilize environmental indicators in its planning, management,
 and public reporting. EPA's specific strategies and performance
 targets to protect human health and the environment are presented
 in the Agency's strategic and annual plans. These planning and
 performance documents, together with the questions, indicators
 and data presented in these reports, will allow EPA to better define
 and measure  the status and trends in environment and .health, and
 to better measure the effectiveness of its programs and activities.

 This technical report is a draft, intended to elicit comments and
 suggestions on the approach and findings. To learn more about
 EPA's Draft Report on the Environment and the Environmental
 Indicators Initiative, and to provide comments and feedback, please
visit .
Introduction
                                                                                                                             XI

-------

-------


  «   ,   .       „ *
f*?"   **   ^    4itfJ-i,^'
tf|^fe'lSfc

 l"'''t           1* •"—••   ^^
                           ff'S      V*  !
                       ,  ft*-" Trf*  *»  W-
                      »Jfr5"  *h  *AW^-W

                    1   v  W*i  ^**3

-------
indicators that were selected and included in this chapter were assigned to one oi[two categories:            •
• Category 1 -The indicator has been peer reviewed and is supported by nationallevel data coverage for more than one time period.
  The supporting data are comparable across the nation and are characterized by^sound collection methodologies, data management
  systems, and quality assurance procedures.                                 i                          !
• Category 2 -The indicator has been peer reviewed, but the supporting data ai|e available only for part of the nation (e.g., multi-state
  regions or ecoregions), or the indicator has not been  measured for more than 
-------
  1.0   Introduction
  In 1970, Congress responded to concern over visible air pollution,
  irritating smog, and associated health and ecological effects by
  enacting the federal Clean Air Act (CAA). As a result, total national
  emissions of the six criteria air pollutants decreased by 25 percent
  between 1970 and 2001. Emissions of air toxics have declined as
  well, dropping 24 percent between 1990 and 1993 (the baseline
  period) and 1996. One of the major components of acid rain, wet
  sulfate deposition, has also decreased substantially (EPA, OAQPS,
  September 2002).

  These improvements occurred during a time of significant growth in
  the nation's population and economy: from 1970 to 2001, the Gross
  Domestic Product (GDP) increased by 161 percent, the number of
  people increased from about  203 million to more than 280 million,
 energy consumption increased by 42 percent, and vehicle miles
 traveled increased by 149 percent (Exhibit 1 -1)  (EPA, OAQPS,
 September 2002).
  txnibit 1-1: Comparison of growth measures and
                          1970-2001
                                               emission
                                                       trends
   200
 olSO
 r^
 OS
 .1—

, *100
!  ° SO
   -so
                >'*"
                                     161%
                                      49%
                                     -25%
     70  80  90  95  96  97
.iSource: EPA, Office of Air Quality Planning and Standards. Latest Findings on National
i Air Quality: 2001 Status and Trends. September 2002.

Despite progress toward cleaner air, in 2001  more than 133 million
people lived in counties where monitored air qualify was unhealthy
at times because of high levels of at least one criteria air pollutant
(EPA, OAQPS, September 2002). Even after decades of regulation
and emissions control, certain air quality problems persist. In
particular, ozone and particulate matter are the criteria pollutants
most often found' at levels above national health-based standards.
 Outdoor air is not the nation's only air quality concern. The levels
 of pollutants in the air inside homes, schools, and other buildings
 can be higher than in the outdoor air. Uncertainty remains about
 levels of indoor air pollutants, such as radon and environmental
 tobacco smoke.

 Changes to stratospheric ozone levels are also concerns. The
 stratospheric ozone layer has become substantially thinner in recent
 decades, although scientists generally believe it will recover over the
 next several decades as a result of international controls (Scientific
 Assessment Panel, 2003).

 This chapter summarizes the current status and trends in air quality,
 the pressures affecting air quality, and information regarding human
 health and ecological effects. It poses fundamental questions about
 air quality, contributors to pollution, and  health and ecological
 effects, and it uses indicators drawn from  well-reviewed data sources
 to help answer those questions. Exhibit 1  -2 lists these questions
 and  indicators, as well as the number of the chapter section where
 each indicator is  presented.

 The  chapter is divided into six main  sections:
 • Section 1.1 discusses the quality of outdoor air.
 H Section 1.2 provides information  about acid deposition.
 Hi Section 1.3 examines the quality of air  inside homes, schools, and
   other buildings.
 Bl Section 1.4 focuses on stratospheric ozone.
H Section 1.5 briefly addresses climate change research plans.
• Section 1.6 reviews the challenges and  data gaps that remain in
   assessing the nation's air quality.
Chapter I - Cleaner Air
                                                        1.0 Introduction
                                                                                                                            1-3

-------

                                                                           *»«'( "I""
                            Chapter 1:  Cleaner Air -  Question^ and Indicators

                                                   Outdoor Air Quality   r
                                                                                                   IT-
                                                       Acid Deposition
   What are the deposition rates of pollutants that cause
   acid rain?
  What are the emissions of pollutants that form acid rain?
   What ecological effects are associated with
   acid deposition?
                                                       Deposition: wet sulfate and wet nitrogen
                                                       Emissions (utility): sulfur dioxide and nitrogen oxides
No Category 1  or 2 indicators identified
Also see Ecological Condition chapter

BilllillllM illilBlllllllllililllillfPlw' !• •llllillllllill •••••••••ItlMIPHMBBl
What is the quality of outdoor air in the United States?
(See also following four questions)
- How many people are living in areas with particulate matter
and ozone levels above the National Ambient Air Quality
Standards (NAAQS)?
- What are the concentrations of some criteria air
pollutants: PM^, PM, 0, ozone, and lead?
- What arc the impacts of air pollution on visibility in
national parks and other protected lands?
- What are the concentrations of toxic air pollutants in
ambient air?
Wjiat contributes to outdoor air pollution?
(See also following three questions)
- What are contributors to particulate matter,
ozone, and lead in ambient air?
- What are contributors to toxic air pollutants in
ambient air?
- To what extent is U.S. air quality the result of pollution
from other countries, and to what extent does U.S. air
pollution affect other countries?
What human health effects are associated with
outdoor air pollution?
What ecological effects are associated with outdoor
air pollution?
Number and percentage of clays that metropolitan
statistical areas (MSAs) have Air Quality Index (AQI) values
greater than 100 ,
Number of people living in areas with air quality levels ,
above the NAAQS for particulate matter (PM) and ozone
Ambient concentrations of particulate matter: PM2.s and
PM10 '
Ambient concentrations of ozone: 8-hour and 1 -hour
Ambient concentrations of lead '.
Visibility
Ambient concentrations of selected air toxics :
See emissions indicators j '
Emissions: particulate matter (PM2.s and PM10) •
sulfur dioxide, nitrogen oxides, and
volatile organic compounds
Lead emissions ,
Air toxics emissions j
No' Category 1 or 2 indicators identified
No Category 1 or 2 indicsitors identified
Also see Human Health chapter
No Category 1 or 2 indicators identified
Also see Ecological Condition chapter
.

2
1
1
1
1
1
2

2
2
2



1.1.1
1.1.1.3
1.1. l.b
1 .1 .1 .b j
1.1. 1.b
1.1. l.c
1.1. l.d
1.1.2
1.1.2.a
1.1.2.3
1 .1 .2.b
1.1 .2.c
1.1.3
1.1.4
                                                                                                                     1.2.1
                                                                                                                     1.2.2
                                                                                                                     1.2.3
1-4
                                                        1.0 Introduction
                                            IQInapter 1 - CJeaner Air

-------
                         Chapter I:  Cleaner Air  -  Questions and  Indicators (continued)
                                                           Indoor Air Quality
     What is the quality of the air in buildings in the United States?
                                                             U.S. homes above EPA's radon action levels
  Percentage of homes where young children are
  exposed to environmental tobacco smoke
                                                                                                                              1.3.1
                                                                                                                              1.3.1
     What contributes to indoor air pollution?
                                                             No Category 1 or 2 indicators identified
                                                             Also see Human Health chapter
     What human health effects are associated with
     indoor air pollution?
  No Category 1 or 2 indicators identified
  Also see Human Health chapter
                                                          Stratospheric O.
                zone
     What are the trends in the Earth's ozone layer?
 Ozone levels over North America
                                                                                                                              1.4.1
     What is causing changes to the ozone layer?
 Worldwide and U.S. production of ozone-depleting
 substances (ODSs)
                                                            Concentrations of ozone-depleting substances (effective
                                                            equivalent chlorine)
                                                                  1.4.2
                                                                                                                              1.4.2
     What human health effects are associated
     with stratospheric ozone depletion?
 No Category 1 or 2 indicators identified
                                                                  1.4.3
    What ecological effects are associated with stratospheric
    ozone depletion?
 No Category 1 or 2 indicators identified
                                                                  1.4.4
Cnapter I - Cleaner Air
1.0 Introduction
                                                                                                                                  1-5

-------
1.1  Outdoor  Air  Quality

Among the pollutants affecting outdoor air quality are:
• Criteria pollutants-ozone (O3), particulate matter (PM),
  sulfur dioxide (SO2), nitrogen dioxide (NO2), carbon monoxide
  (CO), and lead.
• Air toxics-pollutants such as  mercury and benzene.

Under the Clean Air Act, EPA and states collect data on the six crite-
ria air pollutants to measure compliance with National Ambient Air
Quality Standards (NMQS) (Exhibit 1-3). "Primary" NAAQS are set
to protect public health with an adequate margin of safety, and "sec-
ondary" NAAQS protect against adverse welfare effects (e.g., effects
on vegetation, ecosystems, visibility, manmade  materials) (42 U.S.C.
7408 and 7409). After initially adopting NAAQS for each of the cri-
teria air pollutants in the 1970s, EPA has periodically reviewed and
sometimes revised the standards. EPA recently revised the health-
based standard for ozone and added a new standard for fine PM2.s
based on new health studies (EPA, 2003; EPA,  1997).

Criteria air pollutants are monitored through the National Air
Monitoring Stations/State or Local Air Monitoring Stations network.
This network  consists of more than 5,000 monitors operating at
 3,000 sites across the  country, mostly in urban areas (EPA, OAQPS,
 September 2002). Measurements are taken on both a daily and
                                                     continuous basis to assess both peak concentrations and overall
                                                     trends, and are reported in the Air Quality Subsystem (AQS)
                                                     database. In addition to other uses, EPA analyzes these air quality
                                                     measurements to designate areas as either attainment or nonattain-
                                                     ment for specific criteria air pollutants '(i.je., determines if air quality
                                                     levels in an area violate the NAAQS).

                                                     While air quality data on criteria air pollutants are ample, national
                                                     data on air toxics concentrations are limited. Several metropolitan
                                                     areas measure ambient air toxics concentrations, but there are few
                                                     standards by which to evaluate levels of Concern. In addition,
                                                     cumulative or synergistic impacts of various air pollutants are  not
                                                     well understood.

                                                     Visibility is another outdoor air concern.; Some data on this aspect of
                                                     air quality are available from the Interagency Monitoring of Protected
                                                     Visual Environments (IMPROVE) network, which collects data to
                                                     characterize! visibility at national parks arid other protected areas.

                                                     This section addresses the following specific questions about
                                                     outdoor air  quality:
                                                     • What is the quality of outdoor air ih the United States? (Section
                                                        1.1.1)                             ;
                                                        A How many people are living in areajs with particulate matter and
                                                          ozone levels above the NAAQS?   i
                                                                                                       i  i  -
                Exnitit 1-3: National Ambient Air Quality Standards (NAAQS) in effect as of February 2003
    CO


    Pb

    NO2

    03


    PM,0
           8-hourb
           1 -hourb

   Maximum Quarterly Average

     Annual Arithmetic Mean
   9 ppm (10 mg/m3)
  35 ppm (40 mg/m3)
 No Secondary Standard
 No Secondary Standard
                     r"-~  -  —T* r
      1.5 pg/rn^

0.053 ppm (100 pg/m3)
Same as Primary Standard
                                                                              ry i
     S02
  Maximum Daily 1 -hour Averagec
4th Maximum Dailyd 8-hour Average

     Annual Arithmetic Mean
           24-houre
     Annual Arithmetic Mean^
           24-hourS

     Annual Arithmetic Mean
           24-hourb           :
'"O.'li'ppm (235 pg/m3)
 0.08 ppm (157 pg/m3)
 Same as Primary Standard

Ija'me as Primary Standard
 Ijame'as Primary Standard
       50 pg/m3
      150 pg/m3
       15 pg/m3
       65 |Jg/m3
 Siame as Primary Standard
 Same as Primary Standard    ^
 Same as Primary Standard
 Sfame as Primary Standard
  0.03 ppm (80 MgAn3)
  0.14 ppm (365 pg/m3)
                                                                                            I
                        rf
                                           d Three,year average of the innual 4th h.ghest daily niax.mum '8-hour concentrat.on
                                           e The short-term (24-hour) standard of ISO pg/m3 is not to be exceeded more than
                                             on average over three years                          (
                                           f Spatially averaged over devgnated monitors
               l value h an approximately equivalent concentration. (See
      40 CFR Part SO).
    b Not to be exceeded more than once per year.
    c The standard is attained when the expected number of days per calen-
      dar yew with maximum hourly average concentrations above 0.12 ppm  g The form is the 98th perccntile
      0, equal to or less than one, as determined according to Appendix H of
      the Ofoat NAAQS.
    Source: Based on EPA, Office of Air Quality Planning and Standards. National Air Quality and Em&sions Trends Report, 1999 March 2001
          I

_  t     _-t.


once per year
  1-6
                                                        1.1  Outdoor Air Quality
                                                                                        ; Chapter I  - Cleaner Air

-------
    A What are the concentrations of some criteria air pollutants:
       PM2 5, PM10, ozone, and lead?
    A What are the impacts of air pollution on visibility in national
       parks and other protected lands?
    A What are the concentrations of toxic air pollutants in
       ambient  air?
   • What contributes to outdoor air pollution? (Section 1.1.2)
    A What are contributors to particulate matter, ozone, and lead
       in ambient air?
    A What are contributors to toxic air pollutants in ambient air?
    A To what extent is U.S. air quality the result of pollution from
      other countries, and to what extent does U.S. air pollution
      affect other countries?
   I What human health effects are associated with outdoor air
    pollution? (Section 1.1.3)
   I What ecological effects are associate^ with outdoor air pollution?
    (Section 1.1.4)
    Indicator
    Number and percentage of days that metropolitan statistical
    areas (MSAs) have Air Quality Index (AQI) values greater
    than 100
 The nation's air quality has generally improved, as indicated by
 trends derived by averaging the direct measurements from the
 nation's criteria air pollutant monitoring stations on a yearly basis. In
 general, air pollution concentrations are declining, and overall air
 quality is  improving (EPA, OAQPS, September 2002).
                Most areas of the U.S. now have concentrations of NO2, SO2, CO,
                and lead that are below the level of the NAAQS (EPA, OAQPS,
                September 2002). However, ozone levels are above the level of the
                standard in many heavily populated areas, including many of the
                urban areas in the eastern half of the U.S. and in most of the urban
                areas in California (EPA, OAQPS, March 2001). Concentrations of
                PM2.S—particles less than or equal to 2.5 micrometers in diame-
                ter—are above the level of the standard in much of the eastern U.S.
                and parts of California (EPA, OAQPS, September 2002).

                It is important to recognize that while the national trend is toward
                cleaner air, regional and local conditions can vary quite greatly.
                This report focuses on national status and trends, but regional and
                local conditions should be evaluated as well, with the  goal of under-
                standing regional air quality conditions and trends and improving air
                quality in those areas where air quality does not meet the standards.

               A number of indicators, described on the following pages, help
               to answer the questions posed in this section about outdoor
               air quality:
               ffl Number and percentage of days that Metropolitan  Statistical
                 Areas (MSAs) have Air Quality Index (AQI) values greater
                 than 100
               81 Number of people living in areas with air quality levels above the
                 NAAQS for particulate matter and ozone
               il Ambient concentrations of particulate matter: PM2S and PM10
               •I Ambient concentrations of ozone: 8-hour and 1 -hour
               ii! Ambient concentrations of lead
               H Visibility
               • Ambient concentrations of selected air toxics
               • Emissions of particulate matter (PM2 5 and PM10), sulfur dioxide,
                 nitrogen oxides, and volatile organic compounds
               H Lead emissions
               H Air toxics emissions
Cnapter 1 - Cleaner Air
1.1 Outdoor Air Quality
                                                                                                                            1-7

-------
           _____,	,_|     i , i ir - ,-:-.-|.-T-.	, nmr i-i-r"'-rr In ir I 'II-i 1 in-	-"i-7 'Hfi"!™	""'liiimniii.	mill	liiliil«»»gamiMl»l|lW«:Mm
            Number and  percentage of days tnat metropolitan
            Index (AQI) values greater  ^
One measure of outdoor air quality is the daily AQI, which is
based on concentrations of five of the criteria air pollutants:
ozone, PM, CO, SO2, and NO2. The AQI indicates how clean or
polluted the air is and the associated health concerns. It focuses
on the health effects that can occur within a few hours or days
after breathing polluted air. AQI data are compiled by state and
local agencies and must be reported in metropolitan statistical
areas (MSAs) with populations of more than 350,000 (EPA,
OAQPS, March 2001).

AQI values range from 0 to 500, with higher numbers indicating
more air pollution and more potential risk to public health. An AQI
value of 100 generally corresponds to the short-term public
health standard set by EPA for a particular pollutant. Values below
 100 are generally thought of as satisfactory. However, unusually
sensitive individuals may experience health effects when AQI val-
 ues are between 50 and 100. Values above 100 suggest increas-
 ingly unhealthy air, sensitive population groups, such as children,
 the elderly, and those With respiratory illnesses, are likely to be
 among the first affected as the values increase.

 The AQI scale is divided into six categories, each, color-coded to
 correspond to a different level of health concern. For example,
 • The color green is associated with "good" air quality or an AQI
   from 0 to SO.
 • Yellow or "moderate"—51 to 100.
 II Orange or "unhealthy for sensitive groups"—101 to 150.
 • Red or "unhealthy"—151  to 200.
 • Purple or "very unhealthy"—201  to 300.    			_._	
 • Maroon or "hazardous"—301  to 500. AQI
   values over 300 would trigger health warn-
   ings of emergency conditions for the entire  '-
    population (EPA, OAQPS, March 2001).     :
  The highest AQI value for an individual pollu-
  tant becomes the AQI value for that area for
  that particular day. For example, if on a day a
  certain area had AQI values of 150 for ozone
  and 120 for PM, the AQI value would be  150
  for the pollutant ozone on that day. However,
  for all pollutants above 100, the appropriate
  sensitive groups would be cautioned. Ozone
  levels most often drive the AQI, but experts
  anticipate that PM2.s will also be a key driver
  of the AQI in coming years.

  The AQI is useful in communicating to the
  public the air quality in a specific area on a
  given day and the potential health effects and
                    statisl ical areas
               actions to avoid exposure and reduce harfnful impacts. Nationally,
               the number and percentage of days with ^Ql values of more than
               100 gives a sense of the number of days that are potentially
               unhealthy for sensitive populations.
                                                  i
               What the Data Show    ;
                                                  I r
               This indicator is the annual sum of the Intjmber of days, and per-
               centage of days, with AQI values above IpO across all MSAs with
               a population greater than 500,000. To assess trends, the number
               of days is adjusted to reflect changes in air quality standards or
               criteria for the number of MSAs reporting.

                Between 1988 and 2001, the number of jdays with an AQI of 100
                or greater decreased from approximately ,3,300  days to approxi-
                mately 1,000 days. In 1989 and after, the number of days with an
                AQI of 100 or greater ranged between 1 ;000 and 2,000. Based
                on EPA AQI data, the percentage of days! across the country with
                AQI values .ibove 100 dropped from aimpst 10  percent in 1988
                to  3 percent in 2001  (Exhibit 1 -4) (EPA^ OAQPS, December
                1998; EPA, OAQPS, 2001).          i

                indicator Gaps and  Limitations

                Limitations of this indicator include the following:
                9 The data for this indicator are associated with large  MSAs only
                   (500,000 people or more); therefore! the data tend to reflect
                   urban air quality.
                                                  5  1
                          ,.,.                         h
   Exhibit 1-4: Number and percentage of days with Air Quality Index
            I       (AQl)Jeater than 100,1988-2001	
I
                                            Number: of Days
                                            Percent|of Total Days
                                                                          •3
Note: Data are for MSAs > 500,000  [w^ ;••••"     _             ,
Source- Data useS to create graphic aff Sawn from EPA, Office of Air Quality Planning a'nd "Standards.
National Air Quality and Emissions Trenmeporl, ^97. Table A-15. December, 1998; EPA, Office of Air
Quality Planning and Standards. Air trepfis: 'Metropolitan area trends, Table A-17, 2001. (February 25,
1-8
                                                    1.1 Outdoor Air Quality
                                                  'Chapter 1 - Cleaner Air

-------

                Numbg^d pereentage of (Jays tliat m
                Index: (AQl) values greater than 100- Category 2 (continued1)                ',.
                 _—__—_i___	•"••"—"""'^'^i'»i>««»^~""«=''"^^
      This composite AQl indicator does not identify the pollutants
      of concern-that is, it does not show which pollutant(s) are
      causing the days with an AQl of more than 100, or which
      ones have decreased and are responsible for an improvement
      in the AQl.
      This composite AQl indicator does not show which areas, or
      how many areas, have problems-a specific number of days
      could reflect a few areas with persistent problems or many
      areas with occasional problems.
              Data Source

              The data sources for this indicator were "Air Trends: Metropolitan
              area trends," Table A-17, EPA, 2001, and National Air Quality and
              Emissions Trends Report, 1997, Table A-15, EPA, 1998. (See
              Appendix B, page B-2, for more information.)
                                                                In 2001, more than 133 million Americans (of a total population
                                                                of 281 million) lived in counties where monitored outdoor air quality
                                                                was unhealthy at times because of high levels (levels above the
                                                                NAAQS) of at least one criteria air pollutant (EPA, OAQPS,
                                                                September 2002). Ozone and PM remain the most persistent
                                                                criteria pollutants.
   Indicator
   Number of people living in areas with air quality levels above
   the NAAQS for particulate matter (PM) and ozone
               Number of people living in areas witk air quality levels above trie NAAQS for
               particulate matter  (fAAT and ozone-Category I

   The number of people living in areas above the level of the health-
   based NAAQS gives some indication of the number of people
   potentially exposed to unhealthy air.

   What the Data  Show

   Despite trends of decreasing concentrations of criteria pollutants,
   many people still live in areas with air quality levels above the
   health-based standards for ozone and PM. In 2001,  11.1  million
   people lived in counties with air quality concentrations that at
   times were above the NAAQS for PM10, and 72.7 million people
   lived in counties with air quality concentrations above the stan-
   dard for PM2.5- Some 40.2 million people lived in counties with
              concentrations that at times were above the 1 -hour ozone stan-
              dard, and 110.3 million people lived in counties with concentra-
              tions above the 8-hour ozone standard (Exhibit 1 -5) (EPA,
              OAQPS, September 2002).

              indicator Gaps and Limitations

              Limitations of this indicator include the following:
              B The indicator helps in understanding the number of people
               potentially affected by air quality problems, but it does not tell
               the actual number of people exposed to unhealthy air. Not all
               counties have complete monitoring data, so some areas may be
               excluded. However, the areas of most concern are likely covered.
Chapter 1 - Cleaner Air
1.1  Outdoor Air Quality
1-9

-------
Indicator
Number of people living in areas with air quality levels a|p/e the NAAQS for
participate matter (PM) and ozone - Category 1
         Exhibit 1-5: People living in areas with air quality
       above the National Ambient Air Quality Standards
                      (NAAQS)in2001
            Nitrogen
             Dioxide  °
              Ozone


        Sulfur Dioxide  rj.007
           Particulate
      Matter (Si Opro)
           Particulate
      Matter (S2,5(im)
             Carbon „
           Monoxide |j °-7
               Lead

                Any
             NAAQS
                                                   • The indicator does not tell the amount; or extent to which dif-
                                                     ferent areas exceed the standards, and |so does not provide any
                                                     specific exposure data.

                                                   Data Sources                 ;

                                                   The data source for this indicator was Latest Findings on National
                                                   Air Quality: 2,001 Status and Trends, EPA, 2002. (See Appendix B,
                                                   page B-3, for more information.)
                                SO           TOO
                                 Millions of People
                                                          ISO"
   Source; EPA, Office of Air Quality Planning and Standards. Latest Findings on National
   Mr Quality; 2001 Stalin and Trends. September 2002.
   Indicators
   Ambient concentrations of particulate matter PM2.s and PM-|0
   Ambient concentrations of ozone: 8-hour and 1 -hour
   Ambient concentrations of lead
                                                    reductions in SO2, CO, and lead levels (Exhibit 1 -6) (EPA, OAQPS,
                                                    September 2002). However, PM2.s and ozone concentrations are
                                                    above the NAAQS in many areas, potentially exposing a significant
                                                    percentage of the U.S. population to unhealthy air (EPA, OAQPS,
                                                    September 2002).                 i  ;
                                                                                       j
                                                    The data for national levels of criteria pollutants tell only part of the
                                                    story. Although significant improvements; have been occurring
                                                    nationally and regionally, some areas still have chronic air quality
                                                    problems. The Northeast, for example, experiences frequent and
                                                    widespread violations of the ozone heaUjh-based standard
                                                    (Northeast States for Coordinated Air Use Management, 2002).
Three indicators, presented on the following pages, are available to
help answer this question: ambient concentrations of particulate
matter, ambient concentrations of ozone (8-hour and 1 -hour), and
ambient concentrations of lead. Concentrations of the criteria air
pollutants have decreased over the past 2 decades, with substantial
1-10
                                       1.1 Outdoor Air Quality
Chapter I  - Cleaner Air

-------
                       Ti
              -100%
         Jg
         u
              -60%
              -40%
              -20%
                                Exhibit 1-6: Percent reduction in concentration of six criteria air pollutants
                                            regulated under the Clean Air Act, 1982-2001
                        Particulate
                         Matter
                         (PM10>
                                    Ozone
                                   (1-hour)
                            Ozone
                            (8-hour)
                                     ^^


                                                                                       e^^er 2002.

ient concentrations of particulate matter^f'AA^
                                                                            an
                                                                                           - C
 Particulate matter concentrations are a good indication of air
 quality health effects, because of concerns about associated
 respiratory effects. This indicator is based on the annual average
 concentrations, in micrograms per cubic meter ((Jg/rn3) of PM2 s
 and PM10. PM10 refers to particles 10 micrometers or less in
 diameter, and PM2.S  refers to particles less than or equal to 2.5
 micrometers  in  diameter.

 Trends in PM10 are presented from 1992 to 2001, and compara-
 ble PM2 s data  have been collected since 1999 (EPA, OAQPS,
 September 2002).

 What the Data Show

 Concentrations of PM10 decreased by 14 percent between 1992
 and 2001 (Exhibit 1 -7), and are below the NAAQS standard
 concentration in most areas. Concentrations of PM2.5 are above
 the level  of the annual standard in much of the eastern U.S. and
 parts of California (Exhibit 1 -8) (EPA, OAQPS, September 2002).
Annual average PM2.S concentrations are generally higher in the
eastern U.S. than in the West, mostly because sulfate COncentta-
tions are four to five times higher in the eastern U.S. (largely due
to coal-fired power plants) (EPA, OAQPS, September 2001).
Chapter I -  Cleaner Air
                                                                      eo
                                                                  -•ib 40
                                                                  tf .-=>.
                                                                  Ft 30
                                                                   2
                                                                  '7 
-------
                               ^	        - ,BMa^^

            Ambient concentrations of particulate matter: PM2 5
                                                                                                                  \
Indicator Gaps and Limitations

Limitations of this indicator include the following (EPA, OAQPS,
September 2002):
• Ten-year trend data for PM10 are not available before 1990,
  because total suspended particulates, which include particle
  sizes larger than PM10, were monitored until 1990.
• The monitoring is conducted mostly in urban areas,
  although the PM2.S data from the IMPROVE network support
  assessments of rural trends from 1992 to 1999.
                                                        Data  Source

                                                        The data source for this indicator was Latest Findings on National
                                                        Air Quality: 2007 Status and Trends, EPA, 2002. (See Appendix B,
                                                        page B-3, for more information.)
                       Exhibit 1-8:2001 annual average particulate matter ff/W.s) concentrations
           Mkrograms per Cubic Meter (Mg/m3)
           • >20
           B15-20
           B12-1S
            B Do not meet minimum data completeness.
             Minimum 1 1 samples per calendar quarter required.
            D Data unavailable.

            PM2.5 Standard (annual arithmetic mean) is 1 5 pg/m3
                                                                                            ber 200
Source: EPA, Office of Air Quality Planning and Standards. Latest Findings on National Air Qual.ty. 20^Status and T««h September 2002  ^

 1-12
                                                    1.1  Outdoor Air Quality
                                                                                           Chapter 1  - Cleaner Air

-------
                  Ambient concentrations of ozone: 8-nour
     Ozone is one of six criteria pollutants regularly monitored under
     the CM to determine compliance with health-based standards.
     This indicator reflects ambient concentrations in parts per million
     (ppm) of ground- level ozone from 1982 to 2001, based on
     1 -hour and 8-hour measurements to gauge shorter-term and
     longer-term levels.

     The 1 -hour standard is useful in measuring potential effects
     during short-term "spikes" in concentrations. The longer 8-hour
     standard is used in evaluating exposures occurring over a more
     sustained period of time (e.g., an outdoor worker's exposure
     over the  course of a work day).

     What the Data Show

    Although ozone concentrations are generally decreasing,  they
    are higher than the  NAAQS in many areas. Ground-level ozone
    concentrations fell by 11 percent between 1982 and 2001,
    based on the annual fourth highest daily maximum 8-hour
    average (Exhibit 1-9). Ozone levels based on the  annual second
    highest daily maximum 1 -hour standard fell by 18 percent during
    the same time (Exhibit 1 -10). All regions experienced some
    improvement in  8-hour ozone levels during the past 20 years
    except the north central region (EPA Region 7), which showed
    little change (Exhibit 1 -11) (EPA, OAQPS, September 2002).
   j"         Exhibit 1-9: Ozone air quality, 1Q82-20O1
   fj          cased On annual Utri maximum 8-ric
   it-  0.20,	:	__
         i maximum 8-hour average
   ;;§- o.i s
   j \o_ .
    £ 0.-10
   is
      0.05
      0.00
90% of sites have concentrations below this line
                1 0% of sites have concentrations below this line
         82 83 84 SS 86 87 88 89 90 91  92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 00
                                                           01.
                        1982-01: 11% decrease
                        1992-01:  'o%  change
     Coverage: 379 monitoring sites nationwide with sufficient data to assess trends.
     Source: EPA, Office of Air Quality Planning and Standards. Litest Findings on National
   :  Air Quality. 2001 Status and Trends. September 2002.
Chapter 1 -  Cleaner Air
                                             and l-nour - Category 1
                                             a^£"J*i~jlli-8"s""*i!^^

                                                indicator Gaps  and Limitations

                                                Limitations of this indicator include the following:
                                                HI Ground-level ozone is not emitted directly into the air, but is
                                                  formed by the reaction of volatile organic compounds (VOCs)
                                                  and nitrogen oxides (NOX) in the presence of heat and
                                                  sunlight, particularly in hot summer weather. To assess ozone
                                                  trends, VOC and NOX emissions and meteorological
                                                  information are also evaluated.  •
                                               II The monitoring is conducted mostly in urban areas;
                                                  therefore, data may not accurately encompass rural impacts
                                                 from ozone transport.

                                               Data Source

                                               Jhe data source for this indicator was Latest Findings on National
                                               Air Quality: 2001 Status and Trends, EPA, 2002. (See Appendix B,
                                               page B-3, for more information.)
- Exhibit I-1O: Ozone air quality, I982-20OI
  .  baser] on annual 2nd maximum I-hour average
                                                                                90% of sites have concentrations below this line
                                                                               1 0% of sites have concentrations below this line
                                                                         .'82.8.3.84 85,86.87 88 89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 00 0 }~
                                                                   1982-01:  18%. decrease
                                                                   1992-01   3% decrease,
                                              ~ Coverage: 379 monitoring sites nationwide with sufficient data to assess trends.
                                              -  Source EPA, Office of Air Quality Planning and Standards. Latest Findings on National
                                                       2001 Status and Trends September 2002.
                               1.1 Outdoor Air Quality
                                                                                                                           1-13

-------
             Ambient concentrations of ozone: 8-nour and 1-hour -iCftegory \_(continued)               ;
               Exhibit 1-H: Trends in ozone levels (8-Kour), 1Q82-2OO1, awraged across EPA regions
                                                                                            .112   -
                                      .090
            072151 fc* join.
               ^-
      C3 EPA Region 10
      CU EPA Region 9
      C3 EPA Region 8
      EH EPA Region 7
      O EPA Region 6
      E9 EPA Region 5
      C3 EPA Region 4
      C3 EPA Region 3
      "* EPA Region 2  '" '   ""
      E3 EPA Region 1
       Based on annual 4th maximum 8-hour average
   The National Trend
.092    ^	.082
  1982         2001
        f-11%
                          T.
                         Concentrations are in ppm
         r. AUdui level* are included in EPA region 10 averages; Hawaii levels are included in EPA region 9 averages; and Puerto Rico levels are Included in EPA regt
      Note:
      2 averages
      Source-. EPA, Offlce of Air Qualify Planning and Standards, latest Findings on National Air Quality: 20& Status and Trends. September 20ol
1-14
                                                     1.1  Outdoor Air Quality
                               Chapter 1 - Cleaner Air

-------
                      lent concentrations of leaa - y-ategory 1
                                                                                                                           •,; •; " 1
   Lead is a metal found naturally in the environment as well as in
   manufactured  products. The major sources of lead emissions have
   historically been motor vehicles and industrial sources. Due to
   the phase-out of leaded gasoline, metals processing is the major
   source of lead emissions to the air today. The highest air
   concentrations of lead are usually found in the vicinity of
   smelters and battery manufacturers. Lead is a criteria and toxic
   air pollutant with significant health effects, as described in
   Chapter 4, Human Health.
            Exhibit 1-12: Lead air quality, 1982-2001
            Cased on annual maximum quarterly average
      0.0
        82 83 84 8.5 86 87 88 89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 00 01
                      1982-01: 94% decrease
                      1992-01: 25% decrease

    Coverage: 39 monitoring sites nationwide with sufficient data to assess trends.

    Source: EPA, Office of Air Quality Planning and Standards^ Latest Findings on National
    Air Quality: 2001 Status and Trends. September 2002.      ~       '
              What the  Data Show

              This indicator shows ambient lead concentrations measured in
              ug/m3 per year from 1982 to 2001. Lead levels decreased by 94
              percent in those years, largely because of regulations reducing the
              lead content in gasoline (Exhibit 1 -12) (EPA, OAQPS, September
              2002). The most significant decline in ambient lead levels began
              in the late 1970s and continued through the early 1980s.
              Outdoor lead levels are below the NAAQS for most areas of the
              U.S. (EPA, OAQPS, September 2002).

              Indicator Gaps and Limitations

              Limitations of this indicator include the following:
              i) Ambient lead monitoring is conducted mostly in urban areas,
                so it may not accurately encompass  rural concentrations.
              SI This indicator would be very useful in conjunction with
                indicators of lead concentration in indoor air, drinking water,
                and soil to portray a broad picture of potential sources of
                lead exposure.

              Data  Source

              The data source for this indicator was Latest Findings on National
              Air Quality: ,2001 Status and Trends, EPA, 2002. (See Appendix B,
              page B-4, for more information.)
   Indicator
   Visibility
Visibility is a measure of aesthetic value and the ability to enjoy sce-
nic vistas, but it also can be an indicator of general air quality. PM is
              the major contributor to reduced visibility, and high humidity levels
              worsen the effects of pollution on visibility. The Interagency
              Monitoring of Protected Visual Environments (IMPROVE) network
              collects data to characterize visibility in protected lands. IMPROVE
              was established in 1987 to:
              H Determine the type of pollutants primarily responsible for
                reduced visibility in protected areas.
              ij Assess progress toward the Clean Air Act's national goal of
                remedying existing and preventing future visibility impairment.

              The indicator below presents data from the IMPROVE network on
              visibility trends for national parks and other protected lands.
C-napter I -  (Jeaner Air
1.1 Outdoor Air Quality
1-15

-------
  	r	n-pi1	
  ndicator
Visibility - C-ategory 1
                       "71
  This indicator presents visibility trends for U.S. national parks and
  wilderness areas in the eastern and western U.S. by mean visual
  range, as measured in km for 1992 to 1999 and 1990 to 1999,
  respectively, by worst, mid-range, and best visibiliiy. Under the
  Clean Air Act, a Class I area is one in which visibility is protected
  more stringently than under the NMQS, including national parks,
  wilderness areas, monuments, and other areas of special national
  and cultural significance.

  What the Data  Show

  Data  collected by the IMPROVE network show that visibility for
  the worst visibility days in the West is similar to days with the best
  visibility in the East (Exhibit 1 -13). In 1999, the mean visual range
  for the worst days in the  East was only 24 km (14.9 miles)  com-
  pared to 84 km (S2.2 miles) for the best visibility. In the West,
  visibility impairment for the worst days remained relatively
  unchanged over the 1990s, with the mean visual range for  1999
  (80 km or 49.7 miles) nearly the same as the 1990 level (86 km
  or S3.4 miles). Without the effects of pollution, a natural visual
  range in the U.S. is approximately 75 to 150 km (47 to 93  miles)
  in the East and 200 to 300 km (124 to 186 miles) in the West
  (EPA, OAQPS, September 2002).
                                                    Indicator Gaps and  Limitations
                                                                                     !  I

                                                    Limitations of this indicator include the following:
                                                    • The indicator compares trends within .yisibility range categories,
                                                      but it would also be useful to  indicate; how often visibility falls
                                                      into each range during a year.   •  ;  ,
                                                    H The data represent only a samplingjof national park and
                                                      wilderness areas; nevertheless, this indicator provides a good
                                                      picture of the impact of air pollution 9n the nation's parks and
                                                      protected areas. As of 2001, the network monitored 110 sites.

                                                    Data Source                 :

                                                    The data source for this  indicator wasltdtest Findings on National
                                                   Air Quality: 2007 Status and Trends, EPA, 2002. (See Appendix B,
                                                    page  B-4, for more information.)    ;
                                                                             !

                                     rxnioit 1-13: Visibility trends for U.S. Class I areas
               Western U.S., 1990-1999
                                                              [Eastern U.S., 1992
   ]  I

-iUs

•s 200
&.

1 '00
s
50
n
Best Visibility
^-4 	 * 	 * 	 »--*--« * 	 ^
Mid-Range
1 	 • 	 • "• • * * »
~ A A "A~ A A A -T*— ^_
Worst Visibility


, — i
— 1

— a

                                                Best visibility
                                                range is 1 77-208 km

                                                Mid-range visibility
                                                is 118-1 33 km
                                              •3 ^ Worst visibility
                                                range is 73-85 km
          90  91  92  93  94  95  96  97  98  99
                           Year
200
ISO]
1
100:
SO;
— 1

, 1
i
i .1
— i 'A Best Visibility ,
Mid -Range

k Worst Vrsibilitv
.Jill
i : -

r
:i


Best visibility
; range is 79-90 km
Mid-range visibility
I is 42-48 km
*• Worst visibility
range is 20-23 km
                                                                        92
                                                                             r
                                                                   94   95   96
                                                                            Year
                                                                                                  97
                                                                                                        8   99
     Notes Under the Clean Air Act, a Class I area is one in which visibility is protected more stringently than und?(r the National Air Quality Standards (NAAQS), including national parks,
     wildernciurcjs, monuments, and other areas of special national and cultural significance.             ^             ,           |  J
     Source: ERA, Office of Atr Quality Planning and Standards. Latest Findings on National Air Quality: 2001 Status"and Trends. September 2002.
1-16
                                      1.1  Outdoor Air Quality
  Chapter 1 - CJeaner Air

-------

     Indicator
     Ambient concentrations of selected air toxics
   Air toxics, also known as hazardous air pollutants, are pollutants that
   may cause cancer or other serious health effects, such as reproduc-
   tive effects or birth defects, or adverse environmental and ecological
   effects. The Clean Air Act  identifies 188 air toxics; some common
   ones are perchloroethylene (from dry cleaners), mercury (from coal
   combustion), methylene chloride (from consumer products such as
   paint strippers), and benzene and 1,3-butadiene (from gasoline).
   EPA does not set health-based  standards for these pollutants;
   instead, the Clean Air Act mandates a two-phased approach. In the
  first phase, EPA establishes standards for source categories (major
  sources, area sources, and  mobile sources). In the second phase, EPA
                 assesses how well the standards are reducing health and environmen-
                 tal risks, and based on these assessments, determines what further
                 actions are necessary to address any significant remaining, or resid-
                 ual, health or environmental risks.

                 No formal monitoring network for air toxics currently exists, but sev-
                 eral metropolitan areas do maintain monitoring programs. Data from
                 these areas provide the basis for an air toxics indicator. Metropolitan
                 areas with  air toxics data generally show downward trends  (EPA,
                 OAQPS, September 2002). However, although data and tools for
                 assessing risks from air toxics are limited, available evidence suggests
                 that emissions of air toxics may still pose significant health risks in
                 many areas throughout the U.S. (EPA, OAR, September 2002). In
                 addition to ambient concentrations of air toxics, an issue of particu-
                 lar concern is the deposition of toxic air pollutants to surface water-
                 bodies. A pollutant of particular concern is mercury, which  accumu-
                 lates in fish tissue and in humans after they ingest contaminated fish
                 (see Chapter 2, Purer Water; and Chapter 5, Ecological Condition).
                  Ambient concentrations of selectedi air toxics-Category 2
     This indicator reflects data about annual average ambient concen-
     trations of four selected air toxics, in ug/m^, derived from moni-
     toring sites with sufficient trend data from 1994 to 1999.
     Selected air toxics are benzene, 1,3-butadiene, total suspended
     lead, and perchloroethylene (EPA, OAQPS, March 2001).

     What the Data  Show

    Ambient concentrations of the selected air toxics—benzene,
     1,3-butadiene, total suspended lead, and perchlorethylene	
    generally declined between 1994 and 1999, based on the annual
    average from the reporting sites (EPA, OAQPS, March 2001).
    The lead concentration level is well below the  NAAQS standard
    (see Section 1.1.1 .b in this chapter). Benzene levels, measured at
    95 urban monitoring sites, decreased 47 percent from 1994 to
    2000 (Exhibit  1 -14) (EPA, OAQPS, September 2002).

    Indicator Gaps and Limitations

    Limitations of this indicator include the following:
    • Information is limited because no formal network is currently
      in place for monitoring-ambient concentrations of air toxics;
      however, EPA and states are working to establish a national
      toxics monitoring network.
   • The indicator reflects trends for selected air toxics, but not for
      all 188 toxic air pollutants identified under the CAA.
   • More information is available for lead than for the other three
Chapter I - Cleaner Air
                  selected air toxics. Monitoring stations with sufficient trend
                  data for the other three compounds tend to be concentrated in
                  California, the Great Lakes, southern Texas, and the Northeast.

                Data Sources

                The data sources for this indicator were Latest Findings on National
                Air Quality: 2001 Status and Trends, EPA, 2002, and National Air
                Quality and Emissions Trends Report, 1999, EPA, 2001. (See
                Appendix B, page B-4, for more information.)
                       txhibit I-W: Ambient benzene, annual average urban
                      ;:_;__ concentrations, nationwide, I994-20OO
                              90% of sites have concentrations below this li
                            10% of sites have concentrations below this lin
                      94
                              95
                                                              99
                                                                     00
,._,..   	:    96      37   :   98
*-'_':"                1994-00:47% decrease                 ~f
JT Courage: 95 monitoring sites nationwide with sufficient data to assess trends.     *
JKoufce: EPA, Office of Air Quality Planning and Standards. Latest Finding, on National  *
f-$,r Quality: 2001 Status and Trends. September 2002.                    J
1.1 Outdoor Air Quality
                                                                                                                           1-17

-------

Anthropogenic sources of air pollution range from "stationary
sources" such as factories, power plants, agricultural facilities, and
smelters, to smaller "area sources" such as dry cleaners and degreas-
ing operations, to "mobile sources" such as cars, buses, planes,
trucks, trains, construction equipment, and lawn mowers. Naturally
occurring sources such as wind-blown dust, volcanoes, and wildfires
add to the total air pollution burden and may be significant on local
and regional scales.

Most of the six criteria air pollutants show declining emissions since
1982. But as reported in Latest Findings on National Air Quality: 2001
Status and Trends, emissions of NOX, a contributor to ozone, PM,
and acid rain formation, increased by nine percent between 1982
and 2001, with a slight decrease (three percent) between 1992 and
 2001  (EPA, OAQPS, September 2002). A significant amount of that
 increase is attributed to growth in emissions from non-road engines,
 including construction and recreation equipment and diesel vehicles.
 EPA continuously reviews and improves estimates of pollutant emis-
 sions. Emissions estimates for criteria pollutants are currently under
 such evaluation and may be updated.
   Indicators
   Emissions:'[particulate matter (PN/h.s and PMio), sulfur
   dioxide, nitrogen oxides, and volatile organic compounds
           . [L .      .  .   . .... .         | .,( .       .:.:. ...  .
   Lead emissions
Two indicators are available to help answer this question:
• Emissions of particulate matter, sulfur dibxide, nitrogen oxide, and .
  volatile organic compounds.         ;
B Emissions of lead.                                            ;

Particulate matter can be emitted directly jar formed in the atmos-
phere. "Primary" particles, such as dustfr6m roads and elemental
carbon (soot) from wood combustion, ad emitted directly into the
atmosphere. "Secondary" particles are fotjmed in the atmosphere
from primary gaseous emissions. Example^ include sulfates, formed
from SO2 emissions from power plants an|d industrial facilities, and
nitrates,  formed from NOX emissions from power plants, automo-
biles, and other types of combustion sources. The chemical composi-
tion of particles depends on factors such as location, time of year,
and weather.                        ',  *
                                    i  :                        '
The VOCs contributing to ozone formation are emitted from  motor
 vehicles, chemical plants, refineries, factories, consumer and commer-
 cial product; such as paints and strippers, and other industrial
 sources. Nitrogen oxides, also an ozone precursor, are emitted prima-
 rily from vehicles, power plants, and other combustion sources.
 Smelters and battery manufacturers are the largest sources of lead in
 outdoor air.:                        I  j,
   1-18
                                                        1.1 Outdoor Air Quality
                                    (piapter 1 - Cleaner Air

-------
Emissions: particulate matter
organic compounds- (Category 2
                                                         ancj fV\Aj0)> sulfur dioxide, nitrbgen^oxides, and : volatile
   This indicator includes the following data:
   • Direct PM emissions are measured in thousands of short tons
     per year. PMW emissions are presented from 1985 to 2001;
     emissions of PM2 5 from 1992 to 2001.
   • Emissions of NOX, and SO2 presented from 1982 to 2001.
     Emissions of NOX, contribute to nitrogen loading on land and
     in water directly and as runoff from land. NOX, is also a precur-
     sor of ground-level ozone. Sulfates and nitrates, formed by
     emissions of SO2 and NOX, contribute to acid deposition,
     which can have significant impacts  on aquatic life (see
     Chapter 2, Purer Water).
   • Emissions of VOCs, also precursors of ground-level ozone.
     These emissions, presented from 1982 to 2001, are measured
     in thousands of short tons per year.

   What the  Data Show

   Direct emissions of PM10 fell by 13 percent between 1992 and
   2001 (Exhibit 1 -IS). Emissions of direct PM2.5 also fell,
   decreasing by 10 percent between 1992 and 2001  (Exhibit
   1 -16). Sulfur dioxide emissions also  decreased by 25 percent
   between 1982 and 2001 and by 24  percent between 1992 and
   2001 (Exhibit 1 -17). However, emissions of NOX increased by
   9 percent between 1982 and 2001 and decreased by 3  percent
   between 1992 and 2001 (Exhibit 1-18) (EPA, OAQPS,
   September 2002). VOC emissions decreased by 16 percent
   from  1982 to 2001 and by 8 percent from 1992 to 2001
   (Exhibit 1-19)  (EPA, OAQPS, September 2002).

   Indicator Gaps and Limitations

   Limitations of this indicator include the following:
   • The emissions indicators are estimates; however, consistent esti-
     mation methods can provide useful trend data.
   B The methodology for estimating emissions is continually
     reviewed and is subject to revision. EPA is currently conducting
     such an evaluation of emissions data, and emissions estimates
     may be  updated. Trend data prior to these revisions must be
     considered in the context of those  changes.
                                                  Data Source

                                                  The data source for this indicator was Latest Findings on National
                                                  Air Quality: 2001 Status and Trends, EPA, 2002. (See Appendix B,
                                                  page B-5 for more information.)
                                                •;; Exhibit 1-15: Direct particulate matter (FAAio) emissions,
                                                                          1985-2001
r" 7,000.

S^; 6,000

ft] 5,000
^T~O
'~£ 4,000;
r-^G-"
'•! 3,000
 •jcr
;-l-   '
F 2,000!

nv.'i ,000.
                                                        - Emission
                                                         trends
                                                        _ data not
                                                         available.
                                                                  In 1985, EPA refined.its methods for estimating emissions.
                                                                                        • Transportation
                                                                                        H Industrial Processes
                                                                                        D Fuel Combustion
                                                       82
                                                               85
                                   T	1	r-
                                   92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 00 01
                                                                     1992-01:  137o decrease
                                               'f,_ Source: EPA, Office of Air Qualify Planning and Standards. Latest Findings on National  :
                                                      /ity: 2007 Status and Trends. September 2002.
•r:;E>cnibit 1-16: Direct particulate matter
T                        1992-2001
                                                                                                emissions,
                                               ;;. o
                                               "£-
                                               -T3
2,500 ,


2,000 I


1,500


1,000


 500


                                        H Transportation
                                        El Industrial Processes
                                        D Fuel Combustion
                                                                       92   93    94    95    96    97    98
                                                                                      1 992-01: 10% decrease
                                                                                                              99
                                                                                                                   00
                                                                                                                         01
                                                               i Source: EPA, Office of Air Quality Planning and Standards. Latest Findings on National
                                                                Air Qualify: 2001 Status and Trends. September 2002.
CJiapter 1  - Cleaner Air
                                    1.1 Outdoor Air Quality
                                                         1-19

-------
               Emissions: parfciculate matter  (FAA0 c and f AA,n), sulfur dioxide, nitrogen oxides, and volatile
                             I        1     f~*            i.O         l\  l\J       D| l| D,                         I         IT
               organic compounds - L.ategory 2 Icontinued;
      ibit 1-17: Sulfur dioxide (SC^) emissions, 1982-2001

   30,000

   25,000

   20,000

   15,000

   10,000

    5,000
                                                                                  : 1-18: Nitrogen oxides (NOX) emissions,
                     In 1985, EPA refined its methods for estimating emissions.
                                                                                      In 1 98S, EPA refined its methods for estimating emissions
                                                                                                                    Transportation
                                                                                                                  Dl Industrial Processes
                                                                                                                  D Fuel Combustion
                                                                                                                    Miscellaneous
                                                 Industrial Processes
                                              D Fuel Combustion
        82
                   85                  92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 00 01
                        1982-01: 25% decrease
                        1992-01: 24% decrease
                                                                                                          92 93 94 95 9~6 97 98 99*00 Of
                                                                   ;.:.                        1982-01: 9% increase
                                                                   lT            I            1*992-01: 3%decrease
                                                                   9             ,            *.,          <  j         .  .             t
Sources EPA, Office of Air Quality Planning and Standards. Latest findings on National     S Source: EPA, O Ffice of Air Quality Pfannmg and Standards Latest Findings on National
Af QMS%: 2001 Status anil Trends. September 2002.                           !* Air Quality. 20m Status and Trends. September 2002.
                                       Exhibit 1-19: Volatile organic compounds (VOCs)
                                                        emissions, 1982-2001   ;
                                    30,000r
                                                   !  In 1985, EPA refined its methods for estimating emissions.
                                     5,000
                                                                I Miscellaneous
                                                                I Transportation
                                                                I Industrial Processes
                                                                I Fuel Combustion
                                          82
                                                   85
                                                           1982-01 ::167o decrease
                                                           1992-01:  8% decrease

                                   Source: EPA, Office of Air Quality Planning and Standards. Latest fmai
                                   Air Quality. 2001 Status and Trends. September 2002.
                                                                       92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 00 01
1-20
                                                      1.1  Outdoor Air Quality
Chapter 1  - CJeaner Air

-------
                  Lead Emissions - Category 2
                                              - •^•»"««aE''''a»i*-^i^-^^
     This indicator is lead emissions from 1982 to 2001, measured in
     short tons per year.

     What the Data Show

     Lead emissions decreased by 93 percent from 1982 to 2001 and
     by 5 percent from 1992 to 2001  (Exhibit 1 -20) (EPA, OAQPS,
     September 2002). The transportation sector, particularly automo-
     tive sources, used to be the major source of lead emissions. The
     phase-out of lead in gasoline resulted in great declines in lead
     emissions from the transportation sector over the past 2 decades.
     Today, industrial processes, primarily metals processing, are the
     major source  of lead emissions to the atmosphere.

     Indicator Gaps and Limitations

    Limitations of this indicator include the following:
    • The indicator does not present actual emissions data; thus, it
      has the inherent limitations of estimates. However, consistent
      estimation methods can provide useful trend data.
                H Estimation is necessary for mobile sources and several area-
                 . wide sources.
                B The methodology for estimating emissions is continually
                  reviewed and is subject to revision. Trend data for years prior to
                  revisions must be considered in the context of those changes.

                Data Source

                The data source for this indicator was Latest Findings on National
                Air Quality: 2001 Status and Trends, EPA, 2002. (See Appendix B,
                page B-5, for more information.)
                                            Exhibit I-2O: Lead emissions, 1982-2001
                                  •:-.-" 80,000 I
                                                   In 1985, EPA refined its methods for estimating emissions.
                                                   If
                                    6.0,000
                                 Eg
                                 gfer
                                    40,000
                                    20,000
                 • Transportation
                 3 Industrial'Processes
                 it Fuel Combustion
                                         82
                                                 85
                 ii   i " i   i   i  i   i   i
               92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 00 01
                                                       1 982-01: 93% decrease
                                 FSburce: EPA, Office of Air Quality Planning and Standards. Latest Findings on National "'
                                 SfJ&irSualiiy. 2001 Status and Trends. September 2002.
Chapter 1 - Cleaner Air
1.1 Outdoor Air Quality
                                                                                                                        1-21

-------

                                      Vwww
                                      ^

   Indicator
   Air toxics emissions
An indicator for air toxics emissions is available to help address this
question. The Clean Air Act identifies 188 air toxics. EPA estimates
that more than SO percent of air toxics emissions come from vehicles
                                                 and other mobile sources such as aircraft, locomotives, and con-
                                                 struction equipment (EPA, OAQPS, September 2002). Other major
                                                 sources include industrial facilities and area sources such as small dry
                                                 cleaners and gas stations. Emissions of benzene, come from cars,
                                                 trucks, oil refineries, and chemical processes. Mercury emissions
                                                 come from ccial combustion and waste ihcjneration and can travel
                                                 thousands of miles before being deposited in water or on land (see
                                                 Chapter 2, Purer Water). Some air toxics are also released from natu-
                                                 ral sources such as volcanic eruptions and forest fires.
   1. , i	~lililiSiii|iii
   ndfcatof
Air toxics emissions - Category 2
   This indicator is national air toxics emissions, in million of tons per
   year, between the 1990-1993 baseline period and 1996. EPA
   compiles an air toxics inventory, as part of the National Emissions
   Inventory, which focuses on four sectors—large industrial sources,
   smaller industrial and natural sources, on-road mobile sources,
   and non-road mobile sources.

   What the Data Show

    Estimates show a 24 percent reduction in nationwide air toxics
    emissions between the baseline period (1990-1993) and 1996—
    a reduction from  6.11  million to 4.67 million tons per year
    (Exhibit 1 -21) (EPA, OAQPS, September 2002).

    indicator Caps and Limitations

    Limitations of this indicator include the following:
    • Air toxics emissions estimates are currently available for only
       1990 to 1993 (a mix of years depending on data availability on
      various source types) and 1996.
    • The emissions data are based on estimates that are not avail-
      able on an annual basis.
    • The indicator is an aggregate number; actual changes vary
       among the toxic air pollutants and also vary from one part of
       the country to another.
                                                  Data Source                  ;
                                                                                   I   i       .    -
                                                  The data source for this indicator was latest Findings on National
                                                  Air Quality: 2001 Status and Trends, EPA,; 2002. (See Appendix B,
                                                  page B-6, for more information.)       '
       „[*  ,    .  -i     '   .1  i,   {   "-       k-
Exhibit l'-21: National air toxics emissions, 1990-1993,
       T 1996 (total for 188 toxic air pollutants)
       £
                                                                                                           1
                                                                                   • [53 Urban Air Toxics
                                                                                      155 Other Air Toxics
                                                                                   Baseline
                                                                             |  ,, (1990-1993)
                                                                                                             1996
                                                                  fepurce: EPA, Jjffjce of Air *Qualit| Planning and Standards latest Findings on National
                                                                  f'Air Quality: 2(ioi Status and Trends September 20Q2
                                                                  fcl^-L-'il  *»'«!   ""    U.**,    "- ! )> I  -i*  *  '     ^  !—    ".,
  1-22
                                                      1.1 Outdoor Air Quality
                                                                                    Chapter 1  - Cleaner Air

-------
Air pollution does not recognize political boundaries: ozone and PM,
for example, can be transported hundreds or thousands of miles,
depending on weather conditions, including wind speeds. Canada
and the U.S. have jointly studied ground-level ozone occurrence and
transport in eastern North America. Eight-hour ozone measurements
for 1988 and 1995 from eastern Canada and the eastern U.S.
demonstrate how ozone travels in both directions across the U.S.-
Canadian border. The data suggested that ozone was being trans-
ported from urban to non-urban areas.

The U.S.-Canada Air  Quality Committee studied the relative contri-
bution of sources in each country to the ozone precursors-NOx and
VOCs. According to the report, "anthropogenic sources of NOX
emissions in the U.S.  are ten times larger, and VOC emissions are 7
times larger in magnitude than in Canada, paralleling the relative
population ratio between  the 2countries." The study also showed
that wind speed can significantly affect ozone transport between the
two countries. At low wind speed (<3 meters per second), ozone
concentrations were high  over major metropolitan areas or close to
the sources. At  intermediate wind speeds (3 to 6 meters per sec-
ond), overall concentrations were lower and ozone was transported
up to 500 km downwind.  At higher wind speeds, higher concentra-
tions were in downwind corners up to 1,000 km away (U.S.-Canada
Air Quality Committee, March 1999).

Transboundary air pollution issues  are not limited to North America,
as demonstrated in the discussion of stratospheric ozone depletion
(see Section 1.4 in this chapter). More recently, the U.N.
Environment Programme suggested that the so-called Asian Brown
Cloud, a 2-mile-thick blanket of pollution over part  of South Asia,
could travel halfway around the globe in a week (CNN,  2002).

No specific indicators have been identified at this time to address
the issue of transboundary air pollution.
Outdoor air pollution can cause a variety of adverse health effects.
Exposure to air pollution can result in short-term health effects and
can also contribute to or aggravate chronic conditions. One such
              condition is asthma, the leading chronic illness of children in the
              U.S. and a leading cause of school absenteeism. In 2000, asthma
              caused 465,000 hospitalizations and about 4,500 deaths in the
              U.S. (CDC, 2003). Other chronic conditions to which air pollution
              can contribute include lung cancer, asthma, respiratory disease, and
              cardiovascular disease.

              Some of the criteria pollutants, including ozone, NO2, and SO2, are
              associated primarily with respiratory-related effects, including
              aggravation of asthma and other respiratory diseases  and irritation
              of the lung and  respiratory symptoms (e.g., cough, chest pain, diffi-
              culty breathing) (EPA, ORD, 1982,1986, August 1993, 1994).
              Carbon  monoxide, on the other hand, primarily affects people with
              cardiovascular disease by reducing oxygen in the blood, leading to
              aggravation of angina (EPA, ORD, NCEA,  2000).

              Short-term exposure to ozone has been linked to lung inflammation
              and increased hospital admissions and emergency room visits (EPA,
              ORD, NCEA, July 1996). Repeated short-term exposures to ozone
              may damage children's developing lungs and may lead  to reduced
              lung function later in life; long-term exposures to high  ozone levels
              are a possible cause of increased incidence of asthma  in children
              engaged in outdoor sports (McConnell, et al., 2002).  Efforts to
              control automobile traffic in Atlanta during the 1996 Summer
              Olympic Games  were associated with a 28 percent reduction in peak
              daily ozone concentrations during the Games and a significantly
              lower rate of childhood asthma events (Friedman, et al., 2001).

              When EPA introduced a new 8-hour ozone ambient standard in
              1997, it estimated that meeting the standard would reduce the risk
              of significant decreases in children's lung functions (such as difficulty
              in breathing or shortness of breath) by about 1 million incidences
              per year and would result in thousands of fewer hospital admissions
              and visits for people with asthma (EPA, OAQPS, July 1997).

              Exposure to airborne particulate matter is  associated with a broader
              range of health problems, including respiratory-related  and cardio-
              vascular  effects.  For example, short-term exposures to PM  may
              aggravate asthma and bronchitis and have been associated with
              heartbeat irregularities and heart attacks. PM exposures have been
              linked to increased school absences and lost work days, hospital
              admissions and emergency room visits, and even death from heart
              and  lung diseases (EPA, ORD, NCEA, April 1996). Long-term expo-
              sures have also been linked to deaths from heart and lung diseases,
              including lung cancer (EPA, ORD, NCEA, 2002; Pope, et al., 2002).

              When EPA established new PM2.5 standards in 1997, it estimated
              that meeting the standard would save about 15,000 lives  each year,
              especially among the elderly and those with existing heart and lung
              diseases. The Agency said the new standard would reduce hospital
              admissions by thousands each year; reduce risk of symptoms
              associated with chronic bronchitis by tens of thousands each year;
              and  avoid hundreds of thousands of incidences of asthma  each year
              (EPA, OAQPS, July 1997).
Cnapter 1 -  Cleaner Air
1.1 Outdoor Air Quality
1-23

-------

                                                                                         B
Lead, both a criteria pollutant and a toxic air pollutant, has signifi-
cant health effects. Elevated blood lead levels are associated with
behavioral problems, neurological effects, and lowered IQ (EPA,
OAQPS, September 2002), The decrease in the average  level of
lead in children's blood reflects declines in ambient lead  levels by
93 percent from 1982 to 2001 —largely the result of regulations
reducing lead content in gasoline (EPA, OAQPS, September 2002).

Toxic or hazardous air pollutants may cause many other less com-
mon but potentially hazardous health effects, including cancer and
damage to the immune system, and neurological, reproductive, and
developmental problems. Acute exposure  to some air toxics can
cause immediate death. Many of these pollutants can cause serious
health damages even at relatively low concentrations. National
emission standards have been established for eight of the 188 listed
hazardous air pollutants:  asbestos, mercury, beryllium, benzene,
vinyl chloride, arsenic, radionuclides, and  coke oven emissions.

The National-Scale Air Toxics Assessment, a nationwide analysis of
air toxics, develops health risk estimates for 33 toxic air pollutants
using computer modeling of the 1996 National Emissions Inventory
air toxics data. Based on the assessment, chromium, benzene, and
formaldehyde appear to pose the greatest nationwide carcinogenic
risk (EPA, OAR, September 2002). Benzene exposure has been linked
to increases in the risk of leukemia and multiple myeloma (EPA,
OAQPS, July 199S).

No specific indicators have been  identified at this time to address
the health  effects associated with outdoor air pollution. For
additional discussion of air pollution and associated health effects,
see Chapter 4, Human Health.



 Outdoor air not only has the potential to affect human health, but
 also transports pollutants and deposits them onto soils or surface
 waters. There, the pollutants can cause ecological effects and
 damage to property. Ground-level ozone damages plants and crops.
 It interferes with the ability of plants to produce and store food,
 reducing overall plant health and the ability to grow and reproduce.
 The weakened plants are more susceptible to harsh weather, disease,
 and pests. Through its effects on plants, ozone also can pose risks
 to ecological functions such as water movement, mineral nutrient
 cycling, and habitats for various animal and plant species (see
 Chapter 5, Ecological Condition).

 Airborne nitrogen species (including the criteria pollutants NO2 and
 particulate nitrate) can contribute to excess nitrogen levels in
 ecosystems. These excess nitrogen levels can result in:
             • Changes in plant and soil community spjscies diversity.
             • Altered community structure.          !
             • Eutrophication in surface and coastal waters.
             • Acidified soils and waters (see Chapter 2, Purer Water).

             Airborne sulfur species (including the criteria pollutants SO2 and
             particulate sulfate) can also contribute excfess sulfur to ecosystems,
             which can lead to acidification of the soils iand related effects. When
             deposited together, airborne nitrogen and !sulfur species are known
             as acid deposition. (See the discussion of pcid deposition in Section
             1.2 of this chapter.)

             Land and water can be contaminated by deposition of air toxics,
             leading to contamination of plants and anijmals and, eventually, of
             humans further up the food chain. Airbornje mercury from incinera-
             tion, for example, can  settle in water and cbntaminate fish (see
             Chapter 2, Purer Water). People who eat fjsh are then exposed to
             mercury, which is known to be harmful to the nervous system.
                                                   j
             No specific indicators  have been identified at this time to address
             the ecological effects  associated with outdoor air pollution.
             Additional dis.cussion of the ecological effects  associated with
             outdoor air pollution is found in Chapter 5, Ecological Condition.
 1-24
1.1 Outdoor Air Quality
(_napter 1 - (Jeaner /\ir

-------
  1.2 Acid  Deposition

  Sulfur dioxide and NOX emissions in the atmosphere react with
  water, oxygen, and oxidants to form acidic components, also referred
  to as acid deposition or "acid rain." Air contaminants can be
  deposited on land or water through precipitation (wet deposition) or
  directly by dry deposition. Wet acid deposition is monitored by the
  National Atmospheric Deposition Program/National Trends Network,
  a cooperative program of federal and state agencies, universities,
  electric utilities, and other industries. Dry deposition is measured by
  the Clean Air Status and Trends Network (CASTNET), operated by
  EPA and the National Park Service.
 The acidity in precipitation in the eastern U.S. is at least twice as
 high as in pre-industrial times (EPA, ORD, January 2003). To reduce
 emissions of SO2 and NOX, EPA established the Acid Rain Program
 under the Clean Air Act. This program focuses on the largest and
 highest-emitting coal-fired power plants, which are significant con-
 tributors to acid deposition.

 This section addresses the following questions:
 • What are the deposition rates of pollutants that cause acid rain?
   (Section  1.2.1)
 • What are the emissions of pollutants that form acid rain?
   (Section  1.2.2)
 • What ecological effects are associated with acid deposition?
   (Section  1.2.3)
                Indicators
                Deposition: wet sulfate and wet nitrogen
             Efforts to reduce sulfur dioxide and nitrogen oxides emissions from
             power plants have helped to significantly reduce wet sulfate deposi-
             tion and to contain increases in nitrogen deposition. Wet sulfate
             deposition levels for 1999 to 2001 showed reductions of 20 to 30
             percent compared to levels for 1989 to 1991 over widespread areas
             in the Midwest and the Northeast, where acid rain has had its great-
             est impact. Nitrogen deposition levels showed no major changes.
             Although NOX emissions from power plants decreased, nitrogen
             emissions from sources other than power plants (e.g., motor vehicles,
             non-road vehicles, and agricultural activities) increased between
             1990 and 2001 (EPA, OAR, November 2002).

             Deposition of wet sulfate and wet nitrogen is the indicator used to
             address this  question.
Chapter 1  - Cleaner Air
1.2 Acid Deposition
                                                                                                                        1-25

-------
              Deposition: wet sulfate and  wet nitrogen - Category 2 f
 Measures of wet sulfate and wet nitrogen deposition in kilograms
 per hectare (kg/ha), are a key indicator of acid deposition.

 What the Data Show

 Wet sulfate decreased substantially throughout the Midwest and
 Northeast between 1989-1991 and 1999-2001 (Exhibit 1 -22).
 By 2001, wet sulfate deposition had decreased more than 8
 kilograms per hectare (kg/ha) from 30-40 kg/ha/year in 1990 in
 much of the Ohio River Valley and northeastern U.S. The greatest
                                                               reductions occurred in the mid-Appalachian region (EPA, OAR,
                                                               November 2002).                      ;

                                                               There were no dramatic regional changes in wet nitrogen
                                                               deposition beitween 1989-1991 and 19p9J-2001 (Exhibit 1-23).
                                                               Since 1990, nitrogen deposition decreased slightly in areas of
                                                               the eastern U.S., while increases occurred;in some areas with
                                                               significant agricultural activity (e.g., the PJains Snd coastal North
                                                               Carolina) or substantial mobile source emissions (e.g., southern
                                                               California). (tiPA, OAR, November 2002).(
                              Exhibit 1-22: Wet sulfate deposition, 1989-1991 v£ 1999-2001
C«H»t«! 250 National Atmospterie Deposition Program National Trends Network (NApP/NTN) monrtor^fatioTToTated throughout"!
Nate: Mjp colon represent relative concentrations and do not imply ecological or human health status      y      [     (
Source; EPA. Offite of A» and R^iatipn, Clean Air Markets ^ogja^

                           Exhibit 1-23: Wet nitrogen deposition, l989-1991^s. 1999-2001
                                                                                                   --H
    CoviMge 1250 National Atmospheric Deposittan Pro^am'National Trends Network (NADP/NTN) monitonrr^ .stations located throughout the lojJer 48 sta'tes
    Note; Map colors represent relative concentrations and do not imply ecological or human health status
    Source: EPA, Office of Air Jnd Radiation, Clean Air Markets Program. EPA Acid Rain Program: 2001 Progress Report November 2002
1-26
                                                     1.2 Acid Deposition
Chapter i - Cleaner Air

-------
                Deposition; wet sulfate ;and wet nitrogen - Category 2 Idontinuea)
   Wet and dry sulfur deposition make up roughly the same percent-
   ages of total sulfur deposition in the Midwest, whereas, in most
   other areas, wet deposition makes up a greater percentage of the
   total. Wet deposition also makes up most of the total nitrogen
   deposition load at the majority of the monitoring sites in the
   eastern U.S.  In southern California, dry deposition makes up a
   greater percentage of the total (Exhibit 1 -24).

   Using National Atmospheric Deposition Program data, a U.S.
   Department  of Agriculture (USDA) report on sustainable forests
   observed that annual wet sulfate deposition decreased significant-
   ly between 1994 and 2000, especially in  the North and South
   Resource Planning Act regions, where deposition was the highest.
   Nitrate deposition rates were lowest in the Pacific and Rocky
   Mountain regions, where  approximately 84 percent of the regions
   experienced deposition rates of less than  4.2 pounds per acre
   (4.8kg/ha) per year. Only 2 percent of the sites in the eastern
   U.S. received less than that amount (USDA, FS, 2002).

   indicator Gaps  and  Limitations

   Limitations of this indicator include the following:
   • Geographic coverage is limited for measuring wet deposition
     and even more so  for measuring dry deposition. Additional
              monitoring sites for both in coastal areas in the Southeast
              would support improved measurement of nitrogen deposition
              to estuaries. Additional dry deposition monitoring would
              provide a better understanding of acid deposition in the Ohio
              Valley and Central and Rocky Mountain areas.
            B Measurement techniques for dry deposition have improved
              substantially, but still lag behind operational wet deposition
              techniques.

            Data Source

            The data source for this indicator was EPA Acid Rain Program:
            2001 Progress Report, EPA,  2002. (See Appendix B,  page B-6,
            for more information.)
                                   Exnibit 1-24: Total sulfur and total.nitrogen deposition, 2001
                              Sulfur
                                                                                           Nitrogen
                                                      •I WatS
                                                      Days
      Coverage: 70 Clean Air Status and Trends Network (CASTNet) monitoring stations concentrated in the eastern half of the lower 48 states.
      Note: The size of the "pies" indicates the totalmagnitude of deposition; the colors indicate the percentage of wet and dry deposition,
      Source:EPA,OfficeofAirandRadiation,CleanAirMarketsProgram.£JDAAcrdrRamFrograra:200I Progress Report November 2002.
Chapter I - Cleaner Air
1.2 Acid Deposition
1-27

-------
   Indicators
   Emissions (utility): sulfur dioxide and nitrogen oxides
Acid deposition occurs when emissions of SC>2 and NOX in the
atmosphere react with water, oxygen, and oxidants to form acidic
           compounds. Electric utility plants that burh fossil fuels are a
           significant source of SO2 and NOX and monitor their emissions
           continuously. NOX is also emitted from other high-temperature
           combustion sources, including automobiles.

           The indicator used to address this questiop is emissions of sulfur
           dioxide and nitrogen oxides from utilities.  !

               Emissions  (utility): sulfur dioxide and nitrogen oxides - C
                        Category 2
                      jfe	
   This indicator is millions of tons of NOX and SO2 emissions from
   sources covered under the Acid Rain Program from 1990 to 2001
   and 1980 to 2001, respectively. These emissions data are an
   important component of a market-based trading program to
   reduce emissions and consequent impacts on the environment.

   What the  Data Show

   SOj emissions from sources covered under the Acid Rain Program
   were 10.6 million tons in 2001, compared to 15.7 million tons in
   1990. Emissions of NOX from these sources declined from  6.7
   million tons in 1990 to 4.7 million tons in 2001  (Exhibit 1 -25)
   (EPA, OAR, June 2002).
           Indicator Gaps and Limitations
                       ;••                      i  i     '
           Limitations of this indicator include the fojlowing:
           • Although electric utilities and large boilers are key sources of
             SC>2 and NOX, they are not the only sources. It is estimated
             that about 64 percent of annual SO2! emissions and 26 percent
             of NOX emissions are produced by eleqtric utility plants that
             burn fossil fuels (EPA, OAQPS, September 2002).
           • Information on mobile source emissions i$ particularly useful for
             completing the picture of NOX contributions to acid deposition.
                                               t  i
                                               i  i
           Data  Source

           The data source for this indicator was EPA Acid Rain Program:
           2007 Progress Report, Appendices A and 61, EPA, 2002. (See
           Appendix B, page B-6, for more information.)
                                   Exhibit 1-25: Power plant sulfur dioxide (SO2), 1980-2001, and
                                          nitrogen oxides (NOx), 1990-20C&1, emissions
                1980

         Soutee EPA, Office of Aif and Radiation, Clean Air Markets Program. EPA Add Rain Program: 2001 Progress Repo •( November 2002 Appendix A Acid Rain Program Year 2001
         SO2 Allowance Holdings and Deductions. (April 8,2003; http://www.epa.goy/airmarkets/cmprpt/arp01/arjpend
         Affected Units. (April 8, 2003; http://www.epa.gov/atrmarkets/crriprpt/arp01/appenclixbl.pdf).
                        (o pdf) and Appendix Bl 2001 Compliance Results for NOx
 1-28
1.2 Acid Deposition
Criapter 1 - Cleaner Air

-------

 Increased acid levels damage soils, lakes, and streams, rendering
 some waterbodies unfit for certain fish and wildlife species. Indirect
 effects of acid deposition are also responsible for damage to forest
 ecosystems (see Chapter 5, Ecological Condition). Acidic ions in the
 soil displace calcium and other nutrients from plant roots, inhibiting
 growth. Acidic deposition can also mobilize toxic amounts of
 aluminum, increasing its availability for uptake by plants and by fish
 and other aquatic life (EPA, OAR, November 2002).

 The nitrogen in acid rain adds to the total loading of nitrogen in water-
 bodies. As coastal ecosystems become overly rich in nitrogen, conditions
 favor more frequent and more severe emergence of algal blooms, which
 deplete oxygen, harming fish and reducing plant and animal diversity
 (see Chapter 2, Purer Water).

 A recent report assessing deposition-related  changes in surface
 water chemistry in the northern and eastern U.S. found that the
 Clean Air Act has resulted in a large and widespread decrease in the
 deposition of sulfur by approximately 40 percent in the 1990s. In
 the same period, surface water sulfate concentrations declined in all
 regions except the Ridge and Blue Ridge provinces (Virginia). Acid
 .neutralizing capacity (ANC), -a key indicator of recovery, increased in
 three of the regions (Adirondacks, Northern Appalachian Plateau
 and Upper Midwest) and was unchanged in the New England and
 the Ridge/Blue Ridge region. Modest increases in ANC have reduced
 the number of acidic lakes and stream segments in some regions:

 • In the Adirondacks, 8.1  percent of lakes (ISO lakes) were acidic in
   2000. In the early 1990s, 13 percent (240 lakes) were acidic.

 • In the Upper Midwest, an estimated 80 of 250 lakes that were acidic
   in the mid-1980s are no longer acidic.

 • In the Northern Appalachian Plateau region in 2000, there were an
   estimated 3,393 kilometers (2,104 miles) of acidic streams in the
   region, or 7.9 percent of the total population; this compares to 5,014
   kilometers (3,109 miles) of acidic streams (12 percent) in 1993-94.

 • There was no evidence of recovery in New England, or in the Ridge
   and Blue Ridge Provinces; the latter region is no't expected to recover
   immediately, due to the nature of forest soils in the province.

 • In the three regions showing recovery, approximately one-third of
   formerly acidic surface waters are no longer acidic, although still
   subject to episodes of acidification.

 • Nitrogen deposition levels changed little between 1989 and 2001,
   and surface water nitrate concentrations are largely unchanged as well.
   Nitrogen deposition remains a concern, because future increases in
   surface water nitrate concentrations could retard surface water
   recovery (EPA, ORD, January 2003).


No specific indicators have  been identified at this time to address the
ecological effects associated with acid deposition.
              I.3  Indoor  Air  Quality

              People in the U.S. spend 90 percent of their time indoors, and
              indoor air pollutant levels may exceed those allowable outside.
              Radon and environmental tobacco smoke (ETS) are the two indoor
              air pollutants of greatest concern from a health perspective (EPA,
              ORD,  December 1992; NRC, 1988).

              Although methods to monitor and measure indoor air quality (IAQ)
              exist, there is no practical way to assess the general quality of indoor
              air nationwide. There are millions of residences, thousands of work-
              places, and more than a hundred thousand schools in the U.S., and
              representative samples are not practical because of cost and access
              issues. This section, therefore, presents indoor air quality data from
              limited studies, not from ongoing monitoring efforts.

              This section addresses the following questions:
              • What is the quality of the air in buildings in the United States?
                (Section 1.3.1)
              • What contributes to indoor air pollution? (Section 1.3.2)
              • What human health effects are associated with indoor air
                pollution? (Section 1.3.3)
               . • -, 1a|Y««!j'|*s^;,ir;^j;gE^j|i=K;5ai;ji| i&^^fci3iaf«^&testi8»»Sii|!SiiS
               ; in pu ndrnjpy jf: J|j^;;jyi||||^4Bt4si^^
                Indicators
                U.S. homes above EPA's radon action levels
                Percentage of homes where young children are exposed to
                environmental tobacco smoke
             While it is difficult to make general statements about the quality of
             indoor air nationwide, two studies-the National Residential Radon
             Survey and an analysis of ETS exposure based on data from the
             National Health Interview Survey-offer important insights. These
             studies provide data about residential levels of radon and  ETS,
             presented in the description of two indicators on the following pages.

             In addition, several studies have attempted to characterize environ-
             mental issues inside office buildings and schools. The  Building
             Assessment Survey and Evaluation (BASE) study, conducted from
             1994 to 1998, is a study of office IAQ. The study was designed
             with input from more than 40  national IAQ experts and reviewed by
             the EPA Science Advisory Board. The consensus of these  national
             experts was that a sample of 100 to 200 office buildings would be
             sufficient to characterize the central tendency of IAQ in office
             buildings nationwide.

             Limited information about IAQ in schools is available from a 1999
             survey of about 900 public schools by the National Center for
             Education Statistics. This survey addressed concerns related to
Chapter I - Cleaner Air
1.3 Indoor Air Quality
1-29

-------
environmental conditions, defined as lighting, heating, ventilation,
IAQ, acoustics or noise control, and physical security of buildings. In
all, 43 percent of schools responded that at least one environmental
condition was unsatisfactory. Ventilation was the most often cited
environmental issue of concern (DOE, NCES, 2000).

In addition to the indoor pollutants discussed above, pesticides
also may pose IAQ concerns. Approximately three-quarters of U.S.
households use at least one pesticide product indoors during the
course of a year. Products used most often are insecticides and
disinfectants. The EPA Nonoccupational Pesticide Exposure Study
(NOPES),  published in 1990, assessed exposure to airborne pesti-
cides in Jacksonville, Florida, and in Springfield and Chicopee,
Massachusetts. Indoor sources accounted for 90 percent or more
of the total airborne exposure to most of these pesticides. NOPES
found that tested households had at least 5 pesticides in indoor air,
at levels often 10 times greater than levels measured in outdoor air
(EPA, AREAL, January 1990). Some of the pesticides had been
banned or otherwise regulated by EPA (e.g., aldrin, dieldrin,
heptachlor, and chlordane), but continued to be found in the
homes. Since these pesticides previously were widely used to
prevent termites, they are believed to have entered the homes via
diffusion of soil gas into basements, similar to the way radon enters
homes. Another pesticide, DDT, banned for nearly 20  years, was
found in house dust in five out of eight homes (EPA, AREAL, January
1990). Later studies, including measurements in soil just outside
                                                the home, suggested that DDT and other; long-lasting pesticides
                                                can be tracked in from soil clinging to shoes.

                                                No comprehensive nationwide information; is available on the amount
                                                of pesticides used in the nation's 11,000 public schools. The federal!
                                                government has not collected such data, and only one state,
                                                Louisiana, requires its  school districts to specifically report the
                                                amount of pesticides used (GAO, 1999). i

                                                This report ui.es two indicators, discussed ;below, to address        I
                                                the question, "What is the quality of air in'the buildings in the
                                                United States?":                .    ;  ;
                                                | U.S. homes, above EPA radon action levels.
                                                • Percentage; of homes where young children are exposed to ETS.
  Iridicitoi
U.S. homes above EPAs radon action levels - C_a1
ttego y 2
    Naturally occurring radon gas is formed by the decay of uranium
    in rock, soil, and water. Radon enters a home by moving up from
    rock and soil and into the building through cracks or other holes
    in the foundation.

    The amount of radon gas in the air is measured in picocuries
    per liter of air or pCi/L EPA has set a recommended "action
    level" of four pCi/L for homes and schools to reduce the risk of
    lung cancer.

    What the Data Show

    A 1991 representative survey of all housing units in the United
    States estimated that six percent of U.S. homes (5.8 million in
    1990) had an annual average radon level of more than four pic-
    ocuries per liter (pCi/L) in indoor air. Also, about 56 percent of
    Americans' exposure to radon occurs in homes with two pCi/L or
    more. Single-family detached homes were four times more likely to
    require mitigation than multi-family homes. The survey's findings
    were used in constructing EPA's estimate of U.S. lung cancer risks
    from radon, in setting the four pCi/L action level, and in crafting
                                                  testing and mitigation guidance for the American public (EPA,
                                                  OAR, October 1992).               :  '
                                                            I                       •  I "
                                                  indicator Data Gaps  and: Limitations

                                                  The study is several years old and may pot reflect changes
                                                  brought about as a result of significant [EPA radon public
                                                  education campaigns since that time.'Since the mid-1980s,
                                                  about 18  million homes have been tested for radon and about
                                                  700,000 of them have been mitigated, iln addition, since 1990
                                                  approximately one million new homesjh^ve been built with
                                                  radon-resistant features.            ,  •

                                                  Data Source

                                                  The data  source for this indicator was National Radon Residential
                                                  Survey: Summary Report EPA, 1992. (See Appendix B, page B-7,
                                                  for more information.)                :
 1-30
                                     1.3 Indoor Air Quality
                           Chapter 1 - Cleaner Air

-------
                iercentage of homes where young children are: exposed1 to environmental tobacco smoke -
                Category 2    ":• •• v  \-  ,  ''   :--!": '-'•" • '••'..:,  " :  • -v   : •• •: "--j::-. .-•.-'.•-• ''•..-'•.-.':.    .-. '":.-''  :.•' .- •
    Environmental tobacco smoke (ETS)—smoke emitted from the
    burning end of a cigarette, pipe, or cigar, and smoke exhaled by
    a smoker—is a complex mix of more than 4,000 chemical com-
    pounds, containing many known or suspected carcinogens and
    toxic agents, including particles, carbon  monoxide, and
    formaldehyde.

    What the Data Show

    The National Center for Health Statistics has conducted a major
    nationwide survey, known as the National Health Interview Survey,
    continuously since 1957. The survey estimated that in 1998,
   young children were exposed to ETS in 20 percent of homes in
   the U.S.—down from approximately 39 percent in 1986. About
    43,000 households and 106,000 people participated in the
   survey (DHHS, NCHS, 2001).
              Indicator  Data Gaps and  Limitations

              The estimate is not based on a specific question about children's
              exposure to ETS, but rather is calculated based on the number of
              houses with smokers and with children.

              Data Source

             The data source for this indicator was Healthy People 2000 Final
             Review, Department of Health and Human  Services, National
             Center for Health Statistics, 2001. (See Appendix B, page B-7,
             for more information.)
 Indoor air pollutants come from a wide array of sources. In consider-
 ing the potential impact of these sources on indoor air quality, it is
 vital to recognize the exchange between indoor and outdoor air.
 Exchange rates vary considerably from building to building, from one
 part of the country to another, and by seasons. Tight building con-
 struction improves energy efficiency but reduces indoor-outdoor air
 exchange and may contribute to indoor air pollution.

 Among the sources of indoor air pollution are:
 • Combustion of fuel used for heating and cooking, including oil,
  gas, kerosene, coal, and wood.
 • Environmental tobacco smoke.
 • Some adhesives, paints, and coatings (building materials).
 • Furniture made of certain pressed wood products.
 • Deteriorated, asbestos-containing insulation.
 • Some products for household cleaning and maintenance, personal
  care, or hobbies.
 B Inadequate maintenance of central heating and cooling systems.
 • Radon, pesticides, and outdoor air pollution.
• Biological sources, including animal dander, cockroaches, dust
  mites, molds, and fungi.
             In general, indoor air pollution can cause headaches, tiredness, dizzi-
             ness, nausea, and throat irritation. More serious effects include can-
             cer and exacerbation of chronic respiratory diseases, such as asthma.
             The most sensitive and vulnerable population groups—the elderly,
             the young, and the infirm—tend to spend the most time indoors;
             therefore, they may face higher than usual exposures.

             Radon is estimated to be the second leading cause of lung cancer in
             the U.S. In an EPA-sponsored study, the National Research Council
             (NRC) found between 15,000 and 22,000 radon-related lung can-
             cer deaths annually in the U.S. (NRC, 1998).

             Environmental tobacco smoke causes eye, nose, and throat irritation,
             and is a carcinogen. Children exposed to ETS are at increased risk
             for respiratory problems and experience increased episodes of asth-
             ma (Mannino, et al., 2001). In studies of lifelong nonsmoking
             women, there was a 24 percent excess risk of lung cancer as a result
             of ETS exposures from a spouse's smoking (Hackshaw, 1998).

             Asthma, particularly in children, is associated with poor indoor air
             quality. Dust mite proliferation in moist indoor environments can
             lead to asthma attacks. Other allergens  and irritants such as animal
             dander, ETS, pesticide sprays, cockroach particles, and chemical
            fumes from household products have also been shown to increase
            asthma attack rates (IOM, 2000).
Chapter I - Cleaner Air
1.3 Indoor Air Quality
T-31

-------
Fungal spores from mold growth in moist areas in homes have been
associated with health effects in occupants, including allergies and
asthma (IOM, 1993). Headaches, respiratory distress, and cardiovas-
cular effects are also associated with exposure to molds.

No specific indicators have been identified at this time to address
the human health effects associated with indoor air pollution.
                    Stratospheric ;Ozone

            Although ozone is a harmful pollutant at ground level, it plays a   :
            valuable rote in the stratosphere-the parjt of the atmosphere at an
            altitude of 10 to 30 km-by filtering harmful radiation from the
            sun. The sun's radiation bathes the Earth; in ultraviolet (UV) wave-
            lengths of 150 to 400 nanometers (nm).;L)ltraviolet radiation in
            the band between 280 and 320 nm, kno\jvn as UV-B, is harmful to
            most organisms.                    '•  \

            About 90 peirent of the planet's ozone at a given time is in a thin
            layer of the lower stratosphere called the ozone layer, which also
            includes other gases. Ozone is constantly [being created and
            destroyed by UV radiation. About 95  to 9'9 percent of UV-B radia-
            tion that reaches the Earth's surface is absorbed by ozone and oxy-
            gen in the ozone layer (NASA, 2002).   j

            The ozone  layer varies in space and  time1 and is highly susceptible'
            to changes in atmospheric chemical  reactions by  which it is
            created and destroyed. Scientists in thej1970s and 1980s
            discovered  that human-caused changes to the composition of
            the atmosphere were leading to depletion of stratospheric ozone
            (NASA, 2002). They initially identified cihlorofluorocarbons
            (CFCs)  as being particularly significant stratospheric ozone
            depleters. Scientists subsequently identjfied additional human-
            produced ozone-depleting substances (ODSs).

            This section poses four questions about sitratospheric ozone:
            • What are the trends in the Earth's ozorje layer? (Section 1.4.1)
            H What is causing changes to the ozone layer? (Section 1.4.2)
            • What human health effects are associated with stratospheric
               ozone depletion? (Section 1.4.3)   :
            • What ecological effects are associated with stratospheric ozone
               depletion? (Section 1.4.4)
                                                                    Indicators
                                                                    Ozone leyels over North America
                                                                   	M	_	,
                                                                 The most recent authoritative assessment of the Earth's stratos-
                                                                 pheric ozone is the. Scientific Assessment rf Ozone Depletion: 2002
                                                                 (Scientific Assessment Panel, 2003), conducted under the aus-
                                                                 pices of the .United Nations Environment  Programme (UNEP) and
                                                                 the World Meteorological Organization (WMO). The study found
                                                                 an average decrease of about 6 percent in average ozone concen-
                                                                 trations between 35 and 60 degrees Sojjth for the period 1997 to
                                                                 2001, compared with pre-1980 average values. It also found an
 1-32
1.4 Stratospheric Ozone
                                                                                                 c
iapter I - Cleaner Air

-------
   average decrease of 3 percent between 35 and 60 degrees North
   for the same period (Scientific Assessment Panel, 2003).

   It is generally believed that, after years of continuing thinning of the
   stratospheric ozone layer, the ozone layer will recover over the next
   several years as a result of international controls of ODSs. The
   Montreal Protocol on Substances that Deplete the Ozone Layer
   (Montreal Protocol), for example, restricts global manufacturing of
   CFCs (Scientific Assessment Panel, 2003).

   Scientists largely agree that a thinning of the stratospheric ozone
   layer causes an increase in the amount of UV radiation, especially
   UV-B, that reaches the Earth's surface. This outcome is consistent
  with theories about the physical processes involved, measurable
  locally by ground-based and satellite-based instruments.

  While acknowledging high uncertainty in the estimates, it is estimat-
  ed that UV irradiance has increased since the early 1980s by 6 to 14
  percent at more than ten sites distributed over mid and high lati-
  tudes  of both hemispheres. Over the past two decades,,UV increases
  are believed to have been considerably greater at higherlatitudes. In
  the Northern Hemisphere, they are believed to be greater in the win-
  ter/spring than in the summer/fall (Scientific Assessment Panel,
                 2003). The estimates of increasing UV-B levels are based on indirect
                 methods and models rather than direct measurements.

                 Because of the phase-out of ODS, total stratospheric concentrations
                 of ODS seem to have peaked; it is believed that stratospheric ozone
                 concentrations, near the lowest point since systematic measurements
                 began, will not decrease any further and will eventually recover.  -
                These developments lead to the conclusion that UV radiation levels
                reaching the Earth's surface are close to the maximum they will reach
                as a result of human-induced stratospheric ozone depletion
                (Scientific Assessment Panel, 2003).

                Obtaining reliable measurements of broad trends in levels of UV
                radiation reaching ground level in North America, .however, is a com-
                plex task.  It  is particularly challenging to measure in ways that high-
                light the relationship between ozone depletion and UV radiation.
                The amount of incoming UV radiation is affected by several variables,
                including latitude, season, time of day, snow cover, sea ice cover,
                surface reflectivity, altitude, clouds, and aerosols. Determining which
                portion of any change is attributable to ozone depletion is difficult.

                The indicator used to address the extent of change to the ozone
                layer is ozone levels over North America.
                 Ozone levels over North America, - Category I
    Data mapped for this indicator are derived from the Total Ozone
    Mapping Spectrometer (TOMS), flown on NASA's Nimbus-7
    satellite. The TOMS measures amounts of backscattered UV
    radiation at various wavelengths. Backscattered radiation  levels
    at wavelengths where ozone absorption does and does not take
    place are compared with radiation directly from the sun at the
    same wavelengths, allowing scientists to derive a "total ozone"
    amount in the Earth's atmosphere.

    The data for this indicator are presented in Dobson Units  (DU)
    which measure how thick the ozone layer would be if compressed
    in the Earth's atmosphere (at sea level and at 0°C) One DU is
    defined to be 0.01 mm thickness at standard temperature  and
    pressure.

    What the Data Show

    The ozone maps illustrate graphically and quantitatively the thin-
    ning of total column ozone over North America during a 15-year
    period. For example, in  1979, the ozone column over the Seattle

                area was 391 Dobson Units (DU), but in 1994 it had dropped to
                360 DU. Over Los Angeles, the ozone column during that time
                dropped from 368 DU to 330 DU, and over Miami from 303 DU
                to 296 DU (Exhibit 1 -26) (NASA, March 1979 and March
                1994). Although exact calculations cannot be made from Exhibit
                1 -26, the graph demonstrates thinning of the ozone layer over
                much of the globe.

                In general, ozone depletion is greater at higher latitudes.
               Therefore, it is predictable that the decrease in the ozone layer
               over Seattle is greater than over Los Angeles, with the ozone layer
               over Miami experiencing the lowest depletion among the three
               cities. However, southern cities also have higher levels of UV-B, so
               even with less depletion, the net increase in UV-B  can exceed that
               over northern latitudes.

               According to the latest estimates in the Scientific Assessment, the
               global-average total column ozone during 1997 to 2001 was
               about 3 percent below average pre-1980 values (Scientific
Chapter I - Cleaner Air
1.4 Stratospheric Ozone
                                                                                                                         1-33

-------
            o
'zone levels over
	i. "ilium IB	anil11!	liarBM^^                         ^^^aa^si^^^^^^i^^^^smK^W^^S^^^^ pSfS:
NortK America, MarcK 1979 and IVWcin 1994 - Category 1 (continue.
                 ExKiKit 1-26: Ozone levels over NortK Art erica, 1979 and 1994
                                                                                          .^i.il  at,   i
                  Source: NASA, Goddard Space Flight Center. Total Ozone Mapp ng Spectrometer (TOMS),
                  flown on Nimbus-7 satellite. (January 24, 2003;
                  Available: http://www.epa.gov/ozone/science/glob_dep.html).
 Assessment Panel, 2003). Trends over North America reflect this
 global phenomenon.

 Indicator Gaps  and  Limitations

 TOMS provides no data during nighttime or during the longer
 periods of darkness in polar regions.
                                              Data Source

                                              The data source for this indicator was NASA, Total Ozone
                                              Mapping Spectrometer, flown on the Nimbus-7 satellite. March
                                              1979 and March 1994. (See Appendix B, page B-7, for more
                                              information.)

  Indicators
  Worldwide and U.S. production of ozone-depleting substances
  (ODSs)
  Concentrations of ozone-depleting substances (effective
  equivalent chlorine)
Analyses have shown that the presence of CFCs and other ODSs was
negligible before commercial production of CFCs and other ODSs
began in the 1930s and 1940s (Scientific Assessment Panel, 2003).
                                              The adoption of the 1987 Montreal Proijocol significantly affected
                                              production jevels, resulting in reduced concentrations of ODSs.

                                              Worldwide emissions are estimated to Have been reduced signifi-
                                              cantly, since peaking in 1993 (Scientific Assessment Panel, 2003).
                                              Likewise, there have been marked decreases in U.S. emissions of
                                              ODSs over the  past decade, resulting in a 79 percent decrease in
                                              total OOP-weighted emissions from 1990 to 2000 (EPA, OAP,
                                              April 2002).                    j  j

                                              Two indicators are used to address this Question:
                                              • Worldwide and U.S.  production of ODSs.
                                              m Concentration of ODSs (effective equivalent stratospheric
                                                 chlorine).                       [
1-34
                                                 1A Stratospheric Ozone
                                                                              Chapter I - Cleaner Air

-------

 inaicararv
Worldwide and U.S. productioni of;ozone-aepleting;suDstances (ODSs) - Category 2
   Worldwide ODS production estimates are derived from reports
   produced by each nation, as required under the Montreal Protocol
   and subsequent amendments.

   Production, consumption, and emissions of ODSs are not identi-
   cal; even though the ultimate destiny of a given pound  of CFCs
   might be release to the atmosphere, a time lag is involved. ODSs
   initially are contained—and isolated from the atmosphere—after
   they are produced. They  are likely to stay contained until they are
   consumed—for example, used as coolant in a refrigerator or as a
   foaming agent in polystyrene-foam hot cups. Once they are con-
   sumed, the ODSs still might not be released to the atmosphere
   until years later, such as when the cup degrades in a landfill, or
   when the refrigerator is disposed of or recycled (at which time the
   ODS may actually be reclaimed for further use).

   Because of these complexities, consumption and emissions figures
   involve significant uncertainties—they are estimated  based on
   rates of conversion. Production figures may be more meaningful,
           Exhibit 1-27: Worldwide ODS production and
        consumption (ODi-weighted tons), 1986 and 1999
       1986
       1999
          1,768,789
            312,731
1,784,015
  275,382
    Source: United Nations Environment Programme, Ozone Secretariat. Product/on and
    Consumption of Ozone Depleting Substances under the Montreal Protocol:, 1986-2000.
    .April 2002.  -
because they are compiled from data which a relatively small
number of producing companies must report by law.

What the  Data Show

There have been marked decreases in worldwide production, and
consumption of ODSs over the past 2 decades (Exhibit 1 -27).
Worldwide ODS production declined from approximately 1.8
million tons in 1986 to 313,000 tons in 1999 (UNEP, 2002).
Worldwide measures are presented in ozone depletion potential
(ODP)-weighted tons. Each ODS is weighted based on its damage
to the stratospheric ozone; this is its ODP.  U.S. production  of
selected ODSs peaked in 1988 and declined by nearly 65 percent
in 5 years (Exhibit 1 - 28) (USITC, 1994).

Indicator  Gaps and  Limitations

In some cases ODS production data are reliable because laws
require that they.be reported. Coverage from nation to nation is
incomplete, however, and sometimes methods are inconsistent.
Production estimates for the U.S. are generally reliable as a result
of the legal reporting requirement for production figures and the
small number of producers involved.

Data Sources

The data  sources for this indicator were Worldwide Estimates:
Production and Consumption of Ozone Depleting Substances 1986-
2000, Ozone Secretariat/UNEP, 2002, and 7993 Synthetic
Organic Chemicals; U.S. Production and Sales, U.S. International
Trade Commission, 1994. (See Appendix B, page B-7, for more
information.)
                   Exhibit 1-28: U.j. production of selected ozone-depleting chemicals, IQ58-I993
                                                                                                     1988
                                                                                                                    1993
    Source: U.S. International Trade Commission. 1993 Synthetic Organic Chemicals; U.S. Production and Sales. 7994 (July 3, 2002;
    http://www.epa.gov/ozone/science/indicat/index.htmf).
CJiapter I - CJeaner /\ir
                                    1.4 Stratospheric Ozone
                                                                       1-35

-------
               \_oncentrations of ozone-depleting substances leirective
                                                                              i"
  Effective equivalent chlorine (EECI), the amount of chlorine and
  bromine in the lower atmosphere, is used to represent concentra-
  tions of ozone-depleting substances. It is a convenient parameter
  for measuring with a single number the overall potential human
  effect on stratospheric ozone, EECI is derived by considering the
  changing concentrations of about a dozen gases that can affect
  the stratospheric ozone concentration. An index is then developed
  based on the ability of those gases to catalyze the destruction of
  ozone relative to the ability of chlorine to do so. The units of EECI
  are parts per trillion by volume.

  What the Data Show

  The Scientific Assessment states that the total effect of all ozone-
  depleting halogens in the atmosphere, estimated by calculating
  chlorine equivalents from atmospheric measurements of chlorine-
                  Exhibit 1-29: Global total effective
               equivalent chlorine (EECI), 1992-2002
      2000
         1991
                  1993
                           199S
                                   1997
                                            1999
                                                    2001
     Source; Updated from Montzka, Stephen A., et al. Present and future trends in the
     atmosp/WK bttrtltn of ozone-depleting halogens. April 1999;
     NQAA, Climate Monitoring & Diagnostics Laboratory. Halocarbons and other
     Atmospheric Trace Species (HATS). 2002. March 18,2003;
     Mlp://w»iw.cmitinoafi,fw/rais/graphs/graphs.html).
                          equivalent chlorine) - Category 2
              and bromine-: containing gases, continues to decrease. As of mid-
              2000, equivalent organic chlorine in the troposphere was nearly
              five percent below the peak value in 1992'to 1994 (Exhibit 1 .-
              29). The recent decrease is slightly slower] than in the mid-1990s
              due to the reduced influence of methyl chloroform on this decline
              (Scientific Assessment Panel, 2003).

              In 1996, EPA measurements indicated that concentrations of
              methyl chloroform had started to fall, indicating that emissions
              had been reduced. Concentrations of other ozone-depleting sub-
              stances in the: upper layers of the atmosphere, like CFCs, are also
              beginning to decrease. Stratospheric chloriine levels have appar-
              ently peaked 'and are expected to slowly decline in coming years
              (EPA, OAQPS, September 2002). The best current estimate from
              computer models is that the atmospheric burden of halogens will
              return to 1980 levels (pre-Antarctic ozone; hole) around the mid-
              dle of this century if the Montreal Protocol and its Amendments
              are fully adhered to (Scientific Assessment Panel, 2003).

              Indicator Caps and  Limitations

              The precision of this indicator depends ori understanding the
              chemistry and behavior of the many different gases involved. For
              example, accurate estimates of the atmospheric lifetime  of a gas
              are essential to assigning it the proper weight relative to other
              gases. As scientific understanding of atmospheric chemistry
              improves, calculations continue to be refined.
                                                                  Data Source
                                                                                                       I
              The data source for this indicator was Scientific Assessment of
              Ozone Depletion: 2002, Scientific Assessment Panel of the
              Montreal Protocol on Substances that Deplete the Ozone Layer,
              WMO, 2003, (See Appendix B, page B-8, for more information.)
1-36
1.4 Stratospheric Ozone
Cnjapter 1 - CJeaner /\ir

-------

  The increased ground-level UV radiation that can result from stratos-
  pheric ozone depletion is expected to have significant adverse human
  health effects. UV-B radiation is linked to skin cancer, increased inci-
  dence of cataracts, and suppression of the immune system (EPA,
  OAQPS, September 2002). Approximately 1.3 million new cases of
  skin cancer are diagnosed every year in the U.S., according to the
  Centers for Disease Control and Prevention (CDC) and the American
                                    Cancer Society. Malignant melanoma accounts for about 75 percent
                                    of the approximately 9,800 skin cancer deaths in the U.S. annually.
                                    The incidence rate of malignant melanoma is increasing by about 3
                                    percent annually, although death rates have remained constant
                                    (Wingo, et al., 1999).

                                    Possible increased UV radiation levels is only one of many factors
                                    that could affect skin cancer incidence. Others include behavioral
                                    changes (people spending more time at the beach or outdoors) and
                                    changes in screening for, diagnosis of, and reporting of the disease.

                                    Data on UV-B radiation and  tropospheric ozone are used to calculate
                                    benefits from accelerated phase-out schedules for ODSs. EPA
                                Exhibit 1-30: Estimated benefits of phaseout of ozone-depleting substances
                                       •    (sections 6OU, 6O6, and 609 of tne Clean Air Act)
       I Melanoma and nonmelanoma skin
        cancer (fatal)
6.3 million lives saved from skin cancer in the U.S. be-
tween 1990 and 2165
Dose-response function based on UV exposure and demo-
graphics of exposed populations1
      • Melanoma and nonmelanoma skin
        cancer (non-fatal)
299 million avoided cases of non-fatal skin cancers in the    Dose-response function based on UV exposure and demo-
US, between 1990 and 2165                          graphics of exposed populations1
                                          27.5 million avoided cases in the U.S. between 1990 and     Dose-response function uses a multivariate logistic risk function
                                          2165                                             based on demographic characteristics and medical history1
        American crop harvests
                                         Avoided 7.5 percent decrease from UV-b radiation by
                                         2075
                                                 Dose-response sources: Teramura and Murali (1986), Rowe
                                                 and Adams (1987)
                                         Avoided decrease from tropospheric ozone
                                                                                          Estimate of increase in troposhpheric ozone: Whitten and Gary
                                                                                          (1986). Dose-response source: Rowe and Adams (1987)
                                         Avoided damage to materials from UV-b radiation
                                                                                          Source of UV-b/stabilizer relationship; Horst (1986)
      Skin cancer: reduced pain and suffering
      Reduced morbidity effects of increased UV. For example:
        reduced actinic keratosis (pre-cancerous lesions resulting from excessive sun exposure)
        reduced immune system suppression
      Ecological effects of UV. For example, benefits relating to the following:
      • recreational fishing                                           B other crops
      " forests                                                    B other plant species
      • overall marine ecosystem                                      x f;sn harvests
        avoided sea level rise, including avoided b.each erosion, loss of coastal
        wetlands, salinity of estuaries and aquifers
     1) For more detail see EPA's Regulatory Impact Analysis: Protection of Stratospheric Ozone (1988).
     2) Note that the ecological effects, unlike the health effects, do not reflect the accelerated reduction and phaseout schedule of section 606.
     3) Benefits due to the section 606 methyl bromide phaseout are not included in the benefits total because EPA provides neither annual incidence estimates nor a monetary
     value. The EPA does provide, however, a total estimate of 2,800 avoided skin cancer fatalities in the U.S.
     Source: EPA, Office of Air and Radiation. The Benefits and Costs of the Clean Air Act 7990 to 2070. EPA Report to Congress November 1999
                                       '   '      '                                 '
                                                                                                                                               Lil
Chapter 1  - Cleaner Air
                  1.4 Stratospheric Ozone
                                                                                                                                           1-37

-------
estimates that between 1990 and 2165, in the U.S. alone 6.3 million
fatal skin cancers, 299 million cases of non-fatal skin cancers, and
27.5 million cases of cataracts will be prevented because of the
worldwide phase-out of ODSs. (EPA, OAR, November 1999)
(Exhibit 1 -30). These are estimated cumulative effects, so there are
no data series or trends to evaluate.

No specific indicators have been identified at this time for human
health effects of stratospheric ozone depletion.
                     Iffi


 UV radiation in sunlight affects the physiological and developmental
 processes of plants. Even though plants have mechanisms to reduce
 or repair these effects and some ability to adapt to increased UV-B
 levels, UV radiation can still directly affect plant growth. It can also
 produce indirect effects such as changes in  plant form, distribution
 of nutrients within the plant, timing of developmental phases, and
 secondary metabolism. These changes can be even more important
 than direct damage because of their implications for plant competi-
 tive balance, herbivory, plant diseases, and biogeochemical cycles
 (UNEP, 1994).

 UV radiation can also affect aquatic life. UV exposure affects both
 orientation  mechanisms and motility in phytoplankton, resulting in
 reduced survival rates for these organisms. Scientists have demon-
 strated a direct reduction in phytoplankton production as a result of
 ozone depletion-related increases in UV-B (DeMora, et al., 2000).
 Small increases in  UV-B  radiation have been found to cause damage
 in the early developmental stages offish, shrimp, crab, amphibians,
 and other animals, the most severe effects being decreased repro-
 ductive capacity and impaired larval development Animals higher on
 the food chain that depend on these organisms for food could, in
 turn, be affected (UNEP, 1994).

 Increases in UV  radiation could also affect terrestrial and aquatic
 biogeochemical cycles, and, as a result, alter both sources and sinks
 of greenhouse and chemically important trace gases. These potential
 changes would contribute to biosphere-atmosphere feedback that
 attenuates or reinforces the atmospheric buildup of these gases
 (UNEP, 1994). Synthetic polymers, naturally occurring biopolymers,
 and some other materials of commercial interest also are adversely
 affected by UV radiation, but special  additives somewhat protect
 some modern materials from UV-B. Increases in UV-B levels nonethe-
 less will likely accelerate their breakdown, limiting their usefulness
 outdoors (UNEP,  1994).

 No specific indicators have been identified at this time to address
 the ecological effects associated with stratospheric ozone depletion.
          1.5  Climate  Change

          The issue of global climate change involves changes in the radiative
          balance of the Earth-the balance between energy received from the
          sun and emitted from the Earth. This report does not attempt to
          address the complexities of this issue. For information on the $1.7
          billion annual U.S. Global Climate Research Program and Climate
          Change Research Initiative, please find (pur Changing Planet: The
          Fiscal Year 20,03 U.S. Global Climate Research Program (November
          2002) at www.usgcrp.gov and the Draft Ten-Year Strategic Plan for the
          Climate Change Science Program at www.clirhatescience.gov.
                                                                            :   i
                                                                            f	!	
  1-38
1.5 Climate Change
Chapter 1 - Cleaner Air

-------
1.6  CJiallenges  and  Data



(Daps


Outdoor Air (Duality ana Acid Deposition

In general, some very good indicators of outdoor air quality exist.
The national air monitoring network for the six criteria air pollutants
is extensive; however, there are far more monitors in urban areas than
in rural areas. Monitoring in urban areas helps to characterize popu-
lation exposures, because population tends to be concentrated in  '
urban areas.  More rural monitoring might help scientists assess
transport and ecological effects, although EPA uses additional tools
and techniques (e.g., models and spatial analyses) to augment limit-
ed monitoring in  some areas and to better characterize pressures on
ecological condition. EPA is currently conducting a national assess-
ment of the existing ambient monitoring networks and is analyzing,
among other issues, the need for and appropriateness of each of the
nation's urban monitors.

Many major metropolitan areas monitor air quality for the presence
of selected air toxics. However, there is no national monitoring net-
work with standard data collection guidance for air toxics; therefore, .
numerous air toxics are not being measured. National assessments of
levels of air toxics would benefit from a more extensive ambient
monitoring network for toxics. EPA is currently working with state
and local partners to design and deploy such a network.

Questions still exist about how indicators of concentrations and
emissions relate to exposure and human health effects. The use of
one approach to  determining how various air pollution levels affect
health would be to use established and quantified effects and
surrogates for air pollution health impacts from epidemiology stud-
ies, such as asthma hospitalizations and childhood school absences.
Research needs to be conducted that will develop these health
endpoints into useful indicators.

As highlighted in Chapter 4, Human Health, for most health out-
comes other than mortality, no national systems for data collection
currently exist. With regard to criteria air pollutants,  it would  be use-
ful to track asthma and chronic respiratory diseases,  cardiovascular
diseases, and adverse birth outcomes. For air pollutants in general,
including air  toxics and indoor pollutants, the list can also include
neurological  diseases, developmental disabilities, reproductive
disorders, and endocrine/metabolic disorders.
                As described in Chapter 5, Ecological Condition, there are large
                gaps in our ability to report on the condition of ecological systems
                and linkages between Indicators of atmospheric stressors and
                specific ecological effects. There is a need for improved monitoring
                information for deposition and concentrations of both criteria and
                toxic air pollutants to ecosystems. Data on exposure of high-eleva-
                tion forests and their watersheds to ozone and acid deposition are
                especially sparse, relative to data on  lower elevations. And exposure
                patterns are likely to be significantly  different at higher elevations
                because of higher acid deposition rates due to higher rainfall and
                fog, and less diurnal variation in ozone concentrations due to less
                nighttime  scavenging (NAPAP, 1991). Furthermore, despite consid-
                erable progress, there is still no index of ozone exposure that
                relates optimally to plant response (EPA, NCEA, July 1996).
                Although  mercury monitoring has begun as part of the National
                Atmospheric Deposition Program, the availability of data is
                inadequate to assess national trends (EPA, OAQPS, ORD, December
                1997). There are inadequate data on indicators of actual UV
                exposures of ecosystems of all types.

                Indoor Air Ouality

                While environmental indicators have  been developed for some
                aspects of indoor air, significant gaps exist in our knowledge about
                the conditions  inside the nation's buildings.  For schools and
                residences, a large amount of information on IAQ is available, but
                it is composed  primarily of case studies and, at best, small regional
                studies. Exposure studies on a  national scale would help better
                characterize IAQ of schools and residential indoor environments,
                including multiple family residences.  Ideally,  these studies would
                collect exposure data on air toxics and PM in these indoor
                environments, and data for the various biological contaminants
                found  in indoor air.
                jtratospneric Ozone
                In general, high quality data exists with which to predict the human
                health effects of increased ultraviolet exposure resulting from
                depletion of the stratospheric ozone. These include robust satellite
                data on stratospheric ozone concentrations and UV-B levels, com-
                prehensive and well documented incidence and mortality rates for
                cutaneous melanoma, and well characterized action spectra for skin
                cancers and cataracts. However,  there are areas where additional
                data would be useful. First, no national system exists that collects
                incidence data for squamous cell carcinoma and basal cell  carcino-
                ma, the non-melanoma skin-cancers caused by increased UV-B
                exposure. Thus, our incidence estimates are modeled using data
                from a nation-wide survey of non-melanoma skin cancer incidence
                and mortality, and may not represent the most current non-
                melanoma skin cancer rates. Second, there is a lack of adequate
Chapter I - Cleaner Air
1.6 Challenges and Data Gaps
1-39

-------
ground level UV monitoring with which to compare the satellite
data. Satellites cannot directly measure ground level UV, and are
sensitive to pollution. Therefore, while satellite data compare fairly
well to ground level UV measurements in  clean locations, this is not
the case in polluted areas. Additional UV monitoring in cities is
crucial to support future epidemiological research on the human
health effects of UV-B exposure. Third, increased UV-B levels have
been associated with other  human and non-human endpoints
including immune suppression and effects on aquatic ecosystems
and agricultural crops. However, additional research on these top-
ics is necessary before these effects can be modelled or quantified.
Finally, the future behavior of the ozone layer will be affected by
changing atmospheric abundances of various atmospheric gases.
It remains unclear how these changes will affect the predicted
recovery of the ozone layer. Additional research on the interaction
between climate and stratospheric ozone could provide more
accurate predictions of ozone recovery and the  human health
effects resulting from ozone depletion.
                                                                                                     I  i
1-40
1.6 Challenges and Data Gaps
Chapter I - Cleaner Air

-------

-------
Indicators that were selected and included in this chapter were assigned to one o(, two categories:        j  ;         '

• Category 1 -The indicator has been peer reviewed and is supported by national level data coverage for r»ore than one time period.
  The supporting data are comparable across the nation and are characterized b^spund collection methodologies, data management
  systems, and quality assurance procedures.                                 (            ,           j  j
  Category 2 -The indicator has been peer reviewed, but the supporting data a, 4 available only for part of the nation (e.g multi-state
       6  y       .    ,_..,,.. =__,:„,:_ u	* u=«r, ™«=,,TOH for more than one time period, or not all the parameters ol the
• ^ QtCK'Wl V ••  I I 1C HIVII»-afc*^t m.jrf.rf»»»...j- —	„_.-_..  ,          ...      _
 regions or ecoregions), or the indicator has not been measured for more than
   regions or ecoregions), or the indicator nas not oeen meabuieu ,u,  ,,,u,c ^..^ *••— ,.»•-- -       	,  :	
   nTator have been measured (e.g., data has been collected for birds, but not f>r plants or insects).  The supporting data are
   comparable across the areas covered, and are characterized by sound collecticfrmethodolog.es, data management systems, and

   quality assurance procedures.

-------
 2.0   Introduction

 Our nation's water resources have immeasurable value. Animals,
 plants, and ecosystems depend on clean and abundant water,
 without which they could not exist. Humans, too, need clean water
 to drink, to grow food, and to produce goods and services. Clean
 water generates billions of dollars for the economy each year. Water
 resources provide opportunities for families to swim and fish, and
 wetlands protect homes and property against floods. Rivers, lakes,
 wetlands, and coastal waters provide critical  habitats for many
 species and serve as nurseries for many of the valued commercial
 and recreational fisheries. Water beneath the water table in fully
 saturated soils and geological  formations, known as ground water,
 provides half the nation with drinking water.

 An increasing tide of pressures has compromised the health of many
 waterbodies. In the early 20th century, industrial growth and an
 expanding population left behind  a legacy of pollution. After the
 burning of Ohio's Cuyahoga River—so polluted with oil and debris
 that it caught fire—Congress passed the landmark Clean Water Act
 (CWA) and Safe Drinking Water Act (SDWA). These acts and  other
 laws brought to bear strong regulatory and financial tools to clean
 up polluted surface waters and ensure that public water systems
 provide safe drinking water.

 Thanks to these significant investments, pollutant discharges into our  '
 nation's waters have been substantially reduced and the safety of public
 water supplies has improved (EPA, OW, December 1999). Nevertheless,
 significant water pollution problems persist and threats to drinking
 water remain. Today, discharges from industry and sewage treatment
 plants, together with pollution from many other sources—including,
 agricultural lands, residential areas, city streets, forestry operations, and
 pollutants settling out of the air—continue to degrade our nation's
 waters. Other stresses also threaten water quality. These include
 landscape modification, introduction of invasive species, changes in flow
 patterns, and over-harvesting offish and other aquatic organisms.

 Adequately maintained water infrastructure will be essential to
 sustain the water quality gains of the past 30 years  and to address
 challenges to water quality and delivery of safe drinking water in the
 coming years. By achieving a better understanding of the condition
 of our nation's waters, we will be able to make informed decisions
 about how to protect and preserve our water infrastructure.

 This chapter summarizes what is generally understood about the
 current status and trends in water quality, the pressures affecting
 water quality, and information regarding associated human health
 and ecological effects. It poses fundamental questions about water
 quality, sources of pollution, and health  and ecological effects, and it
 uses indicators drawn from well-reviewed data sources to help answer
those questions. Exhibit 2-1  lists these questions and indicators, as
           well as the number of the chapter section where each indicator is
           presented.

           The questions addressed in this chapter are divided into four
           categories:
           • Waters and watersheds, discussed in Section 2.2.
           • Drinking water, discussed in Section 2.3.
           • Recreation in and on the water, discussed in Section 2.4.
           • Consumption offish  and shellfish, discussed in Section 2.5.

           Section 2.1 provides information on the extent and use of our
           nation's water resources. Section 2.6 reviews the challenges and data
           gaps that remain in assessing the condition of our nation's water
           resources.

           The key sources of data used to support these indicators vary and
           are described in each section. Some of the primary data sources that
           contribute directly or indirectly to indicators throughout this chapter
           include data from EPA and other federal agencies. Predominant EPA
           programs or data sets supporting the indicators in this chapter
           include the Environmental Monitoring and  Assessment Program
           (EMAP); the National Sediment Quality Inventory; the Toxics Release
           Inventory (TRI); the Safe Drinking Water Information System
           (SDWIS); the National Health Protection Survey of  Beaches; and the
           National Listing of Fish and Wildlife Advisories  (NLFWA).  Other
           national programs that provide data for the indicators described  in
           this chapter include the:
           • U.S. Geological Survey's National Water Quality Assessment
             (NAWQA) program.
           • U.S. Fish and Wildlife Service's (USFWS's) National Wetlands
             Inventory (NWI) studies of the status and trends of wetlands
             resources.
           • U.S. Department of Agriculture (USDA) Natural Resources
             Conservation Service's (NRCS's) National Resources Inventory
             (NRI).
           • National Atmospheric Deposition Program  (NADP).
           • National Oceanic and Atmospheric Administration (NOAA) programs.

           Many of these data sets have been compiled and  summarized in a
           report titled The State of the Nation's Ecosystems, developed by the
           H. John  Heinz III Center  for Science, Economics and  the Environment
           (The Heinz Center, 2002). Gaps in the data exist that make it
           difficult or impossible to answer some of the questions posed about
           the condition of our nation's waters. Data gaps  and  limitations are
           described under each question and at the end of this chapter.
Chapter 2 - Purer Water
2.0 Introduction
                                                                                                                             2-3

-------
	 ^.m.^.^.i-™™™, ««*-'-, 	 ,•••„- -,B-,,,I,,,,ir 	 	 'I 	 1 	 „ 	 " 	 •"'',""»"" 	 '', • -n.i-1 v '• : ,,,],, „.„„',,.- ,i. ...ll ; ' ' ,„" - 7" ,|Sft^«h ^ ,N>I«I- -">•'''!. Jlriu. 'I11?; •' -jjlln-Jlll, 	 Kf 'HiNilPlu, 'III, ,- "Mf 	 ^ ,,$^1 H'l
i1 I, 	 . • . . '!,,,,'!!' •'" " • i, ' 
Sediment contamination of inland waters
Sediment contamination of coastal waters
Sediment toxicity in estuaries .
Fish Index of Biotic Integrity in streams
Also see Ecological Condition chapter ,
Macroinvertebrate Biotic Integrity index for streams
Also see Ecological Condition chapter
Benthic Community Index for coastal waters
Also see Ecological Condition chapter
	 1 	 sLv 	 ..: : ,.;;,., M ,:,:,,
2
2
•\
2
2
2
2
2

2
2
2
1
2
2

2
2
2
2
2
2

2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2.2.1
2.2.1
2.2.2
2.2.2
b.3
fi.2.3
2.2.3
£.2.3


|2.2.4.a
J2.2.4.3





2.2.4.a
2.2.4.a ,
2.2.4.a
2.2.4.a

p.2.4.b



2.2.4.b
2.2.4.b
2.2.4.b
;2.2.4.b
J2.2.4.b


I2.2.4.C





2.2.4.C
2.2.4.C
2.2.4.C
2.2.4.C
2.2.4.C
~l 2.2.4.C
J2.2.4.C


2.2.5
2.2.5
2.2.5
i

• '• --" '



: ' 	






2-4
                                                    2.0 Introduction
                                                                                            c
lapter 2 - furer Water

-------

                                                                        Drinking Water
                What is the quality of drinking water?
                What are sources of drinking water contamination?
                What human health effects are associated with drinking
           8     contaminated water?
   Population served by community water systems
   that meets all health-based standards
                                                                       No Category 1 or 2 indicators identified
   No Category 1 or 2 indicators identified
   Also see Human Health chapter
                                                               Recreation in and on the Water
                                                             Consumption of Fish and Shellfish
               What is the condition of waters that support consumption
               of fish and shellfish?
               What are contaminants in fish and shellfish, and where
               do they originate?
              •^	
               What human health effects are associated with consuming
               contaminated fish and shellfish?
                                                                     Percent of river miles and lake acres under fish
                                                                     consumption advisories
 Contaminants in fresh water fish
 Number of watersheds exceeding health-based
 national water quality criteria for mercury and PCBs
 in fish tissue
 	.^—^	—

 No Category 1 or 2 indicators identified
 —	—
 No Category 1  or 2 indicators identified
 Also see Human Health chapter
1


23.1
2.3.2
2.3.3
                What is the condition of waters supporting
                recreational use?
                What are sources of recreational water pollution?
                                                                                        indicators identified
                What human health effects-are associated with recreation in
                                                                      No Category 1  or 2 indicators identified
                contaminated waters?
                                                                      Also see Human Health chapter
                                                                     2.5.1
                                                                                                                                         2.5.1
2.5.1


2.5.2

2.5.3
Chapter 2 - Purer Water
2.0 Introduction
                                                                                                                                                     2-5

-------
2.1  Extent  and  Use  of


Water  Resources

Our nation's water resources, which consist of both surface waters
and ground water, are critical to both human activities and the
functioning of ecological systems:
• Surface waters, such as rivers, lakes, ponds, reservoirs, wetlands,
   riparian  (river and stream) areas, and estuarine areas, are
   fundamental components of ecological systems described in this
   report. They are also important sources of fresh water for human
   use, including drinking water, recreation, wastewater treatment,
   industrial usage, livestock, and irrigation. Wetlands and riparian
   areas help provide clean water, reduce flooding, and support
   critical fish and wildlife habitat.
 • Ground water, one of our nation's most important natural
   resources, provides about 40 percent of the U.S. public water
   supply and much of the rural water supply, which comes primarily
    from domestic wells. Ground water also is the source of much of
   the water used for irrigation, is the principal reserve of fresh water,
    and represents much of our nation's potential future water supply.
    Ground water may contribute as much as 40 percent of all stream
    flow in the eastern U.S. (Alley, et al., 1999).
            Extent  of Ground  Water and
                 Fresh Water Resources

     Ground water comprises about 25 percent of all fresh water
     on Earth. By contrast, surface water and soil moisture consti-
     tute less than one percent of the world's fresh water (Alley, et
     al.,  1999) (the remaining 75  percent is stored in polar ice and
     glaciers). The Great Lakes, which cover 60.2 million acres,
     hold about 18 percent of the globe's fresh surface water
     (Environment Canada and EPA, 1995).

     The lower 48 states (conterminous U.S.) contain:
     g About half of our nation's 41.6 million acres of lakes,
        ponds, and reservoirs.
     • About 3.7 million miles of streams and rivers (EPA, OW, June
        2000).
     H An estimated 105.5  million acres of wetlands as of the mid-
        1990s (Dahl, 2000).

      Alaska has an estimated 170 million acres of wetlands, which
      cover approximately 45 percent of the state. Hawaii has nearly
      52,000 acres of wetlands (Dahl, 1990). U.S. coastal waters
      include 66,645 miles of coastline and 57.9 million acres of
      estuarine surface area (EPA, OW, June 2000).
Ground water and surface water are closely| related and, in many
areas, constitute a singe resource. Both are| recharged through
precipitation. The U.S. receives enough annjua! precipitation to cover •
the entire country to a depth of 30 inches | (known as the U.S. water
budget), though the eastern U.S. receives rjnore rainfall than the
western part of the country. Over two-thircjs (21 inches) of this
precipitation returns to the water cycle through evapotranspiration.
The rest becomes surface water, ground water, or soil moisture.

Water use is an important dynamic that can impact both the
quantity and quality of available fresh water resources. Accurate
information about water use helps planners and managers make
informed decisions about our nation's water resources. With this
information, they can project future water [demand and better assess
the effectiveness of alternative  water-management policies,
 regulations, and conservation activities. >  ;

 States report their water use to the U.S. Geological Survey (USGS) in
 five mutually Delusive categories:
 B Public water supply use—water withdrawn by public and private
    water suppliers and delivered  to homes and businesses for drinking,
    commercial, and industrial uses.        j
 • Self-suppliert water—water for domestic uj>e and for livestock that is
    not drawn 'torn the public supply.     ,,  j
 • Irrigation—-th\s includes application toicrpps, pastures, and recre-
    ational lands such as parks and golf courses.
 • ThermoeleMc use—that is, water used for cooling during electric
    power generation.                   '
 m Industrial use—this includes self-suppliec) water for fabrication, pro- ;
    cessing, cooling, and washing (including commercial and mining uses).

 The USGS coordinates the national watef use compilation effort and
  publishes the results every five years in tile circular series Estimated
  Use  of Water in the U.S. Withdrawals are:reported in billions of
  gallons of water per day for the five use (Categories. Sources of
  information and accuracy of water-use !da|ta vary by state and by
  water-use category (The Heinz Center,:2002).

  The USGS (Solley, et al., 1998) estimatejd'that:
  H Total withdrawals of fresh water andisaline water during 1995 were
    402,000 million gallons per day (Mga[l/d) for all water-use
    categories (public supply, domestic,; commercial, irrigation,
    livestock, industrial, mining, and thermoelectric power).
   • Total fresh water withdrawals were an ^stimated 341,000 Mgal/d.
    About 100,000 Mgal/d (29.3  percent) of this was consumed,
     and the rest (241,000 Mgal/d,  or 70j7 percent) was returned.
             1                         I
   From 1960 to 1980, total water use, as well as the water use for
   each majoruse category, increased. Hpvjrever, from 1980 to 1995,
   total water use, as well as usage in several individual  categories
   declined, though water used for public supply continued to grow
   (Exhibit 2-2). The two largest uses of wjater in the U.S.—irrigation
   and'coolinj;  (during electric  power generation)—were responsible
   for much of the decline in total use between 1980 and 1995.
    2-6
                                                 2.1  Extent and Use of Water Resources
                                     Chapter 2 - furer Water

-------
    Decreases in withdrawals by self-supplied industrial users also con-
    tributed to the overall decline.

    In many areas of the U.S., withdrawal of ground water has
    significantly depleted ground water reserves. Since ground water and
    surface water are closely related, this depletion can reduce river
    flows, lower lake levels, and reduce discharges to wetlands and
    springs. These reductions may, in turn, affect drinking water supplies,
    riparian areas, and critical aquatic habitats (Alley, et al., 1999). |n
                                                             the southwestern U.S., for example, the High Plains aquifer covers
                                                             174,000 square miles under eight states stretching from South
                                                             Dakota to Texas. By 1999, an estimated 220 million acre-feet (270
                                                             cubic kilometers, or something over half the amount of water
                                                             contained in Lake Erie) had been removed (USGS, 2002), primarily
                                                             for irrigation.
I
[:,.

ra
r "o
p-fc
I" Q_
U c
Mr

' "Wl
' C
g
a.
^- -
'
400

350
300


250


200
150

100
.50
0

Source of Freshwater
-Withdrawals " _~._fr~:-.^--..



- . ..-. ' . _' 	 - - . ,- 	 ,


Surface Water



-_~~-=sci-- ^T. 	 Ground Water
|
                                  ;  txhibit 2-2: Sources of fresh water withdrawals, 1960-1995
                                                                       400
                                                                       350
                                                                     >,
                                                                    -3 300
                                                                     s.
                                                                     £ 250
                                                                    _o
                                                                    | 200
                                                                     in
                                                                    J 150
                                                                    3
                                                                       100

                                                                        50
             1970   1975  1980   1985    1990   1995

Coverage: all SO.states

Source: Solley et al. Estimated Use of Water in the United States in 7995. 1 998,
                                                                              Freshwater Withdrawals
                                                                                                             Irrigation
                                                                                                        Thermoelectric
                                                                                                                        - Rural
                                                                         I960    1965   1970   1975   1980   1985   1990   195
Chapter 2 - Purer Water
                                    2.1 Extent and Use of Water Resources
                                                                                                                             2-7

-------
2.2  Waters  and
Watersheds
A watershed is the area that drains to a common waterway, such as a
stream, lake, estuary, wetland, or ultimately the ocean. It is a land
feature that is identified by tracing a line along the highest elevations
 (often a ridge) between two areas on a map. Watersheds come in all
 shapes and sizes, and smaller watersheds drain into larger watersheds
 which may cross county, state, and national boundaries. For example, a
 small stream running through a farmer's field in Pennsylvania may drain
 only a few acres within the larger Susquehanna River watershed, which in
 turn is a portion of the Chesapeake Bay watershed, which extends
 across six states and the District of Columbia. The watershed's natural
 processes (e.g., rainfall runoff, ground water recharge, sediment
 transport, plant succession) provide beneficial services when functioning
 properly, but may cause ecological and physical (flooding) disasters
 when misunderstood and disrupted. Watersheds are subject to many
 different pressures (or "stressors"), including pollution and human
 activities (see Exhibit 2-3).

  Because of their many influences on water quality, watersheds are
  often the focus of efforts to manage water use and reduce pollution.
  Traditionally, managers have focused on reducing pollution from
  specific sources (such as sewage discharges) or within specific water
  resources (such as river segments or wetlands). This approach
  successfully reduces pollutant loads, but often does not adequately
  address the combined concentration of multiple sources that
  contribute to a watershed's decline. For example, pollution from a
  sewage treatment plant might be reduced significantly after a new
           Exhibit 2-3: Selected activities affecting water,
              watersheds and drinking water resources
            Air deposition
Urban and suburban activities
                 Forestry
      Agricultural   P™ctkes
       practices
                                technology is installed, and yet the local river may still suffer if other
                                factors in the watershed, such as habitat destruction or non-point
                                source pollution, are not addressed. Watershed management can
                                offer a stronger foundation than more traditional segmented
                                approaches fqr elucidating the many stressors that affect a
                                watershed ami for developing effective ma lagement strategies to
                                protect water resources.
                                                                    ;   I
                                Section 2.2 addresses five questions about our nation's waters and
                                watersheds:                            j
                                H What is the condition of fresh surface waters and watersheds in
                                   theUS.? ,.'...           ,                   '   .. '   i
                                • What are the extent and condition of wetlands?
                                H What is the condition of coastal waters?"
                                | What are pressures to water quality?   \
                                • What ecological affects are associated ^ith impaired waters?
                                                                       [
                                 Loss of wetlands and the diversion of strejam flows are important to
                                 understand and quantify condition. Coition, which is addressed in
                                 the first three questions, is a function of the quality, extent, and
                                 location of the water and how that water equality affects the
                                 condition of the biotic resources that depend on that water. To
                                 answer questions about condition, a watershed's extent, as well as its
                                 chemical, physical, and biological attributes, must be defined. Section
                                 2.2 addresses extent and chemical  and physical attributes. Chapter
                                 5, Ecological Condition, describes the biotic condition of waters and
                                 watersheds.:
Indicators
Altered jjresh water ecosystems
Lake Trophic State Index
                                   Because the components of condition vjary naturally, condition is
                                   most often defined as a trend in concentrations or as concentrations
                                   relative to standards adopted by state Agencies or set by EPA. Only a
                                   few programs collect information on the; condition of waters at a
                                   national scale. One of the most widespread among these programs is
                                   EPA's state;data collection and reporting program, mandated under
                                   Section 305 (b) of the Clean Water Act' (CWA), and the associated
                                   biennial National Water Quality Inventory (NWQI). At this time,
                                   however, these data cannot be used to produce a national indicator
                                   that can answer this question with sufficient confidence and
                                   scientific credibility because the programs vary greatly from state to
                                   state in the:
                                   H Percentage of waters assessed.
                                   • Monitoring approaches used.

    2-8
                                                        2.2 Waters and Watersheds
                                                                      Chapter2-Purer Water
                                                                                                     ,	I

-------
     • Water quality standards upon which the assessments are based
     • Water quality characteristics measured in those assessments.

     The CWA vests responsibility in states, territories, and tribes to assess
     the health of their waters at least every two years. The purpose of these
     assessments is to determine if the water quality in different areas is
     supporting "designated uses," which are defined under state procedures
     and approved by EPA. Typical state designated uses include aquatic life
     protection, drinking water supplies, fish and shellfish consumption,
    recreation, and agricultural, industrial, and domestic uses. Because'of
    the high cost of monitoring, states, territories, and tribes typically
    collect data and information for only a portion of their waterbodies.
    Their programs and sampling techniques differ. Compounding these
    differences is the fact that states also have the responsibility to set
    water quality  standards, many  of which differ between states. States
    monitor water quality to identify and address problems, and they often
    place a higher priority on immediate management concerns than on
    characterizing all their water resources. These issues limit the ability to
    use CWA-mandated state data to describe water quality conditions at
    the national level.

   Two indicators,  "altered fresh  water ecosystems" and "lake trophic
   state," partially address the question of the quality of the nation's
   waters. These indicators are somewhat limited at this time, but they
   do show that  23 percent of fresh water resources have been altered
   physically to some degree and that  22 percent of northeastern  U.S.
   lakes exhibit eutrophic conditions.

   In addition to the CWA 30S(b) reporting program, several other exist-
   ing programs also contribute to our understanding of the condition of
   aquatic resources:

   The U.S. Geological Survey's (USGS's) National Water Quality
  Assessment(NAWQA) program is a  perennial program designed to
  provide consistent descriptions of the status and trends of some of
  the largest and most important streams and aquifer systems of the
  nation  and to link the status and trends to the natural and human
  factors that affect water quality. The  program involves physical,
  chemical, and biological assessments of 42 large hydrologic systems,
  which are-conducted on staggered 10-year cycles. These
  assessments include targeted sampling designs to measure stream
  flow, habitat, water, sediment, and tissue chemistry, and to
  characterize algae, invertebrate, and fish communities. NAWQA
  studies cover watersheds and aquifers contributing a high
  percentage of the water used in the U.S. The NAWQA program has
 made valuable contributions in documenting the close relationship
 between land use, chemicals  used in watersheds (e.g., for
 urban/industrial or agricultural activities), and the presence and
 concentrations of chemicals found in streams and ground water.

. EPA's Environmental Monitoring and Assessment Program (EMAP)
 conducts representative sampling of estuarine and stream resources
 and incorporates biological measures in condition estimates.
 Geographic coverage for fresh water resources is limited to the
                    mid-Atlantic region and the western states. Coverage of estuarine
                    resources has been primarily limited to coastal areas on the East
                    Coast south of Cape Cod, in the Gulf of Mexico, and in some
                    western states. EMAP data on biological condition have been report-
                    ed for fish and macroinvertebrates in Mid-Atlantic Highland streams
                    and for macrobenthos in East Coast and Gulf of Mexico estuaries.

                    The National Oceanic and Atmospheric Administration's (NOAA's)
                    National Status and Trends program (NS&T) collects information
                    on the chemical contamination of sediments and organisms and
                    potential biological effects in the nation's coastal areas. Sampling of
                    sediments .and bivalves was initiated in the  mid-1980s from over 250
                    sites along the U.S. coast in areas not considered to be heavily pol-
                    luted. On a national scale, the higher levels of contamination in sedi-
                   ments are clearly associated with the urbanized areas of the north-
                   east states and with areas near San Diego, Los Angeles,  and Seattle
                   on the West Coast Except at a few sites, higher levels of sediment
                   contamination are relatively rare in the Southeast and along the Gulf
                   of Mexico coast.

                   The Natural Resources Conservation Service's (NRCS's) National
                   Resources Inventory (NRI) is a statistically-based sample of land use
                   and natural resource conditions and trends on U.S. non-federal
                   lands. NRI collects data on  land cover and use, soil erosion, prime
                  farmland soils, wetlands, habitat diversity, selected conservation
                  practices, and related resource attributes. Many of the resource
                  inventories have recognized relationships to water quality. The NRI
                  provides comprehensive data on land use on the 1.5 billion acres of
                  non-federal lands which are made up of roughly equal parts of
                  rangeland (27 percent), forest land (27 percent), and cropland
                  (25 percent).

                  The U.S. Fish and Wildlife Service's (USFWS's) National
                  Wetlands Inventory (NWI) project produces information on the
                 characteristics and extent of the nation's wetlands that is  used by
                 the USFWS to produce status and trends reports. The Emergency
                 Wetlands Resources Act requires USFWS to update this information
                 at 10-year intervals. Data collected from over 4,300 randomly
                 selected sample plots provide important long-term trend information
                 about specific changes in wetland extent, where those changes take
                 place, and the overall status of wetlands in the U.S.. Data are
                 produced by the USFWS National Wetlands Inventory, which has
                 mapped 89 percent of the conterminous U.S. USFWS results are
                 discussed further in Section 2.2.2 of this chapter.

                 These programs portray a general picture of widespread fresh water    '
                 and coastal wetland loss, of water quality widely impacted by stream
                 bank habitat loss, and of chemical contamination as urban land uses
                ancl agriculture encroach into riparian areas. They show that the abun-
                dance of nutrients from agriculture and atmospheric sources  impacts
                coastal areas, with 40 percent of estuaries exhibiting eutrophic condi-
                tions (high nutrient concentrations and algae production), and some
                estuaries also experiencing hypoxia (insufficient oxygen levels to sup-
                port marine life) and reduced water clarity.
Chapter 2 - Purer Water
2.2'Waters and Watersheds
                                                                                                                               2-9

-------

Pesticides from agricultural and urban areas are found widely in
surface waters, and residues from past chemical uses are found in
sediments and fish tissue. Mercury and mercury compounds are
foremost among pollutants contaminating fish. Bacterial
contamination is found throughout surface waters used for drinking,
although treatment of public water supplies is an effective barrier to
protect human health. Contamination of swimming beaches by
bacteria, however, continues to be a concern.

An improved ability to report on the condition of surface waters will
require a collaboration of states, tribal authorities, and federal
agencies. This may  involve a nationally coordinated program/Under
Section 305 (b) of the Clean Water Act, states are required to report
 on the condition of their waterways. This requirement could serve as
 a platform upon which national condition estimates could be
 compiled using a consistent sample design approach and comparable
 data collection  and analysis procedures.

 EPA has long sought to increase the coverage of water quality
 assessments made and submitted biannually in conformance with
 Section 305 (b) of the CWA. Historically, states have employed
 monitoring programs with sampling methods targeted to known
 problem areas that exhibit well-defined point and non-point
 pollution sources.  While these approaches are effective in relating
 pollution sources to water quality conditions, they cannot accurately
  represent both the extent and condition of water quality problems
  and resources. EPA issued guidance on water quality assessments  in
  1997 (EPA, OW, September 1997), and produced a major
  supplement to this guidance in 2002 (EPA, OW, July 2002). These
  documents describe a comprehensive assessment as an evaluation of
  water resources that covers a complete geographic area or resource;
  provides information on the resource condition and spatial  and
  temporal trends in the resource condition; and identifies the
   stressors (causes) and sources of pollution. The approach to these
   assessments is defined as either a complete survey (census), a
   judgmental or targeted design, or a statistical survey (probability-
   based) using randomly selected sample locations that allow
   researchers to make valid inferences about the condition of the water
   resource. The targeted approach is effective for relating specific
   pollution sources to water-condition and is used in guiding pollution
   abatement, whereas the statistical/census survey approaches provide
   a complete or representative assessment of the entire  resource.

    In 2000.14 states reported that they had monitored  and assessed
    more than 95 percent of their lakes, and 10 states reported that
    they had assessed at least 98 percent of their rivers. Two years.
    later, in 2002, three states reported that they had made these
    assessments using a statistically valid sampling design. Several
    states are engaged in multi-year studies that are adding probabilistic
    surveys to their  assessments. Examples of states that are collecting
    data from statistically-based monitoring networks are  described in
    the sidebar.
    Statistically-based water quality
             monitoring in states:
                  Two examples
                                 j  I
Indiana                      ,    !  I
In its 2002 State of the Environment Report, the Indiana
Department of Environmental Management'(IDEM) used a sta-
tistical su[vey to assess stream water quality by major water-
sheds. Historically, IDEM assessed 6^000 to 8,000 miles of
stream e>jlry two years. Beginning in 1996, 20 percent of the
state's streams Were sampled each year in its watershed moni-
toring program and then assessed for ihe ability to support
aquatic life. The results allowed IDEM to  estimate the water
quality W thin each major water basin 'in the state. IDEM
reports His data with  95 percent confidence. Accuracy varies
 between
      aasins, but is Between 11 anci 16 percent.
 Of the 3 5,430 stream miles assessed over the past five years,
 approximately 64.5 percent were estimated to fully support
 the maintenance of welLbalanced aquatic communities. Fish
 and benlhic macroinvertebrate community'assessments provid-
 ed a measurement of adverse response to stressors. -Some of
 the com nunity responses included'loss of sensitive species,
 lack of Diversity, and increase in tolerant species. As a result,
 several rundred stream miles were classified as not fully sup-
 porting aquatic life based on the fish'and macroinvertebrate
 commurity surveyed.

 AAarylana
 The Maijyland Biological Stream Survey (MBSS) uses a probability-
  based survey design to assess the states of biological resources in
  Maryland's non-tidal streams. The state intends to:
  B Characterize biological resources and  ecological conditions.
  • Assets theJ condition" of these resources.
  • Idenjify the likely sources of degradation.

  The state has developed an interim framework for applying biocrite-
  ria in t^ state's water quality inventory (305 [b]  report) and list of
  impairetwaters (303 [d] list). To date,'the proposed biocriteria for
  wadeafclie, non-tidal (first to fourth-order) streams rely on two bio-
  logical 'indicators from tne MBSS; the fish and benthic indices of
  biotic (integrity (IBls). The approach'centers on identifying impaired
   waterbjodies at the Maryland 8-digit watershed and 12-digit subwa-
   tershec levels.
A preliminary evaluati
          nary evaion using MBSS 2000 data was conducted to
          watersheds failing to meetth4 requirements of the interim
         eria framework: For a portion of the state, three 8-digit water-
         [hat were assessed passed, and six were inconclusive. Of the
           rsheds sampled at the 12^-digit subwatershed level, 69
         32 passed, and' 22 were inconclusive.                   !'
     2-10
                                                        2.2 Waters and Watersheds
                                    IKapter 2 - Purer Water

-------
                    Altered fresli water ecosystems - Category 2
       Physically altering a fresh waterbody can change its character and
       the benefits it provides local communities and land owners Fresh
       waterbodies may be altered to increase some other benefit— for
       example, to control floods; improve navigation; reduce erosion-
       increase the available area for farming, livestock grazing, or devel-
       opment; and increase the amount of water available for drinking
      and industrial purposes. However, these alterations also change
      fish and wildlife habitat, disrupt patterns and timing of waterflows
      serve as barriers to animal movement, and reduce or eliminate the
      natural filtering of sediment and pollutants. In addition water
      usage, particularly in the arid West, but also in suburban areas
      that rely on wells, may deplete aquifers and thus cause permanent
      damage to the physical characteristics of surface water resources
      including reduced base flows.

      The altered fresh water ecosystems indicator reports the
      percentage of each of the major fresh water ecosystems (rivers
      and streams, riparian areas, wetlands,  lakes, ponds, and reservoirs)
      that are altered. "Altered" is defined differently for each of these
      ecosystems:
     • Streams and rivers (all flowing surface waters) are altered if they
       are leveed or channelized or impounded behind a dam.
     • Riparian zones along rivers and streams are considered altered
       if they are used for urban or agricultural purposes.
     • Lakes  and reservoirs are considered altered if any portion of the
       area immediately-adjacent to the shoreline is either urban or
       agricultural land. Since there is no agreed-upon proportion of
       shoreline that must be in  these land use categories to classify
       an mdividual lake as "altered," this indicator simply reports the
       overall percentage  of lake or reservoir shoreline with agricultural
       or urban land use in the shoreline zone. (Note that, at present,
       data for lakes and reservoirs are aggregated, even though a
       reservoir is a man-made structure or seriously altered habitat If,'
       in  the future, natural lakes can be.distinguished from reservoirs  '
      these may be reported separately. In  this case, the number or '
      percent of natural lakes whose waterflow has been altered by
      damming would also be reported.)
    • Wetlands are considered altered if they are excavated, impounded,
      diked, partially drained, or farmed (Cowardin, et al., 1979).

   What the Data Show
   Data reported for this indicator were produced using remote
   sensing imagery and the USCS stream/lake database (National
   Hydrography Data Set). These data characterize areas adjacent to
   a waterbody at a resolution of about 100 feet across. Thus they
   present the general land cover surrounding a lake or stream
   rather than a fine-scale picture of the exact composition of a
   shoreline or bank.
    The available data indicate that 23 percent of the banks of both
    nvers and streams (riparian areas) and lakes and reservoirs have
    either croplands or urban development in the narrow area immedi-
    ately adjacent to them. Data on the degree to which streams and
    rivers  are channelized, leveed, or impounded are not available.  -

    Dahl (2000) does provide some information on the extent to
    which  wetlands are altered. For example, from 1986 to 1997-
    • A total of 78,100 acres (31,600 hectares) of forested wetlands
      were converted to fresh water ponds.
    • Human activities, "such as creating new impoundments or raising
      the water levels on existing impoundments (thus killing the
      trees), created conversions to deep water lakes.
    • Additionally, fresh water unconsolidated shores exhibited an 8
     percent gain in acreage or about 32,000 acres (13,000
     hectares). This was. due, in part, to peat mining operations that
     removed the wetland vegetation and exposed the substrate.
     Because these areas were not drained, they remained wetland,
     but their classification was changed from "fresh water shrub
     bogs" to "fresh water unconsolidated shores."

   Indicator Caps  and  Limitations

  There is no nationally aggregated database that records the num-
  ber of impounded or leveed river miles. As noted above, there is
.  also no  method for calculating the extent of downstream effects
  of .dams, other than by  conducting site-specific  investigations for
  each dam.

  At present, there are no nationally aggregated databases that list
  whether natural lakes are dammed at their outlets. It is possible
  that existing databases on dam locations, such as those main-
  tained by the US. Army Corps of Engineers, could be merged with
  other datasets,  such as the National Hydrography Data Set
  (MHD), to derive this information.

 Data on the alteration of rivers and streams are not collected in a '
 manner that allows for aggregation to provide a national
 perspective.

 Data Source
 Data on altered wetlands are available only in paper form on a
 quad-sheet by quad-sheet basis. The data sources for this
 indicator were the:
 • Multi-Resolution Land Characterization Consortium and U S
   Geological Survey National Hydrography Dataset, processed  by
Chapter 2 - Purer Water
                                                   2.2 Waters and Watersheds
                                                                                                                           2-T1

-------
                                                                                                    SjfjJiliSllillSMisls^^
                                                                                                                                  i F	
           Altered fresh, water ecosystems - Category 2 (continuecjl   ,        ^         ;  : n—:ILI
 the EPA's Office of Research and Development (National
 Exposure Research Laboratory).
             Lake Trophic State Index - Category 2
Lakes can be divided into three categories based on trophic state:
oligotrophic, mesotrophic, and eutrophic. These categories reflect
a lake's nutrient and clarity levels.
• Oligoirophlc lakes are generally clear, deep, and free of weeds or
  large algae blooms. They are low in nutrients and do not sup-
  port large numbers offish. Oligotrophic lakes often develop a
  food chain capable of sustaining a very desirable fishery of
  large game fish.
• Eutrophic lakes are high in nutrients and support a large biomass
   (all the plants and animals  living in a lake). They are usually
   either weedy, or subject to frequent algae blooms, or both.
   Eutrophic lakes often support large fish populations, but are
   also susceptible to oxygen depletion. A subcategory, hyper-
   irophic lakes, is used below to describe lakes that are extremely
   eutrophic (i.e., very  nutrient-enriched), resulting in  particularly
   high productivity (Peterson, et al., 1999).
 • Mesotropbic lakes lie between the oligotrophic and eutrophic
   stages.

 A natural aging process occurs in all  lakes, causing them  to change
 from oligotrophic to eutrophic over time. This process is acceler-
  ated by nutrient enrichment from agriculture, lawn fertilizers,
  streets, septic systems, and urban storm drains.

  Various methods are used to calculate the trophic state  of lakes.
  Common characteristics used to determine trophic state are: total
  phosphorus concentration (important for algae growth); concen-
  tration of chlorophyll a (a measure of the amount of algae  pres-
  ent); and secchi  disc  readings (an indicator of water clarity).

  No national data regarding  the trophic state of lakes are available.
  However, regional patterns of lake trophic condition were assessed
  for a target population of 11,076 northeast lakes, which were
  sampled during the summers of 1991 to 1994 using a trophic
  state index based primarily on their nutrient or total phosphorus
   (TP) concentrations (Peterson, et al., 1999). A total of 344 lakes
   were sampled once.
| Department of the Interior, U.S. Fish ancj Wildlife Service,
 National Wetlands Inventory (See Appendix B, page B-9, for
 more information.).                  j.
                                                                                                                                   I  -
The following trophic state categories wefe established based on
total phosphorus concentrations:
• Oligotrophic for nutrient poor (less than 10 parts per
   billion [ppb]).                    ;  I            .
U Mesotrophic to denote nutrient concentrations sufficient to
   support natural algal communities (frojri 10 to 30 ppb).
II Eutrophic for enriched nutrient conditions (from 30 to 60 ppb).
llHypertropWcforvery nutrient-enriched  (greater than 60 ppb).

What tlhe Data  Show      i

 The trophic state analysis (Exhibit 2-4) phowed that 37.9 percent
 of the northeast lakes were oligotroph'icj 40.1 percent were    -
 mesotrophic, 12.6 percent were eutro'prjic, and 9.3 percent were
 hypertrophic (Peterson, et al., 1999).  ;
 f"    "B^pt 2-4: Tropnic State Index for northeast lakes,
 2-12
                                                     2.2 Waters and Watersheds
                                       lapter 2 - Purer Water

-------
                   Lake Trophic State'index - Category 2 (continued)
      Indicator Gaps and Limitations
      These data reflect a one-time sample of lakes in one region, the
      Northeast, and cannot be extrapolated to the national scale or
      provide trends data. Also, trophic status in and of itself does not
     .necessarily imply that water quality problems exist (i.e., that olig-
      otrophy is a common natural state).
                   Data  Source

                   The data source for this indicator was the Environmental
                   Monitoring and Assessment Program Lakes Data Set. (See
                  Appendix B, page B-9, for more information.)
     Indicators
     Wetland extent and change
     Sources of wetland change/loss
  When European settlers first arrived, wetland acreage in the area that
  would become the 48 states was more than 220 million acres, or about
  five percent of the total area of the conterminous U.S. More than one-
  half of the wetlands in the conterminous U.S. have been lost or convert-
  ed to other uses since pre-colonial times. However, in as little as four
  recent decades, the rate of wetland loss has declined dramatically, from
  about 500,000 acres per year to less than 100,000 acres per year
  (Dahl, 2000). By 199? total wetland acreage was estimated to be
  105.5 million acres (Dahl, 2000). Almost 50 percent of wetland loss
  occurring in the 1990s was due to conversion to urban and suburban
  development.

 Wetland ecosystems are areas that are inundated or saturated by
 surface or ground water at a frequency and duration sufficient to
 support (and that  under normal circumstances do support) a
 prevalence of vegetation typically adapted for life in saturated  soil .
 conditions. There are different types of wetlands, including: fresh water
 wetlands, inland wetlands, and coastal wetlands (see glossary for
 definitions). These  habitats provide many benefits to humans and
 ecological systems. For example, wetland habitats are critical to the life
 cycles of many plants and fish, shellfish, migratory birds, and other
 wildlife. They provide essential breeding habitat for roughly one-
 quarter of all North American breeding bird species (Davis, 2000). In
 1997, it was estimated that 81 percent (72 species) of the U.S. bird
 species on the Endangered Species List were dependent on or
 associated with wetlands (Day Boylan and MacLean, 1997).

An estimated 95 percent of commercial fish and 85 percent of sport
fish spend a  portion of .their life cycles in coastal wetland and estu-
arine habitats. Adult stocks of commercially harvested shrimp, blue
                  crab, oysters, and many other species throughout the U.S. (EPA,
                  ORD, OW, September 2001) are directly related to wetland qua'lity
                  and quantity (EPA, OW, OWOW, March 2002). More than half of all
                  U.S. adults (98 million  people) hunt, fish, birdwatch,  or photograph
               1   wildlife (USFWS, 2002). Many of these activities are  associated with
                  healthy wetlands.

                  Wetlands also filter residential,  agricultural, and industrial wastes,
                  thereby improving surface water quality. They buffer coastalareas
                  against storm and wave damage. Wetlands function as natural
                  sponges that trap and slowly release surface water, rain, snowmelt,
                 ground water, and flood waters. Trees, root mats, and  other wetland
                 vegetation also slow the speed  of flood waters and distribute them
                 more slowly over the floodplain. This combined water storage and
                 braking action lowers flood heights and reduces erosion. Wetlands
                 within and downstream of urban areas are particularly valuable,
                 counteracting the greatly increased rate and volume of surface water
                 runoff from pavement and buildings. The holding capacity of wet-
                 lands helps control floods and prevents water logging  of crops.
                 Preserving and restoring wetlands can often provide the level of
                 flood control otherwise provided by expensive dredge  operations
                 and levees. For example,  the bottomland hardwood-riparian wetlands
                 along the Mississippi River once stored at least 60 days of flood
                 water. Now these wetlands store only 12 days of flood  water because
                 most have been filled or  drained (EPA, OW, December  1995).

                Wetlands are diverse. Inland wetlands are most common on flood-  .
                plains along rivers and streams (riparian wetlands), in isolated
                depressions surrounded by dry land (e.g., playas, basins, and "pot-
                holes"), along the margins of lakes and ponds, and in other low-lying
                areas where the ground water intercepts the soil surface orwhere
                precipitation sufficiently saturates the soil (e.g., vernal pools and
                bogs). Inland wetlands include marshes and wet  meadows dominated
                by herbaceous plants, swamps dominated by shrubs, and wooded
                swamps dominated by trees. Many wetlands are seasonal (i.e., they
                are dry one or more seasons every year). In fact, particularly in the
                arid and semiarid West, wetlands  may be wet only periodically. The
                quantity of water present and the timing of its presence in part
                determine the functions of a wetland and its role in the  environment.
                Even wetlands that appear dry at times for significant parts of the
Chapter 2 - Purer Water
2.2 Waters and Watersheds
                                                                                                                           2-13

-------
!!!!!!!!!i!!!!!!!!!!!i!™9i                    	iiiiiiiiuli	li ensure that both wetland
 extent and condition can be properly described in the future.
i	

                   Wetland extent and  change - Category 1
      Two programs, the USFWS NWI status and trends studies and the
      NRCS NRI, estimate wetland extent. The USFWS surveys all
      wetlands in the conterminous U.S. The NRI surveys wetlands on
      non-federal lands, which make up approximately 75 percent of the
      nation's land base. The methods employed differ, but the
      Statistical results from the most recent survey period were not
      significantly different. USFWS data are used for the "wetland
      extent and change" indicator due to their broader coverage. This
      indicator is derived from three separate analyses: one covering the
       1950s to the 1970s; one covering the 1970s to 1980s, and one
       covering the 1980s to the 1990s.

       The USFWS counts all wetlands every 10 years, regardless of land
       ownership, but only recognizes wetlands that are at least three
       acres. A permanent study design is used, based initially on
       stratification of the 48 conterminous states by state boundaries
       and 35 physiographic subdivisions. Within these subdivisions are
       4,375 randomly selected, four-square-mile (2,560 acres) sample
       plots. These plots were examined with the use of aerial imagery,
       ranging in scale and type; most were 1:40,000 scale, color
       Infrared, from the National Aerial Photography Program.

        Field verification was conducted to address questions of image inter-
        pretation, land use coding, and attribution of wetland gains or losses;
        plot delineations were also completed. For example, for the 1980s to
        1990s analysis, 21 percent of the sample plots were verified.
   What the Data Show      :

   When European settlers first arrived, wetjarjd acreage in the area that
   would become the 48 states was more than 220 million acres, or
   about five percent of the total area of the conterminous U.S. Since
   then, extensive losses have occurred, and over half of our original
   wetlands have been-drained and filled. By 1997, total wetland acreage  ',
   was estimated to be 105.5 million  acres '(CJahl, 2000). Of that total,
   nearly 95 percent or 100.2 million acres Were fresh water and about
   five percent or 5.3 million acres were int:erj:idal marine and estuarine.
   Between 1986 and 1997, 98 percent of'allj wetland  losses in the con-
   terminous U.S. were fresh water wetlands.;

   Rates of annual wetland losses have been decreasing from almost
   500,000 acres a year three decades ago to less  than 100,000
   acres, averaged annually since 1986 (Exhibit 2-5). The  USFWS
   estimated the annual rate of loss at 58,500 acres per year
   between 1S86 and 1997. This represent^ an 80 percent reduction
   compared to the previous decade's ratejof loss. The slower rate of
   wetland loss is due to several factors, including:
    • Federal farm policies that discourage drainage  and encourage
      restoration.                       j
    II More effective government regulation.
    H Better land stewardship.          •  ;
    H Acquisition and protection of sensitive environmental areas.
    H More state, tribal, and local involvement in wetland protection
      programs.
      2-14
                                                           2.2 Waters and Watersheds
                                       tnapter 2 - Purer Water  :

-------

                 Wetland extent and cnange - Category:1 (continued1)
            Exhibit 2-5: Average annual wetland loss,
                1954-1974,1974-1983,1986-1997
       600,000
       500,000
                    1954-74        1974-83

              Coverage: Conterminous United States

              Source: Frayer et al. Status and Trends of Wetlands and Deepwater
              Habitats in the Conterrn'mous United States, 1950s to 1970s. T983;
              Dahl, T.E. and C. E. Johnson. Wetlands Status and Trends in the     '
              Conterminous United States:.! 970s to 1980s. 1 991; Dahi.T.E. Status
              and Trends of Wetlands in the Conterminous United States 1986 to
              7997.2000.  ...        . ...   ...       .....   ..
   In addition to loss of wetland acreage, a major ecological impact has
   been the conversion of one wetland type to another, such as clear-
   ing trees from a forested wetland or excavating a shallow marsh to
   create an open water pond. Open water ponds have more than dou-
   bled in area since the 1950s and are not the ecological equivalent
   of fresh water emergent marshes. These types of conversions change
   habitat types and community structure in watersheds and impact
   the animal communities that depend on them.

   Wetland types  include fresh water forested, shrub, and emer-
   gent wetlands,  plus open water ponds. Forested and emergent
   wetlands make  up over 75 percent of all fresh water wetlands.
   Since the 1950s, fresh water emergent wetlands have declined
   by nearly 24 percent—more than any other fresh water wet-
   land type. Fresh water forested wetlands have sustained the
   greatest overall losses—10.4 million acres since the 1950s
   (Exhibit 2-6).

   Coastal wetlands are the vegetated interface between  aquatic and
   terrestrial components of estuarine ecosystems. Estuarine emer-
   gent wetlands account for nearly 75  percent of coastal wetlands.
   The loss of coastal wetland habitats in the U.S. is significant
   (Exhibit 2-7). Since the 1950s, coastal and estuarine losses were
   about 1.4 million acres-a nearly 12 percent decline. Emergent
   and forested intertidal wetlands experienced the greatest absolute
   and proportional losses during this four-decade measurement
   period. Proportional losses along the West Coast have been the
                 largest (68 percent), although the actual number of acres lost
                 there is among the smallest. Absolute and proportional acreages
                 lost in the Great Lakes and Gulf of Mexico are also high  (about
                 50 percent of wetlands that existed in pre-colonial times). Even in
                 more recent years (mid- to late 1990s), wetland losses in south-
                 eastern and  Gulf of Mexico states continue at a high rate—more
                 than one percent per year.
                                                                                   txhibit 2-6: Long-term trends in selected
                                                                                       freshwater wetlands, 1954-1997
                       s (in Thousands)
                             ~6T,150
                    66,6.06.
~  ~  .™_ =	_	t^m
A. Freshwater Forested IB
                 -^ 56,000-
                jgr54.666
                 SS.-.-S2,000-
                fcso.ooo1
                               1 950s
                                            1970s
                                                         1980s
                £=.-v Acres (in Thousands)
                Ss:2o;ooo-
                B™*-~ -  '
                            B. Freshwater Shrubs

                                           15,506
                                                                     18,366
                          S"ource: Frayer et al. Status and Trends of Wetlands and Deepwater Habitats in the     ":•
                          Conterminous United States, 79SOs.fo 7970s. 1983; Dahl, T.E. andCE. Johnson.  "^
                         . Wetlands Status and Trends in the Conterminous United States: 1970s to 1980s. 1991;,;,
                         .. Dahl, f. E. Status and Trends of Wetlands in the Conterminous United States 1986 to   "
                          7997.2000.    "..-...
Chapter 2 - Furer Water
2.2 Waters and Watersheds
                                                                           2-15

-------

Ililll:
Wetland extent and change - Category I (continued)
                                                                               wr
    6.200
                'Exnioit 2-7: Long-term trends in
            selected" estuarine wetlands, IQ54-I997
               1950s
                            1970s
                                         1980s
                                                     1990s
                                  B. Estuarine Vegetated Wetlands
               1950s         1970s         1980s         1990s
741
i" „
C. Estuarine Non-vegetated Wetlands
678
~IT— **-——— _J80 580 '.
sc*
Of
H flf mil •
»
t?'
» Ift * q
Slim in I iiiiii KHIIUI
Is* ''„ '"
• *

               1950s
                            1970s
                                         1980s
                                                      1990s
          Coverage; Conterminous United States

          Sour cc Frayer et »L Stains and Trends of Wetlands and Deepmter Habitats in the     '.;
          G»»(«tiiiK«(Me(lState, TSSOsto 1970s. 1983;Dahl,T.EandCE.Johnson.   ,.;
          WdfanAStetasoikf Trends in tlw Conterminous United States: I970sto 1980s. 1991;..
          DM, T. L State oaf Trends ofWettamli in the Conterminous United States 1986 to   '
          I9J7, 2000.
                                                                                                           4r*VnflFT-p»r™-ErHigp-t-1'fp
                                                    . Indicator Gaps and Limitations

                                                     This indicator' does not effectively address the question of wet-
                                                     land condition. While it is possible to inventory wetlands that
                                                     have been lost, many wetlands have suffered degradation of con-
                                                     dition and functions, which cannot be quantified nationally.
                                                                                           i
                                                     Different methods were used in some of the early classification
                                                     schemes to classify wetland types. The currently used classifica-
                                                     tion system was not applied to some of the earlier (1970s) maps.
                                                     As methods and spatial resolution have improved over time,
                                                     acreage data were adjusted, resulting in changes in the overall
                                                     wetland base over time. Thus, the evaluation process is evolving,
                                                     which contributes to reducing the accuracy of the trends
                                                     observed.
                                                     Forested wetl.snds are difficult to photointej-pret and are generally
                                                     underestimated by the USFWS. Ephemeral Wetlands and effectively
                                                     drained palustrine wetlands observed in farfn production are not
                                                     recognized as a wetland type by the USFWJi and, therefore, are not
                                                     included. Also, USFWS does not survey wetlands under 3 acres in
                                                     size; therefore, no record exists of the exterjit and change in these
                                                     valuable resources. Pacific coast estuarine wetlands are not surveyed
                                                     due to the discontinuity in their patch  sizes,. The temporal coverage
                                                     of the coastal wetland loss indicator (length of record) is not
                                                     consistent ac'oss the U.S.
                                                                                         i  i
                                                     Data Source
                                                                    The data for this indicator are from the Department of the
                                                                    Interior, U.S. Fish and Wildlife Service, S,taj;us and Trends Report.
                                                                    (See Appendix B, page B-9 for more information.)
2-16
                                      2.2 Waters and Watersheds
Cmapter 2 - Furer Water

-------
                sources OT
f wetland cnanqe/ loss - Cateqory 2
                                                             :gory.
   This indicator attempts to estimate the causes or sources of wet-
   land losses. The extensive survey data collected in the NRI by the
   USDA's Natural Resources Conservation Service in cooperation
   with the Iowa State University Statistical Laboratory provides land
   use information that can be associated with estimates of wetland
   extent. This database is a compilation of natural resource informa-
   tion on non-federal land, which comprises nearly 75 percent of
   the nation's total land area. The 1997 NRI captures data on land
   cover and use, soil erosion, prime farmland soils, wetlands, habitat
   diversity, selected conservation practices; and related resource
   attributes at over 300,000 primary sample units (nominally 160
   acres each) containing over 800,000 sample points.

   Data used for the NRI were collected using a variety of imagery,
   field office records, historical  records and data, ancillary materials,
   and a limited number of on-site visits. The data have been com-
   piled, verified, and analyzed to provide a comprehensive look at
   the state of the nation's non-federal lands.
                                         What the Data Show

                                         According to the USDA Agricultural Research Service, between
                                         1954 and 1974, agriculture accounted for 81 percent of all
                                         wetlands conversions. As a result of changing federal agricultural
                                         policies that emphasize wetlands conservation, agriculture
                                         accounted for only 20 percent of national wetlands conversion
                                         between 1982  and 1992 (USDA, 2000). In surveys conducted
                                         between 1992  and 1997, NRI determined that 506,000 acres of
                                         wetlands on non-federal lands were lost, while 343,000 were
                                         gained, for a net loss of 163,000 acres. Agriculture accounted for
                                         26 percent of the net national wetlands  loss for this survey
                                         period, although this varies by region. For example, in the Midwest
                                         and northern plains, about 50 percent of the losses were from
                                         agriculture (Exhibit 2-8). Since the mid-to late 1980s, urban,
                                         suburban, and commercial development have been the major
                                         contributors to net losses of wetland resources and were
                                         responsible for 49 percent of those losses. The East, Southeast,
                                         and South Central states had the highest percentages of wetland
                                         losses due to development. In the East, 67 percent of the wetland
                                         losses were a result of development (USDA, 2000). Timber
                                         harvesting practices and conversion of land to silvicultural uses
                           •Exhibit 2-8: Non-Federal wetland losses and gains and reasons for conversion, 1992-1997
               Silviculture
               Development
                                       coverage does not include Alaska, Hawaii or Puerto Rico
              Sburce: Summary Report 1937 National Resources Inventory (Revised December 2000). 2000.
Chapter 2 - Purer Water
                         2.2 Waters and Watersheds
2-17

-------
 I ^WiMB^"
 Indicat
Sources of wetland cnange/loss - Category 2 (continue/:
                                 j^^T^-niw^^ipm^^iTn yp^j^Bfn^iYSjta^                    ^"'^11


                                 lliStlllf^
  have also contributed to losses in wetland resources. The NRI
  analysis attributed 12 percent of the wetland losses between
  1992 and 1997 to silviculture.

  Using different methods, the USFWS reported a similar result from
  1986 to 1997: 30 percent of wetland losses were attributed to
  urban development; 21  percent to rural development; 23 percent
  to silviculture; and 26 percent to agriculture (Dahl, 2000).

  Indicator  Gaps and Limitations

  The differences in survey design  between NRI and USFWS will
  continue to cause difficulties in assessing the effectiveness of
               current wetlands policies. The USFWS dataj are gathered from
               interpretation of aerial imagery and remotely sensed data, and are
               repeated every 10 years. The NRI data are based on statistical
               sampling, but cio not include an adequate sample of coastal
               resources. They provide information at a coarse scale, summarized
               by state, and jire useful for national reporting. The NRI does not
               collect data oi) federal lands or for the state of Alaska.

               Data Source
                                                     i
               Data for this indicator come from the U.S. Department of
               Agriculture, Niational Resources Inventory (;2000).
               (See Appendix B, page B-10, for more information.)

   Indicators
   Water clarity in coastal waters
   Dissolved oxygen in coastal waters
   Total organic carbon in sediments
   Chlorophyll concentrations
Coastal waters—the interface between the land and the sea—
provide a wide range of habitats for animals and plants essential to
global ecosystems, and they support the majority of commercial and
recreational fisheries in the U.S. Coastal waters also contain
significant energy and  mineral reserves, travel lanes for shipping, and
a base for outdoor recreation and tourism industries (EPA, ORD,
OW, September 2001).

Coastal waters include estuaries—bodies of water that are balanced
by fresh water and sediment influx from rivers and tidal action of
the oceans. They provide a transition zone between fresh water and
saline water. Estuaries  are unique environments that support wildlife
and fisheries and contribute substantially to the economy of
coastal areas. These natural areas are under the most intense devel-
opment pressure in the nation. This narrow fringe accounts for only
17 percent of the total conterminous U.S. land area, but is home to
               more than 53 percent of the population, today, that proportion is
               growing faster than in any other area of the U.S. (NRC, 2000).
                                                  :   i
               Four indicators have been selected to address the condition of
               coastal waters: water clarity, dissolved oxygen content, organic
               carbon content of sediments, and chlorpphyll concentrations. The
               first three—water clarity, dissolved oxygen, and organic carbon
               content—are I derived from EPA's EMAP, which samples estuaries
               using a probability- based design.       •;
                                                     i

               For water clarity and dissolved oxygen, estuaries in the East, West,
               and Gulf of Mexico coast are well represented. These two indicators,
               as reported in EPA's Coastal Condition Report (EPA, ORD, OW,
               September 2C 01), show that water clarity ?nd oxygen conditions are
               good. Organic; carbon data indicate that 1^ percent of the area of
               mid-Atlantic estuaries have enriched carbon levels. About 33 percent
               of the mid-Atlantic estuarine area had chlorophyll concentrations
               exceeding the Chesapeake Bay restoration goal for survival of
               submerged aquatic vegetation. Coastal waters overall exhibited much
               lower chlorophyll concentrations. Chlorophyll  concentrations were
               the most proriounced in the Gulf of Mexico.

               Eutrophication is also an important parameter for understanding the
               condition of coastal waters; however, insufficient data were available
               to develop a scientifically robust indicator for this parameter at the
               national level. Eutrophication is discussed following the indicator
               descriptions.  j                      .;  . |
2-18
2.2 Waters and Watersheds
                                                                                     Chapter 2 - furer Water

-------
                 Water clarity in coastal waters - Category 2
    Light penetration is an important characteristic of many estuarine
    and coastal habitats. Reduced penetration is often associated with
    eutrophic conditions, algal blooms, and erosional events. Reduced
    clarity can impair the normal algal growth that contributes to
    oligotrophy and the extent and vitality of submerged aquatic
    vegetation. This is a critical habitat component for many aquatic
    animals.

    For purposes of this indicator, water clarity is defined as a measure
    of light penetration  (i.e., the amount and type of light reaching a
    one - meter water depth compared to the amount and type of

   |" Exhibit 2-9: Estuarine area with good (>25% of light incident
   S-at the surface),-fair (between 25 and 10% of incident light), and
   |::  poor (
-------
             Dissolved oxygen in coastal waters - (Category 2
 Dissolved oxygen (DO) is a fundamental requirement for all
 estuarine life. Low levels of oxygen often accompany the onset of
 severe bacterial degradation, sometimes resulting in algal scums,
 fish kills, and noxious odors, as well as loss of habitat and
 aesthetic values. Often, low dissolved oxygen occurs as a result of
 the process of decay of large algal blooms whose remnants sink to
 the bottom. Concentrations of oxygen below about 2 parts per
 million are thought to be stressful to estuarine organisms (Diaz
 and Rosenberg, 1995; EPA, OW, October 2000).

 Under EPA's EMAP, data were collected generally at one-meter
 above the bottom using electronic DO meters. In some cases, data
 were point-in-time measurements taken once during the summer
 months (e.g., in the Virginian Province), while in other cases data
 were predominantly collected by continuous readings over a  mul-
 tiple day/time period (e.g., in the Louisianian Province). Values of
 dissolved oxygen were classified into three condition categories:
 • Poor, less than 2 parts per million (ppm)
 • Fair: between 2 and 5 ppm
 • Good: greater than 5 ppm

 What the Data Show

 Dissolved oxygen conditions in the nation's estuaries are reported
 by EPA, ORD, OW (September 2001) in its Coastal Condition
 Report as "good" because 80 percent of the estuarine waters
 assessed exhibited dissolved oxygen at concentrations greater
 than five ppm. Both EMAP and NOAA's National Eutrophication
 Assessment examined the extent of estuarine waters with low
 dissolved oxygen. EMAP estimates that only about four percent of
 bottom waters have low dissolved oxygen (Exhibit 2- 10).
 However, low dissolved oxygen is a  problem in some individual
 estuarine systems like the Neuse River  Estuary and parts of the
 Chesapeake Bay.

 Hypoxia resulting from anthropogenic activities is a  relatively
 local occurrence in Gulf of Mexico estuaries, accounting for about
 4 percent of the total area, however, hypoxia in the shelf waters of
 the Gulf of Mexico is more significant. The Gulf of Mexico hypoxia
 zone is the largest anthropogenic coastal hypoxic area in the
 western hemisphere (CAST, 1999). Since 1993, mid-summer
  bottom water hypoxia in the northern Gulf of Mexico has been
  larger than 3,860 square miles (except in 2000). In 1999, it
  reached over 7.  700 square miles (CENR, 2000).

  Indicator  Gaps and Limitations

  Coverage of the nation's coastline  is limited. Probabilistic surveys
  like those in the Northeast, the Southeast, and the Gulf Coast do
not exist for areas north of Cape Cod or for the Great Lakes.
Similar probabilistic data do not exist for Ruget Sound or San
Francisco Bay.                          ',
            I                        .  j
The relationship between threshold values and effects on aquatic
life is neither well established nor expected(to be consistent
across all regions. For example, warm water|environments would be
naturally lower in DO. The criteria of two ppm might not be
sufficiently protective in cold water environments. Much of the data
apparently represent point-in-time measures. If so, the data contain
limitations, and the length of time that dissolved oxygen concen-
trations were below two ppm would riot haye been considered.
            j                          f
The data set incorporates a mix of time series and point-in-time
measures based on historical data sets collected. Where time
series data are available and used, better estimates of oxygen
conditions would be achieved. Point-in-tirrje measures are weaker.
Since only one season, the summer, was generally represented,
oxygen stressi in other seasons would be rpissed.

Data Source                    ;
            !                        i  j

Dissolved oxygen data used for this indicator are from the EPA's
Environmental Monitoring and Assessment Program Estuaries
database. (See Appendix  B, page B-10, fo|r more information.)
                2-10:,Estuarine	area with |>oor (<2 ppm),
                .ween 2 and 5 ppm), and good (>5 ppm)
              | j'gsojved oxygen conditions, 2000
               4%
             •Ppm
        16%
                                                 807o
     ' I  Coverage Urated States eas^ coast (exclu3mg*wa tersViortli of" Cape CoclJ,
        west coanTand Gulf of Mexico         "      *     """ ..... ' .......... """""* ........ ""
              '           *
Source
                                                                     '"  Naiiomjj
                                 ^ ^  •[  ^ft <
                                fc. |,  j  H jf *
            |PA, Office, of Research and Development ond Office of Water. ^
            *C
-------

                   Total organic carton  in sediments -  Category 2
       Total organic carbon (TOC) is a measure of the concentration of
       organic matter in sediments. It represents the long-term, average
       burial rate of organic matter in the sediments. High TOC values
       can arise from frequent algal blooms in the overlying waters or
       transport of sewage or high organic waste from point sources
       TOC can also sequester or chelate organic compounds and some
       metals and make them less biologically available for uptake
     fEftt 2-11: Wages of Mid-Atlantk estuarine area
     | witn low, intermediate, and Kign total organic carbon
                 content in sediments, 1997-1998
      Note: High is > 3%; Intermediate is >1 to 3%; Low is <1%
                         rCh 3nd DeVel°Pment- Mid-Atlantic Integrated
                                   >^^!>°rt. Mai;2003.
                                        TOC values are calculated as percent carbon in dried sediments
                                        Assessment categories for the Mid-Atlantic estuaries were-
                                        • Low: 1  percent
                                        • Intermediate: >1 to 3 percent
                                        • High: >3 percent

                                        What the Data  Show

                                        Carbon values ranged  from 0.02 to 13 percent throughout the
                                        m.d-Atlantic estuaries  (Paul, et al., 1999). For the mid-Atlantic
                                        reg.on, about 60 percent of the estuarine sediments had low
                                        rOC values, about 24  percent had intermediate TOC values
                                       and 16 percent had high TOC sediment values (EPA ORD
                                       May 2003); (Exhibit 2,11). Values ranged from Delaware  Bay
                                       w,th about 95 percent of its sediments having low TOC values
                                       to the Chowan River in the Albemarle-Pamlico  Estuary with
                                       65 percent of its sediments having high TOC values (EPA, ORD
                                       May 2003). The Chesapeake  Bay mainstem had about
                                       65 percent of its .sediments with low TOC values and about
                                       15 percent with high TOC values.

                                       Indicator Caps and Limitations

                                      These data are from a survey of mid-Atlantic estuaries and cannot
                                      be extrapolated to national-scale estimates. Samples were collected
                                      dunng an EMAP-defined index period of summer months.

                                      Data  Source

                                      The total organic carbon data for this indicator come  from EPA's
                                      Environmental Monitoring and Assessment Program, Mid-Atlantic
                                      Integrated Assessment (MAIA) Estuaries Program.  (See Appendix B,
                                      page B-10, for more information.)
              Chlorophyll
concentrations - Category 2
   Chlorophyll concentrations are a measure of the abundance of
   phytoplankton. Phytoplankton account for most of the plant
   production in the ocean. Excessive growth of phytoplankton as
   measured through chlorophyll concentrations, can lead to
   degraded water quality, such as noxious odors, decreased water
   clarity, oxygen depletion, and harmful algal blooms. Excess
                                     phytoplankton growth is usually associated with increased nutrient
                                     inputs (e.g., watershed or atmospheric transport, upwelling) or a
                                     declme ,n filtering organisms such as clams, mussels, or oysters
                                     (The Heinz Center, 2002).
Chapter 2 - Purer Water
                                                 2.2 Waters and Watersheds
                                                                                                                      2-21

-------
            	^^-.	-a--:	i...	—I-TT—		 (.  r:'«sjE;:iH«;ss
             CKIoropKyll  concentrations - Category 2  (continued)
Chlorophyll concentrations were considered for both estuarme
and ocean waters within 25 miles of the coast (The Heinz Center,
2002). Three categories of concentrations were established by
EPA for mid-Atlantic estuaries:
• Good: 15 ppb
• Fain 15-30 ppb
• Poor: > 30 ppb

The lower threshold of 15 ppb chlorophyll is equal to the restoration
 goal recommended for the survival of submerged aquatic vegetation
 (SAV) in Chesapeake Bay (Batiuk, et al., 2000).

 For ocean waters, the indicator reports the average value for the sea-
 son, displaying the highest concentrations for each region. Estuarme
 chlorophyll concentrations are not available for national reportmg.
 Ocean data, based on surface reflectance, were inferred from National
 Aeronautics and Space Administration's (NASA's) Sea-viewing W,de
 field-of-View-Sensor. Data were analyzed for nine ocean regions by
 NOAA's National Ocean Service. The estuarine chlorophyll concentra-
 tions were obtained from field measurements as part of the EPA EMAP
  Mid-Atlantic Estuaries Program.
               ibit 2-12: Chlorophyll concentrations in
                U.S. coastal waters, 1Q98-2OOO
                                         —•— North Atlantic ';,„»

                                         —•— Mid-Atlantic   S-S

                                         	•— South Atlantic ;,;,„;

                                         —•— Gulf of Mexico j-|

                                         —•— Southern    ^ >
                                               California    p-|

                                         " •  •  Pacific      pi
                                                Northwest   g™,™

                                            t    Alaska      ;,; a

                                          —•-- Bering Sea   r. J

                                            8   Hawaii       '	:
                                        Coverage: all U.S. waters,
                                        including Alaska and Hawaii,
                                        within 25 miles of the coast.
          1995  96    97    98   99   2000

            Source; Modified from The Heinz Center. The Stale of the Nation's
            Eeo»!«ms, 2002. Data from National Oceanic and Atmospheric
                                ^Service.     	
What the  Data Show

Analysis of the data showed that:         j
• Ocean chlorophyll concentrations ranged from average season-
   al concentrations of 0.1 to 6.5 ppb '(Exhibit 2-12) (The Heinz
   Center, 2002).                       ;
• The highest ocean chlorophyll concentrations (4.8 to 6.5 ppb)
   occurred in the Gulf of Mexico, with the lowest concentrations (
   0.1 ppb) in Hawaiian waters (Exhibit 2-1^).
 • Southern California had the next lowest cjhlorophyll concentra-
   tions—between  1.1 and 1.5 ppb (Exhibit 2-12).
 H Other ocean  waters (e.g, north, mid-, ancj south Atlantic, and the
   Pacific Northwest) had chlorophyll coricejntrations ranging from
   2 to 4.5 ppb (Exhibit 2-12).           j
 a Chlorophyll concentrations in the mid-A{lantic estuaries ranged
   from 0.7 to 95 ppb in 1997 and 1998 ^EPA, ORD, May 2003).
 • About 33 percent of the mid-Atlantic estuarine area had chloro-
    phyll concentrations exceeding 15 ppb. ;
 • The Delaware Estuary showed a wide range of chlorophyll concen-
    trations, from a  low (< 15 ppb) in the Delaware Bay, to intermediate
    (15-30 ppb) in the Delaware River, to very high (> 80 ppb) in the
    Salem river.                       ;   I                 .
  • The western tributaries to the Chesapeake Bay were consistently
     high in chlorophyll a, with more than 25 percent of the area
     showing > 30 ppb chlorophyll concentrations.
  • Chlorophyll concentrations in the cqastal bays were generally
     low (< 115 ppb), even though nutrients were elevated because
     of increased turbidity and low light penetration.

   Indicator Gaps and Limitations

   Algorithms used to translate spectral reflectance data into chlorophyll
   concentrations currently provide only roijgh estimates of concentra-
   tions in those waters where concentrations of suspended sediments
   and  colored dissolved organic matter arejhigh (e.g., near-shore waters
   influenced by surface and ground water discharges, coastal erosion,
   and  sediment resuspension).        ;

   The data presented here are based on a [fairly coarse scale (six-mile.
    resolution). Currently, data showing relative changes in chlorophyll
    within a region can be reliable; however, data showing actual concen-
    trations for any  given region might vary by a factor of two. Thus,
    unless differences are large, meaningful comparisons between reg,ons
    are  not yet possible.              •   :

    The mid-Atlantic estuary data are one-time estimates of chlorophyll
    content in mid-Atlantic estuaries only, sp these data cannot be pro-
    jected  to the national scale or to different time periods. Samples were
   2-22
                                                         2.2 Waters and Watersheds
                                        Qapter 2  •• Purer Wateri

-------
                                                                                                                   if"?
   Indicator--
Chlorophyll concentrations — Category 2 (continued)
     collected during an EMAP-defined index period of summer months
     and do not represent conditions at different times.

     Data  Source

     Ocean data are found'in the National Aeronautics and Space
     Administration's Sea-Viewing Wide Reld-of-View Sensor. Estuarine
                                                    chlorophyll concentrations are found in the EPA's Environmental
                                                    Monitoring and Assessment Program, Mid-Atlantic Integrated
                                                    Assessment (MAIA) Estuaries Program. (See Appendix B, page B-11,
                                                  '  for more information.)
- Additional Consideration: Eutropnication
  Another key issue relevant to understanding the condition of
  coastal waters is eutrophication. Eutrophication is a natural process,
  through which there is "an increase in the rate of supply of organic
  matter" to a waterbody (Nixon, 1995). This process usually repre-
  sents an increase in the rate of algal production. Under natural con-
  ditions, algal production is influenced by a gradual buildup of plant
  nutrients in ecosystems over long periods of time and generally
  leads to productive and healthy estuarine and marine environments.
  However, in recent years, human activities have substantially
  increased the rate of delivery of plant nutrients to many estuarine
  and marine areas (NRC, 2000; Peierls, et al., 1991; Turner and
  Rabalais, 1991). As a result, algal production in many estuaries has
  increased much faster than would occur under natural circum-
  stances. This accelerated algal production is referred to as "cultural"
  or "anthropogenic" eutrophication and often results in a host of
  undesirable conditions in estuarine and marine environments.

  These conditions, which include low dissolved oxygen concentrations,
  declining sea grasses, and harmful algal blooms, might impact the
  uses of estuarine and coastal resources by reducing the success of
  commercial and sport fisheries, fouling swimming beaches, and
  causing odor problems from the decay of excess amounts of algae
  (NRC, 2000; Duda, 1982). Despite much research, however, the link
  between coastal eutrophication and effects on living marine resources
  and fisheries is not well understood or quantified (NRC, 2000;
  Boesch, et al., 2001).

  Between 1,992 and  1998, NOAA conducted a survey and series of
  regional workshops to synthesize the best available information on
  eutrophication-related symptoms in 138 estuaries. Data from these
  surveys are presented in NOAA 's National Estuarine Eutrophication
  Assessment (Bricker, et al., 1999). They indicate that the nation's
  estuaries exhibit strong symptoms of eutrophication, which were
  reported by EPA to  be "poor" (EPA, ORD, OW, September 2001).
  When data on the symptoms of eutrophication are combined, they
  suggest that 40 percent of the surface  area of the nation's estuarine
  waters exhibit high levels of eutrophic condition (Exhibit 2-13).
                                                         Exhibit 2-13: Percent of estuaries with high, moderate,
                                                             and low levels of eutrophic condition, 1998

                                                    IF-
                                                    fjuC,,Coverage: United States, excluding the Great Lakes
                                                    ^j   Source: Bricker et al. National Estuarine Eutrophication Assessment: Effects of
                                                    |_ .Nutrient Enrichment in the Nation's Estuaries. 1999; EPA, Office of Research and
                                                    is:.;: Development and Office of Water. National Coastal Condition Report.
                                                    fj:':: September 2001.-

                                                    Many of these waters are in the mid-Atlantic and gulf regions of the
                                                    U.S. Moreover, based on expert opinion, eutrophic conditions are
                                                    expected to worsen in 70 percent of U.S. estuaries  by 2020
                                                    (Bricker, et al., 1999).

                                                    These eutrophication estimates are largely based upon best
                                                    professional judgement. They do not adequately reflect regional
                                                    differences that may occur naturally,  so high scores may not be a true
                                                    measure of eutrophication. Also, there are no strong scientific data to
                                                    indicate that the thresholds used are indeed indicative of eutrophic
                                                    conditions on a region-by-region basis. Use of SAV loss, macroalgae,
                                                    and epiphytic growth is not appropriate for regions/areas where SAV
                                                    beds or macroalgae are not present  (e.g., South Carolina, Georgia).
                                                    Standard methods do not appear to  have been  used among states..
                                                    For all these reasons, these data were judged not to be sufficiently
                                                    robust to qualify as an indicator for purposes of this report.
                                                    Nevertheless, accelerated eutrophication can be an important
                                                    symptom of environmental decline in estuarine and marine areas.
 Chapter 2 - Purer Water
                                    2.2 Waters and Watersheds
                                                                                                            2-23

-------
Therefore, eutrophication should be reconsidered as an indicator in
the future if and when scientifically sound data become available.
  .a	•^at*v'w-	t'-i1	*.	-	;.;;	::!.::«:  t
   Indicators
   Percent urban land cover in riparian areas
   Agricultural lands in riparian areas
   Population density in coastal areas
   Changing stream flows
   Number/duration of dry stream flow periods in
      grassland/shruWa nds
   Sedimentation index
   Atmospheric deposition of nitrogen
   Nitrate in farmland, forested, and urban streams and ground water
   Total nitrogen in coastal waters
   Phosphorus in farmland, forested and urban streams
   Phosphorus in large rivers
   Total phosphorus in coastal waters
   Atmospheric deposition of mercury
   Chemical contamination in streams and ground water
   Pesticides in farmland streams and ground water
   Acid sensitivity in lakes and streams
   Toxk releases to water of mercury, dioxin, lead, PCBs, and PBTs
   Sediment contamination of inland waters
   Sediment contamination of coastal waters
   Sediment toxlcity in estuaries
A complex suite of pressures weighs on surface water resources. EPA
data on water qualify provide some measure of the major stressors.
Under the Clean Water Act, EPA requires states to define and list
waters under their jurisdiction that are impaired, and to identify the
causes of those impairments and develop a program to manage and
control the causes. In 1998, more than 21,000 waterways were
identified as impaired under the provisions of Section  303 (d) of the
CWA (EPA, OW, March 2003). The following top five causes of
impairment accounted for 60  percent of the cases:
• Sediment/siltation
• Pathogens
• Metals
• Nutrients
• Organic enrichment/low dissolved oxygen

The next five causes account for additional 21 percent of
impairment:
• Habitat alteration
• Thermal modifications
• Low or high pH
• Pesticides                            !                        r
• Fish consumption advisories           ;

Twenty indicators have been identified to help answer the question
"What are the! pressures to water quality?" These indicators have
been divided jnto three categories:

General pressures—Section 2.2.4.a presents six indicators of general
pressures that relate in  some way to habitat quality but do not fall
into a specific: stressor category.          j
             i         '              i   I
Nutrient pressures—Section 2.2.4.b  presents six indicators that
relate specifically to nutrient enrichment.  ;
                                       I
Chemical contaminant pressures—Sectiori 2.2.4.C discusses eight
indicators that describe chemical contamination.
             1                       •   i
These indicators do not address sediment/siltation or pathogens
(the two most important causes of water quality impairment as iden-,
tified  under Section 303 [d] of the Clean Water Act), nor do they
address another key concern—the impact of invasive species.
Additional pressures to water quality are discussed in the Ecological
Condition, Better Protected Land, and Clejaner Air chapters.

2.2.4.a Querieral Tressures              [

General pressures that  alter aquatic ecosystems  and for which
indicators are; available, include (1) the extent of urban land cover
and agricultural lands in stream riparian;areas, and (2) the extent of
coastal development, as represented by population density.
Additional indicators of pressures on  streams  relate to changes in
stream flow and altered in-stream habitatThese six indicators,
discussed in -;his section, address pressures directly on stream
ecosystems and coastal areas, but they dcj not attempt to define
pressures on lakes, ponds, reservoirs, or wetland resources, even
though the  pressures are likely comparably.

The difference in pressures related to urban development versus
pressures from agricultural activities generally are a function of the
location of, extent of, and change in urban and agricultural areas.
Coastal deve'opment data, in the form of population density,
suggest strong pressures on coastal systems today and in the future.
Data  on stream flow indicate that changes in minimum and maximum
flow have inc'eased slightly over the last three decades and that
maximum flows in some areas have increased significantly. Zero (no)
flow data  forgrassland and shrubland streams are consistent with
these observations in that the percent of istreams with no- flow
periods has decreased.                 ;
I
 2-24
                                                     2.2 Waters and Watersheds
                                   Chapter 2 - Purer Water

-------
                                                 •a??gf s?^?ps^-dOT^\3«£SHmsigES(p»^*^^

                 Percent urban land cover in riparian .areas - Category 2
    This indicator provides a snapshot in time of the potential stress
    to stream ecosystems across the nation due to urban develop-
    ment. Specifically, the indicator examines the extent of land
    cover within riparian zones, which are defined as the 30-meter
    buffer on each side of a stream or river. The indicator focuses
    on land cover along streams or rivers within watersheds catego-
    rized by the U.S. Geological Survey  (USGS) as eight-digit HUCs
    under its hydrologic unit code (HUC) categorization system.

    To calculate the extent of urban land cover, each of these buffer
    zones was divided into grid cells (of IS minute latitude by IS
    minute longitude dimensions). The extent of urban land cover was
    calculated as the percent of grid cells with land cover, divided by
    the total number of grid cells. To make this calculation:
    • Stream map sets were derived from remote sensing techniques,
      generally aerial photography and satellite imagery.
    • The land cover data sets were collected using remote sensing
      techniques, generally satellite imagery, with ground truth field-
      work.
    • Stream extent and. locations were defined as any line or poly-
      gon feature attributed as "stream/river." This is consistent with
      the definition in the USGS's National Hydrography Dataset
      (NHD), a key data source for this indicator.
   • Urban land cover was defined as (1) the sum of low-intensity
      residential, high-intensity residential, and commercial/industri-
      al/transportation land cover types in the National  Land Cover
      Database (NLCD) and (2) the sum of both high-intensity and
      low-intensity developed land cover types in the Coastal Change
     Analysis Program (C-CAP).

   What the  Data Show

   The analysis  indicates that nearly 80 percent of the watersheds
   (8-digit HUCs) in  the continental U.S. have less than 2 percent
   urban land uses within 30 meters of streams. Five percent of
                watersheds (8-digit HUCs) have urban land uses of greater than
                8 percent within 30 meters of streams. Less than 1 percent of the
                nation's watersheds (8-digit HUCs) have more than 25 percent
                urban uses within stream riparian areas. Watersheds with stream-
                side urban development tend to be concentrated in certain parts
                of the country (e.g., the Midwest, Southeast, and Northeast).

                Indicator Gaps and  Limitations

                The streams data set is known to contain both systematic and
                random errors. Many of these errors, such as positional accuracy
                of stream segments due to digitizing accuracy, are minimized due
                to the scale of this analysis (i.e., at the 8-digit HUC level). But
                stream omission, the degree of which varies between different
                scale maps (i.e., 30- by 60-minute  quadrangle maps), has a higher
                impact on potential error. In addition, the accuracy of whether or
                not a stream was perennial also varied between quadrangle maps,
                preventing a more accurate representation of riparian areas.

                This indicator only examines urban  land within 30 meters of
                streams and rivers, which means that more significant urban devel-
                opment at distances beyond 30 meters is not evaluated. The
                analysis is not a standardized ongoing assessment. Because the
                land cover data sets exists only for  a single year, changes in the
                amount of urban  land cover over time are not addressed by this
                indicator at present.

                Data Source

                Information is available from the specific program datasets
                (National Land Cover Database, Coastal Change Analysis Program,
                National Hydrography Dataset, and Hydrologic Unit Code). Data
                were summarized  by the EPA. (See Appendix B, page B-11, for
                more information.)
Chapter 2 - Turer Water
2.2 Waters and Watersheds
                                                                                                                         2-25

-------
jfaBJSl   Agricultural lands in riparian areas - (Category 2

 Agricultural land uses in riparian areas may have environmental
 effects, due to erosion and disturbance of riparian habitat. When
 land immediately adjacent to streams is used for agricultural pur-
 pose, this may affect water quality in a number of ways:
 I Runoff from plowed fields can potentially become a source of
   stream sediment
 • Fertilizers and pesticides are often conveyed to streams by
   runoff or by drainage.
 • Grazing animals may contaminate streams with coliform
   bacteria.

 Results for this indicator are expressed  in bank miles, calculated as
 the percent of agricultural land cover within the stream corridor,
 multiplied by the total length of stream bank within the 8-  digit
 HUC. The data sets and analytical procedures are the same as
 those for the urban land in  riparian  areas indicator described
 above.

 What the Data Show

 The major areas of high agricultural activities in riparian areas of
 the U.S. are found in the Midwest, in the Southeast, east of the
 Cascade Mountains in Washington state, and in the inland valleys
 of California. The arid Southwest has very few stream miles in
 agriculture, due both to a low stream density and limited agricul-
 ture. Conversely, areas with the highest number of stream miles in
                                                                            Srl^ffPI^!^
agriculture are in watersheds that have expensive agriculture and
high stream density. Only one percent of the watersheds (8-digit
HUCs) in the: conterminous U.S. have no Stream miles in agricul-
ture. Ten percent of the watersheds (8-di^it HUCs) in the conter-
minous U.S. have more than 1,500 miles of streams in agriculture.
About half of the watersheds (8-digit HUCs) in the conterminous
U.S. have lesis than 250 miles of streams in agriculture.

Indicator Gaps and  Limitations

The issues associated with this indicator are the same as those
described for the previous indicator "percent urban land cover in
riparian areas." Because the classified land cover data sets were
only produced once, changes in the amount of agricultural land
cover over time are not addressed  by this indicator at present.
Refer to the ^'Indicator Gaps and Limitations" section in the
discussion oFthe previous indicator for details.

Data  Source                  ;

EPA's  Office of Research and Developmenjt analyzed and summa-
rized  data from the National Land  Cover Database for stream
miles with agricultural uses. Information is available from the spe-
cific program datasets (NLCD, C-CAP, NIJD, and HUC). (See
Appendix B, page B-TI for more information.)
              fopulation density in coastal areas - Category 2
  Land along the U.S. coastline is experiencing more acute pressure
  from population growth than other areas. Using primarily census
  data, NOAA has produced several reports on population distribu-
  tion, density, and growth in coastal areas. These reports describe
  the pressure on coastal environments from land development.

  What the Data Show

  The NOAA reports find that coastal areas are the most devel-
  oped in the nation. The narrow  fringe of coastline, comprising
  17 percent of our nation's total  land area, contains 53 percent
  of the nation's population. The  rate of population growth along
  the coast is faster than for the nation as a whole. At an average
  growth rate of 3,600 people per day, coastal population is
  expected to reach 165 million by 2015 (NOAA, 1998).
 Indicator Gaps and Limitations

 The NOAA estimates of coastal population and pressures are likely
 to be an overestimate, as data are aggregated by counties, which
 have extensive inland areas in addition to coastal shoreline.
 Data Source
 Data for this indicator are from a report !on urban development in
 coastal areas by the U.S. Department of,Commerce, National
 Oceanic and Atmospheric Administration. (See Appendix B,
 page B-11, for more information.)      '
2-26
                                                  2.2 Waters and Watersheds
                                  Gnapter 2 - Purer Water

-------
                      ,.               ,          ^_*  ~-_                       ,    ™*

               (—hanging stream flows - (Category
  Flow is a critical-aspect of hydrology in streams. Low flows define
  the smallest area available to stream biota during the year; high
  flows shape the stream channel and clear silt and debris from the
  stream. Also, some fish depend on high flows for spawning (The
  Heinz Center, 2002). The timing of a stream's high and low flows
  can influence many ecological processes. Changes in flow can be
  caused by dams, water withdrawal, changes in land use, and cli-
  mate trends. This indicator reports the percentage of streams or
  rivers with major changes in the magnitude or timing of their high
  or low flows over three decades (1970s, 1980s, 1990s) compared
  to a reference period from 1930 to 1949.

  The USGS stream gauge database, which served as the data
  source for this indicator, contains 867 gauging sites with at least
  20 years of discharge records within the target dates 1930 to
  1949, and 10 years of records for the 1970s, 1980s, and 1990s.
  The measures were 7-day low flow and the corresponding Julian
  days and the average 1 -day high flow and Julian day.
  |;   Exhibit 2-W: Percent of streams with changes in high
  |  flows (l97Os-I990s) compared to baseline high flow
  F~                 data (1930-19U9)
     100
;"- ra
lu
      80
      60
  II'
  II
      40
  rs 20
  rs
  f£
Increase
Decrease

Timing
             1970s   ,         1980s

       Coverage: lower 48 states
                                               1990s
        , Note: Totals may add to more than 100%, because both the timing and
         magnitude may change in a single stream or river.
                                •                            1
         Source: The Heinz Center. The State of the Nation's Ecosystems. 2002- Data „
         from the U.S. Geological Survey.
What the Data Show

The percentage of streams and rivers with major changes in their
high or low flows or the timing of those flows (i.e., compared to
the same data for those streams or rivers as recorded between
1930 and 1949) increased slightly from the 1970s to the 1990s
(The Heinz Center, 2002). The number whose high flows were
well above the flows in those same streams and rivers between
1930 and 1949 increased by approximately 30 percent in the
1990s (Exhibit 2-14). The baseline period of 1930 to 1949
included some droughts, which may partially explain the increase
in high flows in subsequent decades. However, much of this base-
line period also preceded widespread irrigation projects, which
means that fewer high flows would be expected in subsequent
decades.

Indicator Caps and  Limitations

Data from the period 1930 to 1949 are being used here as a
practical baseline for historical comparison, even though many
dams and other waterworks had already been constructed by this
time, and even though this period was characterized by low rainfall
in some parts of the country. For this reason, it may be more use-
ful to compare changes in stream flows on a decade-by-decade
basis rather than to the 1930 to 1949 baseline period selected
here.                          '

Although the sites analyzed here are spread widely throughout
the U.S., gauge placement  by the USCS is not a random process.
Gauges are generally placed on larger, perennial streams and
rivers, and changes seen in these larger systems may differ from
those seen in smaller streams and rivers. In addition, the USGS
gauge network does not represent the full set of operating stream
flow gauges in the U.S. The U.S. Army Corps of Engineers, for
example, operates gauges, and those data are not available
through the USGS; they were not used in this analysis.

Data Source

Data for this indicator came from the U.S. Geological Survey
gauging station network, compiled for The Heinz Center (2002).
(See Appendix B, page B-12, for more information.)
Chapter 2 - Purer Water
                                                2.2 Waters and Watersheds
                                                                            2-27

-------
               Number/duration of dry stream flow periods in grassland/snruDiands - Category 2
  Many grassland/shrublands are located in arid climates where
  water availability is critical. The number and duration of dry peri-
  ods in streams and rivers is used as a hydrology/geomorphology
  indicator in the Heinz report (The Heinz Center, 2002). Changes
  in the number and/or duration of no-flow periods can significantly
  stress aquatic plants and animals. These alterations can result
  from changes in agricultural management or irrigation practices,
  development, change in flow regulation below dams, or depletion
  of shallow ground water. Riparian condition is critical for grassland
  and shrubland streams. Because most of the streams are
  ephemeral, aquatic organisms have evolved to complete their life
  histories during periods when water is available (Fisher, 1995).
  Increasing the percentage of no-flow periods can significantly
  stress riparian and aquatic communities.

  Gauging sites with at least 50 percent grassland/shrubland were
  identified for 4-digit HUC watersheds. The NLCD coverage was
  used to identify these areas as grassland/shrubland. The number
  of sites with at least one no-flow day in a year was determined  for
  each year from 1950 to 1999. The corresponding percentage of
  area as grassland/shrubland for that year was also calculated. To
  analyze the duration of no-flow, only sites with at-least one no-
  flow day in each decade between October 1,1949, and
  September 30,1999, were considered. This analysis considered
  whether there was an increase, decrease, or minimal change in the
  number of no-flow days, compared to the long-term (50-year)
  average for each stream.
               What the Data Show
                                                   i
               The percentage of no-flow periods has decreased in all grass-
               land/shrubland regions of the West (ThejHeinz Center, 2002).
               The percentage of no-flow periods was sifnilar in the 1950s and
               1960s and then generally decreased in the 1970s, 1980s, and
               1990s (Exhibit 2-15) (The Heinz Center, 2002). The 1980s was
               a relatively wet period,  during which some of the smallest per-
               centages of no-flow periods existed in a 5,0-year period of record
               (The Heinz Center, 2002). The duration 6f no-flow periods also
               decreased during the 1970s through the 1990s, compared to the
               1950s and 1960s (The Heinz Center, 2002).

               Indicator Gaps and Limitations

               These data are from USGS gauging stations, which may be found
               on larger, perennial streams; thus, these, data may not reflect con-
               ditions on very small streams.  Data limitations, generally, are simi-
               lar to those described for the "number/duration of dry stream
                                 •                 f i          j
               flow periods in grasslands/shrublands" indicator described on the
               previous page.                 '       j

               Data Source

               The data source for this indicator was the:U.S. Geological Survey
               gauging stations, analyzed by Colorado State University for The
               Heinz Center. (See Appendix B, page B-12, for more information.)
                                        Exhibit 2-15: Percent of streams that hi
                                                     periods, I950s-1990s
                          2 zero-rlow
                                      100
                         IK:

                                         Coverage: grassland/shrubland regions in lower 48 states,
                                                              1     . '  ' ' '   IB] _ _	_
                                         Source: The Heinz Center, The State of the .Nation'} Eco Stems 2002 Data "
                                         from the U.S. Geological Survey.              F
2-28
2.2 Waters and Watersheds
Chapter 2 - Furer Water

-------
               Sedimentation index - C-ategory 2
  Stream channels undergo a long-term adjustment to a region-
  specific rate of sediment supply that is delivered by erosion
  processes from natural disturbance. The size distribution of
  streambed particles is dependent upon the relationship between
  sediment supply and stream sediment transport capability. Under
  a natural  disturbance regime, sediment supply in watersheds that
  are not altered by human disturbances may be roughly in long-
  term equilibrium with stream sediment transport In watersheds
  that are relatively undisturbed by humans, the relationship
  between bed particle size and stream transport capability should
  tend toward a characteristic value that is typical to the region.
  Human activities may increase sediment input rates to streams,
  resulting  in higher amounts of fine substrates in sediments tha.n
  the predicted regional value.

  Higher sedimentation rates can significantly alter instream habitat.
  These alterations are the greatest stressor to mid-Atlantic streams
  and many other streams throughout the U.S. For example, change
  in channel morphology can affect stream biota and ecological
  condition. Thrush, et al. (2000)  provide 10 geomorphic attributes
  that are needed for suitable stream habitat, in addition to critical
  channel morphological indicators.

  A sedimentation index was developed for Mid-Atlantic Highland
  streams to assess the quality of instream habitat to support
  aquatic communities (Kaufmann, et al., 1999). Stream
  sedimentation was defined as an increase or excess in the amount
  of fine substrate particles (smaller than 16-mm diameter) relative
  to an expected reference value that is based on the region and
  the sediment transport capability of each sample stream reach.
  Streams were given the following ratings with respect to
  sedimentation:
  • "Good" when the proportion  of fine particles was at least  10
     percent below the predicted value.
  • "Fair" when the population of fine particles ranged from 10 per-
     cent below to 20 percent above the predicted value.
  • "Poor" when the proportion of fine particles was more than 2Q
     percent above regional mean expectations.

  What  the Data Show

  Based on the sedimentation index, about 35 percent of the
  Mid-Atlantic Highland stream miles had good instream habitat,
               &^              -      '  •
               ^Exhibit 2-16: Percent of Mid-Atlantic highland streams
               {^exhibiting good, fair, and poor habitat condition based
               jfe»      upon a sedimentation index, 1993-1994
                 -              -• • ,-~  • •                •		 --
               £ "Source: EPA Region 3 and the Office of Research and Development. Mid-Atlantic
               1 Highlands Streams Assessment._August 2000.
               *^~  ^_  _^        __-.__ '. ,-•----;._• ,^ T .  .  J^   	^ .. '    - .,  •-     .
               40 percent had fair instream habitat, and 25 percent of the
               stream miles had poor instream habitat (Exhibit 2-16)  (EPA,
               ORD,  Region 3, August 2000).

               Indicator Gaps and  Limitations

               This sedimentation index has been applied only in the  context
               of the mid-Atlantic region and cannot be used for a national
               assessment. The index itself may not apply equally to other
               regions of the nation.

               Data Source
               The data source for this indicator was EPA's Mid-Atlantic
               Highlands Streams Assessment, part of the Environmental
               Monitoring and Assessment Program. (See Appendix B,
               page B-12, for more information.)
C-napter 2 - furer Water
2.2 Waters and Watersheds
2-29

-------

2.2 AD Nutrient Pressures

Nutrient enrichment by nitrogen and phosphorus is one of the
leading causes of water quality impairment in the nation's rivers,
lakes, and estuaries. In a 1998 water quality report to Congress,
nutrients were listed as a leading cause of water pollution. About
half of the nation's waters surveyed by states do not adequately
support aquatic life because of excess  nutrients. In 1998, states
reported that excessive nutrients have  degraded almost 2.5 million
acres of lakes and reservoirs and over 84,000 miles of rivers and
streams to the extent that they no longer meet basic uses such as
supporting healthy aquatic  life. Nutrients have also been associated
with both the large hypoxic zone in the Gulf of Mexico, the hypoxia
observed in several East Coast states, and P/ister/a-induced fish kills
and human health problems in the coastal waters of several East
Coast and Gulf states.

Many of the nutrients used in chemical fertilizers are water soluble.
Consequently, one of the major potential environmental effects of fer-
tilizer usage Is the nitrogen or phosphorus that may find its way into
water systems, affecting water quality and aquatic habitats. Another
major source of nutrients from agricultural lands are those related to
animal feed operations. Nutrients, particularly nitrogen and phospho-
rus, increase the levels of algae in receiving waterbodies.

Most of the streams that are enriched with nutrients lie in drainage
areas for agricultural and/or urban land. Forested landscapes rarely
contribute to heightened water concentrations of these nutrients.
Ground water from more than half the sites sampled  in a nationwide
study contained nutrients at concentrations higher than natural
background levels. Data presented in Chapter 3, Better Protected
Land, describe a USGS risk analysis that evaluated the  likelihood of
ground water contamination from nitrate resulting from a combina-
tion of well-drained soils and a high proportion of cropland to wood-
               land. The data illustrate a clear relationship between potential
               ground water contamination and predominantly agricultural areas of
               the country (see Chapter 3-Better Protected Land).
                                                    i

               "Nitrogen export" is the annual  quantity of total nitrogen produced
               by nitrogen sources in a watershed that leaves the watershed
               through a river or stream that connects to other watersheds down-
               stream. Estimates of total nitrogen (TN) export were developed by
               Smith, et al. (1997) through analysis ofdata from monitoring sta-
               tions in the LiSGS's National Stream Quality Accounting Network
               (NASQAN) SPARROW (SPAtially-Referenc^d Regressions On
               Watershed attributes). This model relates jn-stream measurements of
               TN export to point and non-point sources of pollution, and to land-
               surface and stream-channel characteristics in the watersheds that
               contain the monitoring stations. This modeling was performed using
               data from approximately 400 long-term stream monitoring sites.
               Using these data, the model empirically estimated the delivery of
               nutrients to streams and the outlets of watersheds from point and
               non-point sources.                  '  |
                           ;	           •  •         :  I
               This section presents  six indicators of pressures on water quality
               related to nutrient enrichment:          \
               • Atmospheric deposition of nitrogen
               • Nitrates in farmland, forested, and urban streams and ground water
               • Total nitrogen in coastal waters
               • Phosphorus in farmland, forested, and urban streams
               • Phosphorus in large rivers            i
               • Phosphorus in coastal waters          j

               Chapter 3-Bstter Protected Land, discusses the potential for nutri-
               ent runoff from  farmlands.

                Atmospheric deposition of nitrogen - Category 2
   Nitrogen, essential to life, is a component of proteins and
   nucleic acids. Natural and human processes convert nitrogen gas
   to a variety of usable forms, including nitrogen oxides, ammonia,
   and organic nitrogen. Natural sources of nitrogen oxides and
   ammonia include volcanic eruptions, lightning, forest fires, and
   certain microbial processes. Anthropogenic sources contribute
   about the same amount of nitrogen oxides and ammonia to the •
   environment as do natural sources. The largest single source of
   nitrogen oxides to the atmosphere is the combustion of fossil
   fuels (such as coal, oil, and gas) by automobiles and electric
   power plants (Schlesinger, 1997). The largest sources of ammo-
               nia emissions are fertilizers and domesticated animals (such as
               hogs, chickeris, and cows).

               In some placeis, nitrogen deposited from the atmosphere is a large
               percentage of the total nitrogen load. For instance, Albemarle-
               Pamlico Sound in North Carolina receives  38 percent of its nitro-
               gen from the Atmosphere (EPA, OAQPS, Jijne 2000). As human
               sources of nitrogen compounds to the atifiosphere increase, the
               importance of atmospheric deposition of nitrogen to bodies of
               water will increase as well.               !
2-30
2.2 Waters and Watersheds
apter 2 - furer Water

-------
                   -jT -' ' ',, J, a'dtl-JU^f ijjjp. ^iM.^^iiiSrfi^.-WY^W^^
     	-—i—-™.- ..^i-^Wi..... Jn*^^^-^a.^i^^i4fl;ag^^
                     :mospheric deposition of nitrogen - Category 2 (continued)
                               .Exhibit 2-17: Ammonium wet deposition, 2OOI
                                                        AK01  0.1 kg/ha
                                                        AK03  0.1 kg/ha
                                                        HI99  0.5 kg/ha
                                                        VI01   0.3 kg/ha
           National Atmospheric Deposition Program, National Trends Network. 2001.
             '       ttP:""afa*WSM'
i
                               Exnitit 2-18: Nitrate wet deposition, 20OI
    LCqverage: lower 48 states                      ..    .  .    .
    ^?M=r3;: &at™rr!AiT.os!?J'eric DeP°?'tion Program, National Trends Network. 2001.
     (March 25, 2003; http://nadp.sws.uiuc.edu/hopteths/maps200T/no3dep.pdf).
"c
    The deposition of nitrogen compounds
  *  on land or water can take several forms.
    Wet deposition occurs when air pollu-
    tants fall with rain, snow, or fog. Dry
    deposition is the deposition of pollu-
  :  tants as dry  particles or gases. In either
    form, the pollutants can reach bodies
    of water as direct deposition falling
    directly into  the water or as indirect
  i  deposition—falling onto land  and
    passing into  a body of water as runoff.
    In either case, atmospheric deposition
  •  is often one of the major sources of
  :  nitrogen in surface waters.

    This indicator focuses on atmospheric
  '  deposition of inorganic nitrogen, as it
 -  is the most immediately available form
    of nitrogen in the environment. Its
    components, nitrate and ammonium,
    are presented using the  National
   Atmospheric  Deposition
    Program/National Trends Network
    (NADP/NTN) data collected in 2001.

   What the Data Show
   Ammonium deposition is lowest in the
   western states, where it is generally less'
   than 1 kg/ha. Highest rates occur in
 :;  the upper midwestern states in the
 ;  upper Mississippi River watershed
 i  (Exhibit 2-17). Nitrate deposition also
   is low in the western states (< 4 kg/ha).
 ;  Highest deposition rates occur in the
   upper Midwest and in the eastern
 i  states (Exhibit 2-18). High ammonium
   values'are associated with wastes from
   animal agriculture, while nitrates are
   largely from fertilizers used in row crop
 :  agriculture.

i  Indicator Gaps and
§  Limitations

J  This indicator measures wet deposition,
*  not dry deposition. Total nitrogen dep-
I  osition is not measured.
Chapter 2 - Purer Water
                                                 2.2 Waters and Watersheds
                                                                                                                             2-31

-------
                                                   	H""1"""'"""	"" " !nhjl" '"'"'	"	"""""  J p     """
             Atmospheric deposition of nitrogen - Category 2 (continued)
 Additionally, the indicator estimates deposition only to the sur-
 face areas, not directly to the water, except where large waterbodies
 are present
                                                  Data Source                   I
                                                                                       i
                                                  The data source for this indicator was thejinteragency National
                                                  Atmospheric Deposition Program. (See Apjpendix B, page B-12 for
                                                  more information.)
. „	tiiiiiiiiiiiJiiHiliJfiii
I ~" 1.  ,
ndicator	
Nitrate in farmland, forested, and urban streams and ground water - Category 2
                                                                                                           if TV »i* '
 Nitrogen is a critical plant nutrient, and most nitrogen is used and
 reused by plants within an ecosystem. Thus, in undisturbed
 ecosystems, minimal "leakage" occurs into either surface runoff or
 ground water, and concentrations are very low. However, when
 amounts of nitrate in streams and ground water are elevated, this
 generally indicates that inputs from human sources have increased
 or that plants in the system are under stress. Elevated nitrogen
 levels might come from fertilizer use, disposal of animal waste,
 onsite septic systems, sewage treatment plants, or rain and snow-
 fall (in the form of atmospheric deposition).

 This indicator reports on the concentration of nitrate in streams
 and ground water in farmland, forested, and urban areas.
 Specifically, the indicator reports the percent of streams with
  average nitrate concentrations in one of four ranges: less than
  two ppm; two-six ppm; six-10 ppm; and 10 ppm or more. The
  data, comprised of samples collected at over 100 stream sites in
  farmland areas, were collected and analyzed by the NAWQA
  program in 36 large watersheds  across the U.S. during 1993
  to1998. Thirty-six forested streams and 21 urban/suburban
  streams also were evaluated. Ground water samples were collect-
  ed from 20 to 30 private wells in each of 36 agricultural study
  areas and 13 urban  study areas.

  What the Data Show

  USGS data, compiled for The Heinz Center (2002), indicate that:
  • Nitrate concentrations were above two ppm (mg/L) in about
    half of-the stream sites and 55 percent of ground water wells
    sampled in areas where agriculture is the primary land use
     (Exhibit 2-19).
  • Most nitrate concentrations in forested streams were less than
     0.5 ppm (SO percent had concentrations of nitrate less than
                                                     0.1 ppm, 75 percent had concentrations of less than 0.5 ppm,
                                                     and only one had a concentration of more than  1.0 ppm).
                                                   i Forty percent of urban/suburban streams had nitrate concentra-
                                                     tions above 1.0 ppm (25 percent had Concentrations below 0.5
                                                     ppm, and three percent had concentrations below 0.1  ppm).
                                                   About 20 percent of the ground water wells and about 10
                                                   percent of stream sites had concentrations that exceeded the
                                                   federal drinking water standard (10 trig/In), Only three percent of
                                                   urban ground water wells had nitrate concentrations exceeding the
                                                   standard. Sa triples of ground water in agricultural areas have
                                                   nitrate concentrations higher than ground waters of forested or
                                                   urban areas.                          !

                                                   In four of 33 major drinking water aquifers sampled, the federal
                                                   drinking waller standard for nitrate was exceeded in more than
                                                   15 percent of samples  collected. In these aquifers, all of which
                                                   underlie intensive agricultural areas, nitrate most often is elevated
                                                   in karst (carbonate) areas or where soilsiand aquifers consist of
                                                   sand and gravel. These natural features enable rapid infiltration
                                                   and downward movement of water and chemicals. Some of the
                                                   more vulnerable areas of the nation are the Central Valley of
                                                   California, and parts of the Pacific North-west, the Great Plains,
                                                   and the Mid-Atlantic region. In contrast,^ contaminants are barely
                                                   detectable "n ground water underlying farmland in parts of the
                                                   upper Midwest,  despite similar high ratei of chemical use. In these
                                                   areas, ground water contamination may be limited, because of the
                                                   relatively impermeable, poorly drained sbils and glacial till that
                                                   cover much of the region, and because tile drains provide quick
                                                   pathways for runoff to streams (Gilliom,jet al., 2002).

                                                   Nitrate contamination in shallow ground water (less than  100 feet
                                                   below land surface) raises potential cbnterns for human health,
2-32
                                                   2.2 Waters and Watersheds
                                                                                     Chapter 2 - "Purer Water

-------
                                                                                ^^C^^                  *• 57"
                                                                                ** ^   " 't-l^tt W~ W-t  f^  *  \
                Nitrate in farmland, forested, and urban streams and ground Water - Category 2 (continued)
    particularly in rural agricultural areas where shallow ground water is
    used for domestic water supply. Furthermore, high levels of nitrate
    in shallow ground water may serve as an early warning of possible
    future contamination of older underlying ground water, which is a
    common source for public water supplies (USGS,  1999).

    Indicator Caps  and  Limitations

    These data  only represent conditions in the 36 major river basins
    and aquifers sampled by the NAWQA program. While they were
    subjectively chosen to be representative of watersheds across the
    U.S., they are the result of a targeted  sample design.

    The data also are highly aggregated and should only be
    interpreted  as an indication  of national patterns. For example, the
                                                           definition of agricultural land included land use by cropland or
                                                           pasture. The percentage of land used for agricultural purposes
                                                           within specific watersheds varied from 10 to 99 percent of the
                                                           land cover, so the characterization of lands as agricultural is
                                                           subject to this degree of variation in land use.

                                                           Data Source

                                                           Data for this indicator were compiled for The Heinz Center
                                                           (2002) from the  U.S. Geological Survey's National Water
                                                           Quality Assessment Program. (See Appendix B, page B-13  for
                                                           more  information.)
                           Exhibit 2-19: Nitrates in Farmland streams and ground water, 1992-1998
                                                 2-6 ppm
                                                 6-10 ppm
                                                 10 ppm or more
                                             fir;? less than 2 ppm
                                             H 2-6 ppm
                                                6-10 ppm
                 1992-1998
                                                                           Farmlands
                                                                                            Forests
                                                                                                               Urban
t
Coverage: lower 48 states. Each sampling area was sampled intensively for approximately 2 years during 1 992-1 998.
Source: The Heinz Center. The State of the Nation's Ecosystems. 2002. .Qata from the U.S. Geological Survey:
Chapter 2 - Purer Water
                                          2.2 Waters and Watersheds
                                                                                                                         2-33

-------
             Total nitrogen in coastal waters - Category 2
                                                                                  tWSS^^fR!^
                                                                                  '  '''    " ::''-	.	  • ;' '; •-' .' ' "\>'l. '.' /'";:," "V1.:" :	.', ,"-" .    c

 Nitrogen in estuaries is commonly regarded as the most important
 limiting nutrient. Nutrients can originate at either point sources
 (e.g., sewage treatment plants and industries) or non-point
 sources  (e.g., farmlands, lawns, leaking septic systems, and the
 atmosphere). Excess nutrients can lead to eutrophication.

 Total nitrogen (TN) in the mid-Atlantic estuaries was calculated by
 summing the concentrations of total dissolved nitrogen and
 particulate organic nitrogen (EPA, ORD, May 2003). Assessment
 categories were determined based on the 25th and 75th
 percentiles. The categories are (EPA, ORD, May 2003):
 • Low: < 0.5 ppm nitrogen
 • Intermediate: 0.5 to 1.0 ppm nitrogen
 • High: > 1.0 ppm nitrogen

 Currently there are no national-level water quality criteria for total
 nitrogen in estuaries, but states are in the process of determining
 nutrient criteria for their waters.

 What the Data  Show

 This analysis yielded the following results:
 • For the mid-Atlantic region, about 35 percent of the  estuarine
   area had low TN concentrations, 47 percent had intermediate
   TN concentrations, and 18 percent had high TN concentrations
    (Exhibit 2-20).
 • About 50 percent of the mainstem area of the Chesapeake  Bay
    had low TN concentrations, with only about five percent having
    high TN concentrations.
 • In contrast, about fives percent of coastal bays had low TN con-
    centrations, and about 35 percent had high  TN concentrations.
 • The entire Delaware River estuary portion of Delaware Bay had
    high TN concentrations.
                   ipil^jyii:;, Btjji'niii^ii ^:3^^     ^^^^4;^ ^ ^"4^ ^*« .^11*^-• i^M

I Exhibit 2-'|6: Extent of Mid-Atlantic estuaries with low,
|g::,L^ *.ij ;.,,'>.^1 :.:;i.::5|p^.!:;ss.:.^;S:ps^^^^^^
                  and high total nitrogen concentrations,
                  lll|"'™l|l|""!"p""  	—"	- —	- ~'TS5E3!MK*ISK5W2T3;*'EET1J.a
           ip  I'   J*.  '**»*»  ,.   >,  i 1 rsir*j**fe"{  i**j fr y
    Source: EPA, Office of Research and Development. Mid-Atlantic Integrated
f-  AssessmentjtdAlA - Estuaries "l])97-98, Summary 'Report ^ May"2003.

Indicator  Caps and Limitations

These TN estimations for estuaries apply only to the mid-Atlantic
region and cannot be used to make national estimates of nitrogen
concentrations.                       •

Data  Source                  !

The data soiirce for this indicator was EPyji's Mid-Atlantic
Integrated Assessment (MAIA)  Estuaries Program, part of
EPA's Enviror.mental Monitoring and Assessment Program.
(See Appendix  B, page B-13, for more information.)
2-34
                                                   2.2 Waters and Watersheds
                                   Cnapter 2 - Purer Water

-------
                                                                                   llMM|pIi

                 Thosphorus in farmland, forested,  and urban streams - Category 2
    Phosphorus, an essential nutrient for all life forms, occurs naturally
    in soils and aquatic systems. However, at high concentrations; phos-
    phates, the most biologically active form of phosphorus, can cause
    significant water quality problems by overstimulating algae growth.
    This is both aesthetically unappealing and can contribute to the
    loss of oxygen needed by fish and other animals. Human activity can
    increase phosphorus levels through fertilizer use, disposal of animal
    waste, sewage treatment, and use of some detergents.

    This indicator reports on the concentration of phosphorus in
    streams that drain watersheds comprised primarily of farmland,
    forested, or urban land  use. Specifically, the indicator reports the
    percent of these streams that have average annual  phosphorus
    concentrations in one of four ranges: less than O.I ppm; 0.1  to 0.3
    ppm; 0.3 to 0.5  ppm; and 0.5 ppm or more. Thirty-six forested
    streams and 21  urban/suburban streams also were evaluated.

    What the  Data Show

    Data compiled by the USGS indicate that:
    • About three-fourths  of farmland stream sites had concentra-
     tions of phosphorus  above 0.1  parts per million (mg/L)
     (Exhibit  2-21).
    • About 15 percent of farmland stream sites had phosphorus
     concentrations greater than 0.5 ppm of phosphorus.
    • Phosphorus concentrations in streams of agricultural lands were
     similar to but slightly higher than those in urban streams and
     much greater than those  in forest streams.
                 EPA has recently set new regional water quality criteria for phos-
                 phorus levels in streams in agricultural ecosystems. These criteria
                 range from 0.023 to 0.076 ppm and vary according to differences
                 in ecoregions, soil types, climate-, and land use.

                 Compared to nitrogen, a smaller proportion of phosphorus
                 (originating mostly from livestock wastes or fertilizers) was lost from ,
                 watersheds to streams. The annual amounts of total phosphorus
                 measured in agricultural streams were equivalent to less than
                 20 percent of the phosphorus that was applied annually to the
                 land. This is consistent with the general tendency of phosphorus to
                 attach to soil particles that move more slowly with runoff to surface
                 water.  Even though less phosphorus is transported from land than
                 nitrogen, phosphorus is more likely to reach concentrations that
                 can cause excessive aquatic plant growth. Nitrogen concentrations
                 are rarely low enough to limit aquatic plant growth in fresh water,
                 whereas  phosphorus concentrations can be low enough to limit such
                 growth. Thus, adding phosphorus to an aquatic system can have a
                 greater impact than adding nitrogen. Hence, excessive aquatic plant
                 growth and eutrophication in fresh water generally result from  ele-
                 vated phosphorus concentrations (typically greater than 0.1 ppm)
                 (EPA, OW, June 1998). In contrast, nitrogen typically  is the limiting
                 nutrient for aquatic plant growth in saltwater and coastal waters.

                 Indicator Caps and Limitations

                 These  data only represent conditions in the 36 major river basins
                 and aquifers sampled by NAWQA. While they were subjectively
                              Exhibit 2-21: Phosphorus in farmland streams and ground water, 1992-1998
                                                  less than 0.1 ppm
                                                  0.1 to 0.3 ppm
                                                  0,3 to 0.5 ppm
                                                J 0.5 ppm or more
                                                                                                Forests
                                                                                                              Urban/Suburban
           Coverage: lower 48 states. Each sampling area was sampled intensively for approximately 2 years during 1 992-1 998

           Source: The Heinz Center. The State of the Nation's Ecosystems. 2002 Data from the U S Geological Survey
Cnapter 2 - Purer Water
2.2 Waters and Watersheds
                                                                                                                            2-35

-------

             Phosphorus in farmland, forested, and urban streams -
                                                          ategory 2 (continued)
                                                                                                                  ,,-^::,...d
 chosen to represent watersheds across the U.S., they are the
 result of a targeted sample design.

 The data also are highly aggregated and should only be interpret-
 ed as an indication of national patterns. For example, watersheds
 dominated by agricultural land included land use by cropland or
 pasture. The percentage of land used for these purposes varied
 from 10 to 99 percent, so the characterization of lands as agricul-
 tural is subject to this degree of variation in land use.
                                              Data Source
                                                          i                         '
                                              Data used for this indicator were compiled for The Heinz Center
                                              (2002) from the U.S. Geological Survey'? National Water
                                              Quality Assessment Program. (See Appendix B, page B-13, for
                                              more informsition.)                    :
              Pnospn
lospnorus in large rivers
-Cab
:egory
 Increased phosphorus in large rivers and other waterbodies leads
 to an increase in growth of algae. While small amounts of algae
 provide the critical base of the food chains in these waterbodies,
 larger amounts lead to eutrophication. As discussed in Section
 2.2.3, eutrophication can lead to loss of oxygen, shifts in fish  •
 population, and "nuisance blooms" of algal species. Algal blooms
 generally degrade aesthetic and recreational values.

 Data on phosphorus were collected from 140 sites in large rivers
 (i.e., rivers with flows exceeding 1,000 cubic feet per second) at
 least 30 times over a 2-year period between 1992 and 1998 by
 the USCS (The Heinz Center, 2002).

 What the Data Show

  Half of the rivers tested had total phosphorus concentrations
 equaling or exceeding 100 parts per billion (The Heinz Center,
  2002) (Exhibit 2-22), which is EPA's recommended goal for pre-
 venting excess algal growth in streams that do not flow directly
 into lakes. None of the rivers had concentrations below 20 parts
  per billion, a level generally held to be free of negative effects
  (EPA, OW, November 1986).

  Indicator Gaps and  Limitations

  Phosphorus measurements in rivers were restricted to those large
  rivers with flows exceeding 1,000 cubic feet per second. To
  ensure proper characterization of average values for each river,
  only sites that had at least 30 samples over the course of 2 years
  were included. Thus, only large rivers with adequate sampling are
  represented.
                                                                                 £
                                                                              > Jj
                                                              lit 2-22: Distribution of phosphorus
                                                                's*'? v^^TSSisf-- "',, A ~ /
                                                                        In large rwers, 1991-1996
                                                                                 -
                                                                                 „-4
                                                The data used for this indicator are from larger rivers. Larger rivers
                                                typically have both larger discharge volutnes and watersheds with
                                                more diverse land uses. These samples, therefore, represent the
                                                integrating influences of many different (and uses. Also, they were
                                                the result of a targeted sample design, a|nd may not be represen-
                                                tative of large  rivers across the U.S.

                                                Data Source

                                                The data u;;ed for this indicator were from the U.S. Geological
                                                Survey as compiled for The Heinz Center (2002). (See Appendix
                                                B, page B-14,  for more information.)    ;
2-36
                                                  2.2 Waters and Watersheds
                                                                                Chapter 2 - Purer Water

-------


                  lotal phosphorus in coastal waters - Category 2
     Phosphorus is an essential plant nutrient. It is derived from
     weathering and erosion of natural mineral deposits, runoff of fer-
     tilizers applied to agricultural and urban areas, and point source
     discharges of sewage, detergents, Pharmaceuticals, and other
     phosphorus-containing products. Phosphorus is generally
     considered the limiting nutrient in fresh water systems (Schindler,
     1977), but it can also become limiting in estuarine areas if total
     nitrogen becomes abundant (EPA, ORD, May 2003).

     Total phosphorus data were collected in the mid-Atlantic
     estuaries (EPA, ORD, May 2003) during 1997 and 1998. TP
     assessment categories were based on the 25th and 75th per-
     centile concentrations measured throughout the mid-Atlantic
     region. These categories are:
    • Low: <0.05 to 0.1  ppm
    • Intermediate: O.OS to 0.1 ppm
    • High: >0.1  ppm

    What  the Data Show

    Analysis of the data showed that:
    • TP concentrations  in  mid-Atlantic estuaries ranged from 0 to
      0.34 ppm.
    • For the mid-Atlantic region, about 58 percent of the estuarine
      area had low TP concentrations, 30 percent had intermediate
      TP concentrations, and 12 percent had high TP concentrations
      (Exhibit 2- 23).
    • About 85 percent of the mainstem area of Chesapeake Bay had
      low TP concentration with no areas having high TP concentrations.
    • The coastal bays, in contrast,  had no areas with low TP concen-
      trations and about  35 percent with high TP concentrations.
    • The Delaware River estuary portion of Delaware Bay had
      100 percent of its area with high TP  concentrations.
                 |£xhit>it 2-23: Extent of Mid-Atlantic estuaries with low,;
                 tpntermediate, and high total phosphorus concentrations,
                 £J..-.,l;..±,,_._;.,,.;i997-l.998....    	'
                '-- Source: EPA, Office of Research and Development Mid-Atlantic Integrated
                ^-Assessment, MAIA - Estuaries _W7-98, Summary Report. May 2003.
                Indicator Gaps and Limitations

                These TP estimations apply only to estuaries of the mid-Atlantic
                region and cannot be used to make national estimates of phos-
                phorus concentrations.

                Data Source

                Data for this indicator came from EPA's Environmental Monitoring
                and Assessment Program, Mid-Atlantic Integrated Assessment
                (MAIA) Estuaries Program. (See Appendix B, page B-14, for more
                information.)
Chapter 2 - Purer Water
2.2 Waters and Watersheds
                                                                                                                      2-37

-------
2.2.4.C Chemical Contaminant Pressures

The waters of our rivers, lakes, and oceans have been contaminated
by pollutants. Some of these pollutants, such as the pesticide DDT
and the industrial chemicals known as PCBs, were released into the
environment long ago. The use of DDT and PCBs in the U.S. was
banned in the 1970s, but these chemicals persist for many years.
Other contaminants enter our waters every day. Some flow directly
from industrial and municipal waste dischargers, while others come
from non-point source pollution in urban and agricultural areas.
Additionally, other contaminants are carried through the air and
eventually are deposited on  lands and in lakes and streams far from
the facilities that produced them. When this happens, sediments in
waterbodies may serve as  a reservoir for these contaminants and,
ultimately, as a source of contamination.

The USGS has compiled contaminant data for waterbodies as part of
 Its National Water Quality Assessment Program. Gilliom, et al.
 (2002) summarized some of major NAWQA findings as follows:
 • Detectable concentrations of pesticides were widespread in  agri-
    cultural area streams. DDT was the most commonly detected
    organochlorine compound, followed by dieldrin and chlordane.
 • Water in urban areas has a characteristic "signature" that is reflec-
    tive of the chemicals used in the watersheds. Insecticides—such as
    diazinon, carbaryl, cholorpyrifos, and malathion—were detected
    more frequently and  usually at higher concentrations in urban
    streams than in agricultural streams.
 • Concentrations of selected trace elements, such as cadmium, lead,
    zinc, and mercury, are elevated above background levels in heavily
    populated urban settings.
 • Volatile organic compounds (VOCs), which are used in plastics,
    cleaning solvents, gasoline, and industrial operations,  are prevalent
    in shallow urban ground  water.
Eight indicators have been chosen to describe chemical contaminant
pressures on water resources:            ;
• Atmospherip deposition of mercury.    ,
• Chemical contamination in streams and ground water.
• Pesticides in farmland streams and ground water.
• Acid sensitivity in lakes and streams.   :
• Toxic releases to water of mercury, dioxifi, lead, PCBs, and persist-
  ent bioaccumulative toxic chemicals (PBJTs).
• Sediment contamination of inland watete.
• Sediment contamination of coastal waters.
H Sediment toxicity in estuaries.         ,

Mercury contamination of waters and sediments is one of the lead-
ing causes of closed fisheries and fish consumption advisories in
the  U.S. (see Section 2.5). Atmospheric [deposition in the Great
 Lakes and northeastern area of the U.S. is the primary source of
 this contaminant. Discharges to waterways as indicated by data
 from EPA's Toxics Release Inventory (TRIJ are a relatively small
 source of mercury contamination.
             I             '          ;  j
 The EPA National Sediment Inventory (NSIJ) has extensively reviewed
 sediment qusility data collected predominantly from sampling programs
 targeted at sites of known contamination (See ). NSj classifies these sites as
 demonstrating, by association or otherwise, probable biological effects
 related to the contamination. Not surprisingly, the most contaminated
 watersheds are found in the Great Lakes region and northeast corridor
 in areas of dense populations and industrial development. Data show
 that a small proportion (1  percent or less) of the sampled estuarine
 areas of the eastern U.S. and Gulf of Mexico coasts contain chemicals
 at concentrations high enough to be associated with biological effects.
	'"

                  Atmospheric deposition of mercury - Category 2
     The primary sources of mercury emissions on a national level are
     coal-fired power plants (33 percent), municipal waste incinerators
     (18 percent), and medical waste incinerators (10 percent)
     (EPA, OW, December 1997). Coal-fired power plants produce
     mercury by burning coal, which contains trace amounts of
     mercury that are released during combustion. Incinerators emit
     mercury when they burn wastes containing mercury. For medical
     waste incinerators, mercury waste comes from medical devices  like
     thermometers and blood pressure cuffs. For municipal waste
     incinerators, mercury comes from discarded appliances, such as
     thermostats and fluorescent lights and lamps.
   Mercury deposition was estimated from measurements made by
   the Mercury Deposition Network (MDN), which is part of the
   National Atmospheric Deposition Program. Precipitation samples
   were collected weekly and analyzed for fatal mercury and
   methylmeniury. The MDN began a transjtion network of 13 sites in
   1995 and, !n the next year, became an official network in the NADP
   with 26 sites. During 2000, more than ko sites were in operation.
   2-38
                                                       2.2 Waters and Watersheds
                                    ;Chapter2-Purer Water

-------
                                                    - > 'i-f.f-y-- « ww-es? S-J£i«v ™rscP'«typia9«8
              Atmospheric deposition of mercury - Category 2 (continued)
  What the Data Show
   Estimates of annual mercury wet deposition in 2001 are
   presented in Exhibit 2-24. Mercury deposition ranges from a low of
   2.4 micrograms per square meter (pg/m2) measured at a California
   site to over 14 pg/m2 at sites in eastern Texas, south Florida, and
   eastern Wisconsin. The Great Lakes and southeastern states are
   those most greatly affected by mercury deposition.

   Indicator Gaps and Limitations

   Limitations for this indicator include:
   • The spatial coverage provided by the Mercury Deposition
    Network is somewhat limited, though the measurement sites
                have been distributed relative to major mercury emission
                sources.
              • Only wet deposition of mercury was measured.

              Data  Source

              The interagency National Atmospheric Deposition Program served
              as the data source for this indicator. (See Appendix B, page B-14,
              for more information.)
                               Exhibit 2-24: Annual mercuiy wet deposition in 2OO1
                                              per square meter (|Jg/m2)
    Note: Coverage does include Alaska, Hawaii, or Puerto Rico

    Source: National Atmospheric Deposition Program, Mercury Deposition Network 2001.
    March 25, 2003; (http://nadp.sws.uiuc.edU/mdn/maps/200T/0 7 MDNdepo.pdf).
Chapter 2 - Turer Water
2.2 Waters and Watersheds
2-39

-------


   iilili
              Cnemical contamination in streams and ground water -
                          Category 2
  The U.S. Geological Survey reported on contaminants in stream
  waters and streambed sediment for the entire U.S. (see The Heinz
  Center, 2002). The contaminants reported include many pesticides,
  selected  pesticide degradation products, PCBs, polyaromatic hydro-
  carbons  (PAHs), volatile organic compounds, other industrial con-
  taminants, and trace elements. In sufficient concentrations, any of
  these chemicals can harm wildlife, but for many of these com-
  pounds, there are no standards or guidelines for acceptable levels in
  aquatic systems.

  In the USGS analysis, water contaminant data were derived from
  36 major river basins, which included 109 stream sites with data
  sufficient to calculate annual averages. Stream water samples gen-
  erally were collected on 20 to 40 occasions over a one-year peri-
  od (Cilliom, et al., 2002) during 1992 to 1998. Ground water
  data were collected from 3,549 wells in these major river basins
  and aquifers.

  What the Data Show

  All stream waters averaged one or more contaminants at
  detectable levels throughout the year. More than 80 percent
  averaged five or more (Exhibit 2-25). About 90 percent of
  ground water sites averaged one or more detectable contaminants.
  40 percent contained five or more contaminants.

  Indicator Caps and Limitations

  The sites sampled are representative of a wide range of stream
  sizes, types, and land uses broadly distributed across the U.S.
  (Gilliom, et al., 2002; The Heinz Center, 2002).
                                                                          it
                     100
                o
              I*
              ij*
              ;is
              t£o
              .,  JE 43
                _ c
              .  f. ro
              |||
              &a
              ft
80
60
40
                      20
                          licit 2-25: Occurrence of contaminants in
                          |S  i         i|      ,  1  t '- * iJ*
                          |t
                          st
    gtreams and cjroi
d around water, IQ92-1998
                         C oVe
                                                          I
                                                           "
                          SKiii-L'i*iii"h ,1	rt-S"*»r  I	       m 1  "n    *   fe T
                          llrcei'f he "fleinz Center The 5ta& of the Nation's Ecosystems 2002
                          SI'K'«!!!»>	*|-:|y;™«	n* IfT^     *^%y4^rw   ^  y  |   st
                           a from the U.S Geological Survey
                           ?ss*i",!	-ffKtfi fi  r* p     si n  ; '(   t   i  i   11
                                      t it _    I'll f L|  '* * 1' U   J J 1   *»^
              Data Source
                                                  i
                                                i  i
              Date for this indicator came from U.S. Geological Survey, as com-
              piled for The Heinz Center (2002). (See Appendix B, page B-15,
              for more information.)                 •

               Testicides in farmland streams and ground water - Category 2
   Nearly one billion pounds of pesticides are used in the U.S. each
   year to control weeds, insects, and other organisms that threaten
   or undermine human activities such as agriculture. The vast
   majority of pesticides—about 80 percent—are used for agricul-
   tural purposes. Although pesticide use has resulted in increased
   crop production and other benefits, it has also raised concerns
   about potential adverse effects on the environment and human
   health. Pesticide contamination of streams, rjvers, lakes, reser-
               voirs, coastal areas, and ground water mjay cause unintended
               adverse effects. These water resources support aquatic life and
               related food chains and are used for recreation, drinking water,
               irrigation, and many other purposes. In addition, water is one of
               the primary pathways by which pesticides are transported from
               their application areas to other parts of the environment.
2-40
2.2 Waters and Watersheds
                         Chapter 2 - Furer Water

-------
               lesticides in farmland streams and ground water - Category 2 (continued)
  From 1992 to 1998, the USGS, under its National Water Quality
  Assessment Program, conducted the largest data collection effort
  ever performed for pesticides (including insecticides and herbi-
  cides) in ground and surface waters. This effort involved analysis
  for 76 pesticides and seven selected pesticide degradation prod-
  ucts in 8,200 samples of ground water/surface water in 20 of the
  nation's major hydrologic basins. Sampling sites included streams
  and ground water in both agricultural areas and urban areas.

  What the Data Show

  In all streams, at least one pesticide was present at detectable
  levels throughout the year. Data were analyzed separately for
  agricultural and urban areas:
  • Agricultural areas. About 75 percent of monitored farmland
     streams had an average of five or more pesticides at detectable
     levels, and over 80 percent had at least one pesticide that
     exceeded aquatic life guidelines. About 60 percent of ground
     water sites in agricultural areas had a  least one detectable
     pesticide, and seven percent had an average of five or more
     compounds at detectable levels. A very small proportion (less
     than one percent) of ground water sites in farmland areas had
     one or more pesticides in concentrations that exceeded human
     health standards or guidelines (The Heinz Center, 2002). A
     relatively small 'number of these chemicals—specifically the
     herbicides atrazine (and its breakdown product desethylatrazine),
     metolachlor, cyanazine, and alachlor—accounted for most
     detections in ground water. The high  detection frequency for
     these pesticides is related to their use. All are among the top
     five herbicides used in agriculture across the nation (Gilliom,
     et al., 2002).
  • Urban areas. Water in  urban areas has a characteristic "signa-
     ture" that is reflective of the chemicals used in the watersheds
     serving those areas. Insecticides  such as diazinon, carbaryl,
     chlorpyrifos, and malathion were detected more frequently, and
     usually at higher concentrations, in urban streams than in agri-
     cultural streams. Herbicides were detected in 99  percent of
     urban stream samples and in more than SO percent of sampled
     weljs. The most common herbicides  in urban streams  and
     ground water were simazine and prometon.

  Frequency of detection,  expressed as a percentage of pesticides in
  water samples, serves as a basic indicator (Exhibit 2-26):
  • Streams. The data suggest that pesticides are fairly ubiquitous
     in both farmland and urban streams and rivers. As noted above,
     at least one pesticide was present at detectable levels through-
     out the year in all monitored streams. Most pesticide detec-
     tions were found in rivers associated with mixed  land uses, fol-
                  lowed by streams associated with urban land use, then streams
                  associated with agricultural land uses.
               • Ground water. Significantly fewer detections of pesticides were
                  found in shallow ground water, and the least detections were
                  found in major aquifers.

               For the 21  most detected pesticides, data suggest that their
               occurrence, in both streams and ground.water, closely mirrors
               their use. Surprisingly, pesticides were detected as frequently, or
               sometimes more frequently, in urban streams than in streams
               associated with agricultural lands. The NAWQA data indicate that,
               in urban and  agricultural streams and shallow ground water, pesti-
               cides most often occur in mixtures (i.e., more than one compound
               is present in the sample). The human health and environmental
               impacts of pesticide contamination, particularly when the pesti-
               cides occur as mixtures, are not well understood.

               Data Gaps and  Limitations

               Knowing how many pesticides are detected and at what concen-
               trations provides basic information on the extent to which these
               compounds are found in streams and ground water. However, the
               presences of pesticides does not necessarily mean that the levels


               I    Exhibit 2-26: jummaiy of detections of one or more
               ilif"-   pesticides in streams and ground water, 1992-1998

               f • All Detections   H Detections >0.01 |ig/L  I: Detections >0.05 ug/L
                   .
               !f;9°
               6% 80
               I   70
                       "- Streams Shallow
                       	,   . CW
                       !.  Agricultural

                      .Coverage: lower 48 states..
Streams  Shallow
         GW
    Urban
Rivers    Major
       Aquifers
Mixed Land Use
                                                                           Source: Modified from The Heinz Center. The State of the Nation's Ecosystems. 2002.
                                                                           Data from the U.S. Geological Survey.
Cnapter 2 - Purer Water
2.2 Waters and Watersheds
                                2-41

-------
                                                                              ,j!,
               Testicides in farmland streams  ana ground water - (_ategi
                            sry 2  (continued)
  are high enough to cause problems. Comparison to standards and
  guidelines provides a useful reference to help judge the signifi-
  cance of contamination.

  Drinking water standards or guidelines do not exist for 43 percent
  (33 of 76) of the pesticides analyzed, and aquatic life guidelines
  do not exist for 63 percent (48 of 76) of the pesticides analyzed.
  Current standards and guidelines do not account for mixtures of
  chemicals and seasonal pulses of high concentrations. In addition,
  potential effects on reproductive, nervous, and immune systems,
  as well as on chemically sensitive individuals, are not yet well
  understood.
               Data Sources                  \
                           I   '        	:,..       ,  i  I
               The data sources for this indicator were The U.S. Geological
               Survey's National Water Quality Assessment Program, as compiled
               for The Heinj: Center (2002), and The EPA's Office of Prevention,
               Pesticides, and Toxic Substances.(See Appendix B, page B-15, for
               more information.)
                Acid sensitivity in lakes and streams - Category 2
                                                                                                                            "	?
   Airborne nitrogen and sulfur gases (i.e., nitrogen oxides and sulfur
   oxides) are referred to as acid precursors because they react with
   water, oxygen, and other compounds to form sulfuric acid and
   nitric acid. For example:
   • They combine with water vapor and oxygen in the atmosphere
     to form acids that fall to earth as a component of snow, fog,
     dry particles, gases, or acid rain.
   • When they reach a waterbody through dry deposition, they
     combine with surface water to form  nitric acid and sulfuric acid.
   • Indirect deposition can occur when these precursors are
     deposited on land and then washed into a waterbody  by storm
     water runoff. The effects of indirect  deposition are particularly
     serious if the storm deposits acid rain.

   Acidification is common in waterbodies in the eastern U.S., where
   weather patterns deposit acids made from air pollutants  generated
   in the Midwest and points further west. Also, many eastern water-
   bodies are naturally acidic,  making them more susceptible to the
   effects of acid deposition because their underlying soils  and rock
   are not able to buffer incoming acids. This is particularly true for
   many lakes in the Adirondack Park, located in upstate New York.

   Acidification affects ecosystems in many ways. For example:
   • Aquatic organisms in acidified waters often suffer from calcium
     deficiencies that can weaken bones and exoskeletons and can
     cause eggs to be weak or brittle.
                • It affects the permeability of fish membranes and, particularly,
                  the ability'of gills to take in oxygen frotjn water.
                • Increasing 'amounts of acid in a waterbody change the mobility
                  of certain trace metals like aluminum, cadmium, manganese,
                  iron, arsenic, and mercury. Species that are sensitive to these
                  metals, particularly fish,  can suffer as a iresult.

                Acid sensitivity in lakes and streams is determined based on a
                suite of chemical measurements, including pH, conductivity, dis-
                solved organ'c carbon (DOC), cations, an|ons, and  acid-neutraliz-
                ing capacity (ANC). Using data for these parameters, it is possible
                to distinguish, on a national scale, natural: sources of acidity such
                as wetlands, from anthropogenic sources such as acid deposition
                and mine drainage (Baker, et al., 1991). For example, in  low pH
                waters:      '
                • High conductivity and high sulfate concentrations indicate acid-
                  mine drainage.
                • High DOC concentrations with low conductivity  indicate acid
                  contributions from wetlands.          |
                • Low conductivity, moderate sulfate concentrations, and low
                  DOC concentrations indicate acid deposition.
                                                     i

                What  the Data Show

                EPA's 1984 to 1986 National Surface Water Survey (NSWS) esti-
                mated that, in acid-sensitive regions of the northern and eastern
2-42
2.2 Waters and Watersheds
Cnapter 2  - Purer Water

-------
               Acid sensitivity in laRes and streams - Category 2 (continued)
  U.S., 4.2 percent of lakes and 2.7 percent of streams were acidic.
  Of those acidic lakes and streams, 75 percent were acidic due
  to acid deposition, 22 percent were acidic due to organic
  sources, and three percent were acidic due to acid-mine drainage
  (Exhibit 2-27).

  These surveys have been repeated periodically for smaller proba-
  bility samples of lakes in the Northeast, the Adirondacks and
  streams in the Appalachians (Stoddard, et al., 1996). More inten-
  sive monitoring also has been conducted on lakes in the
  Northeast, the Appalachians, and the Midwest, and on streams in
  the Appalachian Plateau and Blue Ridge to assess long-term acidi-
  ^      ,    -,^  ^         „	     .__,_   _  ,n_r_r^.  ^
  ~~       •   '              "':','. "'•'--:'    '  ~ ~ •	~   -  , "^
          txnioit 2-27:  jources or acidity in acid-sensitive
                   lakes and streams, 1984-1986
                  Watershed
                 sources 3%
       Coverage: Acid sensitive regions of the United States north and east, inclusive
       of the upper midwest, New England, Adirondack Mountains in New York, the
      ' northern Appalachian Plateau, and the Ridge and Blue Ridge Provinces of
      - Virginia

       Source: Baker et al. Acid Lakes and Streams in the United States: The Role of
       Acidic Deposition. (1991).
               fication trends (Stoddard, etal., 1998). Based on these programs,
               EPA estimated that in three regions, one-quarter to one-third of
               lakes and streams previously affected by acid rain were no longer
               acidic, although they were still highly sensitive to future changes
               in deposition (EPA, ORD, January 2003). EPA has concluded that
               the decrease in acidity is a result of reduced sulfate emissions
               under its acid rain programs. Specifically:
               • Eight percent of lakes in the Adirondacks are currently acidic,
                  down from 13 percent in  the early 1990s.
               • Less than two percent of lakes in the upper Midwest are cur-
                  rently acidic, down from three percent in the early 1980s.
               • Nine percent of.the stream length in the northern  Appalachian
                  plateau region is currently acidic, down from  12 percent in the
                  early 1990s.

               Lakes in New England did not show decreases in acidity, and
               streams in the Ridge and Blue Ridge regions of Virginia were
               unchanged. Even though acid deposition has been decreasing in
               the Ridge and Blue Ridge regions, waterbodies in these areas are
               expected to show a lag time in their recovery due to the nature of
               the soils in those regions. Immediate responses to decreasing
               deposition were neither  seen nor expected in these two regions.

               Indicator  Gaps and  Limitations

               The NSWS has not been repeated nationwide since the mid-
               1980s, so there are no data to assess trends in surface water
               acidification in other sensitive areas of the country.

               Data Source

               The data source for this indicator was EPA's National  Surface
               Water Survey. (See Appendix B, page B-1S, for more information.)
C-napter 2 - Furer Water
2.2 Waters and Watersheds
2-43

-------
               Toxic releases to water of mercury, dioxin, lead, TCDS, a,id TDis - Category 2
  The Toxics Release Inventory (TRI) contains information on toxic
  chemical releases and other waste management activities reported
  annually by certain industries as well as by federal facilities. This
  inventory was established under the Emergency Planning and
  Community Right-to-Know Act of 1986 (EPCRA), which requires
  facilities to use their best readily available data to calculate their
  releases and other waste management estimates. This indicator is
  based on reported TRI releases of mercury, dioxins, PCBs, sum of
  all persistent bioaccumulative toxic chemicals (PBTs), and lead to
  water in calendar year 2000 (EPA, OEI, May 2002).

  PBT chemicals include dioxins, mercury, PCBs, PAHs, and pesti-
  cides (but not lead). PBT pollutants are chemicals that are toxic,
  persist in the environment, and bioaccumulate in food  chains, thus
  posing risks to human health and ecosystems. They transfer easily
  across and among ecological systems.

  Under EPCRA, most dischargers must report releases of toxic
  chemicals. Specifically, a facility must report to TRI if it meets all
  of the following criteria:
  • Conducts manufacturing operations within Standard Industrial
     Classification (SIC) codes 20 through 39 or, beginning in the
     1998 reporting year, is in one of the following industry cate-
     gories: metal  mining, coal mining, electric utilities that combust
     coal and/or oil, chemical wholesale  distributors, petroleum ter-
     minals, bulk storage facilities, Resource Conservation and
     Recovery Act (RCRA) subtitle C hazardous waste treatment
     and disposal facilities, and solvent recovery services. Also, fed-
     eral facilities must report to TRI regardless of their  SIC code
     classification.
  • Has 10 or more full-time employee equivalents.
  • For all but certain PBT chemicals, manufacturers or processes
     more than 25,000 pounds or otherwise uses more than
     10,000 pounds of any listed chemical during the calendar year.
               What the Data Show       .

               During 2000, facilities reporting to the TRI released over 7 billion
               pounds of chemicals (EPA, OEI, May 2002J). Of that total, nearly
               261 million pounds (3.7 percent) were discharged to water,
               including 21318 pounds of PBTs, 29 pouijds of PCBs, 5 pounds
               of dioxin compounds, and 2,302 pounds of mercury compounds.
               (Note that the total for PBTs includes all RBT compounds report-
               ed under TRI. Total releases for specific types of PBT compounds,
               such as PCBs and mercury compounds, ate also aggregated and
               reported separately.)

               Indicator  Gaps and Limitations

               The TRI data have several limitations:
               • The TRI program only accounts for direct releases to water (i.e.,
                 it does not include releases from nonrppint sources). However,
                 it does identify releases of metal and metal compounds from
                 publicly owned treatment works (POT\Vs).
               • It does not include releases below the reporting thresholds.
               • Reporting  is made by the releasing facilities, and no standard
                 estimation procedure is employed (see Chapter 3-Better
                 Protected Land).

               Data Source

               The data souxe for this indicator is EPA's Toxics Release Inventory
               program. (Sec Appendix B, page B-15, formore information.)
2-44
2.2 Waters and Watersheds
Chapter 2 - Purer Water

-------
                jediment contamination of inland waters - Category 2

    Contaminated sediments generally have localized impacts, with the
    severity of impact depending on the degree of chemical contami-
    nation. Contaminated sediments affect benthic organisms, such as
    worms, crustaceans, and insect larvae that inhabit the bottom of
    waterbodies. In some cases, toxic sediments kill these benthic
    organisms, reducing the food available to larger animals such as
    fish. Also, some contaminants in sediments may be taken up by
    benthic organisms and passed onto larger animals that fe'ed on
    these contaminated organisms. In this way, toxins in sediment
    move up the food chain in increasing concentrations. As a result,
    fish and shellfish, waterfowl, and fresh water and marine animals,
    as well as benthic organisms, may be affected by contaminated
    sediments.

   As part of EPA's National Sediment Inventory (described in the
    introduction to Section 2.2.4c), sediment chemical concentra-
   tions were evaluated in over 19,000 samples in the U.S. and cate-
   gorized into  three groups:
   • Tier 1  (associated adverse effects on aquatic life or human
     health are probable).
   • Tier 2  (associated adverse effects on aquatic life or human
     health are possible).
   • Tier 3  (no indication of associated adverse effects on aquatic
     life or human health).

   Tier 1 sampling stations were distinguished from Tier 2 sampling
   stations based  on the magnitude of a contaminant concentration
   in sediment,  or the degree of corroboration among the different
   types of sediment quality measures.

   What the Data  Show

   Of the  sampling stations evaluated, 8,348 stations (43 percent)
   were classified as Tier 1, 5,846  (30.1 percent) were classified as
   Tier 2,  and 5,204 (26.8 percent) were classified as Tier 3. The
   sampling stations were located in 5,695 individual river reaches
   (or waterbody segments) across the conterminous U.S., which
   constitute approximately 8.8 percent of all river reaches in the
   country (based on EPA's River Reach File 1).
   • Approximately 3.6 percent of all river reaches in the contermi-
     nous U.S. had at least one station categorized as Tier 1.
   • Approximately 3 percent of reaches had at least one station
     categorized as Tier 2 (but none as Tier 1).
   • In about 2.3  percent of reaches, all of the sampling stations
     were classified as Tier 3.

   In the National  Sediment Inventory, watersheds (8-digit HUC)
   containing areas of probable concern  (APCs) for sediment con-
                tamination were defined as those that include at least 10 Tier 1
                sampling stations and in which at least 75 percent of all sampling
                stations were classified as either Tier 1  or Tier 2. APC designation
                could result from extensive sampling throughout a watershed, or
                from intensive sampling at a single contaminated location or a few
                contaminated locations.

                Analysis of survey data showed that:
                • Ninety-six eight-digit HUC watersheds were identified as con-
                   taining APCs (Exhibit 2-28).
                • These watersheds represent about 4.2 percent of all eight-digit
                   HUC watersheds in the U.S. (96 of 2,264).
                • In many of these watersheds, contaminated areas may be con-
                   centrated in specific river reaches in the watershed. For example,
                   within the 96 watersheds containing APCs across the country,
                   97 individual river reaches or waterbody segments have 10 or
                   more Tier 1  sampling stations.
                • Twenty-four percent of reaches in watersheds (eight-digit HUC)
                   containing APCs have at least one Tier 1 sampling station and
                   18.3 percent have no Tier 1 sampling station but at least one
                   Tier 2 sampling station.
                                      *
                The evaluation results indicate that sediment contamination asso-
                ciated with  probable or possible adverse effects for both aquatic
                life and human health exists in a number of watersheds across the
                country.

                Indicator Gaps and Limitations

                Two general types of limitations are associated with the National
                Sediment Inventory:
                • Limitations of the compiled data. These limitations include the
                  mixture of data sets derived from different sampling strategies,
                  incomplete sampling coverage of geographic regions and moni-
                  tored chemicals, the age and quality of the data, and the lack  of
                  measurements of important assessment parameters, such as
                  TOC and acid volatile sulfide.
                • Limitations of the evaluation approach. These include uncertain-
                  ties in the interpretive tools used to assess the sediment
                  quality, use of assumed exposure potential in screening-level
                  quantitative risk assessment (e.g., fish consumption rates as a
                  surrogate for human health risk), and the subsequent difficul-
                  ties in interpreting assessment results. Also, because this
                  analysis is based only on readily electronically formatted  data,
                  the survey does  not include a vast amount of information
                  available from sources such as local and state governments and
                  published academic studies.
Chapter 2 - Furer Water
2.2 Waters and Watersheds
                                                                       2-45

-------
              Sediment contamination of inland waters - Category 2  (continued)
              	-ti,—_... «..«_ H.,™™-*—™	.	——i	:	:           . i .,  .  ... L  ....  _.   iffcmft 	nr  ,|iui ,iin,; 1111 ,*„ „ ;   j in          VI
                 Exhibit 2-28: Watersheds in sediment quality inventory (198O-1999) identified as containing areas of

                                                   particular concern (Af Cs)
                                                                                                                       -  'I
               ERA. Oflke of Water. T/u Incidence and Severity of Sediment Contamination in
  Another key limitation is that most of the NSI data were compiled
  from monitoring programs that focus their sampling efforts on
  areas where contamination is known or suspected to occur. While
  this is important for meeting the stated objective of the NSI sur-
  vey, which is to identify contaminated sediments, it means that
  the data cannot be used to accurately characterize the overall
  condition of the nation's sediment, because national sampling
  coverage is incomplete and because uncontaminated areas are
  most likely substantially under-represented. In addition, the data
  analyzed for this indicator were collected over a relatively long
  time period; therefore, they do not definitively assess the current
  condition of sediments, but can serve as a baseline for future
  assessments.
Surface Waters of the United States, National Sediment Qualify

    Data  Source

    The data are described in Appendix A of the draft report The
    Incidence and Severity of Sediment Contamination in Surface Waters
    of the U.S., National Sediment Quality Survey; second edition (EPA-
    822-R-01 -01). A draft is available. The final report is expected to
    be released in 2003. Summary reports oh the data  are not avail-
    able. (See Appendix B, page B-1S, for more information).
2-46
                                                    2.2 Waters and Watersheds
                                       Cpapter 2 - "Purer Water
                                                                                                                                      i	i

-------
               Sediment contamination of coastal waters - Category 2
  Estuaries are important habitats for migratory birds, and many
  species offish and shellfish rely on the sheltered waters of estuaries
  as protected places to spawn. Contamination of sediments in estu-
  aries can pose a threat to individual species and to estuarine
  ecosystems.

  Contaminated sediments may harm benthic organisms that feed
  on these sediments, and they may accumulate up the food chain
  as larger organisms feed on smaller organisms, eventually posing a
  risk'to human health. Additionally, contaminants in sediments may
  be resuspended into the water by dredging and boating activities.

  One of the challenges of assessing sediment contamination is
  distinguishing among naturally occurring contaminants, such as
  certain organics and metals, from those created by human
  activities. PAHs and metals occur naturally in estuarine sediments,
  so a specia[ approach must be used to determine how much of
  their concentrations in sediment are contributed by human
  sources (Windom, et al., 1989). On the other hand, pesticides
  and PCBs are relatively easy to evaluate, as they can  only come
  from human activities.

  Under the EPA's Environmental Monitoring and Assessment
  Program (EMAP), contamination  was measured for sediments from
  estuaries in the Virginian, Carolinian, and Louisianian Provinces of
  the eastern U.S. Chemical concentrations were identified as
  enriched by human sources if they exceeded values expected to
  occur naturally. Sediment chemical concentrations also were com-
  pared to NOAA-derived effects range low (ERL) values and effects .
  range median (ERM) values. These values identify threshold con-
  centrations that, if exceeded, are expected to produce ecological
  or biological effects 10  percent and SO percent of the time,
  respectively. A site was considered contaminated if five or more
  chemical concentrations exceeded the ERL, or if one  or more
  exceeded the ERM.

  What the  Data Show

  Sediment contaminant concentrations indicate that 40 percent,
  45 percent, and 75 percent of U.S. estuarine sediments that were
  sampled are enriched with metals from human sources, PCBs, and
  pesticides, respectively  (Exhibit 2-29).

  One to. two percent of estuarine sediments show concentrations
  of contaminants (PAHs, PCBs, pesticides,  and metals) that are
  above ERM values (Exhibit 2-30). Between 10 and 29 percent of
  sediments have contaminant concentrations between the ERM  val-
  ues and lower-level ERL  values (Exhibit 2-30). Most of the loca-
                         2-29: 'Regional sediment enrichment (1990-1997)
                          • /'     "- due to numan sources
                 Source: EPA, Office of Research and Development and Office of Water. National
                       ondition Report. September 2001.
               tions exceeding the ERM guidelines are in the northeast coastal
               area, while the Gulf of Mexico coast contains many locations
               where concentrations of five or more  contaminants exceed the
               ERL values. The highest contamination is found in the Northeast.
               Estuaries most affected are: Hudson River-New York, New Jersey
               Harbor system; eastern  Long Island Sound; Delaware River;
               Potomac River; and upper Chesapeake Bay.

               Indicator Gaps and Limitations

               Several limitations are associated with this indicator:
               • Assessment of contamination is limited to the three provinces
                 noted above. Probabilistic assessments of coastal watersjaf the
                 Great Lakes, West Coast, and northern New England do not
                 exist, so this indicator does not include data for these regions.
               I The sampling design did not proportionately represent shallow
                 habitats (less than 3  meters), which may represent as much as
                 50 percent of the total estuarine area in the Southeast and
                 Gulf of Mexico.
               • While the data currently are adequate to address regional con-
                 dition, they provide little information on gradients from major
                 sources of contamination (e.g., large  urban areas).
               • Many factors control availability  of contaminants in sediments,
                 including organic content, acid volatile sulfides, pH, particle size
                 and type, and the specific form of chemical (e.g., chromium).
                 Therefore, sediment chemical concentrations,  in and of them-
                 selves, do not directly estimate the biological  availability of
                 those contaminants.
C-napter 2 - Turer Water
2.2 Waters and Watersheds
2-47

-------
               Sediment contamination or coastal waters - Category 2'
                                                                               II-
                                                                 (continuea)
            Exhibit 2-30: Distribution of sediment contaminant concentrations in sampled estuarine sites, 1990 - 1997

              1 % > ERM
                                                                                          i    10%
                                                                                          i between ERL
                                                                                            and ERM
                    Pesticides
                                                           Metals
                                                                                              PAHs/PCBs
                                      Contaminant Concentrations with Adverse Effects on Organisms
                   I Below Levels Associated with Adverse Affects  • Effects Possible But Unlikely  S Effects likely
           t Umted States fust coast (excluding waters north of Cape Cod) and Gulf of Mexico

     Source Ef%, Office of Research and Development and Office of Water. National Coastal Condition Report September 2 301
                                                                                                       1  I
  • The scientific basis for the ERL/ERM criteria may vary among
     estuaries, habitats, and regions depending upon the kinds and
     abundances of indigenous biota.
  H Sediment contamination is not directly related to the biological
     availability of contaminants in sediments. Bioavailability of con-
     taminants in sediments can be directly measured by sediment
     toxicity testing, which forms the basis for the next indicator dis-
     cussed, "sediment toxicity in estuaries."
                                                    Data Source                    ,

                                                    Sediment contamination data are from the EPA's Environmental
                                                    Monitoring and Assessment Program Estuaries dataset.
                                                    (See Appendix B, page B-16, for more information.)
 |1	Pill,
 Indicatot
Sediment toxicity in estuaries - Category 2
  Many factors control the biological availability of contaminants in
  sediments, including acid volatile sulfides, pH, particle size and
  type, organic content, resuspension potential, and specific
  species/form of contaminant (e.g., chromium). Sediment toxicity
  tests are the most direct current measure for determining the
  bioavailability of contaminants in sediments. These tests provide
  information that is independent of chemical characterization and
  ecological surveys (Chapman, et al., 1987). They improve upon
  the direct measure of contaminants in sediments (the basis for
  the previous indicator "sediment contamination of coastal
  waters"), because many contaminants are tightly bound to sedi-
  ment particles or are chemically complex and are not biologically

                                                    available. Thus, the presence of contaminants in sediments does
                                                    not necessarily mean that the sediments are toxic.
                                                    To assess bioavailability of sediment contaminants in estuaries, the
                                                    EPA's EMAP Estuaries Program, in conjunction with the NOAA
                                                    Status and Trends Program, conducted sediment toxicity tests on
                                                    estuarine sediments.
                                                    What the Data Show
                                                                                          i
                                                    The EPA's EMAP Estuaries Program found that about 10 percent
                                                    of the sediments in estuaries in the Virginian, Carolinian,
                                                    Louisianian, West Indian, and Californian provinces were toxic to
2-48
                                    2.2 Waters and Watersheds
Chapter 2 - Purer Water

-------

                 Sediment toxicity in estuaries - Category 2 (continued)
    the marine amphipod, Ampelisca abdita, over a 10-day period
    (EPA, ORD, OW, September 2001). The NOAA Status and Trends
    Program also used a sea urchin fertility test and a microbial test to
    evaluate chronic toxicity in selected estuaries, NOAA found that
    43 to 62 percent of the sediment samples from these selected
    estuaries showed chronic toxicity.

    Indicator Gaps and  Limitations

    Sediment toxicity tests are a useful tool to establish the potential
    availability of contaminants in sediments. That availability can,
    however, be affected by artifacts of laboratory procedures that
                 may make contaminants more or less available. Also, natural sedi-
                 ment features such as particle size and the presence of ammonia
                 and sulfides may cause toxicity that is not related to the presence
                 of contaminants.

                 Data Sources

                 Data for this indicator came from EPA's Environmental Monitoring
                 and Assessment Program, Estuaries Program to Estuaries Dataset,
                 and the National Oceanic and Atmospheric Administration's
                 Status and Trends Program. (See Appendix B, page B-16, for more
                 information.)

 No single program examines the ecological condition of our nation's
 surface waters. However, a number of regional programs do track the
 biotic condition of aquatic organisms and attempt to relate degrada-
 tions in their condition to observed pressures on aquatic systems.
 Biotic condition does not fully represent the breadth of ecological
 parameters that ideally would be needed to answer the question,
 "What are the ecological effects of impaired waters?" However, bio-
 logical condition is widely acknowledged as a valuable indicator that
 contributes to an understanding of overall ecological condition.

 There are several pleasures of biotic condition; three were selected
 for this report:
 • Fish index of biotic integrity (IBI) in streams.
 • Macroinvertebrate IBI for streams.
 • Benthic community index (coastal waters).

 These indicators are discussed in detail in Chapter 5, Ecological
 Condition. As they are relevant to water quality, they are briefly sum-
 marized below to demonstrate their effectiveness for future national
 assessments.

 Fish and Macroinvertebrate Indices of Biotic Integrity

 Consistent sampling methods and index  development procedures were
 used to measure the biotic integrity offish and benthos in streams in
the Mid-Atlantic Highlands (EPA, ORD, Region 3, August 2000). The
                mid-Atlantic streams were assessed using both fish and benthic insect
                indicators. Of the stream miles assessed in the Mid-Atlantic Highlands,
                the fish IBI indicated that 17 percent of the streams were in good con-
                dition and 31 percent were in poor condition. The macroinvertebrate
                condition measures indicated that 17 percent of the Mid-Atlantic
                Highland streams were in good condition, while 26 percent were in
                poor condition. (See Chapter S-Ecological Condition, for definitions
                of these categories.)

                The assessment permits estimates of both the number and propor-
                tion of stream miles in good, fair, or poor condition, but it does not
                provide information about where these categories of streams are
                located. Associations of biological condition with specific stressors
                have not been completed. While the stressors found in the streams
                can be identified, it is not possible to determine  which stressors are
                contributing to the observed biological condition.

                uentnic Community Index (Coastal Waters)

                Samples of bottom sediments were collected and benthic index
                scores were assessed for the northeast, southeast, and Gulf coastal
                areas.  In these three areas, 56 percent of the coastal  waters were  "
                assessed in good condition, 22  percent in fair condition, and
                22 percent in poor condition. The work of associating biological
                condition with specific stressors has been completed for these
                coastal waters, so the stressors  that co-occur with poor benthic
                condition can be evaluated. Of the 22 percent of the coastal
                areas with poor benthic condition, 62  percent also had  sediment
                contamination, 11  percent had low dissolved oxygen concentration,
                seven percent had low light penetration,  and two percent showed
                sediment toxicity (EPA, ORD, OW, September 2001).
Chapter 2  - Purer Water
2.2 Waters and Watersheds
                                                                       2-49

-------
2.3  Drinking Water
Drinking water comes from surface water and ground water. Large-
scale water supply systems tend to rely on surface water resources
(including rivers, lakes, and reservoirs), while smaller water systems
tend to use ground water. Slightly more than half of our nation's
population receives its drinking water from ground water by means of
wells drilled into aquifers (USGS, 1998).

To protect human health, EPA, under the Safe Drinking Water Act
(SDWA), sets health-based standards (called maximum contaminant
levels, or MCLs) for contaminants in drinking water. These standards
specify the maximum allowable level of each regulated contaminant
In drinking water. The standards also prescribe protocols, frequen-
cies, and locations that water suppliers must use to monitor for
about 90 regulated contaminants. The SDWA standards and associ-
ated monitoring and treatment by water suppliers provide a critical
barrier that serves to protect the quality of much of our nation's
drinking water. Some 55,000 community water systems in the U.S.
test and treat water to remove contaminants before distributing it to
customers.

This section addresses three questions relevant to evaluating
progress in drinking water protection:
• What is the quality of drinking water?
• What are sources of drinking water  contamination?
• What human health effects are associated with drinking contami-
   nated water?

An indicator has been developed to help answer the first of these
 questions (Section 2.3.1). The second and third questions are
 addressed in Sections 2.3.2 and 2.3.3, respectively; however, no
 indicators were identified to answer these questions.
    Indicators
    Population served by community water systems that meet all
    health-based standards
  In 2002, state data reported to EPA showed that approximately
  251 million people were served by community water systems that
  had no violations of health-based standards. This number repre-
         sents 94 percent of the total population Served by community
         water systems, up from 79 percent in 1993. Under-reporting
         and late reporting of violations data by, states to EPA affect the
         accuracy of this data.                  :
                      !                       i • i
         The drinking water standards set by EPA under the Safe Drinking
         Water Act apply to public water systems (P^WSs). PWSs are systems
         that serve at least 25 people or 15 service connections for at least
         60 days a year. They may be publicly or privately owned. PWSs
         include:                              !
         • Community water systems (CWSs)— systejns that supply water to
            the same population year- round. Thereiare some 55,000 commu-
            nity water systems in the U.S.         ;
         • Non-transient non-community water systems—systems that regularly
            supply water to at least 25 of the same
   people at least 6 months
            per year, but not year-round (e.g., schools, factories, office build-
            ings, and hospitals that have their own Water systems).
          • Transient non-community water systems—systems that provide water
            in a place where people do not remain for long periods of time
            (e.g., a gas station or campground).   :

          Under the 1996 Amendments to the SDWA, EPA must go through
          several steps to determine, first, whether setting a standard is appro-
          priate for a particular contaminant, and if £o, what the standard
          should be. To make these determinations, JEPA considers many fac-
          tors for each contaminant, including:
          • Its occurrence in the environment.   ;
          • Human exposure and the risks of adverse health effects in the    ,
            general population and sensitive subpopulations.
          • Analytical .methods of detection.      I
          • Available technology.                !
          • How the regulation would impact water systems and public health.

          As of 2003, about 90 contaminants are regulated in drinking water
          under the SDWA.                     ;
  2-50
2.3 Drinking Water
Cpapter 2 - furer Water

-------
 •  -.vp-igesg
 IndicatQC
Topulation served  by community water systems that meet all health-based standards - Category I
   Under SDWA regulations, all-public water systems must monitor
   the quality of their drinking water and report the monitoring
   results to their state. Using these results, states determine
   whether a maximum contaminant level has been violated and must
   report all violations of federal drinking water regulations to EPA
   quarterly. The indicator presents the total population across the
   nation that is served by community water systems that met all
   health-based drinking water standards.

   What the Data Show

   In 2002, community water systems  (CWS) served 268 million
   people—just over 95 percent of the U.S. population as recorded
   in the 2000 census. Analysis of state-reported violations data
   shows that, in 2002, 94 percent of this population was served
   by systems that met all drinking water standards (i.e., did not
   report violations of health-based standards) for the entire year
   (Exhibit  2-31).
                                                  Indicator Gaps and Limitations

                                                  Under-reporting and late reporting of CWS violations data by
                                                  states to EPA affect the ability to accurately report the quality of
                                                  our nation's drinking water. EPA last quantified the quality of viola-
                                                  tions data in 1999. Based on this analysis, the agency estimated
                                                  that states were not reporting 40 percent of all health-based vio-
                                                  lations to EPA. EPA is continuing to verify state-reported CWS
                                                  data and expects to issue an updated estimate of data quality in
                                                  2003.

                                                  Data Source

                                                  The underlying database for this indicator is EPA's Safe Drinking
                                                  Water Information System/Federal version. (See Appendix  B,
                                                  page  B-16 for more information.)
                                      txnibit 2-31: Topulation served by community water
                                              systems (CWSs) with no reported
                                             violations, of heajth-oased standards,
                                                         1993-2002
                                    2002
                                    2001
                                    2000
                                    1999
                                    1998
                                    1997
                                    1996
                                    1995
                                    1994
                                    1993
                                  250,596,287
                                  239,927,650
                                  239,299,701
                                  229,805,285
                                  224,808,251
                                  215,351,842
                                  213,109,672
                                  208,700,100
                                  202,626,433 -
                                  196,229,162
 94
 91
 91
 91
 89
 87
 86
*84
 83
 79
                                {^Coverage: all 50 states
                                jESource: EPA, Office of Water. Safe Drinking Water Information Systems/Federal version
                                f(SBWIS/FED).20te.         "  .    ;,.,.,,
C_-napter 2 - Turer Water
                                      2.3 Drinking Water
                                         2-51

-------
         Ill	!*	I	a	I	Ill	B	£	II	
             ^

Microbiological, chemical, and radiological contaminants can enter
water supplies. These contaminants may be produced by human
activity or occur naturally. For instance, chemicals can migrate from
disposal sites or underground storage systems and contaminate
sources of drinking water. Animal wastes, pesticides, and fertilizers
may be carried to lakes and streams by rainfall runoff or snow melt.
Nitrates from fertilizers can also be carried by runoff and percolate
through soil to contaminate ground water. Arsenic and radon are
examples of naturally occurring contaminants that may be released
into ground water as it travels through rock and soil.

Human wastes from sewage and septic systems or wastes from animal
fecdlots and wildlife carrying microbial pathogens may get into
waters ultimately used for drinking. Coliform bacteria from human
and animal wastes may be found in drinking water if the water is not
properly treated or disinfected. These bacteria are used as indicators
that other harmful microbial pathogens, such as Ciardia,
Cryptosporidium, and E. coli O157:H7, might be in the water.

Disinfection of drinking water is a critical public health measure as it
provides a barrier against harmful microbes.  Under the SDWA, all
surface water supplies, and ground water supplies with close hydro-
logical connections to surface water must disinfect (and most must
also filter) their water to remove pathogens. However, disinfectants
such as chlorine react with naturally occurring organic matter in
source water and in distributions systems to form chemical by-prod-
ucts (known as disinfection by-products) such  as trihalomethanes
and haloacetic acid compounds.

For systems that disinfect, water leaves the plant with a disinfectant
residual. However, in some cases water could become contaminated if
there is a breach in the distribution system.
          • Chemical contaminants. Chemical contarpinants found or expected
             to occur ir drinking water can include metals, pesticides, and sol-
             vents. Most of these would be expected to cause no health effects
             at the levels found in treated drinking water, but they may cause a
             variety of biological responses at high doses. These could include
             cosmetic effects (such as skin discoloration) or unpleasant odors,.
             as well as more severe health effects such as nervous system or
             organ damage, developmental or reproductive effects, or cancer.
             One well-studied consequence of drinking contaminated water is
             the formation of methemoglobin in iiifaVits drinking formula with.
             more than! 10 ppm nitrate. This altered [hemoglobin does not carry
             oxygen efficiently; too much of it in the blood of very young chil:
             dren  can be fatal (i.e., blue baby syndrome).
          • Pathogens. The consequences of consuming water with pathogenic
             microbes can include gastrointestinal illnesses causing stomach
             pain, diarrhea, headache, vomiting, and fever. Waterborne
             pathogens can cause diseases that are jess common in the U.S.,
             such  as typhoid fever and cholera, as w|ell as more common water-
             borne diseases such as giardiasis or cryptosporidiosis. Pathogenic
             microbes can enter water from human and animal wastes. One of •
             the largest outbreaks of disease from contaminated water
             occurred in Milwaukee in 1993, when an estimated 400,000  peo-
             ple became ill from exposure to Cryptosporidium,  a single-celled
             parasite that is found in the large intestines of a large number of
             animals, including cattle and humans! That outbreak killed more
             than  SO people, the vast majority of whom had seriously weak-
             ened immune systems (Hoxie, et al., 1997).

           Drinking water disinfection is one of the great public health success
           stories  of the 20th century. It has been a critical factor in reducing
           the incidence of waterborne diseases such as typhoid, cholera,
           and hepatitis, as well as gastrointestinal illness in the U.S. Though
           drinking water disinfection is a critical public health measure, the
           process does generate disinfection by-products, as mentioned
           earlier. These compounds have been associated with cancer, develop-
           mental, and reproductive risks, the extent of which  is still uncertain
           (see Chapter 4-Human Health).        ,

 Effects of exposure to contaminants in drinking water will vary
 depending on many factors, including the type of contaminant, its
 concentration in drinking water, and how much contaminated water is
 consumed over what period of time.
 2-52
2.3 Drinking Water
lapter 2 - Purer Water

-------
                                           i^^-MliMMiS^^
2.4  Recreation  in  and  on
the  Water
Our nation's rivers, lakes, and oceans are used for recreation in many
different ways, including swimming; fishing, and boating.  .
Environmental programs implemented under the Clean Water Act
(CWA)  have significantly improved the quality of many of our
nation's waters since the early 1970s. These programs help to  main-
tain the quality of waters that have been specifically designated for
recreational uses and ensure that they do not become degraded in
the future. Despite this progress, recreational waters are threatened
or affected bypollution at some times and in  various locations. For
example:
• During and following heavy rainfall, the sewer systems in some
   cities may become overloaded, resulting in the temporary dis-
,   charge of raw sewage, wastewater, and storm water into rivers and
   coastal areas.
• Lakes and ponds may be affected by non-point source pollution,
   for example from septic tanks and agricultural sources, resulting in
   chemical contamination and elevated  levels of nutrients.
• Industries are issued permits under the Clean Water Act that allow
   discharges of certain treated wastewaters to rivers and streams.
   These discharges compromise our ability to also use those waters
   for recreational purposes.

Perhaps the greatest human health concern associated with pollution
of recreational waters is the potential for exposure to human
pathogens. Many Americans risk illness from exposure to contaminated
recreational waters. Epidemiology studies in the U.S. and abroad have
consistently found an association between disease burden and con-
taminated waters. State and local officials monitor water quality at pub-
lic beaches and close the beaches or issue advisories when monitoring
indicates that pathogens in  water may have exceeded thresholds for
public safety. The fact that hundreds of beach advisories and closings
are issued every year at recreational rivers, lakes, and coastal waters
throughout the U.S. suggests that our recreational waters are signifi-
cantly impacted by pollution. Three questions are posed with regard to
recreational waters:
• What is the  condition  of waters supporting recreational use?
• What are sources of recreational water pollution?
• What human health effects are associated with recreation in  con-
  taminated waters?

An indicator has been developed to help answer the first of these
three questions; at least with regard to  pathogens in recreational
waters. The second and third questions are addressed in Sections
                                                                   2.4.2 and 2.4.3, respectively. No indicators were identified to
                                                                   answer these two questions. Note that concerns associated with
                                                                   consumption offish and shellfish, including fish and shellfish caught
                                                                   through recreational activities, are discussed in Section 2.5.

                                                                      Indicators
                                                                      Number of beach days that beaches are closed or under
                                                                      advisory
                                                                  As described in Section 2.2.1, a number of programs collect infor-
                                                                  mation on the condition of waters at a national scale, including the
                                                                  conditions that support recreational uses of waters. However, for a
                                                                  variety of reasons described in Section 2.2.1, none of these pro-
                                                                  grams (including the widespread CWA-mandated 305 [b] state data
                                                                  collection and reporting program) produce data with sufficient confi-
                                                                  dence and scientific credibility to serve as a national indicator for
                                                                  water quality condition. Nevertheless, data from an entirely different
                                                                  source (state and local monitoring of water quality at beaches) can
                                                                  be used to help answer the question "What is the condition of sur-
                                                                  face waters that support recreational use?"—at least with respect to
                                                                  pathogen contamination.

                                                                  When  local and state officials monitor water quality at beaches, they
                                                                  generally test for indicator.organisms, such as coliforms. Not all of
                                                                  these organisms are harmful themselves, but their presence generally
                                                                  suggests that disease-causing microorganisms are also likely to be
                                                                  present When indicator organisms exceed certain thresholds, local
                                                                  or state officials will close the beach to the public. The number of
                                                                  days that beaches are closed or under advisory provides the basis
                                                                  for an  indicator for recreational water quality with respect to
                                                                  pathogen contamination. This indicator reflects decisions made by
                                                                  state and local governments about whether pathogen levels are
                                                                  above  their public health thresholds at beaches under their jurisdic-
                                                                  tion. Beach closure/advisory data predominantly represent coastal
                                                                  and Great Lakes areas. Data on inland waterways generally are not
                                                                  available or are not collected and reported. Thus, the question
                                                                  "What is the condition of surface waters that support recreational
                                                                  use?" can only be addressed for a portion of coastal and Great Lakes
                                                                  beaches on a national level at this time.
CJnapter 2 - Turer Water
                                               2.4 Recreation in and on the Water
2-53

-------
               Number of beach days that beaches are closed or undei
                               advisory - (Category 2
  Data on beach closures are collected by EPA under the Beaches
  Environmental Assessment and Coastal Health (BEACH) Program.
  This program is authorized  by Section 104 of the Clean Water Act
  and described in EPA's Action Plan for Beaches and Recreational
  Waters (EPA, ORD, OW, March 1999).

  The BEACH program collects data for the National Health
  Protection Survey  of Beaches by sending a questionnaire to man-
  agers (usually in health or environmental quality departments in
  states, counties, or cities) who are responsible for monitoring
  swimming beaches on the coasts or estuaries of the Atlantic
  Ocean, Pacific Ocean, and Gulf of Mexico, and the shoreline of
  the Great Lakes. Information on some other inland fresh water
  beaches has also been collected. Responses to these surveys are
  voluntary and have increased substantially from 159 local, state,
  and federal agencies reporting in 1997, to 237 agencies reporting
  on 2,445 beaches in 2001.

  What the Data  Show

  Using the survey data, EPA  compiles the number of days that
  beaches are closed or under advisory and compares that to the
  total number of "beach days"—i.e., days that the beaches would
  normally be open  to the  public. In 2001, survey respondents
  reported a total of approximately 320,000 beach days during the
  swimming season for the 2,445 beaches for which data were col-
                   lected. These beaches were closed or uncjer advisory on almost
                   six percent (over 19,000) of those beacrj days.

                   Indicator Gaps and Limitations
                              I             .          .  ;
                   This indicator has a number of limitations:
                   H Since reporting is voluntary, the data cannot be extrapolated to
                     accurately! determine the suitability on ja national level of sur-
                     face waters to support recreation.     '•
                   H The indicjitor applies primarily at this time to coastal and Great
                     Lakes beaches, as relatively few fresh water inland beaches are
                     surveyed.;                         r
                   H The causes of closures vary greatly ampng states; therefore,
                     linking bench closures to human health problems or stressors is
                     difficult.  '                         '.
                   H Some reports are based upon infrequent monitoring. Infrequent
                     monitoring could miss events that woujd cause closures.
                   • In interpreting the data, the assumptioji is made that the public
                     was at minimal risk of exposure to waterborne illness on days
                     the beach was open. However, this may not always be true.

                   Data  Source

                   Data for this indicator came from EPA's National Health
                   Protection Siurvey of Beaches. (See Appendix B, page B-17 for
                   more information.)                   '

                                 -••..•'
As mentioned earlier, beach advisories and closings in the U. S. are
generally due to elevated levels of indicator organisms, such as
coliforms, some of which do not themselves cause disease but may
indicate the presence of disease-causing microorganisms. In the
survey of beaches (see Section 2.4.1), respondents are asked to
identify, based on best professional judgment, the sources of pollu-
tion (i.e., the indicator organisms and any associated pathogens)
that caused a beach advisory or closing. Exhibit 2-32 presents the
sources reported for the 2001 swimming season.

For just over half the cases, the sources were unknown. Storm water
runoff was the reported cause for one-fifth (20 percent) of the
beach closing or advisories. Rainfall, particularly heavy rain, creates
runoff from farmland, city streets, construction sites, suburban  lawns,
roofs and driveways. This runoff contains harmful contaminants,
                   including human and animal wastes, sediments, and excess nutrients.
                   Runoff can enter waterbodies directly or yia the storm water
                   drainage system. Other reported causes of beach closings and advi-
                   sories were: wildlife (10 percent), sewage line blockages and breaks
                   (four percept), improperly functioning .onsite wastewater facilities
                   (i.e., septic systems—see Chapter 3-Better Protected Land) (three
                   percent), combined sewer overflows (three percent), sanitary  sewer
                   overflows (two percent), boat discharges!(two percent), and publicly
                   owned treatment works (one percent). No indicators have been
                   identified to answer the question "What iare the sources of recre-
                   ational water pollution?" at this time.
                   The primary health concern associated With recreational waters is
                   the risk of infection from waterborne pathogens. People may be at
2-54
2.4 Recreation in and on the Water
(Chapter 2 - Turer Water

-------
       Exnioit 2-32: Reported sources of pollution that
         resulted in oeacn closings or advisories, 2001
    :  Septic system 3% rp°TW1%
         SSO 2% —v \  \ T Sewage line blockage/break 4%
Boat discharge 2% •
    CSO 3%
        Wildlife
         10%
     Stormwater
       runoff
        20%
                                                   Unknown
                                                     52%
it CSO - Combined Sewer Overflow
Is: SSO - Sanitary Sewer Overflow               '.....'   ..".-.'..'."'.  .'. .
p POTW - Publicly Owned Treatment Works
flrSource: EPA, Office of Water. EPA's BEACH Watch Program: 2007 Swimming Season.
EOvfay2002..                        "    	    •    •-------.-
                   risk if they ingest or inhale contaminated water, or simply through
                   general dermal contact with the water. Some people may be more
                   vulnerable than others, either because they are more susceptible to
                   infection or because they have greater exposure to the water. For
                   example, children may be more vulnerable to environmental exposure
                   due to their active behavior and developing immune systems. Elderly
                   and immunosuppressed persons may also be more vulnerable.

                   The health effects of swimming in contaminated waters are usually
                   minor—sore throats, ear infections, and diarrhea. In some instances,
                   however, effects can be more serious and even fatal. Waterborne
                   microbes can cause meningitis, encephalitis, and severe gastroenteri-
                   tis (EPA, ORD, OW, March 1999). However, data on the effects and
                   number of occurrences are limited. The number of occurrences are
                   likely under-reported because individuals may not link common
                   symptoms (e.g., gastrointestinal ailments, sore throats) to exposure
                   to contaminated recreational waters. At this time, .no indicators have
                   been  identified to quantify the health effects associated with recre-
                   ation in contaminated waters. Additional research is needed to better
                   understand the types and extent of health effects associated with
                   swimming in contaminated water.
CJiapter 2 - turer Water
2.4 Recreation in and on the Water
                                                                                                                        2-55

-------
2.5  (Consumption  of  Fish
and  jnellrisn
Many coastal and fresh water environments are contaminated with
a variety of toxic substances. Of particular concern are mercury,
DDT, and PCBs because they persist in the environment and
bioaccumulate in the food chain. Though PCBs and DDT are no
longer manufactured or distributed in the U.S., they persist in his-
torical deposits in watersheds and near-shore sediments. These
deposits continue to provide an active source for contaminating
fish and shellfish. Mercury can come from several sources, including
industrial releases, abandoned mines, the burning of fossil fuels for
electric  power generation, and natural sources such as weathering
of rock and volcanoes.

Persistent chemicals enter the food chain when they are ingested
by bottom-dwelling (benthic) organisms. Benthic organisms are
eaten by smaller  fish, which in turn are eaten by larger fish, which
may be consumed by humans or wildlife. Levels of PCBs and  DDTs
are a concern fn bottom-feeding fish and  shellfish, as well as  in
higher-level predators.  Mercury is concentrated particularly in
larger and longer-lived  predators, such as large-mouth bass, tunas,
swordfish, and some sharks. Concentrations of all these com-
pounds, especially in larger fish, can reach levels that are harmful
to humans. To protect  human health, state and local officials
monitor levels of these compounds in fish and shellfish, and issue
advisories when tissue  concentrations exceed threshold levels.
Typically, a fish or shellfish advisory will suggest that intake of a
particular species be limited, especially for those at higher risk of
health effects such as children,  pregnant women, and nursing
mothers.

Three questions have been posed concerning consumption offish
and shellfish:
• What is the condition of waters that support consumption offish
  and shellfish?
• What are contaminants in fish and shellfish, and where do they
  originate?
• What human health effects are associated with consuming con-
  taminated fish and shellfish?

Sections 2.5.1, 2.5.2, and 2.5.3, respectively, discuss these ques-
tions and, where available, the indicators that are used to help
answer these questions.
                       Indicators
                       Percentage of river miles and lake acres with fish consumption
                       advisories;,"                  ,      -,••••
                       Contaminants in fresh water fish
                               ^ -         -,  	   ,-;,-•
                       Number fif watersheds exceeding health-based national water
                               ijrjtKi'1,,'	"". „',,»', ; „	  i  ,    	
                       quality cttena.. for mercgry and PCB? in fish tissue
                    Three indicators, presented on the following pages, are available to
                    help answer this question:              j
                    • Percentage of river miles and lake acres with fish consumption
                      advisories.                         :
                    • Contaminants'in fresh water fish.
                    • Number of watersheds exceeding  health-based national water
                      quality criteria for mercury and PCBs iri fish tissue.

                    The first indicator describes the extent of fish advisories, such as
                    closed fisheries and/or restricted fish consumption. Fish advisories
                    are issued by state or local authorities when levels of contaminants
                              J                       •  i
                    in monitored fish exceed threshold levels. These advisories, which are
                    widespread across the U.S., limit or restrict consumption of contami-
                    nated species. Mercury, dioxin, PCBs, D,DT,  and chlordane are
                    responsible for many of these advisories (EPA, OW, May 2002a).
                    Increases in the number of advisories over the years may reflect
                    increased monitoring, increased contamination, and in some cases,
                    more stringent health standards.        :
                                                                        5

                    The second indicator examines the number of contaminants in fish
                    tissue from samples across the nation. This indicator shows that
                    more than 90 percent of sampled fish had at least one contaminant
                    and more than half had at least five.     j

                    The third indicator compares average fisrrtissue concentrations of
                    mercury and PCBs across watersheds to rjuman-health based water
                    quality criteria. This analysis showed that more than 30 percent of
                    the watersheds for which there are data exceed mercury criteria.
                    These watersheds are predominantly located  in eastern coastal
                    states, New England, and the lower portidn of the Mississippi River
                    watershed.  !                         ;
                                                        i
                    For all three indicators, data are based on; fish tissue data collected
                    by state or local government agencies, which  tend to focus primarily
                    on areas where these agencies believe there may be contaminated
                    fish. This bias may result in inaccurate estimates of the extent of
                    contamination.
2-56
2.5 Consumption of Fish and Shellfish
Gliapter 2 - Purer Water

-------
 C-oastal risk

 For coastal fish, insufficient data on the edible portion of these fish
 are available to provide a national indicator. However, examination of
 fish tissue collected in coastal waters of the eastern U.S. and Gulf of
 Mexico shows that compounds of concern were present at levels
 above EPA's threshold for issuing an advisory.
 No national indicators are available for shellfish. However, as discussed
 below, data are available on the extent of shellfish waters that were
 classified as harvest-limited or harvest-prohibited from 1966 to 1995.
 These data show a steady decrease over this time period in the extent
 of waters classified as harvest-limited or harvest-prohibited. Still, as
 of 1995, harvesting was limited in 31  percent of shellfish waters and
 prohibited in 13 percent (NOAA, 1997). The predominant causes of
 closures are both human and non-human coliform bacteria.

 Data on shellfish waters come from the National Oceanic and
 Atmospheric Administration (NOAA), which records areas that are
 closed to shellfishing or are subjected to restricted or conditional
 harvesting. NOAA obtains its data from coastal states, which identify,
 survey, and classify shellfish-growing waters according to National
 Sanitary Survey Program (NSSP) guidelines (FDA, 1993).
 Classification status  is based on sanitary surveys of water quality and
 shoreline surveys of pollution sources. Individual shellfish-growing
 areas are classified either as approved for harvest or as  one of four
 harvest-limited categories: conditionally approved, restricted, condi-
 tionally restricted, and prohibited.
                      All identified shellfish-growing waters must be classified as prohibited
                      unless sanitary surveys indicate that water quality meets specific  :
                      NSSP standards for the other categories. Harvesting is permissible in
                      approved areas year-round. The conditionally approved and condi-
                      tionally restricted categories are for voluntary use by states when a
                      predictable pollution event such as seasonal population, heavy rain-
                      fall, or fluctuating discharges from local sewage plants affects the
                      suitability of an area for harvest. Most shellfish harvest restrictions
                      are made based on the concentration of fecal coliform bacteria in
                      shellfish. This organism is not directly harmful to  humans, but typi-
                      cally is associated with human sewage and with organic wastes from
                      livestock and wildlife.

                      The National Shellfish Register provides a record of the acreage of all
                      classified shellfish-growing waters in the conterminous U.S. The
                      Register was first published in 1966 to meet the need for summary '
                      information on the status and extent of the nation's commercial
                      shellfish-growing areas. Since the publication of the first Register, the
                      acreage of classified shellfish-growing waters has increased more
                      than two-fold from 10 million  acres to more than  21 million acres
                      (Houserand Silva, 1966; FDA, 1971; EPA, OE, 1975; DOC and HHS,
                      1985; NOAA, 1991; NOAA,1997), primarily due to an expanding
                      consumer demand for shellfish.

                      Since 1966, the percentage of all classified waters approved for har-
                      vest has decreased 10 percent. However, data compiled for the  7995
                      Register, the last available compilation, suggest significant improve-
                      ments.  For example, the overall percent of harvest-limited waters
                      decreased from a high of 42 percent in 1985 to 31 percent in  1995.
                      The percent  of prohibited waters also decreased from  a high of 26
                      percent jn 1974 to 13 percent in 1995—the lowest percentage
                      recorded.
CJiapter 2 - Purer Water
2.5 Consumption of Fish and Shellfish
2-57

-------

              Percent of river miles and lake acres under fish consumption advisories - Category 2
 State and local governments protect people from possible risks of
 eating contaminated fish by monitoring local waters and issuing
 fish advisories when contaminant levels are unsafe. A consumption
 advisory may recommend that people limit or avoid eating certain
 species offish caught from certain lakes, rivers, or coastal waters.
 Advisories are often very specific. They may apply to specific
 water types (such as lakes), or they might include recommenda-
 tions for specific groups (such as pregnant women or children).
 Advisories apply to locally caught fish or wildlife as well as fish
 purchased in  stores and restaurants. EPA has compiled these advi-
 sory data into the National Listing of Fish  and Wildlife Advisories
 (NLFWA) database, which lists, among other things, the species
 and size offish or wildlife under advisory, the chemical contami-
 nants covered by the advisory, the location and surface area of
 the waterbody under advisory, and the population subject to the
 advisory.

 What the Data Show

 Exhibit 2-33  shows the percent of the nation's river miles and lake
 acres under advisory for the years 1993 to 2001. Note that the
 Great Lakes and their connecting waters are considered separately
 from other waters and are not included in the calculations of total
 lake acres or river miles. Except for 1998,  the percentage
 increased continuously during this 8-year period. Approximately
 79,119  lakes (11,277,276 lake acres) and 485,205 river miles were
 under advisory in 2001, compared to 14,962 lakes and 74,505
 river miles under advisory in 1993. Note that the increase in the
 total size of waters under advisory is due in part to increased
 monitoring for chemical contaminants in fish and wildlife tissue
         Exnioit 2-33: Trends in percentage or river miles and
             lake acres under fish consumption advisory,
                             1993-2001
           1993 1994  199S  1996  1997  1998   1999  2000  2001

          Coverage: ad SO jUtes
          Source: EPA, Office of Water. Update: National Listing of Tab and Wildlife
          Mtisoria, May 2002.
                   and the states' increasing use of statewide advisories. Currently,
                   the 2,618 advisories in the national listing represent almost
                   28 percent of the nation's total lake acreage and 14 percent of
                   the nation's total river miles.            .:

                   In addition to the NLFWA data, much information is available on
                   the advisory status of our nation's waters. EPA and  FDA issued a
                   national mercury advisory in  January 200|l recommending that
                   women of childbearing age and young children limit their con-
                   sumption offish ().
                               :•                          f
                   Many great waters of the U.S. are currently under fish advisories
                   for a variety of pollutants. The great waters include the Great
                   Lakes, Lake Champlain, the Chesapeake Bay, 20 National Estuary
                   Program (NEP) sites, and 14 National Estuarine Research Reserve
                   System (NERRS) sites.              ,   •
                   M All of the Great Lakes and their connecting waters are under
                      advisory.                           ;
                   n Lake Charnplain is under advisory for PCBs and mercury.
                   H Although the Chesapeake Bay is not under any advisories, the
                      Potomac, )ames, Back, and Anacostia Rivers, which connect to
                      it, are all under PCB advisories.       ;
                   SI Baltimore Harbor, which also connects; to the Chesapeake Bay,
                      is under advisory for chlordane and PCB contamination in fish
                      and blue crabs.
                   II Many of the major estuaries listed in the NEP and/or designated
                      as NERRS sites are under fish and/or shellfish advisories for multi-
                      ple chemical contaminants. Sixty-five percent of the total number
                      of NEP, NERRS, and combined sites are under fish consumption
                      advisories. Seventeen sites have no current fish consumption
                      advisories.

                    Several states have issued fish advisories for all of their coastal
                    waters. An estimated 71 percent of the coastline of the
                    conterminous 48 states currently is under advisory. This includes
                    92 percent of the Atlantic coast and 1o6 percent of the gulf
                    coast. The Atlantic coastal advisories have been issued for a wide
                    variety of chemical contaminants, including  mercury, PCBs, dioxins,
                    and cadmium. All of the gulf coast advisories have  been issued for
                    mercury, although other contaminants may  also be present. No
                    Pacific coast state has issued a statewide advisory for any of its
                    coastal waters, although several local areas along the Pacific coast
                    are under advisory.                    :

                    Indicator Gaps and Limitations

                    Currently, fish consumption advisories are being used as a way of
                    informing the public of risks associated with eating contaminated
2-58
2.5 Consumption of Fish and S.hellfish
Chapter 2 - Purer Water

-------

                tercent of river miles and  lake acres under fisK consumption advisories - Category 2 (continued)
   fish in certain waterbodies. Advisories are based on fish tissue
   monitoring data collected by states and are largely focused on
   areas where states know fishing occurs or suspect contamination.
   Criteria used to issue advisories vary among states, with some
   having more stringent criteria and more robust advisory programs
   than others.

   Due to the large range in geographic size of lake acres and river
   miles affected by chemical contaminants that  may be contained
   under a single advisory, the number of advisories is not as accu-
   rate a measure of the contamination as geographic extent. As a
   result, information is now provided on total lake acres and river
   miles where advisories are currently in effect. A large-scale fish
   tissue study is underway and will help identify waters that
                     require further monitoring to determine whether advisories are
                     necessary.

                     This indicator is based on fish tissue monitoring data collected
                     by the states. It does not provide unbiased geographical cover-
                     age, and it is largely focused on areas where states know fishing
                     occurs or suspect contamination problems. At present, 43
                     states issued risk-based advisories.

                     Data  Source

                     Fish advisory indicator data are from the National Listing of Fish
                     and Wildlife Advisories program. (See Appendix B, page B-17, for
                     more information.)
                Contaminants in fresn water fish- Category 2
  From 1992 to 1998, fish samples were collected from 223 stream
  sites in the U.S. Geological Survey's (USGS) National Water
  Quality Assessment (NAWQA) program. Tissue composites from
  whole fish were analyzed for PCBs, organochlorine pesticides, and
  trace elements. These contaminants may harm organisms directly
  or by affecting their reproduction, and they may make fish unsuit-
  able for consumption by humans. These data were compiled for
  the entire U.S.

  What  the Data Show

  More than 90 percent of sampled fish had at least one contami-
  nant detected and about half of the fish tested had at least five
  contaminants at detectable levels (Exhibit 2-34) (The Heinz
  Center, 2002). All fish tested from the Great Lakes had five or
  more detected contaminants.

  Indicator Caps and Limitations

  The sites sampled are representative of a wide range of stream
  sizes, typesrand land uses broadly distributed across the U.S., but
  they do not represent a probability sample, so confidence bounds
  on the estimates could not be calculated (Gilliom, et al., 2002;
  The Heinz Center, 2002).
                    Fish .tissue concentration data are derived from composites of
                    whole fish and not from edible portions alone. Thus it is not pos-
                    sible to compare tissue concentrations to aquatic or human health

                    ig=« exhibit 2-34: Occurrence or contaminants in stream
                    -^-:•_:'--"  :          fish, 1992,1998
                    flCpyerage: lower 48 states.
                    |p Nate: Partial indicator data: freshwater stream fish only,
                    tSburce: The Heinz Center, Tte State of the Nation's Ecosystems. 2002. Data from the
                    ^r U.S. Geological Survey.
Chapter 2 - Purer Water
2.5 Consumption of Fish and Shellfish
2-59

-------


               Contaminants in fresk water fisn -  Category 2  (continued)
                                                                                               13!WRW:53fB!f:W^
                                                                    	u
 guidelines. These data do, however, indicate organism exposure to      Data  Source
 measured chemicals.
                                                                      Data for this indicator came from the U.S. Geological Survey's
                                                                      National Water Quality Assessment Program as compiled for The
                                                                      Heinz Center (2002). (See Appendix B, page B-17, for more
                                                                      information.)                            •
Number of watersheds exceeding health-based national
in fish tissue  - Category 2
                                                                                   water quality criteria for mercury and
  For this indicator, fish tissue concentrations of each chemical in
  the NLFWA database were averaged across 8-digit hydrologic unit
  code (HUC) watersheds. The average concentration was then
  compared to fish- tissue based criteria for mercury and PCBs. The
  average fish tissue concentration is for all monitored species, fillet
  samples only (whole fish samples were omitted from the analysis
  as these are not recommended for use in assessing human health
    i: Watersheds with fisn tissue concentrations exceeding health-based national water c
                        criteria for mercury, 2001
                                                                                   dality
        I Cortta-m Other Sources
        I NoCtcnfnoxcdMDju
                                                Coverage does not include Alaska, Hawaii, or Puerto Rico
    Stale* cumn% u$e wtter column concentration-based mercury water
    quatcty itandwdj and wouid need to adopt, Rsh tissue-based tanjet
    te«h XI orftr to tnc Ml apprca* for nanny Total Majiimim Da«y
    Id**, A*S6wat ndtKttaw "">* be moored to meet EPA rational
    aifld jwert vtate Ith adittwy te«,«h, *hich are often set below the
                            Note: Watersheds highlighted yellow have "significant" mercury sources ot^j
                            deRned as where the total estimated load frojn Publicly Owned Treatment^!
impact). Thus, the average is meant to represent the potential
exposure concentration for persons consuming fish from typically
frequented local lakes, streams, and rivers.

The mercury criterion used in this comparison was the national
fish-tissue-based criterion. The PCBs criterion was based on the
fish tissue levels used to derive the curreht national health-based
                           water concentration criteria. Criteria
                        ~1 exceedancesi can be interpreted as
                         | meaning that the watershed, on aver-
                         1 age, is not meeting maximum tissue
                           contaminant levels designed to be
                           protective of human health.

                           What the Data Show

                           The data for mercury are a fairly
                           good representation of conditions in
                           the eastern U.S. and California. Of
                           the 696 8-digit HUC watersheds with
                           available data, 225 exceeded the mer-
                           cury criterion (Exhibit 2-35). These
                           are predominantly located in eastern
                           coastal states, New England, and the
                           lower portion of the Mississippi River
                           watershed. Data for PCB concentra-
                           tions are less available;  114 of 153
                           watersheds where data were available
                           contained tjssue above the criterion
                            level (Exhibiit 2-36).
r, than deposition
 s (POTW/s) and pulp
                            and paper mills is greater than 5% of estimated wateitody delivered merdjry^at a typical air
                            deposition load (10 gAm2/yr) and/or wrier* mercury ceH chlor Jluli faciln res mercury raineS
                            significant past producer gold mines are present
  !  SMK« CM, Ofltee of Wrtec Htbatml t&tiy of Tab 
-------
                                                                                       ass
                  Number of watersheds exceeding health-based national water quality criteria for mercury and fCBs
                  in fish tissue - Category 2 (continued)
    Indicator Gaps and Limitations

    Several limitations should be noted for this indicator:
    • The data were compiled based on voluntary contributions
      from individual states and have not undergone an independ-
      ent quality assurance/quality control (QA/QC) review. Data
      quality is a function of the distinct programs for which the
      data were collected.
    • Sampling by state agencies was not generally done on a
      statistical basis, but rather was targeted toward specific water-
      bodies and fish species. Some selection of sampling locations
      was based on fishing pressure and/or suspected elevated con-
      taminant levels. For example, there appears to be a bias in the
      mercury data towards top predator or sport fish (of the top 10
      most frequent species sampled, 83 percent are trophic level 4
      species). This bias could potentially skew the average watershed
      concentration level to higher than actual exposure depending  on
      real consumption patterns.
    • Some states  may not have reported tissue data when resultant
      concentrations were found to be below state fish advisory levels.
    • Substantially more data are available for the years 1990 to
      1995. than for more recent years.
    • Spatial gaps  in the data are readily apparent  from the indicator
      maps. Since a large fraction (roughly two-thirds) of the data-
      base was not georeferenced (i.e., no latitude/longitude coordi-
      nates were created), those data
      could not included in the indica-
      tor. Bias  imposed by these miss-
      ing data  was  not examined.
      Latitude/longitude coordinates
      will be assigned in a  database
      update in the near future and
      can be incorporated in future
      indicators.
   • The human health-based criteria
     of 0.3  ppm methylmercury that
     was used for  comparison is
     considerably  higher than  the
     more recent federal advisory of
     0.18 ppm for consumption of
     mercury-contaminated fish. State
     consumption  advisories are
     typically at levels closer to the
     0.18 ppm than to the 0.3 ppm
     level.
   • Sampling patterns of state agen-
     cies are largely being directed
     toward areas of higher fishing
     pressure or based on suspected
                                   elevated contaminant levels. Thus this indicator, which is based
                                   on generalizing from specific sampling locations to watershed
                                   averages, is expected to represent a somewhat conservative
                                   estimate of the average concentration in consumed fish in each
                                   respective area.

                                 Data Sources

                                 The fish tissue indicator data are from the National Listing of Fish
                                 and Wildlife Advisories program. (See Appendix B, page B-18, for
                                 more information.)
          Exhibit 2-36: Watersheds witji fish tissue concentrations exceeding health-based national water quality
                             criteria for polycWorinated biphenyls (f Cfis), 2OOI
     I   | All Results are Non-Detect
     Half for Less Than Detection
8         Currently Meets EPA Criterion
         >1000% Above Criterion
         100% to 1000% Above Criterion
         <100% Above Criterion
         No Georeferenced Rsh Tissue Data
                                            Coverage does not include Alaska, Hawaii, or Puerto Rico.
inr Note: Graphic was created for this report in ArcView using NLFVVA data.
ip—SSurce: EPA, Office of Water. National la&y offish ™K WiUifeAMsorlei (NLFWA>. June 2001.
C-napter 2 -  Hirer Water
          2.5 Consumption of Fish and Shellfish
2-61

-------
       *,,ii!ji! "7\"»n"»i" jiff j '••••• j'li^^           1 'BIB
        ^
                                                                                                                                     i*  a
                                                                                                                                      	djj
 ^S&^Jnll;	1EM^^
          .      •   .   ri!.'-i-  ,-'•'•••'''• :"•;•'•••'-••; :1:'  :•:«•.•;:•.^;
 	istiiSa	tilSi^^
 	:W:^
 ilini T* fi ijaiil / '" 4ri f*"l 'Cni n 3 T & *  il|!t ;'":l'ii!!:ip|:i«:'ii!S!!'•• '''^"'i sis™: *. :!!Si!i;.i!i:i:::::i:". ^i1 :;::! i1 fes*1 ' 't::^:.;'::1!:^!^1!!;!':::!^^:.
 iiiiiJ»	iiii|H^
Information is available to help answer this question in a general
sense. Rsh and shellfish can be contaminated by both chemical pol-
lutants and pathogens. Chemical contaminants of greatest concern
tend to be those that are toxic and persistent and that bioaccumu-
late. Contaminants with these properties that are common in fresh
and coastal waters include:
• DDT mid PCBs.The manufacture and use of these compounds
  have been banned in the U.S. However, deposits from past pollu-
  tion persist in sediments and land-based sources, and these
  deposits continue to pollute watersheds. In addition, PCBs can  be
  found in some products manufactured prior to the ban (e.g., elec-
  trical transformers).
• Mercury This metal, a natural and highly toxic element, can now be
  detected (although in small amounts) in all waters. Sources of
  mercury include wastes from past mining practices and the burning
  of fossil fuels and wastes, which can create mercury emissions that
  settle on land and water. In water, bacteria convert mercury to
  methylmereury, a toxic compound that is absorbed by fish and
  accumulates in their tissue.

 Biological threats to shellfish consumption include bacterial con-
 tamination from human and animal wastes and contamination from
 naturally  occurring toxins that shellfish accumulate from consuming
 certain algae.

 Some data are availabte on the sources of bacterial contamination.
 When state managers close or otherwise restrict a shellfish-growing
 area due  to high levels of fecal coliform bacteria, they typically  cite
 potential sources of that contamination. This information was col-
 lected for the 1990 and 1995 Shellfish Registers (NOAA, 1991;
 NOAA, 1997). In 1995, sources of shellfish contamination cited by
 reporting officials were (in decreasing order of frequency):
 • Urban runoff (40 percent)
 • Unidentified sources upstream of coastal watersheds (39 percent)
 • Wildlife (38 percent)
 • Individual wastewater treatment systems  (e.g., septic tanks) (32
   percent)
 • Wastewater treatment plants (24 percent)
 • Agricultural runoff (17 percent)
 • Marinas (17 percent)
 • Boating (13 percent)
 • Industrial facilities (9 percent)
 • Combined sewer overflows (7 percent)
 • Direct discharges (4 percent)
 • Feedlots (3 percent)
                   The 1990 Register reflects the same top five sources of pollution,
                   although in slightly different order.

                   Marine biotoxins associated with "red tideb" and other naturally
                   occurring contaminants such as Vibrio spejdes (a free-living marine
                   and estuarine bacteria associated with stomach and intestinal disor-
                   ders of varying intensity) can also cause temporary closures,
                   although the;/ are not usually regarded as:a pollution source (Rippey,
                   1994; FDA, 1993).                     !
                               i                        :  |
                   At this time, insufficient data are available to develop national-level
                   indicators about the type and origin offish and shellfish contaminants.
                    The health effects of consuming contaminated fish and shellfish
                    depend on many factors, including the type of contaminant, its con-
                    centration in the organism, and how much contaminated fish or shell-
                    fish is consumed. Health effects include the following:
                   ' • Risk assessments show that exposure to sufficient levels of some
                      contaminants in fish tissues may increase the risk of cancer
                    • Mercury, in sufficient quantities, is toxif—especially to the
                      nervous system.                     ;
                    • Shellfish contaminated with fecal wastes can cause gastrointestinal
                      illness and even death in individuals with compromised immune
                      systems. Mollusks, mussels and whelks [are the  main shellfish that
                      carry biotoxins causing common symptoms, such as irritation of
                      the eyes, nose, throat, and tingling of the lips and tongue.

                    Advisories warn the public of these risks and suggest limits or out-
                    right bans on consuming some species in certain problem areas.
                    Certain groups may be at higher risk for health effects from contami-
                    nated fish and shellfish. These include children, pregnant women, and
                    nursing mothers, who may be more vulnerable to effects, and tribal,
                    ethnic, and other populations that fish for subsistence and therefore
                    consume more fish or shellfish.

                    At this time,; insufficient data are availably to develop indicators that
                    can monitor! at the national level, the health effects of consuming
                    contaminated fish and shellfish. Chapter 4, Human Health, provides
                    more information on the human health impacts of contaminated fish.
  2-62
2.5 Consumption of Fish and S>hellfish
Chapter 2 - Purer Water

-------
  2.6   Challenges  and  Data
  G
aps
 Tremendous amounts of data are being collected on water resources.
 These data provide evidence of water quality condition at the
 national, regional, and state scales. Some of these data are
 sufficiently comprehensive in scope to serve as the basis for
 indicators of water quality at the national level. These indicators
 provide a starting point for describing our nation's water quality.
 However, as discussed  below, they also have limitations.that make it
 difficult to make confident statements about the condition of water
 resources at the national scale or to thoroughly describe the
 stressors that degrade that condition.

 2.6.1 Waters and Watersheds    '

 Several indicators are available that provide information about the
 quality of our nation's waters and watersheds. For wetlands, for exam-
 ple, the relevant indicator shows that the rate of wetland loss has
 dropped dramatically in recent years. However, as discussed in
 Section 2.2.2, there currently are no indicators of wetland biological
 condition and none are being implemented at the national or regional
 scale. Without these indicators and an assessment process, ensuring
 that the net gain goal is sustaining not only wetland extent, but also
 wetland condition, will not be possible.

 Drawing accurate conclusions about the condition of surface waters
 can be equally as challenging as for wetlands, but the indicators in
 this area do provide evidence of some success in reducing important
 stressors. In addition, data suggest that atmospheric deposition of
 sulfates has been reduced (EPA,  ORD, January 2003), which will help
 improve the quality of acidic surface waters. Ongoing efforts by EPA
 (for example, through the National Pollutant Discharge Elimination
 System permit program), the U.S. Department of Agriculture, and
 individual states to reduce the amount of pollutants discharged to
 our nation's waters from both point and  non- point sources will also
 help to improve water quality.

 However, many challenges remain in monitoring water quality and
 taking steps to improve water quality. This is, in part, because signifi-
 cant environmental problems persist, despite environmental manage-
 ment activities to address these problems. Persistent hypoxia in the
 Gulf of Mexico and fish  contaminated by toxic organics and mercury
 are examples.

To better address water quality problems in the  future, more and
better quality data  on the condition of waters and watersheds will
be needed. This will require a greater collaboration among the
federal agencies that participate in monitoring and managing our
nation's waters so that results and metadata can be provided in a
  common format. Data in a common format will be much more useful
  for developing or improving indicators and can also more easily be
  made available to the public. In addition, the relevant federal agen-
  cies should work with the states to design and implement cost-effi-
  cient water quality monitoring programs whose data will be useful
  not only to the state water quality programs, but also to national
  water quality characterizations. State resources often are limited for
  such key activities as characterizing waters, identifying sources of
  watershed stress,  and monitoring the effects of implementing pollu-
  tion controls. Therefore, it is critical to encourage the development,
  dissemination, and use of cost-effective monitoring and assessment
  tools, such as biological methods for water quality assessment and
  a new framework for design and data collection in water quality
  monitoring programs.

 2.6.2 Drinking Water

 The indicator for the quality of treated drinking water in the U.S.
 shows that quality of drinking water has improved from the early
  1990s through 2002. This indicator is based on  health standards
 violations by community water systems that are reported by states
 to EPA's Safe Drinking Water Information System  (SDWIS). The
 systems that are monitored  under SDWIS serve water to  about
 95 percent of the U.S. population. Compliance trencjs may change
 in the future as new regulations create new compliance challenges
 for public water systems.

 The primary limitation of this indicator is under-reporting and late
 reporting of community water systems violations  by states to EPA.
 This affects the accuracy of annual reports produced using SDWIS
 and thus the quality of the indicator. EPA last quantified data
 quality in 1999 and estimated  that states were not reporting
 40 percent of all health-based violations. EPA and states are taking
 steps to address identified deficiencies and to improve data quality.
 A survey of reporting completeness is underway. Another limitation
 of the indicator is that it does  not cover the quality of water from
 private wells.

 It is important to understand the condition of the  raw waters
 (both ground water and surface waters) that serve as drinking
 water sources. For example:
 • States are currently conducting assessments to delineate the extent
  of source waters and identify potential contaminant sources.
 • Data provided by the U.S.  Geological Survey under its National
  Water Quality Assessment  program and occurrence data for unreg-
  ulated contaminants collected by EPA under the Safe Drinking
  Water Act (SDWA) also provide information about raw water stres-
  sors, and are used by EPA to determine whether additional con-
  taminants should be regulated under the SDWA.
• It is important that EPA assure that the frequency of sampling is
  adequate to characterize episodic events affecting source water
  quality.
Chapter 2 - Purer Water
                                          2.6 Challenges and Data Gaps
                                                                                                                          2-63

-------
The incidence of waterborne disease is another parameter that
could be used to describe and track water quality at the national
level. Additional efforts to obtain data could help provide a basis
in the future for a  national-level indicator in this area. This would,
however, require significant new work, as the existing data likely
reflect an unknown but probably very large degree of under-
reporting. For example, there currently are no consistent national
surveillance and reporting requirements for doctors or states with
respect to incidence of diarrhea, except as associated with
Hepatitis A, cholera, salmonellosis, or shigellosis. Doctors rarely
order the tests that would identify these diseases, or tests that
would identify other, more common diseases that can be caused by
contaminants in drinking water.

2.6.3  Recreation in and on the Water •

The quality of recreational waters is compromised when pollution
increases the level of pathogens or (to a lesser extent) chemical con-
taminants in those waters past thresholds judged safe for human
exposure. When this happens at a monitored beach, particularly for
pathogens, local or state authorities close or issues advisories for
beaches. Sufficient information is available to provide the basis for
an indicator about the risks  to public health from exposure to
 pathogens in  recreational water at coastal and Great Lakes beaches.
Although the indicator shows that the number of beaches with advi-
 sories or closures  has increased in recent years,  this trend simply
 represents the fact that more beaches are providing information. In
 fact, as the indicator shows, the percent of beaches under advisory
 or closure has been fairly constant over the last few years. Overall,
 relatively few days (six percent of the days beaches could be open)
 have been lost due to pathogen exposure. This indicator is limited  by
 three considerations:
 • The number of beach days closed or under advisory does not
    directly measure pathogens or contaminants in water.
 • Reporting of beach days  closed or under advisory is voluntary,
    thus the ability of this indicator to describe conditions nationwide
    is unknown.
 • At this time, this indicator applies primarily to coastal and Great
    Lakes beaches, as most fresh water inland beaches are not
    surveyed.
               • Improving the value of this indicator as a national measure of
                 recreational water qualify would entail an assessment of the pres-
                 ence of pathogens in all waters used for recreational activities.
                 Chemical contaminants would need to be selectively measured in
                 waters with known risk from contamination.

               2.6.4 Consumption of Fish and Shellfish

               Three indicators are available to help describe the condition of
               surface waters that support fish and shellfish consumption. For
               example, information about specific areas where contaminants in
               fish are above public health thresholds is available. One indicator
               suggests thsit the number of lake acres and river miles for which
               fish consumption advisories have been issued is increasing. This
               trend may represent an increase in monitoring, more stringent
               state health standards, or increased contamination. Other indica-
               tors show that the vast majority of sampled fish are  contaminated
               to some degree and that contamination for particular  pollutants
               (mercury and PCBs) tends to be concentrated in certain areas of
               the country.i For all three indicators, it is important to  note that
               sampling tends to focus on areas where ;states know fishing occurs
               or suspect there may be a contaminatiop problem, so  the data may
               over-report or under-report the degree pd extent of contamina-
               tion. Also, monitoring offish and shellfish at the state level is very
               inconsistent, and different criteria  are used to issue advisories.

               A true  national assessment of the  safety of fish and shellfish
               for human consumption can only be accomplished through a
               comprehensive, representative survey of pathogens  and chemical
               contaminants in edible fish tissue  in all jvaters. A national survey
               of this type, involving 500 lakes and reservoirs, is underway. Initial
               data on 268 contaminants in the tissue'of fresh water fish have
                been collected. These data are not presented in this  report
                because th«y reflect only one year of a [four-year study and, as
                such, are not ready for public release. However, they should  be
                available for future use as a potential indicator.
  2-64
2.6 Challenges and Data Claps
Chapter 2  - furer Water.

-------

f

-------
Indicators that were selected and included in this chapter were assigned to one of J3«q categories:
                                                                          ijil,level data coverage for more than one time period.
                                                                       I by sound collection methodologies, data management
• Category 1 -The indicator has been peer reviewed and is supported by nations
  The supporting data are comparable across the nation and are characterized '
  systems, and quality assurance procedures.
I Categoiy 2 -The indicator has been peer reviewed, but the supporting data af
  regions or ecoregions), or the indicator has not been  measured for more than  c
  indicator have been measured (e.g., data has been collected for birds, but not  fi
  comparable across the areas covered, and are characterized by sound collectiorj
  quality assurance procedures.                                             '
                                                                           j"available only for part of the nation (e.g., multi-state
                                                                          cine time period, or not all the parameters of the
                                                                           >r plants or insects). The supporting data are
                                                                           "methodologies, data management systems, and

-------
   3.0   Introduction
   The U.S. landscape can be characterized in many different ways—by
   its diversity and distribution of natural resources, by its complex pat-
   tern of land uses reflecting population distribution and management
.   strategies, and by the various ecological systems that provide habitat
   for thousands of plant and animal species. This landscape is continu-
   ously changing due to population growth, the demand  for resources
   and energy, and changing land management practices.

   Our nation's land provides the foundation on which cities are built
   and from which food and other resources are derived to support the
   population. At the  same time, land used for these purposes can be
   changed by pollution, waste disposal, and various physical processes
   (e.g., land clearing) that can change natural processes,  such as the
   hydrologic cycle. Numerous laws and practices have been   -
   implemented—especially over the last 30 years—to help protect
   human health and ecosystems from these types of human actions.

  This chapter addresses the types, extent, and uses of land in the
  geographic area of the U.S., which comprises approximately 2.3
  billion acres of land and water (U.S. Census Bureau, 2001). This
  area includes all 50 states, as well as Puerto Rico, American Samoa,
  Guam, the Northern Mariana Islands, Palau, and the U.S. Virgin
  Islands. In, total, 2.263 billion acres of the  U.S. are land, while 116
  million acres are water. This land acreage is the basis for all calcula-
  tions of percentages in this chapter, unless otherwise noted.

  Population growth is probably the single most important factor that
  has changed and continues to change the land environment of the
  U.S. The use of land is, to a major extent, a function of  human needs
  and population density. According to the 2000 Census, more than
  281 million people  live on our nation's land. The U.S. has added at
  least 20 million people per decade to its population over the last 50
  years, and in the last decade (1990-2000), the U.S. population has
  increased by more than  32 million (13 percent) (Exhibit 3-1). The
  density of population has  also continuously increased, although not
  evenly across the country (Exhibit 3-2). According to the  2000
  Census, the average density of people across our nation is approxi-
  mately 0.125 people per acre. This represents a significant change
  from the first census of population, conducted in 1790,  showing
  only 0.007 people per acre (U.S. Census Bureau, 2001).

  The exponential  growth  in the U.S.  and world population has created
  demands for resources and uses of land that have major effects on
  both human health and ecological condition. The land indicators
  outlined in this chapter are descriptors of the status, trends, and
  effects of various conditions and land practices. These indicators are
  often limited in their capacity to paint an accurate picture of the
  effects of various human practices, due to incomplete, inconsistent,
 or dated data.
            The specific issues explored in this chapter include changing uses of
            land for development, agriculture, and forest management; the use
            and presence of chemicals in the form of pesticides, fertilizers, and
            toxic releases; the generation  and management of various types of
            waste; and the extent of contaminated lands. The chapter poses
            fundamental questions about these issues and their health and
            ecological effects, and it uses indicators drawn from well-reviewed
            data sources to help answer those questions. Exhibit 3-3 lists these
            questions and indicators, and identifies the chapter section where
            each indicator is presented.

            The chapter is divided into four main sections:
            II Section 3.1 examines the extent of various ecological systems
              and land uses in the U.S.
            II Section 3.2 looks at the extent and  potential disposition of
              chemicals used or managed on land.
            II Section 3.3 addresses waste generation and management on land
              and the extent of contaminated lands.
            H Section 3.4 reviews the challenges and data gaps that remain in
              assessing the condition of our nation's land.

            Each of the topic sections (e.g., land use, chemicals, waste) also
            considers what is currently known about associated human health
            and ecological effects.
           I; Exhibit 3-1: Topulation and population density, 179O-2OOO
hPopu
jam
f — . ,.
1250
pa
fei-- -
13=:--- .-
po
OQQ
P"-' - ••
o
ation in millions
• Population (millions)
~ Population Density (per acre mile)
Population per acre of land area
/
/
^/
/
/\\
--— -"""fi 1 1 1
j. I • ! ajJU.1 iHiIiltl>iilil
I
1

L


1


1


L



L
/



L




L
0.109
0.09 ,
0.08
-0.06
0.05 :
0.03
0.02
               1790 1810  1830  1850  1870 1890 1910  1930  1950 1970 1990

             Note: Large amounts of land area were added to the United States in the early
             ISOQs (Louisiana Purchase, 1803), mid-1800s (adding the present states of
             Oregon, Washington, Idaho, California, Nevada, Utah, and parts of Colorado,
            : Kansas, Arizona, and New Mexico), and in 1959 (Alaska and Hawaii statehood).
             These land increases explain population density decreases during these periods.
                                             ig these peri

.Source: U.S. Census Bureau, Statist/en/Abstract of the United States 2001: The
National Data Book. Washington DC: U.S. Census Bureau, 2001.
 Chapter 3 -  Better Protected  Land
3.0 Introduction
                                                                                                                               3-3

-------
,*.._*
                                                               K
                                 Exhibit 3-2: United States population aensit)
             :-jg-gg^^
           ky county, 2000
      Source; Brewer, Cynthia A. and Trudy A. Suchan. Mapping Census 2000: Tte Geography of U.S. Diversity JUrje 2001
 Numerous gaps in the data exist that make it difficult or impossible
 to answer some of the questions posed about the condition of our
 nation's lands. The gaps and limitations of data are described briefly
 under each question and in more detail at the end of the chapter.
There are several major sources of data that contribute to this
chapter, and a report titled The State of the Nation's Ecosystems,
developed oy The H. John Heinz III Center for Science, Economics
and the Environment (The Heinz Center; 2002). These data sets
contribute directly and indirectly to many of the indicators
throughout the chapter.
  3-4
                                                          3.0 Introduction
                        C^napter 3
                                                                                                         - Better Protected Land

-------
                             Exhibit 3-3: Land - Questions and Indicators
f Land Use

1
f
i
1
• f-
sf
f
1
c---
9
st
1-
1
te_
i
K
1
1 - - 	 - 	 „ —...:.,.„..,. .... t.*-"~ JjL-Hif j. ^.'^^!*'""!"™''!:UtLiH"--- VtJferi3j.-;t) ;.i .--.a:. .;. Jn°'ga
-------

                                                                                                           m El
                                         Waste and Contaminated La
nds
How much and what types of waste are generated and     Quantjty of RCRA hazardous waste generated and managed
managed ?
What is the extent of land used for waste management?
What Is the extent of contaminated lands?
What human health effects are associated with waste
management and contaminated lands?
What ecological effects are associated with waste
management and contaminated lands?
Quantity of radioactive waste gei
Number and location of municipa
Number and location of RCRA ha
Number and location of Superfur
Number and location of RCRA C<
No Category 1 or 2 indicator idf
No Category 1 or 2 indicator id<
L 	 ;

•Hafff
(MSW)
:e gener
erated
I solid w
zardous
generated and managed
ated and managed
— 	 i i 	
and in inventory
aste (MSW) landfills
waste management facilities
d National Priorities List (NPL) sites
>rrective Action sites ;
ntifled
•ntified
JipiliilHg
2
2
2
2
2
2
2


•JStSHES
3.3.1
3.3.1
3.3.1
3.3.2
3.3.2
.3.3.3
3.3.3
3.3.4
3.3.5
3-6
                                                     3.0 Introduction
              Chapter 3 - Better Protected Land ',

-------
    3.1   Land  U
se
    Land ownership and the management objectives of the owners tend
    to determine how land is used; thus,  U.S. lands are used for many
    d,fferent purposes. Nearly 28 percent of the nation (630 million
   .acres) is owned and managed by the  federal government. State and
    local governments manage another 198 million acres (GSA, 1999)
    The more than 828 million acres of federal, state, and local
   government lands in the nation are managed for various public pur-
   poses. In contrast, the approximately  1.419 billion acres of private
   and tribal land are more likely to be managed in the interests of
   their owners, with various land use constraints imposed by zoning
   and other regulations (CSA, 1999; USDA, NRCS 1997- Alaska
   DNR, 2000).

   Management objectives are constantly changing on private and
   public lands and can have both positive and negative effects on the
   natural environment and human health. Such effects include loss of
   native habitat to agricultural practices;  loss of prime agricultural
   lands to urban/suburban development; changes in patterns of runoff
   as a result of impervious surfaces, stream flow, dams, or irrigation
   systems; habitat restoration based on land reclamation; and
   urban/suburban development on previously contaminated land.

   There are differing estimates of the extent of various land uses. Those
   discussed in the context of the following questions are often due to
   different classifications, definitions, approaches to data collection, and
  the timing of data collection and analysis. Land cover and land use
  represent two different concepts and both are discussed in this section
  Land cover is essentially what can be seen on the land-the vegetation
  or other physical characteristics—while land use describes how a piece
  of land is being used (or not) by humans.  In some cases, land uses can
  be determined by cover types, which are visible  (e.g., the presence of
  housing indicates residential land use). Often, however, more informa-
  tion is needed for those uses that are not  visible (e.g., lands leased for
  mining, "reserved" forest land, shrublands with grazing rights).
  Techniques for assessing land cover and land use vary, with different
  data required to accurately assess extent and practices. Remotely
  sensed data are increasingly being used to  track land cover. When
  combined with knowledge^ local  land use regulations or other infor-
  mation, such data can be useful for tracking land use.
   Six questions are posed in this section to examine the extent of
   various ecological systems and land uses, including development
   agriculture, and forest management. The questions considered are:

   II What is the extent of developed lands?
   II What is the extent of farmlands?
   • What is the extent of grasslands and shrublands?
   • What is the extent of forest lands?
   • What human health effects are associated with land use?
   H What ecological effects  are associated with land use?

  Tracking national patterns of land use and activities that affect the
  land can be challenging, primarily because land use is regulated by
  many levels of government and also because of the significant varia-
  tions ,n  land cover, geography, and land activities nationwide Data
  produced by different agencies at different levels of government
  must be integrated and analyzed continually to gain a national
  perspective of patterns and trends.

  The primary information sources for this section include the
  National Resources Inventory (NRI) of the U.S. Department of
 Agriculture (USDA) Natural Resources Conservation Service (NRCS)-
 the report titled The State of the Nation's Ecosystems, which was
 developed by The H. John Heinz III Center for Science, Economics
 and the Environment (The Heinz Center, 2002); and data from the
 Forest Inventory and Analysis (FIA) Program.

 This section presents various activities related to land use and land
 cover. Two examples of activities for which indicators have not been
 ident.fied, but that can have significant effects in different ways on
 land are  1) the formal  protection or reservation of land for habitat
 or natural resources and 2) mining and extraction activities. Some
 data are collected locally and for federal lands (e.g., National Park
 acreage) or tracked for economic indicators, but the national picture
 of the extent of land reservation and mining is not generally avail-
able. A snapshot of what is known is described in the two sidebars.
Chapter 3 - Better Protected  Land
                                                          3.1  Land Use
                                                                                                                              3-7

-------
                                            PROTECTED LANP£
                                                                                                           -

of protection. More than 4 percent of the nation ,s managed as ™™m«s'™ ™e  |    s of acres Of lands are also protected in the
wlrness, more than half are in Alaska (Wilde.ness^^^^^ ^! and Bureau of Land Management Wilderness
National Park Service System, within  he U.S. Fish and ™^^™£ * J ona, wild ancf Scenic Rivers, in National Recreation
Study Areas, in National Forest Roadless Areas, ,„                               &^^'il^--j^-^«^ systems,
r :r=t ;—-
providing restrictions from development in perpetuity.
                                 MINING AND EXTRACTION
                ACTIVITIES
     .^
are known to be 1 ,879 coal mines and associated fac .ties m ^ ^^^ntf «?ttS«^ accounts far* 37 percent of U.S. coal
the U.S. coal, primarily from surface mines. The Appa achia are, ed by We ^^^S' 534,000 producing oi, wells (ranging
production, mainly from underground m,nes(DOE, November 2002). Otter energy
from one to millions of barrels of production per year) Top
CaHfornia, Louisiana, Oklahoma, and Wyoming (
ties produce most of the mmerals and metals ,n the U.S
removed in 2000. Overall, 97 percent was mined and q
in which mining for non-fue. minerals occurs are Nevada,
Pennsylvania (USGS, 2000b). In addition to act.ve > mines
                              "65 other mines and processing facili-
                             tons of non-fuel minera, materials were
                iand 3      nt was mined un'derground; The major states
at the surface leve anc '  P                       ^    ohjo_ and
                            ^s a p^ately 10,200 aban-
                                  of abandoned mines on public and
                                                                  w*«>. Mm*, o  aanone  mne
                                ^^
    3.1.1  What is the extent of
    developed  lands?
   Indicators
   Extent of developed lands
   Extent of urban and suburban lands
  Land development is a process of land conversion that changes lands
  from natural or agricultural uses to residential, industrial, transporta-
  tion, or commercial uses to meet human needs. Land development
  has created urban and suburban ecological systems, which are areas
  Where the majority of the land is devoted to or dominated by build-
  ings, houses, roads, lawns, or other elements of human use and
  construction (The Heinz Center, 2002). Urban and suburban
  ecological systems are highly built up and paved, resulting in effects
  such as more rapid changes in temperature, increased runoff, and
  increased chemical contaminants than in more  natural ecosystems.
         Plant and animal life is more heavily influenced by species introduced  '
         in horticulture and as pets, and native:species may be more or less
         completely removed from large areas and replaced by lawns, gardens,
         and ornamentals (World Resources Institute, 2000).

         The majority of Americans live in areas that are considered "devel-
         oped larid." Between 1950 and 2000, the number of Americans
         living in U S. Census Bureau-defined urban areas increased from 64
         percent to 79 percent of the total population (U.S. Census Bureau,
         2001). Estimates vary widely on the amount of land considered
         developed in the U.S., depending on definitions of "developed" and
         different assessment techniques. For example, the Census Bureau
         definitio n is a measure of population density; not specifically a
         measure of actual land use or conversion of land. Census urban areas
         do not take into account low-density suburbs and other developed
         lands such as commercial or transportation infrastructure areas that
         do not include people. The Census definitions may underestimate   ,
          lands that would be categorized as low-level residential or lands
          having dispersed development. (See the following sidebar for
          definitions used in this discussion.) ;
   3-8
                                                        3.1 Land Use
                                Chapter 3 - Better Protected Landj.

-------
  The two indicators presented in this section provide an estimate of
  the extent of developed land, with an estimate of urban and
  suburban lands as a subset of developed lands. These estimates were
  developed using different definitions and methodologies. The extent
           of "developed land" indicator uses a national statistical sample that
           takes into account various development types. The "extent of urban
           and suburban lands" indicator identifies densely developed areas
           classified using remotely sensed satellite data.
                  DEFINITIONS OF DEVELOPED AND URBAN/SUBURBAN LANDS

    U.S. Census Bureau Definitions
    Urbanized Areas and Urban Clusters. The Census Bureau describes urban areas as Urbanized Areas (UAs) and  Urban Clusters (UCs)
    These are donations for densely settled areas, which consist of core census block groups that have a population density of at least
    1 ,000 people per square mile and other surrounding census blocks that have  an overall density of at least 500 people per square mile UAs
    contain 50,000 or more people. UCs contain at least 2,500 people, but less than 50,000. Based on 2000 Census data there are 466
    UAs and 3,172 UCs comprising nearly 60 million acres (or 2.6 percent of the  U.S. land area). These definitions and delineations of urban
    areas  are used by the Office of Management and Budget to delineate the Census Metropolitan Areas, including Metropolitan Statistical
   Areas, which are used for various federaland state budget allocation purposes (U.S. Census Bureau, 2001).

   USDA; NRCS, National Resources Inventory (NRI) Definitions
                                                                      bUilt'UP ^ sma" built-uP areas' and ™al transportation land
     Urban and built-up areas. A land cover/use category consisting of residential, industrial, commercial, and institutional land; construc-
     tion s,tes; public administrative sites; railroad yards; cemeteries; airports; golf courses; sanitary landfills; sewage treatment plants- water
     control structures and spillways; other land used for such purposes; small parks (less than 10 acres) within urban and built-up areas-
     and highways, railroads, and other transportation facilities if they are surrounded by urban areas. Also included are tracts of less than 10
     acres that do not meet the above definition but are completely surrounded by urban and'built-up land. Two size categories are  recog-
     nized in the NRI: areas of 0.25 acre to 10 acres and areas of at least 10 acres.
       Large urban and built-up areas. A land cover/use category composed of developed tracts of at least 10 acres— meeting the
       definition of urban and built-up areas.
       Small built-up areas. A land cover/use category consisting of developed land units of 0.25 to 10 acres that meet the definition of
       urban and built-up areas.
       Rural transportation land. A land  cover/use category that consists of all highways, roads, railroads, and associated rights-of-way
       outside of urban and built-up areas, including private roads to farmsteads or ranch headquarters, logging roads, and other private
       roads, except field lanes.

  The Heinz Report Definitions
  Urban and suburban lands. An area is considered to be urban/suburban if a majority of the lands within a 1 ,000 foot by 1 000  foot
  area (pixel) fall into one of the four "developed" land cover types classified in the  NLCD (low-density residential, high-density residential
  commeraal-mdustnal-transportation, or urban and recreational grasses). In outlying areas, clusters of pixels fiad to total at least 270 acres
  to be considered urban/suburban.
Chapter 3  - Better Protected  Land
3.1 Land Use
                                                                                                                           3-9

-------
Indicator
Extent of developed lands - Category 1
  Land development generally results in significant changes in other
  land uses or cover types. This indicator provides a measure of how
  much developed land exists, where it is, and how it has changed.
  The indicator relies on national statistical data samples conducted
  every five years by the USDA NRCS.

  What the Data Show

  The NRI reports approximately 98 million acres of developed land
  in the U.S., not including Alaska (USDA, NRCS, 2001). This figure
  represents about 4.3 percent of the total land area. Exhibit 3-4
  shows the distribution of non-federal developed lands nationwide.
  Each dot on the map represents 15,000 acres. The map displays
  the Census Metropolitan Area boundaries, which are larger in
                                                    western states due to the large size of many counties. States
                                                    along the Northeast corridor have the highest percentages of   •
                                                    developed hand, exceeding more than one-third of a state's area
                                                    in some casas.                        j

                                                    Between 1982  and  1997, developed lands increased by 25 million
                                                    acres, primarily through conversion of croplands and forest lands
                                                     (USDA, NRCS,  2000a). This represents a 34.1 percent increase.
                                                     Developed lands as a percentage of the nation rose from 3.2
                                                     percent in 1982 to 4.3 percent in 1997 (USDA, NRCS, 2000a).
                                                    The pace of land development between [1992 and 1997 was more
                                                     than 1.5  times the rate of the previous JO years. The distribution
                                                     of changes in developed land varies nationwide, with extensive
                                                     changes in the eastern part of the country from south to north.
                                    Exhibit 3-4: Extent of non-federal developed land, 1997
                      98,251,700 acres of developed land

                      Metropolitan areas are defined as U.S. Census
                      Bureau Metropolitan Statistical Areas.
                                                                                                             Each red dot represents
                                                                                                             15,000 acres of
                                                                                                             developed land
                                                                                                                95% or more
                                                                                                                federal area
                                                                                                             CJ Metropolitan area
                                                                                                                boundaries
                                                                                                                Metropolitan area
                                                                                                                central cities
       Hawaii
                     Alaska
                                                                                                          Puerto Rico/U.S.-Virgin Island
      Source: USOA, Natural Resources Conservation Service. National Resources Inventory, 1997, revised D.Lember 2000- Acres of Developed Land, 1997 2000
      yawary2QQ5;Mtp://wmnrcsMsda.gov/techmcal/land/meta/m4974.html).                    [^
                                                                                                                '  tit
 3-10
                                                            3.1 Land Use
                                                                              Chapter 3 - Better Protected Land

-------
                                                                                                        nvuiQnmen
                   Extent of developed lands - Category I  (continued)
      Exhibit 3-5 depicts the change in developed land (urban and
      suburban areas and rural transportation land) by watershed in the
      1982 to 1997 time frame.

      Indicator Gaps and  Limitations

      The NRI data are limited in not providing data on Alaska and not
      assessing development on federal lands, including
      recreational development and transportation infrastructure.

      Data  Source

     Acreage estimates and map data presented for this indicator are
     from the  National Resources Inventory, U.S. Department of
     Agriculture, Natural Resources Conservation Service, 1997
     (Revised December 2000). (See Appendix B, page B-18, for
     more information.)
                                                           National Resources Inventory

                                                   The NRI is a longitudinal survey designed to assess conditions
                                                   and trends of soil, water, and related resources on non-federal
                                                   lands in the U.S. The NRI statistical sample involves approximately
                                                   300,000 sample units and 800,000 sample points on non-
                                                   federal lands. The sample is a stratified two-stage unequal
                                                   probability design that can be modified to address specific
                                                   national survey goals or special studies. Stratification was devel-
                                                   oped county by county, based on the Public Land Survey System
                                                   (PLSS) where possible, and on latitude/longitude, Universal
                                                   Transverse Mercator Grid, or artificial superimposed lines when
                                                   necessary. The national sampling varies across strata and ranges
                                                   from 2 to 6 percent The NRI measures numerous variables, which
                                                   are then extrapolated as national totals. Variables include the
                                                   following: soil characteristics, earth cover,  land cover and use,
                                                   erosion, land treatment, vegetative conditions, conservation treat-
                                                  ment needs, potential for cropland conversion, extent of urban
                                                  land, habitat diversity, and Conservation Reserve Program cover.
                                                  NRI sample data are generally reliable at the 95 percent
                                                  confidence interval for state and certain broad sub-state area
                                                  analyses (Goebel, 1998).
                                      Exnikit 3-5: Land d
                                        evelopment patterns, 1982-1997
25,005,900 New Developed Acres
                                                                                                    New Acres
                                                                                                  50,000 or more
                                                                                                  25,000 to 50,000
                                                                                                  15,000 to 25,000
                                                                                               O Less than  15,000
                                                                                                  95% or more
                                                                                                  Federal area
                                                                                                  Metropolitan areas

                                                                                           Puerto Rico/US. Virgin Islands
                   ?
Chapter 3 - Better Protected  Land
                                                        3.1  Land Use
                                                                                                                        3-n

-------

Indicator
Extent of urban and suburban lands - Category 2
  Urban and suburban lands are considered a subset of developed
  lands and one of the ecological systems described in Chapter 5,
  Ecological Condition. These are highly developed areas and
  surrounding suburbs, including developed outlying areas above a
  minimum size. Acreage estimates are based on an analysis of the
  remotely sensed NLCD data conducted by the U.S. Geological
  Survey (USGS), Areas of at least 270 acres that are substantially
  covered with roads, buildings, concrete, and other hard  surfaces
  must be identified to be classified and counted as urban/subur-
  ban (The Heinz Center, 2002). This definition excludes smaller
  built-up areas.

  What the Data  Show

   Urban and suburban ecological systems occupied 32 million acres
   in the conterminous U.S. in 1992, or about 1.7 percent of that
   land area (The Heinz Center, 2002). This estimate was derived
   from a re-analysis of the 1992 NLCD. The analysis includes
   information on the amount and character of undeveloped land
   Within urban/suburban areas. Most of the lands designated urban
   and suburban are in the South and Midwest, but they account for
   less than 2  percent of the land in those regions. In the Northeast,
   urban and suburban lands account for more than 5 percent of
   the landscape.
                                                  Indicator Gaps  and Limitations
                                                                                     !
                                                  The NLCD database is derived from a one-time interpretation
                                                  of satellite imagery of the nation from the early 1990s.
                                                  Although limited by the ability to detect land use remotely
                                                  based on spectral characteristics, NLCD data are available for
                                                  all of the conterminous U.S. Original!estimates of the NLCD
                                                  indicated a total of 36.7 million acres pf land in three different
                                                  "developed" land cover classifications (low density residential,
                                                  high density residential, and commercial/industrial/transporta-
                                                  tion) (The Heinz Center, 2002).     i

                                                  Data Source

                                                  Acreages presented for this indicator are derived from a
                                                   re-analysis of the National Land Cover Data, a product of the
                                                   Multi-Resolution Land Characteristics Consortium,, which is a part-
                                                   nership belween the U.S. Geological Survey; the U.S. Department
                                                   of Agriculture, Forest Service; the National Oceanographic and
                                                   Atmospheric Administration; and the EPA- (See Appendix B, page
                                                   B-18 for more information).
     3.1.2 Wpat is the extent of
     farmlandst
   Indicators
   Extent of agricultural land uses
   The farmland landscape
  Farmlands represent one of the nation's major ecological systems
  and are discussed in Chapter S, Ecological Conditions.(The Heinz
  Center, 2002). As noted in the sidebar, on the following page, crop-
  lands, which can include pasturelands and haylands, are at the heart
  of the  farmland ecosystem. The broader "farmland landscape" also
  includes other lands that are not actively used for crop, pasture, or
  hay production. The composition of lands that surround croplands,
  such as forests, wetlands, or built-up areas, are discussed further in
  the "farmland landscape" indicator.
                                                    The U.S. produces a wide range of food crops, grains, and other
                                                    agricultural products over vast areas of the country that are part of
                                                    the farmland landscape (see adjacent sidebar). Agricultural lands can
                                                    be thought of as all those lands that contribute to this production.
                                                    Other words such as farmland, cropland, pastureland, rangeland,
                                                    grazing land, or grassland are also used to describe aspects of
                                                    agricultural lands. Some of these words define cover types, while
                                                    others define land use. The areas overlap but do not necessarily
                                                    coincide with each other. This situation creates challenges in estab-
                                                    lishing accurate estimates of extent. Under the discussion of the
                                                    agricultural land use indicator, an effort is made to  distinguish the
                                                    various definitions and provide a measure of acreages. (Current
                                                    definitions as used by the USDA NRC^ NRl are shown in the sidebar
                                                    that follows.)                      I
   3-12
                                                           3.1 Land Use
                                                                            Chapter |3 - Better Protected Land ;

-------
Aside from the challenges of defining types of agricultural land,
assessing the amount of land used for crops is an imperfect science,
given the seasonally of agricultural practices and changes in
economics and technology. As with developed land, estimates vary
depending on the classification criteria and mapping or sampling
methodologies. Until the 1950s, the amount of agricultural land •
needed to meet demands for food continued to grow, reaching a
peak of more than a billion acres of cropland and rangeland in the
        mid 1960s. Since then, crop and farmland acreages have decreased
        and increased in cycles, as both economics and technology have
        changed demands and as production capabilities have increased.

        Two indicators are considered on the following pages. The first
        assesses the extent of land used to grow food crops and forage. The
        second considers the farmland landscape, which includes not only
        land used for agricultural production but also adjacent areas.
                            NRI Land Cover Definitions for Agricultural  Land

  Cropland. A land cover/use category that includes areas used for the production of adapted crops for harvest. Two subcategories of
  cropland are recognized: cultivated and noncultivated. Cultivated cropland comprises land in row crops or close-grown crops and also
  other cultivated cropland, such as hayland or pastureland in a rotation with row or close-grown crops.  Non-cultivated cropland includes
  permanent hayland and horticultural cropland.

  Conservation Reserve Program (CRP). A federal program established under the Food Security Act of 1985 to help private landowners
  convert highly erodible cropland to vegetative cover for 10 years.

  Pastureland. A land cover/use category of areas managed primarily for the production of introduced forage plants for livestock grazing.
  Pastureland cover may consist of a single species in a pure stand, a  grass mixture, or a grass-legume mixture. Management usually consists
  of cultural treatments: fertilization, weed control, reseeding or renovation, and control of grazing. For the NRI, it includes land that has a
  vegetative cover of grasses, legumes, and/or forbs, regardless of whether it is being grazed by livestock.

  Rangeland. A land cover/use category on which the climax or potential plant cover is composed principally of native grasses, grasslike'
  plants, forbs or shrubs suitable for grazing and browsing, and introduced forage species that are managed like rangeland. This would include
  areas where introduced hardy and persistent grasses, such as crested wheatgrass, are planted and such practices as deferred grazing,
  burning, chaining, and rotational grazing are used, with little or no chemicals or fertilizer being applied. Grasslands, savannas, many wet-
  lands, some deserts, and tundra are considered to be rangeland. Certain communities of low forbs and shrubs, such as mesquite, chaparral,
  mountain shrub, and pinyon-juniper, are also included as rangeland.
  (USDA, NRCS, 2000a)
 Chapter 3 - Better Protected Land
3.1 Land Use
                                                                 3-13

-------


  Indicate
Extent of agricultural land uses - Category I
    Land can be used for a variety of agricultural purposes. Two
    general categories are differentiated in this discussion. The first
    includes lands that are actively managed to cultivate food crops
    or forage. This category comprises croplands, or lands that grow
    perennial and annual crops such as fruits, nuts, grains, and vegeta-
    bles; and pasturelands, or lands that are actively cultivated to
    produce forage for livestock. The second category includes lands
    that may be used to produce livestock as an agricultural commodi-
    ty, but are not planted, fertilized, or otherwise intensively
    managed. These livestock production lands may be called grazing
    lands or rangelands and can include forest land, shrubland, and
    grassland, which are described in the following sections. Livestock
    production may also include concentrated  animal feedlot
    operations, acreages of which are not included in this discussion.
                                                    What the Data Show

                                                    In 1997, the NRI identified nearly 377 million acres of cropland
                                                    and more than 32 million acres of Conservation Reserve Program
                                                    (CRP) land. CRP lands, as noted in the sidebar, are croplands that
                                                    are set aside (farmers are provided incentives) for up to 10 years
                                                    for conservation purposes, but that could be returned to crop
                                                    production if the program ceased. This total equals nearly 410
                                                    million acres of land currently growing or specifically identified
                                                    with the potential to grow crops in the U.S. (USDA, NRCS,
                                                    2000a) (Exhibit 3-6).

                                                    The NRI reports about 120 million acres of pastureland. As
                                                    defined in the sidebar, pastureland includes land that has a
                                                    vegetative cover of grasses,  legumes, and/or forbs, regardless of
                                          Exhibit 3-6: Extent of croplands, 1997
                                                                                                               95% or more
                                                                                                               Federal area
                     Each green dot represents 25,000
                     acres of cropland
                     Total acres: 376,997,900
         Hawaii
                                                                                                       Puertjj Rico/U.S.Virgrn Islands
                                                                                I '
       Source: USDA. National Resources Conservation Service. National Resources Inventory, 1997, revised Deci mfaer 2000. Acres of Cropland. 2000
       Oanuafy2003iwvw.nrcs4isda.gov/technical/land/meta/m4964.html).'                        -1
3-14
                                          3.1  Land Use
Chapter 3 - Better Protected Land

-------
   Indicate
txtent of agricultural  lane! uses ": Category 1  (continued)
                                                                                      ^^
   whether it is being grazed by livestock. It is usually managed to
   produce feed for livestock grazing, using fertilization, weed
   control, and reseeding. Thus the total estimate from the NRI for
   cropland, CRP land, and pastureland is 530 million acres.

   The Heinz Center (2002), using four different sources of data,
   estimated that cropland, including pasture and haylands, covered
   between 430 and 500 million acres in 1997. For the most part,
   the report did not include CRP lands in its estimates. According to
   the 1992 NLCD, the U.S. had 510 million acres of agricultural land
   in the 1990s (EPA, ORD, 1992).

   Crazing to support livestock production can potentially occur
   on pastureland, rangeland, and, in some cases, forest land.  .
   These lands can also be defined based on their cover type (e.g.,
   grasslands, shrublands, or forested range). Not counting pasture-
   land, the NRI identified nearly 406 million acres of non-federal
   rangelands and another 62 million acres of non-federal forest land
   that can be used for grazing  livestock (USDA, NRCS, 2000a). In
   addition, according to estimates generated by the Bureau  of Land
   Management, more than half of theJederal land in the lower 48'
   states, or 244 million acres, is available for livestock grazing (DOI,
   1994). The total of these estimates is 712 million acres  of lands
   that may be used for grazing, but are not cultivated. Adding in the
   pastureland acreage results in 832 million acres of land that may
   be used for grazing livestock  nationwide (excluding Alaska).
     exhibit 3-7: Change in cropland, Conservation Reserve
        Program (CRP) land and pastureland, I982-1Q97
     600
              1982
                          1987
                                       1992
                                                   1997
    Source: USDA, Natural Resources Conservation Service.
    Summary Report 1997 National Resources Inventory (revised December 2000). 2000.
                                                  Agricultural lands constantly shift among crop, pasture, range, and
                                                  forest land to meet production needs, implement rotations of land
                                                  in and out of cultivation, and maintain and sustain soil resources.
                                                  Within these shifts, however, trends indicate a gradual decrease in
                                                  cropland acreage. Between 1982 and 1997, cropland decreased
                                                  10.4 percent, from about 421  million acres to nearly 377 million
                                                  acres (Exhibit 3-7). Of this 44 million acre decrease, however,
                                                  30.4 million acres are now enrolled in the CRP, resulting an 13.6
                                                  million fewer acres of cropland as a result of conversion to other
                                                  land uses (USDA, NRCS, 2000a). During this same time frame,
                                                  pastureland area decreased 9.1 percent, or about 12 million acres
                                                  (USDA, NRCS., 2000a). The total change in acreage, considering
                                                  lands in the CRP was 23 million fewer agricultural land acres in
                                                  .1997 than in 1982.

                                                  Decreases in cropland have occurred particularly in the southern
                                                  and southeastern part of the U.S. The distribution of change in
                                                  cropland acreage is displayed in Exhibit 3-8. There are no
                                                  comprehensive estimates of changes in acreages of grazing lands.

                                                  Indicator Gaps and Limitations

                                                  A specific objective of the NRI is to assess changes in cropland.
                                                  Again, however, the ability to couple it with current remote sens-
                                                  ing imagery would likely contribute to improved resolution and
                                                  national mapping of cropland types (See the discussion about
                                                  NRI data in the "Extent of Developed  Land" indicator box).

                                                  There is no single, definitive, accurate estimate of the extent of
                                                  cropland. Estimates of the amount of land devoted to farming
                                                  differ because different programs use  different methods to
                                                  acquire, define, and analyze their data. Cropland is also a flexible
                                                  resource that is constantly being taken in and out of production.
                                                  The Heinz report used four different data sources to describe the
                                                  range of estimates. The four data sets are not fully consistent, and
                                                  comparisons are difficult to make. For example, the USDA
                                                  Economic Research Service" (ERS) and Census of Agriculture data
                                                  include croplands in Alaska and Hawaii, while NRI does not. The
                                                  ERS data used in the Heinz report estimate included CRP lands,
                                                  while the Census of Agriculture and NRI estimates used by the
                                                  Heinz report did not (The Heinz Center, 2002).

                                                  Data Sources

                                                  The data sources for this indicator are the National Resources
                                                  Inventory, U.S. Department of Agriculture, Natural Resources
                                                  Conservation Service, 1997 (Revised in December 2000);
                                                  Summary Report:  1997 National Resources  Inventory (Revised
                                                  December 2000), U.S. Department of Agriculture, NRCS; and
Chapter 3 - Better Protected Land
                                         3.1 Land Use
                                                                                                          3-15

-------


Indicator
      		.*~~-~—»r
       Extent of agricultural land uses - Category I  (continuedl
                            	-_	 tiki— -
  Draft Environmental Impact Statement, U.S. Department of the
  Interior, Bureau of Land Management, 1994. The Heinz Center
  estimates of cropland acreages are derived from the National Land
  Cover Data, a product of the Multi-Resolution Land
  Characteristics Consortium,
                                                          which is a partnership between the U.S. Geological Survey; the
                                                          U.S. Department of Agriculture, Forest Service; the National
                                                          Oceanographic and Atmospheric Administration; and the EPA.
                                                          (See Appendix B, page B-19, for more information.)
                                                                                        li^
                              Exhibit 3-8: Percent change in cropland trea, 1982-1997
         There was a *10.4% decrease In cropland
         are* between 1982 and 1997.
'*   SN^-^X
                                                                                                      Percent Change

                                                                                                    Increase > 25

                                                                                                    Increase of 5 to 25

                                                                                                    Little change

                                                                                                    Decrease of 5 to 25


                                                                                                    Decrease .25

                                                                                                    Less than 5% cropland

•                                                                                                    95% or more
                                                                                                    Federal area
                                                                                                      Piierto Rieo/U,S. Virgin Island;
           ; USDA, Natural Resources Conservation Service. National Resources Inventory, 1997, revised Decemb^ ;2000: Percent Change in Cropland Area, 1982-1997.2000
      (January 2Q03; www.nrc5lusda.gov/techmcal/!and/meta/m5874.html).
3-16
                                                          3.1 Land Use
                                                                                  Chapter 3 - Better Protected Land

-------
                ! ne farmland landscape- Category 2
    Examining the broader context of agricultural lands can provide
    a better understanding of agricultural ecosystems. As previously
    noted, the Heinz report defined this term as not only the lands
    used to grow crops, but also the field borders, windbreaks,
    small woodlots, grassland and shrubland areas, wetlands, farm-
    steads, and small villages and other built-up areas within or
    adjacent to croplands. These covers/uses support not only
    agricultural production, but provide habitat for a variety of
    wildlife species as well.

    What the Data Show

   The farmland landscape indicator describes the degree to which
   croplands dominate  the landscape and the extent to which other
   lands are intermingled  (The Heinz Center, 2002).

   Croplands comprise  about half of the farmlands in the East and
   Southeast, while in the Midwest, almost three-quarters of the
   farmland ecosystem is cropland (The Heinz Center, 2002). Forests
   make up the remainder of the farmland ecosystem in the East,
   wetlands the remainder in the Southeast, and both forests and
   wetlands in the Midwest. In the West, about 60 percent of farm-
   land ecosystem is cropland, with grasslands and shrublands
   dominating the remainder in the western and northern Plains areas.
   Forests  and grasslands/shrublands are about equal in the farmland
   landscape for the non-cropland area of the South Central region.
   In many U.S. areas, other land cover types are almost as prevalent
   as croplands arid can provide habitat for non-agronomic species.
          Indicator Gaps and  Limitations

          This indicator uses satellite data from the early 1990s to describe
          the farmland landscape. Remote sensing technology can underes-
          timate dispersed land development that is denser than scattered
          rural settlements, but not as dense as traditional  "suburbs."

          Data Source

          The National Land Cover Database, with 21 land  cover classes,
          was used to estimate the area coverage for the U.S. The NLCD is
          based on remotely sensed imagery from the Landsat 5 Thematic
          Mapper. Data are available from .
          (See Appendix B, page B-19, for more information.)
  3.1.3. What is the  extent of
  grasslands and  shrublands?
  Indicator
  Extent of grasslands and shrublands
Grasslands and shrublands can be viewed as one of the major
ecological systems of the U.S. and are discussed in Chapter 5,
Ecological Condition, (The Heinz Center, 2002). Grasslands and
shrublands can be used for grazing and, in that sense, overlap in
         extent with agricultural land. As previously defined, pastureland and
         rangeland are covered by grass and shrub species. This ecosystem is
         one of the largest types in the U.S. and includes not only the
        . grasslands and shrublands of the American West, but also coastal
         meadows, grasslands and shrubs in Florida, mountain meadows, hot
         and cold deserts, tundra, and similar areas in all states.
Chapter 3 - Better Protected Land
3.1 Land Use
                                                              3-17

-------
Indicator
Extent of grasslands and sriruolanas - Category 2
 There was an estimated 900 million to 1 billion acres of grass-
 lands and shrublands in the lower 48 states before European
 settlement (Klopatek, et al., 1979). By 1992, between 40 million
 and 140 million acres had been converted to other uses. Many
 pastures are managed in such a way that little of their original
 grassland character remains, however. Thus, the area  of relatively
 unmanaged grasslands and shrublands has probably declined
 more than the overall figures would indicate (The Heinz Center,
 2002). One factor in the decline of grassland pasture and range
 acreages since the 1960s is that forage productivity has
 increased and the number of domestic animals has declined
 (Vesterby,  2003).

 What the Data Show

 Based on remote sensing satellite data, it is estimated that grass-
 lands and shrublands (including pasturelands and haylands) occu-
 py about 861 million acres in the lower 48 states and 205 million
 acres in Alaska, for a total of 1.066 billion acres or about 47 per-
 cent of the U.S. (not including Hawaii) (The Heinz Center, 2002)
  (Exhibit 3-9). This estimate distinguishes 178 million acres of pas-
 turelands and haylands, which are also considered to be part of
 the farmland landscape, leaving 683 million acres of grasslands
  and shrublands in the lower 48 states (The Heinz Center, 2002).
                                                    Indicator Gaps and Limitations

                                                    NLCD was used to estimate extent of grasslands and shrublands in
                                                    the lower 48 states. Other data were estimated for Alaska. This is
                                                    a complicated and changing ecosystem that is subject to conver-
                                                    sion to other uses. It would be useful to have better means to
                                                    characterize and track extent.            ;

                                                    Data  Sources

                                                    The National Land Cover Database with 21  land cover classes, was
                                                    used to estimate the area coverage for the U.S. The NLCD is
                                                    based on remotely sensed  imagery from the Landsat 5 Thematic
                                                    Mapper.  Data are available from .
                                                    Data for Alaska were estimated from a vegetation map of Alaska
                                                    by Flemming (1996), based on Advanced Very High Resolution
                                                    Radiometer remote sensing images with an approximate resolution
                                                    of 1  kilometer on a side (The Heinz Center, 2002). (See Appendix
                                                    B, page B-19, for more information.)
                                Exhibit 3-9: Extent of grassland's and snrublanjs, 1991 and 1992
           Area of grasslands and sKrublands, lower U8 states
                                1992
       1000
                                                                    1000
                                                                     800
                                                                     600
                                                                  S 400
                                                                     200
                                                                 ,rea of grasslands and scrublands, Alaska
                                                                                 1991'"
            Source: IPA, Office of Research and Development. Multi-Resolution
            Und Characteristics Consortium, National Land Cover Data. 1992.
            (February 19,2003; http://mw.epa.sov/mrlc/tilcd.html).
                                                            Souree. Flerajning, M D A Statewide Vegetation Map of Alaska Using a
                                                                   al Classification ofAVHKR Data February 1996.
3-18
                                                         3.1 Land Use
                                                                           Chapter 3 -; Better Trotected Land

-------
     3.1.4 What is the extent of
     forest  lands?
    Indicator
    Extent of forest area, ownership, and management
  Forests provide a range of important benefits to society. In addition
  to providing wood products, such as paper and lumber, forest lands
                                                   help to purify air and water, mitigate floods and droughts, regulate
                                                   climate through storage of carbon dioxide, regenerate soils, provide
                                                   habitat for fish and wildlife, and support recreational opportunities.
                                                   Trends in the extent of forests are an important indicator of human
                                                   management of the landscape, since forest lands cover about one-
                                                   third of the total U.S. land area. This section provides information on
                                                   the status and trends relating to the amount and management of
                                                   forest land. Additional information on the condition of forest land is
                                                   found in Chapter 5, Ecological Condition.
   Indicat
txtent of forest area, ownership, and management - Category
    It is estimated that in 1630, 1.045 billion acres of forest land
    existed in what would become the U.S. land area. (USDA, FS,
    2001). Nearly 25 percent of these lands were cleared by the early
    1900s, leaving 759 million acres in 1907. Since that time the total
    amount of forest land nationwide, while changing regionally has
    remained relatively stable, with an increase of 2 million acres
    between 1997 and 2001.

    What  the  Data Show

    There were an estimated 749 million acres of forest land in  the
    U.S. in 2001  (USDA, FS, 2002). In the period between  1987 and
    2001, forest land acreage increased by about 11 million acres
    (USDA, FS, 2002).

    There have been regional changes in the amount of forest land
    due to changing patterns of agriculture, development, and rever-
    sion to forests. Since the 1950s, forest lands in the northeast and
    northcentral states have increased by almost 10 million acres,
    while the South has lost about 11 million acres (USDA, FS, 2001).
    Private forest lands are being converted to developed land uses
    faster than any other land type (USDA, NRCS^ 2001).

    Forest land management varies greatly depending on differences
   in ownership,  management intent, and desired outcomes, ranging
   from lands managed intact to protect water supplies, to harvesting
   for timber production. About 55 percent of the nation's forest
   lands are in private ownership (USDA, FS, 2002). Most forest
   lands are managed for a mix of uses, such as recreation, timber
   harvest, grazing, and mining. In the southern and eastern U.S.,
   most forest land is privately held in relatively small holdings,
   while in the Rocky Mountains and western U.S., most forest Ian
   d is in large blocks of  public ownership in national forests
   (Exhibit 3-10). As previously noted, ownership affects how lands
   are managed and used.
                                                   ~*  exhibit 3-10: Forest land ownership by region, 2001
                                                   ^--250
                                                           . _t>iorth __ r_Squth    Rocky   Pacific
                                                  fc               ~       Mountains  Coast
                                                  {^Source USDA, U. S, Forest Service. Draft Resource Planning Act Assessment Tables.
                                                  1 May 3; 2002 (updatedAugust 12, 2002).
                                                   ^(September 2003; http://www.nm.^.fed.us/480T/FIADB/rpaJabler/
                                                  ^ Draft_RPA_2002Jorest_Resource_Tables.pdf).

                                                  About 76 million acres, or 10 percent of the nation's forests are
                                                  "reserved" and managed as national parks or wilderness areas
                                                  (USDA, FS, 2002). These estimates of reserves include state
                                                  and federal parks and wilderness areas, but do not include
                                                  conservation easements, areas protected by non-governmental
                                                  organizations, or most urban and community parks and reserves.
                                                  There are significant regional differences in the amount of forest
                                                  reserves. In the West, reserves are common, comprising nearly 18
                                                  percent of the total forest area. Much of the protected forest in
                                                  the West is in stands over 100 years old. Only 3 percent of
                                                  eastern forests are in reserves such  as parks and wilderness
                                                  (USDA, FS, 2001),
Chapter 3 - Better Protected Land
                                        3.1 Land Use
                                                                                                                          3-19

-------

Indicator
Extent of forest area, ownership, and management - Ca
    ,,      j
^continued;

 About 66 million acres, or 9 percent of forest lands, are man-
 aged by private forest industries to produce timber (USDA, FS,
 2002). Much of the remaining forest land receives less intensive
 management activity, such as periodic harvest of mature timber.
 Approximately S03  million acres of public and private forest
 land are currently classified as timberlands by the USDA Forest
 Service, an increase of 17 million acres since 1987 (USDA, FS,
 2002). Approximately 63 percent of all U.S. timber harvesting is
 conducted in the South, predominately from private lands. Total
 timber harvest increased substantially between  1976 and 2001
 in the East. In the West, after increasing steadily from  1952 to
  1986, timber harvesting on public lands has declined sharply.
  Public lands harvested nationwide dropped nearly 47  percent
  from 1976 to 2001, to less than 2 billion cubic feet per year. In
  the same time frame, private lands harvested increased by about
  29 percent, from 11 to 14 billion cubic feet annually. (USDA, FS,
  2002) (Exhibit 3-11).

        Exhibit 3-11: Timber removals in the United States      •;
                  by owner group, 1Q52-2001
                                     1986
                                              1996  2001
          19S2     1962       1976
   Source: USD*. U, S. Forest Service. Draft Resource Planning Act Assessment Tables.
   May 3, 2002 (tifxfcted August 12, 2002). (September 2003; http://www.nm.fs.fed.us/
   Between 1980 and 1990, approximately 10 million acres were
   harvested annually. Of the public and private forest lands
   harvested for timber approximately 62 percent are selectively cut,
   while 38 percent are clearcut. Most of the clearcutting occurs in
   the South (USDA, FS, 2001).
                                                  Indicator Gaps  and Limitations

                                                  Limitations for this indicator include the following:
                                                  • The data for this indicator were collected by the USFS FIA
                                                    program; Forest Industry and Analysis (FlA) currently provides
                                                    updates of assessment data every five years. Field data are
                                                    collected on a probability sample of 125,000 forested sites and
                                                    extended to a  remote sensing database on 450,000 sites by
                                                    the FIA program (Smith, et al., 2001). The resulting data on
                                                    extent have an uncertainty of 3 to 10 percent per million acres
                                                    for data reported since 1953. Regional estimates have errors of
                                                     less than two percent (The Heinz Center, 2002).
                                                   BThe FIA delta on reserved lands do not include information on
                                                     private lands that are legally reserved from harvest, such as
                                                     lands held by  private groups for conservation purposes. In
                                                     addition, other forest lands are at times reserved from harvest
                                                     because of administrative or other restrictions.

                                                   Data Source

                                                   The  data for this indicator are from tine Draft Resource
                                                   Planning and Assessment Tables,  U.S.  Department of Agriculture,
                                                   Forest Service, 2002. (See Appendix B, page B-20, for
                                                   more information.)
                                                         USDA Forest Service Definitions
                                                             v    •     '            .......     .    .
                                                     Forest lar. d. Land that is at least 10 percent stocked by forest
                                                     trees of af;y size, including land that formerly riad tree cover
                                                     and that will be naturally or artificially regenerated. The mini-
                                                     mum area,: for classification of forest land is 1 acre.
                                                             ill.1"n  '           '      '     :       ...
                                                     Timber l^nd. Forest land that is capable of producing crops
                                                     of industrial wood (at least 20 cubic feet per acre per year in
                                                     natural stands) and not withdrawn'from timber utilization by
                                                     statute orfadministrative regulation.

                                                     Reservec forest land. Forest land withdrawn from timber
                                                     utilizatior through statute,  administrative regulation, or
                                                     designation. (USDA, FS, April 2001)
 3-20
                                                         3.1  Land Use
                                                                           Chapter 3 - Better Protected Land

-------
    3.1.5  What  human health  effects
    are  associated ^ith  land  use?
  Land development patterns have direct and indirect effects on air
  and water quality, which can then affect human health. For example,
  the increased concentration of air pollutants in developed areas can
  exacerbate human health problems like asthma. Increased storm
  water runoff from impervious surfaces threatens the waterbodies that
  urban and suburban residents rely on for drinking and recreation.
  Development patterns can affect quality of life by limiting recreation-
  al opportunities, decreasing open space, and increasing vehicle miles
  traveled and the amount of time spent on roads. Also, as discussed
  later, agricultural land uses may expose humans to dust and various
  chemicals. No specific indicators have been identified  at this time.

  Land use also can have indirect effects on air quality. Low-density
  patterns of development can often increase commutes—more
  people drive more miles. "Heat islands," or domes of warmer air over
  urban and suburban areas, are caused by the loss of trees and
  shrubs and the absorption of more heat by pavement, buildings, and
  other sources. Heat islands can affect local, regional, and global
  climate, as well as air quality. Agricultural land uses also result in
  increased  wind erosion. Degraded air quality can contribute to  '
  human health issues such  as asthma. Additional discussion  of the
  effects of  land uses on air and water quality, human health, and the
  environment is included in other chapters.
   3.1.6 What  ecological  effects  are
   associated  with land use?
  Indicator
  Sediment runoff potential from croplands and pasturelands
 Land use and land management practices change the landscape in
 many ways that have both direct and indirect ecological effects. One
 direct effect is the loss or conversion of acres of certain cover or
 ecosystem types to other more human-oriented, land uses such as
 developed and agricultural uses. Indirect effects may include changes
 in runoff patterns or increased soil erosion.

 The 25 million acre increase in developed land that occurred
 between 1982 and 1997 came about through the conversion of
 about 10 million acres of forest land, 7 million acres of agricultural
 land, 4 million acres of pastureland, 4 million acres of rangeland, and
 1 million acres of various other land cover types including wetlands .
 (USDA, NRCS, 1997). The causes of wetland loss are detailed in
 Chapter 2, Purer Water. Changing land use patterns have also affect-
 ed the extent and location of agricultural land. Between 1982 and
           1997, approximately 13.6 million acres were converted from cropland
           to other uses, including 7.1  million acres converted to developed
           land. At the same time, approximately 4 million acres of rangeland
           were converted to more intensive crop uses (USDA, NRCS, 2000a):
           The conversions of land from agricultural, forest land, and rangeland
           cover types to developed land can affect different species in specific
           locations that depend on those cover types for habitat and food.
           Species effects in various ecosystems are discussed in more detail in
           Chapter 5, Ecological Condition.

           Land development also creates  impervious surfaces through
           construction of roads, parking lots, and other structures. Impervious
           surfaces contribute to non-point source water pollution  by limiting
           the capacity of soils to filter runoff. Impervious surface areas also '
           affect peak flow and water volume, which heighten erosion potential
           and affect habitat.and water quality (e.g., temperature increases).
           They also affect ground water aquifer recharge. With  sufficient storm
           water infrastructure, higher population density in concentrated areas
           can reduce water quality impacts from impervious surfaces by
           accommodating more people and more housing units on less land
           and developing water runoff systems that address issues  of
           pollutants and sediment. Impervious surfaces developed  as the result
          of suburban or dispersed development patterns are more difficult to
          mitigate; given that the effects are more dispersed and development
          of runoff infrastructure is costly.

          Storm runoff from urban and suburban areas contains dirt, oils
          from road surfaces, nutrients from fertilizers, .and various  toxic com-
          pounds. Point source discharges from industrial and municipal
          wastewater treatment facilities can contribute toxic compounds and
          heated water. Directing water through channels alters hydrologic flow
          patterns. Increases in siltation and temperature can make  stream
          habitats unsuitable for native microinvertebrate and fish species.
          Changes in the nutrient and chemical composition of stream water
          can encourage growth of toxic algae and harmful organisms. The
          types of crops planted, tillage practices, and various irrigation
          practices can limit the amount of water available for other uses, such
          as municipal, industrial, and natural ecosystems. Livestock grazing in
          riparian zones also can change landscape conditions by reducing
          stream bank vegetation and increasing water temperatures,
          sedimentation, and nutrient levels. Runoff from pesticides, fertilizers,
          and nutrients from animal manure can also degrade water'quality.

         An  indirect ecological effect of land use is the introduction of
         invasive species. Certain land use practices, such as overgrazing, land
         conversion, fertilization, and the  use of agricultural chemicals can
         enhance the growth of invasive plants. Other human activities can
         result in unstable or disturbed environments and encourage the
         establishment of invasive plants. These activities include farming;
         creating highway and utility rights-of-way; clearing land for homes
         and recreation areas such as golf courses; and constructing ponds,
         reservoirs, and lakes (Westbrooks, 1998). Failure to manage invasive
         species can lead to a major threat to native ecosystems. Non-native
         species can alter fish and wildlife  habitat, contribute to decreases in
Chapter 3 - Better Protected Land
3.1 Land Use
                                                                                                                          3-21

-------

biodiversity, and create health risks to livestock and humans.
Introduction of invasive species on agricultural lands also can reduce
water quality and water availability for native fish and wildlife species;
clog lakes, waterways, and wetlands; weaken the ecosystem; and
adversely affect water treatment facilities and public water supplies.
Agricultural uses also can encourage the growth of invasive species
(USFWS, 2002).

Land practices related to development, timber harvest, and
agriculture can affect soil quality both positively and negatively.
Some agricultural practices encourage soil conservation, minimizing
                                                  effects on soil resources. These practices include organic farming;
                                                  creating buffer strips in riparian zones; tree planting for windbreaks
                                                  or to decrease water temperature to improve fish habitat; soil erosion
                                                  control; integrated pest management; and precision pesticide and
                                                  fertilizer application technology. In contrast, other agricultural
                                                  activities promote soil compaction or result in loss  of topsoil
                                                  through soil erosion. The indicator identified for this question
                                                  addresses the potential for sediment to run off from croplands and
                                                  pasturelands,,
  Indicator
Sediment runoff potential from croplands and pasturelar
35 - Category 2
   Soil erosion and transport can occur both by wind and by water
   and have several major effects on ecosystems. Sediment is the
   greatest pollutant in aquatic ecosystems—both by mass and
   volume—and soil erosion and transport are the source (EPA, OW,
   August 2002). Soil particles also can transport nutrients and
   pesticides into aquatic systems where they may degrade water
   quality. Although rates of erosion declined between 1982 and
    1997 by about 1.4 tons/acre, more than one-quarter of all
   croplands still suffer excessive wind and water erosion (USDA,
   NRCS, 2000f). Excessive is defined as exceeding tolerable rates as
   defined by USDA NRCS models (USDA, NRCS, 2000g).

   Agricultural soil erosion decreases soil quality and can reduce
    soil fertility, and soil movement can make normal cropping
    practices difficult (The Heinz Center, 2002). The loss of
    productive top soil and organic matter affects the productivity of
    agricultural lands. Further discussion on the extent and effects of
    soil erosion can be found in Chapter 2, Purer Water, and in
    Chapter 5, Ecological Condition.

    What the Data Show

    The potential for soil erosion and sediment runoff varies depend-
    ing on specific land use, rainfall amounts and intensity, soil
    characteristics, landscape characteristics, cropping patterns, and
    farm management practices. This indicator is the result of analyses
    conducted by combining land  cover, weather patterns, and soil
    information in a process model that incorporates  hydrologic
    cycling, weather, sedimentation, crop growth, pesticide and nutri-
    ent loading, and agricultural management to estimate the amount
    of sediment that could potentially be delivered to rivers and
    streams in each watershed. The simulation estimated sheet and rill
    erosion using a process model known as the Soil and Water
    Assessment Tool (SWAT).
                                                   SWAT is a model that is supported by the USDA Agricultural
                                                   Research Service. The sediment runoff data have been categorized
                                                   and are presented as low, medium, and high potential for runoff.

                                                   Exhibit 3-12 displays the distribution of watersheds (based on 8-
                                                   digit hydrologic unit codes [HUCs]) nationwide and the potential
                                                   for sediment runoff (or delivery to rivers and streams) from crop-
                                                   lands and pasturelands. The highest potential for sediment runoff
                                                   is concentrated in the central U.S., predominately associated with
                                                   the upper Mississippi River Valley and the Ohio River Valley. Most
                                                   of the western U.S. is characterized by low runoff potential (lower
                                                   percentage of cropland and pastureland).

                                                   Indicator Gaps and Limitations

                                                   This indicator has several limitations for:
                                                   • Sediment loads from non-agricultural land uses are not included
                                                      in these estimates.
                                                   • Estimate:; represent potential loadings to rivers and streams,
                                                      and do not represent in-stream loads.
                                                   • Gully ercision and channel erosion are not included.

                                                    Data Source

                                                   The Soil and Water Assessment Tool is a public domain model
                                                    actively supported by the U.S. Department of Agriculture,
                                                    Agricultural Research Service at the Grassland, Soil and Water
                                                    Research Liaboratory in Temple, Texas
                                                    (see http://www.brc.tamus.edu/swat/).
                                                    (See also Appendix B, page B-22, for more information.)
  3-22
                                                           3.1 Land Use
                                                                           Chapter 3 - Better Protected Land

-------
 Indicator
jeqiment runoff potential from croplands ana pasturelands - Category 2  (continued)
           txniDit  3-12: jediment runoff potential from croplands and pasturelands, 1990-1995
      Watershed Classification (number of watersheds)
      JPTI Low Potential for Delivery (528)
      |   " j Moderate Potential for Delivery (1,048)
      |—;: j High Potential for Delivery (530)
      ggg] Insufficient data (156)
       Hawaii
                                                                                                  Puerto Rico/U.S. Virgin Islands
  |:
  •kSource: Walker, C. Sediment Runoff Potential, 1990-1995. August 24,1999.
  |f '(September, 2002; http://www.epa.gov/iwi/l999sept/iv12c_usmap.htmr).
Chapter 3 - Better Protected Land
                                         3.1  Land Use
3-23

-------
                                3.. I .ssiGiJaii s5BEHBiii$*?frR''^"V7?
3.2  Gi
Land
     emicais  in
scape
This section focuses on the extent, potential disposition, and effects
of chemicals used or managed on land. The production and use of
chemicals in the U.S. has increased over the last 50 years. The use
and release of chemicals can have various effects on human health
and ecological condition. Commercial and industrial processes such
as mining, manufacturing, and the generation of electricity all use
and release chemicals. Chemicals that control weeds, insects,
rodents, fungi, bacteria, and other organisms are called pesticides
and are commonly used on agricultural lands, as well as in urban,
industrial, and residential settings. Fertilizers—supplements to
improve plant growth—are also used extensively in a variety of
settings. Pesticides and fertilizers have contributed to high
agricultural productivity levels in the U.S.

EPA began monitoring the production and importation of industrial
chemicals in 1977 through the Toxics Substances Control Act
Chemical Inventory, which presently identifies more than 76,000
chemicals used in U.S. commerce. Nearly 10,000 of these chemicals
are produced or imported in quantities greater than 10,000 pounds
per year (excluding inorganics, polymers, microorganisms, naturally
occurring substances, and non-isolated intermediaries). About 3,100
of these chemicals are produced or imported in quantities exceeding
1 million pounds per year. Associated annual production/import
volumes increased  by 570 billion pounds (9.3 percent) to 6.7
trillion pounds between 1990 and 1998 (EPA, OPPTS, 2002).

The questions posed in this section consider the amounts and types
of chemicals released to the landscape, addressing toxic substances,
pesticides, and fertilizers. The discussion also looks at the potential
for chemicals to move from their use on land to places where humans
and other organisms can be exposed to them. In this context,
questions also address what is currently known about health and
ecological effects from exposure to chemicals used on land.
The six questions considered in this section are:

H How much and what types of toxic substances are released into
  the environment?
| What is th(5 volume, distribution, and extent of pesticide use?
| What is the volume, distribution, and extent of fertilizer use?
H What is the potential disposition of chemicals from land?
• What human health effects are associated with pesticides,
  fertilizers, iind toxic substances?      ;
• What ecological effects are associated with pesticides, fertilizers,
  and toxic substances?               |

The primary sources of data for this section are the EPA Toxics
Release Inventory (TRI), describing quantities of toxic chemical
releases; pesticide use estimates (based on sales) from both EPA and
the non-profit National Center for Food and Agricultural Policy
(NCFAP); data from the USDA's Agricultural Resources and
Environmental Indicators report published in 2000 on the volume,
distribution, land extent of fertilizer use (see Appendix B); and data
from the USDA Pesticide Data Program on pesticide residues found
on food samples.
                                                       •» • *» • "•»  ii >-'!' "l:'  ' >  i   ••"• ••'• 
-------
 Indicator
Quantity ana type of toxic chemicals released and managed - Category 2
  The data collected in TRI represent only part of a broader
  universe of chemicals used and released into the environment.
  TRI includes a large amount of information on a range of
  categories of toxic chemicals, including many arsenic, cyanide,
  dioxin, lead, mercury, and nitrate compounds and provides
  information on the amount and trends in releases and
  management of chemicals, including recycling, recovery, and
  treatment. TRI data cover releases from reporting facilities in all
  parts of the country and can be searched for releases within
  individual zip codes. All data presented below can be found in
  the EPA 2000 Toxics Release Inventory Public Data Release Report
  (EPA, OEI, May 2002).

  What  the Data  Show

  Releases to the environment for all EPA-tracked TRI chemicals
  from nearly 23,500 facilities totaled 7 billion pounds in  2000. Of
  these releases, 58 percent were to land, 27 percent were to air, 4
  percent each were to water and underground injection at the
  generating facility, and 7 percent were chemicals disposed of
  off-site to land or underground injection. Three industries
  accounted for most of the releases: metal mining (27 facilities)
                                                           ...'. txnibit 3-15:  lotal toxic release inventory
                                                                   (TIM) releases by industry, 200O
                                                              -'-   -    :  (Total = 7 billion pounds)
                                                              Metal Mining: 47%
                                                         Chemical Wholesale
                                                         Distributors: <1 %
                                                         Petroleum Terminals/
                                                         Bulk Storage: <1 %
                                                         Coal Mining: <1 %
                                                     Manufacturing
                                                     Industries: 32%
                                                 Electric Utilities: 16%
                                          Hazardous Waste/
                                          Solvent Recovery: 4%
      txnibit 3-W-: loxics release inventory (I T\l) total releases and change by industry, 1998-2000
             learly Totals Across Industry
       Source: EPA, Office of Environmental Information. 2000 Toxics Release Inventory (T)U) Public Data Release Report. May 2002.
                                                     feSSciuree: .EPA, Office of Environmental Information. 2000 Toxics Release Inventory
                                                     6 (TR/I Public Data Release Report. May 2002.

                                                     accounted for 47 percent, manufacturing industries (21,352
                                                     facilities) for 32 percent, and electric utilities (706 facilities) for
                                                     16 percent. The remaining 5 percent was split among hazardous
                                                                                   waste/solvent recovery, coal
                                                                               ,   mining, petroleum terminals/bulk
                                                                                   storage, and chemical wholesale
                                                                                   distributors (Exhibit 3- 13).
                                                                                   Between 1998 and 2000, the
                                                                                   total amount of toxic releases as ,
                                                                                   estimated by the TRI decreased
                                                                                   by approximately 409 million  •
                                                                                   pounds, or 5.5 percent. Of that
                                                                                   total, releases to land decreased
                                                                                   approximately 276 million ,
                                                                                   pounds. Decreases in the
                                                                                   releases by certain industries
                                                                                   (e.g., manufacturing and metal
                                                                                   mining) account for most of the
                                                                                   overall decrease between 1998
                                                                                   and 2000. A few industries
                                                                                   (e.g., hazardous waste/solvent
                                                                                   recovery, coal mining, and chemi-
                                                                                   cal wholesale distributors)
                                                                                   increased their releases during
                                                                                   this time period. Off-site releases
                                                                                   from production increased by 75
                                                                                   million pounds in the 1998 to
                                                                                   2000 time frame (Exhibit 3-14).
Change ty Industry, I998-2OOO
Chapter 3 - Better Trotected Land          3.2 Chemicals in the Landscape
                                                                                                               3-25

-------
Indicator
               Quantity and type of toxic chemicals released and managed - Category 2 (continued)
   The seven billion pounds of chemicals actually released into the
   environment (air, water, and land) are a subset of toxic chemicals
   managed and tracked In TRI. Another 31 billion pounds of toxic
   chemicals were managed as waste in 2000. Nearly all (>99  per-
   cent) of these toxic chemicals were production related, Of the 31
   billion pounds, SO percent was treated, 39 percent was recycled,
   and 11 percent was burned for energy recovery.

   The total amount of toxic chemicals managed as waste during the
   three-year period of 1998 to 2000 increased by almost 29
   percent, a net increase of 8.4 billion pounds (Exhibit 3-15). Two
   industries in the southeastern U.S., printing/publishing and chemi-
   cals and allied products, accounted for most of this increase.
   Between 1998 and 2000, the chemicals recycled increased by
   more than 12 percent (1.3 billion pounds). In contrast, the

       Exhibit 3-15: Trends in toxic chemicals 1998-2000
             • Energy Recovery • Quantify Released
             B Quantify Treated • Recycled
                1998
                                1999
                                                2000
     Note: The dJtJ shown ss "Quantify Released" vary from the data in Exhibit 3-14
     tx£4Ulc some facilities include off-site transfers for disposal to other TRI facilities
     Hut then report the arrount as on-site release.

     Source: EPA, Office of Environmental Information. 2000 Toxics Release Inventory
     (TRI) Public Data Rekasn Report. May 2002.
  quantities of chemicals combusted for energy recovery decreased
  4.1 percent.

  The TRI data are also used to support EPA's National Waste
  Minimization Partnership Program, which focuses on reducing or
  eliminating the generation of hazardous waste containing any of
  30 Waste Minimization Priority Chemicals (WMPC). These chemi-
  cals are found in hazardous waste and are documented contami-
  nants of air, land, water, plants and animals. EPA has tracked 17 of
  these chemicals since 1991 and reports that WMPC generation
  quantities have been steadily declining since  1993 (Exhibit 3-16).
                                                                 Overall, between 1991 and 1998, the generation of WMPC in
                                                                 industrial hazardous and solid waste decreased by 44 percent.

                                                                 Indicator Gaps and Limitations

                                                                 The TRI data do not reflect a comprehensive total of toxic
                                                                 releases nationwide. Although EPA has added to the  number of
                                                                 industries (SIC codes) that must report, the TRI program does
                                                                 not cover all releases of chemicals from all industries. Second,
                                                                 industries are: not required to report the release of several types
                                                                 of toxic chemicals, because these chemicals are not included in
                                                                 the TRI list, "Hiird, facilities that do not meet the TRI reporting
                                                                 requirements (those with fewer than 10 full-time employees or the
                                                                    Waste Minimization Priority Chemicals

                                                                  Organic chemicals and chemical compounds:
                                                                  *1,2,4-Trichlorobenzene
                                                                  1,2,4,5-Tejrachlorpbenzene
                                                                  *2,4,5-Trichlorophenol
                                                                  4-BromopqenyI phenyl  ether
                                                                  Acenaphtherie
                                                                  Acenaphthjflene
                                                                  *Anthracerie
                                                                  Benzo (g,h,tt perylene
                                                                  *Dibenzofiiran
                                                                  Dioxins/FuBris (considered one chemical on this list)
                                                                  Endosulfarfij alpha & Endosulfan, beta (considered one chemi-
                                                                  cal on this list)
                                                                  Fluorene  "!              "        .-•...'.         ',
                                                                  *Heptachlor & Heptachlor epoxide (considered one chemical
                                                                  on this list);       1"" 'v";'	"	"  '   ' "''   "	'  "'  'i'"   '"	"
                                                                  "Hexachlorpbenzene
                                                                  "Hexachlorpbutadiene
                                                                  *Hexachlorocyclohexane, gamma-
                                                                  *Hexachlorpethane
                                                                  *Methoxyc|jlor
                                                                  *Naphthalene
                                                                  PAH Group: (as defined  in TRI)
                                                                  Pendimetha'lin
                                                                  Pentachlorcibenzene
                                                                  *Pentachlorpnitrobenzene
                                                                  *Pentachlorophenol
                                                                  Phenanthrepe
                                                                  Pyrene
                                                                  *Trifluralin

                                                                  Metal and Metal Compounds:
                                                                  *Cadmium j
                                                                  *Lead
                                                                  *Mercury

                                                                  (*17 chemicals tracked since 1991)
3-26
                                               3.2 Chemicals in the Landscape         Chapter 3 - Detter Trotected Land

-------
                                                                                           ^^^
                                                                                         •••  --.  •• >•« •-    •.,. •     ..'-   -•
-..,^..^..,^,,..,..:> .
   Indicator
Quantity ana type of toxic chemicals released and managed - Category 2 (continued)
      Exhibit 3-16: Trends in toxics release inventory (TRI) Waste
      Minimization Priority Qemicals (WMPO, 1991-1998
       200
       ISO
       100
        SO
                          +1%
                                                           -44%
            1991
                          1993
                                       199S
                                                   1997    1998
           Source: EPA, Office of Solfd Waste and Emergency Response.
           Waste Minimization Trends Report (1991-1998). September 2002.
                                                   employee equivalent, or those not meeting TRI chemical-specific
                                                   reporting threshold amounts) are not required to report their
                                                   releases and therefore are not included as part of the total. Finally,
                                                   facilities report their release and other waste management data to
                                                   TRI using monitoring data, emission factors, mass balance
                                                   approaches and engineering calculations. EPA does not mandate
                                                   monitoring of releases, although many industries do conduct
                                                   monitoring. Various estimation techniques are used when monitor-
                                                   ing data are not available. EPA has published estimation guidance
                                                   for the regulated community, but not all industrial facilities use
                                                   consistent estimation methodologies, and variations in reporting
                                                   may result. With approximately 76,000 different types of chemi-
                                                   cals in existence, and new ones constantly being developed, the
                                                   challenge is to ensure that those that are likely to pose the
                                                   greatest hazards are tracked and managed.

                                                   Data Source

                                                   The data source for this indicator is EPA, Toxics Release Inventory,
                                                   2000.  (See Appendix B, page B-20, for more information.)
    3.2.2 What is the volume,
    distribution,  and extent of
    pesticide use?
   Indicator
   Agricultural pesticide Use
  Pesticides are substances or mixtures of substances intended for
  preventing, destroying, repelling, or mitigating plant or animal pests.
  Conventional pesticides include herbicides, plant growth regulators,
  insecticides, fungicides, nematicides, fumigants, rodenticides, mollus-
  cicides, aquatic pesticides, and fish/bird pesticides. Most pesticides
  create some risk of harm to humans, animals, or the environment
  because they are designed to kill or otherwise adversely affect living
  organisms. At the same time, pesticides are useful to society because
  of their ability to kill potential disease-causing organisms and control
  insects, weeds, and other pests.

  Currently, no reporting system provides information on  the volume,
  distribution, and extent of pesticide use nationwide across all
  sectors.  Estimates, however, of total pesticide use have been devel-
  oped based on available information such as crop profiles, pesticide
  sales, and expert surveys. Several of these data sets are  collected by
  the private or non-profit sectors rather than federal agencies.
                                                   EPA's recent Pesticide Industry Sales and Usage Report estimates show
                                                   that conventional annual pesticide use declined by about IS percent
                                                   between 1980 and 1999. This change has not been steady; in 1999,
                                                   pesticide use was higher than it was in the early 1990s. Of the three
                                                   sectors of pesticide use assessed in EPA estimates (agricultural,
                                                   industry-commercial-government, and home-garden), the industrial-
                                                   commercial-government use of pesticides has seen the most steady
                                                   decline over this 20-year period. EPA estimates show that in 1999,
                                                   agricultural pesticide use accounted for nearly 77 percent (956 million
                                                   pounds) of all pesticide use; home and garden use was 11 percent
                                                   (140 million pounds); and industrial, commercial, and government
                                                   use was nearly 12 percent (148 million pounds) of total conventional
                                                   pesticide use (1244 million pounds). These estimates do not
                                                   include wood preservatives, biocides, and chlorine/hypochlorites
                                                   (EPA, OPPTS, 2002).

                                                   An important class of pesticides—insecticides—has undergone
                                                   significant use reduction in the  last 5 years. Insecticides, as a class,
                                                   tend to be the most acutely toxic pesticides to humans and wildlife.
                                                   The number of individual chemical treatments per acre, referred to
                                                   as "acre-treatments," for insecticides labeled "danger for humans"
                                                   has undergone a 43 percent reduction in use from 1997 to 2001.
                                                   Over the same period, acre-treatments for insecticides labeled
                                                   "extremely or highly toxic to birds" have been reduced by
                                                   SO percent, and insecticides labeled "extremely or highly toxic to
                                                   aquatic organisms" have been reduced by 23 percent (EPA, OPP,
                                                   2001). The indicator identified for this question specifically
                                                   addresses agricultural pesticide use.
  Chapter 3 - Better Protected Land          3.2 Chemicals in the Landscape
                                                                                                           3-27

-------
  Indicator
Agricultural  pesticide use - Category 2
   Building on EPA and USDA estimates, as well as on pesticide use
   surveys, the National Center for Food and Agricultural Policy
   (NCFAP), a private, non-profit, research organization, has
   established a pesticide use database that provides estimates of
   agricultural pesticide use by chemical, crop, and state.

   What the Data  Show

   According to NCFAP, and as shown in Exhibit 3-17, total
   agricultural pesticide use increased from 892 to 985 million
   pounds between 1992 and 1997. (EPA reports  a similar increase in
   use of all pesticides in this same time frame, and a leveling of use
   between 1997 and 1999.) (EPA, OPPTS, 2002). Approximately
   half of these agricultural pesticides are herbicides used to control
   weeds that limit or inhibit the growth of the desired crop. While
   many pesticides are synthetic chemicals, some  biopesticides, such
   as Bacillus thuringiensis, are also broadly used and are key
   components of organic farming programs.

   The 1997 NCFAP summary report shows that more pesticides are
   used on corn than on any other crop. At the same time, corn is
   planted on more acres than any other single crop. It is also most
   effectively treated with a combination of chemicals that are
   applied in high  quantities per acre.

   Oil, most often applied as a spray, is  used in greater quantities
   than any other pesticide across all crops. In the context of the
   NCFAP report, "oil" includes plant oil extracts with insecticidal
   properties, vegetable oils that work by smothering pests, and
   petroleum derivatives used as solvents and insecticides. Sulfur—
   through its broad applicability as  an insecticide, fungicide, and
   rodenticide—and atrazine, largely due to its use with corn,  are
   the next two most commonly used chemicals.
                                                   Indicator Gaps and  Limitations

                                                   Limitations for this indicator include the following:
                                                   • The data quality of the NCFAP national pesticide use database
                                                     is unknown. The database is not a direct record based on
                                                     reports of actual usage and application. Some of the database
                                                     estimates are derived from surveys of farmers, and others are
                                                     expert opinions from knowledgeable extension service special-
                                                     ists. Also, because of the absence of data for many states and
                                                     crops, many records have been assigned based on the data
                                                     from a nearby state. It is unclear how accurate these sources
                                                     and procedures are. The 1997 summary report for the database
                                                     carefully makes no claims to statistical accuracy because of the
                                                     variety of «,ources and techniques for estimation of chemical
                                                     usage. Several federal agencies, however, use the information,
                                                     and NCFAP has received funding from USDA to update the
                                                     pesticide use database for 2002 (Gianessi and Marcelli, 2000).
                                                   • NCFAP data only report on the agricultural use of pesticides,
                                                     which leaves out other commercial non-agricultural and residen-
                                                     tial applications. Additional data would be advantageous for
                                                     tracking these uses of pesticides.

                                                   Data Source

                                                   The data source for this indicator is the National Center for Food
                                                   and Agricultural Policy's Pesticide Use  Database, 2000. (See
                                                   Appendix B, page B-21, for more information.)
                                                                     1200
                                                             'rtxjiibit 3-17: fesjiicide use in crop
                                                             ||»  production, 1992 and 1997
                                                                    lurce: Gianessi. jSj'anHlvlB Marcelli Pesticide Use in U S Qog "Production:"19J7,
                                                                    itiofial S.umma'iy Re/sort. November 2CJOC)
3-28
                                3.2 Chemicals in the Landscape         C-napter 3 - Detter Trotected  Land

-------
   3.2.3  What is  the volume,
   distribution,  and  extent  of
   fertilizer use?
  Indicator
  Fertilizer use
 Fertilizers have contributed to an increase in commercial agricultural
 productivity in the U.S. throughout the latter half of the 20th
century. Using fertilizers and soil amendments, farmers have success-
fully enhanced the productivity of marginal soils and shortened
recovery times for damaged areas. Similar to pesticide use, however,
the increasing use of commercial fertilizers in agriculture has
consequences for human health and ecological condition. Between
World War II and the early 1980s, commercial fertilizer use increased
consistently and significantly (Battaglin and Goolsby, 1994).
Fertilizer use patterns today are greatly influenced by crop patterns,
economic and climatic factors, and crop reduction programs imple-
mented by local and federal government agencies (Council on
Environmental Quality, 1993). The indicator identified for this
question specifically addresses the volume, distribution, and extent
of fertilizer use.
^ffi^^™ fertilizer use - Category 2
Most data on the volume and distribution of fertilizer use are
based on sales data collected by USDA. Usage is concentrated
heavily in the midwestern states where agricultural production —
particularly that of corn — is greatest.
What the Data Show
According to the 2000 USDA Agricultural Resources and Environmental
Indicators Report, the use of nitrogen, phosphorus, and potash — the
most prevalent supplements used in fertilizers for commercial farm-
ing — rose from 7.5 million nutrient tons in 1961 to 23.7 million tons
in 1981 . Although aggregate use dipped in 1983, it increased most
recently between 1996 and 1998 to more than 22 million nutrient
tons (Daberkow, et al, 2003) (Exhibit 3-18).
Indicator Gaps and Limitations
Several limitations are associated with this indicator:
• The data that do exist are based primarily on sales information
and use estimates. Gross sales data are not necessarily a reflec-
tion of fertilizer usage, nor do they convey any information
about the efficiency of application of various nutrients.
• A variety of factors such as weather and crop type influence the
amount of fertilizer used by farmers from year to year. A
decrease in usage over time may be due to a reduced reliance
on these chemicals or a change in crop rotation, weather, or
other factors, and may not be permanent.
• These data do not necessarily reflect residential fertilizer use.
f: Exhibit 3-18: Use of fertilizer, 1960-1998
i-.- 	 	 . . . . . .
1 — Total
f - — Nitrogen - ^S\
" — Phosphorus . . f^ \
-Potash /\/ \ 1-
'" I \ /
yv V
i. / -/^
\ _- /^~

/^_^
X^_^- — -'' "
"-""" ^^=^\ ^
0 — 1 — 1 — 1 — 1 — 1 — 1 — 1 — l — 	 i i i < i i i i r i i i
* \ f r i i i i i i i i t
j|._ 1960 1962 1964 1966 1968 1970.1972 1974 1976 1978 1980 1982 1984 1986 1988 1990 1992 1994 1996 1998
1 Source: Daberkow, et al. Agricultural Resources and Environmental Indicators: Nutrient Use and Management. February 2003.

Data Source
, The data source for this
indicator is the Agricultural
Resources and Environmental
- Indicators Report, U.S.
Department of Agriculture,
Economic Research Service,
. 2000. (See Appendix B,
page B-21 , for more
information.)
• S
' g

Chapter 3 - Better Protected Land         3.2 Chemjcals in the Landscape
                                                    3-29

-------
  3.2.4 What is the potential
  disposition of chemicals from
  land?
 indicators
 Pesticide residues in food
 Potential pesticide runoff from farm fields
 Risk of nitrogen export
 Risk of phosphorus export
Disposition describes the potential for chemicals and nutrients to
move from their location of use or origin to a place in the environ-
ment where humans and other organisms can be exposed to them.
People can be affected by these chemicals and nutrients when
exposed to them through foods, drinking water supplies, or in the
air they breathe. The environment can be affected when these chem-
kals accumulate on land or enter the water. A significant challenge
lies in tracking the movement of pesticides and fertilizers in the
environment and then correlating their existence in water or air to
health or environmental effects. These chemicals often move
through the environment and react in ways that are difficult to track
and understand.

Pesticide contamination of ground water is a  potential problem when
teachable pesticides are applied to soils. Soil  leaching potential can
be determined by assigning rankings to organic matter, clay content,
and acidify, which are the three main factors controlling pesticide
leaching through soils (Hellkamp, et al., 1998). Pesticide-leaching
potential is a measure of how tightly and quickly a pesticide binds to
organic particles and is determined by the leaching potential of the
                                                  pesticide itself, the pesticide's persistence, and the rate and method
                                                  of application. Some analysis of the pesticide leaching risk based on
                                                  these variables has been conducted in .the mid-Atlantic region,
                                                  showing that relatively little acreage has a high potential for leach-
                                                  ing. Other variables should also be considered in assessing the risk
                                                  of pesticide leaching including precipitation, antecedent soil
                                                  moisture conditions, soil hydraulic conductivities and pe'rmeability,
                                                  and water table depths.

                                                  Under ideal circumstances, crops would iake up the vast majority of
                                                  nutrients that are applied as fertilizers to  soil, but many factors,
                                                  including weather, overall plant health, and pests, affect the uptake
                                                  ability of crops. When crops do not use all applied nutrients, resid-
                                                  ual concentrations of nutrients and other components of chemical
                                                  fertilizers  remain in the soil and can become concentrated in ground
                                                  water and surface water. The USGS National Water Quality
                                                  Assessment provides one measure of these chemical concentrations
                                                  in waterbodies based on samples from 36 major river basins and
                                                  aquifers (see Chapter 2, Purer Water). Calculating residual concen-
                                                  trations (known as the "residual balance") for agricultural areas
                                                  provides an understanding of the potential risks fertilizer use poses
                                                  to  local environmental conditions. If the residual balance is positive,
                                                  then excessive nutrients may exist and present an ecological risk.
                                                  If it is negative, then plants are taking up not only the amount of
                                                  nutrient added by the fertilizer but others already present in the
                                                  soil and atmosphere. In this case, the soil might be depleted over
                                                  time (Vesterby, 2003).

                                                  Four indicators are considered on the following pages, one that
                                                  measures the actual presence of chemicals in  food,  and three that
                                                  assess the potential for pesticides and nutrients to runoff the land.
  Indicator
Pesticide residues in food - Category I
   An indication of the amount of pesticides that are detectable in
   the U.S. food supply provides information about the disposition
   of some chemicals. Food is one of the pathways through which
   people can be exposed to the effects of pesticides. USDA has
   maintained a Pesticide Data Program (POP) since 1992 that
   collects data on pesticide residues on fruits, vegetables, grains,
   and in dairy products at terminal markets and warehouses.
   Thousands of samples have been analyzed for more than 100
   pesticides and their metabolites on dozens of commodities.
   Samples are collected by USDA immediately prior to these
   commodities being shipped to grocery stores and supermarkets.
   They are then prepared in the laboratory as if for consumption
   (e.g., washed, peeled, cored, but not cooked) so that samples are
                                                   more likely to reflect actual exposures. Pesticide residue levels
                                                   are then measured.

                                                   What the  Data Show
                                                                                       I

                                                   The Department of Agriculture's Pesticide Data Program (POP)
                                                   measures pesticide residue levels in fruits, vegetables, grains, and
                                                   dairy products from across the country, sampling different
                                                   commodities each year. In  2000, POP collected and analyzed a
                                                   total of 10,907 samples: 8,912 fruits and vegetables, 178 rice,
                                                   716 peanut butter, and 1,101  poultry tissue samples which origi-
                                                   nated from 38 States and  21 foreign countries. Approximately 80
                                                   percent  of all samples were domestic, 19 percent were imported,
3-30
                                 3.2 Chemicals in the Landscape         Chapter 3 - Better Protected Land

-------
 Indicator
Pesticide residues in food - C-ategory 1 (continued)
  and less than 1  percent were of unknown origin. Overall,
  approximately 42 percent of all samples contained no detectable
  residues, 22 percent contained 1 residue, and 35 percent con-
  tained more than 1 residue. Detectable residues are not inherently
  violations of regulatory tolerances. Residues exceeding the
  pesticide tolerance were detected in 0.2 percent of all composite
  samples. Residues with no tolerance level were found in 1.2
  percent of all samples. These residues were detected at low
  concentrations and may be due to spray drift, crop rotations, or
  cross contamination at packing facilities. PDF reports these
  findings to the Food and Drug Administration.

  Indicator  Gaps and Limitations

  Limitations for this indicator include the following:
  • The POP does not sample all commodities over all years, so
     some gaps in coverage exist. For example, a specific commodity
     might be sampled each year for a two or three year period and
     then not be sampled for two or more years before being
     re-sampled during a subsequent period. Differences in the per-
     cent of detections for any given class of pesticides might not
     be due to an  increase (or decrease) in the predominance of
     detectable residues, but might simply reflect the changing
     nature and identity of the commodities selected for inclusion in
     any given  time frame (given that each POP "market basket" of
     goods differs to some extent over time).
  • The PDF has  the ability to detect pesticide residues at
     concentrations that are orders of magnitude lower than those
     determined to have human health effects. The simple presence
     of detectable pesticide residues in foods  should not be
     considered indicative of a  potential health concern (USDA,
     AMS, 2002).
                                                  Data Source

                                                  The data source for this indicator is the Pesticide Data Program:
                                                  Annual Summary Calendar Year 2000, U.S. Department of
                                                  Agriculture, Agricultural Marketing Service. (See Appendix B,
                                                  page B-21, for more information.)
Chapter 3 - Better Protected Land         3.2 Chemicals in the Landscape
                                                                                                         3-31

-------
MESS?
  Indicator
Toteritial pesticide runoff from Farm fields - Category 2
   This indicator identifies the potential for movement of agricultural
   pesticides by surface water runoff in watersheds nationwide. The
   indicator represents potential loss at the edge of a field based on
   factors that are known to be important determinants of pesticide
   loss, including: 1) soil characteristics, 2) historical pesticide use,
   3) chemical properties of the pesticides used, 4) annual rainfall
   and its relationship to runoff, and 5) major field crops grown
   using 1992 as a baseline. Watersheds with high scores (i.e., the
   "high potential for delivery" class) have a greater risk of pesticide
   contamination of surface water than do those with low scores
   (i.e., the "low potential for delivery" class). (See Section  3.1.6 for
   more on runoff categories.)
                                                     Calculations for watershed pesticide runoff potential are based on
                                                     a National Pesticide Loss Database, that uses the chemical fate
                                                     and transport: model GLEAMS (Croundwater Loading Effects of
                                                     Agricultural Management). GLEAMS is a model that estimates
                                                     pesticide leaching and runoff losses using the following as inputs:
                                                     soil properties, field characteristics  (e.g., slope and slope length),
                                                     management practices, pesticide properties, and climate. GLEAMS
                                                     estimates were generated for 243 pesticides applied to 120
                                                     specific soils; the estimates are for 20 years of daily weather for
                                                     each of 55 climate stations distributed throughout the U.S.
                                                     (Knisel, 1993).
                                                                                 if .            .           ,  .
                        Exhibit 3-19:  Potential pesticide runoff from farm fields, 1990-1995
          Watershed Classification (number of watersheds)
               Blow Potential for Delivery (394)
               Moderate Potential for Delivery (788)
               High Potential for Delivery (395)
               Insufficient data (685)
          Hawaii
                                                                                                        Puerto Rico/U.S. Virgin Islands
         Note: Alaska is not covered by the National Resources Inventory.
        Source: USDA, Natural Resources Conservation Service. National Resources Inventory. 1992; Granessi, L.P., and J E. Anderson. Pesticide Use in US Crop
        Pmdudhn: National Data Report. February 1995; Goss, Don W. Pesticide Runoff Potential, 199(
                                                                  -1995 August 24, 1999. (September 2002;
 3-32
                                  3.2 Chemicals in the Landscape         Chapter 3  - Better Protected Land

-------
                              ^
    idicator
Totential pesticide runoff from farm fields - Category 2  (continued)
    Chemical use for 13 different crops taken from the National
    Pesticide Use Database was estimated for 1990-1993 (Gianessi
    and Anderson, 199S). A total of 145 pesticides were included in
    the derivation of the pesticide runoff indicator (using the joint set
    of pesticides from the National Pesticide Use Database and the
    National Pesticide Loss Database for the 13 crops). Estimates of
    percent of acres treated and average application rates were imput-
    ed to the NRI sample points by crop and state. Each NRI sample
    point where corn was grown in Iowa, for example, included chemi-
    cal use for 22 of the pesticides Gianessi and Anderson reported
    were used on corn in Iowa. The simulation assumed that each
    pesticide was applied at the average rate for the state. In reality,
    pesticide use varies widely from field to field. The simulation thus
    reflects general pesticide use patterns to provide an indication of
    where the potential for loss from farm fields is the greatest.

    The total loss of pesticides from each representative field was
    estimated by 1) multiplying the estimate of percent loss per
    acre by the application rate to obtain  the mass loss per acre
    for each pesticide, 2) calculating the number of acres treated
    for each pesticide by multiplying the estimate of percent acres
    treated by the number of acres associated with the sample
    point, 3) multiplying the number of acres treated by the mass
    loss per acre to obtain the mass loss for the representative
   field for each pesticide, and 4) summing the mass loss esti-
    mates for all the pesticides.

   Watershed scores were determined by averaging the scores
   for the NRI sample points within each watershed. The  average
   watershed score was determined by dividing the aggregate
   pesticide loss for the watershed by the number of acres of
   non-federal rural land in the watershed. Dividing by the acres
   of non-federal rural  land provides a watershed level perspective
   of the significance of pesticide loss.
                                                   What the  Data  Show

                                                   Exhibit 3-19 shows the distribution of watersheds and the
                                                   potential for pesticide runoff nationwide. The highest potential for
                                                   agricultural pesticide runoff is concentrated in the central U.S.,
                                                   predominately associated with the upper and lower Mississippi
                                                   River Valley and the Ohio River Valley.

                                                   Indicator Gaps and Limitations

                                                   The following limitations are associated with this indicator:
                                                   • The indicator estimates only the potential for pesticides to run
                                                     off farm fields. It does not estimate actual pesticide loss.
                                                     Research has shown that pesticide loss from farmlands can be
                                                     substantially reduced by management practices that enhance
                                                     the water-holding capacity and organic content of the soil,
                                                     reducing water runoff. Where these practices are being used,
                                                     the potential loss measured by this indicator will be over-
                                                     estimated because the practices are not considered in the
                                                     analysis.
                                                   • The indicator does not include croplands used for growing
                                                     fruits, nuts, and vegetables. Thus, watersheds with large
                                                     acreage of these crops will have a greater risk of water
                                                     quality contamination than shown by this indicator.
                                                   • For each field, pesticide usage was assumed as an average
                                                     for the state, when actual use varies widely.
                                                   • This indicator does not address pesticide usage in
                                                     non-agricultural areas.

                                                   Data Sources

                                                   The data sources for this indicator are the Summary Report:
                                                   1997 National Resources Inventory  (Revised December 2000),
                                                   U.S. Department of Agriculture, Natural Resources Conservation
                                                   Service, and the National Pesticide Use Database, National Center1
                                                   for Food and Agricultural Policy, 1995. (See Appendix B, page
                                                   B-21, for more information.)
Chapter 3 - Better Protected Land          3.2 Chemicals in the Landscape
                                                                                                          3-33

-------

Indicator
Risk of nitrogen export - C-ategory 2
1

                                                                              F"
 Predictive risk models show higher nutrient concentrations in
 watersheds dominated by agricultural and urban and suburban
 land uses. Watersheds with mixed uses tend to have forested lands
 that reduce concentrations of nutrients. Various field-based
 studies show a strong relationship between land cover and the
 amount of nutrients exported from a watershed (e.g., measured in
 the stream at the watershed outlet) (Beaulac and Reckhow, 1982).
 Exports are typically measured as mass per unit area per unit time
 (e.g., Ibs/acre/year). Nitrogen exports tend to increase as agricul-
 ture and urban and suburban uses replace forest land. Several
 additional factors affect the actual amount exported, however,
 such as cropping management practices, the timing of rainfall ver-
 sus cropping stage, density of impervious surfaces, and soil types.

 The risk classes described by this indicator are based solely on
 proportions of agriculture, forest, and urban and suburban  land
 within a watershed derived from the NLCD. Nutrient export data
 compiled from watersheds with homogenous land cover were used
 in a Monte Carlo approach to simulate loads of nitrogen for
 watersheds with mixed land cover. The model can be used to
 estimate annual load for any point in the distribution or for risk
 of exceeding user-defined thresholds. When used to estimate risk,
 the model conceptually incorporates factors other than land cover
 as mentioned above.

 What the  Data  Show

  Exhibit 3-20 shows the risk of nitrogen export. Risk is expressed
  as the number of times per 10,000 trials the nitrogen export
  exceeded a threshold of 6.5 Ibs/acre/year. The  6.5 threshold was
  chosen because it represents the maximum value observed for
  watersheds that were entirely forest. A risk value of 0.5 indicates a
  1 out of 2 chance that a particular watershed would exceed the
  risk threshold because of its mix of land cover (e.g., forest, agricul-
  ture, urban/suburban). The watersheds in Exhibit 3-20 are
  categorized into five classes based on risk. About 46 percent of
                                                   the watersheds are in the lowest risk class and 15 percent in the
                                                   highest. The lowest risk watersheds make up most of the western
                                                   U.S., northern New England, northern Great Lakes, and southern
                                                   Appalachians. The highest risk classes are concentrated  in the -
                                                   midwestern grain belt. The eastern U.S. shpws a mottling of high
                                                   and low risk classes among adjacent watersheds.

                                                   Indicator  Gaps  and Limitations

                                                   The potential risk of nitrogen runoff calculated from the NLCD
                                                   data relies on various classifications and models that have inaccu-
                                                   racies that might affect results. To nationally monitor all watershed
                                                   variables that affect nutrient export is impossible. Therefore, the
                                                   data for this indicator are based on statistical simulation and the
                                                   well-documented relationship between land cover and nutrient
                                                   export to estimate the risk (or likelihood) of export exceeding a
                                                   certain threshold. The accuracy of the model is affected by the
                                                   accuracy of the classification of the cover types—forest, agricul-
                                                   ture, and urban/suburban—which range from 80 percent to 90
                                                   percent in most cases. The accuracy also is affected by lack of
                                                   model input for other land cover classes that can occur within
                                                   watersheds, particularly in the western U.S. Model performance
                                                   has been evaluated in the mid-Atlantic region, and  modeled
                                                   results generally agree with observed values. In the western  U.S.,
                                                   shrubland and  grassland  cover share dominance with forest  and
                                                   agriculture. For national application of the model, shrubland and
                                                   grassland classes were treated as forest because these land-cover
                                                   classes, like forest, lack strong anthropogenic inputs of nitrogen.
                                                   Further research to refine the empirical  models for  shrubland and
                                                   grassland cover classes would be useful.

                                                   Data Sources

                                                   The data source for this  indicator is the National Land Cover
                                                   Data, Multi-Resolution Land Characteristics Consortium, 1992.
                                                   (See Appendix B,  page B-22, for more information.)
3-34
                                  3.2 Chemicals in the Landscape         Chapter 3 - Better Protected Land

-------
  Indicator'
Risk of nitrogen export - Category 2 (continued)
1
                     txhibit 3-20: Estimates of risk of nitrogen export by watershed, 1992
        Risk Classes
        •  0.000 - 0.149
        13  0.150- 0.299
        El  0.300-0.449
        •  0.450 - 0.599
        B  0.600-0.749
           (max. = 0.696)
     Source: Wickham, j.D. et al., Land Cover as a Framework for Assessing Risk of Water Pollution, 2000.
  idicator
    of phosphorus export - Category 2

  Like nitrogen export, the same strong relationship exists
  between land cover and phosphorus export. Risk is expressed
  as the number of times out of 10,000 trials that the phospho-
  rus export threshold  of 0.74 Ibs/acre/year was exceeded. The
  0.74 threshold was chosen because it represents the maximum
  value observed for watersheds that were entirely forest. The
  model uses an identical approach to that just described in the
  "risk of nitrogen export"  indicator.
                                              What the Data Show

                                              Exhibit 3-21 shows potential for phosphorus export at greater
                                              than 0.74 pounds per acre per year. About 74 percent of the
                                              watersheds are in the two lowest risk classes. These make up most
                                              of the western U.S., as well as the eastern seaboard and the
                                              Appalachians. Only 1  percent of the watersheds are in the highest
                                              risk classes, and these are scattered throughout the midwestern
                                              grain belt, but also in many of the nation's major urban/suburban
Chapter 3 - Better Protected Land         3.2 Chemicals in the Landscape
                                                                                                   3-35

-------


Indicator
             Risk of phosphorus export - Category 2 (continued)
 areas. Many major urban/suburban areas exist at the intersection
 of two watersheds, and the "urban" influence, which would make
 the phosphorus risk higher, is spread over multiple watersheds.
 This partially explains why some urban/suburban areas show lower
 risk than others. Identification of higher phosphorus export risk in
 urban/suburban areas differs somewhat from the spatial pattern
 for nitrogen export risk, because the empirical data suggest that
 urban/suburban areas present higher risk of phosphorus export
 than nitrogen export.

 Indicator Gaps and Limitations

 The potential risk of phosphorus export is based on the aggregate
 classes of forest, urban/suburban, and agriculture from the  NLCD.
 Accuracy of these classes ranges from 80 to 90 percent in most
 cases. Model performance  has been evaluated in the mid-Atlantic
                                                               region, and modeled results generally agree with observed values.
                                                               In the western U.S., shrubland and grassland cover share domi-
                                                               nance with forest and agriculture. For national application of the
                                                               model, shrubland and grassland classes were treated as forest,
                                                               because these land-cover classes, like forest, lack strong anthro-
                                                               pogenic inputs of phosphorus. Further research to refine the
                                                               empirical models for shrubland and grassland land-cover classes
                                                               would be useful.

                                                               Data Source

                                                               The data source for this indicator is the National  Land Cover
                                                               Data, Multi-Resolution Land Characteristics Consortium, 1992.
                                                               (See Appendix B, page B-22, for more information.)
                                                                         r
                  Exhibit 3-21: Estimates of risk of phosphorus Export hy watershed, 1992
         Risk Classes
         •  0.000-0.123
         B  0.124-0.247
         H  0,248-0.371
         •  0.372-0.495
         •  0.496-0.619
            (max. - 0.619)
     Source: Wickham, ).D. et al.. Land Comas a Framework for Assessing Risk of Water Pollution. 20pO
3-36
                                               3.2 Chemicals in the Landscape         Chapter 3 - Better Protected Land

-------

   3.2.5 What  human  health effects
   are  associated with pesticides,
   fertilizer?,  and toxic substances?
 Many pesticides pose some risk to humans and the environment
 because they are designed to kill or otherwise adversely affect living
 organisms. The degree to which individuals and populations are
 exposed to pesticides varies greatly by geographic location and
 demographics. Children may be more susceptible than adults to the
 effects of chemicals, including pesticides. Certain populations may
 be more at risk than others, depending, for example, on sources of
 drinking water or direct exposure to pesticide application.

 Various pesticide,surveillance systems exist that collect information
 on pesticide-related injury and illness, but data are limited. One
 example, the Toxic Exposure Surveillance System (TESS), contains
 information from poison control centers  around the country that
 report occurrences of pesticide-related injury and illness.

 Other data collected from poison control centers showed that in
 2000, more than 100,000 people were  sufficiently concerned about
 exposure to various types of pesticides to call their local Poison
 Control Center.

 The TRI database tracks toxic chemicals because of the risks that these
 chemicals pose to human health and ecological condition. Studies have
 made accurate associations between isolated chemicals and their specific
 health effects. For example, the pesticide atrazine has been shown to have
 developmental and reproductive effects in animals and fish, depending on
 the level of exposure (EPA, OPP, 2002). PBT chemicals such as mercury
 and lead can cause acute or chronic health problems, even when people
 are exposed to small quantities of the chemicals (See box "Persistant
 Bioaccumulative Toxic Chemicals") (EPA, October 1999). Though these
 single chemical assessments are useful, a greater challenge lies in correlat-
 ing the existence of chemicals that interact in the environment to the
 health effects observed in a given population.

 Fertilizers are often applied in greater quantities than crops can
 absorb and end up in surface or ground water. Although fertilizers
 may not be inherently harmful, they can be linked to human health
 problems when excess nutrients cause algal blooms and
 eutrophication in waterbodies. Drinking ground water contaminated
 with runoff from some fertilizers can have severe or even fatal  health
 effects, especially in infants and children (e.g., blue baby syndrome)
 (Amdur, etal, 1996).

Another emerging issue is the use  of recycled industrial waste in
fertilizer. Depending on the material and how it  is processed, the
presence of heavy metals such as lead or cadmium in fertilizers
produced with recycled waste can  introduce  contaminants to the
soil and increase the health risks associated with fertilizer use.
Many states have begun to test and require labeling for fertilizers
containing metals and hazardous waste.

No specific indicators have been identified at this time. There  is
additional discussion of human health effects of chemical use  in
Chapter 4, Human Health.
                                                                     Persistent Bioaccumulative Toxic Chemicals
                                                                    Human exposure to PBT chemicals increases over time because
                                                                    these chemicals persist and bioaccumulate in the environment.
                                                                    Therefore, even small quantities of these chemicals are of
                                                                    concern. In 1999, EPA lowered the TRI reporting threshold for 13
                                                                    chemicals called persistent bioaccumulative toxic chemicals
                                                                    (PBTs), including dioxins, mercury, lead, and polychlorinated
                                                                    biphenyls (PCBs).  Of the total 38 billion pounds of managed
                                                                    toxic chemicals in 2000, PBTs comprised approximately 72
                                                                    million pounds. Of the total 7.10 billion pounds of toxic
                                                                    chemicals released to the environment, PBTs accounted for 12.1
                                                                    million (less than 1 percent). The specific  types of PBTs that
                                                                    comprised the 12.1 million pounds were polycyclic aromatic
                                                                    compounds (45 percent), mercury and mercury compounds
                                                                    (36 percent), PCBs (12 percent), pesticides (0.7 percent), and
                                                                    other PBTs  (7 percent) (EPA, OEI, 2002).
Chapter 3 - Better Protected Land         3.2 Chemicals in the Landscape
                                                       3-37

-------

  3.2.6 Whajt ecological effect?  are
  associated I With  pesticides,    !
  fertilizers* aftd toxic substances?
Nitrogen runoff from farmlands and animal feeding operations can
contribute to eutrophication of downstream waterbodies and some-
times impair the use of water for drinking water purposes. Nutrient
enrichment (nitrogen and phosphorus) is one of the leading causes
of water quality impairment in the nation's rivers, lakes, and estuaries.
EPA reported to Congress in 1996 that 40 percent of rivers in the
U.S. were impaired due to nutrient enrichment; 51  percent of the
surveyed lakes and 57 percent of the surveyed estuaries were simi-
larly adversely affected (EPA, OW, December 1997). Nutrients have
also been implicated in identification of the large hypoxic zone in the
Gulf of Mexico, hypoxia observed in several East Coast states, and
harmful algal bloom-induced fish kills and human health problems in
the coastal waters of several East Coast and Gulf states .

Just as the sources of nitrogen in watersheds vary, so do the  effects
of exported nitrogen. While high levels of nitrogen might not affect
the watersheds from which the nutrient is exported, exports can
                influence the condition of coastal estuaries arid lakes. The effects
                vary with such factors as water-column mixing, sunlight, temperature,
                and the availability of other nutrients.

                No specific indicators have been identified at this time. Effects
                of chemical use on ecological condition are discussed more
                extensively in Chapter 2, Purer Water; and Chapter 5,
                Ecological Condition.
 3-38
3.2 Chemicals in the Landscape         Chapter 3 - Better Protected Land

-------
3.3  Waste  and
(Contaminated  Land:
Waste and contaminated lands are discussed in this section. Waste is
broadly defined as unwanted materials left over from manufacturing
processes or refuse from places of human or animal habitation.
Several waste categories and types are included within this broad
definition. In general, waste can be categorized as either hazardous
or non-hazardous. Hazardous wastes are the by-products of society
that can pose substantial or potential hazards to human health or
the environment when improperly managed. These wastes may
appear on special EPA lists and they possess at least one of the four
following characteristics:  ignitability, corrosivity, reactivity, or toxicity.
Hazardous waste includes specific types of waste, such as toxic
waste and radioactive waste. All other waste is considered to be
non-hazardous (EPA, OEI, May 2002).

Several specific kinds of waste consist of mixed hazardous and
non-hazardous content. For instance, municipal solid waste (e.g.,
garbage) is largely non-hazardous but does typically contain some
household hazardous waste items such as solvents or batteries.
Other materials and waste types that can have mixed
hazardous/non-hazardous content include animal waste, by-products
of oil and gas production, materials from leaking underground
storage tanks, and waste  from coal combustion.

Contaminated lands are lands that have been  contaminated with
hazardous materials and require remediation. Contaminated lands
are not the same as lands used for waste management. In many
instances, lands used for  waste management are not contaminated.
Similarly, often  no waste is present on contaminated lands.
Contaminated lands can pose a direct risk if they expose people,
animals, or plants to harmful materials or cause the contamination
of air, soil, sediment, surface water, or ground  water.

Despite  numerous waste-related data collection efforts at the state
and national levels, nationally consistent and comprehensive data on
the status, pressures, and effects of waste and contaminated lands
are limited. Various parties are responsible for tracking types and
amounts of waste and contaminated sites. National-level data on
waste and contaminated land tend to be collected to satisfy  the
requirements of specific federal regulations. For example, EPA's
Resource Conservation and Recovery Act Information System
(RCRAInfo)  contains data on RCRA hazardous waste and EPA's
Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation, and Liability
Information System (CERCLIS) contains some data on contaminated
sites, including Superfund sites.
Few national data sets exist for the waste types that are not federally
regulated, such as non-hazardous industrial waste. Although a signifi-
cant amount of waste information and some site contamination
information is collected and tracked at the local or state government
levels, these data are seldom aggregated nationally. Also, most of the
available data describe waste in terms of weight, rather than volume.
The weight data alone do not address the extent of the waste situa-
tion in the U.S. Similarly, national information about contaminated
lands tends to fociis on number of sites and types of contamination,
rather than the extent of land contaminated. Finally, there is a lack of
national data that track the effects of waste and contaminated land
on human health and. ecological condition.

While major improvements have been  made in managing the nation's
waste and cleaning up contaminated sites, more work remains.
National, state, tribal, and local waste programs and  policies aim to
prevent pollution by reducing the generation of wastes at their
source and by emphasizing prevention over management and dispos-
al. Preventing pollution before it  is generated and poses harm is
often less  costly than cleanup and remediation. Source reduction
and recycling programs often can increase resource and energy effi-
ciencies, reduce pressures on the environment, and extend the life
span of disposal facilities.

The following questions and discussion of indicators provide an
overview of what is known about  waste generation and  management
and about contaminated lands in the U.S. Trends and conditions on
a national  basis are described to  the extent that data are available.
The five questions considered in this section are:
• How much and what types of waste are generated  and managed?
• What is the extent of land used for waste management?
• What is the extent of contaminated land?
• What human health effects are associated with waste management
  and contaminated lands?
• What ecological effects are associated with waste management
  and contaminated lands?

EPA is the primary source of data for this section, providing
municipal  solid waste data on generation, management, recovery,
and disposal; data on RCRA hazardous waste and corrective
action  sites from the RCRAInfo database; and data on the number
and location of contaminated sites that are on the Superfund
National Priorities List (NPL) from CERCLIS. The U.S. Department
of Energy's (DOE) Central Internet Database provides information
on the types and quantities of radioactive waste generated and
in storage.
Chapter 3 - Better Protected  Land        3.3 Waste and Contaminated Lands
                                                       3-39

-------

  3.3.1  How much and what types  of
  waste are generated and managed?
 Indicators
 Quantify of municipal solid waste (MSW) generated and managed
 Quantity of RCRA hazardous waste generated and managed
 Quantity of radioactive waste generated and in inventory
                 There are numerous types of waste, but only three types are tracked
                 with any consistency on a national basis. The three that are
                 described as indicators on the following pages include municipal
                 solid waste  (MSW), hazardous waste (as defined by RCRA), and
                 radioactive waste. The other types of waste range from materials
                 generated during mining and agricultural activities to wastes from
                 manufacturing and construction. Current national data are not
                 available on these other types of waste. Exhibit 3-22 summarizes
                 the types of waste.

•ii'i'iT^iBijiagr
iB^u-*SP|"T*.
Municipal
Solid Waste
(Indicator)
RCRA Hazardous
Waste
(Indicator)
Radioactive
Waste
(Indicator)
Extraction
Wastes
Industrial
Non-Hazardous
Waste
Household
Hazardous
Waste
Agricultural
Waste
Construction
and Demolition
Debris
Medical Waste
Oil and Gas
Waste
Sludge
Exkirjit 3-22: Types of Waste


Municipal solid waste (MSW) is the waste discarded by households, hotels/motels, and commercial, institutional, and industrial sources. MSW
typically consists of everyday items such as product packaging, grass clippings, furniture, clothing, bottles, food scraps, newspapers, appliances,
paint, and batteries. It does not include wastewater. In 2000, 232 million tons of MSW were generated. (EPA, OSWER, June 2002)
The term "RCRA hazardous waste" applies to certain types of hazardous wastes that appear on EPA's regulatory listing (RCRA) or that exhibit
the specific characteristics of ignitability, corrosiveness, reactivity, or toxicity. More than 40 million tons of RCRA hazardous waste were
generated in 1 999. (EPA, OSWER, June 2001 )
Radioactive waste is the garbage, refuse, sludge, and other discarded material, iricluding solid, liquid, semi-solid, or contained gaseous material
that must be managed for its radioactive content (DOE Order 43 5.1 Issued July 1999). The technical names for the types of waste that are
considered "radioactive waste" for this report are high-level waste, spent nuclea r fuel, transuranic waste, low-level waste, mixed low-level waste,
and contaminated media. Data on the amounts of these waste types are provided in the radioactive waste discussion. (See Appendix D for
definitions of these terms).
Extraction activities such as mining and mineral processing are large contributors to the total amount of waste generated and land contaminated
in the U.S. EPA estimates that S billion tons of mining wastes were generated in 1988 (EPA, OSWER, October 1 988).
Industrial non-hazardous waste is process waste associated with electric power generation and manufacturing of materials such as pulp and paper,
iron and steel, glass, and concrete. This waste usually is not classified as either municipal solid waste or RCRA hazardous waste by federal or state
laws. State, tribal, and some local governments have regulatory programs to manage industrial waste. EPA estimated that 7.6 billion tons of
industrial non-hazardous wastes were generated in 1 988. (EPA, OSWER, October 1988)
Most household products that contain corrosive, toxic, ighitable, or reactive ingredients are considered household hazardous waste. Examples
include most paints, stains, varnishes, solvents, and household pesticides. Special disposal of these materials is necessary to protect human health
and the environment, but some amount of this type of waste is improperly disposed of by pouring the waste down the drain, on the ground, in
storm sewers, or by discarding the waste with other household waste as part of municipal solid waste. EPA estimates that Americans generate 1 .6
million tons of household hazardous waste per year, with the average home accumulating up to 1 00 pounds annually. (EPA, OSWER, October
2002)
Agricultural solid waste is waste generated by rearing animals and producing and harvesting crops or trees. Animal waste, a large component of
agricultural waste, includes waste from livestock, dairy, milk, and other animal-related agricultural and farming practices. Some of this waste is
generated at sites called Confined Animal Feeding Operations (CAFOs). The waste associated with CAFOs results from congregating animals,
feed, manure, dead animals, and production operations on a small land area. Animal waste and wastewater can enter water bodies from spills or
breaks of waste storage structures (due to accidents or excessive rain) and non-agricultural application of manure to crop land (EPA, OW,
November 2001 ; EPA, OW, June 2002). National estimates are not available.
Construction and demolition debris is waste generated during construction, renovation, and demolition projects. This type of waste generally
consists of materials such as wood, concrete, steel, brick, and gypsum. (The MSW data in this report do not include construction and demolition
debris, even though sometimes construction and demolition debris are considered MSW.) National estimates are not available.
Medical waste is any solid waste generated during the diagnosis, treatment, or immunization of human beings or animals, in research, production,
or testing. National estimates are not available.
Oil and gas production wastes are the drilling fluids, produced waters, and other wastes associated with the exploration, development, and
production of crude oil or natural gas that are conditionally exempted from regulation as hazardous wastes. National estimates are not available.
Sludge is the solid, semisolid, or liquid waste generated from municipal, commercial, or industrial wastewater. National estimates are not available.

-------
 Indicator
Ouantity of rpunicipai solid waste \/V\jVV} generated and managed - \_ategory 2
  As noted in Exhibit 3-22, municipal solid waste (MSW) is the
  waste discarded by households and by commercial, institution-
  al, and industrial operations. This type of waste is familiar to
  most Americans because they are specifically responsible for
  its generation. MSW typically consists of everyday items such
  as product packaging, grass clippings, furniture, clothing,
  bottles, food scraps, newspapers, appliances, paint, and
  batteries. It does not include wastewater.

  What the Data Show

  In 2000, Americans generated 232 million tons of MSW (Exhibit
  3-23). This total amount, which does not take into account MSW
  that was ultimately recycled or composted, equated to approxi-
  mately 4.5  pounds of waste per person per day. Paper and
  paperboard products accounted for the largest component of
  MSW generated (37 percent), and yard trimmings constituted the
  second-largest material component (12 percent). Glass, metals,
  plastics, wood, and food scraps each constituted 5 to 11  percent
  of the total. Rubber, leather, and textiles combined made up about
  seven percent of MSW, while other miscellaneous wastes made up
  approximately 3 percent (EPA, OSWER, June 2002).
    txnibit 3-23:  lota! municipal solid waste generated, 2000
         Total (before recycling and composting) - 232 million tons
              Wood: 5.5%  —y   \~
             Glass: 5.5%      ^""
                                Other: 3.2%
       Rubber, Leather &
         Textiles: 6.7%

        Metals: 7.8%
        Plastics: 10.7%
                              Paper: 37.4%
              Food Waste: 11.2%
                                    Yard Waste: 12%
   Source: EPA, Office of Solid Waste and Emergency Response. Municipal Solid Waste in
   the United States: 2000 facts and figures. June 2002.
                                                   The total amount of MSW generated increased nearly 160 percent
                                                   between 1960 and 2000 (Exhibit 3-24). For comparison purpos-
                                                   es, during that same time frame, the U.S. population increased by
                                                   56 percent, gross national product increased nearly 300 percent,
                                                   and per capita generation of waste rose more than 70 percent
                                                   (DOC, BEA, 2002; EPA, OSWER, June 2002). The amount of
                                                   MSW generated per capita generally stabilized between 1990 and
                                                   2000, increasing less than one percent.

                                                   The data on the total amount of MSW generated do not factor in
                                                   source reduction and waste prevention or materials recovery
                                                   (recycling and composting), which are also important contributors
                                                   to the overall  municipal waste picture. Source reduction and waste
                                                   prevention include the design, manufacture, purchase, or reuse of
                                                   materials to reduce their amount or toxicity or lengthen  their life
                                                   before they enter the MSW system. Between 1992 and 2000,
                                                   source reduction in the U.S. prevented more than 55 million tons
                                                   of MSW from  entering the waste stream (EPA, OSWER, June
                                                   2002) (Exhibit 3-25).
                                                                    txnibit 3-24: AAunicipal solid waste generation rates,
                                                                                        1960-2000
                                                                                  (before recycling and composting)
                                                       H Tons of Waste Generated (millions)
                                                       m Population (millions)
                                                      -0-Per-capita Generation (pounds/day)
                                                  .     .-.
                                                    jurce: EPA, Office of Solid Waste and Emergency Response. Municipal Solid Waste
                                                    thf United States: 2000 Facts and[Figures. June 2002.        _
C-napter 3 - Better Trotected Land       3.3 Waste and Contaminated Lands
                                                                                                            3-41

-------


 Indicator
Quantity of municipal solid waste (AAWV) generated j
   jnd managed - Category 2 (continued)
           Exhibit 3-25: Source reduction of municipal
                    solid waste, 1992-2000
           Materials Categories:
           • Other MSW
           3 Containers & Packaging
           • Nondurable Goods
           • Durable Goods
           • Total Amount
          1992  1993  1994  1995  1996 1997  1998  1999 2000
    Source: ERA. Office of Solid Waste and Emergency Response. Municipal Solid Waste
    m trw United State; 2000 Facts and figures. June 2002.
   Materials recovery (recycling and composting) has also reduced
   the total amount of MSW being discarded. In 2000, approximate-
   ly 30 percent (70 million tons) of the MSW generated was recov-
   ered and thereby diverted from landfills and incinerators. Between
   1960 and 2000, the total amount of MSW recovered has signifi-
   cantly increased from 5.6 million tons to 69.9 million tons, more
   than a 1,100 percent increase. During this time period, the
   amount recovered on a per capita basis increased from 0.17
   pounds per person per day to 1.35 pounds per person per day—
   an 8-fold increase (EPA, OSWER, June 2002). The percentage of
   MSW disposed  of in landfills has dropped from 83.2 percent of
   the amount generated in 1986 to 55.3 percent of the amount
   generated in 2000 (Exhibit 3-26). Combustion (incineration) is
   also used to reduce waste volume prior to disposal in a  land-
   based waste management facility. Approximately 33.7 million tons
   (14.5 percent) of MSW were combusted in 2000. Of this amount,
   approximately 2.3 million tons were combusted with energy
   recovery—also  known as waste-to-energy combustion
   (EPA, OSWER, June 2002).
                                                        Exhibi
^0-26: /
                                                                    250 I
                                                     200
 AAunicipal solid waste management,
"  r, 19^6-2600'  '•"" *
(2000 totaf = 232 million, tons)
I Recovery for Composting*
I Recovery for Recycling
I Combustion
I Landfill
                                                                       1960
                                                                              65   1970   1975   1980  1985  1990  1995  2000
                                                                                     _
                                                    * Composting of yard trimmings and food wastes Does not include mixed MSW
                                                    composting oTthackyard composting

                                                    Source EPA, Office of Solid Waste and Emergency Response Municipal Solid Waste
                                                    in the United Slates 2000 Facts and figures June 2002
                                                  v-  ___    »f _  _  __  ____               J           "

                                                   Indicator  Caps and Limitations

                                                   Limitations for this indicator include the following:
                                                   • The MSW data  do not include construction and demolition
                                                     debris, municipal waste water treatment sludge, automobile
                                                     bodies, combustion ash,  and non-hazardous industrial wastes
                                                     that may g;o to  a municipal waste landfill. The data (including
                                                     the generation,  recycling, and recovery data) are generated
                                                     using the materials flow method, which does not include
                                                     these materials, even though some of these materials
                                                     (namely construction and demolition debris) are typically
                                                     counted a<; MSW.
                                                   • Residues associated with other items in MSW (usually
                                                     containers) are  not accounted for in the data.
                                                   • The percentage of total waste that MSW represents is unknown.
                                                   • The indicator does not necessarily measure the effects of
                                                     changes in consumer or disposal trends.

                                                   Data Source

                                                   The data source for this indicator is Municipal Solid  Waste Data,
                                                   EPA, Office of Solid Waste and Emergency Response, 1990-2000.
                                                   (See Appendix B, page B-22, for more information.)
3-42
                               3.3 Waste and Contaminated Lands        Chapter 3 - "Better Trotected Land

-------
  Indicator
Quantity of RGlxA hazardous waste generated and managed - Category 2
   Businesses that generate a substantial amount of RCRA hazardous
   waste as part of their regular activities are called "large quantity
   generators" or LQGs. ("Substantial" is defined as more than
   2,200 pounds  per month.) National data on "small quantity
   generators" (SQGs) and "conditionally-exempt small quantity
   generators" (CESQGs)  are not available. Estimates indicate, how-
   ever, that the amount of RCRA hazardous waste that SQGs and
   CESQGs generate is  relatively small (EPA, OSWER, June 2000).

   What  the Data  Show

   In 1999, EPA estimated that more than 20,000 LQGs collectively
   generated 40 million tons of RCRA hazardous waste (EPA,
   OSWER, June 2001). The number reflects between 95  and 99
   percent of the total amount of RCRA hazardous waste generated.
   The exact total amount of RCRA hazardous waste generated by
   LQGs, SQGs, and CESQGs combined  is not known, but the con-
   tributions of SQGs and CESQGs are estimated to be between 0.4
   million tons and 2.1  million tons (or 1 to 5 percent) of the total
   amount of RCRA hazardous waste (EPA, OSWER, June 2000).

   LQGs within EPA  Region  6  (see Exhibit 1 -12 for Regional delin-
   eation) generated more than half of all RCRA hazardous waste in
   1999 (Exhibit 3-27). Less than 9 percent of the LQCs  nation-
   wide are located in Region  6, but 15  of the 22 largest national
   generators (by quantity generated) are there. Of the large
   Region 6  generators, 13  manufacture chemicals, petrochemicals,
               Exhibit 3-27: Amount of Resource
           Conservation ana Recovery Act (RCRA)
        hazardous waste generated in EPA regions, 1999
                              (Tons)
           Region 10: 3% (1,025,614) -,
         Region 9:1 % (480,858)
       Region 8: <1% (162,099)
           Region 7: 5%
           (1,842,853)
          Region 6: 52%
          (20,901,778)
                  CBI*Data:
-------
                                                                                                                ••iMiiiiiBiiiiiiiiyriiiiinnliiii iilii iiii iliiiiii
                                                                                                                ilflil IWr 111  1 II I I
Indicator
              Quantity of RCRA hazardous waste generated and m||iaged - Category 2 (continued)
  Indicator Gaps and Limitations

  While RCRAInfo is a reliable source of data about much of the
  hazardous waste generated throughout the U.S., it does not pro-
  vide information about all hazardous waste generated nationally.
  RCRAInfo includes data  on amounts and types of hazardous waste
  generated nationally by large quantity generators only. Data about
  amounts and types of hazardous waste  generated by RCRA SQGs
  and CESQGs are not collected. Similarly, data on waste that does
  not fit the RCRA definition of "hazardous" are not available. Some
                                                               states regulate and collect data on wastes they designate as
                                                               "hazardous" that are not tracked by EPA, but these data are not
                                                               aggregated nationally.

                                                               Data  Source

                                                               The data source for this indicator is 1999 RCRAInfo data,
                                                               from EPA, Office of Solid Waste and Emergency Response.
                                                               (See Appendix B, page B-22, for more information.)
 Indicate
              Quantity of radioactive waste generated and in inventc-
*
ategory 2
  The manufacture and production of nuclear materials and
  weapons requires activities that can generate large amounts of
  radioactive waste. Over the past few decades, the production of
  nuclear weapons has largely been suspended. The largest quanti-
  ties of radioactive waste generated today (when measured by
  volume) result from the cleanup of contaminated sites.

  What  the  Data Show

  A significant amount of the radioactive waste in existence
  today will remain radioactive for many years—in some cases
  thousands of years. When measured by volume, the radioactive
  waste that is still being generated reflects only a small percent-
  age (<10 percent) of the total amount of waste that is either in
  storage (inventory) or disposed of already. When measured by
  radioactivity, the amount  of radioactive waste in inventory far
  exceeds the radioactivity  of newly-generated radioactive waste
  (U.S. DOE, April 2001). Exhibit 3-28 provides summary data
  on the total amount of radioactive waste generated and in
  inventory (storage) at the end of fiscal year (FY) 2000.

  Over time, the amount of radioactive waste generated  has fluc-
  tuated primarily due to the progress of site cleanup operations.
  Trend data on generation  rates over the past several years are
  not available. According to the DOE, however, the amount of
  waste generated between  late 1997 and late 2000 remained
  fairly constant,  while the amount in inventory increased in pro-
  portion to the amount generated  (DOE,  2002). Although some
  radioactive waste Is still being disposed of (e.g., small  amounts
  of transuranic waste are being disposed of at the Waste
                                                               Isolation Pilqt Plant in New Mexico), most of the highly radioac-
                                                               tive waste types remain in storage until they can be placed in safe
                                                               long-term disiposal facilities.

                                                               The amount of radioactive waste being generated and stored is
                                                               expected to drop over the next few decades as cleanup operations
                                                               are completed and waste currently in storage is disposed of.
                                                               Depending on the radioactive decay rate, the disposed-of waste
                                                               will remain raidioactive for time periods ranging from days to
                                                               thousands of years.

                                                               Indicator Gaps and Limitations

                                                               The radioactive waste data in this report do not account for all
                                                               radioactive materials in the U.S. The term "radioactive waste"
                                                               applies to any garbage, refuse, sludge, and other discarded
                                                               material that must be managed for its radioactive content (DOE
                                                               Order 435.1, issued July 1999). Other radioactive materials are
                                                               used for defense, energy production, and other purposes, but
                                                               these materials are not considered  "waste." Further, DOE is not
                                                               responsible for some additional radioactive waste (quantity
                                                               unknown). Data on these wastes are not included in this report.

                                                               Data Source

                                                               The data source for this indicator is radioactive waste data, from
                                                               U.S. Department of Energy's Central Internet Database, 2000.
                                                               (See Appendix B, page B-23, for more information.)
3-44
                                            3.3 Waste and Contaminated Lands       Chapter 3 - Better Protected Land

-------
    idicator:
Quantity of radioactive waste generated! aniin Inventory - Category 2 (continued1)
F~
. 1,
f
I-'
i
i
1
It"
1
tS-O—
Exhibit 3-28: Total amount of radioacti
HBHRSSHSilBBBMflBHflSHnNlfflBfifiilMi^H^HnnwiRMim^ra^ramflBHBF1:
^
Vitrified High-Level Waste .
High-level Waste
Low-Level Waste
Mixed Low-Level Waste
Ex-Situ Contaminated Media
Transuranic Waste
Spent Nuclear Fuel
*/e waste generated in fisca
Generated
n/a
14,166
38,911
10,834
559,249
1,621
0.85
year 20OO as reported by Department of Energy
Inventory (Storage)
1,201
353,501
101,256
44,588
63,570
111 ,226
2,467
Units ;
Canisters
Volume
(cubic meters)
Mass (metric tons
of heavy metal)
Source: U.S. Department of Energy, Office of Environmental Management, Central Internet Database. 2002.
(January 2003; http://cid.em.doe.gov).
* For the purposes of this report, all of the materials in this table are considered radioactive waste.

1
A
   3.3.2  What is  the extent of land
   used for waste management?
  Indicators
  Number and location of municipal solid waste (MSW) landfills
  Number and location of RCRA hazardous waste management facilities
Most types of waste are disposed of in land-based waste manage-
ment units such as MSW landfills and surface impoundments. Prior
to the 1970s, waste disposed of on the land was typically dumped
in open pits,  and waste was seldom treated to reduce its toxicity
prior to disposal (EPA, OSWER, June 2002). Early land disposal units
that still pose threats to human health  and the environment are
considered to be contaminated lands subject to federal or state
cleanup efforts and are discussed in the next section. Today, most of
the hazardous and MSW land disposal units are subject to federal or
state requirements for landfill, surface impoundment, or pile design
and management. National data.for these disposal units is described
in the indicators following.
                                               Many other sites are used for waste management in addition to the
                                               MSW landfills and RCRA hazardous waste facilities just mentioned.
                                               Although comprehensive data sets are not available to assess the
                                               number of additional sites used for waste management, various
                                               EPA estimates show that there were approximately 18,000
                                               non-hazardous industrial waste surface impoundments in 2000,
                                               more than 2,700 non-hazardous industrial waste landfills in 1985,
                                               and more than 5,300 non-hazardous industrial waste piles in 1985
                                               (EPA, OSWER, March 2001). These numbers do not include other
                                               v/aste management sites, such as those used to collect and manage
                                               (but not dispose of) waste (e.g., recycling centers, household
                                               hazardous waste collection centers), waste transfer stations, sites
                                               that store discarded automobile and industrial equipment, and
                                               non-regulated landfills.

                                               The two indicators identified for this question address the number
                                               and location of MSW landfills and RCRA facilities.
Chapter 3 - Better Protected Land        3.3 Waste and Contaminated Lands
                                                                                                                    3-45

-------


Indicator
             NunLer and location of municipal solid w4ste (MSWlJapdfills - Category 2
 Municipal solid waste landfills are the most commonly known places
 of waste disposal. Yet this does not mean that there are good data
 to track them. The data presented in support of this indicator are
 estimates compiled by a national journal. No federal agency specifi-
 cally compiles information nationally on these landfills.

 What the Data Show

 In 2000, approximately 128 million tons (55 percent) of the
 nation's 232 million tons of MSW were disposed of in the nation's
 2,216 municipal waste landfills (EPA, OSWER, June 2002).
 Between 1989 and 2000, the number of municipal landfills in the
 U.S. decreased substantially (down from 8,000). Over the same
 period, the capacity of all  landfills remained fairly constant
 because newer landfills typically have larger capacities. In 2000,
 these landfills were geographically distributed as follows: 154 (8
 percent) in the Northeast, 699 (35 percent) in the Southeast,
  459 (23 percent) in the Midwest, and 655 (33 percent) in the
 West (Goldstein, 2000).
                                                              indicator Caps and Limitations
                                                                          i           	          i  ],
                                                              MSW data are voluntarily submitted to BioCycle Journal and are
                                                              not reviewed for quality or consistency. The data exclude land-
                                                              fills in Alaska and Hawaii and-do not indicate the capacity or
                                                              volume of landfills, or in general, a means to estimate extent of
                                                              lands used for MSW management. For example, the fact that
                                                              there are fewer landfills does not mean that less land is used for
                                                              managing wastes because newer landfills are typically larger than
                                                              their predecessors. The information is also limited by the fact
                                                              that other lands are also used for waste management, such as
                                                              for recycling facilities and waste transfer stations, but are not
                                                              included in the indicator data. The data also do not reflect upon
                                                              the status or effectiveness of landfill management or the extent
                                                              to which contamination of nearby lands does or does not occur.

                                                              Data  Source

                                                              The data source for this indicator is BioCycle journal municipal
                                                              landfill data 1990-2000. (See Appendix B, page B-23, for more
                                                              information.)
Indicator
               Number and location of RGRA hazardous waste marflgernent facilities - Category 2
  The RCRA Treatment, Storage, and Disposal (TSD) facilities used to
  manage the more than 26 million tons of annually generated haz-
  ardous waste are tracked closely by EPA. The data,  however, are
  tracked and reported in terms of number of facilities and volumes of
  waste managed, not the acres of land used for management.

  What the  Data  Show

  Nearly 70 percent of the RCRA hazardous waste (not including
  wastewater) generated in 1999 was disposed of at one of the
  nation's 1,575 RCRATSDs. Of the 1,575 facilities, 1,049 were
  storage-only facilities. The remaining facilities perform one or
  more of the following management methods, which include recov-
  ery operations (the percentages reflect the percentage of total
  facilities that conduct each management method): metals recovery
   (16.8 percent), solvents recovery (21.1 percent), other recovery
   (8.8  percent), incineration (28.4 percent), energy recovery
   (18.9 percent), fuel blending (19.8 percent), sludge treatment
   (3.0  percent), stabilization (16.0 percent), land treatment/appli-
   cation/farming (1.3 percent), landfill (11.4 percent), surface
   impoundment (0.4 percent),  deepwell/underground injection
   (8.8  percent), or other disposal methods (7.4 percent).
                                                               TSD facilities in five states accounted for approximately 65 per-
                                                               cent of the national management total, From another perspective,
                                                               over 80 percent of the TSD facilities are located in EPA Regions
                                                               4 (19.6. percent), Region 5 (16.9 percent), and Region 6
                                                               (43.7 percent) (EPA, OSWER, June 2001).

                                                               Indicator Gaps and Limitations

                                                               Some hazardous waste management information that is collected
                                                               by states is not included in the provided totals because it is not
                                                               compiled nationally. Further, data on actual extent of land used for
                                                               waste management are not collected, reported, or aggregated.
                                                               Basic data on the number of sites or facilities used for waste
                                                               management do not answer the extent question.

                                                               Data Source

                                                               The data source for this indicator is 1999 RCRAInfo data from EPA
                                                               Office of Solid Waste and Emergency Response. (See Appendix B,
                                                               page B-23, for more information.)
 3-46
                                            3.3 Waste and Contaminated Lands       Chapter 3 - Better Protected Land

-------
     3.3.3  Wfiat is  the  extent  of
     contaminated  lands?
    Indicators
    Number and location of superfund national priorities list (NPL) sites
    Number and location of RCRA corrective action sites
   Contaminated lands range from sites where underground storage
   tanks have failed to areas where accidental spills have occurred to
   legacy sites where poor site management resulted in the contami-
   nation of soil, sediment,  and ground water. Sites are still being
   discovered and national data do not currently exist to describe the
   full extent of contaminated lands. Additionally, sites are continually
   being cleaned up by a variety of programs, although these sites are
   not always immediately removed from the tracking lists maintained
   by the cleanup programs (e.g., Superfund NPL).
                                            Two indicators are described. One addresses Superfund (NPL) sites
                                            and the other RCRA Corrective Action sites. They represent the
                                            limited data available for a national view of contaminated lands.
                                            Both indicators are based on data collected to track cleanup
                                            efforts and list numbers of sites, but neither specifically delineate
                                            the extent or total area of land contamination. Besides these two
                                            indicators that track specific programs, there are several other
                                            types of contaminated lands for which national data are limited
                                            or are not available. In some cases, states collect and maintain
                                            accurate data inventories, but these state-specific data sets are
                                            not compiled  nationally. Exhibit 3-29 summarizes the types of
                                            lands that are or might be considered contaminated.
  ifc-
                                      txhibit 3-29: Types of contaminated  lands
  || Superfund
     National Priorities
     List Sites
     (Indicator)

 Congress established the Superfund Program in 1980 to clean up abandoned hazardous waste sites throughout the U.S. The
 most seriously contaminated sites are on the NPL. As of October 2002, there were 1,498 sites on the NPL ^EPA SERP
 October 2002).                                                                            '
     RCRA
     Corrective
     Action Sites
     (Indicator)
 EPA and authorized states have identified 1,714 hazardous waste management facilities that are the most seriously
 contaminated and may pose significant threats to humans or the environment (EPA, OSWER, October, 2002). Some RCRA
 Corrective Action sites are also identified by the Superfund Program as NPL sites.
     Leaking
     Underground
     Storage
     Tanks
EPA regulates many categories of underground storage tanks (USTs), often containing petroleum or hazardous substances.
These exist at many sites, such as gas stations, convenience stores, and bus depots. USTs that have failed due to faulty
materials, installation, operating procedures, or maintenance systems are categorized as leaking underground storage tanks
(LUSTs). LUSTs can contaminate soil, ground water, and sometimes drinking water. Vapors from UST releases can lead to     ;
explosions and other hazardous situations if those vapors migrate to a confined area such as a basement. LUSTs are the most
common source of ground water contamination (EPA, OW, 2000), and petroleum is the most common ground water
contaminant (EPA, OW, 1996). According to EPA's corrective action reports, in 1996 there were 1,064,478 active tanks
located at approximately 400,000 facilities. In 2002, there were 697,966 active tanks  (a 34 percent decrease) and
1,525,402 closed tanks (a 42 percent increase). As of the fall of 2002, 427, 307 UST releases (LUSTs) were confirmed
(EPA, OSWER, December 2002).
    Accidental
    Spill Sites
Each year, thousands of oil and chemical spills occur on land and in water. Oil and gas materials that have spilled include
drilling fluids, produced waters, and other wastes associated with the exploration, development, and production of crude oil
or natural gas. Accurate national spill data are not available.
• Chapter 3 - Better Protected Land        3.3 Waste and Contaminated Lands
                                                                                                                             3-47

-------
                            Exhibit 3-2Q: Types of contaminated lands (continued)
                                                                                                                ^

  Land
  Contaminated
  with Radioactive
  and Other
  Hazardous
  Materials

  Brownfields
  Some
  Military
  Bases
  Poorly Designed
  or Poorly
  Managed Waste
  Management
  Sites
   Illegal
   Dumping
   Sites
   Abandoned
   Mine Lands
Approximately 0.54 million acres of land spanning 129 sites in over 30 states are contaminated with radioactive and other
hazardous materials as a result of activities associated with nuclear weapons production and research. Although DOE is the
landlord at most of these sites, other parties, including other federal agencies, private parties, and one public university, also
have legal responsibilities over these lands (DOE, January 2001).
Brownfields are real property, the expansion, redevelopment or reuse of which may be complicated by the presence or
potential presence of a hazardous substance, pollutant, or contaminant (Small Business Liability Relief and Brownfields
Revitalization Act, 2002). Brownfields are often found in and around economically depressed neighborhoods. As brownfields
are cleaned and redeveloped, surrounding communities benefit from a reduction of health and environmental risks, more
functional space, and improved economic conditions. A complete inventory of brownfields does not exist. According to the
General Accounting Office (1987), there are approximately 450,000 brownfields nationwide (General Accounting Office,
1987). The EPA's national brownfield tracking system includes a large volume of data on brownfields across the nation, but
does not track all of them. EPA's Brownfield Assessment Pilot Program includes data collected from over 400 pilot
communities (EPA, OSWER, May 2002).
Some (exact number or percentage unknown) military bases are contaminated as a result of military activities. A national
assessment of land contaminated at military bases has not been conducted; however, under the Base Realignment and
Closure (BRAQ laws, closed military bases undergo site investigation processes to determine extent of possible
contamination and the need for site cleanup. Currently, 204 military installations that have been closed or realigned are
undergoing environmental cleanup. These installations collectively occupy over 400,000 acres, though not all of this land is
contaminated. Thirty-six of these installations are on the Superfund NPL list, and, of these, 32 are being cleaned up under
the Fast Track program to make them available for other uses as quickly as possible (DOD,  2001).
 Prior to the 1970s, untreated waste was typically placed in open pits or directly onto the land. Some of these early waste
 management sites are still contaminated. In other cases, improper management of facilities (that were typically used for
 other purposes such as manufacturing) resulted in site contamination. Federal and state cleanup efforts are now addressing
 those early land disposal units and poorly-managed sites that are still contaminated.
 Also known as "open dumping" or "midnight dumping," illegal dumping of such materials as construction Waste, abandoned
 automobiles, appliances, household waste, and medical waste raises concerns for safety, property values, and quality of life.
 While a majority of illegally dumped waste is not hazardous, some of it is, creating contaminated lands.
  Abandoned mine lands are sites that have historically been mined! and have not been properly cleaned up. These abandoned
  or inactive mine sites may include disturbances or features ranging from exploration holes and trenches to full-blown, large-
  scale mine openings, pits, waste dumps, and processing facilities. The Department of the Interior's (DOI) Bureau of Land
  Management (BLM) is presently aware of approximately 10,200 abandoned hardrock mines located within the roughly 264
  million acres under its jurisdiction. Various government and private organizations have made estimates over the years about
  the total number of abandoned and inactive mines in the U.S., including estimates for the percent land management
  agencies, and state and privately-owned lands. Those estimates range from about  80,000 to hundreds of thousands of small
  to medium-sized sites. The BLM is attempting to identify, prioritize, and take appropriate actions on those historic mine sites
  that pose safety risks to the public or present serious threats to the environment (DOI, BLM, 2003).
                                                                                  IE:
3-48
                         3.3 Waste and Contaminated Lands        Chapter 3 - Better Protected Land

-------
                 Number and location of Superfund National Priorities  List (NFL) sites - Category 2

    Congress established the Superfund Program in 1980 to clean up
    abandoned hazardous waste sites throughout the U.S. The
    Superfund Program tracks and investigates thousands of poten-
    tially contaminated sites to determine whether they are  indeed
    contaminated and require cleanup. Some sites are not contaminat-
    ed, whereas others are seriously contaminated  and require either
    extensive, long-term cleanup action and/or immediate action to
    protect human health and the environment. The most seriously
    contaminated sites are proposed for placement on the NPL.
    "Proposed" NPL sites that meet the qualifications for cleanup
    under the Superfund Program become "final" NPL sites.  Sites are
    considered for deletion from the NPL when all cleanup goals are
    met and there is no longer reason for federal action.

   What the Data Show

   As of October 1, 2002, there were 1,498 sites that were either
   final (1,233) or deleted (265). Of the 1,498 sites, 846 have
   completed all necessary cleanup construction. A construction
   complete site is a former toxic waste site where physical  construc-
   tion of all cleanup actions are complete, all immediate threats have
   been addressed, and all long-term threats are under control. An
   additional 62 sites were proposed in 2002 (Exhibit 3-30). The
   total number of NPL sites (including proposed) grew from 1,236
   in 1990 to 1,560  in 2002. During this time period, the  number
   of sites that have been cleaned up and have been transferred from
   "final" to "deleted" status have increased nearly 10-fold, from 29
   in 1990 to 265 in 2002. In 2002, over 56 percent of the final
 and deleted sites were construction complete, compared to only
 four percent of the sites in 1990 (EPA, SERP, February 2003).

 Indicator Gaps and Limitations

 The NPL sites are tracked in CERCLIS. This database contains
 information on hazardous waste sites across the nation and U.S.
 territories including location, status, contaminants, and actions
. taken from 1983 to the present. The  number of NPL sites provides
 a general indicator of contaminated lands, but these numbers do
 not translate directly to the extent of contaminated land. The NPL
 data cannot easily be used  to clarify how many lands are contami-
 nated because the NPL sites are divided into administrative
 groups (i.e., proposed, final, and deleted) that do not clearly
 describe whether the sites are currently contaminated.
 Additionally, there are many contaminated sites in CERCLIS that
 are not listed on the NPL, some contaminated sites are not in
 CERCLIS (e.g., are known only by local and state programs); and
 not all of the sites in CERCLIS are contaminated.

 Data Source

 The data source for this indicator is Comprehensive Environmental
 Response Compensation, and Liability Information System
 (CERCLIS) data, EPA Superfund Emergency Response Program,
 1983-2002. (See Appendix B, page B-24, for more information.)
                                                                   •v
                  Exnirjit 3-3O. Superfund National Priorities  List (NFL) site totals by status and
                  m Deleted Sites   31 Proposed Sites
                    Final Sites     B Construction Complete
                                                                                                 2000
                                                                                                         2001
                                                                                                                 2002
      !„-,. Mote: "Construction Complete" sites include most "Deleted" sites and some "Final" sites.

F        Source: EPA, Office of Solid Waste and Emergency Response. National Priorities List Site Totals by Status and Milestone. March 26, 2003. (April 3, 2003;
        http://amf.epa.gov/saperfund/snes/ciueiy/tiueryMm/npltotalMm) and Number of NPL Site Actions and Milestones by Fiscal Year. March 26, 2003. (April 3, 2003;
      •^r-http://wwvf.epa.gov/supetfund/sites/query/queryhtm/npljy/htm).
Chapter 3 - Better Protected Land.        3.3 Waste and Contaminated Lands
                                                        3-49

-------


              Number and location of RCRA corrective action sites
                              I Category!
                             It—	_	„ -
  Congress established the RCRA Corrective Action Program in
  1984 because many hazardous waste management facilities were
  contaminated from current or past solid and hazardous waste
  management activities and required cleanup to protect humans
  and the environment. As with the Superfund Program, some sites
  subject to RCRA corrective action may be investigated and found
  to require little or no cleanup, while others may be found to have
  extensive soil, ground water, and/or sediment contamination.

  What the  Data Show

  EPA estimates that approximately 3,700 hazardous waste
  management facilities may be subject to cleanup under the
  RCRA corrective action program (EPA, OSWER, October 2002).
  To date, EPA and authorized states have identified approximately
  1,700 hazardous waste management facilities that are the most
  seriously contaminated and may pose significant threats to
  human health or the environment (EPA, OSWER, October
  2002). These sites typically have both soil and ground water
  contamination and many also have contaminated sediments.
  Some RCRA corrective action sites are also identified by the
  Superfund Program as NPL sites.
                   Indicator Gaps and  Limitations

                   RCRAInfo contains information about hazardous waste genera-
                   tors and management facilities in the U.S. and its territories.
                   RCRAInfo includes data on site location, status, contaminants
                   and contaminant sources, and actions taken. RCRAInfo provides
                   reliable data about the number and location of RCRA corrective
                   action sites and about cleanup priorities; however, information
                   on cleanup status at sites is less reliable, particularly for lower
                   priority sites. Cleanup status data for the 1,700 high priority
                   sites is current—particularly with respect to ongoing exposures
                   of humans to contamination and  migration of contaminated
                   ground water, the two site conditions that the RCRA corrective
                   action program has chosen to track most closely. Also, there
                   are overlaps between the list of high priority RCRA corrective
                   action sites and NPL sites. Due to these overlaps, number-of-
                   site comparisons between programs and simple counts of
                   contaminated sites can be misleading.

                   Data Source
                              !
                   The data source for this indicator is EPA Office of Solid Waste and
                   Emergency Response, RCRA Info Data, 1997-1999. (See Appendix
                   B, page B-24, for more information.)

                    .    ......
 ...... co n t a m i n a te d  I a n d s ?
                                                     I   99 E
While some types of waste (e.g., most food scraps) are not typically
toxic to humans, other types (e.g., mercury) pose dangers to human
health and must be managed accordingly. The number of substances
that exist that can or do affect human health is unknown; however,
the TRI program requires reporting of more than 650 chemicals and
chemical categories that are known to be toxic to humans.

The EPA Superfund Emergency Response Program and the Agency
for Toxic Substances and Disease Registry (ATSDR) have created
useful lists of common contaminant sources and their potential
health effects. Every 2 years, the ATSDR and EPA prepare a list, in
order of priority, of hazardous substances that are  most commonly
found at the NPL sites and pose the most significant threat to
                   human health due to their known or suspected toxicity and potential
                   for human exposure (EPA, SERF, September 2002; ATSDR, 2001).
                   Arsenic, lead, and mercury are the highest ranking substances on the
                   list. All three of these substances are toxic to the kidneys, and lead
                   and arsenic can cause decreased mental ability, weakness, abdominal
                   cramps, and Jinemia (EPA, SERP, September 2002). Additional dis-
                   cussion of these substances is available in Chapter 4, Human Health.

                   EPA also maintains a separate list of common contaminants and their
                   potential health effects. The list includes commercial solvents,
                   household items, dry cleaning agents, and chemicals. With chronic
                   exposure, commercial solvents such as benzene, can  suppress bone
                   marrow function and cause blood  changes. Dry cleaning agents and
                   degreasers contain trichloroethane and trichloroethylene, which can
                   cause fatigue, depression of the central nervous system, kidney
                   changes (e.g., swelling, anemia), and liver changes (e.g., enlarge-
                   ment). Chemicals used in commercial and industrial manufacturing
                   processes such as arsenic, beryllium, cadmium, chromium, lead, and
                   mercury, are toxic to kidneys. Long-term exposure to lead can cause
                   permanent kidney and brain damage. Cadmium can cause kidney and
3-50
3.3 Waste and Contaminated Lands        Chapter 3 - Better Protected Land

-------
  lung disease. Arsenic, beryllium, cadmium, and chromium have been
  implicated as human carcinogens (EPA, SERF, September 2002).

  Contaminants can come into contact with humans through three
  exposure pathways: inhalation, ingestion, and direct contact.
  Exposure routes can vary for each substance. Chemicals can contam-
  inate ground water due to leaking tanks, runoff, and leaching through
  soil or sediment. In addition, the cleanup of sites contaminated with
  radioactive materials has^ involved the remediation of approximately
  1.7 trillion gallons of ground water—an amount equal to four times
  the U.S. daily water consumption (DOE, 2000).
 Information on waste generation amounts alone does not lead to a
 complete understanding of the effects of waste on people and the
 environment. The specific risks and burdens differ substantially from
 waste type to waste type. For example, one pound of grass clippings
 is not "equal" in terms of potential risk in exposure to one pound of
 dioxin. Exposure to waste is likely to vary as a function of manage-
 ment practices: treatment, storage, transfer, and disposal actions.
 Waste that is efficiently and safely treated and disposed of is likely
 to have relatively little effect on human health. No specific indicators
 have been identified at this time. Additional discussion of the human
 health effects associated with waste  management and contaminated
 lands is found in Chapter 4, Human  Health.
    3.3.5  What ecological  effects are
    associated  with Waste management
    and  contaminated lands?
 Hazardous substances can have negative effects on the environ-
 ment by degrading or destroying wildlife and vegetation in
 contaminated areas, causing major reproductive complications in
 wildlife, or otherwise limiting the ability of an ecosystem to survive.
 Certain hazardous substances also have the potential to explode
 or cause a fire, threatening both wildlife and human populations
 (EPA, SERF, September 2002).

 Waste from extraction activities can contaminate  water, soil, and air;
 affect human health; and damage vegetation, wildlife, and other
biota. Toxic residues left from mining operations can be transported
into nearby areas, affecting resident wildlife populations. This type of
damage is often the result of unlined land-based units that have min-
imal release controls. These units include surface impoundments
containing mill tailings and/or process wastewater, heap-leaching
solution ponds, dusts, piles of slags, refractory bricks, sludge, waste
rock/overburden, and spent ore. Spills and leaks from lined manage-
ment units, valves, and pipes also are known to occur.

Contaminated lands can pose a threat depending on several factors
such as site characteristics and potential exposure of sensitive
populations. The negative effects of land contamination on
ecosystems and wildlife occur after contaminants have been released
on land (soil/sediment) or into the air or water. Often, land contami-
nation leads to water or air contamination by means of gravity, wind,
or rainfall. No specific indicator was identified at this time.
Chapter 3 - Better Protected Land        3.3 Waste and Contaminated Lands
                                                                                                                       3-51

-------
3.4  Challenges   and
Data  Gaps
Many of the specific data gaps related to development of the
described indicators and their ability to answer the questions posed
have already been identified. The discussion below augments the
previously identified gaps.

3.4.1 Land Use

The ability to accurately characterize and track land use over time is
limited. Various federal efforts, such as the USDA NRCS, NRI, the
USDA Forest Service FIA, the U.S. Rsh and Wildlife Service (USFWS)
Status and Trends Program, and the NLCD, contribute in part to
tracking some land uses and a variety of cover types. None of
these are comprehensive for all lands or land uses, and some have
limitations in their frequency of data collection or analysis. Some
cover types and land uses are  not sampled in  any detail, including
private and federal desert lands, federal shrublands and grasslands,
and rangeland. In addition, Alaska is seldom included  in national
inventories, although Alaska represents approximately 16 percent
of the land area of the U.S. and includes extensive shrublands,
grasslands, and tundra.
                            Each of the national systems has developed different methods,
                            definitions, and classification criteria. While some effort has been
                            made to share definitions across some of these systems (e.g., the
                            NRI and FIA systems use essentially the same definition of forest
                            land, and NRI and FWS define wetlands similarly), not all are
                            consistent, especially in descriptions  of developed or urban land,
                            cropland, and rangeland. Examples of differences in classifications
                            and acreage from several current national efforts are shown in
                            Exhibit 3-31  for developed and agricultural land uses. The NLCD
                            uses different classification and land  use definitions because it is
                            based on remote sensing data (an aerial perspective) rather than
                            on ground sampling. FWS information is also based on aerial photo
                            interpretatioiri. Given the increasing availability of high resolution
                            aerial imagery, remotely sensed techniques for land cover delin-
                            eations are likely to increase and classifications  based  on this
                            inventory approach should be coordinated and  defined.

                            Another challenge is developing data on uses and cover types that
                             at present are not adequately sampled. Further challenges include
                             effectively integrating and harmonizing the various results of
                             multi-agency, as well as state and local, efforts and coordinating the
                             limited resources dedicated to national tracking  of land cover/land
                             use changes among agencies, so that inventories can be performed
                             as frequently and as comprehensively as possible. The overarching
                             goal  is to assess national patterns in  such  a way that changes in  land
                             cover and land use that might have implications for human health or
                             ecological condition can be detected and  addressed.
                                      Exhibit 3-31: Land cover/land i se estimates
                                                                                                                               TTI
                                                 rJ Land:;:-!

     National Resources Inventory
     (NRI)A
     The Heinz Center8
     U.S. Census Bureauc
     National Land Cover Data
     (NtCD)°
                                       98 million acres developed land
32 million acres urban and suburban land
47 million acres urbanized areas
13 million acres urban clusters
36.7 million acres low and high density
residential and commercial/industrial/
transportation
                                        377 million acres cropland
                                        32 million acres Conservation Reserve Program land
                                        120 million acres pastureland
                                                                               43.0-500 million acres cropland, hayland, and pastureland
                                                                                No data
331 million acres cropland
179 million acres pastureland and hayland
                                                                                                                                  .••
    Note; The NRI, Helm Center, and NLCD sources do not include Alaska as part of the estimates.

    * USOA, Natural Resouites Conservation Service. Summary Report: 1997 National Resources Inventory (Revise^December 2000). 2000
    8 The Heinz Center, Tht State of the Nation's Ecosystems. 2002.                               IJ
    c US. CenfW Bureau. Corrected Lists of Urbanized Areas and Urban Clusters. November 25, 2002. (Marc|2003; http://www.cemus..
                                  _                                                         ..
    0 U5GS,NaikK«1 Und Cover Dataset NLCD Und Cover Statistics. 2001. (March 2003; MtP://landcoveru\j>sgov/nlcdhtml).
  3-52
             3.4 Challenges and Data Gaps          Chapter 3 - Better Protected Land   [

-------
     The data available that actually summarize a national picture of land
     use are extremely limited. Relatively little comprehensive information
     exists about federal land management practices and extent  For
     example, while the USDA Forest Service tracks acres managed for
     timber production, data are not easily accessible on acres used for
     grazing; oil, gas, and mineral development; or recreation  Data
     needed to. summarize all lands under some form of "protection "
    such as parks, wilderness areas, reserves, or conservation easements
    at all levels of government, do not exist.

    In many cases, where land is used to produce food or fiber, indica-
    tors that report the amounts and  values of these commodities might
    be used to' identify the condition/stress/pressure on the land.
    Examples of commodities include agricultural products forest
    products, and cattle produced from grazing land. The amount of
    fresh water used by humans might also be a good indicator of the
    pressure being applied to land and water resources. Commodity
    production is commonly correlated closely to population growth
    Reporting of commodity production trends in agriculture and
   forestry might also provide another view of the effects of these
   activities on the land  and help evaluate policy options for ensuring
   long term, sustainable commodity production while reducing
   environmental effects.

   Land  provides many other benefits  in addition to commodity produc-
   tion. Research is being conducted on the subject of quantifying
   these "ecosystem services." Indicators are needed that will enable
   measuring and tracking some of these, services.

  3.4.2 Qemicals

  Most of the national efforts to track chemical usage focus on how
  much is produced, used, or released, with less emphasis on tracking
  the extent or area of use. The TRI database requires reporting of
  releases of certain volumes of specific chemicals, but aside from
  knowing the location of initial releases, it does not track the extent
  of the  area that might in some way be affected by the chemicals
  In addition, pesticide and fertilizer use are primarily tracked by
  understanding where these chemicals are sold, rather than where
  they are actually used.

  Further, not all toxic chemicals are on the list of TRI chemicals and
 therefore, some toxics are not reported.  The TRI program faces the
 challenge of maintaining a current list that reflects the constant
 development, use, and release of new chemicals that might have
 effects  on  human and ecological health.
    lnd,cators for pesticide residue in food, potential pesticide runoff
    from farmlands, risk of nitrogen runoff, and risk of phosphorus runoff
    all address some part of the question of potential chemical
    d,spos,tion. Only the indicator for pesticide residues in food
    however, goes beyond stating the potential for chemicals to leave
   their point of use and actually shows the potential for consumers to
   be exposed to these chemicals. Indicators to better understand the
   actual deposition of chemicals, rather than potential disposition
   would be useful to correlate with actual human health and ecological
   condition indicators.
     State Pesticide Use Reporting Systems

    While there is no national pesticide use reporting system, several
    state systems exist. For example, California, with the most
    advanced system in the country, has had full pesticide use
    reporting since 1990. Reports about the specifics of application
    are filed by large- and small-scale farmers, commercial agricultural
    pesticide applicators, structural pest control companies, and
    commercial landscaping firms. (California Department of
    Pesticide Regulation, 2000.)
  Better indicators of the linkages between chemical applications on
  the landscape and chemicals that find their way into the bodies of
  humans and other species are needed This includes better informa-
  tion on the chemistry, quantities, and longevity of various sub-
  stances; on the cumulative effects of various chemicals on the envi-
  ronment and humans; and on the pathways and effects of exposure
  In cases where nutrients do reach receiving waterbodies and raise the
 concentrations^above background levels, considerable uncertainty
 still exists concerning ultimate ecological effects. Current research
 does not clearly quantify the relationship between raised nutrient
 levels and resulting ecological changes.

 Better information is needed to provide an accurate picture of the
 human health effects of pesticide use. This information is difficult to
 collect, however. Even in California, where significant resources are
 ded,cated to  pesticide regulation, the best available indicator is a
 measure of reported illnesses and injuries from pesticide exposure in
the workplace. While this is valuable information, it does not address
potential long-term health effects of non-workplace exposure that
might result through drinking water and food exposure.
Chapter 3 - Better Protected Land
                                                 3.4 Challenges and Data Caps
                                                                                                                            3-53

-------
          , „ .        11 l| I       •:•* •>:   '  :. .  ' i	i.,,-1	-• ••-•!-•	—i™™^^                   H.npii«
3.4.3 Waste and Lands Used for Waste Management

Several challenges and data gaps limit the understanding of waste
and its effects on human health and ecological condition. First, as
noted, waste data tend to be developed in response to the require-
ments of specific mandates or regulations. Because these regulat.ons
do not apply to all types of waste and are carried out at different
levels of government, and in the private sector, complete data do
not exist to answer the question: "How much waste is generated?
Additionally, most waste generation is reported only by we.gnt  	
 providing little  understanding of the volume of waste produced.

 Information about the amount of waste generated  does not provide
 a complete picture on either the extent of waste-related problems or
 the effects of waste on human health, ecosystems, or the ambient
 environment. Different waste types pose substantially different types
 of risks. Some  wastes are known to be hazardous to humans and the
 environment, but specifics about exposures and the effects of many
 other waste types are not well understood and data are limited.
 Finally, the risks posed by waste are largely a function of the type
 and effectiveness of waste management. The available data on waste
  and waste management have been limited by the stringent  regulatory
  requirements  and definitions that have driven most of the national
  information collection efforts.

  Data to describe how lands are affected by waste management are
  also limited.  Even basic statistics  on the acreage of lands used for
  managing waste and the condition of those lands are  not available
  at the national level. To gain a more complete understanding  ot
  the extent and effects of land used for waste management would
   require information on waste management methods, standards,
   and compliance, as well as information on lands where illegal
   dumping occurs. Establishing  linkages to human populations or
   ecosystems within close proximity to lands managed for waste is
   an additional challenge.
3.U.4 Contaminated Land

Today the best available information used to describe extent of
contaminated land includes measures of the number and location of
sites, two indicators of contaminated land that" lack national-quality
data are the extent of contaminated land and the effects of
contamination.

 Determining the extent of contaminated land would require national-
 level information on the number, location, and area of contaminated
 lands and data on the specific site contaminants and the associated
 risks, hazards, and potential exposures. Additional factors such as the
 potential contamination of ground water sources and the
 transportation or disposal methods needed to clean up the
 contamination would have to be considered. Such data are currently
 captured for only a subset of the  nation's contaminated lands. In
 addition, information on known contaminated lands (e.g., some sites
 in EPA's Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation,
 and Liability Information System)  that are not on the Superfund's
 NPL data in state and local databases, and information on the other
 type's of contaminated  lands (e.g., leaking underground storage
 tanks) are not captured in the existing data.
     3-54
                                                      3.4 Challenges and Data Gaps
                            Chapter 3 - Better Protected Land

-------
   Cl : i:-[ ••''. : 1: ••;*?•'..., j- ;;i 'i •••••!: - M '' v'-•.'''• • •• '.
   hapter 4:


Human Health

-------
Indicators that were selected and included in this chapter were assigned to one o| |w,o categories:
• Category 1  -"he indicator has been peer reviewed and is supported by natioi} j| level data coverage for more than one time period,
  The supporting data are comparable across the nation and are characterized bj jsounrf collection methodologies, data management
  systems, and quality assurance procedures.
• Category 2 -The indicator has been peer reviewed, but the supporting data a||availab|e only for part of the nation (e.g., multi-state
  regions or ecoregions), or the indicator has not been measured for mpre than |pe time period, or not all the parameters of the
  indicator have been measured (e.g., data has been collected for birds, but not | olants or insects). The supporting data are
  comparable across the areas covered, and are characterized by,; sound cpllectio Qfiethodologies, data management systems, and
  quality assurance procedures.                                            i

-------
                                        ocument
  4.0  Introduction
 The U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) is moving in the
 direction of measuring and assessing human health and ecological
 outcomes. Traditionally, EPA has used indicators such as decreases
 in emissions/discharges or decreases in ambient pollutant levels to
 measure environmental improvement. Health outcome measures
 complement these traditional approaches by reflecting the actual
 public health or ecological impacts that result from environmental
 pollution. By providing a quantitative assessment of these impacts,
 outcome indicators can strengthen environmental decision-making
 and enhance EPA's ability to evaluate, prospectively or retrospec-
 tively, the success of those decisions.

 The key to using outcome-based indicators is a clear understanding
 of the sequence of events that link changes in environmental
 conditions to health or ecological outcomes. Exhibit 4-1 depicts
 this sequence for human  health. Each block in the diagram can
 have indicators associated with it. Indicators for the presence of
 pollutants or other stressors affecting air, water, and land are
 covered  in Chapters 1  (Cleaner Air), 2 (Purer Water),  and
           3 (Better Protected Land), respectively, of this report. Indicators for
           the presence of pollutants in the body and their effects on health
           (altered structure or function, morbidity, or mortality) are covered
           in this chapter.

           The paradigm depicted in Exhibit 4-1 underlies the science upon
           which EPA bases its risk assessment process (NRC, 1983). Risk
           assessments, to a large degree, seek to estimate all linkages depicted
           in the exhibit. However, understanding the link between human expo-
           sure and  health outcomes has always been challenging. Decades of
           research have provided the scientific foundation for understanding
           how exposure to individual pollutants at elevated levels'may affect
           human health. There is less certainly, however, about the effects of
           ambient exposures, which typically involve exposure to multiple
           pollutants at lower levels. Improved understanding of the linkages
           between these exposures and public health would strengthen EPA's
           ability to  make and evaluate decisions.

           The indicators that describe the public health consequences of
           environmental exposures  are called environmental  public health
           indicators (EPHIs). Numerous national and international organiza-
           tions have recognized the compelling need for EPHIs. The greatest
           impetus came from a series of reports, by the Pew Environmental
                                        Exhibit 4-1: Environmental public health paradigm
                                                        "**   ). s  .   *     a.    3   X*     _ ... t, ,
                  [utant Formation
                  and Release
                 ^Lfnom Source
                                           Exposure/Contact   I
        Air, Water, and Land Chapters
                                                      - Individual
                                                      - Community
                                                      - Population
                                                                                                   Adverse Outcomes
                                                                                                      Mortality and
                                                                                                       Morbidity
       : Modified from National Research Council, Risk Assessment in the federal Government Managing the Process 1983

       	•	•—-"—s—".-^~~~—<—-——__i^uu__^UUE	***itmf™li*mma&atmtmlnimfauimau^
Chapter 4 - Human Health
4.0 Introduction
                                                                   4-3

-------
TecMcal  Document
                                                                      raft Report on the  Ehyironi^ent 2p|)|
Health Commission, which called on "Congress and the White House
to protect Americans from chronic diseases—by tracking where and
when these health problems occur and possible links to environmen-
tal factors." The commission proposed that a Nationwide Health
Tracking Network be established to track selected diseases and
priority environmental exposures (Pew, 2001). When combined with
other information, such as environmental monitoring data and data
from toxicological, epidemiological, or clinical studies, EPHIs can be
an important key to improving understanding of the relationship
between pollution and health outcomes.
     Use of Environmental Public Health
                        Indicators

  Environmental public health indicators can be used to:
  • Describe the health status of a population and discover
    important time trends in disease and exposure frequency.
    Most, if not all, of the indicators presented in this chapter
    perform this function.
  • Explain the occurrence or prevalence of diseases and exposure
    by helping to identify causal factors for specific diseases or
    trends. For example, the decline in the lung cancer rate in men
    has been related to the decline in smoking. For some areas
    presented in this chapter, the evidence for a  relationship is
    quite strong (e.g., air pollution and pulmonary-cardiovascular
    related-illnesses). Other areas will require further research to
    better understand these linkages.
  • Predict the number of disease occurrences and the distribu-
    tion of exposure in specific populations. Such predictions
    could be used, for example, as input for setting priorities and
    making decisions to protect public health—e.g., establishing
    cleanup levels for  environmental waste sites or regulatory levels
    for ambient pollutant levels. (Understanding the relationship
    between  exposure and consequent health effects is critical to
    using indicators for predictive purposes.)
  • Evaluate policy decisions or interventions. (Again, understand-
    ing the relationship between exposure and effect is critical for
    this use.)
 Two types of environmental public health indicators are described
 in this chapter:
 • Health outcome indicators. These indicators measure the occur-
   rence in a population of diseases or conditions that are known or
   believed to be caused to some degree or exacerbated by exposure
   to environmental pollutants or stressors.
 • Exposure indicators. While there are four types of exposure
   indicators (see sidebar), this chapter focuses on biomonitoring
   indicators, which involve using tests of human fluid and tissue
   samples to identify the presence of a substance or combination
   of substances in the human body.
                                                                                       S^
                                             For some of the EPHIs. described in this chapter, a strong linkage has
                                             been established between environmental exposure and outcome.
                                             However, for many of the EPHIs presented, such as the outcome
                                             indicator of overall mortality, no linkage between environmental
                                             exposure and outcome has been determined. For these, further
                                             research, would be needed to establish and strengthen any linkages.
                                             Similarly, for some EPHIs, the linkage with the source of the pollution
                                             is clear (e.g., lead in gasoline), while for others the source or sources
                                             are much less certain.             '  -      .
                                                    if fypes of Exposure Indicators

                                               Four j pproaches can be used to measure pr estimate exposure
                                               (i.e., t irect human contact with a pollutant). No approach is
                                               best": uited to all pollutants. Different approaches are
                                               appropriate to different types of pollutants, and each approach
                                               has si rengths and weaknesses.
                                               • Arrbient pollutant measurements. Historically,
                                                 en\ ironmental measurements "of arobjent pollutant
                                                 concentrations have generally beerj used to estimate hupian	
                                                 exposures. One limitation of ambient measurements is that
                                                 the "presence of a pollutant in the environment does not
                                                 necessarily mean that anyone has been exposed. Chapters 1
                                                 (Cleaner Air), 2 (Purer Water), arid 3  (Better Protected
                                                 Laiiid) provide examples of ambient measurement indicators.
                                               • Stochastic models of exposure. This approach combines '.'.'.
                                                 knowledge of environmental pollutant concentrations with
                                                 information on people's activities and  locations (e.g., time
                                                 spent working, exercising outdoors, sleeping, shopping) to
                                                 account for their contact with pollutants. This approach
                                                 requires knowledge of pollutant levels  where people live,
                                                 work and play, as well as knowledge of the choice's thai t'Hey
                                                 make in regard to day-to-day activities.            .......

                                               • Personal monitoring data. With personal monitoring, the
                                                 mmbnifoTing''datar'S"everal environmental pollutants,	'
                                                  nctably heavy metals and some pesticides, can be found  it),.:
                                               :   th]l body. These, pollutants or their breakdown products  (ue.,
                                                  metabolites formed when a pollutant is broken dpwh in the
                                               ;	b|ray)  leave residues that can be measured in human tissue
                                                  ouj.uicjs such as. blood or urine. These  residues je fleet the^ ^^
                                                  a|Eunt of the pollutant that actually gets into the body, tut by"
                                                  trfimselves they provide no information on how the individual
                                                  came into contact with the pollutant.
                                                    1
 4-4
                                                         4.0 Introduction
                                                                           Chapter 4 - Human Health

-------
the Environment 2Q03: • ^chrik
                                                                                                  Document
  One of the greatest challenges to elucidating the connection between
  environmental exposure and disease is the fact that exposure to an
  environmental pollutant or stressor is rarely the sole cause of an adverse
  health outcome. More generally, individuals are exposed to more than
  one pollutant at a time, and exposure is just one of several factors that
  contribute to the disease occurring or to the severity of a preexisting
  disease. Other factors include, for example, diet, exercise, alcohol
  consumption, heredity, medications, and whether other diseases are also
  present Also, different people have different vulnerabilities, so some may
  experience effects to certain ambient exposure levels while others may
  not. All these factors make it difficult to establish a causal relationship
  between exposure to environmental pollutants and disease outcome
  except in rare cases, such  as some historical occupational exposures,
  where exposure was unusually high.

  This chapter presents a broad spectrum of indicators that can now be
  used, or could potentially be employed in the future, to assess and track
  the public health impacts of environmental exposures. These indicators
  provide an overview of the health and exposure of people in the U.S.
 and identify the trends of those indicators in the U.S. Specific indicators
 for exposure and outcomes  in children are presented, as children may
 be especially susceptible to_environmental pollutants.

 This chapter is organized into six sections:

 • Section 4.1 describes three case studies that  illustrate the role of
   indicators in establishing linkages between effects and outcomes
   and in evaluating environmental management actions.

 • Section 4.2 compares health measures within  the U.S. to these
   same measures throughout the rest of the world.
 • Section 4.3 discusses outcome indicators and trends for selected
   diseases that either have a major impact on the health .of people
   in the U.S. or may be caused to some extent by environmental
   pollution. Exhibit 4-2 lists the key public health questions thatare
   asked in this section and the indicators that are available to help
   answer these questions.

 • Section 4.4 presents biomonitoring indicators and trends for spe-
   cific environmental pollutants. The section begins by providing
   background on biomonitoring indicators and their limitations and
   data sources. The section then presents biomonitoring indicators
   for numerous specific pollutants and discusses  other important
   pollutants for which  biomonitoring data are not yet available.
   Exposure  information for many of these pollutants is discussed in
   Chapters  1  (Cleaner Air), 2  (Purer Water), and  3 (Better
   Protected Land) of this report. The key exposure questions asked
   in this section and the  indicators available to help answer these
   questions are presented in Exhibit 4-2.

• Section 4.5 discusses  an emerging field that attempts to quantify
   the overall burden of environmental disease on  society.
• Section 4.6 discusses the key challenges and data gaps for
   understanding the link between environmental exposure and
   health outcomes,  and some recent government  activities to
   continue and advance the work in this  area.
                               Many federal and state government agencies collect data that
                               underlie environmental public health indicators. Continued effective
                               coordination and collaboration among such agencies will be vital to
                               further the development and use of environmental public health
                               indicators. Key data sources used for this chapter include the:

                               • World Health Organization (WHO), World Health Statistics
                                 Annual, a joint effort by the national health and statistical admin-
                                 istrations of many countries, the United Nations, and WHO.

                               • United Nations, Demographic Yearbook, a comprehensive
                                 collection of international demographic statistics compiled from
                                 questionnaires sent annually and monthly to national statistical
                                 services and other government offices.

                               • National Center for Health Statistics, National Vital Statistics
                                 System, which provides data on births, deaths, marriages, and
                                 divorces in the U.S.  since 1933.

                               • National Center for Health Statistics, National Health
                                 Interview Survey (NHIS), a continuous nationwide survey in
                                 which data  on personal and demographic characteristics, illnesses,
                                 injuries, impairments, chronic conditions,  utilization of health
                                 resources, and other health topics are collected through personal
                                 household interviews.

                               • Centers for Disease Control and Prevention, Epidemiology
                                 Program Office, National Notifiable  Diseases Surveillance
                                 System, which provides weekly provisional information on the
                                 occurrence of diseases defined as notifiable (i.e., a disease
                                 that health  providers must report to state or local public health
                                 officials due to its contagiousness, severity, or frequency).
                               • National Institutes  of Health,  National  Cancer Institute,
                                 Surveillance, Epidemiology, and End  Results Program,
                                 which provides data  on all residents diagnosed with cancer in
                                 11 geographic areas  of the U.S.

                               • The EPA's National Human Exposure Assessment Survey
                                 (NHEXAS), a multiday, multimedia study that examined
                                 chemical concentrations in indoor air, outdoor air, dust, soil, food,
                                 beverages, drinking water, and tap water.

                              • National Center for Health Statistics, National Health and
                                 Nutrition Examination Survey  (NHANES), a series of surveys
                                designed to collect data on the health and nutritional status of
                                the U.S. population.  Chemicals and their metabolites were
                                measured in blood and urine samples from selected participants.

                              The chapter is not intended to be exhaustive. Rather, it provides a
                              snapshot, at the national level, of the current U.S. environmental
                              public health indicators and status  based on  key data sources with
                              sufficiently robust design, quality assurance, and maturity. The
                              chapter does not provide health status information that may be
                              more applicable to certain geographic areas or to subgroups with
                              potentially greater susceptibility to environmental pollution due to
                              such factors as age, genetics, lifestyle, or medical status.
Chapter 4 - 'Human Health       4.1 Environmental Pollution and Disease: Links Between Exposure and Health Outcomes
                                                                                        4-5

-------
,	—~	:	1 	* 	"            if,          -


 £FAs Draft teport on the Environment 2003
                                     ecnnica
                                                          BWSBil^

                        Exhibit U-2:  Human Health - Questiqhs and indicators
                                                                                            !
  s
  i

  i"

  i
  r  -
  i.
•s -Health Status of the U.S. : Indicators and Trends,Ef Health and Disease
                           I      *-  «
0,,«r«n i ' i i . Indicator ^ame i: ; j
What are the trends for life expectancy?



What arc the trends for cancer, cardiovascular disease,
chronic obstructive pulmonary disease and asthma?
What are the trends for gastrointestinal illness?
What arc the tends for children's environmental health issues?
Life expectancy
l_ancer mortality
Cancer incidence
Cardiovascular disease mortality
Cardiovascular disease prevalence
Chronic obstructive pulmona 7 disease mortality
Asthma mortality
Asthma prevalence
Cholera prevalence
Cryptosporidiosis prevalence
E. coli O157:H7 prevalence
Hepatitis A prevalence
Salmonellosis prevalence
Shigellosis prevalence
Typhoid fever prevalence
Infant mortality
Low birthweight incidence
Childhood cancer mortality
Childhood cancer incidence
Childhood asthma mortality
Childhood asthma prevalence
Deaths due to birth defects
Birth defect incidence
*- 	 it
Category ],.;. [
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1

' 1
] Section 1 1
4.3.1
4.3.2
4.3.2
4.3.2
4.3.2
4.3.2
4.3.2
4.3.3
4.3.3
4.3.3
4.3.3
4.3.3
4.3.3
4.3.3
4.3.4
4.3.4
4.3.4
4.3.4
4.3.4
4.3.4
4.3.4
4.3.4

	 1 	 | 	 i Measuring Exposure to Environmental follutioi|: Indicators and trends, r , t
Question [ : , - i , , ,


What is the level of exposure to heavy metals?

What is the level of exposure to cotinine?
What is the level of exposure to volatile organic compounds?
What is the level of exposure to pesticides?
What is the level of exposure to persistent
organic pollutants?
What are the trends in exposure to environmental
pollutants for children? _,
What is the level of exposure to radiation?
What is the level of exposure to air pollutants?
Wttatis the level of exposure to biological pollutants?
What is the level of exposure to disinfection by-products?
Indicator Name i
Blood lead level
Urine arsenic level
Blood mercury level
Blood cadmium level
Blood cotinine level
Blood volatile organic compound levels
Urine organophosphate levels to indicate pesticides
No Category 1 or 2 indicators identified
Blood lead level in children
Blood mercury .level in children
Blood cotinine level in children
No Category 1 or 2 indicators identified
No Category 1 or 2 indicators identified
Also see Cleaner Air chapte •
No Category 1 or 2 indicators identified
No Category 1 or 2 indicators identified
Categrku
1
2
1
1
1
1
1

1
1
1




Section j 1
4.4.3
4.4.3
4.4.3
4.4.3
4.4.4
4.4.5
4.4.6
4.4.7
4.4.8
4.4.8
4.4.8
4.4.9
4.4.9
4.4.9
4.4.9
   4-6
                                           4.0 Introduction
                                                   Chapter U - Human Health

-------
                    Tecnriical DocunientM Efir\i|  Draft Report  oh tke Environment 20Q3


 U.I  Environmental  Follution
 and  Disease:  Links
 "Between  txposure  and
 Health  Outcomes
 Many studies have demonstrated an association between environ-
 mental exposure and certain diseases or other health problems.  '
 Examples include radon and lung cancer; arsenic and cancer in
 several organs; lead and nervous system disorders; disease-causing
 bacteria such as £. coli O157:H7 (e.g., in contaminated meat and
 water) and gastrointestinal illness and death; and particulate matter
 and aggravation of cardiovascular and respiratory diseases.

 As mentioned in Section 4.0, indicators of outcome and exposure
 can be important tools both for elucidating these links and monitor-
 ing the success of environmental management efforts. Indicators are
 one of several components needed to establish linkage. Other
 important components include ambient pollutant measures and toxi-
 cological, epidemiological, and clinical studies. Three case studies
 are described in this section to demonstrate how indicators can be
 used to establish associations between exposure and effect and to
 evaluate environmental management actions.
                                 fever each year. Deaths due to diarrhea-like illnesses, including
                                 typhoid, cholera, and dysentery, represented the third largest cause
                                 of death in the nation.

                                 Then scientists identified the bacteria responsible for most diarrhea
                                 deaths (typhoid, cholera, and dysentery) and elucidated how these ,
                                 bacteria were transmitted to and among humans. Infected and
                                 diseased individuals shed large quantities of microbes in their feces,
                                 which flowed into and contaminated major water supplies. The  -
                                 contaminated water was then distributed untreated to communities,
                                 which used the water for drinking and other purposes. This created a
                                 continuous transmission cycle.

                                 When treatment (filtration and chlorination) of drinking water was
                                 initiated to remove pathogens, the number of deaths due to
                                 diarrhea diseases dropped dramatically. Deaths due to typhoid fever
                                 were tracked throughout the early 20th century, as drinking water
                                 treatment was implemented across the country. Exhibit 4-3 shows
                                 the percent of the U.S.  population that had treated water and the
                                 disease rate for typhoid fever from 1880-to 1980.

                                 In this example, the outcome measure was death rates due to
                                 typhoid, which was used in conjunction with an environmental
                                 process (the number of people getting treated drinking water)
                                 to evaluate and promulgate the use of drinking water treatment
                                 across the U.S.

                                 Drinking water treatment was one of the great public health success
                                 stories of the 20th century (NAE, 2000). It dramatically and
                                 significantly reduced death rates from waterborne disease, increasing
C_ase jtudy on Waterborne Di
isease
This case study focuses on the impact of drinking
water treatment on the decrease in mortality related
to waterborne diseases. It demonstrates the valuable
contribution to public health protection that can
occur when the link between exposure and health
outcomes is successfully made. As the case study
describes, officials knew there was a high incidence of
gastrointestinal disease, but they were not able to
protect human health until they understood what
caused these diseases. Based on this connection,
officials were able to take effective action to protect
public health. They also were able to use an outcome
measure (deaths due to typhoid) to evaluate the
success of these protective actions.

At the beginning of the 20th century, waterborne
diseases such as typhoid fever and cholera were
major health threats across the U.S. More than
ISO in every 100,000 people died from typhoid
                             txhioit £1-3  tercent of population with treated water
                           s versus typhoid deaths in the United States, 1880-1980
                                                                                       -=$
                          ^«?fe*^;p-r,4,^«^^JMt^^^	„,


                      -stf^K'Wj^^rnfc^r-^i^^^^^^^^^^lF^iti'i'.';",I'1^."«1

                  r^rls|communicationi_^6p3.L|. ,'; r ./ -;•- . J_: .,., ."j, 17;.'.'  ..  , -V> •''"'  -.'- • ".,  ••".   • •'. '  ',.'•'-  ' -'-''-..' P'!'
V_napter 4 - tiuman Health       4.1 Environmental Pollution and Disease: Links Between Exposure and Health Outcomes
                                                                                     4-7

-------
EPAs  Draft Report on  the Environment 20d3
                                                                  echnica
                                                                               IE
           I "' i
Uocuniierit
 life expectancy and reducing infant mortality. Today, public health is
 protected against new and emerging waterborne microbial
 contaminants by continual improvements to the drinking water
 treatment process and continual monitoring of waterborne diseases.
 Deaths due to cholera, typhoid, and dysentery are so rare in this
 country that they do not provide valuable information for evaluating
 the public health impacts of drinking water treatment Instead, the
 number of cases of these diseases are tracked to some extent,
 although reporting is not federally required. Indicators for
 waterborne disease and other important diseases with actual or
 potential environmental origins are discussed in Section 4.3.

 Case Study on Air iollution

 This case study illustrates how the association between deaths and peak
 air pollution concentrations was initially discovered by comparing mortali-
 ty rates and air monitoring data. It also describes how basic research on
 the health effects of air pollution has helped to establish strong linkages
 between levels of certain air pollutants and human health effects. These
 associations have provided sufficient basis for establishing regulations to
 control the level of pollutants in air. The success of these environmental
 management efforts can be evaluated by monitoring levels of regulated
 pollutants in air. However, except for lead (the subject of the third case
 study below), there are as yet no biomonitoring or outcome indicators
 that can more directly measure reduced human exposure or outcome on a
 national level. Nevertheless, a number of potential outcome indicators are
 discussed tliat could be available in the future if systems can be set up to
 track relevant biomonitoring or outcome data with sufficient reliability
 and coverage at a national level.

 Air pollution has been associated with several human health out-
 comes, including reported symptoms  (nose and throat irritation),
 acute onset or exacerbation of existing disease (e.g., asthma,  hospi-
 talizations due to cardiovascular disease), and deaths. The impact of
 air pollution on health was underscored in London in December of
 1952, when a slow-moving area of high pressure came to a halt over
 the city. Fog developed, and particulate and sulfur pollution began
 accumulating in the stagnating air mass. Smoke and sulfur dioxide
 concentrations built up over 3 days. Mortality records showed that
 deaths increased in a pattern very similar to that of the pollution
 measurements.  (This is illustrated in Exhibit 4-4.)  It was estimated
 that 4,000 extra deaths occurred over a 3- to 4-day period.  This
 was the first quantitative air pollution exposure data with a link to an
 adverse health outcome (i.e., mortality).

 While the London episode highlighted the hazard of extreme  air
 pollution episodes, it was unclear whether health effects were
 associated with lower concentrations. By the 1970s, the association
 between respiratory disease and particulate and/or sulfur oxide air
 pollution had been well established (Dockery and Pope, 1997).

 Clinical studies (controlled studies in healthy adult subjects)  also
 provide information about the association between air pollutants and
 health effects. For example, these studies have demonstrated  that
                                                      ozone causes a number of functional, symptomatic, and inflammatory
                                                      responses, which tend to increase with an increase in ozone exposure
                                                      dose (EPA, 1!?96). Effects of ozone include:

                                                      •I Decreased pulmonary function, characterized by changes in lung
                                                         volumes and flow; changes in airway resistance and
                                                         responsiveness; and respiratory symptoms, such as cough and
                                                         pain on deep inspiration (EPA, 1996).

                                                      • An inflamii|iatory response in the lungs (EPA, 1996).

                                                      Based on these types of associations from toxicological, epidemio-
                                                      logical, and clinical studies, EPA has established National Ambient Air
                                                      Quality Standards for six pollutants of concern: ozone, particulate
                                                      matter, carbcin  monoxide, lead, nitrogen dioxide, and sulfur dioxide.
                                                      These standards set limits to protect human health, including the
                                                      health of "sensitive populations" such as asthmatics, children, and
                                                      the elderly (EPA,  1999).  '

                                                      Improvements in measuring air pollution and health endpoints,
                                                      together with advances in analytical techniques, have made it
                                                      possible to begin to quantitatively  evaluate the success of air
                                                      pollution control measures—such as the National Ambient Air
                                                      Quality Standards and associated regulations—to protect and
                                                      improve  public health. Though insufficient data were available at  the
                                                      time of this report to develop EPHIs for any criteria pollutants
                                                      except lead, possible future EPHIs for air pollution include death due
                                                      to respiratory and cardiovascular disease as well as increased hospital
                                                      admissions for respiratory and cardiovascular disease.

  4-8
4.1 Environmental Pollution and Disease: Links Between Exposure and Health Outcomes
             Chapter 4 - Human

-------
                                          ^


                                                                        feSS^K'E*.asSiasS :*=
  Future EPHIs include:

  • Mortality. In many countries including the U.S., particulate air
    pollution has been associated with increased daily mortality from
    heart and lung diseases (e.g., congestive heart disease, chronic
    obstructive lung disease). In addition, chronic exposure to air
    pollution has been linked with increased risk of premature
    mortality (EPA, April 2002).

  • Hospital admissions. Hospitalization records are not widely
    available, and studies have been limited by their availability in
    communities around the U.S. Nevertheless, many studies have
    shown that increased admissions for cardiovascular and respiratory
    diseases are associated with increased pollutant concentrations.


  Most recently, subtle changes in the cardiovascular system that
  can increase a person's risk of heart attack and bring about other
  cardiovascular effects have been identified  as possible EPHIs.


  Establishing EPHIs for air pollution and health effects, whether
 cardiovascular or pulmonary, is still challenged by limits in knowledge
 of how much air pollution contributes to the risk of both
 cardiovascular and respiratory disease. Research is still needed to
 better understand which components of air pollution (i.e., gases,
 metals, or organics) cause health effects; the extent to which they
 contribute to risk; and  the extent to which other factors (e.g.,
 genetics, lifestyle, age) contribute to risk. Given these limitations, no
 indicators are presented for any of the six criteria pollutants except
 lead. A case study on lead is presented below, with further
 discussion on lead as an indicator provided in Section 4.4.

 Case  Study on Lead

 The third case study concerns lead, a toxic pollutant to which there is
 human  exposure from many different sources. In the previous case studies,
 outcome indicators were an important key to establishing a linkage
 between a health effect and its cause. Understanding the cause  enabled
 officials to take action to protect public health. In the case of lead,
 though  it was a known toxin, exposure came from so many sources that it
 was difficult to know what actions at the national level would effectively
 reduce lead exposure. Once regulations to do so were put in place,
 biomonitoring data provided a way to evaluate the success of this
 environmental management effort in reducing exposure to lead in the U.S.

 Lead is a neurotoxic metal that affects areas of the  brain that regu-
 late behavior and nerve cell development  (NAP, 1993). Its adverse
 effects  range from subtle responses to overt toxicity, depending on
 how much lead is taken  into the body and the age and health status
 of the person (CDC, 1991).

 Currently in the  U.S:, human exposure to lead may occur in several
ways,  as listed in Exhibit 4-5. For example:
 • Homes built before 1978, commercial buildings, and steel struc-
   tures may contain deteriorating lead-based paint, which creates
   lead-contaminated dust (EPA, 1996). An estimated 24 million
   housing units in the U.S. are at risk for containing some lead paint
   hazards (U.S. Department of Housing and Urban Development,
   2000). Of these, 16 million homes with lead-based paint have
   children in  residence who are younger than 6 years old.

 • Other sources of lead exposure include lead-contaminated soil,
   dust, and drinking water; industrial emissions; and miscellaneous
   sources (CDC, 1991).

 For many years, the largest source of lead in the U.S. environment
 came from leaded gasoline. Elemental  lead was emitted in the
 exhaust and settled on the ground and in people's homes.

 Most lead enters the body via ingestion and inhalation, after which it
 is absorbed by the bloodstream. Also, lead can cross the placenta,
 exposing the fetus to lead (EPA, 1996). In adults,  most lead poison-
 ing is associated with occupational exposures.

 Infants, children, and fetuses are more vulnerable to the effects of
 lead because'their blood-brain barrier is not fully developed
 (Nadakavukaren, 2000). In addition, ingested lead is more readily
 absorbed into a child's bloodstream. Children absorb 40 percent of
 ingested lead into their bloodstreams,  while adults absorb only 10
percent. In children, three major organ systems are affected by lead:
the nervous system (the brain), the kidney, and the blood-forming
organs (NRC,  1993).
    Lead-based paint
Homes (built before 1978)
Commercial buildings
Steel structures (bridges, water towers)
    Lead-contaminated
    soil and dust
Industrial emissions
Past leaded gasoline use
Deteriorating lead-based paint
    Lead-contaminated
    drinking water
Leaded plumbing solder
(now banned)
    Miscellaneous          Home hobbies - art, jewelry,
                         fishing weights
                         Use of pewter dishware
                         Cosmetics, traditional medicines
                         Parental occupations
                                                                        gpurce CDC. Preventing lead Poisoning in Young Children 1991.
Chapter 4  - Human  Health        4.1 Environmental Pollution and Disease: Links Between Exposure and Health Outcomes
                                                           4-9

-------
EFAs Draft feort on  the Environment 2003 •  Technical Document
                     l'"T                      ::  I               ••'•'!-                      •      . :||:, ;,
 As awareness of the health effects of lead has increased, the CDC
 has lowered the level considered to be a human health hazard
 (Exhibit 4-6) (CDC, 1991). In 1970, a blood lead level of 40 micro-
 grams per deciliter (Ug/dL) or higher was considered a hazard.
 Today, 10 |Jg/dL or higher is considered a hazard (EPA, December
 2000). Recent research suggests that blood lead levels less than 10
 (Jg/dL may still produce subtle, subclinical health effects in children
 (Schmidt, 1999). In 1984, an estimated 6 million children and
 400,000 fetuses were exposed to lead at levels that placed them at
 risk for adverse effects (NAP, 1993). Approximately 4.4 percent of
 all U.S. children in the 1990s had elevated blood lead levels (NCEH,
 1998). As of 1998, an estimated 1 million U.S. children had blood
 lead levels above 10 Mg/dL (NCEH, 1998).

 Lead is one of the few pollutants for which biomonitoring and link-
 age data are sufficient to clearly evaluate environmental management
 efforts to reduce lead in the environment. The National Center for
 Health Statistics' National Health and Nutrition  Examination Survey
 (NHANES), a national survey of the health status of the U.S. popula-
 tion, has determined blood lead levels for the U.S. population since
 the early 1970s. In the 1970s, lead poisoning occurred increasingly
 in children who did not live in dwellings with lead-based paint,
 suggesting that another source or sources of lead exposure were
 of even greater concern than lead paint. Research found that
 combustion of leaded gasoline was the primary source of lead in
 the environment EPA promulgated two regulations:
 • One required the availability of unleaded fuel for automobiles
   designed to meet federal emission standards (e.g., catalytic
   converters) (EPA, 1973).
 fc  Exhibit U-6: Blood lead levels considered elevated by the   ^
 '.Centers for Disease Control and Prevention and the Public  ,
 1          :     HealtK Service, 1970-1990
             „ 1970
                        1975
                                 1980
                                          1985
                                                1990
|

fcSWMSK,£fiC. Prmntmg I-""* ftiisorring in Young CWWren. 1991.
                                                          d
                                           in Hiiiniii 111 inn u i in • in  iii iii i n«iff i i
                                                                • The second required a reduction of the lead content in leaded
                                                                  gasoline (EPA, 1986).


                                                                Over the next decade, peak outdoor-air lead concentrations
                                                                decreased as a result of these controls. Exhibit 4-7 compares the
                                                                amount Of lead used in gasoline production and the average blood
                                                                lead levels  provided by the NHANES from 1976 to 1980. The
                                                                NHANES survey found a similar decline in children's blood lead levels
                                                                (Exhibit 4-8). In 1991, a report from the National Academy of
                                                                Sciences predicted that declining ambient lead levels would reduce
                                                                the average.blood lead level to less than IS Ug/dL By the late
                                                                1990s, the average  blood lead level in the U.S. for children was
                                                                3 |Jg/dL (Schmidt, 1999). These data show a demonstrable effect
                                                                between regulatory actions to control lead and human exposure.

                                                                                         id used in qasoW production
                                                                                            f    ^^^K&^fAMMs^iAi^ffy'iAtf^ii^iS
                                                                                 ik,  .4    *,*-*    ««y^«gK*afe;fe!WS*S^
                                                                                  *   i     V«« /-,^~ *to^'>:.n^.te***^iS!S«*^*-i!^yfe|iii
                                                                                 ;d rates per TOQ.OOO people                        .  |
                                                                                                                          'iS*iiSliiS|
                                                                                      Lead used in gasoline
                                                                                      Average blood lead (ug/dL)
                                                                                            icit Measunn^ le^w Expdswres7n/nfonts,  •
                                                                                            i^i'n-lfcVVW (>Tn»W,T&f"l^-j;Ar^S*1".'a1f;"X>ai%W>* IV.JJi.-lft^HSlW^r
                                                                               fe?i^-;;:,?v^;iK«J^'a*'P"?-.^^i .' ,.-;:«,>:,;--?-»;;;»;' :-.,i: ISr., fc.s,;,3;;,,;,;.rj.
   4-10
            4.1 Environmental Pollution and Disease: Links Between Exposure and Health Outcomes      Chapter U - Human Health

-------
                                                           '" • ' * * '"''-•   i    "•••••" •- "  '  '°              ~-~ . •			.—   .__	

                                                            £fi^i:DraftReport on the  Environment 2003
    tlucidating Other Linkages
   For all three case studies, the linkage between exposure and disease
   is fairly strong. Subsequent sections of this chapter describe a
   number of areas of concern regarding the potential human health
   impacts of environmental exposure. The linkage in these areas ranges
   from strong to weak. For example, in some cases outcome indicators
   are available, but scientists are not yet sure how much of that
   outcome is contributed by environmental factors. In other cases,
   biomonitoring indicators are available, but scientists are not sure
   whether the presence of a contaminant in the body at the levels
   shown by the indicators causes adverse health effects. These areas
   are discussed in this chapter, despite relatively weak linkages,
   because the use of outcome and biomonitoring indicators is a
   developing area. Understanding of linkages will be strengthened
   over time as more research is conducted to develop environmental
   public health indicators and other data that reveal how pollutants
   contribute to disease.
    Exnibit 4-8: Concentration of lead in Uood of
          age 5 and under, 1976-198O 1988-1991,
Li'               1992-1994,1999-2000
                                                   children
                                                            "T
                                                              "4
         25
    *<*  20
         15
     S .1QU
  Err
                        90th percentile (10 percent of
                        _ children have this blood lead level
                        or greater)
             Median value
             (SO percent of children
             have this blood lead level
             or greater)
             1976-
             1980
                              1988-  1992-
                              1991   1994
1999-    J
2000     J
            10 jig/dL of blood lead has been identified by CDC as elevated, which
           indicates the need for int^rver^on, (CDC Preventing Lead Po,Son,ng m
           Young Children  1991.)

            Recent research suggests that bipod Jewels less than 10 (ig/dl. may still
           produce subtle, subclinical heajth, effects m children (Schmidt, C W
           Poisoning Young Minds. 1999.)

           Source- U S ^Environmental Protection Agency America's Children and the
           Environment-Measures of Contaminants, Body Burdens, and Illnesses, Second
           Edition  February 2003. Data from CDC, National Center for Health
           Statistics, National Health and Nutrition Bafiwahoji Survey, 1976-
          2000
                                                  -       J
    4.2    Health  Status  of the



    U.j.   C-ompared  to  the



    Rest of  the  World

    Several measures are used worldwide to describe health status.
    These indicators include life expectancy (i.e., the number of years
    people can expect to live at birth), the number of infant deaths, and
   the major causes of deaths.

   Collecting and reporting the data necessary to compare these
   measures between nations is a challenge. Yet, as travel and
   communications increasingly link the health of nations in the world,
   the importance of having comparable information has increased.
   Fortunately, considerable progress has been made to improve the
   comparability of the necessary data  among nations.

   In addition to enabling comparisons of health status, the data also
   can be used to inform U.S. environmental health policy and
   programs, to focus research efforts, and to provide insights into
   linkages between environmental factors and health.

   Life Expectancy

  Life expectancy is the average number of years at birth that a
  group of infants would live if throughout life they experienced the
  age-specific death  rates present at birth. In 2000, life expectancy at
  birth for all people in the U.S. was a record 76.9 years  (Pastor, et al.,
  2002). In 1997, the U.S. ranked 19th in terms of life expectancy for'
  both females and males when compared with other countries
  (Exhibit 4-9). Life expectancy at birth varies widely, both between
  males and females and between nations. For both sexes, Japan
  reports the highest life expectancy of all nations, with males
-  expected to  live 772 years and females expected to live 83.8 years.

  Infant Mortality

  Infant mortality is a particularly useful measure of health status
  because it indicates both the current health status of the population
 and predicts the health of the next generation (NCHS, 2001).
 Between 1970 and 2000, the infant mortality rate in the U.S.
 declined from 20.0 to 6.9 per 1,000  live births, the lowest ever
 recorded in the U.S. (Pastor, et al.,  2002; Mannino and Smith,
 2001). When compared to other countries, the U.S. ranked 11 th in
 1960 with regard to infant mortality. In 1998,  the U.S. ranked 28th
 (Exhibit 4-10).
Chapter 4 - Human Health       4.2 Health Status of the U.S. Compared to the Rest of the World
                                                                                                                       4-11

-------
EFAs Draft Report on tne Environment 2OQ3
                                                                         JL.
 Leading Causes of Death

 It Is customary to measure the health of a nation by listing the lead-
 ing causes of death. Comparisons of the 10 leading causes of death
 in the U.S. and for the world demonstrate that infectious diseases
 are a major contributor to deaths outside of the U.S. Four of the 10
 leading causes of death in the world are infectious diseases
 (Exhibit 4-11). These diseases account for 20.3 percent of the
 deaths worldwide. Heart disease is the leading cause of death in the
 U.S. as well as in the world. While heart disease accounts for nearly
 one-third of the deaths in the U.S., it accounts for only 12.4 percent
 of the deaths in the world.
                                                        Cancer Morbidity and Mortality
                                                        The age-adjusted cancer mortality rates for all body sites except skin
                                                        are higher for males than females in all of the countries presented in
                                                        Exhibit 4-12. There is wide variation among men and women in age-
                                                        adjusted cancer death rates. Hungary has the highest age-adjusted
                                                        total cancer (except skin) death rates for both males and females
                                                        (272.3  and 149.4 per 100,000 people, respectively). The U.S. ranks
                                                        16th for males, with an age-adjusted cancer death rate of 161.8 per
                                                        100,000, and 10th for females, with an age-adjusted cancer death
                                                        rate of 116.4 per 100,000. Sweden has the lowest age-adjusted
                            Exnitit 4-9:  Life expectancy at birth,i:|ccording to sex,
                                    United States and selected coifitries, 1997
                                         •   --T .->     •-  .... 1^..	-..-. ->-..; .-...vfe-	:••	•..•.•-:X".:.l*&!

Note:
least f
Source:
              milfion'people.
               Pastor* R.N., et al. Health. United States, 2I&02.
                                                          .  (jgeinyedia    Jit                             ,
                                     lowest life, expectancy base j on the latest d|teha6rewfo^ountries^rge6gPaPh!c areas with at
    4-12
                     4.2 Health Status of the U.S. Compared to the Rest of the World
                                                                                      Chapter 4 - Human Health

-------
                                                                                       °fi the;Environment  2003
         ioit 4-10:  Infant mortality rates per 1,000 live oirtns,  ,
           United States and selected countries, 1998
Hong kong
fesor^ i. Sweden
jlpi*~
/apan
Norway
, Finland
ISEX, f
1 f Singapore
1 Ife-^- France
(fc, • Germany
&, 4 Denmark
jf~ _» -Switzerland

H^ Austria
^™v Australia
|L Czech Republic
Is
SN>. . Netherlands
ft* i
SL, Canada

E=.— - " Italy

J"?}^ New Zealand

Is • Scotland

1*" Northern Ireland

E Belgium

Spain
nd and Wales

Israel

Greece

Portugal

Ireland

Cuba
United States
Slovakia

Kuwait

Poland

Hungary

Puerto Rico

Chile

Costa Rica

Bulgaria
EZL— "* Russia

Romania
B?2-
te,, .(
J!
	 IV — 1 4.2
-- '__J 4.6
; 	 ^__J4.6
14.7
1 4.8 -

14.9
~ 15.0
15.2

; : 15.2

I 5.3

15.3

15.5

1 5.5

_ J 5.6

15.6

15.7
I 5.7

15.7

' 	 -:----\ 5.7

15.9

	 16.2

S 7.1

	 	 1 8 8

I 9.4

..'. .19.5

19.7

110.5

. _ J10.9

1 12.6

114.4
1 16.4

	 1 20.5
till
} 5 10 15 20 2
JT












-,


































'A



1



5!
                                 Rate per 1,000 live births
                                1                    f v
                                4       «„„  -; ^v
    ' Data for Ki^wait, Slovakia, and Spam are for 1996.

IT Source; Pastor, Jl.N., et al. Health. United States,2002. 2002.
                            cancer death rate for males, and Greece has the lowest rate
                            for females (137.9 and 81.8 per 100,000, respectively)
                            (United Nations, 2001).

                            The age-adjusted incidence of cancer for all sites except skin
                            varies widely among different countries (Exhibit 4-13).
                            Hungary reported the highest age-adjusted incidence of
                            cancers for males (405.4 per 100,000 people). New Zealand
                            had the highest age-adjusted cancer incidence rate for
                            females (303.2  per 100,000 people). The U.S. has the third
                            highest age-adjusted cancer incidence rates for both males
                            and females (361.4 and 283.2, respectively). Age-adjusted
                            cancer incidence rates are higher for males than females in
                            each of the countries presented in Exhibit 4-13 except
                            Denmark (GLOBOCAN 2000, 2001).

                            The varying incidence and mortality rates for cancer between
                            different countries could be due to many factors. Factors
                            related to the economic, social, cultural, psychological,
                            behavioral, and biological mechanisms that influence the
                            onset of cancer may contribute to these differences in rates
                            (NCI, 2002). A portion of these differences might also be
                            attributable to the varying prevalence of certain behavioral
                            risk factors for cancer—such as cigarette smoking, diet, and
                            alcohol consumption—within different countries. The
                            availability and use of certain drugs, such as anticancer and
                            immunosuppressive drugs, may also cause differences in the
                            rates of cancer among different countries. The extent to
                            which early diagnoses and treatment methods are available
                            and utilized could also account for some portion of the
                            variation  in cancer rates among different countries, as could
                            variations in  methods of classifying and reporting cancer.

                            For more on  morbidity, mortality, and age-adjusted rates,
                            see Section 4.3.
Chapter 4 - Human Healtn
4.2  Health Status of the U.S. Compared to the Rest of the World
4-13

-------
EPAs Draft Report on the Environment 2003 • Technical Docur|i|h^
                                                                 " 'LJUyX ' "' :" MMI^^
                                                                 HflUliH
" ' , f' '" »- : L: •:"" • '• ' 	 'f
Cxnioit 4-11; NJumber of deaths and percent of total deaths;
l|

H
in
i
;
UN
I,,
L
! i
i



1
i
i










\ > world (including U.S.), 1990,
Lit H , h. [LI, i, ,1 	 iiailS;
•
i Cause of Death ;
World (Including U.S.) (1990)
All causes
Heart disease
Stroke
Lower respiratory infections
Diarrheal diseases
Conditions arising during the perinatal period
Chronic obstructive pulmonary disease
Tuberculosis
Measles
Road traffic accidents
Trachea, bronchus and lung cancers
All other causes
United States (1999)
All causes
Heart disease
Cancer
Stroke
Chronic lower respiratory diseases
Accidents (unintentional injuries)
Diabetes mellitus
Influenza and pneumonia
Alzheimer's disease
Nephritis, nephritic syndrome, and nephrosis
Septicemia
All other causes
;,„ 'Sources: TOfid Resources Institute, e, t 'al. World Resources 'i'9,98-,99.
and Unite!
iSiSiiiiKSilSsiSi
iNumber
,6f Deaths

50,467,000
6,260,000
4,381,000
4,299,000
2,946,000
2,443,000
2,211 ,000
1,960,000
1,058,000
999,000
945,000
27,502,000

2,391 ,399
725,192
549,838
167,366
124,181
97,860
68,399
63,730
44,536
35,525
30,680
484,092
'l9S»8;'Ari3ef|
prJO Jeading causes of death,
Itates, 1999^ 	
H3M539b££&3Mbl!!9&!S!£l!£S$^1&%!?!!?
'.;]
Percent of : I ^H
Total Deatjhs | j •

100.0
12.4
8.7
8.5
5.8
4.8
4.4
3.9
2.1
2.0
1.9
54.5

100.0
30.3
23.0
7.0
5.2
4.1
2.9
2.7
1-9
1.5
1.3
20.2


\ *
"i
;1
-•i
r,4
si


i?
I
i
'!
•' • 1
:'-.!
^
%
;,:-.|
;"1
;"!
/j
~i
1
3
3
"" "LS
•1
#&£
«8|
	 • 	 : 	 : 	 " : 	 n 	 ii 	 ; 	 ; 	 :.: 	 ; 	 • 	 i::,,, ; ; '.;: .• .'^ 4^ • ^i&'^:£3jj^^
4-14
4.2 Health Status of the U.S. Compared to the Rest of the World
Chapter 4 - Human Health

-------

     m
                Exhibit 4-12: Age-adjusted cancer mortality rates for all sites except skin, Ly sex for selected countries, 20OO
                                                                           Unjtedingdom __ -128-1
                                                                                    lreland  1 27. 8
                                                                             Netherands    120
          anada i:116.7
                 116.4
        Austria  113.8
       Nprwa
      Slovakia   108.8

                               1673
                                161.8
                                       United States

    _Sweden104
JJwjtzerland J103.3
   'Australia 2J 103.2
Russian Fed.  ; 100.6
                                                                                   J 92-5
                                  149.5
                                   145.8
 Bulgaria^ ^89.4
 Portugal J89.1
   _Spain_j85
                                                                          Greece   81.8
               260     220      180     140     100
     Surce: United Nations. Demographic Yearbook, l!)99.2QOT.
                                                          60       20  ,   60f
                                                         *Rate per 100,000 peopfe "
                                                                                                              T
                                                                                                                       I
          100 ,    140,     180     220      260
                                                     300
_ Qiapter 4 - Human Health           4.2 Health Status of the U.S. Compared to the Rest of the World
                                                     4-15

-------
Exnitjit 4-13: Age-adjusted cancer incidence rates for all sites excepllljin, b^ sex
                                                                                 for selected countries, 2000
4-16
         4.2 Health Status of the U.S. Compared to the Rest of the World
Chapter 4 - Human

-------

                                                             Pw=:a«vvr^\—x^e-rr—.•••• "--•
           Exhibit 4-13: Age-adjusted cancer incidence rates for all sites except skin, by sex for selected countries, 2000
                                                           Males
         405.4]

              375.31

361.4]
359.3 1
                 355.3
                                                                    Females
                                                                                         New Zealand  303.2
                                                                                           Denmark  : 296.9
                      United States
                                                                                     United States

    342.6J
    335.2 j
      323.4]
       318.3
                        3123


                          299.7
                          299.6 J
                            290.511!

             287.2
             283.4
             281
              278
                              275-5
                               272.3
                               272.1
                               270.3

                                                                                                   283.2
                                                                                       "Australia 1 279.3
                                                                                                 275-9
                                                                                       Canada ! 266
                                                                                 Netherlands   253.4
                                                                                    Sweden; 250.1
                                                                           2 249.8
                                                                         I242-6
                                                                           237.1
                                                                          235.3
                                                                          234.3
                                                                                        222.6
	  AustriaJ 219.6
 ~™IZOiE 217-8
 SwrtzeriancT? 211.3
  ~SlovaEia"s 204.3 -.
                                                              d^^J 193.5
                                                         PortugaH 192.8
                                                        Romania^ 185.8
                                                       Bulgaria^! 180.4
                                                       japarT^ 170.5
                                                       Spain_ _^ 166.3
                                                    Greece :! 158
  -~  450     400     350     300     250
                                               200     150     100     15J3     2.0Q
                                                                    ^                  i
                                                    Incidence rate per 100,000 people
                                                                          250     300     350     400     450
  = Source GLOBOCAN. Cancer Incidence, Mortality, and Prevalence Worldwide, Version 1.0 2001, Internattonal Agency for Research on Cancer. 1ARC Cancer Base No. 5. 2001
4-16
  4.2 Health Status of the U.S. Compared to the Rest of the World
                               Oiapter U - Human

-------
                 Technical Document • EfAs Draft  Report on the fii4/ironm
        Exhibit 4-12: Age-adjusted cancer mortality rates for all sites exce:
                                                                        Hungary J149.4
                                                                               144
                                                                 ew Zealand   131 .1
                                                             jnite
-------

4.3   Health  Status  of the
U.J.:  Indicators  and   Irend:
   f Health  and   Di
                                                                 Morbidity
o
isease
This section identifies key indicators of health outcomes (mortality
and disease) in the U.S. and describes trends for these outcomes.
These outcomes are featured in this report because they are
important measures of the health of people in the U.S., and/or
because environmental exposure does or may play a role in
contributing to the outcome.

The case study on air pollution, presented earlier in Section 4.1,
provides an example of how health outcome  data can be used to
elucidate the linkage between pollution exposure and health
outcomes. In this case study, a comparison between mortality rates
and air monitoring data revealed an association between deaths and
peak air pollutant concentrations.
Mortality
Overall mortality is a key measure of health in a population. There
were more than 2,391,399 deaths in the U.S. in 1999 (Anderson,
2001), a number much larger than the 1,989,84T recorded in 1980.
The increase in the number of deaths reflects the increase in the size
and the aging of the U.S. population. The age-adjusted death rate for
all causes has declined steadily since 1950, from 1,446 per 100,000
people to, 876 in 1998. The age-adjusted death rates are higher for
men than for women, a relationship that has not changed over the
years. Heart disease, cancer, and stroke are the three leading causes of
death, accounting for about 60 percent of all deaths.

This section presents trends in life expectancy and in mortality
due to cancer, cardiovascular disease, chronic obstructive pulmonary
disease, and asthma. It also presents trends in mortality for children,
including infant mortality and mortality due to cancer, asthma, and
birth defects.

Unless otherwise noted, the death statistics are based on the
underlying cause of death and are compiled from death certificates.
The underlying cause of death is the disease or injury that is judged to
have initiated the events that  led to death. The mortality rate is the
proportion of the population  that dies of a disease. The rate is usually
calculated for a calendar year, is often expressed per 100,000
population, and is called the crude death rate.
Morbidity is another measure of health for a population. Morbidity
data are often described by using the incidence and prevalence of a
disease or condition:
• Incidence refers to the number of new cases of a disease or con-
  dition in a given time period in a specified population.
• Prevalence refers to the total number of persons with a given
  disease or condition in a specified population in a particular
  time period.

This section provides information on trends for several diseases,
including cancer, cardiovascular disease, asthma, and gastrointestinal
illness. It also examines trends in children's environmentally related
diseases, including cancer and asthma as well as low birthweight and
the incidence of birth defects.

C-omparison Across lime, Topulations, and (ueograpnic

Areas

Incidence, prevalence, and mortality statistics may be used to
compare the rates of disease at two or more points in time or across
different populations or between different geographic areas. These
comparisons are particularly useful to determine whether the
populations differ by some factor (often called a risk factor) that
is known or suspected of affecting the risk of developing the disease
or condition. For example, different populations that are compared
can be countries, workers in factories, or states.

In general, disease incidence, prevalence, and mortality increase with
age. For this reason, when comparing different populations, the data
must often be adjusted to account for the age differences between
the populations. The adjusted data, called "age-adjusted rates," are
used when appropriate in this chapter.
                                                                 Terceived Well-Being
                                                                 Another measure of health, perceived well-being, is discussed briefly
                                                                 here, but is not covered by an indicator. The reporting of health as
                                                                 excellent, very good, good, fair, or poor captures both the physical
                                                                 health of the individual and the emotional aspects of well-being
                                                                 (Kramarow, et al., 1999). In 1999, approximately 90 percent of the
                                                                 population of the U.S. reported that they were in good, very good,
                                                                 or excellent health (Eberhardt, et al., 2001), a slight increase from
                                                                 89.6 percent in 1991. As might be expected, the percentage of
                                                                 people reporting good-to-excellent health decreases  with age. While
                                                                 95 percent of those 18 to 44 years of age reported good-to-
                                                                 excellent health, only 77 percent of persons 65 years of age and
                                                                 older reported that they were in good-to-excellent health. Also,
                                                                 non-Hispanic African  Americans and Hispanics of all ages reported
                                                                 worse  health than non-Hispanic Whites (Eberhardt, et al., 2001).
 Chapter 4 - Human Health        4.3 Health Status of the U.S.: Indicators and Trends of Health and Disease     .   4-1 7

-------
tr/vs Draft Mport $,NO!
        OfjlcwS phuyrw
.





—
-


-
_

-

-
„
.



















-











_

-
-3
-45.;
-49.8
66.51
39.3 I
•BBH
JBBH
)••
^•H;
a 20
9H izf
• 10.3

-------
               Cancer mortality - Category 1 (continued)
               Cancer incidence - Category 2 (continued)




































_-~--~_J*__^ .^,. , , -^^^^^^^J
E Exhibit 4-14: Trends in United States cancer mortality rates and Surveillance, Epidemic ogy and End Results (SEER)
^ - incidence (annual percentage change 1973-1998)
Er Mortality Incidence
Sr^~
!^__ Lung (females)
||r Liver &, intrahep
g Non Hodgkm
fe?"» Melanomas of skin
ISr" "Multiple myeloma
i^
pttS? .".Esophagus
H^_ Kfdney/renaf
|%x=— - Brain &ONS
SF£ Lung (males)
~f- Prostate
&^T_ .All cancers
jS^ ~ Pancreas •
k_ Leukemia
js^ ~ Alt except lung
^~ Ovary
^L, ™_Breast (females)
|r _ ^ Larynx
aUS^n. ~ "^"Thyroid
^^ Urinary bladder
H^ , Colon/rectum
^Corpus & uterus, NOS
K£ ^ Oral cav & pharynx
Sr.^ Stomach
k— L Cervix i4ten
SPife— H.pdgfa'n's
E= Testis


-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-






































-
















-
-?
-^
-2
-2
-31
-45.2
-49.8
«iayJi^--i..».mJi.MJJi.»i".m»a 150.6

m^
^im
^a3
?S 20
SI 17.S
JH 10.3
|J 4.4
1 1.6
i 0.0
-3.2 1
-9.0 1
-10.0^
13.0 •
4.2 B
4.7 B|
0.9 !S(
4.1 HS
.801
.1 BH
4 •!
tt@B{
f^s6t
66.5 BSSSSaaJ!
-^93
I 56 1
45.2
?5.8
2.7
4

'




































































- i
Melanbmas of skin
Lung, (females)
Prostate
b'ver & intrghep
Non-Hodgkin's
•Testis
Thyroid
Kidney/renal
Breast (females)
Ali cancers
AH except lung
Multiple myeloma
Brain S.ONS
Esophagus
Urinary bladder
Ovary
lung.(males)
Colon/rectum
ieukemias
Pancreas
Oral cav & pharynx
Hpdgkin's
Larynx
Corpus & uterus, NOS
Stomach
Cervix uteri
-
-
-
_
-
_
_
_
_
_
_
_
-
-
-



























































Jgjr,,,,,,,' ,-- -- ^—^-,-j; 14q ^

116 3
tew^sfcs— isj^4n

JKiSSSa^fi •?
£^^S4.9
ia^aite/
inat-;j>^
SB! 22.4
SI 21 d
8119.0
»17.6

llO.l
-l.ll
-4.8|
-S.9<
-6.7*
-9.5 g
-14.71
16.4 B
-?3.oB|
-26.3 IB!
-34.0 BB
-43.7 H|














































if
1

'! *
i

' 'I
. ' '|
? " 1
; ...i

1 '• i
-"'i
."1
' 1
•••'I
j
1
5*
. •. .4
•• 1
-.".1
-'. '1
-'I
•'. J

•Sf
:.
iv
i*^. ~ "20° "15° •10° ~SO ° 50 10° 1SO 20° ^ -200 -150 -100 -JO 0 SO 100 ISO 200 '
|^ Percent change, 1973-1998 ^ Percent^change, 1973-1998
sf*?TQS » Not otherwise specified _ , ^ J
g-OI^S « Other nervous system |
?,Source Ries LAG, eta! Swrvq/fance, Epidemiology and End Results (SEER) Cancer Statistics Review, 7573 1998 2001 * " 1






4-20       4.3 Health Status of the U.S.: Indicators and Trends of Health and Disease       Chapter 4 - Human Health
   Chapter 4 - Human .Health      4.3 Health Status of the U.S.: Indicators and Trends of Health and Disease       4-23

-------
              raft Report  on the Environment 2003  •  lecnnical  Document

EPAs Draft "Report on the Environment 2003  •  Ipchnical  Documeht
 includes five years 1997-2001. These include two diseases—cholera
 and typhoid fever—that are rarely identified in this country. These
 diseases are nevertheless included because they can be severe
 illnesses and a sudden increase in their reporting would signal a
 public health emergency for which prompt action would be needed.
 In addition to the seven diseases discussed here, a number of other
 gastrointestinal diseases are caused by microorganisms. These
 include giardiasis, caused by the pathogen Giardia. Giardiasis has
 become notifiable only as recently as 2002 (CDC, 2003), so no
 indicator is available at this time.
The primary means of transmission for the seven diseases reported
here is oral-fecal. The disease microbes shed in the feces of infected
individuals and then can be transmitted to humans through food,
water, person-to-person contact, or contact with ill animals. The
seven diseases are cholera, cryptosporidiosis, E. coli O157:H7,
Hepatitis A, salmonellosis, shigellosis, and typhoid fever. Exhibit 4-22
shows the incidence of each for 1997 through 2001.
          Waterborne Disease Outbreaks Associated wit* Drinking Water 1971 -2000
   Since 1971, the Centers for Disease Control and Prevention (CDC), EPA, and the Couij oil of State and Territorial Epidemiologists have
   maintained a collaborative surveillance system for the occurrences and causes of water!: orne-disease outbreaks (WBDO). These data are only
   a small part of the larger body of information related to drinking water quality in the United States. State, territorial, and local public health
   agencies are primarily responsible for detecting and investigating WBDOs and voluntary reporting them to CDC these data are used to
   identify types of water systems, their deficiencies, the etiologic agents (e.g., microorgar
   evaluate current technologies for providing safe drinking water and safe recreational wa
             sms and chemicals) associated with outbreaks, and to
            ers. This system reports outbreaks and estimated
   numbers of people who become ill. It does not provide information on non-outbreak re ated or endemic levels of waterborne illness.
   Moreover, the focus is on acute illness. The system does not address chronic illnesses s
   CDC and EPA are collaborating on a series of epidemiology studies to assess the magn tude of non-outbreak waterborne illness associated
   with consumption of municipal drinking water.
    Between 1971 and 2000, there were 751 reported waterborne disease outbreaks associ
    ty systems, and community water systems (Exhibit 4-21). During 1999-2000,
    community systems, and 12 from community systems) associated with drinking water
             ted with drinking water from individual, non-communi-
    a total of 44 outbreaks (18 from private wells, 14 from non-
             ; reported by 25 states (Craun and Calderon, 2003).
    However, these data should be interpreted with caution. Many factors can influence
    local, territorial, and state public health agencies. For example, the size of the outbre
    public awareness of the outbreak, whether people seek medical care or report to a
    laboratory testing for organisms, and resources for investigation can all influence
    This system underreports the true number of outbreaks because of the multiple stej
    investigated. Thus, an increase in the number of outbreaks reported could either refj
    and reporting at the local and state level.
                           Exnibit 4-21: Number or reported waterborne diseasi
                    with drinking water by year and type of water system, Unite
             :h as cancer, reproductive, or developmental effects.
           Ic'call
    hether a WBt)O is recognized and investigated by
    k, severity of the disease caused by the outbreak,
    :al health authority, reporting requirements, routine
the identification and  investigation of a WBDO.
    ; required before an outbreak is identified and
    ct an actual increase or improved surveillance
                                                                             ifr
             •outbreaks associated
            ! Btates, 1971-2000 (n=75l)
                                                                                                    Type of Water System*
                                                                                                    IHH  Non-community
     •Non-community water systems are systems that either (1) regularly supply water to at least 25 of the s|
     Krtooh, f«tori«s, office buildings, and hospitals that have their own water systems), or (2) provide water ij
     a JJS iUtion of campground).                                       '        '     *

     Individual water systems .are not regulated by the Safe Drinking Water Act and serve fewer than 25 persoij
                                                                             *
     Community water jystems provide water to at least 25 of the same people or service connections year roj

     Source; Based on data pre;ented in Craun, G.F. and R.L Calderon. Waterborne Outfcreafo in the United States^

             \e peopfe at least 6 months per year, but not year round (e.g.,
             1 place where people do not remain for long periods of time (e.g.,
             fe ,    ,™    0^,,         ^   ^     *    5   «,


            i or 15 service connections, including many private wells.
                     20Q3,
 4-26        4.3 Health Status of the U.S.: Indicators and Trends of Health and Disease       .Chapter 4 - Human Health

-------

 The data source for these seven indicators is the Centers for Disease
 Control and Prevention, Epidemiology Program Office, National
 Notifiable Diseases Surveillance System. This system provides weekly
 provisional information from the Council of State and Territorial
 Epidemiologists (CSTE) on the occurrence of diseases defined as
 notifiable. A notifiable disease is one that, when diagnosed, health
 providers report to state or local public health officials. Notifiable
 diseases are of public interest because of their contagiousness,   -
 severity, or frequency (Pastor,  et al., 2002). State epidemiologists
 report cases of notifiable diseases to CDC, and CDC tabulates and
 publishes -these data in Morbidity and Mortality Weekly Report
 (MMWK) and Summary of Notifiable Diseases,  United States. Policies
 for reporting notifiable disease cases can vary by disease or report-
 ing jurisdiction. CSTE and CDC annually review and recommend
 additions or deletions to the list of nationally notifiable diseases
 based on the need to respond to emerging priorities. Reporting
 nationally notifiable 'diseases to  CDC, however, is voluntary. Reporting is
currently mandated by law or regulation only at the local and state
level. Therefore, the list of diseases that are considered notifiable
varies slightly by state.

Notifiable disease data are useful for analyzing disease trends and
determining relative disease burdens. These data, however, must be
interpreted in light of reporting practices. The degree of
completeness of data reporting is influenced by many factors such as
the diagnostic facilities available; the control measures in effect;
public awareness of a specific disease; and the interests, resources,
and priorities of state and local officials responsible for disease
control and public health surveillance. Finally, factors such as
changes in case definitions for public health surveillance,
introduction  of new diagnostic  tests, or discovery of new disease
entities can cause changes in disease reporting that are independent
of the true incidence of disease.
                     1997    • 1998    M 1999
                         H 2000    • 2001
                       Exhibit 4-22: Prevalence of reported gastrointestinal diseases, United States, 1997-2001
                                Cryptosporidiosis   E. co/i O1 57:H7
                                   t   ^  „ »         *   r»iWi wJ-.-»    Disease
   gyrces CDC Notice to Readers- Final 2001 Reports of Notifiable Diseases. 2002; CDC Notice to Readers Ftnal 2000 Reports of Notifiable Diseased 2001, CDC Notice to Readers
   Inai 1999 Reports of Notifiable Diseases. 2000. CDC. Notice to Readers: Final 1998 Reports ofNabfiqble Diseases 1999, CDC Notice to Readers Final 1997 Reports of Notifiable
Chapter 4  - Human Health        4.3 Health Status of the U.S.: Indicators and Trends of Health and Di:
                                         Disease        4-27
 Chapter 4 - Human Health        4.3 Health Status of the U.S.: Indicators and Trends of Health and Disease         4-29

-------
EfAs  Draft "Report on the Environment 20Q3  •  technical DocurneM
                                      lf?nCP_ — \.nolprfl — y ^pit'pnf
                                                                       __l                   ,     !  I
E"PAs Draft "Report on the Environment 20O3 • Technical Documejfij:
               Infectious disease prevalence - Salmonellosis - Category[2
   Salmonellosis is a disease caused by one of the more than 2,000
   strains of the bacterial genus Salmonella. Most persons infected
   with Salmonella develop diarrhea, fever, and abdominal cramps 12
   to 72 hours after infection. The illness usually lasts 4 to 7 days,
   and most persons recover without treatment, though antibiotics
   can be used. In some persons, however, the diarrhea may be so
   severe that the patient needs to be hospitalized. In these patients,
   the Salmonella infection may spread from the intestines to the
   bloodstream and then to other body sites. It can cause death
   unless the person is treated promptly with antibiotics. The elderly,
   infants, and those with impaired immune systems are more likely
   to become severely ill from salmonellosis (CDC, 2001 f).
                                                 What the Data  Show

                                                 Every year, approximately 40,000 cases of salmonellosis are
                                                 reported in the U.S. Because many milder cases are not diagnosed
                                                 or reported, CDC estimates the actual number of infections to be
                                                 1.4 million. Salmonellosis is more commori in the summer than
                                                 winter. It is estimated that somewhat more than SOO persons die
                                                 each year with acute salmonellosis (CDC,'2001 f).

                                                 Data Source

                                                 National Notifiable Diseases Surveillance System, Centers for
                                                 Disease Control and Prevention. (See Appendix B, page B-29, for
                                                 more informaition.)

               Infectious disease prevalence - jnigellosis - Category 2 -
   Shigellosis is a bacterial disease affecting the intestinal tract.
   Anyone can get shigellosis, though it is most common in children
   between the ages of 1 and 14. Most who are infected with Shigella
   develop diarrhea, fever, and stomach cramps starting a day or two
   after they are exposed to the bacterium. The diarrhea is often
   bloody. Shigellosis usually resolves in S to 7 days. In some per-
   sons, especially young children and the elderly, the diarrhea can
   be so severe that hospitalization is necessary. Some persons who
   are infected may have no symptoms at all, but may pass the
   Shigella bacteria to others (CDC, 2001 g).

                                                What the Data Show                     I

                                                Every year, about 14,000 cases of shigellosis are reported in the
                                                U.S. Because many milder cases are not diagnosed or reported,
                                                the CDC estimates the actual number of infections to be
                                                448,000. Shigellosis is particularly common and causes recurrent
                                                problems in settings where hygiene is poo]r (CDC, 2001 g).
                                                                                   !
                                                Data Source
                                                              National Notifiable Diseases Surveillance System, Centers for
                                                              Disease Control and Prevention. (See App'endix B, page B-29,
                                                              for more information.)
 4-30
4.3 Health Status of the U.S.: Indicators and Trends of Health and Disease       Chapter 4 - Human Health

-------
The data source for these seven indicators is the Centers for Disease
Control and Prevention, Epidemiology Program Office, National
Notifiable Diseases Surveillance System. This system provides weekly
provisional information from the Council of State and Territorial
Epidemiologists (CSTE) on the occurrence of diseases defined  as
notifiable. A notifiable dfsease is one that, when diagnosed, health
providers report to state or local public health officials. Notifiable
diseases are of public interest because of their contagiousness,
severity, or frequency (Pastor, et al.,  2002). State epidemiologists
report cases of notifiable diseases to CDC, and CDC tabulates and
publishes these data in Morbidity and Mortality Weekly Report
(MMWR) and Summary of Notifiable Diseases, United States. Policies
for reporting notifiable disease cases can  vary by disease or report-
ing jurisdiction. CSTE and CDC annually review and recommend
additions or deletions to the list of nationally notifiable diseases
based on the need to respond to emerging priorities. Reporting
nationally notifiable 'diseases to CDC, however, is voluntary. Reporting is
currently mandated by law or regulation only at the local and state
level. Therefore, the list of diseases that are considered notifiable
varies slightly by state.

Notifiable disease data are useful for analyzing disease trends and
determining relative disease burdens. These data, however, must be
interpreted in light of reporting practices. The degree of
completeness of data reporting is influenced by many factors such as
the diagnostic facilities available; the control measures in effect;
public awareness of a specific disease; and the interests, resources,
and priorities of state and local officials responsible for disease
control and public health surveillance. Finally, factors such as
changes in case definitions for  public health surveillance,
introduction of new diagnostic tests, or discovery of new disease
entities can cause changes in disease reporting that are independent
of the true incidence of disease.
                      txniuit 4-22: Trevalence or reported gastrointestinal diseases, United jtates, I997-20O1
                     1997    • 1998    B 1999
                           2000    H 2001
                                Cryptosporidiosis   E. co/iO157H7
                                                                     Disease
  &'                                               «- -:  -                         w ,**">•         '                 *
  gpurces CDCJVofice to Readers, Final 2001 Reports of Notifiable Diseases 2002, CDC Notice to Readers Fmaf2000 Reports of Notifiable Diseases 2001; CDC Notice to Readers.
  fjjjtJ999 Reports of Notifiable Diseases. 2000: CDC. Notice to Readers final 1998 Reports of Notifiable Diseases 1999, CDC. Notice to Readers' Final 1997 Reports of Notifiable
  jjseases 1998
Chapter 4 - Human Health        4.3  Health Status of the U.S.: Indicators and Trends of Health and Disease         4-27

-------
UT/AS Draft  "Report on the "Environment 2003  • lechnical  Docum^t
                nfectious disease prevalence - CJnolera - Category 2
                                                        1
   Cholera is a diarrhea illness caused by infection of the intestine
   with the bacterium Vibrio cholerae. Infections can often be mild or
   without symptoms, but can sometimes be severe, and even fatal.
   Approximately 1 in 20 infected persons has severe disease
   characterized by severe, watery diarrhea that can lead to dehydra-
   tion and shock. Without treatment, death can occur within hours
   (ICTDRN, 2002).
What the Data  Show

Very few caseis of cholera are reported on Jan annual basis in the
U.S. It is believed most cases are associ^t^d with consumption of
contaminated seafood or with international travel to areas where
cholera is endemic (e.g., South America) (CDC, 2001 a).

Data Source
                                 i
National Notifiable Diseases Surveillance ^ystem, Centers for
Disease Control and Prevention. (See Appendix B, page E>-27, for
more information.)                  '
               Infectious disease prevalence - Cryptosporidiosis - Category 2
   Cryptosporidiosis is an illness resulting from infection of the
   gastrointestinal tract with Cryptosporidium panum and other
   species of Cryptosporidium. This pathogen is excreted by humans,
   as well as wild and domestic animals, including farm animals; it
   contaminates water sources via animal feces or domestic sewage.
   Runoff from agricultural operations into drinking water sources has
   been one cause of Cryptosporidiosis outbreaks (Franzen and
   Muller, 1999).

   Severe diarrhea is the most common symptom. Additional
   symptoms include gastric pain, fever, nausea, and fatigue
   (Guerrant, 1997). There is no antibiotic that is effective for
   treatment of Cryptosporidiosis. As a result, a healthy immune
   system is important in limiting an individual's response to
   Cryptosporidium parvum infection. Cryptosporidiosis can be deadly
   when contracted by immunocompromised individuals. In extreme
   cases of Cryptosporidiosis, infection can spread beyond the
   gastrointestinal tract to the gall bladder and biliary tract.
What the Data  Show      ;

The occurrence of symptoms or conditions associated with
Cryptosporidiosis are likely underreported, "We do not know
exactly how many cases of Cryptosporidiosis actually occur. Many
people do not seek medical attention op ate not tested for this
parasite and so Cryptosporidium often gbe|s undetected as; the
cause of intestinal illness" (CDC, 1998b).;                ;

Data Source

National Notifiable Diseases Surveillance £ystem, Centers for
Disease Control and Prevention. (See Appendix B, page B-28,
for more information.)
4-28       " 4.3 Health Status of the U.S.: Indicators and Trends of Health and Disease       Chapter 4 - Human rlealtn

-------

               nfectious disease prevalence -  £ coll Ol57:j i7 - Category 2
  E. coll O157:H7 is one of over 170 strains and many hundred
  sub-strains of the bacterium Escherichla coli. Most strains are
  harmless and live in the intestines of healthy humans and animals;
  this strain can cause severe illness. E. coli O157:H7 is not a
  disease itself, but rather a cause of illness. The identifier in the
  name of the bacterium refers to the specific antigenic markers
  found on its cell wall and distinguishes it from other types of £.
  co/i. Infection often leads to bloody diarrhea and occasionally to
  kidney failure, particularly in young children (CDC, 2001 b). A
  1982 outbreak of severe bloody diarrhea was traced to
  contaminated hamburgers.
What the Data Show

CDC estimates that 73,000 cases of £. coli O157:H7 occur
annually in the U.S., and that 61 fatal cases occur annually. The
illness is often misdiagnosed; therefore, expensive and invasive
diagnostic procedures may be performed. Patients who develop
severe disease may require prolonged hospitalization, dialysis, and
long-term follow-up (CDC, 2001 b).

Data Source

National Notifiable Diseases Surveillance System, Centers for
Disease Control and Prevention. (See Appendix B, page B-28, for
more information.)
               nfectious disease prevalence - Hepatitis /\ - Category 2
  Hepatitis A virus (HAV) is one of five viruses in the hepatitis
  group of viruses (A to E) that cause liver disease. Symptoms
  include jaundice, fatigue, abdominal pain, loss of appetite, nausea,
  diarrhea, and fever. Adults tend to be more symptomatic than
  children. HAV is found in the feces of infected people and is
  usually spread through contaminated food, water, or intimate
  contact (CDC,  2002d).
What the Data Show

The annual number of reported cases for HAV in the U.S.
exceeds 10,000. The estimated number of new infections
approaches 100,000 per year. It continues to occur in epidemics
both nationwide and in communities. The number of cases is
now reaching historic lows and continues to slowly decline, though
about one-third of Americans show evidence of past infection
(CDC, 2002e).

Data Source

National Notifiable Diseases Surveillance System, Centers for
Disease Control and Prevention. (See Appendix B, page B-28,
for more information.)
Chapter 4 - Human Health       4.3 Health Status of the U.S.: Indicators and Trends of Health and Disease        4-29

-------
EPAs  Draft "Report on  the Environment 2003
            ecnnica
Document
               Infectious disease prevalence - Salmonellosis - Category
   Salmonellosis is a disease caused by one of the more than 2,000
   strains of the bacterial genus Salmonella. Most persons infected
   with Salmonella develop diarrhea, fever, and abdominal cramps 12
   to 72 hours after infection. The illness usually lasts 4 to 7 days,
   and most persons recover without treatment, though antibiotics
   can be used. In some persons, however, the diarrhea may be so
   severe that the patient needs to be hospitalized. In these patients,
   the Salmonella infection may spread from the intestines to the
   bloodstream and then to other body sites. It can cause death
   unless the person is treated promptly with antibiotics. The elderly,
   infants, and those with impaired immune systems are more likely
   to become severely ill from salmonellosis (CDC, 2001 f).
What the Data Show

Every year, approximately 40,000 cases of salmonellosis are
reported in the U.S. Because many milder; cases are not diaghosed
or reported, CDC estimates the actual nujnber of infections to be
1.4 million. Salmonellosis is more common in the summer than
winter. It is estimated that somewhat mpr^ than 500 persons die
each year with acute salmonellosis  (CDC, !2001 f).
           I                      i  I               !
Data Source

National Notifiable Diseases Surveillance System, Centers for
Disease Control and Prevention. (See Appendix B, page B-29, for
more information.)                   j
                                                                         lie
               nrectious disease prevalence - Jnigellosis - Category 2 I
               	         	,	,	^	p.™™™™™^™™™™^,.^™.^™^^!!!!*
  Shigellosis is a bacterial disease affecting the intestinal tract.
  Anyone can get shigellosis, though it is most common in children
  between the ages of 1 and 14. Most who are infected with Shigella
  develop diarrhea, fever, and stomach cramps starting a day or two
  after they are exposed to the bacterium. The diarrhea is often
  bloody. Shigellosis usually resolves in 5 to 7 days. In some per-
  sons, especially young children and the elderly, the diarrhea can
  be so severe that hospitalization is necessary. Some persons who
  are infected may have no symptoms at all, but may pass the
  Shigella bacteria to others (CDC, 2001 g).
What the Data Show
                                   i
Every year, about 14,000 cases of shigellosis are reported in the
U.S. Because many milder cases are not diagnosed or reported,
the CDC estimates the actual number of infections to be
448,000. Shigellosis is particularly common and causes recurrent
problems in settings where hygiene is poof (CDC, 2001 g).

Data Source
                                                              National Notifiable Diseases Surveillance System, Centers for
                                                              Disease Control and Prevention. (See Appendix B, page B-29,
                                                              for more information.)                 |
4-30       4.3 Health Status of the U.S.: Indicators and Trends of Health and Disease       Chapter 14 - Human Health j

-------

               Infectious disease prevalence - Typhoid fever - Category 2
   Typhoid fever is a life-threatening illness caused by the bacterium
   Salmonella typhi. Typhoid fever is characterized by fever, headache,
   nausea, and loss of appetite. Salmonella typhi lives only in humans.
   Persons with typhoid fever carry the bacteria in their bloodstream
   and intestinal tract. In addition, a small number of persons (2 to 5
   percent), called carriers, recover from typhoid fever but continue
   to carry and shed the bacteria. Both ill persons and carriers shed
   S. typhi in their feces and urine (WHO, 1997).
What the Data Show

In the U.S., about 400 S. typhi cases occur each year, many of
which are acquired while traveling internationally. Typhoid fever is
transmitted by eating food or drinking beverages that have  been
handled by a person who is shedding S. typhi, or by consuming
water contaminated with S. typhi bacteria (CDC, 2001 h).

Data Source

National Notifiable Diseases Surveillance System, Centers for
Disease Control and Prevention. (See Appendix B, page B-30,
for more information.)
  4.3.4 What are the  trends for
  children's  environmental health
  issues?
Special consideration must be given to children's health issues '
because children may be more susceptible to disease and generally
may be more vulnerable to their surroundings for many physiological
reasons. This section discusses five indicators for children's
environmental health issues: infant mortality, low birthweight,
childhood cancer, childhood asthma, and birth defects.
Chapter 4 - Human Health       4.3 Health Status of the U.S.: Indicators and Trends of Health and Disease
                                                   4-31

-------
EPAs Draft "Report on the Environment 2003
                                                   ecnca
Document
          Infant mortality - Category
Infant mortality in the U.S. is defined as the death of a child
before age 1 .
What the Data Show
In 1999, a total of 27,937 deaths occurred in infants under 1 year
of age (Hoyert, et al., 2001). The infant mortality rate was 7.1 per
1 ,000 live births, the lowest ever recorded in the U.S. The infant
mortality rate for African American infants was 14.6 per 1 ,000
live births, more than twice the rate for White infants (5.8 per
1 ,000 live births). The infant mortality rate for Hispanic infants
was 5.8 per 1 ,000 live births. The 10 leading causes of infant
deaths account for 67.6 percent of all infant deaths in the U.S.
(Exhibit 4-2:5). Delaware, Maine, Massachusetts, and Utah have
the lowest infant mortality rates. Mississippi, Alabama, and
Louisiana have the highest (Hoyert, et al., 2001 ).
Data Source
National Vitiil Statistics System, Centers for Disease Control and
Prevention. (See Appendix B, page B-30, for more information.)
1 ; ,
|" 	 ' •""• 	 	 WWRff&S$''~1SBf '' ~r 7TIT*ii£T~4:^'"7P'
if lf* '" MI Exhibit U-23: Number of infant deatns, percent of fptai deaths, and infant
It! ~™ " " <^S~ "i IT mil n Ita ft in into Mi 1 ^fc^y,..^ ^ j, kite (»* T *M, 4,  4 Newborn affected by maternal complications of
i pregnancy
J 5 Respiratory distress of newborn
"I
ii 6 Newborn affected by complications of placenta, cord,
1 and membranes
i
i 7 Accidents
1 8 Bacterial sepsis of newborn
|; 9 Diseases of the circulatory system
|;:! 10 Atelectasis
in All other causes
1' — " '
U R»t« a pel 100,000 ir« births in 1999
E, ^
tou«;..% : _
: ^'
•*£,/-%
J,. ^.
vl •
-"i
-^*
^ili'irri^i - !
' 1


4-32      4.3 Health Status of the U.S.: Indicators and Trends of Health and Disease     Chapter 4 - Human Health

-------
                     ;..-.'-;...•:.:•----  .--•--.-•-..-.. • ;  •; . .- -  _ .. ;  ;-...--_.. I |  -•-.-'.'- :  . . - -'  I   .•-•.-.-'.••!'.(;.'.,'>.--'  __ •• .' . . ,.."_.....'.. ,••".. ';',%l -..•' -f. „.....',.....'. -
                Low Dirtnweignt - Category I
An infant with low birthweight is defined as a full-term infant, born
between week 37 and 44 of pregnancy, and weighing 2,500
grams or less at birth. Weight is a critical health measure because
low birthweight children are more prone to death and disability
than their counterparts.
What the Data Show
The percentage of infants who were born with a low birthweight
(weighing less than 2,500 grams) was 7.6 percent in 2000
(Martin, et al., 2002). In 2000, the low birthweight rate for non-
Hispanic African Americans (13.1 percent) was twice the rate of
that for non-Hispanic Whites (6.6 percent), a relationship that
existed for at least the 9 prior years as well (Exhibit 4-24). In




2000, the low birthweight rate for Hispanics was similar to that of
non-Hispanic Whites (6.4 and 6.6, respectively). Also shown in
Exhibit 4-24 is that non-Hispanic African Americans had the
highest proportion of very low birthweight infants (weighing
less than 1 ,500 grams) in 2000, compared with Hispanic and
non-Hispanic White populations in the U.S.
Data Source
National Vital Statistics System, Centers for Disease Control and
Prevention. (See Appendix B, page B-30, for more information.)
KS ' ' > * ? t * & tf J 3 4 * ' |
^ Exhibit 4-24; Tercent of live birtns of very low birthweight and" low birthweight,
|$ri_ '<• ty race and Hispanic origin of mother, United States, 1991-2000
5S~~ w ., ^ ^ ^^un-tsw*^,^^* ^^ ^^ ~- * * S
1 ! Very Low Birthweight1
1 White Black
Non-Hispanic Non-Hispanic Hispanic3
" 2000 1.14 3.10 1.14
i 1999 • ' 1.15 . 3.18 1.14
1998 1.15 3.11 1.15
1 1997 1.12 3.05 1.13
| 1996 1.08 3.02 1.12
1 1995 . 1.04 2.98 1.11
; 1994 1.01 2.99 1.08
I 1993 1.00 2.99 1.06
! 1992 0.94 2.97 1.04
i 1991 0.94 2.97 1.02
Jless than 1 ,500 grams (3 Ib 4 02 )
EUss than_2,JOO grams (5 Ib 8 oz )
jpStr -
^Includes all persons of Hispanic origin of any race
pboxe Martin, I A , et al Births Final Data for 2000 2002
l^~"^

Low Birthweight2 B^l
White Black ^
Non-Hispanic Non-Hispanic Hispanic3 :
6.6 13.1 6.4 1
6.6 13.2 • 6.4 ?
6.6 13.2 6.4 . .1
i 6.5 13.1 6.4 '.'4
i 6.4 13.1 6.3 "3
] 6.2 ' 13.2 6.3 , '_'_i
j 6.1 13.3 6.2 :~f
; 5.9 13.4 6.2 , 1
! 5.7 13.4 6.1 1
5.7 13.6 6.1
1 1 \ " » / •> , H v> , , JM
4^ ( "1^^ ^ t T & ^A(t^^ \!w
S * AJ
Chapter 4 - Human Health       4.3 Health Status of the U.S.: Indicators and Trends of Health and Disease
4-33

-------
E"RAs Draft foport on the Environment 2003
           ecnnica
Documdrit

                Childhood cancer mortality - Category
                Childhood cancer incidence - Category 2
— 	 " 	 •"••' -•-•••— "-"|f
il
. . 1
^
y2
i
qP_^_~__lw^v_rw____r_
8 1


'


-mfKpm—^-nTvv**-^*

I
*,> , i
                                                                                                                     tn*w%

                                                                                                                         1
   Cancer is a disease characterized by uncontrolled growth of cells.
   A cancerous cell loses its ability to regulate its own growth, con-
   trol cell division, and communicate with other cells. These cellular
   changes are complex and occur over a period of time. They may
   be accelerated in children. Cancer cells can invade nearby tissues
   and can spread through the bloodstream and lymphatic system to
   other parts of the body (NCI, 2003). The classification of cancers
   in children differs from the classification used for adult cancers.

   What the Data Show

   In 1999, there were nearly 2,200 deaths due to cancer in children
   and adolescents under 20 years of age (Anderson, 2001). The
   age-adjusted cancer mortality rates by race and age group are
   presented in Exhibit 4-25. In 1999, cancer was the third leading
   cause of death in children 1 to 4 years of age, accounting for 8
   percent of the total deaths in this age group (Anderson, 2001).
   The death rate for cancer in this age group was 2.8 per 100,000
   population.  For children 5 to 9 years of age, cancer was the sec-
   ond leading cause of death accounting for  14.7 percent of total
   deaths. The death rate was 2.6 per 100,000 for children 5 to 9
years of age. In older children (15 to 19 years of age), 5.4
percent of total deaths in this age group were due to cancer,
Cancer ranked fourth among leading causes of death, with a
mortality rate of 3.8 per 100,000 population.

Exhibit 4-26 presents the age-adjusted iricidence rates for cancers
in children of all races between the ages of 0 and 19 years, 1975
to 1998. There has been an increase in the incidence for all types
of childhood cancer since 1975. There als,o has been a substantial
decline in the cancer death rate for children, largely due to
improved treatment (EPA, December 200|0).

Data Sources

Mortality: National Vital Statistics System, National Center'
for Health Statistics. (See Appendix B, page B-31, for
 more information.)                   |

Incidence: Surveillance, Epidemiology, and End Results Program,
National Cancer Institute.  (See Appendix^, page B-31,
for more information.)                 !
            i,	 ;    „     ..-..;    ...        ,	:.. :; i .;,V,.,.;;,..:	
            Exhibit H-25: Age-adjusted1 Surveillance, Epidemiology and End Results ISEER) childhood cancer (all sites) incidence        J  '
                         t 3    '           ir          i      " i         i  •Ip^*'*'*'*^^
             ...    -      ,„,      and United Jtates mortality rates by race and ag!rarpi)|, 1994-1998                ••-..,
Bi • - i : ' -. M :
Ages 0-14 , !; . , ; . .; : Ages 0-19 jj •. j
a
I
|
i-
M
sin
3
•«
L
§N
1
p

Race
All Races
White
Black
	 ill**
Rates Jcc dci
nit nil
Source: R:ei
Incidence
Total Male Female
14.4 15.4 13.4
14.8 15.6 13.9
12.0 13.0 10.9
Mortality
Total Male Female
2.7 3.0 2.4
2.7 3.0 2.4
2.8 2.9 2.6
Incidence
Total Male Female
15.9 16.7 15.0
16.4 17.2 15.6
12.5 13.3 11.7
' Mortality
Total Male Female
3.0 3.3 2.6
3.6 3.4 2.6
:3.1 3.2 2.9
, 	 ,, 	 „, 	 , 	 i,,,, 	 , 	 	 	 „ 	 , 	 	 	 ; 	 ;, 	 „„„ 	
tlis per 100,000 per year and are age adjusted to the 1970' US. standard populat
LA.G, irt al. SffR Cancer Statistics Review, !973- 1988. 2001 . '. '[ ". .


,:3l^l4J4i3IISi3£SsEs5a35Siil;&

 4-34        4.3 Health Status of the U.S.: Indicators and Trends of Health and Disease       Chapter U - Human Health

-------

             Cnildnood cancer mortality - Category 1  (continued)
             Cnildnood cancer incidence - Category 2 (continued)





P-«- Exhibit U-26: Age-adjusted Surveillance, Epidemiology and End Results (SEER) cancer incidence rates by
f-'~ international c assification of childhood cancer (1CCC) selected group and subgroup and year of diagnosis,
|£" . ' childrenO to 19 years, 1975-98
a— , ,_ -f1 ,» *,<< i t , J
|iH': \ 1975-1980 i 1981-1986 1987-1992 1993-1998 ^Hj^^HI
F '
£
£"-"
IP^
£
%£•
fti
E
E1*
tw :
^£5
g^L
^
BN^_
^ -• "
^ !
E-
ITT
iS-E^
cw
p-
All groups combined 140.0 149.0 157.5 159.1
Leukemia 33.2 36.3 37.6 . 37.4
Lymphomas and
reticuloendothelial
neoplasms 24.1 , 24.9 24.8 23.9
Central nervous system 23.4 24.3 29.6 27.8
Sympathetic nervous
system tumors 7.7 8.1 ^ 7.6 8.5
Retinoblastoma 2.6 2.7 2.9 3.1
Renal tumors 6.0 6.6 6.3 7.1
Hepatic tumors 1-2 1.5 1.7 1.8
Malignant bone tumors 7.8 9.2' 8.9 9.4
Soft tissue sarcomas 10.4 10.9 11.2 11.4
Germ cell, trophoblastic
and other gonadal .
neoplasms 8.6 9.8 11 .3 11 .7
Carcinomas and other ' ,
malignant epithelial
neoplasms 13.9 13.5 14.6. 15.0
Notes Rates are cases per 1 ,000,000 per year and are age adjusted to the 1970 U S standard population
Source Ries, L A G , et al SEER Cancert Statistics Review, 1973 7998 2001
• . 1
- ' - 1
'-• •• 1
I
	 \

Chapter 4 - Human Healtn       4.3 Health Status of the U.S.: Indicators and Trends of Health and Disease
4-35

-------
EFAs Draft pport Ml the Environment 2^63 •  I ethnical  Upcum^Hi|:

                 Childhood asthma mortality - Category 1
                 Childhood astnma prevalence - Category 1
                                                                         ir
   Asthma is a chronic respiratory disease characterized by inflam-
   mation of the airways and lungs. During an asthma attack, the
   airways that carry air to the lungs are constricted. As a result,
   less air is able to flow in and out of the lungs (NCHS, 2001).
   Currently, there are no preventive measures or cure for asthma;
   however, children and adolescents who have asthma can still lead
   quality, productive lives if they control their asthma. Asthma can
   be controlled by taking medication and by avoiding contact with
   environmental "triggers" for asthma. Environmental triggers
   include cockroaches, dust mites, furry pets, mold, tobacco smoke,
   and certain chemicals (CDC, 2002g; CDC, 2003b).

   What the Data Show

   In 2001, approximately 6 million (9 percent) of U.S. children had
   asthma, compared to approximately 3.6 percent of children in
   1980 (EPA, 2003a).

   In 1999, there  were 32 deaths due to asthma for children
   under 5 years of age and 144 deaths for children 5 to 14 years
   of age (Mannino, et al., 2002). This number is slightly lower
   than the 189 asthma deaths among children under IS years
   of age in 1998.
                                                        Boys were more likely to have been diagnosed with asthma than
                                                        girls; the condition was diagnosed in 13 percent of boys
                                                        compared with 10 percent for girls. Of the 4 million children who
                                                        reported that they had an asthma attack in the last 12 months,
                                                        boys were most likely to have had an attack when they were 5 to
                                                        11 years of age. Girls were most likely to nave had an attack in the
                                                        previous year at 12 to 17 years of age. Fourteen percent of non-
                                                        Hispariic African American children had been diagnosed with
                                                        asthma. The proportion of non-Hispanic White and Hispanic
                                                        children who had ever been diagnosed with asthma was nearly the
                                                        same, 11 percent and 10 percent, respectively. Asthma rates in
                                                        children have increased since 1980, especially for children age 4
                                                        and younger and for African-American children (Exhibit 4-27).

                                                        Data  Sources

                                                        Mortality: National Vital Statistics System, National Center
                                                        for Health Statistics. (See Appendix B, page B-31,
                                                        for more information.)

                                                        Prevalence: National Health Interview Survey, Centers for
                                                        Disease Control and Prevention (See Appendix B, page B-32,
                                                        for more information.)
                                                                        .  !
  t.	MO
        120
       !>100
                                       astnma attack prevalence, 1997-2001, i
        40
        20
                                                                           diagnosis, current asthma, ana
                                                                           OWvSr   ***** *»***   ^ P* ^ * -  M
                                                                    children
                                       Asthma prevalence
                                                                                                Asthma lifetime diagnosis
                                                                                              Current asthma prevalence
                                                                                                Asthma attack prevalence
               J_
                             J_
    Nate:
    T980  198?  1982 1983 1984 1985  1986  1987 1988 1989 1990 1991  1992
The survey question! for asthma changed in 1997; data before 1 997 cannot be directly compai

i! Based 0" and updated (jpoi Akinfaami, LJ. and K,C. Schoendorf. Trends in C/iiUfipoi
4-36        4.3 Health Status of the U.S.: Indicators and Trends of Health and Disease       Chapter 4 - Human Health

-------

                                                                                                  ^b^^A^^lSi^y-'^lk^j^'^^-^^'^-'ig-
                 Deaths due to birth defects - Category 1
                 Birth defect incidence - C-ategpry I
   Congenital anomalies, or birth defects, are structural defects
   that are present in the fetus at birth. Because the causes of
   about 70 percent of all birth defects are unknown, the public
   continues to be anxious about whether environmental pollu-
   tants cause birth defects, developmental disabilities, or other
   adverse reproductive  outcomes. The public also has many
   questions about whether various occupational hazards,
   dietary factors, medications, and personal behaviors cause or
   contribute to birth defects (CDC, 2002c).
          txnioit U-28: Number and rate of live births witn :
^p1" I_AIHUIU M--Z.U. i >*uinut;i CLIIU iau3 uj uvti uuuii wiui M; fc:(-Leq cviiyeiHLcll
Hi* anomalies, United States, 2000
aa.
•
I
I
I5
i
i
1
r
J
I
i
E
P
i"
P
S
K
£
i
i
;i
i
f
K-
h
i

Congenital Anomaly ;
(All races) | . j
Anencephalus
Spina bifida/Meningocele
Hydrocephalus v
Microcephalus
Other central nervous system anomalies

Heart malformations
Other circulatory/respiratory anomalies
Rectal atresia/stenosis
Tracheo-esophageal fistula/Esophageal atresia
Omphalocele/Gastroschisis
Other gastrointestinal anomalies
Malformed genitalia
. Renal agenesis
Other urogenital anomalies

Cleft lip/palate
Po lydacty ly/Sy ndactyly/Adacty ly
Clubfoot
Diaphragmatic hernia
Other musculoskeletal/integumenta! anomalies
Down's syndrome
Other chromosomal anomalies
A ^
Number of Congenital
Anomalies Reported
425
822
940 .
284
822

4,958
5,484
333 •
481
1,180
1,185
3,344
547
3,943

3,259
3,460
2,271
427
8,614
1,863
1,575
4 j -;
!
Rate !
10.7
20.7
23.7
7.2
20.7

124.9
138.1
8.4
12.1
29.7
29.9
84.2
13.8
99.3 .

82.1
87.2
57.2
10.8
217.0
46.9
39.7
What the  Data  Show

Birth defects (congenital anomalies) are a leading cause of
infant deaths, accounting for 5,473 (19.6 percent) of the
27,937 infant deaths in 1999 (Hoyert, et al., 2001). The most
frequently occurring types of birth defects were those affecting
the heart and the lungs. Because some birth defects are not
recognized immediately, they are und.erreported on the death
certificate, so the numbers underestimate the problem (Friis, et
al., 1999). Exhibit 4-28 presents the number and rate of live
births with congenital anomalies.

                       Data Source
                                                                                        National Vital Statistics System,
                                                                                        National Center for Health Statistics.
                                                                                        (See Appendix B, page B-32,
                                                                                        for more information.)
     __ Stes^aca nuniber of live births with specified congenital anomaly per 100,000 IIVP births in
     [specified group                                                                   I
    jj-,                                                                            I
    y3ote- Of the 4,031,591 live births, there was no response recorded for the congenital anomaly item    t
    %r 61,744 births                                                                 ,
     r                                     , s                                    i
      ource- Martin, J.A, et al. Birihs: final Data for 2000. 2002.
Chapter 4 - Human Health       4.3 Health Status of the U.S.: Indicators and Trends of Health and Disease        4-37

-------
£"PAs Draft import !on the Environment 2dOS  • 1e{:hnical Dqc^m|||j:
   4.3.5 What are the trends for
   emerging health effects?
 In addition to the diseases reported in the preceding pages, several
 other diseases are the cause of emerging concern because of their
 potential impacts on the health of the .U.S. population. Information
 for eight such diseases—diabetes, Alzheimer's disease, Parkinson's
 disease, renal disease, autism, and three arthropod-borne diseases
 (lyme disease, Rocky Mountain spotted fever, and West Nile
 virus)— is presented in this section. The increasing prevalence of
 these "emerging" illnesses positions them as potential future candi-
 dates for consideration as EPHIs. This will be dependent on  their  ,
 increasing prevalence in the population or a better determination
 of the role of exposure to environmental pollutants in the onset or
 exacerbation of these  diseases. No specific indicators have been
 presented for these diseases at this time, but data collected by the
 CDC, individual states, and other sources illustrate the recent
 trends in these diseases.

 Diabetes

 Diabetes is a set of metabolic disorders. Diabetes mellitus (type 2) is
 the most common form of diabetes and is a disease whereby the
 body's insulin activity is altered. Insulin is a hormone that signals
 many biological processes such as the conversion of glucose  to
 glycogen. Glycogen is  the form in which food energy is stored in the
 body. The general symptoms of diabetes are elevated blood glucose
 levels, excessive thirst, frequent urination, and unexplained weight
 loss. Heredity, obesity, and age are factors that also contribute to
 diabetes. Estimates of the prevalence of diabetes vary widely.
 However, CDC estimates that there are about 11.1 million diagnosed
 cases of diabetes (CDC, 2002b).  In addition to these cases,  CDC
 estimates that there may be about 5.9 million more cases that are
 undiagnosed (CDC, 2002b). The total of 17 million diagnosed and
 undiagnosed cases combined amounts to a prevalence of 6.2
 percent of the U.S. population. CDC estimates that 1  million new
 cases of diabetes are diagnosed per year among people aged
 20 years and older (CDC, 2002b).

 In 1999, diabetes ranked as the sixth leading cause of death  in the
 U.S. There were 68,399 deaths due to diabetes (Hoyert, et al.,
 2001). The age-adjusted death rates for diabetes increased between
 1980 and 1996 from 15.3 to 20.6 per 100,000 people. By  1999,
 the rate had risen to 25.2 per 100,000 people.

 On average, Hispanic Americans are 1.9 times more likely to  have
 diabetes than non-Hispanic Whites of similar age. The risk of
 diabetes for Mexican Americans and non-Hispanic Blacks is almost
 twice that for non-Hispanic Whites. Similarly, residents of Puerto
 Rico are 2.0 times more likely to have diagnosed diabetes than U.S.
 non-Hispanic Whites. On average, American Indians and Alaska
Natives are 2.6 times more likely to have diabetes than non-Hispanic
Whites of similar age. Approximately 15 percent of American Indians
and Alaska Natives receiving care from the Indian Health Service have
diabetes. At the regional level, diabetes is' least common among
Alaska Natives (5.3 percent) and most cpmrnon among American
Indians in the southeastern U.S. (25.7 percent) and in certain tribes
from the Southwest (CDC, 2002b). Exhibit 4-29 shows age-adjust-
ed prevalence data for diabetes in the U.S. by race/ethnicity.
Alzk
Dis
     leimers Uisease               ;
                                -1  I
                                 r  j
Alzheimer's disease is a neurodegenerative disorder. The symptoms
of Alzheimer's disease may include demerytia, loss of memory, and
decreasing physical abilities such as dressing or eating. In the U.S.,
an estimated 4 million people, mostly elderly, have Alzheimer's dis-
ease (Hoyeit and Rosenberg, 1999). In 1999, an estimated       ,
354,000 non-institutionalized adults 18 |to 64 years of age!reported
Alzheimer's disease as their main disability (CDC, 2001 e).

The death rate  due to Alzheimer's disease rose steadily from 1979 to
1996. In 1999, Alzheimer's disease was the eighth leading cause of
 4-38        4.3 Health Status of the U.S.: Indicators and Trends of Health arid Disease       Chapter 4 - Human Health

-------
 death in the U.S. (Hoyert, et al., 2001). There were 44,536 deaths
 attributed to Alzheimer's disease (16.3 deaths per 100,000
 population). The death rate for Alzheimer's disease rises sharply with
 age. In 1999, among people 75 to 84 years of age, there were
 15,836 deaths and in this age group Alzheimer's disease ranked as
 the seventh leading cause of death (Anderson, 2001). The death
 rate for Alzheimer's disease for this age group was 130.4 per
 100,000 population. Among persons 85 years of age and older,
 there were 24,980 deaths due to Alzheimer's disease for a death
 rate of 598.3 per 100,000 population.

 Death rates for Alzheimer's disease are higher for women than for
 men and higher for Whites than African Americans (Hoyert, et al.,
 2001). The 1999 death rates for Alzheimer's disease are highest for
 White females (25.6 per 100,000), followed by White males (11.4),
 African American  females (9.0), and African American males (4.2).
 The Alzheimer's disease death rate for Hispanics is 3.1 per 100,000.
 Hispanic females  have a higher death rate (4.3 per 100,000 popula-
 tion) than Hispanic males (2.0 per 100,000). The death rates from
 Alzheimer's disease are higher in the Northeast and in the Northwest
 regions of the U.S. (Hoyert and Rosenberg, 1999).
 Tarki
Dis
    insons L/isease

 Parkinson's disease is a neurodegenerative disorder characterized by
 symptoms such as tremors, muscle rigidity, and changes in walking
 patterns. The National Institute of Neurological Diseases and Stroke
 (NINDS) estimates that there are about 500,000 people in the U.S.
 with Parkinson's disease (NINDS, 2002). The disease mostly affects
 elderly people and is second only to Alzheimer's disease in the num-
 ber of older people that are affected (Checkoway and Nelson,
 1999). It affects about 0.4 percent of those 40 years of age and
 older, 1  percent of those older than  65 years, and about 3 percent
 of those 80 years of age and older. Males are 1.3 times more likely
 than females to have Parkinson's disease.

 A steady increase in the death,rate due to  Parkinson's disease among
 people 75 years of age and older has been observed in the U.S. In
 1999, there were 14,593 deaths due to Parkinson's disease (Hoyert,
 et al., 2001). Virtually all of the deaths (14,298) occurred in people
 65 years of age and older. The death rate was 5.4 per 100,000
 population, with males having a higher death rate than females  (6.2
 versus 4.5 per 100,000).

 The 1999 death rate due to  Parkinson's disease was higher for
 Whites (6.2 per 100,000 people ) than for African Americans
 (1.5 per 100,000)  (Hoyert, et al., 2001). The death rate for
 White males was 7.1 per 100,000 and for White females 5.3  per
 100,000. The death rate for African American males was 1.6  and
for African American females 1.3 per 100,000. The death rate for
 Hispanics was 1.2 per 100,000, with Hispanic males having a
slightly higher death rate (1.4 per 100,000) than Hispanic
females  (1.1 per 100,000).
 "Renal Disease

 The kidneys are vital organs and can be seriously affected by a
 number of primary diseases such as diabetes or hypertension. As
 these diseases progress, the kidneys may fail to function. Total and
 permanent  kidney failure is called end stage renal (kidney) disease
 (ESRD). It is estimated that about 424,179 people in the U.S. have
 ESRD (NIDDK, 2001). Most ESRD occurred in people who have
 diabetes (150,404 people), hypertension (100,169 people), or
 glomerulonephritis, a kidney disease (62,119 people).

 The U.S. government maintains the U.S. Renal Data System, which
 provides information on the incidence, prevalence, and mortality for
 ESRD (CDC,-2000a). Data from this system indicate that there were
 89,252 people with ESRD who began treatment in 1999. These
 cases of ESRD resulted from diabetes for 38,160 people and  from
 hypertension for 23,133 people. Kidney diseases and other primary
 diseases were responsible for the remainder.

 Between 1979 and 1998, the age-adjusted  death rates for all types
 of kidney disease increased, peaking between 1984 and 1988. The
 age-adjusted death rates for all types of kidney disease are higher
 among African Americans than among Whites, with African American
 males having the highest rates during the 1979 to 1998 period.

 In 1979, the death rate for total kidney disease was 8.6 per
 100,000 people. By 1999, kidney disease had risen to rank as the
 ninth leading cause of death in the U.S. (Hoyert, et al., 2001). That
 year there were 35,525 deaths due to all types of kidney disease;
 34,719 of them were due to kidney failure. The death rate for kidney
 disease was  13.0 per 100,000 people; the death rate for kidney
 failure was 12.7 per 100,000 people (Exhibit 4-30). Death rates for
 kidney failure were  highest for African American females at 19.0 per
 100,000, followed by African American males at 17.8 per 100,000.

 African Americans and American Indians have higher rates of ESRD
 than Whites or Asians (AHA, 2001). African Americans represent 32
 percent of the patients receiving treatment for ESRD. Recently there
 has been an increase in ESRD due to diabetes among American
 Indians and Alaskan Natives (CDC, 2000c). Between 1990 and
 1996, the age-adjusted rate of new ESRD treatment among
American Indians with diabetes increased 24 percent, from 472 to
584 per 100,000 persons with diabetes.

Autism

Autism is one of several related severe cognitive and neurobehavioral
disorders that are classified under the term autistic spectrum
disorders. Information about the prevalence  of autism in the U.S. is
limited, reflecting the use of different diagnostic criteria and a lack of
research. First described in the 1940s, autism was thought to affect
2 to 4 children per 10,000 population^ Today the prevalence  is
currently believed to be as high as 1 in 500  children* for all autistic
Chapter 4 - Human Health        4.3 Health Status of the U.S.: Indicators and Trends of Health and Disease
                                                                                                             4-39

-------
EPAs Draft feport on  the Environment JJ30$

                    Exhibit 4-30: Death rates for kidney disease  United States, 1999
                                                             i   I          _ks ,                     *rii;:.'S«.:»: v.
'„ IB!::.:;/,,: n
pmHiHi
Cause
of Death
Nephritis, nephrotic
syndrome, nephrosis
Kidney failure
Other

All Races
Both Male Female
Sexes
13.0 12.8 13.3
12.7 12.5 13.0
0.3 0.3 0.3
e
White 1 ,:i ' , i
Both Male Female
Sexes
12.5 12.4 12.6
12.2 12.1 12.3
0.3 0.3 0.3
«
A! Other : i
Both Male Female
Sexes
1S.6 14.8 16.3
15.2 14.4 16.0
0.4 0.4 0.3*

HEDi@39MHMHHniI
: Both Male Female
' Sexes !
. ,19.3 18.2 20.2
i 1
18.9 17.8 19,0
| 0.4 0.4* 0.4*
•-i
-«
!'i
,;:|
>r,.f
. ;f;
S-
y
-.'«
 J  (Utfts are per 100,000 population.
 I: '%i(e does not meet the standards of reliability or precision.
 !  Source; Hoyert, et it. Deaths: flnol Data for 1999. 2001.
 spectrum disorders (Iversen, 2000). Currently, autism affects about  ,
 400,000 people in the U.S., and occurs about four times more often
 in boys than in girls.

 Researchers have reported that the number of persons with autism is
 increasing. For example, a recent California Department of
 Developmental Services (CDDS) report showed an over 200 percent
 increase in the number of persons entering the regional center
 service system with autism between 1987 and 1998  (CDDS, 1999).
 Other states have reported increasing numbers as well  (Yazbak,
 1999). However, these reports do not necessarily reflect a change in
 the rate of autism because they do not consider the increase in the
 total population (Fombonne, 2001).

 The number of cases of autism in children in the U.S. has increased
 over time. The number of children 0 to 21 years old with autism who
 are also enrolled in federally supported programs for the disabled
 has grown from 5,000 in 1991 to 79,000 in 2000 (NCES, 2001).
 This represents an increase from 0.1  to 1.1  percent of all children
 with disabilities served, or an increase from 0.01 to 0.14 percent of
 all children  in  public schools.
 Artnropoa-fiome Diseases
  Certain ticks and mosquitoes (arthropods) can carry bacteria and   ,
  viruses that cause disease in humans. They acquire the bacteria and
  viruses when they bite an infected mammal or bird. Arthropod-borne
  diseases include Lyme disease, Rocky Mountain spotted fever
  (RMSF), and West Nile virus (WNV).

  Lyme Disease

  Lyme disease is the most commonly reported arthropod-borne
  disease in the U.S. (Orloski, et al., 2002). The illness was first      ;
  described in Europe during the 1800s; however, it was not identified
  in the U.S. until the early 1970s when a cluster of children with
                                                               ??SS5S;JS^^

                                                                           !!>iiJ:i^!iifii
                                                  "juvenile rheumatoid arthritis" in Lyme, Connecticut, was reported
                                                  by their parents (Shapiro and Gerber, 20:00). Investigation of the
                                                  cluster led to the description of Lyme arthritis in 1976 and then to .
                                                  the identification of the causal pathogen) Between 1992 and 1998,
                                                  there were 88,967 cases of Lyme diseasej reported to the CDC..
                                                  The number of cases increased from 9,8$6 in 1992 to 16,802 in
                                                  1998 (Exhibit 4-31).               ,   j

                                                  The incidence of Lyme disease was highejst in eight northeastern and
                                                  mid-Atlantic states and two north centraj states. These states
                                                  accounted for 92 percent of the total ca£es.
                                                                                   :   i
                                                  Rocky Mountain Spotted Fever     .   ;
                                                                                   it               ,
                                                  Although Lyme disease is the most commonly reported tick-borne
                                                  disease in the U.S., RMSF is the most cojnmonly fatal tick-borne
                                                  disease in the U.S. (Holman, et al., 2001^. Physicians first recognized
                                                  RMSF in the; northwestern  U.S. during the late 1800s; Howard
                                                  Ricketts identified the causal pathogen ir) the early 1900s (Gayle
                                                  and Ringdahl, 2001; Paddock, et al., 199|9). RMSF was the first
                                                  disease in the U.S. shown to be transmitted by tick bite (Walker,
                                                  1998). Although RMSF was first identified in the Rocky Mountain
                                                  states, fewer than 3 percent of cases we^e reported from that area
                                                  between  1993 and 1996. The highest incidence of cases in that time
                                                  period was found in North Carolina and  Oklahoma. These two states
                                                  accounted for 35 percent of the total cases from 1993 to 1996
                                                   (CDC, 2002c). RMSF has been reported throughout the continental
                                                  U.S. (excep" in Maine, New Hampshire, a|nd Vermont).

                                                 '  Between 1990 and 1998, there were approximately 4,800 cases of
                                                   RMSF reported to the CDC (CDC, 2000b). The annual number of
                                                  cases has varied between 250 and 1,200 cases since 1942J, with a ;
                                                   peak between 1975 and 1981.          ;                      |

                                                                                   1   i          •            I
                                                  The ratio o':the number of deaths due tb RMSF compared to the
                                                   number of cases of the disease is the highest'in children  under 10
  4-40
4.3 Health Status of the U.S.: Indicators and Trends of Health and Disease        Chapter 4 - Human Health

-------
                       Exhibit 4-31: Number of reported cases of Lyme disease, United States, 1982-1998
              1982   1983   1984   1985   1986   1987   1988   1989  1990   (1991   1992   1993  1994  1995  1996   1997   1998
 BCS&urce: Orloski K.A, et al Surveillance for Lyme Disease. 2002.
years of age (2 to 3 percent) and those over 70 years of age (9
percent) (CDC, 2000b).

West Nile Virus

In 1937, WNV, a strain of encephalitis, was first identified as a human
pathogen in the West Nile region of Uganda. The pathogen was
found in blood taken from a woman during a yellow fever
investigation (Rappole, et al., 2000). Since  1937, WNV has been
determined to be widespread in many areas of the world, particularly
Africa, the Middle East, Europe, Russia, India, and Indonesia
(Horga and Fine, 2001).
                                                                Year
Cases of WNV were first documented in the U.S. in 1999 (CDC,
2000d). A total of 80 cases in humans were reported in 1999
(62 cases) and 2000 (18 cases). Because severe neurological illness
(encephalitis meningitis) occurs in fewer than 1 percent of persons
infected, it is thought that a greater number of cases with less
severe symptoms may go unreported. Based on this assumption,
it is estimated that approximately 2,000 persons may have been
infected with WNV during 2000 (CDC, 2000d). The prevalence of  .
the disease in humans is increasing. During 2002 there were 3,989
diagnosed cases in humans (CDC, 2002f). The number of deaths
caused by West Nile encephalitis has increased from 7 in 1999 to
259 in 2002 (CDC, 2002f).
Chapter 4 - Human Health       4.3 Health Status of the U.S.: Indicators and Trends of Health and Disease        4-41

-------
El As Draft "Report on the  tnvironment 2dQ3
           ecnnica
            AAeasuring  txposure
 to  tnvironmental Tollution:
 Indicators  and   Irends
 Historically, human exposure to pollutants has been estimated
 based on:
 • Measurements of ambient pollutant concentrations in air, water,
   or land, combined with:
 • Estimates or measurements  (through personal monitoring) of
   the frequency and duration  of human contact with the
   contaminated media.
 This approach has provided a valuable foundation for many of the
 regulatory and non-regulatory actions that have been taken to limit
 exposure to ambient pollutants. However, ambient measurements do
 not provide information on the degree to which ambient pollutants
 actually enter into the body. Another type of indicator—biomonitor-
 ing data—can help provide this information. Biomonitoring measures
 the amount of a pollutant in human tissue or fluids. It provides an
 important complement to more traditional exposure assessment
 indicators. National-scale biomonitoring data can be used to:
 • Measure and track average body burden  resulting from exposure
   across the entire population to a variety of pollutants.
 • Enhance environmental disease prevention efforts by providing an
   important bridge to understanding the relationships between
   ambient pollutant concentrations, exposures to these poljutants,
   and health problems. (The lead case study, discussed earlier in
   Section 4.1, provides an excellent example of this application.)
 • Establish reference ranges to identify people with unusually high
   exposures or the percentage of the population with pollutant
   exposures above established levels of concern (CDC, 2003a).

 This section focuses primarily on biomonitoring indicators and is
 divided into ten parts:
 • Section 4.4.1 provides background information on biomonitoring
   indicators—what they are and their limitations.
 • Section 4.4.2 describes the major data sources for these
   indicators.
 • Sections 4.4.3 to 4.4.8 describe specific pollutants and the data
   available to monitor these pollutants, including heavy metals
   (Section 4.4.3), cotinine (Section 4.4.4), volatile organic com-
   pounds (Section 4.4.5), pesticides (Section 4.4.6), and persist-
  ent organic pollutants (Section 4.4.7): Section 4.4.8 presents
  indicators that are available to specifically monitor children's expo-
  sure to some of these pollutants. In'alj, 10 biomonitoring indica-
  tors are currently available for trackingjtrends in human exposure
  to specific environmental pollutants. Summaries of the data linking
  exposure to human health effects can be found in ATSDR's toxico-
  logical profiles and EPA's criteria documents for these chemicals.

H Section 4,4.9 briefly discusses a number of pollutants—radiation,
  air pollutants (except for lead), biological pollutants, and
  disinfection by-products —for which rio biomonitoring indicators
  currently are available or feasible. For these pollutants, traditional
  exposure assessment will continue to s^rve as the method for
  estimating human exposure until biomonitoring indicators become
  available or feasible.                ,

•I Finally, Section 4.4.10 touches on endocrine disrupters—
  considered an emerging issue.       '


U.U.I Diomonitoring Indicators   •'•  •.                      :

"Dose" (the amount of a pollutant that enters the body) is often
expressed as average daily dose or total potential dose. Once a
pollutant crosses the  boundary into the body, biological processes :
act on that contaminant to utilize, remov£, or store the contaminant
and/or its metabolites. Body burden isjthe concentration of a
contaminant dose that is retained in the human body Body burden
can be estimated from measurements of the contaminant in the
blood, urine, or adipose tissue.  These 'measurements provide the
basis for biomonitoring indicators.      ,

The buildup of a contaminant in the body (i.e., the level of body
burden) depends on a variety of factors, including the nature of the
contaminant; the efficacy of the biological removal processes; and
the magnitude, timing, frequency, and duration of exposure. Some
contaminants, such as lead, are not easily removed and are retained
in the body for long periods of time. Other contaminants, such as
many volatile organic compounds (VOCs), are rapidly eliminated in
exhaled breath or other removal processes.                     ;

The level of body burden is usually estimated from the concentration
of a contaminant (or its metabolite) meaiured in the blood, urine,
hair, or adipose tissue, and can be used 1:o infer that an exposure
occurred. In some cases, the level of body burden associated with a
particular contaminant may prove to be ajn indicator of the person's
extent of exposure to that pollutant.    '                      ;

There are a number of potential problemk, however,  with using body
burden as an indicator of exposure. In some cases, several different
pollutants may give rise to the same biomarker. Further,  most      '
measures of body burden reflect only a
different exposure scenarios can lead to •
snapshot" in time and many
:he same concentration
measurement. Lastly, the measure gives no information about how
the person was exposed.              \
 4-42        4.4 Measuring Exposure to Environmental Pollution: Indicators Jind Trends       CJiapt£r 4 - Human Health

-------
Nonetheless, national scale measures of body burden are useful
indicators of exposure in the population. While such measures do
not necessarily provide information about the nature of the expo-
sures, they do represent the average levels of exposure in the popu-
lation as a whole. Such national scale measures of body burden are
often more convenient to obtain than to estimate the exposures by
accounting for all of the exposure concentrations and durations for
the whole population. As mentioned earlier, body burden (biomoni-
toring) data are not available for all pollutants of interest to EPA. In
such cases, ambient data or exposure measurements and  models are
used to assess human exposure.

4.4.2   Data Sources for Diomonitoring Indicators

Two primary sources provided data for the biomonitoring indicators
presented in this section:

• The National Health and Nutrition Examination Survey
  (NHANES), conducted by the National Center for Health
  Statistics (NCHS). Specifically, data were used from the second,
  third, and fourth surveys (NHANES II; NHANES III; and NHANES
  IV [1999-2000]).

• EPA's National Human Exposure Assessment Survey
  (NHEXAS). Specifically, data were used from surveys of three
  regions: Maryland, EPA Region 5, and Arizona (NHEXAS-MD;
  NHEXAS-Region 5; and NHEXAS-AZ).
Two others sources of biomonitoring data—autopsy data and tissue
registry data—were considered but not used for these indicators. As
described below, neither of these sources contains rich biomonitor-
ing data, which significantly limits their usefulness as data sources for
human contaminant levels.

National Center for Health Statistics, National Health and

Nutrition Examination Survey (NHANES)

NHANES consists of a series of surveys conducted by CDCs
NCHS. The survey is designed to collect data on the health of the
U.S. population, including information on topics such as nutrition,
cardiovascular disease, and exposure to chemicals (CDC, 2001 c).
The NHANES surveys have been performed over a number of
years. The first survey, NHANES  I, took place from 1971 through
1975; NHANES II  occurred from 1976 through  1980; NHANES III
was performed from 1988 through 1994; and the most recent
NHANES for which data are available took place in 1999-2000. In
this section, the year(s) in which the data were collected are
identified in each  citation, of NHANES.

As part of the survey, blood and urine samples were collected to
measure the amounts of certain chemicals thought to be potentially
harmful to people. Because of the extensive work involved with
laboratory analysis, some chemicals were measured for all people in
the survey, while other chemicals were only measured in representa-
tive subsamples of people in an age group.

The CDC National Report on Human Exposure to Environmental
Chemicals (often referred to as the "CDC Report Card") (CDC,
2001 c) summarizes chemical exposure data from NHANES.
Information from the CDC report is presented hereafter under the
heading "NHANES 1999-2000." To date, this report  has been
released twice. Data from the first report are updated in the larger,
second report. The second report represents the U.S. population
over a  2-year period, 1999-2000. Two years of data  provide more
stable  estimates for the total population and are necessary for
adequate sample sizes for some subgroup analysis. Future reports
will be released every 2 years and will cover data for a 2-year
period (e.g., 2001-2002, 2003-2004, 200S-2006).

National Human Exposure Assessment Survey

(NHEXAS)

The goal of NHEXAS was to better understand the complete picture
of human exposure to toxic chemicals by looking at humans' many
exposures to all types of toxic chemicals. NHEXAS was a multiday,
multimedia study that examined chemical concentrations in indoor
air, outdoor air, dust, soil, food, beverages, drinking water, and tap
water. For some contaminants, body burden measurements were
obtained from samples of blood, hair, or urine.

Phase 1 of NHEXAS consisted of demonstration and scoping studies
in Maryland; Phoenix, Arizona; and EPA Region  5 using  probability-
based sampling designs. Although the study was conducted in three
different regions of the U.S., it was not designed to be nationally
representative. The Region 5 study was conducted in Ohio,
Michigan, Illinois, Indiana, Wisconsin, and Minnesota and measured
metals  and VOCs. The Arizona study measured metals, pesticides,
and VOCs. The target population for the NHEXAS-MD  study
consisted of the non-institutionalized permanent residents of house-
holds in the city of Baltimore or four counties in Maryland. Samples
from select environmental and biological media, as well  as question-
naire data, were collected in NHEXAS-MD. The three NHEXAS
studies are identified in this section as  NHEXAS-AZ, NHEXAS-
Region 5, or NHEXAS-MD, to indicate where they were performed.
Autopsy Data
Autopsies can provide important information about deaths resulting
from known or suspected environmental or occupational hazards. For
example, one of the earliest indications of the rise in lung cancer
deaths came from reports that lung cancers were being identified
with increasing frequency in autopsies (Hanzlick, 1998).

The value of an autopsy database for body burden and
epidemiologic studies has been recognized;  however, few such
studies have been conducted. This is partly  because autopsies are
Chapter H - tiuman Health       4.4 Measuring Exposure to Environmental Pollution: Indicators and Trends        4-43

-------
                       ;                              i         '.'.,,..     J_ -              :.:,•' |
El/As Draft Report on the  Environment 2003 | Technical Docqnp||t
 performed on a non-random sample of deaths and because
 environmental contaminant levels are typically not measured during
 an autopsy (Moore, etal., 1996). Also, autopsies are performed on
 only a small percentage of the U.S. population. In 1980, autopsies
 were performed in approximately 17 percent of deaths in the U.S. By
 1985, the percentage had declined to 14 percent. While nearly all
 deaths due to homicide and other medico-legal causes were
 autopsied, autopsies were performed in only 12 percent of all deaths
 due to natural causes (CDC, 1998a).

 Difficulties in accessing autopsy data can limit their usefulness as
 well. Prior to 1995, the National Center for Health Statistics (NCHS)
 collected data from death certificates indicating whether an autopsy
 was performed. Since that time, however, such information is no
 longer available from the NCHS national mortality statistics
 databases (Hanzlick, 1998).
 Tissue Registry Data
 Human tissues are stored for study in many forms including solid
 organs, organ sections, histology slides, cells, and DMA. Tissue
 registries are maintained for medical education and biological
 research, but few studies have been conducted to identify trends in
 environmental contaminants in tissues using tissue registries. Tissue
 registry samples and information are not population-based, and at
 present there is no central database containing information about
 tissue samples (Eiseman and Haga, 1999).

 EPA has conducted one of the most extensive tissue studies. From
 1976 to 1987, the  EPA conducted the National Human Adipose
 Tissue Survey  (NHATS). NHATS was a national survey that
 collected adipose tissue samples to monitor exposure to toxic
 compounds among the general population. Pathologists and -
 medical examiners  from 47 metropolitan areas collected samples
 from autopsies and elected surgeries (Crinnion, 2000; Orban, et
 al., 1994). Even though  the study was a significant biomonitoring
 effort, data from NHATS are not presented in this report because
 nesver data sources are available.
 14.4.3 What is the leVef  of !expsij(re
 [to heavy metals?        j  |            j     I
Heavy metals; are important environmental pollutants because they
are related to several adverse health effecjts when ingested or      ;
inhaled. Five metals have been selected fojr in-depth presentation in
this section: chromium, lead, arsenic, mercury, and cadmium. These
metals are known to be related to severe Adverse health effects and
are relatively common  in household, workj and school environments.
Exhibit 4-32 presents  EPA regulatory standards and guidelines for
these five metals. Indicators are available for lead, arsenic, mercury, •
and cadmium and are discussed on the following pages. At present,
no indicator is available for chromium, but it is discussed bejow
because human health may be adversely Affected by chromium iri
the environment. (For additional information on heavy metals in the:
environment, see Chapter 1, Cleaner Air.):

(_nromium                      '  I     "

Chromium is a naturally occurring element found in rocks, animals,
plants, soil, and in volcanic dust and gase^. Chromium is present in
the environment in several different forms!, but primarily in two
valence states: trivalent chromium (III) anid hexavalent chromium (VI).
Chromium (111) is an essential nutrient and is much less toxic than
chromium  (VI), which is generally produced by industrial processes.
Chromium (III) and chromium (VI) are used for chrome plating, dyes
and pigments, leather tanning, and wood preserving (ATSDR, 2001).

In air, chromium compounds are present rnostly as fine dust  particles
that eventually settle over land and water. Chromium can strongly
attach to soil and only a small amount cap dissolve in water and
move deeper in the soil to  underground \vater. Fish do not accumu-
late much chromium in their bodies from Water (ATSDR, 2001).

People can be exposed to chromium by eating food containing
chromium  (III); breathing contaminated! workplace air or experiencing
skin contact during use in the workplace; Idrinking contaminated well
water; or living near uncontrolled hazardous waste sites containing ;
chromium  or near industries that use chromium (ATSDR, 2001).
Although studies have been conducted trjat measure the amount of
chromium  in drinking water, ground water, soil, and air, there,are no
studies that measure the body burden 'of;chromium in human tissue.
                                                                                                     I
 4.44        4.4  Measuring Exposure to Environmental Pollution: Indicators and Trends       LJiapt^r 4 - "Human Health

-------
   Chromium III is an essential nutrient that helps the body use sugar,
   protein, and fat. An intake of 50-200 JJg of chromium (III) per day is
   recommended for adults. On average, adults in the U.S. take in an
   estimated 60-80 (Jg of chromium per day in food. Therefore, many
   people's diets may not provide enough chromium (III). Without
   chromium III in the diet, the body loses its ability to use sugars,
   proteins, and fat properly, which may result in weight loss or
   decreased growth, improper function of the nervous system, and a
   diabetic-like condition. Therefore, chromium (III)  compounds have
   been used as dietary supplements and are beneficial if taken in
   recommended (but not excessive) dosages (ATSDR, 2000). Chronic-
   high exposures to chromium (III), however, may affect the skin, liver,
   or kidneys (ACGIH, 1991; Rom, 1992).
 In general, chromium (VI) is more toxic than chromium III. Breathing
 in high levels (greater than 2 (Jg/m^) of chromium (VI), such as in a
 compound known as chromic acid or chromium (VI) trioxide, can
 irritate the nose, causing symptoms such as runny nose, sneezing,
 itching, nosebleeds, ulcers, and holes in the nasal septum. These
 effects have primarily occurred in factory workers who make or use
 chromium (VI) for several months to many years. Long-term exposure
 to chromium (VI) has been associated with lung cancer in workers
 exposed to levels in air that were 100 to 1,000 times higher than
 those found in the natural environment. Lung cancer may occur long
after exposure to chromium VI has ended (ATSDR, 2000).

No biomonitoring data are readily  available for chromium.
Interest is developing in examining chromium  as an emerging
environmental pollutant.
                                         : United States federal standards and criteria for five heavy metals
                                                               "^     f o         -f       ,          *
                           fT. MCLs are regulatory standards developed pursuant to the Federal Safe Drinking
                           *~ Water Act (SDWA).                                                     &
                           2r A groundwater cleanup level is most often the MCL (per the Comprehensive
                           - Erwronmental Response, Compensation, and Liability Act [CERCLA] [also known as
                             Superfund] and Resource Conservation and Recovery Act [RCRA] guidance) for
                             the particular contaminant Groundwater cleanup levels are established by EPA and
                             S?D^" a"se-by-«se basis for Superfund site clean-ups and corrective actions
                             at KCKA solid and hazardous waste management.
                          &-Thjs Standard is a quarterly average. Lead is a criteria air pollutant (under the Clean
                          ;  Air Act) and therefore has a health-based standard
                          _4 This heavy metal is not a criteria air pollutant and thus there is not a health-based
                          ' -standard. Air pollution standards for this heavy metal are technology-based
                           •-standards,  not health-based standards. For example, the emission standard for
                         _ _ arsenic is that which is achieya,ble wi,t,h the best available technology (BAT) for
                         ±   treating arsenic air emissions.Jn addition, the BAT for arsenic emissions varies
                        |T  across industry sectors and thus emission standards for arsenic also vary across
                       te-^ Industry sectors                                                    ,„  ,,..,._„,,.
                        ^Source: EPA Current Drinking Water Standards. 2002; EPA  EPA Handbook of
                        groundwater Poliaesfor RCRA Corrective Action 2000; EPA. National Air Quality and
                        jyyitssions Trends Report 1999. 2001.  ^ _ w_      „                    _
Chapter 4 - Human Health        4.4 Measuring Exposure to Environmental Pollution: Indicators and Trends
                                                     4-45

-------
	,	—	__,_.___.	          :        • ,  ,  | !    i    I   :    :

 EfAs  Draft Rlport 66  the Environment 2J3C)$ • lechnic^
                    ;''" I       "                               '    ,,:•.'     i   • i
                                                                         JE,
                Blood lead level - Category 1
    Lead is a naturally occurring metal found in small amounts in rock
    and soil. Lead has been used industrially in the production of
    gasoline, ceramic products, paints, and solder. Lead-based paint
    and lead-contaminated dust from paint are the primary sources of
    lead exposure in the home. The body burden of lead can be
    measured as the amount of lead in blood or the amount of lead in
    urine. The health effects of lead are discussed in Section 4.1 of
    this chapter.

    What the Data Show

     NHANES 1999-2000. The mean blood lead levels for adults are
     illustrated in Exhibit 4-33. The mean blood lead level for all males
     in the survey was 2.0 micrograms per deciliter (pg/dL) and 1.4
     ug/dL for all females. The mean blood lead level for non-Hispanic
     African Americans was 1.9 pg/dL The mean blood  lead level for
     Mexican Americans was 1.8 ug/dL (CDC,  2001 c).
                                                NHANES Illl (1988-1994). Blood lead jevels of people were
                                                surveyed in two separate phases of NHANES 111. The data collect-
                                                ed during Phase 2 (1991 through 1994)1 indicated that the U.S.
                                                population's; exposure to lead was decreasing.

                                                NHEXAS-Region 5. Blood lead levels fqr 165 participants were
                                                obtained during NHEXAS-Region 5. Lead levels in blood were
                                                detectable for about 94 percent of the population; most of the
                                                individuals had lead levels well below lOJpg/dL. The mean blood
                                                lead level of the participants was 2.18  M&/dL (Clayton, et al.,
                                                1999).                         !  •
                                                                               !  i
                                                Data Source              ;  :
                                                                               i  i

                                                NHANES 1999-2000, National Center for Health Statistics.
                                                (See Appendix B, page B-33, for more information.)
      pr

      i
      i
 Exhibit 4-33: Geometric mean and selectee] percentiles ol
  ! ""  ior*the United States population, aged* 1 year and o
lead concentrations Vm |jg/dL)
                                           of tota
:or the United States population, aged I year and older, by selected demographic groups,
 lixlational Health and Nutnt.on Exanunabon Survey WANES), 1999-2000
 *<: >aclv-"""                          t            ,                 ».*». *J* rti*fc*i»a
                                                                                   Selected Percentiles
                                                  Geometric Mean
                                                                         1

-------
               Urine arsenic level  -  C-ategory 2
  Arsenic occurs in rock, soil, water, air, plants, and animals.
  Exposure occurs when arsenic is further released into the environ-
  ment through erosion, volcanic action, forest fires, or human   _
  actions. Human activities involve its use in wood preservatives,
  dyes, paints, paper production, and cement manufacturing.
  Arsenic mining is also a source of human exposure (EPA, 2001 a).

  Inorganic arsenic has been recognized as a human poison since
  ancient times, and large oral doses (above 60,000 ppb in food or
  water) can produce death. Lower levels of inorganic arsenic
  (ranging from about 300 to 30,000 ppb in food, water, or
  Pharmaceuticals) may cause symptoms such as stomach ache,
  nausea, vomiting, and diarrhea. Inorganic arsenic is a multi-site
  human carcinogen. Populations with exposures above several
  hundred ppb are reported to have increased risks of skin, bladder,
  and lung cancer. The U.S. Department of Health and Human
  Services (USDHHS) has determined that inorganic arsenic is a
  known carcinogen. The International Agency for Research on
  Cancer (1ARC) had determined that inorganic arsenic is
  carcinogenic to humans. Both the EPA and the National
  Toxicology Program (NTP) have classified inorganic arsenic as a
  known human carcinogen (ATSDR, 2001).

  A large number of adverse noncarcinogenic effects have been
  reported in humans. The most prominent are changes in the
  skin, (e.g., hyperpigmentation and keratoses). Other effects
  that have been reported include alterations  in gastrointestinal,
  cardiovascular, hematological, pulmonary, neurological,
  immunological, and reproductive developmental function
  (NRC, 1999).

  Children who are exposed to arsenic may have many of the same
  effects as adults, including irritation of the stomach and intestines,
  blood vessel damage, skin changes, and reduced nerve function.
  Thus, all health effects observed in adults are of potential concern
  in children (ATSDR, 2001).
What the Data Show

NHEXAS-Region 5. Arsenic levels in urine were measured for
approximately 202 participants during NHEXAS-Region 5. The
mean urine arsenic level was 29.32 micrograms per liter (fJg/L),
while the median urine arsenic level was 3.65 |Jg/L. The mean
level is much higher than the median level, indicating that the
distribution is highly skewed to the higher values (Clayton, et
al., 1999).

MHANES. Future NHANES studies will include arsenic. Therefore,
MHANES will serve as the biomonitoring data source for arsenic.
When NHANES becomes the indicator data source for arsenic,
the indicator will become a Category 1  indicator.

Data Source

MHEXAS, Environmental Protection Agency. (See Appendix B,
page B-33, for more information.)
Chapter 4 - Human Health        4.4  Measuring Exposure to Environmental Pollution: Indicators and Trends        4-47

-------
EPAs Draft Report on trie Environrrient i(3t)^
                       1                                       :    i • •  •

               Blood mercury level - (Category
Mercury is a naturally occurring metal that is widespread and per- .
sistent in the environment. It is found in elemental form and in
various organic compounds and complexes. Methylmercury
(one organic form of mercury) can accumulate up the food chain
in aquatic systems and lead to high concentrations of methylmer-
cury in predatory fish. Consumption of contaminated fish is the
major source of human exposure to methylmercury in the U.S.     '
(NRQ 2000).

Methylmercury is rapidly absorbed from the gastrointestinal tract
and readily enters the brain, where it accumulates and is slowly
converted to inorganic mercury. A spectrum of adverse health
effects has been observed following methylmercury exposure,
With the severity depending largely on the magnitude of the
dose. The most severe effects reported in humans were seen
following high-dose poisoning episodes in Japan and Iraq. The
fetus is considered much more sensitive than the adult Prenatal
exposures interfere with the growth and migration of neurons and
have the potential to cause irreversible damage to the developing
central nervous system. Infants exposed in utero during the Japan
and Iraqi  episodes were born with severe disabilities, such as
mental retardation, seizure disorders, cerebral palsy, blindness,
and deafness. Chronic low-dose prenatal methylmercury exposure
from maternal consumption offish has been associated with more
subtle end points of neurotoxicity (e.g., IQ deficits, abnormal
muscle tone, decrements in motor function, attention and
visuospatial performance) (NRC, 2000).

The human health effects of mercury are diverse and depend
upon the forms of mercury encountered and the severity and
length of exposure. Large acute exposures to elemental mercury
vapor can result in
lung damage. Lower
dose or chronic
inhalation may affect
the nervous system,
resulting in symptoms
such as weakness,
fatigue, weight loss,
gastrointestinal prob-
lems, and behavioral
and personality
changes. Organic
mercury is more toxic
than inorganic and
elemental mercury
(CDC, 2001 c).
Health effects of
                                                                  organic mercury include vision changes, $ensory changes in the
                                                                  limbs, cognitive.disturbances, dermatitis,; and muscle deterioration.;
                                                                  The developing nervous system of the fetus and infants is suscep- !
                                                                  tible to the effects of methylmercury (CDC, 2003).

                                                                  What the Data Show      \
                                                                                                  • i  I                       :
                                                                  NHANES 1 999-2000. The blood mercpry level reported in      ''
                                                                  NHANES is total blood mercury, including both organic and
                                                                  inorganic mercury. Mercury levels were measured in blood and
                                                                  urine during NHANES  1999-2000  for 70S children aged  1 -5
                                                                  years, and 1,709 adult females aged 16-49. The mean blood    ;
                                                                  mercury level for males and females aged 1 -5 years was 0.34     !
                                                                  micrograms per liter (Mg/j-), and the rriea'n blood mercury level for :
                                                                  adult females was 1.02 [Jg/L.        •  !
                                                                                                   I  ;                       ;

                                                                  NHEXAS-Region 5. Mercury concentrations in human hair were
                                                                  measured for 182 participants during NHlEXAS-Region 5.  The
                                                                  mean mercury level in hair, annualized fof seasonally, was  287
                                                                  ppb. More people in older age categories have high levels of
                                                                  mercury in their hair. This increase in mefcury level was found not ,
                                                                  to be an effect of income level (Pellizari, jst al., 1999).

                                                                  Data Source

                                                                  NHANES 1999-2000, National Center fpr Health Statistics.      \
                                                                  (See Appendix B, page B-33, for more information.)
                                                                                           Selected PerceniiU
                         Age Group and Sex
                         Mates/Females 1-5 years
                         Mates
                         Females
                         Females 16-49 years
                                            Sample Size ,  Geometric Mean; ,    10th
                                             - W M
                                r^y^-r
otirce CDC Second National Report on Human Exposure to EnmonmentaffKelnicals 200:
4-48         4.4 Measuring Exposure to Environmental Pollution: Indicators and Trends        C-napter 4 - T~]umcin Health

-------
                           ';. ;y«:"";-'' •'•:r .. : ''' V- ''-..:• A- rV.'.". • .~\-J-'''.~' "'.'V.,:";'• '-j.--1- * ;.;..'.• =;.: '. ;;';>;,-';"* "'••'-.-"'- •-' •--' .!'(-"-';-'•-.•'"•--'*"• v.:'•-/:.-""-•-= -'•-• -•»-"• 1 V-.->vV.-^/>-"-[':-'i'+S-^'.4:^'t^fI^>,.:c'V^i:t:^'-Al:.-^Ki;^i- rt.!1--^1?;^:;^';.^- -...-i"-^ -'••. • •.'••';:.-^Sf"-*—.
                                                                                                                           !^>#fes3^^^^
                                                                                                                                  ^^s^i^«a£^te
                     Dlooa cadmium level  - Category 1
^
Elemental cadmium .is a metal that is usually found in nature
combined with other elements such as oxygen, chlorine, or sulfur.
. Cadmium enters the environment from the weathering of rocks
and minerals that contain cadmium. Exposure to cadmium can
occur in occupations such as mining or electroplating, where
cadmium is used or produced. Cadmium exposure can also occur
from exposure to cigarette smoke (CDC, 2001 c).
Cadmium and its compounds are toxic. Once absorbed into the
human body, cadmium can remain for decades. Exposure to
cadmium for many years may result in cadmium accumulation in
the kidneys and serious kidney damage. Chronic ingestion of
cadmium has resulted in osteomalacia, a bone disorder similar to
rickets. Acute airborne exposure, as occurs from welding on
cadmium-alloy metals, can result in swelling (edema) and scarring
(fibrosis) of the lungs (CDC, 2003).






















"" *~M^^™»>«**^^
What the Data Show
NHANES 1 999-2000. This survey measured blood cadmium
levels in people 1 year and older, and urine cadmium levels in a
sample of people 6 years and older. Recent advances in analytical
chemistry have made it possible to measure cadmium in very small
amounts in blood and urine. Finding a measurable amount of
cadmium in the blood or urine does not mean that the level of
cadmium causes an adverse health effect (CDC, 2001 c). The
blood cadmium biomonitoring measurements are similar among
males and females as well as among the racial or ethnic groups
sampled. Exhibit 4-35 shows that blood levels were higher among
people 20 years of age or older than for people younger than 20
years of age (CDC, 2001 c). The mean urine cadmium level was
0.3 ug/L (CDC, 2001 c).
Data Source
NHANES 1999-2000, National Center for Health Statistics/
(See Appendix B, page B-34, for more information.)
p1 ^ " Exhibit 4-35. Geometric mean and selected percentiles of blood cadmium concentrations (in ug/L) ]
Ifr k>r ^e United States population, aged I year and older, Ly selected demographic groups,
ffcrrr National HealtK and Nutrition E^minj^njuryey (NHANES), 1999-2000
1 ' ' " ' :
J Selected Percentiles B^^HI
ij . 1 Sample Size Geometric Meap 10th 25th 50th 75th onth H^^^^ll
f. Total, Age 1 and Older 7,970 0.4
 ^rn* ,- , , ^i^M3^"^ "^.^fr-in ft* ^, !?,«,• ,P - $


Chapter 4 - Human Health          4.4  Measuring Exposure to Environmental Pollution: Indicators and Trends
4-49

-------

                                                                                                    .,.,
  4.4.4 What is the  level of exposure
  to  cotinine?
Environmental tobacco smoke (ETS) is a dynamic, complex mixture
of more than 4,000 chemicals found in both vapor and particle
phases. Many of these chemicals are known toxic or carcinogenic
agents (ALA, et al., 1994). The EPA has classified ETS as a known
                                                              human carcinogen and estimates that it is'responsible for approxi-  :
                                                              mately 3,000 lung cancer deaths per year, among non-smokers in
                                                              the U.S. (EPA, NCEA, December 1992).  ,

                                                              Cotinine is a major metabolic product of ijiicotine and is currently   '•
                                                              regarded as the best biomarker for exposure of active smokers and
                                                              non-smokers to ETS. Measuring cotinine is preferred over measuring'
                                                              nicotine because, although both are specific for exposure to tobac-
                                                              co, cotinine remains in the body much (or ger than nicotine.
IndiclS
               Blood cotinine level - C_ategory

Cotinine can be measured in blood, urine, saliva, and hair.
Non-smokers exposed to ETS have cotinine levels of less than 1
nanogram per milliliter (ng/mL), with heavy exposure to ETS
producing levels in the 1 to 15 ng/mL range. Active smokers
almost always have levels higher than  15 ng/mL (CDC, 2001 c).

What the Data Show

NHANES 1999-2000. Exhibit 4-36 presents data for the U.S.
non-smoking population aged 3 years and older. Males have
higher levels than females, and people aged 20 years and older
have lower levels than those younger than 20 years of age.
Levels for non-Hispanic African Americans are higher than for
other ethnic groups (CDC, 2001 c).
                                                                NHANES III (1988-1991). As part of NHANES III, CDC
                                                                determined that the median level of cotin ne among non-smokers
                                                                in the U.S. *as 0.20 ng/mL (Pirkle, et al.,
                                                                                                  1996, in CDC, 2001 c).
                                                                Results from NHANES 1999-2000 shoy jthat the median cotinine
                                                                level has decreased to less than 0.050 ng^mL—more than a 75
                                                                percent decrease from NHANES 111 to NHJANES 1999-2000 (CDC,
                                                                2001 c). NHANES 111 (1988-1991) provided the first evidence from
                                                                a national study that serum cotinine levels are higher among Black
                                                                smokers than among White or Mexican American smokers at all
                                                                levels of cigarette smoking (Caraballo, etal., 1998).

                                                                Data Source

                                                                NHANES 1999-2000, National Center tor Health Statistics.
                                                                (See Appendix B, page B-34, for more information.)
ESt U-36 Selected percentiles of serum cotinine concentrations (in ng/mU |
f 4ge'd 3 years and older. National HealtK and Nutrition Examination ,

'
,'


!H;heUnited3tate non smoking, population,^
Ley (NHAKlB), 1999-2000 * '**
I ' " . i i j ' ' Selected; Percentiles Mill ' I
\ Sample Size M ] ! ! 10th 25th 50th " 75th: j jW M ii I
HBBB^iMBi^B^Bi^BI
Total, Age 3 years and Older
Sex
Male
Female
Race/Ethnicity
Black, non-Hispanic*
Mexican American
White, non-Hispanic"
Age Croup
3-11 years
12-19 years
204- years
^^m^^m^^m^^m^mm
5,999
3,210
1,333
2,242
1,949
1,174
1,773
3,052

-------
                        l-!!fci**E«^*«i^%^                                                            "•-''1'"i* :""VK '-"••-'•^i^i^i-»**.£>^>..4^^iW^^"^;:f\^.;,Iv..^:!ik*\: v: .
     4.4.5  What is the level of exposure
     to volatile organic compounds?
   In addition to the health effects attributed to VOCs themselves,
   VOCs are also chemical compounds that contribute significantly to
   the formation of ground-level ozone (smog) when released to the air.
   Exposure to ground-level ozone can damage lung tissue and cause
   serious respiratory illness. (For additional information on VOCs in
   the environment, see Chapter 1, Cleaner Air.)
                Blood VOC levels - Category
    Biomonitoring data for volatile compounds are difficult to obtain
    because these compounds do not persist for very long in the
    body. For this reason, biomonitoring data are indicative of recent
    exposure only. Only relatively older sources of data, NHEXAS and
    NHANES III, are available for the body burden of VOCs.

    What the Data  Show

    NHEXAS-Region 5. Blood levels of four VOCs were obtained for
    participants in NHEXAS-Region 5. The four compounds were
    benzene, chloroform, tetrachloroethylene (PERC), and
    trichloroethylene (TCE). The mean level of benzene measured in
    blood was 0.07 ug/L The mean level of chloroform was 0.07 ij/L.
    The mean level of PERC was 0.21 jjg/L The mean level of TCE
    was below the limit of detection (Clayton, et al.,  1999).
  NHANES III (1988-1994). Blood samples were analyzed for the
  presence of VOCs during NHANES III. NHANES III was conducted
  on a nationwide probability sample of approximately 33,994
  persons aged 2 months or older. Of these, an exposure
  questionnaire was administered and blood samples analyzed for
  VOCs in a convenience sample of 1,018 adult participants aged
  20 to 59 years. Toluene, styrene, and benzene were present in the
  blood of more than 75 percent of the participants. Analysis of
  this and other data collected during NHANES III shows a strong
  association between lifetime cigarette smoking and toluene,
  benzene, and styrene levels (Churchill and Kaye, 2001).

  Data Source

 NHANES III (1988-1994), National Center for Health Statistics.
 (See Appendix B, page B-34, for more information.)
   4.4.6  What is the level of
   exposure to  pesticides?
Organophosphate pesticides account for about half of the insecti-
cides used in the U.S. Organophosphate pesticides are active against
a broad spectrum of insects and are used on food crops as weir as in
residential and commercial buildings and on ornamental plants and
lawns. Exposure to these pesticides occurs primarily from ingestion
of food products or from residential use (CDC, 2001 c).
The mechanism of toxicity of the Organophosphate pesticides is to
inhibit the enzyme that breaks down acetylcholine, which transfers
nerve impulses between nerve cells or from a nerve cell to other
types of cells, such as muscle cells. This leads to a buildup of
acetylcholine, which overstimulates muscles, causing symptoms such
as weakness and paralysis (CDC, 2001 c). (For additional information
on pesticides in the environment, see Chapter 1, Cleaner Air;
Chapter 2, Purer Water; and Chapter 3, Better Protected Land.)
Cnapter 4 - Human Health        4.4 Measuring Exposure to Environmental Pollution: Indicators and Trends
                                                    4-5 T

-------

EPAs Draft feport on the Environmen
                                                                      ecnnica
1  Document
                                                                          ~3K.
         Urine organopnospnate levels to indicate pesticides -

                                                                            -?te9ory '
   Pesticides biomonitoring data are obtained by measuring the
   chemicals that pesticides are broken down into in the body.
   Measurement of these pesticide metabolites reflects exposure to
   pesticides that has occurred predominantly in the last few days
   (CDC 2001 c). The reason is that these metabolites persist within
   the body for only a short time.

    Presently, national biomonitoring data are available primarily for
    organophosphate pesticides. Future studies may provide
    additional indicators for non-organophosphate pesticides, such as
    carbamates and persistent pesticides.

    What the Data Show

    NHANES 1999-2000. Urine levels of organophosphate
    pesticide metabolites were measured in a subsample of NHANES
    participants 6 through 59 years of age who were selected to be:
    representative of the U.S. population. Finding a measurable
    amount of one or more metabolites in urine does not mean that
    the level of the organophosphate causes an adverse health
                                                           effect. Whether organophosphate pesticides at the levels of
                                                           metabolites reported during NHANES 1J999-2000 are a cause
                                                           for health concern is not known (CDC, |2001 c). Exhibit 4-37
                                                           shows the amount of each metabolite it) urine reported in
                                                           NHANES 1999-2000.             ;  !'                      '.
                                                                                            I  !                       :
                                                           NHEXAS-MD. Urine levels of metabolites of some common
                                                           pesticides v/ere measured during NHEXA'S-MD. 1 -naphthol
                                                           (1 NAP) is «i urinary metabolite of both jarbaryl and naphthalene.
                                                           The mean urine level of 1 NAP measured' for 338 participants was
                                                           33.7 Lig/L 3,5,6-trichloro-2-pyridinol (JTCPY) is the major
                                                           metabolite  in urine of the pesticides chiprpyrifos, chlorpyrifos-
                                                           methyl, and triclopyr. The mean urine lejrel of TCPY measured for
                                                           346 participants was 6.8 Ljg/L Malathi0n dicarboxylic acid
                                                            (MDA)  is a principal metabolite of malajhion, an organophosphate
                                                            pesticide used against insects. The meap urine level for MDA
                                                            measured during NHEXAS-MD was below the level of detection.
                                                            Atrazine mercapturate (AM) is a urinary! metabolite of atrazine, a  :
                                                            widely used herbicide in the U.S. The mean urine level for AM
                                                            measured during NHEXAS-MD was below the level of detection
                                                                                            ;  (Macintosh, et al., 1999).
I	Ill	 l|l||lllll(	illli	   i^    •  ' 	I 	II	Ill	Ill	Illlllll HI IPIII pita 1    Hill'  ]J tJlt ^fM «a"pwp™ IT- "n^rr-™™-""
     E 14-37: Geometnc mean and selectecTpercenbles of selected pestiade metabolS urine concentetions
      "' ' ' j creahnine-adjusted levels for tke United States population aged 6-59 ysfe, National
               	and Nutrition Examination Survey (NHANES). 1999-jgOO
                                                                                                    (Data Source

                                                                                                    NHANES 1999-2000,
                                                                                                    Rational Center for Health
                                                                                                    Statistics. (See Appendix 6,
                                                                                                    page B-35, for more
                                                                                                    information.)
        Dimtlhjtphosphate
          pg/L of urine
          pg/goftreatMne"
        Olmcthylthiophosphale
          (ig/1. of urine
          ug/gofc«atln![»%
          |)£/l of urine
          ps/goferealinine*
        Dtethylphosplttte
          pg/L of urine
          Hg/gofcreatinine'
         Dicthylthiophosplute
          gg/L of urine
          pj/goferealinir.c"
    4-52
           4.4  Measuring Exposure to Environmental Pollution: Indicators and Trends        Copter 4 - Human Health

-------
                                       ^                                                                           2003
   4.4.7  What  is the  level of exposure
   to persistent  organic pollutants?
 Persistent organic pollutants (POPs) are manmade organic chemicals
 that remain in the environment for long periods of time. Some POPs
 are toxic; others are not. Toxic POPs are of a special concern
 because they often remain toxic for decades orlonger. The more
 persistent a toxic chemical is, the greater the probability for human
 exposure over time.

 POPs have been linked to adverse health effects such as cancer,
 nervous system damage, reproductive disorders, and disruption of
 the immune system in both human and  animals. POPs released in one
 part of the world can travel to regions far from their place of origin,
 because they circulate globally long after their release into the
 atmosphere, oceans, and other pathways (EPA, 2001 b).

 Under the United Nations Environment Program, the international
 community has identified  12 chemicals as primary POPs. These
 chemicals include certain insecticides such as dichlorodiphenyl-
 trichloroethane (DDT) and chlordane, which were once  commonly
 used to control pests, and polychlorinated biphenyls (PCBs), which
 were used in hundreds of commercial applications for electrical,
 heat transfer, and hydraulic equipment, and in plasticizers in paints,
 plastics, and rubber products.

 The 12 chemicals targeted by EPA as POPs are the pesticides aldrin,
 chlordane, DDT, mirex, toxaphene, dieldrin, endrin, and heptachlor;
 hexachlorobenzene, an industrial chemical; PCBs; polychlorinated
 dibenzo-p-dioxins (dioxins); and polychlorinated dibenzo-p-furans
 (furans) (EPA, 2001 b).

 The following discussion of human exposure to POPs is derived from
 the Second National Report on Human Exposure to Environmental
 Chemicals, published in.January 2003 by the CDC National Center
 for Environmental Health (CDC, 2003). Four of the 12 POPs are not
 addressed by the CDC report and are therefore not addressed
 specifically in this chapter. These four chemicals are aldrin,
 toxaphene, dieldrin, and endrin. The remaining POPs were not
 evaluated for indicators at this time but  EPA anticipates that these
 chemicals will become indicators in the future.
Cnlordane and Heptacnlor
In 1988, EPA banned the use and production of chlordane in the
U.S.  Chlordane is an organochlorine pesticide that was applied in
and around buildings to eliminate termites and was also used as an
agricultural and lawn pesticide. The technical grade of chlordane
consists of a group of related chemicals, including heptachlor,
c/s-chlordane,  trans-chlordane, and trans-nonachlor. Note that
heptachlor was also used individually as a pesticide separate from
chlordane. However, pesticide applications were mostly made with
 technical grade chlordane and therefore chlordane is the main form
 of heptachlor exposure.

 Within the body, chlordane is metabolized to oxychlordane and
 heptachlor is metabolized to heptachlor epoxide. Human exposure to
 chlordane and heptachlor is determined by measuring the blood
 serum concentrations of oxychlordane, trans-nonachlor, and
 heptachlor epoxide. However, generally recognized guidelines for
 serum levels of these metabolites have not been established.

 The NHANES 1999-2000 mean levels of oxychlordane and
 heptachlor epoxide in the overall population were below the lipid-
 adjusted level of detection, which averaged 7.4 ng/g of lipid. The
 NHANES II (1976-1980)  9Sth percentile level was about twice the
 NHANES 1999-2000 level for oxychlordane and trans-nonachlor.

 DDT      .

 DDT was initially used by the military during the 1940s to control
 mosquitoes that carried vector-borne diseases such as malaria. EPA
 banned the use of DDT in the U.S. in 1973. DDT, however,  is still
 produced and used in other countries.

 For the general population, food is the most common pathway of
 exposure. Diets that involve large amounts of Great Lakes fish will
 increase an individual's exposure to DDT. Food intake of DDT has
 decreased since the 1950s; however, food imported to the U.S. may
 have DDT contamination,  especially food imported from tropical
 regions where DDT is used in the greatest quantities.

 Dichlorodiphenyldichloroethylene (DDE) (more persistent than
 DDT) is a major DDT metabolite that can be produced in people
 or in the environment. DDT in the human body reflects either a
 relatively recent exposure  or a cumulative past exposure over time.
 A high DDT-to-DDE ratio may indicate a recent exposure, and a low
 DDT-to-DDE ratio may indicate an exposure in the more distant past.

 The NHANES 1999-2000 95th percentile levels (lipid-adjusted
 serum) for DDT and DDE in the overall population range from 5-fold
 to 15-fold lower than levels detected in a non-random subsample of
 NHANES II (1976-1980). These decreases in the U.S. levels are
 consistent with the decreased use and manufacture of these chemi-
 cals. Also, within NHANES  1999-2000, the group aged 12 to 19
years had DDE levels 2-fold lower than the group 20 years and older.

Hexacnlorobenzene (HCfi)

Hexachlorobenzene is a persistent, bioaccumulative, and toxic pollu-
tant (EPA, 2003b). It was commonly used as a pesticide until 1965,
as a fungicide to protect wheat seeds, and for a variety of industrial
purposes, including rubber, aluminum, and dye production and wood
preservation (EPA, 2003c). In 1984, EPA canceled its registered use.
There currently are no  commercial uses of HCB in the U.S. (EPA,
Chapter 4 - Human Health       4.4 Measuring Exposure to Environmental Pollution: Indicators and Trends
                                                       4-53

-------
EPAs Draft Report on the Envirdnment J003 • flechnicai DocurnHt
 2003c); however, HCB is still formed as a by-product during the     ,
 manufacture of other chemicals (mainly solvents) and pesticides.

 Human exposure to HCB can occur through work in or proximity to
 chemical manufacturing sites where it is formed as a by-product or
 to waste facilities where it is disposed. People also can be exposed
 by consuming foods tainted with hexachlorobenzene (EPA, 2003 c).
 EPA has set the maximum contaminant level (MCL) for
 hexachlorobenzene in drinking water at 1  part per billion. If HCB
 levels exceed this level, the water supplier must notify the public
 (EPA, 2002g).

 HCB has been found to potentially cause skin lesions and nerve and :
 liver damage when people are exposed at levels above the MCL for
 relatively short periods (EPA, 2002g). Lifetime exposure at levels
 above the MCL can damage the liver and kidneys and cause
 reproductive effects, benign tumors of endocrine glands, and cancer
 (EPA, 2002g).

 Epidemiologic studies of persons orally exposed to  HCB have not
 shown an increased cancer incidence. However, EPA has classified
 HCB as a probable human carcinogen (Group B2) based on animal  '
 studies that have reported cancer of the liver, thyroid, and kidney
 from oral HCB exposure. Very few inhalation data are available
 (EPA, 2003c).

 Generally recognized guidelines for HCB serum levels are not
 available. HCB was detected in 0.6 percent of people during the
 1999-2000 NHANES study. Rnding detectable amounts does not
 mean that those levels produce adverse health effects. HCB has a
 residence time of approximately IS years in  body fat.

 fCBs

 PCBs are chlorinated aromatic hydrocarbon chemicals that were
 once used as electrical insulating and heat exchange fluids. Within
 the U.S., peak production occurred  in the early 1970s and
 production within the U.S. was banned in 1979. Concern over these
 chemicals remains high  because they are still released into the
 environment

 Sources of exposure  for the general population include release of
 PCBs from waste sites and from fires involving transformers and
 capacitors; ingestion of foods containing PCBs due to contamination
  of animal feeds; migration from packaging materials; and
  accumulation in the fatty tissues of livestock. PCBs are found at
  higher concentrations in fatty foods. In occupational settings,
  workers can be exposed to PCBs from remediation activities at
  hazardous waste sites and from the repair of transformers,
  capacitors, and hydraulic systems (CDC, 2003a).   .              :

  The Food and Drug Administration  and the Occupational Safety and
  Health Administration have developed criteria for allowable levels of
                                                   PCBs in foods and the workplace. EPA hgs established criteria for
                                                   water and for the storage and removal of PCB-contammated wastes.

                                                   Overall, there are three categories of at least 25 different PCB    '.
                                                   compounds (termed congeners) as determined by molecular     ;
                                                   structure. Congeners are closely related ;chemical compounds. The•
                                                   three categories are coplanar PCBs, mor|o-ortho substituted PCBs,
                                                   and other PCBs. The significance of these categories is that coplanar
                                                   and mono-ortho substituted PCBs have health effects similar to
                                                   dioxins. Overall, the human health effects of PCBs include liver
                                                   disorders, elevated lipids, and gastrointestinal cancers
                                                   (CDC, 2003a).                      ;
                                                                                    I  i        •
                                                   The detection of serum PCBs can reflect either recent or past
                                                   exposures to PCBs. Those PCBs with'higher degrees of chlorination
                                                   persist in the human body from several |months to years after
                                                   exposure. In the NHANES 1999-2000 kubsample, the frequency
                                                   of detection  of the eight mono-ortho substituted PCBs ranged from
                                                   2 percent to 47 percent. Finding detectable amounts does not  |
                                                   mean that those levels result in adverse! health effects. (For     :
                                                   additional information on PCBs in the environment, see Chapter 2,
                                                   Purer Water;  Chapter 3, Better Protected Land; and Chapter 5,
                                                   Ecological Condition.)                                      :

                                                   Pol/chlorinated Dibenzo-p-Dioxins i(Dioxins) and

                                                   Polycrilorinated Dibenzo-p-rUrans (flirans)
                                                                                    ;  i                       •
                                                   Dioxins and furans are similar classes of] chlorinated aromatic
                                                   chemicals usually generated as pollutants or byproducts. They have
                                                   no commercial or natural use. Processes that result in their
                                                   generation include the incineration of Waste, the production of pulp
                                                   and paper, and the synthesis of variousjmanmade chemicals. Releases
                                                   from industrial sources have decreased ty approximately 80 percent
                                                   since the 1980s. The largest releases of dioxins and furans today are
                                                   the open burning of household and municipal trash, landfill fires,  and
                                                   agricultural and forest fires. In the environment, dioxins and furans
                                                    occur as a mixture of about 20 congen
                                                    chemical compounds).
irs (i.e., closely related
                                                    Human exposure occurs primarily through foods that are
                                                    contaminated with dioxins and furans. Food contamination occurs
                                                    due to the accumulation of these chem
                                                    high-fat foods, such as dairy products,
icals in the food chain and in
eggs, animal fate, and some
                                                    types offish. People have also been exposed through industrial
                                                    accidents, the burning of PCBs, and through the spraying of
                                                    contaminated herbicides such as Agent; Orange. Workplace
                                                    exposures are rare and generally recognized standards for external
                                                    exposure have not been established.   '.
                                                                                   i   i
                                                    Human health effects associated with dioxins and furans are wide-
                                                    ranging. Given that the exposure of the general population occurs as
                                                    exposure 1» a mixture of congeners, this effects of individual
                                                    congeners, are difficult to determine. Overall, associated dioxin and
                                                                                      I                       :
  4-54
4.4  Measuring Exposure to Environmental Pollution: Indicators and Trends       CJiapter H - Human liealfcn

-------
                                                      ii':.:ipjj>^
                                                      • l-lTM:Urart 1\ep<5rt brTtht triv!ra|tmtnt2QQ3.
   furan health effects include liver disorders, fetal injury, porphyria,
   elevated lipid levels, chloracne, hormonal changes, neurologic
   damage, and immunogic changes. The dioxin cogener termed TCDD
   is the most toxic form of dioxin and it is classified as a known human
   carcinogen.

   It is estimated that human serum lipid-based levels of overall dioxins
   and furans have decreased by 80 percent since the 1980s and the
   low NHANES 1999-2000 values support that estimation. The levels
   detected via NHANES 1999-2000 are far below those associated
   with occupational and unintentional exposures that resulted in
   human health effects.

   Further, the NHANES 1999-2000 subsample reveals that the more
  highly chlorinated dioxin and furan cogeners are the main
  contributors to the human body burden. The higher concentrations
  in human tissues of these cogeners are due to their greater presence
  in the food chain, resistance to metabolic breakdown, and greater
  solubility in body fat. Half-lives for all the dioxin and furan cogeners
  range from 3 to 19 years  and TCDD is estimated to be 7 years.
                                                    4.4.8 What are the trends in
                                                    exposure to  environmental
                                                    pollutants  for children?
                                                 Children may be affected by environmental pollutants quite
                                                 differently than adults, both because children may be more highly
                                                 exposed to pollutants and because they may be more vulnerable to
                                                 the toxic effects of pollutants. Children generally eat more food,
                                                 clrink more water, and breathe more air relative to their size than do
                                                 adults, and consequently may be exposed to relatively higher
                                                 amounts of pollutants. Also, unlike adults, children's normal activities,
                                                 such as putting their hands in their months or playing on the
                                                 ground, create greater opportunities for exposures to pollutants. In
                                                 addition, environmental pollutants may affect children
                                                 disproportionately because their organ systems are still developing
                                                 and therefore may be more susceptible (EPA, December 2000). This
                                                 section presents three environmental pollutants that represent
                                                 exposures of concern to children: lead, mercury, and cotinine.
   Indicaffir'
Blood lead level in children - Category 1
    Infants, children, and fetuses are more vulnerable to the effects of
    lead because the blood-brain barrier is not fully developed
    (Nadakavukaren, 2000). Thus, a smaller amount of lead will have
    a greater effect in children than in adults. In addition, ingested
    lead is more readily absorbed into a child's bloodstream. Children
    absorb 40 percent of ingested lead into the bloodstream, while
    adults absorb only 10 percent. Because of lead's adverse effects
    on cognitive development, CDC has defined an elevated bloojd
    lead level as equal to or greater than 10 (jg/dL for children under
    6 years of age (CDC, 2001 c).

   What  the Data  Show

   In NHANES III (1988-1994), the mean blood lead levels for chil-
   dren ages 1  to S declined from 3.6 (Jg/dL in Phase 1  (1988 to
   1991) to 2.7 ug/dL in Phase 2 (1991 to 1994). Over the same
   time interval, the percentage of children aged 1 to 5 years with
   elevated blood lead levels decreased from 8.6 percent to 4.4 per-
   cent (Pirkle, 1998). In NHANES  1999-2000, the geometric medi-
   an blood lead level for children 1  to 5 years old is 2.2 yg/dL. The
  . median blood lead level for children 6 to 11 years old is 1.5 ug/dL
   (see exhibit 4-8 in this chapter).
                                                Data Source

                                                NHANES 1999-2000, National Center for Health Statistics.
                                                (See Appendix B, page B-35, for more information.)
Chapter 4 - Human Health
                      4.4
Measuring Exposure to Environmental Pollution: Indicators and Trends        4-55

-------
EPAs Draft feport on the Environment 2Q(}3
                                                         echnica
1  Dbcumjmt
               Blood mercury level in children - Category
   Children may be more highly exposed to mercury and may be
   more vulnerable to its toxic effects. The health effects of mercury
   are diverse and can include developmental and neurological
   effects in children.

   What the Data  Show

   Extremely limited information has been available about children's
   exposure to mercury and how it relates to levels in adults. Exhibit
   4-38 shows that the geometric mean of blood mercury levels
   among U.S. children measured in NHANES 1999-2000 was 0.34
    1/g/L The geometric mean of blood mercury levels of women of
    childbearing age was  1.02 ug/L Levels among women of child-
    bearing age are particularly important because they reflect levels
                                               of mercury to which the fetus is exposed j(NRC, 2000). During a
                                               toxicological review of mercury levels, the; National Research
                                               Council estimated a benchmark dose, whjch was an estimate of a
                                               methylmercury exposure to the fetus, associated with an increase
                                               in abnormal scores on cognitive functionjtests among children.
                                               The lower 95 percent confidence bound Jon the benchmark dose
                                               was 58 ug/L (NRC, 2000). To account fit 1-38: Geometric mean and selected" percentiles of total blood mercury c

             |^^
                          Sample Size
      ChtUrcn, aged
      1-5 years, males
      and females
          70S
                          0.34
                                        
-------

 4.4.Q Pollutants for Which Biomonitoring Data
 Are Not Available                                 •  ,

 As mentioned above, biomonitoring is an emerging field. More
 biomonitoring indicators are available now than a few years ago. Still,
 there are many environmental pollutants for which biomonitoring
 techniques are not available or feasible. These include radiation, air
 pollutants (except for lead), biological pollutants, and disinfection
 by-products. Biomonitoring efforts have begun recently for disinfec-
 tion by-products; however, at this time data are not sufficient to
 develop indicators for these pollutants. All these pollutants are of
 concern because exposure is widespread. For these pollutants,
 exposure assessments currently rely primarily  on ambient data.
   What is  the leve|l of exposure  to
   radiation?
 Radiation is energy given off by atoms in the form of particles or
 electromagnetic rays. There are actually many different types of
 electromagnetic radiation that have a range of energy levels. They
 form the electromagnetic spectrum and include radio and micro
 waves, heat, light, and x-rays (EPA, 2002w).
 Radiation that has enough energy to move atoms in a molecule
 around or cause them to vibrate, but not enough to change them
 chemically, is referred to as "non-ionizing radiation." Examples of
 this kind of radiation are sound waves, visible light, and microwaves
 (EPA, 2002y). Non-ionizing radiation can be used for some common
 tasks, -such as using  microwave radiation for telecommunications and
 heating food, infrared radiation for producing warmth, and radio
 waves for broadcasting (EPA, 2002y). Non-ionizing radiation has
 relatively long wavelengths and low frequencies, in the range of 1
 million to 10 billion  Hertz (EPA, 2002y).

 Radiation that has enough energy to actually break chemical bonds
 or strip electrons away from atoms is called "ionizing radiation
 (EPA, 2002x)." Radioactive materials that decay spontaneously
 produce  ionizing radiation. Any living tissue in the human body can
 be damaged by ionizing radiation. The body attempts to repair the
 damage,  but sometimes the damage is too severe or widespread,
 or mistakes are made in the natural repair process. The most
 common forms of ionizing radiation are alpha and beta particles, or
 gamma and X-rays (EPA, 2002x). Ionizing radiation has very short
 wavelengths, and very high frequencies,  in the range of 100 billion
 billion Hertz (EPA, 2002y). This is the type of radiation that
 people usually think of as 'radiation.' Ionizing radiation can be
 used to generate electric power, to kill cancer cells, and in many
manufacturing processes (EPA, 2002y).
                         Exnifait tt-39 EPA map of ra
-------
             raft port Mi the  Envircihfcnt #$$
                                                               ecnnica


pathway occurs when people breathe radioactive materials into the
lungs. The chief concerns are radioactively contaminated dust,
smoke, or gaseous radionuclides such as radon (EPA, 2002z). Radon
is a colorless, tasteless, and odorless gas that comes from the decay
of uranium found in nearly all soils. Levels of radon vary throughout
the country. Radon usually moves upward from the ground and
migrates into homes and other buildings through cracks and other
holes in their foundations. The buildings trap radon inside, where it
accumulates and may become a health hazard if the building is not
properly ventilated (EPA, June 2000; EPA, 2002b).

No biomonitoring data are feasible for national estimates of exposure
to radon. Data for average national indoor and outdoor radon levels   ;
are available, but unlike biomonitoring data, these data do not
represent the amount of radon found in human tissue. Rather, they
are the levels of radon measured in the air. Radon levels vary
throughout the U.S. Exhibit 4-39 shows the distribution of  radon
levels throughout the country (EPA, 2003d). Based on a national
residential radon survey completed in 1991, the average indoor
radon level is 1.3 picocuries per liter in the U.S. The average outdoor
level is about 0.4 picocuries per liter (EPA, 2002b).

Radiation exposure by the ingestion pathway occurs when someone
swallows radioactive materials. For example, exposure by ingestion
can occur when drinking water becomes radioactively contaminated,
or when food is grown in contaminated soil. Alpha and beta emitting
radionuclides are of most concern for ingested radioactive materials.
They release large amounts of energy directly to tissue, causing DMA
and other cell  damage (EPA, 2002z).

The third pathway of concern is direct or external exposure from
radioactive material. The concern about exposure to different kinds
of radiation varies by the particular type of particle or wave that is
being emitted. Alpha particles cannot penetrate the outer layer of
skin, but open wounds may pose a risk. Beta particles can burn the
skin in some cases, or damage eyes. Greatest concern is about
gamma radiation. Different radionuclides emit gamma rays of different
strength, but gamma rays can travel long distances and penetrate
entirely through the body. Gamma rays can be slowed by dense
material  (shielding), such as lead, and can be stopped if the material
is thick enough. Examples of shielding are containers; protective
 clothing, such as a lead apron; and soil covering buried  radioactive
 materials (EPA, 2002z).

 Radiation can occur from man-made sources such as x-ray machines;
 or from natural sources such as the sun and outer space, and from
 some radioactive materials such as uranium in soil (CDC, 2003).
About 80 percent of human exposure to radiation is from naturally
 occurring forms of radiation. The remaining 20 percent of exposure
 is to manmade radiation sources, primarily medical x-rays (CDC,
 2003).

 Radiation doses that people receive are measured in units called
 "rem (CDC, 2003)." Most people receive about 300 mrem every
                                                   year from natural background sources of radiation, primarily radon.
                                                   Health physicists generally agree on limitihg a person's exposure   :
                                                   beyond background radiation to about 100 millirem (mrem) per year
                                                   from all sources. Exceptions are occupational, medical or accidental
                                                   exposures. (Medical X-rays generally deliver less than 10 mrem). EPA
                                                   and other regulatory agencies generally limit exposures from specific
                                                   sources to the public to levels well underllOO mrem. This is far below
                                                   the exposure levels that cause acute health effects (EPA, 2002x).
                                                    For additional information on radiationln' the environment, see
                                                    Chapter 1 , Cleaner Air.
                                                      What is the level  of <^posure to j^ir
                                                      pollutants?                 !              |
                                                    Criteria air pollutants are common air pojlutants comprised :of ozone,
                                                    nitrogen dioxide, carbon monoxide, sulfuj- dioxide, lead, and
                                                    particulate matter. The health effects associated with criteria air   ;
                                                    pollutants are discussed in Chapter 1, Cleaner Air, Section 1.1.3.
                                                    Ozone is the result of a chemical reactiori in the atmosphere between
                                                    VOCs and nitrogen oxides. Nitrogen dirajide comes from the burning
                                                    of gasoline, natural gas, coal, and oil. Cars are an important source of
                                                    nitrogen dioxide.                      1

                                                    Carbon monoxide comes from the burning of gasoline, natural gas,
                                                    coal, and oil. Carbon monoxide reduces {he ability of blood to  bring
                                                    oxygen to body cells and tissues. Carborji monoxide may be
                                                    particularly hazardous to people who have heart or circulatory
                                                    problems.                          .  |                       .

                                                    Particulate matter (PM) can be emitted directly into the atmosphere,
                                                    such as dust from roads or elemental car,bon (soot) from wood
                                                    combustion. PM can also be formed  in t(ie atmosphere from primary
                                                    gaseous emissions such as sulfur dioxide; and nitrogen oxides, which
                                                    come from power plants, industrial facilities, automobiles, and other
                                                    types of coijnbustion sources.        j  ;              '         ,

                                                    The primary source of sulfur dioxide is the burning of coal and oil, '
                                                    especially high-sulfur coal from the eastern U.S., and industrial
                                                    processes  (paper, metals). The primary source of lead in ambient air
                                                    was leaded gasoline, which has been phased out in the U.S. Other '
                                                    sources of lead include paint, smelters, And the manufacture of lead
                                                    storage batteries. Major health effects associated with lead are
                                                    discussed in Section 4.1.              j                '

                                                    Except for lead, biomonitoring methods'are not available or feasible
                                                    for the remaining criteria air pollutants.
                                                    ambient air pollutant levels are available
Data for average national
(see Chapter 1, Cleaner Air).
                                                     Research on actual intake measures of a r pollutants and their rela-
                                                     tionship to :ambient levels as measured by monitoring networks is ;
                                                     under way. Many other studies have fou id links between air
 4-S8
4.4  Measuring Exposure to Environmental Pollution: Indicators and Trends        Chapter 4 - Human Health

-------

  pollutants and disease, as noted in the discussion of diseases and
  their relationships to environmental pollutants (see Section 4.1).
    What is the level  of exposure  to
    biological pollutants?
  Biological p'ollutants are or were living organisms. In addition to
  arthropod-borne, foodborne, or waterborne disease discussed
  previously, other biological agents can promote poor indoor air
  quality and may be a major cause of days lost from work or school
  and of doctor and hospital visits. Some can even damage surfaces.
  inside and outside the residence. Some common indoor biological
  pollutants include: animal dander (minute scales from hair, feathers,
  or skin); dust mite and cockroach parts, fungi (molds); infectious
  agents (bacteria or viruses); and pollen.

  Everyone is exposed to biological pollutants. The effects on one's
  health, however, depend upon the type and amount of biological
  pollution and the individual person. Some people do not experience
  health reactions from certain biological pollutants, while others may
  experience one or more of the following reactions: allergic,
  infectious, or toxic.

  Except for the spread of infections indoors, allergic reactions may be
 the most common health problem with indoor air quality in homes.
 They are often connected with animal dander (mostly from cats and
 dogs), with 'house dust mites (microscopic animals living in
 household dust), and with pollen. Allergic reactions can range from
 mildly uncomfortable to life-threatening, as in a severe asthma attack.
 Health experts are especially concerned about people with asthma,
 who have very sensitive airways that can react to various irritants,
 making breathing difficult. Infectious diseases caused by bacteria and
 viruses, such as flu, measles, chicken pox, and tuberculosis, may be
 spread indoors. Most infectious diseases pass from person to person
 through physical contact Crowded conditions with poor air
 circulation can promote this spread. Some bacteria and viruses
 thrive in buildings and circulate through indoor ventilation systems.
 (For additional information on indoor air pollution, see Chapter 1,
 Cleaner Air.)

 As with air pollutants and radiation, biomonitoring methods are not
 available or feasible for many of the biological pollutants discussed
'in this section.
   What  is the  level of exposure to
   disinfection  by-products?
 Disinfection by-products (DBFs) are chemicals that form in drinking
 water when disinfectants are added during the drinking water
 treatment process. Disinfectants are added to drinking water to kill
 bacteria and other microbes that cause disease. DBFs are formed
 when the disinfectants react with organic matter (primarily from leaf
 and vegetation decay) that is found naturally in drinking water
 sources such as rivers and lakes (EPA, 2002c). The most  common
 drinking water disinfectant is chlorine. Other lesser-used
 disinfectants include chloramines, chlorine dioxide, ozone, and
 ultraviolet light. More than 200 million people within the U.S. drink
 disinfected water (EPA, June 2001 a).

 Hundreds of different DBPs—most of which result from chlorine-
 have been identified in drinking water, and occurrence data have
 been reasonably established for over 30 DBPs (EPA,  ORD, November
 1997). The two types of DBPs that are typically measured by
 drinking water utilities are trihalomethanes (THMs) and haloacetic '
 acids (HAs).

 DBP levels vary throughout the country because the levels are
 dependent on several factors, including amount of organic matter in
 the drinking water source, amount of rainfall in the area, season of
 the year, water temperature, type of disinfectant used, water
 treatment plant configuration, and size of trie water system
 distribution system (EPA, 1999).

 Current information on DBP exposures draws on monitoring results
 from drinking water systems. Data for average national levels of
 THMs in treated drinking water are available. Water monitoring for
 DBPs is of limited value in classifying or identifying individual
 exposures to DBPs. Individual exposures are influenced by route of
 exposure (ingestion, inhalation,  dermal absorption), individual habits
 relating to water use or consumption, time and spatial distribution of
 DBPs in the water system, and seasonal variables that affect the
 precursors to DBPs (e.g., rainfall, temperature). The complex nature
 of exposure to DBPs will require a better understanding of the chain
 of events as illustrated in Exhibit 4-1.

 4.4.10 Endocrine Disrupters	An Emerging Issue

An endocrine disruptor is defined as an exogenous agent that alters
the function of the endocrine system and consequently causes
adverse health effects in an intact organism, or its progeny or
 (sub)populations (IPCS, 2002). A number of pharmaceuticals,
pesticides, commercial chemicals and environmental contaminants
are known to disrupt the endocrine system across a wide range of
species—invertebrates, fish, birds, reptiles,  and mammals.
 Chapter 4 - Human Health        4.4 Measuring Exposure to Environmental Pollution: Indicators and Trends
                                                       4-59

-------
EMs Drcffi Rlporgfl thef :rwiB!npnt'2:a|S
 There is little information on the magnitude and pattern of human
 exposures to endocrine disrupters. The limited exposure data that
 exist are primarily for various environmental media, such as chemical
 concentrations in air, food, and water. Often these data are limited by
 geographical regions and cannot be extrapolated to national trends.
 More relevant measures of human exposure, such as chemical con-
 centrations in human blood, breast milk, and human tissue, are rare.
 Often these data are available  only for high exposure areas and pop-
 ulations. As chemicals suspected of contributing to endocrine dis-
 ruption in humans are identified, it will be necessary to obtain  high-
 quality exposure data to perform human risk assessments. Each
 major state of the science report on endocrine disrupters has
 acknowledged the critical need for research to increase our under-
 standing of human exposures and related health outcomes.          '•

 The human health issue regarding exposure to endocrine disrupters
 primarily relates to: (1) adverse effects observed in fish and  wildlife,
 (2) the increased incidence of specific endocrine-related adverse
 human health outcomes/diseases, and (3) observations of endocrine
 disruption in well-conducted experiments involving laboratory
 animals. These chemicals can affect the endocrine system in several
 ways including interfering with hormone synthesis and release  from
 the endocrine gland, competing with the hormone for the binding   \
 sites on transport proteins in the blood, binding to the receptor to   .
 either block hormone action or mimic it, and producing changes in
 hormone metabolism and elimination (IPCS, 2002).

 There are a few clear examples of adverse human health effects fol-
 lowing high exposures to environmental chemicals (e.g., accidental
 releases or poisoning incidents). Analysis of the human data by itself
 has not provided firm evidence of direct causal associations between
 low level exposure to endocrine-disrupting chemicals and adverse
 human health outcomes.

 Of particular interest is exposure during very early development,
 both in utero and postnatally.  Sexual differentiation, growth, and
 development are under hormonal control. Many of these early
 processes are unique to this time period and disruptions of
 carefully timed processes may lead to irreversible adverse human
 health outcomes. Interest has focused on: (1) adverse effects on
 reproductive and sexual development and function, (2) altered
 immune system, nervous system, and thyroid development and func-
 tion, and (3) cancers of various endocrine-sensitive tissues including
 the testes, breast, and prostate. Additional research is needed to
 determine whether linkages exist between these adverse human
 health outcomes/diseases and exposure to suspected endocrine
 disrupters. However, this research is challenging as the manifestation :
 of the condition is frequently not observed until years after exposure,
 has occurred and the measured concentration of the chemicals in
 the affected adult may be very different from in utero, neonatal, or
 pre-pubertal exposures/concentrations that may have given rise to  ,
 the adverse outcome.
                                         4.5   A
                                         Environmental  Burden
             ssessing
                                         o
fDi
isease
                                         Many factors may cause or influence djsejase in humans. These
                                         factors include heredity, social factors, dietary factors, and environ-i
                                         mental factors (e.g., chemical pollutants, infectious microorganisms,'
                                         and radiation). The extent to which enyiranmental factors influence
                                         overall  disease is not entirely understopd. Disease burden, global
                                         burden of disease, and environmental bu'den of disease are concepts
                                         used to express the burden of disease or society:

                                         || Disease burden is the effect on sociey of both disease-related
                                            mortality and disease-related morbidity (Kay, 2000; WHO, 2002).
                                            It is  assessed by several health measures, including mortality rates,
                                            morbidity rates, and the number of days in the hospital.
                                            Historically, disease burden has been i ivestigated by analyzing
                                            disease outcomes, such as cancer, rath er than analyzing risk
                                            factors trjat may cause cancer or disease in general. For example, it
                                            is easier to compare cancer incidence between two countries than
                                            to compare risk factors of cancer; iqnfcing  radiation may be the
                                            major risk factor for cancer in country A, while dioxin may be the
                                            major risk factor in country B.     j  ;

                                         || Global burden of disease (GBD) assesses the disease burden on
                                            a worldwide basis and then apportions that burden to various
                                            causes, such as genetic, behavioral, and environmental.
                                                                          I  I                ,     -  !
                                         Di Environnental burden of disease (EBD) measures that portion
                                            of the GBD which is due solely to environmental risk factors.    ,
                                          EBD provides a method for summarizmgkhe environmental health of
                                          population:;. The summary health data collected from EBD measure-
                                          ments help identify environmental risk factors with significant public
                                          health implications. EBD data can also b'e used to help prioritize
                                          funding allocations for health and environmental  research, assist in:
                                          environmental policy development, justify environmental advocacy,
                                          assess the cost-effectiveness of interventions, and monitor the
                                          progress of a population's health (Prilss, et al., 2001). More impor-
                                          tant, EBD pirovides a way to normalize risk factors, allowing cpmpara-
                                          ble health evaluations between populations. Two  approaches are
                                          commonly jsed to determine the degree of disease burden that   |
                                          stems from ^environmental risk factors: :                        ,

                                          • The outcome-based approach determines the degree to which,
                                            specific environmental risk factors caijse a disease relative to other
                                            environmental risk factors.         ,                        ;
  4-60
4.5  Assessing the Environmental Burden of Disease
                                                 :       :
                          Chapiter 4 - Human,Health

-------
 • The exposure-based approach assesses the adverse health out-
   comes resulting from dose-response relationships between risk
   factors and associated disease outcomes (Priiss, et al., 2001).


 This section summarizes estimates, in different studies, of the
 environmental burden of disease.

 World Health Organization Evaluation

 In 1998, WHO estimated that 23 percent of GBD is due to environ-
 mental hazards, including occupational exposures (WRI, et al., 1998).
 In 1999, WHO researchers and researchers from the University of
 California reported that an estimated 25 to 30 percent of the GBD
 was attributable to the environment (Smith, et al., 1999).

 In 2000, WHO introduced a new methodology for evaluating
 changes to EBD, termed comparative risk assessment (CRA). CRA
 measures the GBD due to risk factors. WHO is currently developing
 CRA guidelines to help countries and smaller population groups,
 such as villages and towns, measure their respective EBD (Kay,
 2000). CRA does not have one standard unit, however, and it
 incorporates other methodologies used to assess EBD. Because of
 this variability in assessment methodologies, comparing EBD for
 different countries can be difficult. Further, because EBD has not
 been quantified extensively in the U.S., this country's level of EBD
 cannot be easily compared with that  of the rest of the world.

 Doll and Teto Estimates

 Richard Doll and Richard Peto quantified the environmental contribu-
 tion to disease in their 1981 landmark study The Causes of Cancer:
 Quantitative Estimates of Avoidable Risks of Cancer in  the United States
 Today. In that study, they concluded that pollutants in air, water, and
 food contributed from 2 to 5 percent to cancer mortality (Doll and
 Peto, 1981). They quantified the portion of cancer deaths that were
 attributable to various environmental  causes, excluding tobacco
 smoke (Exhibit 4-40). Thirty percent of cancer was ascribed to
 tobacco use.

 Other Estimates

 Other studies of EBD have investigated specific environmental risk
 factors and disease outcomes. For example, Wynder and Gori
 concluded in  1972 that environmental factors caused  12 percent of
 all cancer cases for men and 14 percent for women in the U.S.
 (Doll and Peto, 1981).

Why EBD Estimates Differ

EBD estimates are affected by the definition of "environment" that is
used in making the determination (Smith, et al., 1999), as well as the
measurement unit used, such as reporting mortality  as a percentage
of the population. For example, some researchers include factors
                  such as stress or injury as environmental causes of disease, while
                  others include stress and injury as social causes of disease.

                  The quantity of disease burden (such as disease outcome or risk
                  factors) measured in EBD studies also produces variation in EBD
                  estimates. These differences can be attributed to the different ways
                  that risk factors are categorized, or to differences in the amount of
                  disease burden attributed to a particular source.
                                                              cancer <

                   Brer  f- •lcco-jy,2Jl£l Sly'Si!" tf"5 If^fe J"he,Ee *ts fiot a distinction between
                   l|g«T(pnmental tobacco smofee and mainstream smoke

                         P°!kRJ,ctl!s! ^Oflgsstiard Peto JJi^Cguse^of Cancer Quamtative Estimates   i
                    "f Avoidable Risks of Cancer in theJJmted States Tgday 1981,                   >
Chapter 4 - Human Health
4.5  Assessing the Environmental Burden of Disease
4-61

-------
EPAsDrift

                                                            'octirM
 4.6    Challenges  and


 Data  (naps

 This chapter described key indicators for health and exposure.
 Many exposure indicators presented were measured by biomonitor-
 ing. Where biomonitoring data are not available, ambient exposure
 measures serve to describe human exposure to key environmental
 pollutants. Areas where strong associations have been demonstrated
 between environmental exposures and health  outcomes were
 highlighted. However, in many areas those associations have not yet
 been demonstrated.

 The success of environmental decisions in improving public health
 can be measured on a variety of levels:
 M National level (e.g., U.S. Department of Health and  Human
    Services' Healthy People 2010 initiative).
 • Geographic/regional level (e.g., East Coast versus West Coast,
    CDC's state health reports).
 • Community level (e.g., air and water quality monitoring).
 • Individual level (e.g., screening programs for blood lead in
    children).

  Many indicators may be used at a number or all of these levels.
  This report has focused on describing indicators and impacts at a
  national level. Future versions of this report may utilize indicators to
  evaluate success in reducing environmental health exposure and
  outcomes at some of the other levels as well.

  Use of Health Outcome Measures to Evaluate
  Environmental Tolicy Decisions or Interventions

  Mortality data were chosen as one of the major disease indicators
  because these are collected nationwide in every state, county, and
  community. These mortality data  constitute a comprehensive data-
  base, since every death is presumed to be reported. This information
  has been collected for more than the past SO years and has been
  used to document the success of major public health programs. For
  example, treatment of drinking water through filtration or chlorina-.
  tion eliminated diarrhea diseases as a major cause of death in the
  20th century. More recently, anti-smoking campaigns aimed at men
  are believed  to be responsible for the sudden downward trend in
  deaths due to lung cancer. In fact, an analysis of  the key indicators  of
  health for the country confirm that the health of the U.S. population
  is improving. The U.S. population is living longer  (life expectancy)
  and death rates  for major causes of death (cancer, cardiovascular
  disease) are declining. Except for those rare diseases that have a
  short survival period and 100 percent death rate, death represents
                                  only a small fraction of the true number pf cases for a disease in the
                                  population (see Section 4.2).          '•                        ;

                                  Better information and insight into the health of the U.S. population
                                  can be obtained from evaluating incidence data (new cases of illness)
                                  or prevalence data  (all existing cases of illness). At this time, no com-
                                  prehensive nationwide systems for collecting incidence or prevalence
                                  data on disease are in place. The majority of morbidity data reported
                                  in this chapter are available either from national surveys that sample
                                  the U.S. and are.assumed to be representative of the nation, or from
                                  data (e.g., birth defects and cancer registries)  collected by the state-
                                  based centers around the country. The ; ctual  picture of health  may
                                  differ from that suggested by the data, i s in the case of chjldhood :
                                  asthma prevalence  that has been rising fas described in Section
                                  4.3.4). CDC has launched an initiative tj> improve the nation's health
                                  tracking system. CDC recently awarded grants to state and local
                                  health depjirtments to begin developing a national environmental
                                  health tracking network and to develop Capacity in monitoring envii
                                  ronmental health at the state and local levels ().
                                  Several emerging areas of health conce
       •n (e.g., Parkinson's disease,
                                  diabetes) and emerging areas of enviro imental exposure (e.g.,
                                  endocrine disrupters) were recognized
                                  these areaij, either the link between en
       n this chapter. In many of
       ironmental exposures and
                                  the disease has not been established or no systematic surveillance
                                  or established indicators currently eXis
                                  include many of the diseases and expo
       ;. Future reports may well .
       ;ures identified as emerging
                                  issues and may establish associated indicators. Major efforts to  ',
                                  address diabetes, asthma, and obesity also present a very       ;
                                  promising opportunity to incorporate research on the role of
                                  environmental exposures into such plaijis.

                                  Use of Exposure Measures to Evaluate Environmental Tolicy

                                  Decisions  or Interventions                         :        :

                                  Most exposure indicators described in this chapter were biomonitor-
                                  ing indicators. Ambient exposure measures were described for a
                                  number of areas where, at present, bionjionitoring data are not
                                  available (e.g., for certain air pollutants where there are no markers
                                  in blood or urine).             .    ;  .

                                  The NHANES data  provide examples where biomonitoring data have
                                  reflected a public health benefit from EI^A actions. For example, the
                                  decline in blood lead levels confirms that the removal of lead from,
                                  gasoline, water, and paint has successfu ly reduced exposures.     !
                                  Similarly, the decline in urinary cotinifie levels demonstrates that  :
                                  efforts to reduce smoking have led to public health improvements.
                                  However, interpretation of many of tHe pther exposure indicators is
                                  difficult at this time. Either not enough is known about the exposure
                                  levels in the population, or data gathering at a national level has just
                                  begun.  It will take time for a stable reference base to emerge.     .
  4-62
4.6  Challenges and Data Gaps
Chapter 4 - Human Health

-------

    Efforts to .establish a national reference base are under way through
    the work of CDC's National Center for Environmental Health, which
    is developing the National Human Exposure to Environmental
    Chemicals Report. The first report was released in 2001
    ()
    and a second one was released in January 2003 with data on 116
    chemicals (). CDC is
    committed to expanding this database, and its recent Federal Register
    notice called for nominations of chemicals to consider for inclusion
    in the third report, to be published in 2005. The report will fill a
    critical need to describe exposure. Use of the report indicators for
   explanatory or predictive functions will require an understanding of
   pathways and sources that may have contributed to the exposure
   and the exposure's relationships to health effects. With this
   additional understanding the report ultimately could be used to
   guide exposure reduction programs.

   Monitoring Environmental Health Status at trie
   Community Level

   Except for mortality data, many communities must look to their .
   own local  public health officials to monitor the health status of their
   community. This is true for a number of reasons, including:

  • Current health surveys have limited application at the community
     level and often require extrapolation from a larger population
     (state or national).

  • Current disease reporting systems, whether national sample or
    reporting systems- (e.g., National Notifiable Diseases Reporting
    System), can rarely provide an answer for a specific community.

  • Biomonitoring surveys that apply to specific communities are
    extremely rare.  For example, blood lead screening programs,  while
    common across the country, do not report in a systematic fashion
    to a centralized location for compilation and analysis of the data.


  Until such systems are developed, communities will continue to rely
  on environmental monitoring programs to tell them about their
  exposure to air or water pollution. EPA is pursuing a number of
 activities to increase the capacity of information  providers  (e.g.,
 states) and users (e.g., communities) to share information.  This'
 effort includes working closely with other federal agencies,  such as
 CDC, to build compatible systems for linking health and
 environmental data bases. One potential outcome of such
 partnerships is an opportunity to  revisit and refine current sampling
 designs such that future data collection efforts would provide better
 information for smaller units (community level) and would ensure
 better temporal and spatial congruence between environmental,
 biomonitoring, and surveillance programs.
   future Challenges

   For EPA to make better use of more direct indicators of public health
   outcomes, the science underlying the Agency's key public health  •
   functions (describe, explain, predict, evaluate) will need to be
   strengthened. EPA will continue to work on providing a better under-
   standing of the components of the source-dose-health continuum
   (Exhibit 4-1). Key among them will be establishing the necessary
   degree of predictive validity between indicators of each component
   (e.g., exposure versus dose). Such an understanding is critical to
  defining the degree to which one indicator can be successfully used
  as a surrogate for another. However, this may not be conducive to
  widespread use in surveys or may be difficult to ascertain in smaller
  populations (e.g., at a community level).

  EPA also will continue to build collaborations with CDC and other
  federal agencies responsible for collecting health surveillance and
  human exposure data. Such partnerships are  essential to any effort
  to describe the status and trends of exposure and disease in the U.S.
  with the eventual goal of every U.S.,citizen understanding what the
  status is for his or her family and community. An important initiative
  along these lines is the interagency effort to develop the National
  Children's Study, in which EPA is a collaborator. The  Children's Health
  Act of 2000 authorized the National Institutes of Child Health and
  Disease and a consortium of federal agencies "to conduct a national
  longitudinal study of environmental influences on children's health
 and development." The study will investigate the interaction of
 biologic, genetic, social, and environmental factors to better
 understand their role(s) in children's health.

 EPA will also seek to develop and evaluate methodologies for
 understanding the contribution of other risk factors to a given
 health condition in comparison to  the environmental exposure
 (i.e., partitioning out the risk attributable to the environmental
 exposure[s]  of concern). Such  measures will  assist  in prioritizing
 intervention/prevention programs and will allow the benefits and
 cost of environmental management to be placed in the context  of
 the larger public health picture.

Other issues of emerging, or emerged, concern include:

• Susceptible populations. This chapter identified children as a
  susceptible population and described indicators relating specifical-
  ly to them. EPA also recently announced an initiative to define the
  environmental risks associated with the ever-increasing aging pop-
  ulation ()
  to be undertaken in partnership with other federal agencies  and
  the many alliances for the aging. Many of the indicators in this
  report are particularly relevant to the elderly (e.g., cardiovascular
  disease, chronic obstructive pulmonary disease), and they are, or
  can be, reported by age group. As other susceptible populations   '
  are identified,  EPA will need to continue working with its federal
  partners to  see that the data are collected and analyzed to track
  those populations.
Chapter 14 - Human Health
                                                            4.6 Challenges and Data Gaps
                                                                                                                            4-63

-------

• Aggregate and cumulative risks. Individuals are not exposed to
  single chemicals, but rather to multiple pollutants and other
  stressors through multiple pathways and routes over the course of
  a day. The reality of aggregate and cumulative exposures further
  complicates attempts to attribute risk to a single  environmental
  agent EPA has begun to look at this issue, stimulated in part by
  mandates under the Food Quality Protection Act. The recently
  released Cumulative Risk Guidance report (EPA, 2003e) lays the
  groundwork for taking on this challenge and will  help target the
  research to better understand the nature and impact of such
  "composite" exposures, especially as related to targeting
  regulatory and health prevention strategies.

 Finally, the health and exposure indicators described in this chapter
 are only a portion of the story on the state of the  environment.
 These indicators should be viewed in conjunction with the other
 indicators identified in the companion chapters on ecological
 condition, land, air, and water. As presented in Exhibit 4-1, that
 integration is vital to fully developing the understanding envisioned
 by the cascade  of events from source to effects.
   4-64
4.6  Challenges and Data Gaps
                                                                                                  Chapter 4 - Human Health

-------

-------
Indicators selected and included in this chapter were assigned to one of two catego
  • Category 1 - The indicator has been peer reviewed and is supported by
    period. The supporting data are comparable across the nation and are charact
    management systems, and quality assurance procedures.
national level data cpverage for more than one time
     Sized by sound collection ^ethodologies, data
    Category 2 - The indicator has been peer reviewed, but the supporting data t
    state regions or ecoregions), or the indicator has not been measured for more
    the indicator have been measured (e.g., data has been collected for birds, but
    comparable across the areas covered, and are characterized by sound collectiqri
    qualify assurance procedures.
     re available only for part of the nation (e.g., multi-
     IJian one time period, or not all the parameters of
     iot for plants or insects). The supporting data are
       methodologies, data management systems, and

-------
 5.0  Introduction
 As described in Chapter 4, Human Health, EPA is moving in the .
 direction of measuring outcomes that reflect the actualimpacts that
 result from environmental pollution. This chapter applies that
 approach to ecosystems. Previous chapters examined impacts on air,
 water, and land—all elements of the environment that EPA seeks to
 protect. This chapter links the state of the nation's air, water, land,
 and living organisms into a broad framework termed "ecological
 condition"—the sum total of the physical, chemical, and biological
 characteristics of the environment, and of the resulting processes
 and interactions among them.1  Understanding ecological condition is
 crucial, because humans depend on ecosystems for food, fiber, flood
• control, and countless other critical "services" they provide to
 society (Daily, 1997). Many Americans also attribute deep,
 significance and important intangible benefits to ecosystems and
 their diverse flora and fauna.

 Ecological condition reflects the result of a complex array of factors,
 including natural disturbances,  invasions of new species, resource
 management, planning and zoning, and  pollution. EPA has statutory
 authority to regulate only a few of these factors, but it exerts policy
 leadership across a broad spectrum of public and private activities,
 including review of significant federal projects under the National
 Environmental Policy Act (NEPA). These efforts  reflect the EPA's
 important role as one of many  federal, tribal, state, and local govern-
 ment and private partners in protecting the nation's environment.

 This chapter asks questions about our current understanding of the
 ecological condition of:

 •  Forests:
 •  Farmlands
 •  Grasslands and shrublands
 •  Urban and suburban areas
 •  Fresh waters
 •  Coasts and oceans
 •  The entire nation2

 Exhibit 5-1 is a depiction of the events that link environmental
 changes to ecological outcomes. "Stressors," indicated by arrows, rep-
 resent factors such as insect outbreaks or pollutants affecting the
 system. These act directly on one or more of the "essential ecological
 attributes" shown in the circles  in the center of the  diagram. (These
 attributes are described in more detail below.) Each of these attributes
 can, in turn, act on and be acted on  by others. The web of arrows
 among the indicators illustrates some of the possible interactions.
 Effects on ecological attributes can be direct or indirect. This diagram
• illustrates the fact that ecological processes have important feedbacks
 on the chemical and physical structure of the environment  in which
 these changes occur. The overall changes in the attributes result in
          altered structure and function of the ecosystem, which in turn lead to
          outcomes (good or bad) about which society is concerned.

          Exhibit 5-1 shows that monitoring only stressors or monitoring
          single ecosystem attributes-such as living things-in isolation
          cannot convey a full and accurate picture of ecological condition.
          Assessments of ecological condition must incorporate measures of
          different characteristics,  potentially at different times and in differ-
          ent places within a system. EPA can build on decades of monitoring
          stressors to develop and appropriately monitor multidimensional
          and better-linked ecological condition indicators.

          This chapter presents initial work toward identifying indicators that
          can help to answer the question "What is the ecological condition
          of the U.S.?" and it can help elucidate the sequence of events
          shown in Exhibit 5-1. The chapter is organized into nine sections
          that describe:

          n The framework used in this report to identify indicators to assess
            ecological condition and outcomes (Section 5.1).
          m The ecological condition of forests (Section 5.2), farmlands
             (Section 5.3), grasslands and shrublands (Section 5.4), urban and
            suburban areas (Section 5.5), fresh waters (Section 5.6), coasts
            and oceans (Section 5.7), and the entire nation (Section 5.8).
          M The key challenges and data gaps for developing adequate
            indicators of ecological condition (Section 5.9).               ,

          Because ecological condition depends critically on the physical and
          chemical characteristics of land, air, and water, this chapter draws on
          indicators from Chapters  1 through 3 of this report, as shown  in
          Exhibit 5-2. Those chapters should be consulted for the  data
          sources for those indicators. Many of the indicators were drawn from
          The H. John Heinz 111 Center for Science, Economics, and the
          Environment (The Heinz Center) report, The State of the  Nation's
          Ecosystems: Measuring Lands, Waters, and Living Resources of the United
          States, 2002, which also  presents more detail on data sources, as
          does Appendix B of this report.

          The key data sources reflect the fact that monitoring ecological con-
          dition is a multi-organizational task. Organizations in addition to EPA
          that are responsible for collecting the data to support indicators in
          this chapter include:
          • The U.S. Department of Commerce (National Oceanic and
            Atmospheric Administration)
          •  National Aeronautics and Space Administration
          •  The U.S. Department of Agriculture (Forest Service, Agricultural
             Research Service, National Agricultural Statistics Service, and
             Natural Resource Conservation Service)
          •  The U.S. Department of Interior (U.S. Geological Survey and U.S.
             Fish and Wildlife Service)
          •  NatureServe, a private foundation
      TThe term ecosystem is used in its broadest sense as any interacting sys-
 tem of physical, chemical, and biological components and the associated
 flows of energy, material, and information (Odum, 1971).
- Chapter 5  - Ecological Condition
               2This seventh category refers to the overall condition of the complex,
           interconnected mosaic of different ecosystem types across the
           entire nation.
5.0 Introduction
5-3

-------
                                                                                    _

                                  txnioit 5-1: tcological  condition  paradigm
                   Together, the six ecological attributes constitute "ecological condition
            Stressors (shown as    ) affect ecological attributes directly and al
            (interaction)among the attributes (  | )
                       p indirectly through feedback
Programs such as the U.S. Department of Agriculture Forest
Inventory and Analysis (FIA) program and the Natural Resources
Inventory (NRI) have a long history, because they measure aspects
of the environment that are critical to multi-billion dollar industries
(e.g., timber, crops, etc.). Programs with a strictly "ecological" focus
(e.g., the USDA Forest Service Forest Health Monitoring [FHM]
Program, the U.S. Geological Survey  National Water Quality
Assessment Program [NAWQA], the  multi-agency Multi-Resolution
Land Characterization Consortium [MRLC], and EPA's Environmental
Monitoring and Assessment Program [EMAP]) are newer on the
          scene, and most have produced only Category 2 indicators as this
          report goes to press.        '           !
          Like Chapter 4, Human Health, this chapter is not intended to be   ;
          exhaustive. Rather, it provides a snapshot,|at the national level, of   [
          current U.S. ecological condition indicatorjs and status based on key :
          data sources with sufficiently robust desigri, quality assurance, and
          maturity.        ,                    ',                         i
5-4
5.0 Introduction
C-napter 5 -' Zoological Condition

-------
                    Exhibit 5-2: Ecological C-ondition - Questions and Indicators



                                                   Forests
- " • -.-v-. " -;•;• i;--';: ••-..-: '••-:•" .'!;•- i:/.. -.-•','-•-: !'~'.!>; ' :',.;-'. ':£;•" .. '..-' '.: '•• '.;• ;•'-. -•-".'-" •:-.-. ..-.'••- - •!-•!" -' -' :. .'"' M '.. .•".'••,':.' .: V":" -" '.. |.| : •'- *-'•'•:' - ". :' --•--•. ' •- •'-•• -'•:. '- • :'.'•' ' • •"• •'• '•' •'•'. ••'•'.".'• .-.'''- '* ••;':"<- ; : •'•'••• ;---•-••- >~'<..:- . . ;.*"• •-.• •.••'•.;::•'
. ;,;o;!^;4^y^
What is the ecological condition of forests?
Extent of forest area, ownership, and management
Nitrate in farmland, forested, and urban streams and ground water
Deposition: wet sulfate and wet nitrogen
Changing stream flows
Extent of area by forest type
Forest age class
Forest pattern and fragmentation
At-risk native forest species
Populations of representative forest species
Forest disturbance: fire, insects, and disease
Tree condition
Ozone injury to trees
Carbon storage
Soil compaction
Soil erosion
Processes beyond the range of historic variation
7
2
2
7
1
2
2
2
2
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
5.7.4
2.2.4 Ji
1.2.2 '
2.2.4.a
5.2
5.2
5.2
5.2
5.2
5.2
5.2
5.2
5.2
5.2
5.2
5.2
                                                          L,



                                                  Farmlands


What is the ecological condition of farmlands?"
Extent of agricultural land uses
The farmland landscape
Nitrate in farmland, forested, and urban streams and ground water
Phosphorus in farmland, forested and urban streams
Pesticides in farmland streams and ground water
Potential pesticide runoff from farm fields
Sediment runoff potential from croplands and pasturelands
Pesticide leaching potential
Soil quality index
Soil erosion

7
7
2
2
2 -
2
2
2
2
2
3.7.2
3.7.2
2.2.4.fc
2.2.4.b
2.2.4.C
3.2.4 ..
3.7.6
5.3
5.3
5.3
                                           Grasslands ana SnruDlancIs
                                                         1
. - ••:-.•,•".••,• --:•«!-/•- ..-.. •: |2uestiorY .•: ssiipaEaassssi^BBSE^ indicator KtemS™JHSfpaMW^
What is the ecological condition of grasslands
and shrublands?
Extent of grasslands and shrublands
Number/duration of dry stream flow periods in grasslands and shrublands
At-risk native grassland and shrubland species
Population trends of invasive and native non-invasive bird species
7
2
2
1
3.7.3
2.2.4.0
5.4
5.4
      : Italicized indicators are presented in other chapters.
CJiapter 5 - ecological C-ondition
5.0 Introduction
5-5

-------
(T 51" ' l ' fri |
Uroan and Suburban Lands . ,
;;"- ™ 	 ; 	 "~f: 	 jQj^g^:;:;:3L:»
£
f
What is the ecological condition of urban ^
and suburban areas? f
(.
f
xtent of urban and suburban lands
tnbient concentrations of ozone: 8-hour and 7 -hour '
'titrate in farmland, forested and urban streams, and ground water '•
hosphorus in farmland, forested, and urban streams
'hemical contamination in Urban streams and ground water
atches of forest, grassland, shrubland, and wetland in urban/suburban areas
\ t ^ f
fS ' I
t> / t
Fresn Waters :" \ "
i

1 1 3.7.7
2
2
j_2
j 2
2
7.J.7.b
2.2.4.b
2.2.4.b
2.2.4.C
5.5
h
1
. T" ,, ~: i&kfon 	 ::=i: 	 pip 	 ' 	 ; 	 i 	 f 	 i 	 	 	 :: 	 :: 	 : 	 : 	 41: 	 ^^^^^[l^^^'^^^^^^^j^^^^l^^i^^^
What is the ecological condition of fresh waters?
Wetland extent and change ' :|: ' 1 2-2'2 1
Altered fresh water ecosystems
Contaminants in fresh water fish ; !
Phosphorus in large rivers ; :
Lake Trophic State Index
Chemical contamination in streams and ground water !
Acid sensitivity in takes and streams
Changing stream flows • ; " •
Sedimentation index .
Extent of ponds, lakes, and reservoirs ;
At-risk native fresh water species :
Non-native fresh water species '
Animal deaths and deformities <
At-risk fresh water plant communities ; •>
Fish Index of Biotic Integrity in streams
Macroinvertebrate Biotic Integrity Index for streams
C-oasts and Oceans "h ; \ i

What is the ecological condition of coasts
and oceans?
Chlorophyll concentration's
Water clarify in coastal waters "' [
Total nitrogen in coastal waters
Total phosphorus in coastal waters
Dissolved oxygen in coastal waters . J
Total organic carbon in sediments
Sediment contamination of coastal waters
Sediment toxicity in estuaries '
Extent of estuaries and coastline ! . . ;
Coastal living habitats ; • '
Shoreline types
Benthic Community Index i ;
Rsh diversity !
Submerged aquatic vegetation '
Rsh abnormalities :
Unusual marine mortalities
iote: Italicized indicators are presented in other chapters.
E ^
! 2
: 2
i 2
i 2
'2
\ 2
\ 1
• 2
1
j 2
2
2
2
2
2
2.2.1
2.5.1
2.2.4.b
2.2.7
2.2.4.C
2.2.4.C
2.2.4.a
2.2.4.0
5.6
5.6
5.6
5.6
5.6 .
5.6
5.6


2
2
i 2
! 2,
! 2
2
' . "2
2
i . 1
1 2
2
i 2
2
2
2
2

2.2.3
2.2.3
2.2.4.fc
2.2.4.fc
2.2.3
2.2.3 :
2.2.4.C
2.2.4.C
. 5.7
5.7
5.7
5.7
5.7 .
5.7
5.7
5.7
f
» i
T * - A- ^ i L
5-6
5.0 Introduction
Chapter 5 -
Zoological
C-onditi'
                                                          on

-------
                                                    Tne Entire Nation
•\- ;-,^-:< j'^^/'-S:^
What is the ecological condition of the
entire nation?
	
Ecosystem extent
At-risk native species
Bird Community Index
Terrestrial Plant Growth Index
Movement of nitrogen
Chemical contamination
2
2
2
T
•\
2
5.8
5.8
5.8
5.8
5.8
5.8
|f Npte: Italicized indicators are presented in other chapters.



 5.1   Links Between  jtressors


 and  Ecological  Outcome:


A framework for AAeasuring


tcological Condition

The primary reasons to monitor ecological condition are similar to
those for monitoring air, water, and land;
• To establish baselines against which to assess the current and
  future condition.
• To provide a warning that action may be required.
• To track the outcomes of policies and programs, and adapt them
  as necessary.

Measuring ecological condition is not as straightforward as monitoring
water or air to determine whether temperatures or concentrations of
pollutants exceed a legal standard, however. Ecosystems are dynamic
assemblages, of organisms that have more or less continuously adapted
to a variety of natural stresses over shorter (e.g., fire, windstorms) and
longer (climate variations) periods of time, taking on new and different
characteristics. This makes determination of the condition of a "natu-
ral"  system difficult (Ehrenfeld,  1992). In addition, people  have altered
natural ecosystems to increase  their productivity of food, timber, fish,
and game, and to provide the infrastructure needed to support a mod-
ern  society. How should the ecological condition of these  altered
ecosystems be measured, and against what reference points? Several
recent reports by experts in the field have provided advice to guide
current and future efforts.

The National Research Council (NRC) report, Ecological Indicators for
the Nation (NRC, 2000), provides an introduction to recent national
 efforts to measure ecological condition and a thoughtful discussion
 of the rationale for choosing indicators. EPA's Science Advisory
 Board (SAB) also proposed a Framework for Assessing and Reporting
 on Ecological Condition (EPA, SAB, 2002). The framework identifies
 six "essential ecological attributes" (EEAs) of ecosystems:
 81 Landscape condition '
 • Biotic condition
 m Chemical and physical characteristics
 si Ecological processes
 Bl Hydrology and geomorphology
 Bl Natural disturbance regimes

 The EEAs, along with reporting categories and examples of
 associated indicators, are displayed in Exhibit 5-3. Neither report
 identifies specific methodologies, network designs, or actual datasets
 corresponding to the examples.

 The H. John Heinz III Center for Science, Economics, and the
 Environment (The Heinz Center) led a nationwide effort by
 government, academia, and the private sector to develop a report
 entitled Jhe State of the Nation's Ecosystems: Measuring Lands, Waters,
 and Living Resources of the United States (The Heinz Center, 2002).
 According to the introduction, the report "provides a prescription
 for 'taking the pulse' of the lands and waters. It identifies what
 should be measured, counted, and reported, so that decision-makers
 and the public can understand the changes that are occurring in the
 American landscape." The Heinz Center report identified 103
 specific indicators, of which 33 were judged by the authors to have
 adequate data for national reporting.

 The Heinz Center report provides an  important core of indicators for
 this chapter. The Heinz Center report uses a somewhat different cat-
 egorization of indicators than the Category 1 and 2 designations,
 and indicators identified by The  Heinz Center that have inadequate
 data or need further development have not been included here. The
 Heinz  Center indicators in this chapter are organized around the SAB
framework, but given the similarities among the NRC, SAB, and Heinz
 Center approaches, this choice does not affect the final result. This
chapter also includes, in addition to The Heinz Center national indica-
tors, some Category 2 indicators from regional monitoring studies that
Chapter 5 - Ecological  Condition         5.1  Links Between Stressors and Ecological Outcome
                                                      5-7

-------
                                   Exhibit 5-3: Essential ecological attributes ar
     Landscape Condition	]
     • Extent of Ecological System/Habitat Types
     • Landscape Composition
     • Landscape Pattern and Structure
     Biotic Condition
                                                                                                                          '    '        :'
      I Ecosystems and Communities
       - Community Extent
       - Community Composition
       - Trophic Structure
       - Community Dynamics
       - Physical Structure
      [ Species and Populations
       - Population Size
       - Genetic Diversity
       - Population Structure
       - Population Dynamics
       - Habitat Suitability
      | Organism Condition
       • Physiological Status
       - Symptoms of Disease or Trauma
     ^Chemical and Physical Characteristics
     Jigger;'TCfc Soil, and Sediment) ^' _^
      • Nutrient Concentrations
        - Nitrogen
        - Phosphorous
        - Other Nutrients
      • Trace Inorganic and Organic Chemicals
        - Metals
        - Other Trace Elements
        - Organic Compounds
      • Other Chemical Parameters
        -pH
        - Dissolved Oxygen
        - Salinity
        - Organic Matter                   ;
        - Other
      • Physical Parameters  ;
reporting categories
          rrfljp^/Ceornorpjjojogy_
       I Energy Flow
        - Primary Production
        - Net Ecosystem Production
        - Growth Efficiency
       | Material Flow
        - Organic Carbon Cycling
        - N and P Cycling
        - Other Nutrient Cycling
         Surface and Ground Water Flows
         - Pattern of Soqrc£ Flows
         - Hydrodynamics j                 '
         - Pattern of Gro'urtd Water Flows      ;
         - Salinity Patterhs j
         - Water Storage  .                 •
         Dynamic Structural Characteristics
         - Channel/Shoreline Morphology, Complexity
         - Extent/Distribution of Connected Floodplain
         - Aquatic Physical Habitat Complexity •
         Sediment and Material Transport
         - Sediment Supply/Movement
         - Particle Size Distribution Patterns
         - Other Material Fjlux
         itural Distu
        I Frequency
        | Intensity
        | Extent
        I Duration
    Source: EPA, Science Advisory Board. A Framework for Assessing and Reporting on Ecological Condition. June 2002.
show promise for implementation on a national scale. Regardless of
whether the indicators are Category 1 or 2, all indicators were drawn
directly from scientifically defensible studies published in peer-
reviewed reports and journals.                                      ',

One of the most critical data quality objectives of monitoring for EPA
is representativeness, the degree to which monitoring data accurately   ;
and precisely represent the variations of a characteristic over an entire
population (e.g., all streams or forests)3. Sampling design4 approaches
the problem of representativeness and the effects of sampling and
measurement error on environmental management policies and deci-
sions. Sampling designs fall into two main categories, probability designs
and judgmental designs.  Probability designs apply sampling theory, so
that any sampling unit (e.g., a stream of a stand of trees in a forest)
has a known probability of selection. This important attribute allows
the characteristics of the entire population  of streams or forest stands
to be estimated with known uncertainty, ensures that the results are
reproducible within that uncertainty, and enables one to calculate the
probability of decision-error based on the uncertainty in the data.
Probability designs do  not provide information on the precise condi-
tions at any location where measurements are not made, or of the
                              populations during times when measurements are not made,5 or of
                              populations not included in the sampling jdesign.     '      i        :

                              Judgmental (designs rely on expert knowledge or judgment: to select  ,
                              sampling units. They can be easier and jess expensive to implement
                              than probability sampling. Monitoring sites selected at random can be
                              difficult or even impossible to access, ahd'some monitoring programs1
                              require sites that are easy to access repeatedly, or remote sites from
                              which to search for faint signals such as climate change or long-range
                              transport of pollutants. The accuracy of the  results of judgment
                              designs depends on the quality of the professional judgment,  but in
                              the best of cases quantitative estimates or uncertainty cannot be
                              made. In this report, Category 1 indicators were  required to be based
                              on indicators collected using probability c esigns  or "wall-to-wall"
                              coverage by remote sensing, unless a stro ig case could be made that
                              the data were representative of the popul ation being sampled.

                              This chapter follows The Heinz Center (2CJ02)  in reporting on six major
                              ecosystem types.6 With a few exceptions,  Environmental and natural
                              resource monitoring programs currently! are structured to track the   .
                              condition of individual natural resources! (ig., trees, crops, soil, water, or
                              air) represented by the first six ecosystem [types. Though some of this
     Hike the U.S. Census, which strives to collect data on every person in
the U.S., an ecological census could attempt to collect data on every plant,
animal, stream, etc. This is generally impossible or cost-prohibitive, except for:
data collected on land cover or other features of the environment that can be
measured by satellite.
                                   4Olsen, et al., 1999, and Yoccoz, et aj., £0.01, provide useful .discus- :
                               sions of sampling oriented toward ecological hionitoring.

                                   5For example, if estuaries are sampled ojnly in the fall, the sample reveals
                               nothing about estuaries in the spring or winter.
 5-8
15.1 Links Between Stressors and Ecological Outcome
                           L-napter 3 - tcology

-------


monitoring takes place on a national level, it still focuses on discrete
resources or ecosystem types. For this reason, most available indicators
can help answer questions about the condition of individual ecosystem
types, but cannot track the overall ecological condition of an area
comprising different interconnected and interacting ecosystem types.
Therefore, this chapter includes a seventh category representing
indicators potentially suitable for the entire nation.

A few indicators are available to help provide a more holistic assess-
ment of ecological condition at the national level. For example, large or
migratory organisms (e.g., bears or neotropical birds, respectively)
depend on many ecosystem types  over large areas for their continued
survival. As another example, all of the terrestrial ecosystems types
may contribute nitrogen, carbon, or sediment to streams and rivers in
watersheds. Even the arrangement of ecosystems in the landscape and
the composition of patterns of land cover and land use have  been
identified as critical components in the way ecosystems function
(Forman and Godron, 1986;  Naiman and Turner, 2000; Winter, 2001;
EPA, SAB, 2002). Section 5.8 corresponds approximately to the core
national indicators in The Heinz Center report

Ideally, the indicators in this chapter would be presented in a way
that spoke to the success of our efforts to protect and restore the
ecological condition of the types  of ecosystems considered in this
chapter. Trends in biotic condition and ecological functions and in
the physical, chemical, hydrological, landscape, and disturbance
regimes of each ecosystem would provide keys to stories involving
acid rain, or landscape fragmentation, or changing climate.  The
resulting "stories" would establish baselines, provide warnings, and
track the effectiveness of management actions by EPA and  its part-
ners, as envisioned by the NRC (2000). Because so few  reliable data
exist on trends for any indicators  at the national level, however, such
a presentation is not yet possible. Instead, the chapter presents a
disturbingly fragmentary picture of what little is known reliably and
nationally based on Category 1 indicators. It also anticipates what
could reasonably be known  if monitoring of Category 2 indicators
were to be  expanded.

Sections 5.2 through 5.8 below describe the ecological  condition  of
the seven ecosystem types. Each  section begins with an introduction
that summarizes data on the indicators that appear in  the previous
chapters of this report on air, Water, and land. Indicators  presented
for the first time then are described in detail.  Each section ends with
a summary of what the available indicators, taken together, reveal
about the ecological condition of that ecosystem type.
5.2  What is  the  tcologica
Condition of Forests \
Forests, as defined by the U.S. Department of Agriculture. (USDA)
Forest Service (FS), are any lands that are at least 10 percent cov-
ered by trees of any size and at least 1 acre in extent (Smith, et al.,
2001). Some forested ecosystems are rich sources of biodiversity
and recreational opportunities, while others are managed intensive-
ly for timber production. All are important for carbon storage,
hydrologic buffering, and fish and wildlife  habitat. Forested ecosys-
tems are under  pressure in the  U.S. from a number of non-native
insects and pathogens and from deviations from natural fire regimes .
(The Heinz Center, 2002). They also are becoming increasingly
fragmented by urbanization and other human activities (Noss and
Cooperrider, 1994).

Under its statutory programs, EPA has particularly focused on the
effects of air pollution on forest ecosystems, including the effects
of acid rain on forests and forest streams. Such impacts might
affect not only  the health and  productivity of trees, but also
biodiversity in forest ecosystems (Barker  and Tingey, 1992). Under
the Clean Air Act, EPA must promulgate secondary standards for
criteria air pollutants that present unreasonable risks to plants,
animals, and visibility. EPA also has statutory authority to control
the effects of forest management practices on  aquatic communi-
ties; safe use of herbicides  and pesticides in forest systems; and
significant federal activities in forested  ecosystems subject to EPA's
review under NEPA.

Forests are possibly the best monitored  of the six ecosystem types
in this report. The Forest Service has long monitored standing tim-
ber volume and production, as well as damage from fire  and pests, in
its Forest Inventory and Analysis (FIA) program (Smith, et al., 2001).
This program relies on probability sampling to ensure that the
results are statistically representative, and  there is complete long-
term national coverage. This results in two Category 1 indicators
relating to forest extent and one to biotic  condition. In the early
1990s, the Forest Service in collaboration  with EPA's Environmental
Monitoring and Assessment Program (EMAP) developed the Forest
Health Monitoring (FHM) program to monitor additional indicators
of the ecological condition of forests (see Stolte, etal., 2002), also
using a probability design. Over the course of the 1990s, forests in
a growing number of states  were sampled in the FHM program, and
many of the FHM indicators were merged into the FIA program in
1999. Although data on these indicators are now being collected  in
47 states, with  all 50 expected to be covered by 2005, at the time
this report was  being prepared, coverage was not yet sufficiently
complete for these to reach Category 1  status.
     6The concept of an ecosystem, while extremely useful and relevant, is a
 somewhat vague classification for purposes of environmental monitoring. See
O'Neill, et al. (1986); Turner (1989); Suter (1993), pp. 275-308; and Knight
and Landres (1998) for highly relevant discussions.
 Chapter 5 - tcological C-ondition          5.2 What is the Ecological Condition of Forests?
                                                           5-9

-------
EfAs Draft feport ofi the  Environment 2005 • "Tetkrjiejal Doctimirtt
                    i  I         •                             ,     i •.  , i   '   "! •• ;• •         '•'••• r   :• 'H!  i
            i
           r
                   Exhibit 5-U: Forest ndicatoC
               Essential Ecological 'Attribute
                                                                                        	 i „ 	
|[f
= j Extent of Ecological System/
I Habitat Types
r
Landscape Composition
I Landscape Pattern/Structure
fe!e|icj:oiid!tion 	 _ 	 	 '
] Ecosystems and Communities
Species and Populations
Organism Condition
.Ecological Processes
i Energy Flow
Material Flow
[Chemical & Physical Characteristics
, Nutrient Concentrations
Other Chemical Parameters
Trace Organic and Inorganic Chemicals
Physical Parameters
Hydrology and Geomorphology
h 11 •"•• .««" 	 Si! 	 ' 	 i"" 	 	 	 ,11
Surface and Ground Water Flows
* Dynamic Structural Conditions
] Sediment and Material Transport
Natura ! Disturbance Regimes
I Frequency
] Extent
Duration
jr
Extent of forest area,;ownership, and rmmagement
Extent of area by forest type
Forest age class
Forest pattern and fragmentation
IE
At-risk native forest species
Populations of representative forest species
Forest disturbance: fire, insects, and disease
Tree condition
Ozone injury to trees
• ' 'W^JS

Carbon storage
IE' V.
Nitrate in farmlands, forested, and urban
streams and ground water
Wet sulfate deposition
Wet nitrogen deposition

Soil compaction
f"" 	 '•":•'.
Ifc::-, 	 : 	 :-
Changing streamflows

Soil erosion
| fit"' ~ ' " '"
- - , --„-, •:•. iM 	 ,„ 	 i.!,'
Processes beyond the range of historic variation


1
•
•





•











•






2


• ,
•

•
•
j
• :
•


•
•
• ;
• •
!
m



m
m


L 	 	 1 	 , 	 , 	 „,„.,..

USDA
USDA
USDA
USDA
; ,:!;,:,_
NatureServe
NatureServe
USDA
USDA
USDA


USDA

DOI
EPA
EPA

' USDA

! DOI

USDA

USDA



Many of the indicators monitored by the FIA and FHM (Smith, et al.,
2001) were included in the Heinz report (2002) and formed the
original core of this chapter. As this chapter was being completed,,
however, the Forest Service published its Final Draft National Report
on Sustainable Forests-2003 (USDA, FS, 2002) under the Montreal
Process. Several of the indicators contained in this 2002 report (all
Category 2) were included in this chapter to demonstrate the kinds
of data that will be available nationwide for a range of the forest
                                  EEAs as the FIA achieves data collection a id analysis on a national
                                  basis. Data for several of these indicators  [e.g., air quality, atmos-
                                  pheric deposition, and the chemistry and  biology of forest streams)
                                  are contributed by national monitoring prbgrams operated by other
                                  government amd private sector organizations.
                                  The forest indicators used in this report a
                                  grouped according to the EEAs. Some ind cators
•e displayed in Exhibit 5-4,
      relating to the EEAs
5-10
5.2 What is the Ecological Condition of Forests?         C_napter 5 - tcological C-onaition

-------

 of forest landscape condition, the chemical and physical attributes of
 forest streams, and the hydrology of forest watersheds are discussed
 in the chapters on Cleaner Air, Purer Water, and Better Protected
 Land, because they also relate to questions about those media. This
 section briefly summarizes the data for these indicators as they
 relate to the ecological condition of forests. This section then intro-
 duces additional indicators that relate to the EEAs of forest land-
 scape condition, biotic condition, ecological processes, physical con-
 dition of forest soils, and natural disturbances in forests.

 The following indicators presented in the previous chapters  relate to
 the ecological condition of forests:

 • The indicator Extent of Forest Area, Ownership, and Management
   (Chapter 3, Better Protected Land),  is important for assessing
   trends in how forests are managed and protected. Forested
   ecosystems cover some 749  million acres in the U.S., or about
   one-third of the total  land area. While approximately 25 percent
   lower than the pre-settlement acreage in the 1600s,  the total
   acreage  has held steady for the past century, although regional
   and local patterns have changed (USDA, FS, April 2001).  Since
   the 1950s, forest land has increased by 10 million acres in the
   Northeast and North  Central 'states, and decreased by 11 million
   acres in the Southeast (USDA, FS, April 2001).

   About 55 percent of all U.S. forests are in private ownership, with
   83 percent of forests in the East being privately held  (USDA,  FS,
   2002). About 9 percent of forest lands are managed  by private
   industry to produce timber. Although 503  million acres of forests
   are classified as "timberland," the rest receive less intensive man-
   agement. Harvest on public lands declined nearly 50 percent  from
   1986 to  2 billion cubic feet per year in 2001, but increased on pri-
   vate land by 1 billion cubic feet per year, to 14 billion cubic feet
   per year during the same period (USDA, FS, 2002). About 38 per-
   cent of harvesting is by clearcut, mostly in the South (USDA,  FS,
   2002). About 76 million acres of forests are "reserved" and man-
   aged as national parks or wilderness areas, an almost threefold
   increase  since 1953  (USDA, FS, 2002). Much of the protected for-
   est in the West is in stands more than 100 years old.
H  The indicator Nitrate in Farmland, Forested, and Urban Streams and
   Ground Water (Chapter 2, Purer Water) is important for tracking
   the loss of nitrate from forested watersheds, which often indicates
   the effects of acid rain or insect infestation. In  36 forested
   streams monitored by the National .Water Quality Assessment
   (NAWQA) program, almost 50 percent had concentrations of
   nitrate less than  0.1 parts per million; 75 percent had concentra-
   tion of less than 0.5 ppm; and only one had a concentration  of
   more than 1.0 ppm. By comparison,  of 107 agricultural water-
   sheds, almost half of the streams had nitrate concentrations
   greater than 2.0 ppm.

• According to the indicator Deposition-Wet Sulfate and Wet Nitrogen
   (Chapter 1,  Cleaner Air), wet sulfate deposition decreased sub-
   stantially throughout the Midwest  and Northeast between 1989-
   1991 and 1999-2001  (Chapter 1, Cleaner Air). By 2001, wet sul-
  fate deposition had decreased by more than 8 kilograms per
  hectare per year (kg/ha/yr) from 30-40 kg/ha/yr in 1990 in
  much of the Ohio River Valley and northeastern U.S. The greatest
  reductions occurred in the mid-Appalachian region. Wet nitrate
  deposition levels remained relatively unchanged in most areas dur-
  ing the same period and even increased up to 3 kg/ha in the
  Plains, eastern North Carolina, and southern California.

  Using National Atmospheric Deposition Program data, a USDA
  report on sustainable forests observed that annual wet sulfate
  deposition decreased significantly between 1994  and 2000, espe-
  cially in the North and South Resource Planning Act (RPA)
  regions, where deposition was the highest. Nitrate deposition
  rates were lowest in the Pacific and Rocky Mountain RPAs, where
  approximately 84 percent of the regions experienced deposition
  rates of less than 4.7 kg/ha/yr (4.2 pounds per acre per year).
  Only 2 percent of the sites in the eastern U.S. received less than
  that amount (USDA, FS, 2002).

I  The indicator Changing Stream Flows (Chapter 2, Purer Water)
  addresses altered stream flow and timing, which are  critical
  aspects of hydrology in forest streams. Low flows define the small-
  est area available to stream biota during the year,  and high flows
  shape the stream channel and clear silt and debris from the
  stream. Some fish depend on high flows for spawning, and the tim-
  ing of the high and low flows also can influence many ecological
  processes. Changes in  flow can be caused by dams, water with-
  drawal, and changes in land use and climate. This indicator reveals
  that 10 percent of predominantly forested watersheds showed
  decreased minimum flow rates during the period 1940 through
  2000 compared to the period  before 1940, while 25 percent had
  increased minimum flow rates (USDA, FS, 2002). Five percent of
  the watersheds had  lower maximum flow rates, and 25 percent had
  higher maximum flow rates compared to the earlier period. There
  were no obvious trends in maximum flow  rates in the decades
  since 1940, but minimum flow rates increased over the period.
  Increased flows were generally found in the East, but decreased
 flows were found in the West.

 The other 12  forest indicators in Exhibit 5-4, described on the
 following pages, appear for the first time  in this report in this
 chapter. Most of these indicators are from the Final Draft National
 Report on Sustainable Forests-2003 (USDA, FS,2002) which
 became available after The Heinz Center report went to press. All
 are Category 2 indicators because the data are not yet available
 for the entire  country.
Chapter 5 - Ecological Condition      5.2 What is the Ecological Condition of Forests?
                                                        5-11

-------


                       of area oy forest type - Category i
  Trends in the distribution of forest types ultimately control the
  different types of communities that they support. The data for
  this indicator were collected by the FIA program, which currently
  updates the assessment data every 5 years. This indicator com-
  pares current conditions to those in 1977.

  What the Data Show

  Oak-hickory forest is the most common forest type in the U.S.,
  covering 132 million acres—an increase of 18 percent since 1977
  (Exhibit 5-5). Maple-beech-birch forest covers 55 million acres and
  has increased 42 percent since 1977. Pine forest of various types
  covers 115 million acres; spruce-birch forests cover 61 million acres
  (mostly in Alaska); and Douglas fir covers 40 million acres, mostly
  in the Pacific Northwest. Mixed forests (e.g., oak-pine and oak-
  gum-cypress) cover 64 million acres, mostly in the South (USDA,
  FS, 2002).

  In the East, longleaf-slash pine and lowland hardwoods (elm-ash-
  cottonwood and oak-gum-cypress) had the largest decreases in
  acreage (12 million and 17 million acres, respectively). In the
  West, hemlock-sitka spruce, ponderosa pine, and lodgepole pine
  decreased the most (by 9 million, 8 million, and 6 million acres,
  respectively). In both  regions, "non-stocked" land, on which  trees
  have been cut but that has not yet regrown as forest, has declined
  steadily.

  Indicator Gaps and Limitations

  Limitations of this indicator include the  following:
  • Since the late 1940s, field data on species composition have
    been collected on a probability sample of 450,000 sites,
    nationwide (Smith,  et al., 2001). The resulting estimates of area
    by forest type have an uncertainty of 3 to 10 percent per
    million acres of area sampled  (The Heinz Center, 2002).
  m The  data do not include information on private lands that are
    legally reserved from harvest, such as lands held by private
    groups for conservation purposes. Other forest lands are  at
    times reserved from harvest because of administrative or other
    restrictions. Data on these lands would provide a more com-
    plete picture of U.S. forest lands.

  Data Source

  The data source for this indicator was Forest Resources of the
  United  States, 1997, Smith, et al., 2001. (See Appendix  B,
  page B-36, for more information.)
                                                            the United States, 1963-1997

                                                                              • Maple-Beech-

                                            j fej^                                    ! "" V '",
                                                                       p^^'iii^i^v^^lhortl.eafPine/- /^
                                                                          iiii»^J Other Types!' : ' 'I

                                                           '^^'^^^^^^^^^^ ^^i^:™, ^^rfekl
                                                            5	."••r^if-."- *M"""	;""":"	•"-	"1
                                sSource- The Heir|
                                CData from the US,
                                =ftw.^  _j _-_    -«..1J^,%
5-12
5.2 What is the Ecological Condition of Forests?         Chapter 5 -| Ecological Condition

-------

                Forest age class - Category 2
   Maintaining forest cover with a wide age range and a variety of
   successional stages sustains habitats for a variety of forest-
   dependent species and provides for the sustainable yield of a
   range of forest products. This indicator reports the  percentage of
   forest area, with stands in each of several age classes.7

   What the Data Show

   In the eastern U.S., 35 percent of forests classified as "timber-
   lands" are more than 60 years old, and 10 percent are more than
   100 years old; in the West, the corresponding numbers are
   70 percent and 35 percent, respectively (Exhibit 5-6). Softwood
   age distributions are skewed slightly toward younger age classes
   due to their  management for timber. Hardwoods have a more
   normal distribution,  with a peak in the 40 to 79 year age class,
   reflecting maturing second and third growth forests in the East.
   Stands averaging 0 to 5 inches and  those over 11 inches are
   increasing, while intermediate stands in the 6 to 10 inch range
   are decreasing, indicating a rise in selective harvesting in the U.S.
   (USDA, FS, 2002).

   Indicator Gaps and Limitations

   Data  for national parks and wilderness areas and other forested
   land are  not  available at this time, but  will be in the  future (The
   Heinz Center, 2002).

   Data  Source

   The data source for this indicator was Forest Resources of the
   United States, 7997, Smith, et al., 2001. (See Appendix B,
   page  B-36, for more information.)
       7 Age class is defined by the mean age of the dominant or codomi-
   nant crowns in the upper layer of the tree canopy.
              txnioit 5-6: Forest age class, 1997

pt   Partial Indicator Data: West (Timberlands Only)
                                             Age of Stand (yrs) *
                                             II 1-19
                                             & 20-59
                                             • 60-99
                                             Si 00-199
                   ^                         • 200+

                   3
                               Future
j|r.  Partial Indicator Data: East (Timberlands Only)
   SQ              "                       Age of Stand (yrs)
                                           IT 1-19
3 4C(      H                             g| 20-59
                                           • 60-99
                                           IS 100-199
                                           • 200+
                                           HJ Uneven-Aged
                                                           1
    7f
   10
                               Future
UPTCoverage all 50 states (timberlands only)
    j>te "Timberlands^js^a USDA Forest Service designation for lands
_   hat grow at least 20 cubic feet of wood per acre per year, which is
fpufeonsidered be sufficient to support commercial harvest under current
t: ^economic conditions Lands on which harvest is prohibited by statute
g"' are nqt^mcluded asj^timberlands " Note also that the term
™L^ 'uneven-age" is being phased out; such stands are composed of
Ji^intermmgled trees that differ considerably in age
£*£" Source The Heinz Center The State of the Nation's Ecosystems 2002
   Data from the USDA, Forest Service
Chapter 5 -. Ecological Condition     5.2 What is the Ecological Condition of Forests?
                                                         5-13

-------
                    •.                  '           "          • ' -   .   '      J_                        , II
EFAs Draft {Uport oh the Environment 2bd)^ •  Technical  Document
                    r   1                           '           i .   !     ! '      !       •      '  '.  .     t ! j •  I

                   Forest pattern and fragmentation - Category 2
                                                                                                ^1,—i.Ji
   Forest pattern and fragmentation affect the plant and animal
   species that live in forests. Large blocks of contiguous forest sup-
   port interior forest species. Partial forest cover creates forest edge
   habitat, which supports birds and other animals that nest in
   forests but forage in nearby fields (Ritters, et al., 2002).
   Fragmentation also creates areas that concentrate airborne nutri-
   ents and pollutants by increasing the amount of unprotected for-
   est edge (Weathers, et al., 2001). This indicator captures some of
   these features.

   What the Data Show

   Fragmentation in forests in the U.S. is significant. Based on 1992
   data (The Heinz Center, 2002), two-thirds of all points within
   forests were surrounded by land that was at least 90 percent
   forest in their "immediate neighborhood" (i.e., a  radius of
   250 feet) (Exhibit 5-7). However, only one-fourth of the points
   within forests were surrounded by land that was  at least
   90 percent forest within their "larger neighborhood" (i.e., to a
   radius of 2.5 miles) (The Heinz Center, 2002). Approximately half
   of the fragmentation consists of "holes" in otherwise continuous
   forest cover. About three-quarters of all forest land is found in or
   near the boundaries of these large (greater than 5,000 hectares),
   but heavily fragmented, forest patches (Ritters, et al., 2002). In
                                 short, most forest is near other forest, and "holes" in forest cover
                                 caused by development, agriculture, harvesting, etc., tend to be
                                 isolated from each other.            '  j

                                 Indicator Gaps and Limitations

                                 Although this indicator was calculated for the conterminous .U.S.,
                                 it has been categorized as a Category 2 indicator because it is
                                 only one of many potentially important fragmentation indicators.
                                 The exact impact of the amount and type of fragmentation on
                                 biotic structure and ecological processes |is poorly known, and is
                                 likely to vary from one species and process to another (Ritters, et
                                 al., 2002). The FHM program is developing additional landscape
                                 fragmentation indicators, but the data haye not been fully evaluat-
                                 ed as this report was being finalized.
                                 Data Sources
                                 The data source for this indicator was Forest Health Monitoring
                                 National Technical Report, 1991 to 1999, U.S. Department of
                                 Agriculture, Forest Service, Southern Research Station, 2002; and
                                 Fragmentation of Continental United States Forests, Ritters, et al.,
                                 2002. (See Appendix B, page B-37, for rnore information.)
                                  •  Exhibit 5-7: Forest cover and neighborhqbq size, 1
-------

               At-risR native forest species - Category 2
Species richness is considered to be an important indicator of
ecological condition by both the National Research Council
(2000) and the Science Advisory Board (2002). Although the
role of species richness in maintaining a stable ecosystem is
debated,  greater species richness (i.e., greater number of species)
is generally accepted as desirable. Species richness could be
altered by air pollution, fragmentation, and forest disturbance by
fire, insects, or disease.

What the Data Show

Based on an assessment of 12 factors, NatureServe and its mem-
ber programs in the Natural Heritage program determined  that
5 percent of forest animal species are imperiled, 3.5 percent are
critically imperiled, and 1.5 percent are or might be extinct (The
Heinz Center, 2002) (Exhibit 5-8). This indicator includes reports
on mammals, amphibians, grasshoppers, and butterflies; too little is
known about other groups, including plants, to assign risk cate-
gories. NatureServe data reveal that of the 1,642 species of ter-
restrial animals associated with forests, 88 percent still occupy
their full  historical geographic range on a state-by-state basis
(USDA, FS, 2002).

The Natural Heritage Program uses standard ranking criteria and
definitions, making the ranks comparable across groups. This
means that "imperiled" has the same basic meaning whether
applied to a salamander, a moss, or a forest community. Ranking is
a qualitative process, however, taking into
account several factors that function as guide-
lines rather than arithmetic rules. The ranker's
overall knowledge of the element allows him
or her to weigh each factor in relation to the
others and to consider all pertinent informa-
tion for a particular element. The factors con-
sidered in ranking species include population
size, range extent and  area of occupancy,
short- and long-term trends in the foregoing
factors, threats, and fragility (Stein, 2002).
                                                                  The information gathered by Natural Heritage data centers also
                                                                  provides support for official designations of endangered or threat-
                                                                  ened species. However, because Natural Heritage lists of vulnera-
                                                                  ble species and official lists of endangered or threatened  species
                                                                  have different criteria, evidence requirements, purposes, and taxo-
                                                                  nomic coverage, they normally do not coincide completely with
                                                                  the official designations of "rare and endangered" species.

                                                                  Indicator Gaps and Limitations

                                                                  The data for this indicator are not from a site-based monitoring
                                                                  program, but rather from a census approach that focuses on the
                                                                  location and distribution of at-risk species.  Determining whether
                                                                  species are naturally rare or have been depleted is currently not
                                                                  possible. It is not clear that trends can be quantified with any
                                                                  precision.

                                                                  Data Source

                                                                  The data source for this indicator was The State of the Nation's
                                                                  Ecosystems, The Heinz Center, 2002, using data from the
                                                                  NatureServe Explorer Database. (See Appendix B, page B-37, for
                                                                  more information.)
                                                                8: f\t-risR native Forest species, by risk category, 2000
                                                                -m, i«J- -***, W -SI Ififti *** fS~Snf -a-^&lf   H&ISBBBJil, sh 1*1   £ *A  J*i SiK, fc&i..    it*    f '"cmff
                                                                                                            Extinct
                                                                                                            Critically
                                                                                                            Imperiled
                                                                                                            Imperiled
                                                                                                            Vulnerable
                                                                                                            All'Rare/At Risk
                                                          e: TJie Heinz Center The State of the Nation's Ecosystems. 2002 Data from NatureServe
                                                      -arid ils Natural Heritage member programs
                                                       v;^.-,™-.Hi,-_      ^ 5        r  °      T                                ^
Chapter 5 - tcological Condition     5.2 What is the Ecological Condition of Forests?
                                                                                                                          5-15

-------
EDA'	FY	il'Tr	rn^^;pii«!UTiM.p«^	^pfg3^s^'^p
t_JAsUratt KeportSTT.me'':1invitronmenfc!'2Q.Q5
                   1  -I     ' "' ' "   '      '       '   J ;       !!  !  1 I  '

              Topulations of representative species - Category 2
   The abundance of species representative of particular forest types
   is a more sensitive and less dramatic measure of ecological
   condition than species richness alone. Species richness reflects
   the net number of species invading an area and species going
   extinct, whereas species abundance also includes the numbers of
   individuals in each species (USDA, FS, 2002). The FHM program
   has collected abundance data on bird and tree species.

   What the Data Show

   Between 1966 and 1979, 21 percent of bird species associated
   with forests experienced population declines. This figure rose to
   26 percent between  1980 and 2000 (USDA, FS, 2002). Areas
   with the greatest population declines were along the  coasts and in
   the Appalachians. Between 1966  and 2000, 26 percent of bird
   species associated with forests showed population increases.

   In the majority of tree species groups, the number of trees with
   trunk diameters greater than 1  foot increased by more than
   50 percent between  1970 and 2002, indicating a more abundant
   community of older trees (USDA, FS, 2002) (Exhibit  5-9).
                                Indicator Caps and Limitations

                                Several limitations are associated with thi^ indicator:

                                • Population data are available only for b rds and trees. Data for
                                  big game ;ire reported by the states, ,bilt generally very few
                                  systematic measures of animal population density exist.

                                • The data from the Breeding Bird Survey (BBS) are based on a
                                  volunteer observer program and might jiot be statistically,
                                  reliable.                         j
                                Data Sources                |

                                The data sources for this indicator were the Breeding Bird
                                Survey, U.S. Geologic Survey (1966-2000); and U.S.
                                Department of Agriculture, Forest Seryick Draft Resource  •
                                Planning and Assessment Tables, 2002; anp National Report on
                                Sustainable Fprests-2003, Final Draft, U.S. Department of
                                Agriculture, Forest Service, 2002. (See Appendix B, page B-38,
                                for more information.)               .               ,
              I     Exhibit 5-Q: Populations of representative fore
                                            -50% H-50 to 0% n 0 to[±50%','jg >+50%;'' {
                                          |species, i970-2C)C)2      '

                                                                              iag^                 :--
                                        8	10	12	14	1J5	l§.,2
                                 ,
                 Coverage: 3 7 states.
              (  Source: USDA, Forest Service. Draft Respur.ce Planning A<
              j!  May 3,2002 (updated August 12,2002). (Septemberg)02;
              ll  http://www.ncrs.fs.fed.us/4801/FIADB/ipaJabler/Draft RPA       '
                                                     •       •'  ••'••-
5-16
5.2 What is the Ecological Condition of Forests?         CJiapter 5 - Ecological C-onditiori

-------



               Forest disturbance: fire, insects, and disease - Category 1
  Fires, insects, and disease often occur naturally in forests. Their
  impact on forest ecosystems can  be influenced by their interac-
  tion with other variables such as  management decisions, air
  pollutants, and variations in climate. For example, trees weakened
  by pollutants might be more susceptible to attack by pathogens.
  When ecological processes are altered beyond a critical thresh-
  old, significant changes to forest  conditions might result.

  What the Data Show

  Wildfire acreage has declined from a peak of more than 50 million
  acres per year in the 1930s to 2 to 7 million acres per year,
  largely due to fire suppression policies (The Heinz Center,
  2002).8 However, there has been a slight increase in fires in
  national forests in recent decades, with -8.4 million acres burned
  in 2000 (Exhibit 5-10).
Insect damage fluctuates from year to year, mostly as a result of.
population cycles of the gypsy moth and southern pine beetle,
affecting between 8 and 46 million acres per year. Data for two
major parasites, fusiform rust and mistletoe, are available only for
the past several years, but the total acreage affected is 43 to 44
million acres (The Heinz Center, 2002).

Indicator Caps and Limitations

Limitations of this indicator include the following:

• This indicator does not distinguish between forest fires, other
  wildfires, and prescribed burns. It also does not track the
  intensity of the fires.
• Data are not available on forests affected by diseases other
  than those listed above.
• Some insects can cause widespread damage before it is
  apparent from aerial surveys.
              -10: Forest disturbance: Fire, insects, and disease, I979-2OOO
                                                                 -
                                                                 Insects
                                                                 Fire
                                                                 (including
                                                                 grasslands/
                                                                 shrublands)
                                                                 Disease
             Data Sources

             The data sources for this indicator were The State
             of the Nation's Ecosystems, The Heinz Center, 2002,
             using data from Western National Forests: Nearby
             communities are increasingly threatened by catastrophic
             wildfires, U.S. General Accounting Office, 1999;
             Forest Health Monitoring National Technical Report,
             1991-1999, U.S.  Department of Agriculture, Forest
             Service, Southern Research Station,  2002;
             and National Fire Statistics, the National
             Interagency Fire Center, (See Appendix B,
             page B-38, for more information.)
        1975   1980    1985   1990   T995    2000   2005
          Insects gypsy moth, spruce budworm, southern pine beetle, mountain pine
          beetle, western spruce budworm (alf but the gypsy moth are native to the
          United States)
          Diseases:. .fusiform rust, dwarf mistletoe
          Coverage, all 50 states
          Note: Data are not limited to nationaLforests.
          Source. The Heinz Center. The State of the Nation's Ecosystems. 2002
          Data from the USDA, Forest Service Health Protection/Forest Health
          Monitoring Program (insects, disease) and the National Forest System (fire).
       8These data include wildfires in grasslands and shrublands.
(_napter 5 - tcological C-Ondition     5.2 What is the Ecological Condition of Forests?
                                                          5-17

-------

    |i;:	riz^^jjB
  ndicaKr
Tree condition - Category 2
   Changes in tree condition reflect the sum total of factors acting
   on the tree, including stress due to pollutants, climate, nutrient
   status, soil condition, and disease. This indicator (called "dimin-
   ished biological components" in USDA, FS, 2002), reports on the
   percentage of trees in each region of the conterminous U.S. states
   that exhibit significant changes in three measures: mortality vol-
   ume, crown condition, and the area in fire Current Condition Class
   Z. A Resource Planning Act region (shown in Exhibit 5-11) was
   considered to have poor tree condition (designated as diminished
   biological components in the exhibit) if (1)  average annual mortal-
   ity volume was more than  60 percent of gross annual growth vol-
   ume, or  (2) the ZB-index, an indicator of crown condition, was
   increasing at a rate of 0.015 or more per year, or (5) more than
   half of the forest area was in fire Current Condition Class 3. Fire
   condition Class 3 represents a major deviation from the  ecological
   conditions compatible with historic fire regimes and might require
   management activities such as harvesting and replanting to
   restore the historic fire regime.

   What the Data Show

   According to the data for this indicator, 20 percent of forests in
   the U.S. were observed to exhibit poor tree  condition, 40.9 per-
   cent were in fair or good condition, and 38.8 percent had no or
                                                    insufficient data (USDA, FS, 2002) (Exhibjit 5-11). Mortality was
                                                    highest in the Pacific Northwest and northern Minnesota, and a
                                                    large portion of these forests was in fire uurrent Condition Class
                                                    3, indicating that mortality might be producing a high fuel load.
                                                    The South and Rocky Mountain regions hjad the smallest areas of
                                                    poor tree condition, but more than half of those areas had insuffi-
                                                    cient data or no data at all.             ;
                                                                                         I                .

                                                    Indicator  Gaps and Limitations

                                                    The data used to calculate this indicator \jrere available at the time
                                                    for only 32 states; more than half of the South and Rocky
                                                    Mountain regions had insufficient or no1 data at all.
                                                               i  ,,,,,,,           ;  ^    „           ,

                                                    Data Sources                i
                                                    The data sources for this indicator were Forest Health Monitoring
                                                    National Technical Report, 1991 -1999, U.SJ. Department of
                                                    Agriculture, Forest Service, Southern Research Station, 2002, and
                                                    National Report on Sustainable Forests-2003, Final Draft, U.S.
                                                    Department of Agriculture, Forest Service,; 2002. (See Appendix
                                                    B, page B-39, for more information.)
                                             Exhibit 5-11: Tree condition, 1990-1099
                                                                      ^^^Im^L
              U Forest area having; diminished biological components that may indicate changes In fundamental ecj
              i::,,Pircentages baser! on forest area in conterminus 48 States.          '    "         1
              ij, i Source: Conklma B., et al. Forest Health Monitoring National Technical Report' 1991-1999. 2002.11
              ET ''         '                         "  ^  ':::':,:;','T "'!",ii ::„?*' aa:/: !',c '^'MicwKii1""'"":'!! p
5-18
                5.2 What is the Ecological Condition of Forests?
lapter 5 - tcological Condition

-------

              Ozone injury to trees - Category 2
  Ozone injury to trees can be diagnosed by examination of plant
  leaves (Skelly, et al., 1987; Bennet, et al., 1994). Foliar injury is the
  first visible sign of injury of plants from ozone exposure and
  indicates impairment of physiological processes in the leaves.

  What the Data Show

  Little or no ozone injury was reported at 97 percent of Pacific Coast
  sites and 100 percent of Rocky Mountain sites (Exhibit 5-12). In
  the North and South regions, however, 23 percent of biompnitoring
  sites showed at least low levels of injury, with severe levels observed
  at about 5 percent of the plots (USDA, FS, 2002).
                                    Indicator Gaps  and  Limitations
                                    • Any further injury to the plant (beyond injury to the leaves)
                                      requires that ozone penetrate through the stomata into the leaf
                                      interior, which is regulated by  a variety of environmental
                                      processes; some plants that show foliar damage show no
                                      further damage, and some plants show damage without
                                      concurrent signs of leaf damage (EPA, ORD, July 1996).

                                    • Biomonitoring site data were available for only 32  states at the
                                      time the data for this indicator were analyzed.


                                    Data Sources

                                    The data sources for this indicator were the Forest Health
                                    Monitoring Program,  U.S. Department of Agriculture (1991 -
                                    2000) and National Report on Sustainable Forests-2003, Final
                                    Draft, U.S. Department of Agriculture, Forest Service, 2002.
                                    (See Appendix B, page B-39, for more information.)
                          Ixkkit 5-12: Ozone injury to trees, 1994-2000
                                            i             -~t~     »   i.            &
                              100-
                                                                        North
                                                                        Pacific Coast
                                                                        Rocky Mt
                                                                        South
                                     little or no
                                        injury
                              low        moderate      severe
                             injury         injury        "fnjury
                           *  '                      i       •**,'>
                          " Biosite Index
" Coverage: 32 states.
jtSource: USDA, Forest Service. National Report on Sustainable Forests -
pO'03. Final Draft. 2002.
CJiapter 5 - tcological C-onciition    5.2 What is the Ecological Condition of Forests?
                                                                                         5-19

-------

               Carbon storage - Category 2

                                                                                           M»gaB««iB CT»»ililgsiUfl
   As a result of photosynthesis, carbon is stored in forests
   for a period of time in a variety of forms before it is ultimately
   returned to the atmosphere through the respiration and decom-
   position of plants and animals. A substantial pool of carbon is
   stored in woody biomass (roots, trunks, and branches). Another
   portion eventually ends up as dead organic matter in the upper
   soil horizons. Carbon storage in forest biomass and forest soils
   is essential for stable forest ecosystems, and it reduces atmos-
   pheric concentrations of a carbon dioxide, a greenhouse gas
   (see Chapter 1, Cleaner Air).

   What the Data  Show

   For the period 1953 to 1996, the average annual net storage of
   non-soil forest carbon pools was  175 million tonnes of carbon per
   year (MtC/yr). The rate of storage for the last period of record
   (1987-1996) declined to 135 MtC/yr (Exhibit 5-13). The
   decrease in sequestration in the last period is thought to be due
   to more accurate data, increased harvests relative to growth, and
   better accounting of emissions from dead wood. The Northern
   region is sequestering the greatest amount of carbon, followed by
   the Rocky Mountain region. The trend of decreasing sequestration
   in the South is due to the increase in harvesting relative to
   growth. Some of the harvested carbon is sequestered in wood
   products (USDA, FS, 2002).
                                                       Indicator Caps and  Limitations

                                                       Limitations of this indicator include the fc (lowing:
                                                       • The data only cover forest classified as "timberland," which
                                                        excludes about one-third of U.S. forest >.
                                                       • Carbon stored in soil is not included,  •
                                                       • Several of the carbon pools are not measured, but are estimated
                                                        based on inventory-to-carbon  relationships developed with
                                                        information from ecological studies.    ;
                                                      Data Sources
                                                      The data sources for this indicator were the Forest Inventory and
                                                      Analysis, U.S; Department of Agriculture (1979-1995); and
                                                      National Report on Sustainable Forests, 2003, Final Draft, U.S.
                                                      Department of Agriculture, Forest Servicel 2002.
                                                      (See Appendix B, page B-39, for more information.)
           Exhibit 5-13: Contribution of forest ecosystems to the totalqlobal carbon budget, 1953-1996
                                                                           j|fu«» 4
          	-	5                                                       <&
                j>  •£ 250.0
                                                  C3 Abovegrd live
      Z e 200.0
      41 "-*
      e  | 150.0
      •3  fe
      §  2" 1°°-°
      1  r
      5  a  so.o
                e  §
              0.0
                                                    Abovegrd
                                                    standing dead
                           *v    *\^   *s
                        ^^^
H Understory

• Down dead

D Forest floor

D Blw grd live

• Blw grnd dead
                          Years of Period
            Average annual net forest carbon change
            (Mt/yr), 1953-1996                     '

Coverage: lower 4 8 states.
Source: USDA, Forest Service. National Report on Sustainable Forests - 200.
1953    1963-   1977-  1987-
1962    1976    1986.  .1996

      .    Year
                           iNorth BSouth DRocky Mtn DF'acific Coast

                          jage annual net forest carbon change
                           '  r) by region, 1953-1996
                             A   WV"«««f h     it + 4 » ^"   -,
                                                                             }nal Draft. 2002.
5-20
                    5.2 What is the Ecological Condition of Forests;?          Chapter 5 >•'. Icological Condition

-------
                          fflca
                                        •1>',M""r:i!'r,;-"'"'v .."•s ,:-r :.•:,•.;•,•!,:'*,•:;:: .'-;;*• •-''"-i---; -'tf-1'^'- ."-'--':liliLL ^ -''-.^1: --^i-s' . • --'.-"-.- -"-'•' '^i*''-:,->''" '••' •?--•• -L'.:^.';
              joil compaction - (Category 2
  This indicator measures the extent of changes to the physical
  properties of forested soils resulting from forest harvesting, road
  construction, or other human impacts that are of sufficient magni-
  tude to lower soil fertility or cause significant reductions in site
  productivity. Compaction can have a variety of negative effects on
  soil fertility by causing changes in both physical and chemical
  properties (Sutton, 1991; Fisher and Binkley, 2000). Reduction in
  pore space makes the soil more dense and  difficult to penetrate
  and thus can constrain the size,, reach, and  extent of root systems.
  Reduction in  soil aeration and water movement can reduce the
  ability of roots to absorb water, nutrients, and oxygen, resulting in
  shallow rooting and stunted trees. Destruction of soil structure
  can limit water infiltration and increase rates of runoff and soil loss
  from erosion.

  What  the Data Show

  Soil compaction is primarily a local phenomenon. More than 86
  percent of the plots measured showed less than 5 percent of the
  plot area exhibitng of soil compaction (Exhibit 5-14) (USDA, FS,
  2003). Only a small fraction of plots (1.6 percent) showed com-
  paction on more than 50 percent of the plot
  Indicator Gaps and  Limitations

  Soil physical properties (e.g., bulk density) are not conventionally
  monitored in a way that facilitates national reporting, and the
  current approach relies heavily on visual inspection and the State
  Soil Geographic Database (STATSGO)' state soil maps (USDA, FS,
  2003). No measurements were made of the degree or intensity of
  compaction. Physical disturbances that are not readily visible from
  the surface might be under-reported. Therefore the national maps
  thus far are only indicative of the potential for soil compaction on
  a regional basis. The FIA program has begun monitoring actual soil
  physical properties at the FIA sites, to be used in conjunction with
  the current method, but the data were  not available nationally for
  development of the indicator in 2002 (USDA, FS, 2003).

  Data Source

  The data  sources for this indicator were the Forest Health
  Monitoring Program, U.S. Department of Agriculture  (1999-
  2000); and State Soil Geographic Database (STATSGO) state soil
  maps. (See Appendix B, page  B-40, for more information.)
                                Exhibit 5-14: Frequency distribution of percent of plot area
                                   exhibiting evidence of surface compaction reported on
                         ^  Forest f-lealth Monitoring (FH?V9 frogram plots, 1999-2OOO
                                                                                   --  100%
                              3
                              CT
1311 Frequency
"•'Cumulative percent
                                                 5   10   20   30   40
                                                    Percent Compaction
             50 More
                           Coverage: 37 states.
                       |;3_Source: USDA, Forest Service. National Report on Sustainable Forests-2003. 2003.
CJiapter 5 - tcological (Condition    5.2 What is the Ecological Condition of Forests?
                                                         5-21

-------
EFAs Draft ReJDort on  trie Environment StSiCpji • Tebriflidal  Document
  Indiclior
Soil
oil erosion
-Cab
                    egory.
   Erosion is a term used to describe various mechanisms that wear
   away the land surface. Soil erosion is caused naturally by running
   water, wind, ice, and other geologic processes, but forest harvest-
   ing and road construction can increase erosion beyond natural
   levels. Erosion in excess of soil formation decreases the long-term
   productivity of forest systems and contributes to siltation of
   streams, lakes, and reservoirs. The Water Erosion Prediction Project
   (WEPP) model is commonly used in conjunction with the STATSGO
   state soil maps to estimate and predict the amount of soil loss
   based on several factors influencing erosion (Liu, et al., 1997).

   What the Data Show

   Modeled erosion rates on undisturbed forest lands were less than
   0.05 ton per acre per year, on nearly 90 percent of the measured
   plots, compared to 3.1 tons per acre per year in agricultural
   ecosystems (USDA, FS, 2003) (Exhibit 5-15). Exposed mineral
   soil is a substantial contributor to erosion  in the regions of the
   country sampled, and about 65 percent of the measured
   forest plots showed bare soil on less than five percent of the plot.
                                                 Indicator Gaps and Limitations
                                                                                    i                 \
                                                 Limitations of this indicator include the following:
                                                 • The modeling approach  (WEPP) was. originally designed for
                                                   agricultural systems. It might overestimate erosion from well-
                                                   managed forest plots and underestimate erosion on plots
                                                   that have been harvested and mechanically prepared. (USDA,
                                                   FS, 2003).                       i
                                                 • The erosicm indicator was calculated for! only 37 states by 2002.
                                                 Data Sources
                                                                                    I
                                                 The data sources for this indicator were the Forest Health
                                                 Monitoring Program, U.S. Department of Agriculture (1991-
                                                 2000); and State Soil Geographic Database (STATSGO) state soil
                                                 maps. (See Appendix B, page B-40, for more information.)
                                  exhibit 5-15: frequency distribution for modeled erosion ralif on Tbrest Health
                                                             *         r "* * 4fct^'W*W^'<** ^^f*
                                            Monitoring (FHM) Program plots (l999-.!c500>
                                            Following a 2-year (average) and 100-year s
                                                        050    1 0

                                            Modeled Erosion Rate (tons acre
                                        .                     t
                                :  Coverage: 23 states, excluding Alaska and Hawaii
                                	Note: As an initial step in this analysis, model runs assume an un<
                                1  Source: USDA, Forest Service. 'National Report on Sustainable Foresi
5-22
               5.2 What is the Ecological Condition of Forest;;?         C-napter 5 ;- tcological C^ondition

-------
                 Processes beyond the range of historic variation - Category 2
      The Forest Health Monitoring (FHM) program (USDA, FS, 2002)
      provided one of the few examples of an indicator that considers the
      essential ecological attribute of natural disturbance. The FHM pro-
      gram analyzed Forest Inventory and Analysis (FIA) data on climatic
      events, fire frequency, and insect and disease outbreaks between
      1996 and 2000. These data were compared to anecdotal data from
      1800 to 1850 to determine whether recent patterns in such inci-
      dents were beyond the range of historic variation. The FIA data were
      also compared to data from between 1978 and 1995 to determine if
      they were beyond the range of "recent" variation.

     What the Data Show

     A number of incidents were determined to be outside the range of
     recent variation in natural disturbance:
     • El Nino during 1997 to 2000.

     • A 1998 ice storm in the Northeast.

     • Total area burned in the West during 1996, 1998, and 2000,
       and the total area burned nationwide in 2000.

     • Outbreaks of spruce beetle in 1996, spruce budworm in 1997,
       and southern pine beetle in 2000.
 Indicator Caps and Limitations

 Several limitations are associated with this indicator:
 11 This analysis was limited by the lack of metric data
   (actual measurements) available to describe conditions from
   1800 to 1850.

 • A relatively complete data set for major forest insects and
   diseases exists for the period 1979 to 2000, but these data are
   too recent for establishing a historical baseline.

 Data Sources

The data sources for this indicator were the Forest Inventory and
Analysis, U.S. Department of Agriculture (1979-1995); and
National Report on Sustainable Forests-2003-Final Draft,
U.S. Department of Agriculture, Forest Service, 2002.
(See Appendix B, page B-41, for more information.)
Chapter 5 - Ecological Condition     5.2 What is the Ecological Condition of Forests?
                                                                                                                      5-23

-------
_^_—~~,——. n..i nu-.T,-	—r-riTTirri    i^t\as •:i.?,;!.!.•..*• s  . •• •: «.•,:<• /.i' /,; • > i:' c"i: „••!I ,,i:,	I':».L• •:••»!.!	•::••: •;;: •:!•:w i; * ••:::«<	fti'..i-MMi
  Summary: Tne Ecological Condition of Forests

  The available data are not, at this point, sufficient to track the
  progress of EPA's programs as they relate to the ecological condition
  of forest ecosystems. When the FHM/FIA program indicators are
  measured nationwide and repeatedly, they will form an important
  baseline against which to monitor the response of forests and their
  associated fauna to air pollutants, climate change, and management
  practices that impact forest ecosystems. At this point, the results of
  the leaf injury indicator suggest that research and assessment of the
  actual effects of ozone on forest ecosystems should be continued.
  The increasing acreage of older forests stands and changes in forest
  stream  hydrology might bear watching inasmuch as these factors
  alter responses of forest systems to air and water pollutants.

   Landscape condition
   The total acreage of forests has remained steady over the past
   century and, although the acreage of some of the types of forests
   have changed, none are currently at risk of being lost. Over the past
   SO years, the amount of non-stocked forest has decreased, while the
   amount of forest with older trees has increased. Forests are highly
   fragmented, but most forest land exists in or near the boundaries of
   large tracts of forest land.

   Biotic condition
   Most forest-related species continue to occupy a large portion of
   their original range. Eleven percent of species dependent on forest
   land are imperiled  (5.7 percent are mammals, 2.3 percent are
   amphibians, and 1.4 percent are birds). Twenty-five  percent of forest
   bird species have declined since 1975 (mostly in the Southeast),
    25 percent have increased (mostly in the North), and 50 percent
    have stayed approximately the same. These results indicate that
    some forest habitats may not be supporting all the species they did.
    historically. Currently no reliable data exist on the condition of biota
    in  forest streams nationally or regionally. Our understanding of the
    relationship between indicators and biological conservation strate-
    gies remains weak (Lindenmeyer, et al.,  2000).

    According to available data, 20 percent of forests monitored in the
    U.S. were observed to exhibit poor tree condition, and 23 percent of
    biomonitoring plots in the eastern U.S. showed more than a small
    amount of ozone impact on plant leaves. Severe ozone damage to
    leaves was observed at 5 percent of the plots.

     Ecological Processes
     Annual rates of carbon storage in timberland increased over the
     three decades between 1953 and 1986 due to increasing age of tim-
     ber stands and growth of woodlots on what was once farmland.
     However, annual storage declined in the decade 1987 to 1996, in
     part because of harvesting in Southeastern forests.
Chemical and physical characteristics

Nitrate loss from most forests does not af
                                     ipear to be resulting in
high nitrate concentrations in forest strea ns, but few streams are
monitored in .areas where nitrate deposition is high (the. East), and
the baseline Is too short to determine whether there are trends in
the data.
Hydrology and geomorphology

With respect to forest streams, there has
                                      been a tendency toward
 VVILIl ICOWtv-i. *•" iwi.-—». ——	1 	                        •
 decreased minimum flow rates in 10 percent of forest streams during
 the period 1940 through 2000 comparejd to pre-1940, while
 25 percent of forest streams had increased minimum flow rates.
 Five percent of the watersheds had lower! maximum flow rates and  |
 25 percent had higher maximum flow ratjs. There were no obvious ,
 trends in maximum flow rates in the decades since 1940, but there
 was an increase in the minimum flow rate; during that period-      ;
 Increased flows were generally found in tie East, and decreased flows
 were found in the West. Soil compactibn is a problem on  more than
 10 percent af the plots in only 10 perce it of monitored forest land.
 Natural disturbance regimes

 A number of events were determined tc
 recent variation in natural disturbance,
 events, a seivere ice storm in the North
                                      be outside the rahge of
                                     including two El Nino
                                     ;ast, total area burned in
  the West during three years and the total area burned nationwide
  in 2000, and several tree pest outbreaks. The ecological conse- .
  quences of these events are undoubtedly significant, but have not
  been systematically analyzed.         j                      ":
                                   •  i                 •       !
  Many indicators currently being evaluated by the FlA and FHM
  programs are not included in this seciioln because the results were;
  not included in the Forest Service's rrtos}t recent report on'sustain-
  able forests (USDA, FS, 2002). Becai!is
-------



 5.3 What  Is the  Ecological
 Condition  of farmlands:
 Agricultural practices using high-yielding crop varieties, fertilization,
 irrigation, and pesticides have contributed substantially to increased
 food production over the past 50 years (Matson, et al., 1997).
 These same practices also have altered the biotic interactions in
 farmlands, with local, regional, and global ecological consequences
 (Matson, et al., 1997). This report (following The Heinz Center,
 2002) defines a farmland as consisting of not only of the lands used
 to grow crops, but also the field borders, windbreaks, small woodlots,
grassland and shrubland areas, wetlands, farmsteads, small villages,
and other built-up areas within or adjacent to croplands. These land
covers/uses both support agricultural production and provide habi-
tat for a variety of wildlife species. Farmlands include lands that grow
perennial and annual crops as well as lands that are used to produce
forage for livestock. This definition overlaps with other ecosystems;
most notably, pastures are considered croplands, but are also con-
sidered part of grassland/shrubland ecosystems.

Among ecologists concerned with ecological condition, farmlands
are often referred to as "agroecosystems." EPA is interested not only
in the ecological condition of farmlands, but also in their effects on
adjacent ecosystems. Developing and implementing agricultural prac-
tices that integrate crop and livestock production with ecologically

pj EsseStiaTEc^logrcaiAMKiK'^lE":3L
Landscape Condition
1 - - - -'•- • ~ . . - -- -:;:-
; Extent of Ecological System/Habitat Types
^ Landscape Composition
| Landscape Structure/Pattern
Biotic Condition
• Ecosystems and Communities
j Species and Populations
•\ Organism Condition
I Ecological Processes
1 Energy Flow
3 Material Flow
Chemical and Physical Characteristics
1 Nutrient Concentrations .
! •
? Other Chemjcal Parameters
^ Trace Organics and Inorganics
1 •
f •

E Physical Parameters
f .Hydrology and Ceomorphology
^ Surface and Ground Water Flows
| Dynamic Structural Conditions
S Sediment and Material Transport
F
. Natural Disturbance Regimes
8 Frequency
1 Extent
1 Duration

^i%^;i ExhjbitS^


Extent of agricultural land uses
The farmland landscape









Nitrate in farmland, forested, and urban streams and ground water
Phosphorus in farmlands, forested and urban streams

Pesticides in farmland streams and ground water.
Potential pesticide runoff from farm fields
Pesticide leaching potential
Soil qualify index




Soil erosion
Sediment runoff potential from croplands and pasturelands




	 	 _ ^ _ ^^^^ _w ^u, tv_ 2^.

JiBiBiS
1
•
•



























SUfii
2











a
•

•
•
a
•




*





•-/: •••'.. : :; ;'-:-.


USDA
DOI









DOI
DOI

DOI
USDA
USDA
EPA




EPA
USDA





Chapter 5 - Ecological Condition    5.3 What Is the Ecological Condition of Farmlands?
                                                     5-25

-------
EPAs Draft Import on  the Environment 20C|| •  Technical Dpcumlijjt

 based management practices has become the key for sustainable
 agriculture (NRC, 1999).

 Some of the data on farmlands are available through the National
 Agricultural Statistics Service (NASS). Over the past 80 years, NASS
 has administered the USDA's program of collecting and publishing
 national and state agricultural statistics. NASS currently publishes
 more than 400 reports a year covering virtually every facet of U.S.
 agriculture—production and supplies of food and fiber, prices paid
 and received by farmers, farm labor and .wages, and farm aspects of
 the industry. These estimates are based on a statistical area sampling
 frame that represents the entire land mass of the U.S. The biological
 indicators currently measured by NASS are primarily related to crop
 or animal production. However, NASS does not report on indicators
 of ecological condition. Physical or chemical indicators usually pro-
 vide information relevant for agronomic production, but also can
 provide limited information on potential stressors to adjacent terres-
 trial and aquatic ecosystems such as soil erosion; nitrogen, phospho-
 rus and pesticide runoff; and phosphorus and nitrate concentrations
 in farmland streams.

 In 1990,  EPA and the USDA Agricultural Research Service (ARS)
 undertook an  interagency effort to assess the ecological condition of
 agroecosystems as part of the Environmental Monitoring and
 Assessment Program (EMAP). In  1994 and 1995, EMAP piloted a
 regional-scale assessment in the mid-Atlantic region (Hellkamp, et
 al., 2000). Some of the resulting indicators used in that pilot are
 included  as Category 2 indicators in this report. These  indicators
 could be measured in other regions and eventually across the  nation
 in conjunction with the NASS annual surveys.

 The farmland indicators used in this report are displayed in
 Exhibit 5-16, grouped according to the essential ecological attrib-
 utes (EEAs). Some indicators relating to the EEAs of farmland
 landscape condition, the chemical and physical attributes of farm-
 land streams, and the hydrology of farmland watersheds have
 been presented in the previous chapters on Better Protected Land
 and Purer Water, because these indicators also relate to questions
 about  those media. Below, this section briefly summarizes the
 data for these indicators as they relate to the ecological condition
 of farmlands. The section then introduces additional indicators
 that relate to the EEAs of physical and chemical properties  of
 farmland soils and the hydrology and  geomorphology contribut-
 ing to  loss of soil from farmlands. Data are insufficient for nation-
 al reporting on indicators in three of the six categories of EEAs:
 biotic  condition, ecological processes, and natural disturbance
 regimes  (The Heinz Center, 2002).

 The following indicators presented in previous chapters relate to the
 ecological condition of farmlands:
 • According to the indicator Extent of Agricultural Land Uses
    (Chapter 3, Better Protected Land), croplands total 377 million
    acres. As of 1997, Conservation Reserve Program (CRP) lands
                                     totaled 32;million acres, excluding Alaska (USDA, NRCS, 2000).
                                     Between 1982 and 1997, cropland decreased 10.4 percent, from
                                     about 4211 million acres to nearly 377 million acres. Of this
                                     44-million 'acre decrease, however, 32.7 million acres are now
                                     enrolled in,the CRP, leaving an 11.3  mil(ion acre loss as a result
                                     of conversion of croplands to other land uses (USDA, NRCS,
                                     2000).
                                     Unfortunately, there is no single, definitive, accurate estimate of  ;
                                     the extent of cropland. Cropland is a flexible resource that is
                                     constantly.being taken in and out of production. In addition,
                                     estimates of the amount of land devoted to farming differ because
                                     different programs use different methoqs to acquire, define, and
                                     analyze their data. For example, The Heiinz Center report assesses;
                                     total cropland (including pasture and hayland) as covering
                                     between 430 and 500 million acres in [1997, or about a quarter of
                                     the total liind area in the U.S. (excluding Alaska). This report does
                                     not reconcile these differences, but does acknowledge that there
                                     are different estimates.                               \       !
                                    I The Farmland Landscape indicator (Cha 3ter 3, Better Protected
                                     Land) describes the degree to which croplands dominate the
                                     landscape and the extent to which oth£r land uses  are
                                     intermingled (The Heinz Center, 2002). Croplands comprise
                                     about half of the larger farmland ecosystems in the East and
                                     Southeast and almost three-quarters of the farmland ecosystems ;
                                     in the Midwest (The Heinz Center, 20Q2). The remainder of the
                                     farmland Ecosystems are forests in the;East, wetlands in the
                                     Southeast, and both forests and wetlands in the Midwest. In the  j
                                     West, about 60 percent of farmland ecosystems are cropland, with
                                     grasslands and shrublands dominating the remainder in the
                                     western arid northern Plains areas. Forests and
                                     grasslands/shrublands are about equal1 in the farmland landscape;
                                     for the non-cropland area of the Soutr) Central region. In many
                                     areas of the U.S., other land cover typ£s are almost as prevalent as
                                     croplands land can provide habitat for non-agronomic species.    !

                                    I The indicator Nitrate in Farmland, Forested, and Urban Streams and
                                     Ground Water (Chapter 2, Purer Water) shows the loss of nitrate
                                     from agricultural watersheds, usually indicating the extent to which
                                     nitrogen fertilizer is lost or animal manure reaches streams via runoff
                                     or ground water. Sampling in areas where agriculture is the primary
                                     land use found that about 50 percent of the 52 stream sites
                                     sampled and 45 percent of the ground yater wells sampled had
                                     nitrate concentrations greater than 2 p|W About 20 percent of the
                                     ground waiter sites and 10 percent of^tne stream sites sampled had
                                     nitrate concentrations exceeding the drinking water nitrate standard
                                     of 10 ppm.  These figures are much higher than the nitrate
                                     concentrations in forest streams (The hjeinz Center, 2002).

                                    n The indicator Phosphorus in Farmland, Forested, and Urban Streams'
                                     (Chapter 2, Purer Water), shows the Icjss of phosphorus from
                                     agricultural watersheds, again usually indicating losses from
                                     fertilizer Jind animal manures. Total phosphorus concentrations in
                                     farmland .streams were reported in foui" classes in the Heinz report:
                                     < 0.1 ppm, 0.1 -0.3  ppm, 0.3-0.5 ppm, and > 0.5  pprn (The Heinz
  5-26
5.3 What Is the Ecological Condition of Farmlands?       Chapter 5 -
Icologica
                                                                                                                   .1 Condition

-------


   Center, 2002). EPA has set new regional criteria for phosphorous
   concentration, ranging from 0.023 to 0.076 ppm, to protect
   streams in agricultural ecosystems from eutrophication. The
   criteria vary according to differences in ecoregions, soil types,
   climate, and land use. The Heinz Center (2002) reports that
   about 75 percent of farmland streams had phosphorous
   concentrations greater than 0.1 ppm, thus exceeding any of EPA's
   criteria for eutrophication. Fifteen percent had phosphorous
   concentrations equal to or exceeding 0.5 ppm (The Heinz Center,
   2002). Average phosphorous concentrations in farmland streams
   were similar to phosphorous concentrations .measured in  urban
   streams. As with nitrate concentrations, forest streams  had  lower
   phosphorous concentrations than farmland or urban streams.
 I The indicator Pesticides in Farmland Streams and Ground Water
   (Chapter 2, Purer Water), captures the extent to which chemical
   conditions in streams may exceed the tolerance limits for aquatic
   communities. All streams monitored by the National Water Quality
   Assessment (NAWQA) program in farmland areas had at least one
   pesticide at detectable 'levels throughout the year (The Heinz
   Center, 2002). About 75 percent of these streams had an average
   of five or more pesticides at detectable levels, and more than 80
   percent of the streams had at least one pesticide whose
   concentration exceeded the applicable aquatic life guideline.
   About 60 percent of ground water wells sampled in agricultural
   areas  had at least one pesticide at detectable levels. A relatively  .
   small number of these chemicals—specifically the herbicides
   atrazine (and its breakdown product desethylatrazine),
   metalachlor, cyanazine, and alachlor—accounted for most
   detections.

 I The Potential Pesticide Runoff from Farm Fields indicator (Chapter 3,
   Better Protected Land) identifies the potential for movement of
   agricultural pesticides by surface water runoff in watersheds
   nationwide, based on factors known to be important determinants
   of pesticide loss. These factors include:  1) soil characteristics,
   2) historical pesticide use, 3) chemical properties of the
   pesticides used, 4) annual rainfall and its relationship to runoff,
   and 5) major field crops grown. The indicator uses 1992 as  a
   baseline. Watersheds with high scores (i.e., the 4th quartile of
   runoff estimates) have a greater risk of pesticide contamination of
   surface water than do those with low scores (i.e., the  1 st quartile
   of runoff estimates). The highest potential for pesticide runoff is
   projected for the central U.S., primarily in the upper and lower
   Mississippi River valley and the Ohio  River valley. These areas are
   part of the "breadbasket" of the U.S., where pesticide application
   is  highest. Many of the western watersheds have not been
   assessed.

   The hydrologic attribute indicator Sediment Runoff Potential from
   Croplands and Pasturelands (Chapter 3, Better Protected Land),
   captures the loss of valuable soil from the farmland, sediment
   impacts to the physical habitat of farmland streams, and transport
   of many pollutants to downstream lakes, reservoirs, and estuaries.
   This indicator combines land cover, weather patterns, and soils
   information in a process model thatjncorporates hydrologic
   cycling, weather, sedimentation, crop growth, and agricultural
   management to estimate the amount of sediment that could
   potentially be delivered to rivers and streams in each watershed.
   The highest potential for sediment runoff is concentrated in the
   central U.S., predominately associated with the upper Mississippi
   River valley and the Ohio River valley. Most of the western U.S.
  region is characterized by low runoff potential.


The other three indicators in Exhibit 5-16, described on the following
pages, appear for the first time in this chapter.
Chapter 5 - tcological Condition    5.3 What Is the Ecological Condition of Farmlands?
                                                         5-27

-------

             Pesticide leaching potential - Category 2
 Retention of pesticides in their target areas maximizes pesticide
 efficiency and minimizes off-site contamination (Hellkamp, et al.,
 2000). Pesticide leaching not only can contaminate surface and
 ground water, but also can have both chronic and acute toxic
 effects on non-target organisms, such as fish, birds, and other
 wildlife. This leaching potential is affected by soil properties, rain-
 fall and runoff, pesticide chemistry, and other factors. The indica-
 tor was used as part of the NASS survey approach, so it has the
 potential for national application.

 What the Data Show

 During the 1994-1995 period, there were about 13.5 million
 acres of cropland in the Mid-Atlantic region (Hellkamp et al,
 2000). Although a large proportion of these 13.5 million acres
 had soils with properties conducive to pesticide leaching, the
 authors estimate that 50 percent (6.75 million acres) of the
 cropland received no pesticide application. Also, pesticides with
 moderately high to high leaching potentials were seldom  applied
 to croplands with highly to very highly leachable soils.
 Consequently, only about 1 million acres (less than 10 percent of
 the total cropland acreage) was at moderately high to high risk for
 loss of pesticides from the on-farm target area (Hellkamp, et al.,
 2000).
                                  Indicator Gaps and Limitations

                                  The limitations of this indicator include the following:
                                  • The pesticide leaching potential indicator has only been applied
                                    in the mid^Atlantic region and has not been tested or applied in
                                    other regions. It has the potential to be applied in other areas,
                                    but it will have to be adjusted for regional differences.
                                  • Data collection occurred only during 1994 and 1995.
                                  Data Source                  ;
                                             :                       ;  i       •         ,   -
                                  The data source for this indicator was the Mid-Atlantic Integrated
                                  Assessment Program, U.S. Environmental Protection Agency
                                  (1994-1995). (See Appendix B, page B|-fl, for more information.)
5-28
5.3 What Is the Ecological Condition of Farmlands?       Chapter 5 -
Ecological Condition

-------
                  Soil quality index - Category 2
     A Soil Quality Index (SQI) was developed and measured for
     agroecosystems in the mid-Atlantic region in 1994 and 1995
     (Hess, et al., 2000;  Hellkamp, et al., 2000). The SQI includes
     indicators of soil attributes, including physical (i.e., clay content,
     cation exchange capacity, base saturation), chemical  (i.e., PH,
     sodium adsorption ratio, total nitrogen, total carbon, organic car-
     bon/clay), and biological (i.e., microbial biomass). The SQI score
     is an average of eight numerical ratings (McQuaid and Olson,
     1998) (Hellkamp, et al., 2000). The high soil quality range
     begins at SQI scores of 2.4, while the  range of low SQI scores is
     from 0.0 to 1.6. While the SQI is an indicator of the  capacity of
     the soil to support plant growth and is related primarily to agri-
     cultural productivity,  it can also provide information on the
     capacity of the site to support non-agronomic plants.

     This indicator was used as part of the MASS survey approach, so
     it has the  potential for national application.

     What the Data Show
    SQI scores were obtained for the
    five-state mid-Atlantic region in
    1994 and 1995 (Hellkamp, et al.,
    2000) (Exhibit 5-17). In 1994, the
    mean SQI score was 2.23 (CI9 =
    2.17 to 2.29); in 1995, the mean
    SQI was 1.98 (CI = 1.73 to 2.23).
    The difference in SQI scores
    between 1994 and 1995 was due
    to different index calculation pro-
    cedures and sampling variability.
    SQI scores were lower in tilled soils
    compared with unfilled soils, such
    as hay fields,  in both 1994 and
    1995. Unfilled sites had higher
    microbial biomass values than con-
    ventional or reduced tillage sites in
    both years
Evaluation of the individual factors
related to the moderate SQI scores
indicated that cation exchange
capacity (1994), carbon (total
1994, organic 1995), and microbial
biomass (1995) had the lowest val-
ues (Hellkamp, et al., 2000).

     9The confidence interval (CI) of the mean is a range of values (interval)
with a known probability (confidence, in this case ,95 percent) of containing
the true population mean. The 1994 measured SQI scores are only a sample
                          Increasing the carbon content of soils might increase their capac-
                          ity to support plant growth. Retaining or adding crop residues to
                          the soils could increase both the carbon content and substrate
                          for microbial activity. Crop residues can also reduce soil erosion
                          and associated transport of nutrients and pesticides off the field.
                          Nutrients and pesticides contribute to negative effects on aquatic
                          receiving systems.

                          Indicator Caps and Limitations

                          Data are available only for the mid-Atlantic region for 2 years.
                          The indicator has the potential to be applied in other areas, but
                          it will have to be adjusted for regional differences.

                          Data  Source

                          The data source for this indicator was the Mid-Atlantic Integrated
                          Assessment Program, U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (1994-
                          1995). (See Appendix B,  page  B-41 for more information.)
                                                                                  "'«1
                                             I?I,9ji?^ri-t!lage systems
                                 Anligilai^iqQ^anfJ }$95_. ;
     1.5
r» nj
  
-------
	_-,-_.
 EFAs  Draft Report gn the Environmen
   Inaicafell
Soil
oil erosion
-Qb
                                                                          JSV
:egory.
                                                                                                 7
    Sediment resulting from soil erosion and transport is the greatest
    pollutant in aquatic ecosystems, both by mass and volume (EPA,
    OW, August 2002). Soil particles also can transport sorbed nutri-
    ents and pesticides and carry these into aquatic systems where
    these constituents contribute to water quality problems.
    Agricultural soil erosion decreases soil quality and can reduce soil
    fertility, and soil movement can make normal cropping practices
    difficult (The Heinz Center, 2002). Soil erosion and transport can
    occur both by wind and by water.

    Soil erosion estimates were calculated using the U.S. Geological
    Survey hydrologic unit codes watersheds (8-digit HUCs), National
     Resources Inventory soils data, the Universal Soil Loss Equation
     (Renard, etal., 1997), and the Wind Erosion Equation (Bondy, et
     al., 1980; Skidmore and Woodruff, 1968). Soil parameters were
     obtained from the USDA Natural Resources Conservation Service
     database.
                                                Indicator Gaps and Limitations

                                                This indicator provides estimates for the initiation of soil move-
                                                ment, not sediment transport or delivery 'off farmlands, which
                                                would require additional measurements and calculations. The dis-
                                                tance the soil particles are moved might lie considerable or mini-
                                                mal and cannot be determined from soil erosion estimates.
                                                 Data Sources
                                                 The data sources for this indicator were the National Resources
                                                 Inventory, U.S. Department of Agriculturj (1982-1997); and the
                                                 State Soil Geographic Database (STATSCO), U.S. Department of
                                                 Agriculture (1982-1997). (See Appendix) B, page B-42, for more
                                                 information.)
     What the Data Show

     The acreage of U.S. farmland with the greatest
     potential for wind erosion decreased by almost
     33 percent to about 63 million acres from 1982
     to 1997 (The Heinz Center, 2002)  (Exhibit
     5-18). This acreage represents about IS per-
     cent of the total cropland in the U.S. The
     acreage with the greatest potential for water
     erosion also decreased by about 33 percent to
     89 million acres, which represents about 22
     percent of U.S. cropland (The Heinz Center,
     2002). Reductions in erosion can occur through
     improved tilling or management practices, taking
      marginal land out of production, participation in
      the Conservation Reserve Program, or similar
      activities. These reductions not only can
      contribute to increased soil quality, but also
      improved water quality in adjacent and
      downstream aquatic ecosystems.
                                 	•	..lyyrKB^ft.	
                                 Exhibit 5-18: Crop ands most prone to erosion, IQ97 ;.
                                  :"":;	:	 :;	   Croplands ijj gsi prone to wind erosion , l"§97      ;/.  '} .  ^
                                                                                                 "l^Ssf
                                                                                       Each dot ec|uals
                                                                                       20,000 acres of
                                                                                       cropland that is
                                                                                       ,most prone to
                                                                                            erosion.
                                                                       X' i>

                                                                    _\_if
                                              UlCrpplands Kst prone to water erosion, KJK
                                                   :": Coverage: lower 48 stages. "j
                                                    ;, "I'S;:.™; «:3E ;w'3S irarann v
                                                    Note: data coyer cropland.
                                                                                        Each dot equals
                                                                                        20,000 acres of
                                                                                        cropland that is
                                                                                        most prone to
                                                                                        ;:w_ajer;erosipn.^,£

                                                                                  ;raffi:;1an<3s,"'l:iut'hot pasture'; - ;:'
                                                                      mJP!BSJWlWMww^m^lltD«j4^«to»^r^i4^'-^v-v? V.1 .^-''iL'!'' " ' ^
                                                                      Notion s Ecosystems. 2002. Data from the
     5-30
                                 5.3 What Is the Ecological Condition of Farmlands?       Ckapter 5 - Ecological Condition

-------
    Summary: The Ecological Condition of Farmlands

    Farmlands represent a significant portion of the landscape, but their
    ecological condition nationally, or even for most regions, is unknown.
    In a limited number of watersheds in which agricultural lands are the
    predominant land use, data indicate that concentrations of nitrate,
    phosphorus, and many contaminants are above levels of concern, but
    these data are not available for a representative sample of streams
   that could serve as a baseline for water quality management deci-
   sions for the entire U.S. No data for national indicators are available
   for three of the six essential ecological attributes, and  many of the
   indicators for the other EEAs relate primarily to crop or livestock
   production. Habitat  alteration and constituent loading from farm-
   lands represent some of the major stressors on other ecosystems
   (see Chapter'2, Purer Water, and Chapter 3, Better Protected Land,
   for discussion of specific stressors.)

   Landscape condition

   While there is no single, definitive, accurate estimate of the extent of
   cropland, it has been estimated to have decreased by 10.4 percent
   between 1982 and 199? from about 421 million acres to nearly
   377 million acres. Of this 44-million acre decrease, 32.7 million
  acres are now enrolled in the CRP, leaving an 11.3 million acre loss as
  a result of conversion of croplands to other land uses. The Heinz
  report assesses total cropland (including pasture and hayland) as
  covering between 430 and  500 million acres in 1997, or about a
  quarter of the total land area in the U.S. (excluding Alaska). In many
  areas of the U.S., other land cover types within croplands are almost
  as prevalent as croplands themselves and can provide habitat for
  non-agronomic species. For example, croplands comprise only half of
  the larger farmland ecosystems in the East and Southeast and about
  three-quarters of the farmland ecosystems in the Midwest. This situ-
  ation suggests that much of the farmland in the country supports
  more biodiversity and  associated ecological processes than if it were
  more completely monoculture. Indicators for fragmentation of farm-
  land landscapes by development and the shape of "natural" patches
  in farmland landscapes would be helpful additional indicators of
  landscape condition (The Heinz Center, 2002).


 Chemical and physical characteristics

 The physical and chemical characteristics of farmlands could provide
 information to measure national progress in controlling and manag-
 ing non-point source pollutant transport to receiving waters under
 EPA's clean water Government Performance and Results Act (GPRA)
 goal. Unfortunately, many of the indicators for physical and chemical
 characteristics are estimated based on land use, rather than on
 measurements of water quality. The National Water Quality
 Assessment (NAWQA)  program provides consistent and comparable
 information on nutrient and pesticide concentrations in streams in
 agricultural areas. The data show that nitrate and phosphorus con-
 centrations in farmland  streams are generally higher than in urban
 and suburban streams, and that more than 80 percent of the
    streams sampled had at least one pesticide whose concentration
    exceeded guidelines for protection of aquatic life. The sites sampled
    do not represent a probability sample and are too few to ensure that
    these data are representative of farmlands nationwide. Additional
    stream monitoring networks are required to assess the physical and
    chemical characteristics of streams in agricultural areas and the
    effectiveness of agricultural management practices for protecting or
    improving stream quality. A pesticide leaching potential indicator and a
   so/7 quality index indicate that only 10 percent of the soils in the mid-
   Atlantic region were highly leachable with respect to pesticides, and
   that soil quality was in the "moderate" range,  but the indicator has
   not been widely applied elsewhere.
   Hydrology and geomorphology
   Sediment Runoff results in loss of valuable soil from the farmland, sed-
   iment impacts to the physical habitat of farmland streams, and trans-
   port of many pollutants to downstream lakes, reservoirs, and estuar-
   ies. The highest potential for sediment runoff is concentrated in
   upper Mississippi River valley and the Ohio River valley. Most of the
   western U.S. region is characterized by low runoff potential. Between
   1982 and 1997, the acreage with the greatest potential for water
  erosion decreased by about 33 percent to 89 million acres, which
  represents about 22 percent of U.S. cropland. Wind can also erode
  soil. The acreage of U.S. farmland with the greatest potential for
  wind erosion decreased by almost 33 percent to about 63 million
  acres from 1982 to 1997, about 15 percent of the total cropland in
  the U.S. There were no indicators of hydrology available for either
  surface or ground water associated with  agricultural ecosystems.
  Modification or elimination of wetlands and riparian areas con-
  tributes to hydrologic alteration of farmlands, as does agricultural
  irrigation, primarily in the western states. This consumption affects
  not only surface water through irrigation return flows, but also
  ground water through depletion of aquifers. Both water quantity and
  quality can be affected in farmlands. No national, representative
  monitoring programs exist for either the quantity or quality of water
  in farmlands.

 No  Category 1  or 2 indicators were available for this report for biot-
 ic condition, ecological processes, or natural disturbance regimes. The
 Heinz Center (2002) suggested that several indicators could be
 promising: soil biological condition, status of animal species in farm-
 land areas, native vegetation in areas dominated by cropland, and
 stream habitat quality. An indicator of ant diversity and wildlife habi-
 tat also was developed and tested in the mid-Atlantic region by the
 Mid-Atlantic Integrated Assessment Program (MAIA). Data are insuf-
 ficient, however,  to report on agroecosystems nationally for any of
 these indicators  (Hellkamp, et al., 2000; The Heinz  Center, 2002). A
 particular problem in farmlands is establishing appropriate reference
 conditions for biological structure and ecosystem function measures
 (The Heinz Center, 2002). Agricultural systems are highly managed
ecosystems, so no natural reference exists. It would be unrealistic to
expect fish and invertebrate communities in farmlands to be compa-
rable to relatively undisturbed forest or grassland ecosystems.
Chapter 5 - Ecological  Condition    5.3 What Is the Ecological Condition of Farmlands?
                                                                                                                            5-31

-------
5.U    What Is  the



Ecological  Condition  or



Grasslands and  Scrublands f

Grasslands and shrublands include lands in which the dominant veg-
etation is grasses or other non-woody vegetation, or where shrubs
and scattered trees are typical (The Heinz Center, 2002). This
ecosystem type includes chaparral, deserts, mountain shrublands,
range lands, Florida grasslands, and non-cultivated pastures.
Grasslands and shrublands also can be used for grazing, so some
land use summaries may include them in estimates of farmlands.
Grasslands and shrublands include lands revegetated naturally or
 artificially to provide a non-crop plant cover that is managed like
 native vegetation. The vast majority of grasslands and shrublands
 occur in the western U.S. Collectively, these ecosystems constitute
 over one-third of the area in the conterminous U.S.

 Environmental issues associated with grassland and shrubland
 ecosystems include introduction of non-native and invasive species,
 desertification, ground water depletion, and overgrazing. Several fed-
 eral agencies (e.g., Bureau of Land Management, Forest Service,
 National Park Service) have responsibility for the majority of publicly
 owned grasslands and shrublands.

  Ecological indicators used in this report for grassland and shrubland
  ecosystems are listed in Exhibit 5-19. The Heinz report serves as the
  primary source of information for this ecological resource (The Heinz
  Center, 2002). The following indicators presented in previous chap-
  ters relate to the ecological condition of grasslands and shrublands:

  • The Extent of Grasslands and Shrublands indicator (Chapter 3,
    Better Protected Land) reveals that grasslands and shrublands
    occupy about 861 million acres or just over one-third of the land
    area in the conterminous U.S. states. Alaska contains about 205
    million acres of grasslands and shrublands.
• Number/Duration of Dry Stream Flow Periods in Grasslands and
  Shrublands (Chapter 2, Purer Water) is ajn important indicator of
  the hydrology of grasslands and shrublahds. This indicator shows
  that the percentage of no-flow periods jias decreased in all
  grassland and shrubland regions of the West (The Heinz Center,
  2002). The percentage of no-flow periods was similar in 1950 and
  1960 and then decreased in the 1970s, 1980s, and 1990s. The
  1980s was- a relatively wet period and experienced some of the
  smallest percentages of no-flow period^ over the 50-year period
  on record. W duration of zero-flow periods also decreased
  during the'period from the 1970s throijgh the 1990s, compared
  to the 1950s and 1960s (The Heinz Center, 2002).
                                  • ' !                      \

 The two biotic structure indicators in Exhibit 5-19, described on the
 following pages, appear for the first time jn this chapter: At-Risk
 Native Species and Population Trends of Invasive and Native, Non-inva-

 sive Birds.                            I
    5-32
                                 5.3 What Is the Ecological Condition of Farmlands?      Chapter! 4 - Ecological Condition

-------
             lecnn
                            nrca
b/oGuraent

                              - Exhibit 5-19= Grasslands and snruDiands indicators
  Landscape Composition
  Landscape Structure/Pattern
 Biotic Condition
  Ecosystems and Communities
                                               At-risk native grassland and shrubland species
                                       Population trends in invasive and native non-invasive bird species
                                                                                                       NatureServe
                                                                                                           DOI
  Species and Populations
  Organism Condition
 Ecological Processes

  Energy Flow
  Material Flow
1— Chemical and Physical Characteristics
  Nutrient Concentrations
  Other Chemical Parameters
  Trace Organics and Inorganics
  Physical Parameters
t Hydrology and Geomorphology
  Surface and Ground Water Flows
                                               Number/duration of dry stream flow periods in
                                               grasslands/shrublands
                                                                                                           DOI
  Dynamic Structural Conditions
  Sediment and Material Transport
  Natural Disturbance Regimes
  Frequency
  Extent
  Duration
Chapter 5 - tcological (Condition    5.4 What Is the Ecological Condition of Grasslands and Shrublands?
                                                                                                                       5-33

-------
                                       £^^
                                                                                         ^isten^^ife
                At-risR native grassland and snrubland species - C-ategpry 2
                                                                                                                       i
   Native species contribute substantially to the goods and services
   provided by grasslands and shrublands. These species have
   evolved in and adapted to the reange of environmental conditions
   that has occurred in grassland and shrubland ecosystems over
   thousands of years. While species extinction is a natural geologic
   phenomenon, the extinction of species has increased over the
   past 100 years (Vitousek, et al., 1997), and many ecologists
   believe that ecosystem function and resilience is related to biodi-
   versity (Naeem, et al,, 1999), so that preserving biodiversity is
   critical for sustainable ecosystems. Whether or not this is always
   the case10 many people believe that more species is preferable to
   fewer species.

   What the  Data Show

   About 3.5 percent of native grassland and shrubland animal
   species are critically imperiled, 6 percent are imperiled, and
   0.5 percent are or might be extinct (The Heinz Center, 2002)
   (Exhibit 5-20). When vulnerable species (7 percent) are counted,
                  I:
                  I1!
                  I	•
                    txnibit 5-2O: 7\t-risk native grassland e nd snrubland
                               species, by risk category, 20f)0
                                                  about 17 percent of grassland and shrubland animal species are
                                                  considered "at risk."                   •
                                                                                    :  i
                                                  Indicator Gaps and Limitations

                                                  The data for this indicator are not from aisije-based monitoring pro-
                                                  gram, but rather from a census approach that focuses on the loca-
                                                  tion and distribution of at-risk species. Determining whether species
                                                  are naturally rare or have been depleted is currently not possible. It
                                                  is not clear that trends can be quantified with any precision.

                                                  Data Source                  |
                                                                                      i
                                                  The data source for this indicator was Thk State of the Nation's
                                                  Ecosystems, The  Heinz Center, 2002, using data from
                                                  NatureServe Explorer database. (See Appendix B, page  Ei-42, for
                                                  more information.)                    '
         ™j->lt  {  iff


             1     "I

                   i
                          1     Partial Indicator Data: Grassland and
                      "D
                     ;; c
                              25
      ,=!i
      	::: (j  O.
      •F :1|IOI!!&'
                              20-
                      = ' "'   1C.
                      ^S -T-I   I -J
                         c
                         ro
                              10-
                                                  H
                                           tftj
                                          2000
   Extinct
   Critically
   Imperiled
   Imperiled
   Vulnerable
   All At-Risk
                                                                                    \  J
                                                   Future
                                                '"    j.
          Coverage: all 50 states.
     |    Source: The Heinz Center. The State dfthe Nation's E&jsystems. 2002.
     Is   Data from NatureServe and its Natural Heritage member
                                              '  '  '•'
                                                                                    ams.
             f  t t
          ,,  f  I *

           ,1  J
                   a

           \j* ft  L A4tu«lK
  '"An ongoing debate exists within the scientific community on the importance of species diversity in sustaining ecosystem function (Tilman and Downing.
      1994; Crime, 1997; Hodgson, et al., 1998; Wardle, et al., 2000)
5-34
5.4 What Is the Ecological Condition of Grasslands and Shrublands?
Chapter 5 - Ecological Conditi
dition

-------


                topulation trends of invasive and native, non-invasive birds - Category 1

    Bird species are mobile and can respond quickly to environmental
    change (The Heinz Center, 2002). The Heinz report uses an indi-
    cator of population trends in invasive and non-invasive birds to
    determine if invasive bird species are increasing more than other
    bird populations (The Heinz Center, 2002). Invasive species are
    defined as non-native species (species that are not native to
    North America or that are now found outside their historic range)
    that spread aggressively. Some invasive bird species increase when
    the landscape becomes more fragmented or stress on the ecologi-
    cal system increases. The invasive species considered for grassland
    and shrublands are believed to be indicative of agricultural conver-
    sion, landscape fragmentation due to suburban and rural develop-
    ment, and the spread of exotic vegetation (The Heinz Center,
    2002). Native, non-invasive species are considered to reflect rela-
    tively intact, high-quality native grasslands and shrublands (The
    Heinz Center, 2002).

   What  the Data  Show

   Since the late 1960s, invasive and non-invasive bird species
   increased in similar proportions until the period 1996 to 2000,
   when invasive species increased significantly (The Heinz Center,
   2002) (Exhibit 5-21). This increase might represent a short-term
   fluctuation in bird populations, or it could be a sign of changing
   ecosystem condition. Continued monitoring of bird populations
                                  and indicators in other essential ecological attributes is required
                                  to evaluate these changes.

                                  Indicator Caps and  Limitations

                                  The limitations of this indicator include the following:
                                  • The calculation method could mask increases or decreases in
                                    particular species. The two groups of birds contain species that
                                    differ in their habitats, relative abundance, and range, and bird
                                    populations normally fluctuate from year to year. If half the
                                    species in one of the groups were to increase and the other half
                                    to decrease over a given period, no consistent change would
                                    appear for that group (The  Heinz Center, 2002).
                                  • The recent period of change is too short to provide an
                                    indication of a possible increasing trend in invasive bird species.

                                  Data Source

                                  The data source for this indicator was the Breeding Bird Survey,
                                  U.S. Geological Service (1966-2000). (See Appendix B,
                                  page B-42, for more information.)
                         If"
                                         txnibit 5-21: Topulation tiends of invasive and
                                            native, non-invasive birds, 1966-2OOO
                            TOO
                             80
                         feo  60
40
                             20
                              O
                                                                  Tl


                                                                   *

                                                                   «
                                   rilli    i
                                                                                    Native,
                                                                                    non-invasive
                                                                                    Invasive
                               t1966- 1971- 1976- 1981-  1986- 1991- 1996-
                                 1970  1975  1980 1985,  1990  1995" 2000

                         |g5verage:^elected grassland and shrubland areas.
                         gpoprce: The Heinz Center. The State of the Nation's Ecosystems. 2002. Data from the
                                           ', Breeding Bird Survey; analysis by W. Mark Roberts.
Chapter 5 - Ecological Condition     5.4 What Is the Ecological Condition of Grasslands and Shrublands?
                                                                                      5-35

-------
         '!	fr	irrs	;ni^^^^^^^^^^^           ill"	mftsil
          	Urait	Report	;Q^^
BlimlMllillillllllBlllilllilllllllllliiiBllillllllillli BilBBBIBB ••••liilllllliilftiliilliliii •••••••iMiiiBiiii""'i"»^i»«ii«iiiBlliiil'HPiiHEmm"m"i"Lffili"™i


  Summary: The Ecological Condition of Grasslands and

  jnrublanas

  Grassland and shrubland ecosystems are at risk from the introduc-
  tion of non-native and invasive species, desertification, ground water
  depletion, and overgrazing. Few ecological indicators are currently
  being measured at a national or regional scale, and this situation is
  unlikely to change in the near future, so the overall ecological condi-
  tion of the nation's grasslands and shrublands is and will remain
  effectively unknown.

  Landscape condition
  The extent of grasslands and shrublands can be estimated from
  National Land Cover Database (NLCD) information. Grasslands
  and shrublands occupy about 861 million acres or just over one-
  third of the land area in the conterminous U.S. Alaska contains about
  205 million acres of grasslands and shrublands. This is  a diverse
  group of ecosystems, however, ranging from Florida grasslands to the
  Mohave desert, and land use information is not readily available for
  all of them.
   Biotic condition
   At-risk native species and population trends in invasive and non-inva-
   sive birds are two indicators that can provide information on the sta-
   tus of, and change in, biotic condition. About 3.5 percent of native
   grassland and shrubland animal species are critically imperiled,
   6 percent are imperiled, and 0.5 percent are or might be extinct.
   When vulnerable species (7 percent) are counted, about 17  percent
   of grassland and shrubland animal species are considered "at risk."
   However, there is no context in which to interpret the at-risk native
   species data. The proportion of species that would naturally be rare
   is unknown. Invasive species are believed to be  indicative of agricul-
   tural conversion, landscape fragmentation due to suburban and rural
   development, and the spread of exotic vegetation, whereas native,
   non-invasive species are considered to reflect relatively intact, high-
   quality native grasslands and shrublands. Until  recently, invasive and
   non-invasive bird species have changed in similar proportions, but
   from 1996  to 2000, invasive species increased significantly. This
   might be a  short-term fluctuation in bird populations, or it could be
   a sign of changing ecosystem condition. Information on stream biota
   in grasslands and shrublands are needed to be able to assess the
   condition of grassland and shrubland streams,  especially as it may be
   affected by grazing.
                                                   Hydrology and geomorphology

                                                   Periods of no !flow can certainly be stressfiil to aquatic communities
                                                   of grasslands and shrublands, and may ind cate harm to the vegeta-
                                                   tion during drought periods. The Number/Duration of Dry Stream Flow
                                                   Periods indicator has decreased in all grassland and shrubtand regions!
                                                   of the West. The percentage of no-flow periods was similar in 1950 >
                                                   and 1960 and then decreased in the 19^0s, 1980s, and 1990s. The |
                                                   duration of zero-flow periods also decreased during the period from
                                                   the 1970s through the 1990s, compared to the 1950s and 1960s.  ',
                                                   Currently, dry stream flow periods are nbtj monitored nationally.
                                                                                         i                 •       '.
                                                   There were no Category 1 or 2 indicators available for this report for
                                                   ecological processes, physical and chemical c laracteristics, or natural
                                                   disturbance regimes for grasslands and shrublands.
    5-36
5.4 What Is the Ecological Condition of Grasslands and Shrublands?       Chapter 5 - Ecological Condition

-------
5.5  What  Is the Ecological
Condition of Urban and
juouroan Areas?
                                                          Urban and suburban ecosystems are areas where the majority of the
                                                          land is devoted to or dominated by buildings, houses, roads, con-
                                                          crete, grassy lawns, or other elements of human use and construc-
                                                          tion (The Heinz Center, 2002). Urban ecosystems are highly built-up
                                                          and paved over, resulting in more rapid changes in temperature,
                                                          runoff, and other variables than in more natural ecosystems. Plant
                                                          and animal life is heavily influenced by species introduced in horti-
                                                          culture and as pets, and native plant species might be more or less
                                                          completely removed from large areas and replaced by lawns, gardens,
                                                          and ornamentals (WRI, 2000). These areas generally show high lev-
                                                          els of many air and water pollutants because of the concentration of
                                                          pollutant sources in small areas. Nonetheless, substantial biodiversity
                                     Exhibit 5-22: Urban and suburban ind
*•

essential ecological AttriDute . ~+~-^=~-
j Landscape Condition
f 	 . 	 — 	 	 •• • 	 ' -nrr,,. ,.nnrlf»rT . .,
S Extent of Ecological System/Habitat Type
Landscape Composition
Landscape Structure/Pattern
f Biotic Condition
s: Ecosystems and Communities
E Species and Populations
I Organism Condition
S Ecological Processes
m -
E: Energy flow
£ Material Flow
: Chemical and Physical Characteristics
i: Nutrient Concentrations
i!
| Other Chemical Parameters
| Trace Organics and Inorganics
*
. Physical Parameters
1 Hydrology and Geomorphology
t Surface and Ground Water Flows'
1 Dynamic Structural Conditions
: Sediment and Material Transport
Natural Disturbance Regimes
A Frequency
? Extent
5 Duration

•••••••••••••ill i ,., 	 	 	 ,„,,,„,,, ,_„.,..„. 	 	 	
•feiiiiiiiiiiiSiS^ 'H " i"

Extent of urban and suburban lands
Patches of forest, grassland, shrubland, and wetland in
urban/suburban areas









Nitrate in farmland, forested and urban streams and ground water
Phosphorus in farmland, forested and urban streams

Chemical contamination in urban streams and ground water
Ambient concentrations of ozone, 8-hour and 1 -hour












1
•














HI











'J:ijj»!jfc*
2

•









•
•

•












|^M|E^W^liHg

USDA
DOI









DOI
DOI

DOI
EPA









Giapter 5 - Ecological Condition    5.5 What Is the Ecological Condition of Urban and Suburban Areas?
                                                                                                      5-37

-------
EiVKs Draft feJDbrt dri the  Envirofjrrfent 2^^g
 can remain in these systems; for example, a 1993 survey identified
 115 bird species in Washington, DC (Hadidian, et al., 1997).

 There is substantial interest in understanding urban and suburban
 ecosystems, as evidenced by two urban National Science Foundation
 long-term ecological research sites (Phoenix and Baltimore), a pro-
 fessional journal, Urban Ecosystems and a number of recent writings
 on the subject (Pickett, et al., 2001; Kinzig and Grove, 2001; Grimm,
 et al., 2002). Much of urban ecosystems research is aimed not at
 preserving natural ecosystems, but at "smart growth" and under-
 standing how to enhance ecosystem services in a highly built envi-
 ronment Despite the growing amount of research, the entire science
 of urban ecosystem ecology is not sufficiently developed to have a
 substantial number of ecological indicators. In addition, there may be
 a lack of understanding regarding what to expect when applying indi-
 cators typically used in less built-up land cover classes to urban and
 suburban ecosystems. The Heinz report lists eight indicators for
 urban and suburban ecosystems, only two of which have adequate
 data for national reporting.

 Indicators for urban and suburban ecosystems used in this report are
 listed in Exhibit S-22, grouped according to essential ecological
 attributes. Extent and chemical and physical condition data are the
 most widely available. There were no indicators for biotic condition,
 ecological processes, hydrology and geomorphology, or natural dis-
 turbance regimes for urban and  suburban ecosystems suitable for
 national or even regional reporting (The Heinz Center, 2002).

 This section summarizes data related to urban and suburban ecosys-
 tems for five indicators, most of them relating to pollutant concen-
 trations, that appear in earlier chapters. The section then introduces
  one indicator that appears for the first time in this report—Patches
  of Forest, Grassland, Shrubland, and Wetland in Urban/Suburban
 Areas—which relates to the landscape essential ecological attribute.

  The following indicators presented in previous chapters relate to the
  ecological condition of urban and suburban areas:
  m The indicator Extent of Urban and Suburban Lands (Chapter 3,
    Better Protected Land) was assessed using the National Land
    Cover Database and estimating the proportion of the area in
    1,000 foot pixels that fell into one of four developed land cover
    types: low-intensity residential; high-intensity residential;
    commercial-industrial-transportation; or urban and recreational
    grasses (The Heinz Center, 2002). In 1992, urban and suburban
    areas occupied about 32 million acres in the conterminous U.S. or
    about 1.7 percent of the total land area (The Heinz Center,
     2002). As with the estimate of the extent of farmlands, urban and
    suburban areas are defined differently by different organizations,
     sometimes using different data sources, thus affecting the area
     estimates. For example, the Extent of Developed Lands indicator in
     Chapter 3, Better Protected  Land is based on USDA National
     Resources Inventory delineation of developed lands, which is
     about 98 million acres in the conterminous U.S., or about 4.3
                                                   percent of the total land area of the li.si, not including Alaska
                                                   (see Chapter 3, Better Protected Land).;

                                                   The indicator Ambient Concentrations ofQzone, 8-hour and 1-hour
                                                   (Chapter 1J Cleaner Air) revealed that irj 1999, about 55 percent
                                                   of the urban and suburban monitoring stations had high ozone
                                                   concentrations on 4 or more days, and jhat the percentage
                                                   fluctuated between 35 percent and 60 percent during the  1990s
                                                   (The Heinz'Center, 2002). The number|of sites with 10 days or-
                                                   more of high ozone fluctuated between  J20 and 30 percent of the
                                                   sites, with no apparent trend, but the njimber of sites v/ith high   ,
                                                   ozone on 25 days or more decreased from about 10 percent to
                                                   around 5 percent over the decade. Fluctuations are caused in part
                                                   by changes in the weather. As noted in {he section on forests,
                                                   biomonitoring plots frequently reveal at least some ozone damage
                                                   to tree leaves.                        j

                                                  I The indicator Nitrate in Farmland, Forested, and Urban Streams and
                                                    Ground Water (Chapter 2, Purer Water),
                                                    21  streams in which the predominant \i
shows that 40 percent of
nd use was urban and
                                                    suburban had nitrate concentrations above 1.0 ppm; 25 percent
                                                    had concentrations below 0.5 ppm; and 3 percent had
                                                    concentrations below 0.1 ppm (The Heinz Center, 2002).
                                                    Concentrations of nitrate in these urban streams were generally
                                                    lower than those of agricultural watersheds, but higher than those
                                                    in forested watersheds.

                                                   I The indicator Phosphorus in Farmland, Forested, and Urban Streams
                                                    (Chapter 2, Purer Water) showed that two-thirds of 21 urban    ;
                                                    streams sampled had phosphorus concentrations of at least
                                                    0.1 ppm, a level usually associated with excess algal growth (The
                                                    Heinz Center, 2002). About 10 percent of the urban streams had
                                                    concentrations of at least 0.5 ppm.   ,

                                                   I According to the indicator Chemical Contamination in Streams and •
                                                    Ground Water (Chapter 2, Purer Water}, 85 percent of 21  urban
                                                    streams sampled had an average of ab(j>ut five detectable
                                                    contaminants throughout the year  (Th|e Heinz Center, 2002). All
                                                    of the streams had at least one chemicjal that exceeded guidelines
                                                    'for the protection of aquatic life. For rtjany urban and suburban
                                                    streams, the nutrient and contaminant signature is similar to the
                                                    signatures; from agroecosystems (The Heinz Center, 2002;
                                                    Wickhanvetal., 2002).             '
                                                  The following indicator, Patches of Forest, ^Grassland, Shrubland, and .
                                                  Wetland in Urban/Suburban Areas, provides data on landscape condi-
                                                  tion in urbaii and suburban areas.       .                       .
   5-38
5.5 What Is the Ecological Condition of Urban and Suburban Areas?     Chapter 5 •  Ecological  Condition

-------


               Fatcnes of forest, grassland, shrubland, and wetland in urban /suburban areas - Category 2
   Patches of forest, grassland, shrubland, and wetland in urban/sub-
   urban areas provide habitat for birds, amphibians, and small mam-
   mals. They also increase water infiltration and reduce  temperature
   by evapotranspiration. Patches of urban and suburban vegetation
   generally reduce  particulate matter, and they can increase or
   decrease ozone concentrations, relative to  built surfaces (Nowak,
   et al., 2000). According to The Heinz Center (2002), the size of
   patches of undeveloped land in urban and  suburban areas is
   important, with smaller patches generally considered to provide
   poorer quality habitat. Recent studies have indicated a significant
   loss of forest patch coverage in Atlanta and Baltimore in the last
   several decades (American Forests, 2001, 2002).

   What the Data Show

   Around half of the undeveloped land in urban and suburban areas
   occurs in patches smaller than 10 acres (Exhibit 5-23). Urban and
   suburban areas in the Northeast have the largest percentage of
   large (1,000 to 10,000 acres) patches of undeveloped land.
   Patches of undeveloped land larger than 10,000 acres occur only
   in urban and suburban areas of the West.
                                        Indicator Gaps and Limitations

                                        Several limitations are associated with this indicator:

                                        • Natural patches may extend beyond the boundary of the
                                          "urban and suburban area" land use class, which would cause
                                          the size of the patches to be undere'stimated.
                                        • Very small patches are difficult to distinguish if they are mixed
                                          with developed classes, which also leads to underestimates.
                                        • Remote sensing cannot distinguish between land that has
                                          always been "non-urban" and patches, such as landfills, that
                                          have reverted to grasslands or forest.

                                        • Patch size is not the only factor that contributes to habitat
                                          quality (The Heinz Center, 2002).


                                        Data Source

                                        The data source for this indicator was the National Land Cover
                                        Database, Multi-Resolution Land Characterization Consortium
                                        (1990s). (See Appendix B, page B-43, for more information.)
                              txnibit 5-23: Fatcnes of forest, grassland, snrubland, and
                                      wetland in urban and suburban areas, 1992
                   fct-o.
 100

  80

  60

  40

 ^20

   0
, „ _ Northeast     South      Midwest

     Coverage: lower 48 states
Less than 10
acres

10 to 100 acres
100 to 1,000
acres   ;

1,000 to 10,000
acres : .

Greater than
10,000 acres
                                                                     West
                             Source: The Heinz Center. The State of the Nation's Ecosystems. 2002. Data from
                             Multi-Resolution Land Characteristics Consortium, and the USCS Earth Resources
                             Observations Systems Data Center.
Cnapter 5 - Ecological Condition    5.5 What Is the Ecological Condition of Urban and Suburban Areas?
                                                                                             5-39

-------
Summary: The Ecological Condition of Urban and Suburban
Ecosysten
ems
Urban and suburban systems have been the subject of increasing
ecological interest, but their overall condition, nationally or even
regionally, is virtually unknown.

Landscape condition
Within the technical limitations of using remote sensing data to
define urban and suburban ecosystems and the landscape patches
they contain, The Heinz Center (2002) has established a baseline
against which to judge current trends in urbanization. In 1992, urban
and suburban areas occupied  about 32 million acres in the contermi-
nous U.S. or about 1.7 percent of the total land area, but different
organizations, sometimes using different data sources, produce dif-
ferent estimates. For example, USDA National Resources Inventory
delineation of developed lands, estimates there to be about
98 million acres in the conterminous U.S., or about 4.3 percent of
the total land area of the U.S., not including Alaska  (see Chapter 3,
Better Protected Land), However, there is currently no firm plan in
place to collect the remote sensing data in the future to allow trends
to be calculated. Although the land use indicators identified provide
some useful information on extent, they do not address the actual
condition of those lands. Given the concentration of the human
population in developed areas of the country, a better understanding
of the interaction among humans and their developed environment
could help improve human health and the effects of developed lands
on ecological condition.

Chemical and physical characteristics
Chemical data from the NAWQA program used to develop the
stream quality indicator in this report and the Heinz report (2002)
include only 21 urban streams across the entire U.S. Nitrate and
phosphorus concentrations in these streams were intermediate
between farmlands and forest streams, but all of them had at least
one chemical that exceeded guidelines for the protection of aquatic
life. Given the numerous factors that can affect these systems,
21 streams are not likely to be an adequate baseline against which
to track the progress of environmental protection activities, including
stormwater management, controls on non-point source pollution
from lawns, golf courses, and  septic systems, with any statistical cer-
tainty. An indicator of the extent of impervious surfaces might be
useful for inferring non-point source pollution impacts.

There were no  Category 1 or 2 indicators available for this for biotic
condition, ecological processes, or  natural disturbance regimes. The
Heinz Center (2002)  identified several indicators that could be
promising but for which there are not even regional data:
• An indicator that would report on the percentage of urban and
   suburban areas in which <25 percent, 25 to 50 percent, 50 to
   75 percent,  and >75 percent of the original species had been
   lost or displaced.
 i An indicator that would report on the nbmber of nuisance species
  in urban and suburban areas (e.g., white-tailed deer, kudzu).

• Fish Index of Biotic Integrity (IBI) and N/ acroinvertebrate Biotic
  Integrity Index (MBII) indicators in urba i/suburban streams.
• An indicator that would report on the c average of stream bank-
  vegetation.                          i

The lack of mational biotic indicators for uhban fresh water systems
makes it particularly difficult to measure national progress in main-
taining balanced communities in urban streams.
                                    :  I
A particular problem in urban and suburban systems is establishing
appropriate reference conditions for biplo'gical structure and ecosys-
tem function measures (The Heinz Centen 2002). For example,
expecting fish and invertebrate communities in urban streams to be
typical of relatively undisturbed forest or grassland ecosystems
would be unrealistic. Data are insufficient bn both the current status
of species and the original species presenj: to calculate the number
of native species lost. As another example! an indicator tracking
national trends in urban stream buffers would be particularly helpful
to states tracking the effectiveness of watershed management pro-
grams. However, a decision would be needed on a threshold for
buffer strips of adequate width to protect stream channels, and fur- •
ther development of satellite measurements would be needed before
such an indicator could be used for national reporting.

A potentially'useful hydrology/geomorph
-------


    5.6   What  Is  the

    Ecological  Condition  of

    Fresh Waters?
    Fresh waters include wetlands, lakes.and-reservoirs, and streams and
    rivers. Wetlands are areas where saturation with water is the domi-
                                                            nant factor determining the types of plant and animal communities.
                                                            Wetlands vary widely because of differences in soils, topography, cli-
                                                            mate, hydrology, water chemistry, vegetation, and other factors. Two
                                                            general categories of wetlands are recognized: coastal (tidal) wet-
                                                            lands and inland (non-tidal) wetlands. Wetlands have been threat-
                                                            ened by outright loss and conversion from one type to another, but
                                                            programs.designed to restore or enhance wetlands, such as the'
                                                            Wetlands Reserve Program, as well as state, local, and private initia-
                                                            tives on agricultural lands, have resulted in reduced losses
                                                            (see Chapter 2, Purer Water).
                                                           The U.S. contains more than 3.7 million miles of streams and rivers
||^----:--^^^                                                    of a" these strea"i mites are found in small, head-
S^ivV^^V,^^
                                                                            licators
           ^Landscape Condition
           Extent of Ecological System/Habitat Types
                                  Wetland extent and change
           Landscape Composition
                                            Altered fresh water ecosystems
           Landscape Structure/Pattern
           Biotic Condition
           Ecosystems and Communities
                                            Non-native fresh water fish species
                                            Animal deaths and deformities
                                                     water plant communities
                                            Fish Index of Biotic Integrity in streams
                                               oinvertebrate Biotic Integrity Index for streams
          Species and Populations
                                            At-risk native fresh water species
        |j Organism Condition
        =
                                            Contaminants in fresh water fish
           cologicaf Processes
                ar and Physical Characteristics
        3 Nutrient Concentrations
                                           Phosphorus in large rivers
                                           Lake Trophic State Index
          Trace Organic and Inorganic Chemicals
                                           Chemical contamination in streams
          Other Chemical Parameters
                                           Acid sensitivity in lakes and streams
          Physical Parameters
                nd Ground Wate
                Structural C
Oiapter 5- Ecological Condition          S.6 What is the Ecological Condition of Fresh Waters?
                                                                                                                           5-4T

-------An error occurred while trying to OCR this image.

-------
                              J?^
  11,076 Northeast lakes sampled as part of the EPA EMAP during
  summers from 1991 to 1994 using the Lake Trophic State Index. It
  was found that 37.9 percent (±8.4 percent)12 of the lakes were
  oligotrophic (TP<10 ppb), 40.1 percent (±. 9.7 percent) were
  mesotrophic (1060 ppb) (Peterson, et al., 1998).
 i The indicator Chemical Contamination in Streams and Ground Water
  (Chapter 2, Purer Water), revealed that all the streams sampled by
  the NAWQA program had one or more contaminants at detectable
  levels throughout the year, and 85 percent had five or more  (The
  Heinz Center, 2002).13 Three-fourths of the streams tested had one
  or more contaminants that exceeded aquatic life guidelines. One-  .
  fourth of the streams exceeded the standards for four or more
  contaminants. Nearly all of the stream sediments tested had an
  average of five or more contaminants (PCBs, polycyclic aromatic
  hydrocarbons [PAHs], other industrial chemicals and trace elements)
  at detectable levels, and half had one or more contaminants that
  exceeded aquatic life guidelines. Half of the fish tested had at least
  five contaminants (PCBs, organochlorine pesticides, and trace
  elements) at detectable levels, and approximately the same number
  had one or more contaminants at levels that exceeded the aquatic
  life guidelines (The Heinz Center, 2002).14

  The indicator Acid Sensitivity in Lakes and Streams (Chapter  2,
  Purer Water) is affected by the natural buffering capacity of the
  soil and the rate of acid deposition from the atmosphere. The
  National Surface Water Survey (NSWS) (Landers, et al., 1988;
  Linthurst, et al., 1986; Messer, et al., 1986, 1988) determined that
  4.2 percent of the NSWS lakes and 2.7 percent of NSWS streams
  were acidic (Acid Neutralizing Capacity <0  u,eq/L) (Baker, et al.,
  1991). Almost 20 percent (19.1 percent) of NSWS lakes and
  11.8 percent of NSWS streams were susceptible to acidic
  deposition (ANC< SO jieq/L)  (Baker, et al., 1991 ).ls Of the acidic
  NSWS lakes, 75 percent were classified as acidic from acid
  deposition, 22  percent were organic acid dominated, and
  3 percent were acidic from watershed sulfur sources. Of the acidic
  stream reaches, 70 percentjvere acidic from acid deposition,
  29 percent were organic acid dominated, and  1  percent were
  acidic from watershed sulfur sources (Baker, et al., 1991).

  These surveys have been repeated periodically for smaller
  probability samples of lakes in the Northeast, the Adirondacks,
  and streams in the Appalachians (Stoddard, et al., 1996). More
  intensive monitoring also has been conducted on lakes in the
  Northeast, the  Appalachians, and the Midwest, and on streams in
  the Appalachian Plateau and Blue Ridge to assess long-term
  acidification trends (Stoddard, et al.,  1998). Based on these
  and wildlife habitat, disrupt patterns and timing of water flows, act
  as barriers to animal movement, or reduce or increase natural
  filtering of sediment and pollutants. The indicator Altered Fresh
  Water Ecosystems (Chapter 2, Purer Water), reveals that 23 percent
  of the banks of both rivers and streams (riparian areas) and lakes
  and reservoirs have either croplands or urban development in the
  narrow area immediately adjacent to the stream. Data on the
  degree to which streams and rivers are channelized, leveed, or
  impounded are not available. According to Dahl (2000),
  78,100 acres (31,600 hectares) of forested wetlands were
  converted to fresh water ponds. Conversions of forested wetlands
  to deep water lakes, resulted from human activities by either
  creating new impoundments or raising the water levels on existing
  impoundments, thus killing the trees.

  The indicator Contaminants in Fresh Water Fish (Chapter 2, Purer
  Water) reported on contaminants in fish tissue for the entire U.S.,
  including polychlorinated biphenyls (PCBs), organochlorine
  pesticides, and trace elements (The Heinz Center, 2002). The
  presence of contaminants can be harmful to the organisms
  themselves, or can affect reproduction, and they can make fish
  unsuitable for consumption. Half of the fish tested had at least
  five contaminants at detectable  levels, and approximately the same
  number had one or more contaminants at levels that exceeded the
  aquatic life guidelines.

  For Mid-Atlantic Highland streams with sufficient fish tissue for
  analysis (44 percent of stream miles did not have sufficient
  quantities offish tissue), about  4 percent of the stream miles had
  fish tissue mercury concentrations that exceeded wildlife criteria
  (EPA, ORD, Region 3, August 2000).  -
 l For the the indicator Phosphorus in Large Rivers  (Chapter 2, Purer
  Water), The Heinz Center (2002) reports that half of the rivers
  tested had total phosphorus concentrations of 100 ppb or higher.
  This concentration (100 ppb) is EPA's recommended goal for
  preventing excess algal growth in streams that do not flow directly
  into lakes. None of the rivers had concentrations below 20 ppb, a
  level generally held to be free of negative effects (EPA, OW,
  November 1986).  Data were insufficient to report on lakes and
  reservoirs nationally.
 I The indicator Lake Jmphic State  Index (Chapter 2, Purer Water)
  assessed the nutrient  or total phosphorus (TP) concentrations in
  northeast lakes (Peterson, et al., 1998). Once phosphorus enters
  lakes, it frequently serves as the nutrient that limits the growth of
  nuisance blooms of phytoplankton (algae). National data on lake
  trophic condition are not available. However, regional patterns of
  lake trophic condition were assessed for a target population of
     12 Concentrations in parentheses represent the 95 percent confidence
interval.

     13 Nitrate, ammonium, and trace metals were not'included in the occur-
rence analysis, because they occur naturally (Heinz(The HeinzCenterHeinz
Center, 2002, p.50).
     14Additional information on chemical contamination in all waters of the
U.S. is provided in the technical notes, pp. 210-214, of the Heinz report
(2002).

     15There were regional differences in these percentages: only 0.1 per-
cent of NSWS lakes in the West and Florida were sensitive, but 22.7 percent
of Northern Appalachian streams were sensitive.
CJiapter 5 - tcological C_ondition          5.6 What .is the Ecological Condition of Fresh Waters?
                                                          5-43

-------
                                           affitSiWSHKiJB	%^&JIF&*
                                                                              'cnflica
                                                                       'QcuiTK
 programs, EPA estimated that in three regions, one-quarter to
 one-third of lakes and streams previously affected by acid rain
 were no longer acidic, although they were still highly sensitive to
 future changes in deposition (EPA, ORD, January 2003).
 Specifically:
   • Eight percent of lakes in the Adirondacks are currently acidic,
     down from 13 percent in the early 1990s.
   m Less than 2 percent of lakes in the Upper Midwest are
     currently acidic, down from 3 percent in the early 1980s.
   • Nine percent of the stream length in the Northern
     Appalachian Plateau region is currently acidic, down from
      12 percent in the early 1990s.
 Lakes in New England registered insignificant decreases in acidity,
 and streams in the Ridge and Blue Ridge regions of Virginia were
 unchanged. The Ridge and Blue Ridge regions are expected to
 show a lag time in their recovery due to the nature of their soils,
 and immediate responses to decreasing deposition were neither
 seen nor expected. The NSWS has not been repeated nationwide,
 so  no data exist to assess trends in surface water acidification in
 other sensitive areas of the country.
I The indicator Changing Stream Flows is one of two indicators
 presented in Chapter 2, Purer Water that are associated with fresh
 water hydrology and geomorphology and relate to the ecological
 condition of fresh water. Changes in stream flow can result in
 significant effects on fish habitat and chemical concentrations in
 streams. According to The Heinz Center (2002), the percentage
 of  streams and rivers with  major changes in the high or low flows
 or  timing of those flows increased slightly from the 1970s to the
  1990s, but the number with high flows well above the  high flows
 between 1930 and 1949 increased by approximately 30 percent
 in the 1990s. The earlier 1930 through 1949 period included
                                              some droughts, but much of it also preqeded widespread dam-
                                              building and irrigation projects.       |

                                            • The greatest stressor to mid-Atlantic streams, and many other
                                              streams throughout the U.S., is altered instream habitat (EPA,
                                              ORD, Region 3, August 2000). A Sedimentation Index (Chapter 2, [
                                              Purer Water) was developed for Mid-Atl antic Highland streams to '
                                              assess the quality of instream habitat fc r supporting aquatic     ;
                                              communities (Kaufmann,  et al., 1999). The amount of fine
                                              sediments pn the bottom of each strearp was compared with
                                              expectations based on each stream's ab'ility to transport fine
                                              sediments downstream (a function of the slope, depth  and
                                              complexity of the stream). When the amount of fine sediments
                                              exceeds expectations, it suggests that the supply of sediments
                                              from the watershed to the stream is greater than what the stream
                                              can naturally process. Streams with levels of fine particles at least
                                              10 percent below the predicted value Were rated to be  in "good"
                                              condition relative to the  sedimentation Icriteria. Those with  levels
                                              from 10 percent below to 20 percent above the predicted value
                                              were rated "fair." Those with levels more than 20 percent above
                                              regional mean expectations were rated fpoor." Based on the
                                              Sedimentation Index, about 35 percent of the stream miles  had
                                              good instream habitat, 40 percent had [fair instream habitat, and
                                              25 percent of the stream miles had popr instream habitat (EPA,
                                              ORD, Region 3, August 2000).       i
                                                                                 !  •
                                                                                 j
                                            Several indicators presented for the first time in this report are
                                            described below. They include a Category 1  indicator related to    ]
                                            landscape condition and six Category 2 indicators relating to  biotic ;
                                            condition. There were no indicators for ecological processes or natu-
                                            ral disturbance regimes.
5-44
5.6 What is the Ecological Condition of Fresh Waters?
Chapter 5 -
Ecological Condition

-------


 Indicator!
txtent of ponds, lakes, and reservoirs - Category I
  This indicator reports the area of ponds, lakes, and reservoirs in
  the conterminous U.S., excluding the Great Lakes. Over the long
  term, changes in this indicator reflect the effects of climate on
  water levels in existing lakes, ponds, and reservoirs, and of reser-
  voir construction, destruction, and management..

  What the Data Show

  The Heinz Center (2002) reports that, excluding the Great
  Lakes, the conterminous U.S. contains 21 million  acres of lakes,
  ponds, and reservoirs. The number of ponds (small water bodies
  usually less than 20 acres and 6 feet deep) increased by  100
  percent'since the  1950s (Exhibit 5-25). For unknown reasons,
  the rate of lake and reservoir creation declined 43 percent from
  the 1970s to 1980s; deep water lakes and reservoirs showed a
  modest but statistically unreliable increase between the 1980s
  and 1990s (Dahl,  2000).
                                               Indicator Caps and Limitations
                                               The USGS National Hydrography Dataset identifies a considerably
                                               larger area of lakes, reservoirs, and ponds at least 6 acres in size
                                               (26.8 million acres), and the cause of the discrepancy is unknown
                                               (The Heinz Center, 2002).

                                               Data Source

                                               The data source for this indicator was the National Wetlands
                                               Inventory, U.S. Fish and Wildlife Service (1970-2000).
                                               (See Appendix B, page B-43 for more information.)
                  ft™  Exhibit 5-25: Extent of ponds, lakes, and reservoirs, 195Os-1990s
                  *&_   —            " • -   - *•   •
     •b   12
                                                                                  Lakes and
                                                                                  Reservoirs
                                                                                  Ponds
                    '-   o
                         1950    1960    1970    1980    19,90    2000  „
                  Coverage: lower 48 states.
                  flMote: Lake area does not include the Great Lakes, which
                  Jcover about 60.2 million acres within the United States.
                                                "%V ^ f   ^  "*"      I
                    lource: The Heinz Center. The State of the Nation's Ecosystems. 2002.
                    )ata from the U.S. Fish and Wildlife Service's National Wetlands Inventory.
Chapter 5 - Ecological Condition         5.6 What is the Ecological Condition of Fresh Waters?
                                                                                                  5-45

-------
Ef!As  Draft Report  on the Environment 20t);3 • Technical DpcumeM
                    I  r       ".  "                   '           ,  !'l .:  I.     .. !'• •...'..'. . .; •'     '• :,•: '!.:• : (  [:

               At-risk fresh water native species - C-ategory 2
   The U.S. was sufficiently concerned about preserving species to
   enact the Endangered Species Act in 1973 to provide legal pro-
   tection for species that were endangered or threatened. Many of
   these species depend on lakes, streams, and adjoining wetlands
   for their continued existence. It is impossible to monitor all fresh-
   water species, but this indicator reports on species offish,
   amphibians, reptiles, aquatic mammals, butterflies, mussels, snails,
   crayfish, fresh water shrimp, dragonflies, damselflies, mayflies,
   stoneflies, and caddisflies that are at various degrees of risk of
   extinction (The Heinz Center, 2002).

   What the  Data Show

   According to The Heinz Center (2002), approximately 13  per-
   cent of native fresh water species are critically imperiled, 8 per-
   cent are imperiled, 11 percent are vulnerable, and 4 percent are
   or might be extinct (Exhibit 5-26). Critically imperiled species
   are typically found at no more than five places, and may have
   suffered steep declines or very high risk. Vulnerable species may
   be found in 20 to 80 locations and shown widespread declines
   or moderate levels of risk (Stein, 2002). Mussels and fish are
   particularly at risk. Hawaii and the Southeast have significantly
                                         higher percentages of at-risk species than other regions, but this
                                         condition may be partially the result of Hawaii and parts of the
                                         Southeast having a higher number of naturally rare species (The
                                         Heinz Center, 2002).                '•

                                         Indicator Gaps and Limitations

                                         The data underlying this indicator are notifrom a site-based moni-
                                         toring program, but rather from a census approach that focuses
                                         on the location and distribution of at-risk species. The data do
                                         not distinguish species that are naturally rare from species that
                                         have becomelrare because of human actiohs, making it difficult to
                                         distinguish actual trends in this indicator, i
                                         Data Source
                                         The data source for this indicator was The
                                         Ecosystems, The Heinz Center, 2002, usjnj
              State of the Nation's
              ; data from
                                         NatureServe Explorer database. (See Appendix B, page B-43, for
                                         more information.)
                                                           i      •            Tssx '^--"^^TS
                         Exnioit 5-26: At-risk native fresn water speciesLpy risk factor, 2000
                                                           H             iKfe**HY^^Ms«^,fe««!ii» m   .=r*i "nn H
                            100,
                                 Partial Indicator Data: Fresh water Aniir
                       c
                       5
                                                                                  	   Extinct
                                                                                  •   Critically
                                                                                    '  Imperiled
                                                                                       Imperiled
                                                                                       Vulnerable
                                                                                       AllAt-Risk
                         ^Coverage: all 50 states.
                         "H  111 in'i«" F"rw  iimn i n*l  Tli    <,  T^fctj.   ft  i ^s t slJEWfc^ *% s( Uaif*."  *v  t
                         -Source: The Heinz Center. Tne State of the Nationis Ecosystems. 2002.
                         Data from NatureServe and its Natural Heritage member programs.
                                                           I            iBtem *,   1% i ^A*iVf i, I
 5-46
5.6 What is the Ecological Condition of Fresh Waters?
C_napter 5 - (ecological (Condition

-------
                                    ^
 indicator
INon-native Fresh water fish species - Category 2
  This indicator reports on the percentage of watersheds with dif-
  ferent numbers of non-native species with established breeding
  populations (The Heinz Center, 2002). Non-native species
  include species not native to North America and species that are
  native to this continent but are now found outside their historic
  range. Such species, once introduced from some other location,
  often lack predators or parasites that kept them in check in their
  native habitats, and expand to cause a degree of ecological and
  economic disruption. Some non-native species are introduced
  intentionally (e.g., rainbow trout).

  What the Data Show

  Data are currently available nationally only for fish: of 350 water-
  sheds (6-digit HUCs) in the U.S., only five have no non-native fish
  (The Heinz Center, 2002). Sixty percent have 1 to 10 non-native
  species, and two watersheds have 41  to SO non-native fish species
  (Exhibit 5-27).
                                                Indicator Gaps and Limitations

                                                The data are not from a site-based monitoring program; they
                                                rely for the most part (90 percent) on the published literature
                                                and (10 percent) direct reporting by governmental and private
                                                biologists. New discoveries are not always reported (The Heinz
                                                Center, 2002).

                                                Data Source

                                                The data source for this indicator was The State of the Nation's
                                                Ecosystems, The Heinz Center, 2002, using data from the
                                                Non-indigenous Aquatic Species, database. (See Appendix  B,
                                                page B-44, for more information.)
                         txnioit 5-27: i^lon-native fresn water fisn species, 2OOO
                   ^Coverage: lower 48 states.
                    *
                    Source: The Heinz Center. The State of the Nation's Ecosystems. 2002.
                    JData frqrn the U.S. Geological Survey.
Chapter 5 - Ecological Condition          5.6 What is the Ecological Condition of Fresh Waters?
                                                                                                    5-47

-------
                                                                         icnn ca
 InaicritoT
Animal deaths and deformities - Category 2
  Unusual mortality events (e.g., fish kills) or deformities (e.g., frog
  deformities) can have economic consequences, and they are also
  seen as evidence that something is wrong (e.g., a contaminant is
  present, or the oiganisms are under stress from some other
  source). Although data are collected on die-offs of mammals, fish,
  and amphibians, and on amphibian deformities, data are insuffi-
  cient for national reporting (The Heinz Center, 2002). This indi-
  cator reports on unusual mortality events for waterfowl only.

  What the Data Show

  From 1995 to 1999, approximately 500 incidents of unusual
  waterfowl mortality were reported (The Heinz Center, 2002)
  (Exhibit 5-28). In slightly more than 20 percent of the incidents,
  more than 1,000 birds died, and in 15 of the incidents, more than
  10,000 birds died. The total number of die-offs reported from
  1995 to 1999 was 20 percent lower than the numbers reported in
  two earlier periods (1985 to 1989 and 1990 to 1994) (The
  Heinz Center, 2002). A larger number of events were reported in
  the Pacific and Midwest regions; fewer were reported in the
  Southwest and Southeast.
                                               Indicator Caps and Limitations
                                                                                :  i
                                               The data are not from a defined site-basec) monitoring program,
                                               but are provided by various sources such as state and federal per-
                                               sonnel, diagnostic laboratories, wildlife refuges, and published
                                               reports, as they are discovered or reported (The Heinz Center,
                                               2002). This makes it hard to distinguish r£al trends from trends in
                                               reporting.

                                               Data Source
                                               The data sou-ce for this indicator was The^State of the Nation's
                                               Ecosystems, The Heinz Center, 2002, using data from the
                                               National Wildlife  Health Center database, i
                                               (See Appendix B, page B-44, for more information.)
                           Exhibit 5-28: Animal deaths and defornrfeties, 1985-1999
                                 Partial Indicator Data: Waterfowl Morta
                                                                                <100
                                                                                100 to 1,000
                                                                                1,000 to 10,000
                                                                                >10,000
                                   1985-1989   1990-1994   1995-1999
                                                          i    '  ^       ite&
                         Coverage: all 50 states, Puerto Rico, and the U.S. Virgin Islands
                         Source: The Heinz Center. The State o^the Nation's EJOTsysfems? 20*02.
                         Data from the U.S. Geological Survey.
5-48
      5.6 What is the Ecological Condition of Fresh Waters?
Chapter 5 - 'Icological Condition

-------



             /\t-risR Fresh water plant communities - C-ategory 2
  The Heinz report employs an indicator of the threat of elimination
  of wetland and riparian area plant communities. This indicator
  uses an expert assessment conducted by NatureServe (Stein,
  2002) of factors such as the remaining number and condition of
  the community, the remaining acreage, and the severity of threats
  to the community type.

  What the Data  Show

  According to this indicator, 12 percent of the 1,560 wet|and com-
  munities ranked are critically imperiled, 24 percent are imperiled,
  and 25 percent are vulnerable (The Heinz Center, 2002)
  (Exhibit 5-29).
Indicator Gaps and  Limitations

The Heinz report states that data are not adequate for national
reporting (The Heinz Center, 2002). The report concludes that
technical challenges in classifying riparian communities prevent
national estimates for stream bank plant communities. In addition,
interpreting the data is complicated  because some species are
naturally rare, and the total number of species for any ecosystem
is unknown.

Data Source

The data source for this indicator was The State of the Nation's
Ecosystems, The Heinz Center, 2002, using data from
NatureServe Explorer database. (See Appendix B, page B-44, for
more information.)
                 hxniDit 5-29: /\t-risk Fresh water plant communities, 200O

                                                               ; on Riparian Communities
                         Partial Indicator Data: Wetlands
                                         r- -
                         Critically
                         Imperiled
                         Imperiled
                         Vulnerable
                         Total At-Risk
                                 .  2000
Future
                 Coverage: excludes Alaska.
                 —                       -               "   ~ -
                 Source: The Heinz Center. The State of the Nation's Ecosystems. 2002.
                 Data from NatureServe and jts Natural Heritage member programs.
CJiapter 5 - tcological C-ondition         5.6 What is the Ecological Condition of Fresh Waters?
                                                 5-49

-------
EFAs Draft "Report on trie Environment 20(}$ • Technical Docum^hp
               risn Index or Diotic Integrity in streams - Category 2
   Rsh communities integrate the effects of the physical, chemical,
   and biological stressors in the environment. The Heinz Center
   (2002) listed the status of fresh water animal communities as an
   indicator in need of development. Karr, et al. (1986,1997) devel-
   oped a Rsh Index of Biotic Integrity (IBI) that incorporates
   species richness, trophic composition, reproductive composition,
   and abundance and individual health offish communities in
   streams. This index, modified by McCormick, et al. (2001), was
   applied to a regional survey of streams in the mid-Atlantic states,
   and provides an example of an indicator that could be applied
   nationally.

   A sample of reference sites that represented the best conditions
   observable today in the mid-Atlantic region (e.g., sites free of
   influences from  mine drainage, nutrients, habitat degradation)
   provided a frame of reference for ranking the condition of streams
   overall. The IBI scores calculated for the reference sites ranged
   from 57 to 98. The 25th percentile of this distribution (IBI=72)
   was used to distinguish sites that were in good condition from
   those in fair condition. The first percentile value (IBI=57) separat-
   ed sites in fair condition from those in poor condition. A statisti-
   cal way to describe this setting of thresholds is to say that
   any IBI score of less than 57 in a sampled stream is 99 per-
   cent certain to be below the range of values seen in refer-
   ence sites (McCormick, et al., 2001).

   What the Data Show

   Rsh were collected at probability sites that represent about
   90,000 miles of streams in the mid-Atlantic. The fish IBI
   indicated that 27  percent of the streams were in good con-
   dition  and 14 percent were in poor condition in the Mid-
   Atlantic Highlands (see Exhibit 5-30). About 38 percent of
   the streams were scored in fair condition. No fish were
   caught in about 21 percent of the streams. The estimates
   of stream condition have a confidence interval of about
   ±.8 percent (McCormick, et al., 2001).
                                           Indicator Caps and Limitations
                                                                               i
                                           The limitations of this indicator include the following:
                                           • Condition cannot be assessed in stream|s where no fish were
                                             caught. Poor condition cannot be inferred from no fish caught,
                                             because some streams were likely too srfiall to support a fishery.
                                             Data were insufficient to indicate if the stream had poor quality
                                             or simply no fish (EPA, ORD, Region 3, August 2000).
                                             The data are available only for a limited [geographic region, and
                                             no repeated sampling is available to estimate trends.
                                           Data Source
                                           The data source for this indicator was the Mid-Atlantic Highlands
                                           Streams Assessment, Environmental Protection Agency, August
                                           2000, using data from the Mid-Atlantic .Integrated Assessment.
                                           (See Appendix B, page B-45, for more information.)

                                                          lsSSs1i^i:¥S;!;J:!i)SS!
                                                                                             -.--,••-          -     •',-•*
                                                                                        ^
                                                                           t floes ' npj; indicate; poor condition. Sptrje streams     '''    "
                                                                                         em of an InaexajBiow Integrity fa?
                                                                                          *1
                                   ^i'*-i' ,,''^^'1''^ .^-PP.t f?^'
                                    S::;:T,>
                                   *;:- Mitt-Atlantic HiMa,
                                    Upn-;!- •' .u't?1™;1!! ;u;.i'l.i7'"-i;finii» ir;."»«i ,N' "-'w-?",t\
5-50
5.6 What is the Ecological Condition of Fresh Waters?
Cnapter 5 - Ecological Condition

-------


              AAacroinverteorate Diotic Integrity Index for streams - Category 2
   Like fish, macroinvertebrate communities integrate physical, chemi-
   cal, and biological stressors, but because many of them are more
   sedentary than fish and occupy different ecological niches, they
   provide a complementary picture of ecological condition.

   A Macroinvertebrate,Biotic Integrity Index (MBII) was developed
   for mid-Atlantic streams by Klemm, et al. (2002, 2003). The MBII
   incorporates taxa richness, assemblage composition, pollution tol-
   erance (includes all maroinvertebrates, not just insects), and func-
   tional feeding groups (Klemm, et al., 2002). Similar to the
   approach used to separate the Rsh IBI scores (McCormick, et al.,
   2001), the 25th percentile of the reference site MBII scores was
   used to distinguish sites in good condition-from those in fair con-
   dition. The first percentile was used to separate  sites in fair condi-
   tion from those in poor condition (McCormick, et al., 2001).
What the Data Show

The MBII scores indicated that 17 percent of the streams in the
mid-Atlantic were in good condition, 57 percent were in fair con-
dition, and 26 percent were in poor condition (Exhibit 5-31).

Indicator Gaps and Limitations

The data are available only for a limited geographic region, and no
repeated sampling is available to estimate trends.

Data  Source

The data source for this indicator was Development and Evaluation
of a Macroinvertebrate Biotic Integrity Index (MBII) for Regionally
Assessing Mid-Atlantic Highlands Streams. 2003, Klemm, et al.,
using data from the Mid-Atlantic Integrated Assessment. (See
Appendix B, page B-45, for more information.)
                        £-~                      Exhibit 5-31:
                        JSS--* 4                  "  *         *     ki        ~        "
                        I AAacroinvertetrate Diotic Integrity Index (AAfill),
                        5?I    Mid-Atlantic Highlands, 1993-1996
                        tCoverage: Mid-Atlantic Highlands
                       jjp>ource: Klemm, D.J., et al. Development and Evaluation of a Macroinvertebrate Biotic
                       if integrity Index (MBII) for Regionally Assessing Mid-Atlantic Highlands Streams.  2003.
                                                                                              *vj&+-m
Chapter 5 - Ecological Condition         5.6 What is the Ecological Condition of Fresh Waters?
                                                    5-51

-------
                                            '
Summary: me Ecological Condition of Fresh Waters

Fresh water systems are under pressure from point and non-point
pollution, atmospheric deposition, altered habitat, and invasive
species. A review of Exhibit 5-24, however, indicates that there are
virtually no Category 1  indicators or monitoring programs that pro-
vide a national picture of the ecological condition of fresh waters.
No national condition data are available on ecological processes, not
are there any nationally or regionally reported indicators of natural
disturbance regimes.

Landscape condition
The National Wetlands Inventory provides unbiased statistical esti-
mates of the extent of wetlands, ponds, lakes, and reservoirs in the
conterminous U.S. at decadal scales since the 1970s. There is no
similar effort for the extent of streams (losses can occur because of
mining, damming, water withdrawal, or climate change). Chapter 2,
Purer Water, estimates that the U.S. has more than 3.7 million miles
of streams and rivers (EPA, OW, June 2000a, 2000b). About
60 percent of all these stream miles are found in small, headwater
streams. The  Heinz Center reports, however, that because there is no
agreed-upon  system to classify streams  (e.g., by discharge, drainage
area, or stream order), there are no national data sets for reporting
on stream size.

Blotlc condition
At this time, no national condition data  are available on lake, wet-
land, or stream biota. The USGS National Water Quality Assessment
(NAWQA) program has collected data on the biota in rivers and
streams in the network, but  no analysis has been performed on the
data at a national level (USGS, 2002; ). Surveys of stream benthos arid fish communities have
been conducted for the mid-Atlantic region that provide unbiased
estimates of the condition of 90 percent of the streams in the
region. Both surveys showed only 17 percent (±8 percent) of the
streams to be in good condition, but there is no indication of
whether they are the same streams or of the likely cause(s) of
impairment. No fish were caught in 16 percent of the streams, so
their condition could not be judged based on this criterion. Similar
regional studies have been conducted in the western states, but the
data have not yet been reported. There are no nationally or
regionally representative data on the aquatic communities of lakes.
Based on NatureServe data, 36 percent of aquatic biota in several
categories are either extinct or at some  risk of extinction, but
because this database relies on voluntary reporting, future trends
might not be discernable with statistical reliability. NAWQA collected
contaminant data from fish tissue in 223 streams, and almost half
showed concentrations that exceeded aquatic life guidelines for at
least one contaminant. However, these data have not been related to
the condition of the fish communities in the corresponding streams,
so ecological condition cannot be determined. There are no specific
plans to re-sample in any of these programs, and so there is no
assurance that trend data will be available in the future.
                                             Chemical ami physical characteristics

                                             Better data are available for chemical and physical characteristics of
                                             streams, less for lakes, and none for wetlarjds. The NAWQA program
                                             reports data on total phosphorus concentrations in more than      l
                                             140 large rivers nationwide, but there are no corresponding national
                                             data on either lake or reservoir concentrations (where algal blooms
                                             are likely to develop), nor on the correspo iding biological communi-
                                             ties. Reliable regional  estimates  have been made of total phosphorus
                                             concentrators in 11,076 lakes in the Northeast states. These esti-  ',
                                             mates showed with a high degree of confic ence that fewer than 22
                                             percent of the lakes were estimated to be sutrophic or hypertrophic.
                                             While a relationship exists between totalpiosphorus concentrations ;
                                             and algal biotnass or productivity (Carlson, 1977), lake-to-lake varia-
                                             tion is considerable, so none .of these datz  truly express the known
                                             ecological condition of these lakes  or riyets with respect to eutrophi-
                                             cation. Nitrate is not often a limiting nutrient in fresh waters, so it
                                             provides little ecological information on'fnbsh waters themselves
                                             (although it does provide useful informatipn  on the watershed, as
                                             discussed in 1:he sections on forests and farmlands).
                                                                                  !                 ,
                                                         • •  •         ••••             i	       4
                                             The NAWQA program reports on contaminants in stream waters   '•
                                             from 109 streams, and sediments from 55:8 stream sites across the ;
                                             U.S. At least half of the streams had concentrations that exceeded
                                             wildlife criteria, but there are as yet no an alyses  relating these to the
                                             condition of fish or invertebrate communities in the streams natural-
                                             ly. Incorporation of water quality data monitored by the states could
                                             improve the coverage, if care is given to' representative sampling and
                                             comparable methods  and indicators.  ' [
                                                                                  \
                                             A national survey in the 1980s provided estimates of the sensitivity
                                             of all lakes arid all streams in the eastern U.S. to acidic deposition
                                             (Landers, et al., 1988; Kaufmann, et al., 1?91). Periodic resurveys
                                             and intensive sampling of representative lakes and  streams have
                                             allowed EPA to conclude that, because of Deductions in sulfate emis-
                                             sions under its acid rain regulations, one-quarter to one-third of
                                             lakes and streams in three regions affected by acid rain are no longer
                                             acidic (EPA, ORD, Region 3, August 2000). Corresponding biologi-
                                             cal community data exist only for streams; in  the Mid-Atlantic
                                             Highlands.                            I                     •   "

                                                        ;                       '!
                                             Hydrology and geomorphology       !

                                             There are nationally reported data  on onjy one hydrologic/geomor-:
                                             phological indicator: changing stream flo\j/.  This indicator is reported
                                             on all rivers and streams for which the retord of data is adequate,
                                             and it shows that high flows have increased during the past decade.
                                             There are nci corresponding data to indidate why, however, nor are
                                             there data on any accompanying change iin the fish communities, so
                                             ecological condition cannot be  assessed ^vith any reliability.
                                                                                  I
5-52
5.6 What is the Ecological Condition of Fresh Waters?
C-napter 5 -
Zoological
Condition

-------
There were no Category 1 or 2 indicators available for ecological
processes or natural disturbance regimes for fresh waters. Limnologists
have long measured primary productivity in lakes, and nutrient spiral-
ing and leaf-pack decomposition in streams, but no systematic data
were available in the form of an indicator for this report. Phenomena
involved in natural disturbance regimes in fresh waters include
hydrology (e.g., low-flow frequencies, floods), time of ice-out in
lakes, and fires and other factors that affect watersheds.
5,7    What  Is  the
tcological  (Condition  of
C^oasts  and  Oceans:
                                                               The coasts and oceans of the United States extend from the
                                                               shoreline out approximately 200 miles into the open ocean. The
                                                               indicators in this report, however, focus on estuaries and coastal
                                                               waters within 25 miles of the coast. Coastal ecosystems are pro-
                                                               ductive and diverse, and include estuaries, coastal wetlands, coral
                                                               reefs, mangrove forests, and upwelling areas. Critical coastal habi-
                                                               tats provide spawning grounds, nurseries, shelter, and food for
                                                               finfish, shellfish, birds, and other wildlife. Coastal areas are also
                                                               sinks for pollutants transported through surface water, ground
                                                               water, and atmospheric deposition.

                                                               Coastal areas are among the most developed areas in the nation.
                                                               Coastal areas comprise 17 percent of total conterminous U.S. land
                                                               area, yet these areas are home to 53 percent of the U.S. human
                                                               population. The coastal population is increasing by about 3,600
                                                               people per day, giving rise to a projected total increase of 27 million
                                                               people between 2000 and 2015 (U.S. Census Bureau, 2002).

                                                               Coastal areas also contribute significantly to the U.S. economy.
                                                               Almost 31  percent of the Gross National Product is produced in
                                                               coastal counties (EPA, ORD, OW, September 2001). Almost
                                                               85 percent of commercially harvested fish depend on estuaries and
                                                               adjacent coastal waters at some stage in their life cycle (NRC, 1997).
                                                               About 180 million people use coastal beaches each year
                                                               (Cunningham and Walker, 1996). Estuaries supply water, receive dis-
                                                               charge from municipal and industrial sources, and support agricul-
                                                               ture, commercial and sport fisheries, and  recreational uses such as
                                                               swimming, and boating.

                                                               National estuarine and coastal monitoring programs have been in
                                                               place for 15 to 20 years. A number of agencies and programs pro-
                                                               vide information on the condition of coastal waters and wetlands,
                                                               including the National Oceanic and Atmospheric Administration's
                                                               (NOAA) National Status and Trends Program,  National Estuarine
                                                               Research Reserve System, and National Marine Fisheries Service
                                                               National Habitat Program; EPA's National  Estuary Program and
                                                               Environmental Monitoring and Assessment Program; and the Fish and
                                                               Wildlife Service National Wetlands Inventory and Coastal Program.

                                                               In 2000, EPA, NOAA and USGS, in cooperation with all 24 U.S.
                                                               coastal states, initiated the National Coastal Assessment (also known
                                                               as Coastal 2000 or C2000). Using a compatible, probabilistic
                                                               design and a common set of survey indicators, each state conducted
Chapter 5 - tcological Condition         5.7 What is the Ecological Condition of Coasts and Oceans?
                                                     5-53

-------
F~n A'  I~>v  r ::il'ri!il:  t'1**1'  I   .p-.:'.;. i'i'^Y-:,ww:''^^nym&i\'
tlr\s  [Draft -Report on the tnvirdnmepit 2QQI
                   1"    • •  ;               :  ,<•  .  :• . IVV : 1 :,
                                                                  	MHIMMMMM
1	'"
                                   Exnioit 5-32: Coasts and oceans indicators
f
1
i::
;
1
fe-
i
I-
r
8"
I"
•=
5"
i>.
|:r
1" f
F
r
*.


;„;
i 	
illl.
!

	
,.
:,
i-
;„
-.
f:
':'
g__g_j IgjUjg,^ j SBijBl^'il^^^^S
\ Landscape Condition
Extent of Ecological System/Habitat Types
Landscape Composition

Landscape Structure/Pattern
Biotlc Condition
Ecosystems and Communities


Species and Populations
Organism Condition

Ecological Processes
Enenjy Flow
Material Flow
^.Stmical aod^Physical Characteristics
Nutrient Concentrations

Other Chemical Parameters

Trace Organics and Inorganics

Physical Parameters
Hydrology and Gconioi phology
Surface and Ground Water Flows
Dynamic Structural Conditions
Sediment and Material Transport
Natural Disturbance Regimes
Frequency
Extent
Duration
iiii^^
' V *. ~if
; . lL 	 , 	 ,..
Extent of estuaries and coastline
Coastal living habitats
Shoreline types

M 	 ' 	 ' 	 ' 	 -"
ii 1. ,.
Benthic Community Index
Fish diversity
Submerged aquatic vegetation
Chlorophyll concentrations
Rsh abnormalities
Unusual marine mortalities :
ji i


lla-^ '. r, f .-.
Total nitrogen in coastal waters
Total phosphorous in coastal waters
Dissolved oxygen in coastal waters ;
Total organic carbon in sediments
Sediment contamination of coastal waters
Sediment toxicity in estuaries
Water clarity in coastal waters
,; ;,.,.... .»,,..



' If 	 	 ' 	 -^" 	
Jj. 	 , .. _ , __^ ,




I
•











I

















S||
a

•
n


H
M
H
n
H
n




a
n
•
H
•
H
•
.,- ;-,.-',







IBiiRIII

EPA
DOI
DOC


EPA .
EPA
EPA
EPA
EPA
DOC




EPA
EPA
EPA
EPA
EPA
EPA
EPA








  Note; MAlA indicators included pending completion of peer review
                                                                                                              i	
5-54
               5.7 What is the Ecological Condition of Coasts and Oceans?    •     Chapter 5 -' Icological Condition

-------
                                   ^P^
the survey and independently assessed the condition of their coastal
resources. These estimates currently are being aggregated to assess
the condition of the nation's coastal waters. While the first complete
assessment of the nation's coastal waters will be available in 2003, a
preliminary assessment of selected estuarine systems was published
in 2001 (EPA, ORD, OW, September 2001).

Exhibit 5-32 lists the ecological indicators of coastal condition used
in this report. Eight indicators are discussed in Chapter 2, Purer
Water. The indicator Chlorophyll Concentrations deals with biotic
structure of phytoplankton communities, and the rest are associated
with the chemical and physical characteristics of coastal ecosystems.
These eight indicators are summarized below. The section then pres-
ents nine indicators that appear for the first time in this report. Two
involve the coastal  landscape, and the rest involve the biotic struc-
ture of coastal ecosystems. There are  no indicators of ecological
processes, hydrology and geomorphology, or natural disturbance
regimes with data suitable for national or regional reporting.

The following indicators presented in  previous  chapters relate to the
ecological condition of coasts and oceans:

• The indicator Chlorophyll Concentrations is a measure of the
  abundance of phytoplankton. Excessive growth  of
  phytoplankton, as measured by chlorophyll concentrations, can
 ' lead to degraded water quality, such  as noxious odors,
  decreased water clarity, andoxygen depletion. Excess
  phytoplankton growth is usually associated with increased
  nutrient inputs (e.g., watershed or atmospheric transport,
  upwelling) or a decline in filtering  organisms such as clams,
  mussels,  or oysters (The Heinz Center, 2002).
  Average seasonal ocean chlorophyll  concentrations (within 25 miles
  of the coast)  ranged from 0.1  to 6.5 ppb (The Heinz Center,
  2002). The highest ocean chlorophyll concentrations (4.8 to  6.5
  ppb) were in the Gulf of Mexico with the lowest concentrations in
  Hawaiian waters (0.1 ppb). Southern California had the next lowest
  chlorophyll concentrations, between 1.1  and  1.5 ppb. Other ocean
  waters (e.g., north, mid-, and south Atlantic, and Pacific Northwest)
  had chlorophyll concentrations ranging from 2 to 4.5 ppb.
  Estuarine chlorophyll concentrations were not available for
  national reporting in the Heinz report, but chlorophyll
  concentrations in the mid-Atlantic estuaries ranged from 0.7 to
  95  ppb in 1997  and 1998 (EPA, ORD, May  2003). EPA
  established three categories: good  <15 ppb; fair 15-30 ppb;  and
  poor >30 ppb. The lower threshold of 15 ppb chlorophyll is equal
  to the restoration goal recommended for the survival of
  submerged aquatic vegetation (SAV) in the Chesapeake Bay
  (Batiuk, et al., 2000). About 33 percent of the mid-Atlantic
  estuarine area had chlorophyll concentrations, exceeding 15 ppb.
  The Delaware Estuary showed a wide range of chlorophyll
  concentrations, from low in the Delaware Bay (<15 ppb) to
  intermediate  in the Delaware River  (15 to 30 ppb) to very high
  (>80 ppb) in the Salem River. The western tributaries to the
  Chesapeake Bay were consistently high in chlorophyll, with more
  than 25 percent of the area showing >30 ppb chlorophyll
  •concentrations. Chlorophyll concentrations in the coastal bays
  were generally low (< 15 ppb), even though nutrients were
  elevated, because of increased turbidity and low light penetration.
• The Water Clarity in Coastal Waters (Chapter 2,  Purer Water)
  indicator is important for maintaining productive systems in good
  condition and is affected by chlorophyll concentrations. Light
  penetration is important for submerged aquatic vegetation (SAV),
  which serves as food, nursery, shelter, and refugia habitat (areas
  that provide protection from predators) for aquatic organisms.
  EMAP measured water clarity using a light penetrometer, which
  recorded the amount of surface light that penetrated to a depth
  of 1 meter (EPA, ORD, OW, September 2001).  Water clarity was
  considered poor if less than 10 percent of surface  radiation
  penetrated to 1 meter. Water clarity was considered fair if there
  was between  10 and 25  percent penetration, and clarity was
  considered good if there was greater than 25 percent penetration.
  Data were collected for all conterminous estuaries  in  the U.S. The
  10  percent light penetration at 1 meter is required to support
  SAV, which is an ecological endpoint in several estuarine
  ecosystems. Overall, 64 percent of the nation's  estuarine area had
  light penetration of at least 25 percent at 1  meter (EPA, ORD,
  OW, September 2001). Only 4 percent of the nation's estuarine
  area had poor light penetration  (less than 10 percent).
• Nitrogen, and less often phosphorus, control the chlorophyll
  concentrations in coastal ecosystems. The indicator Total Nitrogen
  in Coastal Waters (Chapter 2, Purer Water), was calculated for the
  mid-Atlantic estuaries by summing the concentrations of total
  dissolved  nitrogen and particulate organic nitrogen (EPA, ORD,
  May 2003). Assessment categories were determined  based on the
  25th and  75th percentiles because there are no total nitrogen
  (TN) criteria for estuaries. The categories are: low  < 0.5 ppm N;
  intermediate 0.5 to 1.0  ppm N; and high > 1.0  ppm N. About
  35  percent of the mid-Atlantic estuarine area had  low TN
  concentrations, 47 percent had intermediate TN concentrations,
  and 18 percent had high TN concentrations.  About 50 percent of
  the mainstem area of the Chesapeake Bay had low TN
  concentrations, with only about 5 percent having high TN
  concentrations. The coastal bays, in  contrast, had about 5 percent
  of their area with low TN concentrations and about 35 percent
  with high  TN concentrations. The Delaware River estuary portion
  of Delaware Bay had 100 percent of its area with high TN
  concentrations.
H The indicator Total Phosphorus in Coastal Waters (Chapter 2, Purer
  Water) assessment categories were based on the 25th and
  75th percentile concentrations measured throughout the mid-
  Atlantic. These categories are: low <  0.05 mg P/L; intermediate
  0.05 to 0.1 mg P/L; and high > 0.1  mg P/L. Total phosphorus
  (TP) concentrations ranged from 0 to 0.34 mg P/L. About
  58  percent of the mid-Atlantic estuarine area had  low TP
  concentrations, 30 percent had intermediate, and  12 percent had
  high TP concentrations (EPA, ORD, May 2003). About 85 percent
  of the mainstem area of the Chesapeake Bay had low TP
Chapter 5 - Ecological Condition         5.7 What is the Ecological Condition of Coasts and Oceans?
                                                         5-55

-------
                                        ....... ilf ............ i^S*8S^B^^Wi!*i|^if*


  concentrations, with no areas having high TP concentrations. The
  coastal bays, in contrast, had no areas with low TP concentrations
  and about 35 percent with high TP concentrations. The Delaware
  River estuary portion of Delaware Bay had TOO percent of its area
  with high TP concentrations.
  Dissolved oxygen is depleted when phytoplankton in estuaries die
  and decompose. Data on the Dissolved Oxygen in Coastal Waters
  indicator (Chapter 2, Purer Water) were reported primarily for
  estuaries in the Virginian, Carolinian, and Louisianian Provinces16.
  Dissolved oxygen in these estuaries was reported as good because
  80 percent of estuarine waters assessed were estimated to exhibit
  dissolved oxygen at concentrations greater than 5 ppm (EPA,
  ORD, OW, September 2001). Hypoxia resulting from
  anthropogenic activities is a relatively local occurrence in Gulf of
  Mexico estuaries; only 4 percent of the combined bottom areas in
  these estuaries is hypoxic. The occurrence of hypoxia in the  shelf
  waters of the Gulf of Mexico is more significant. The Gulf of
  Mexico hypoxic zone is the largest area of anthropogenic coastal
  hypoxia in the western hemisphere (CAST, 1999). Since 1993,
  mid-summer bottom water hypoxia in the Northern Gulf of Mexico
  has been larger than 3,860 square miles and in 1999, it reached
  over 7,700 square miles (CENR, 2000).

  Total Organic Carbon in Sediments (Chapter 2, Purer Water) is often
  an indicator of organic pollution (e.g., from decomposing
  phytoplankton blooms or waste disposal). Total organic carbon
  (TOC) values are calculated as percent carbon in dried sediments.
  Values ranged from 0.02 to 13  percent carbon (Paul, et al. 1999).
  Assessment categories for the mid-Atlantic estuaries were
  tentatively set at: low 1 percent; intermediate 1 to 3 percent, and
  high >3  percent, but they are still under evaluation. For the mid-
  Atlantic region, about 60 percent of the sediments had low TOC
  values, about 24 percent had intermediate TOC values, and
  16 percent had high sediment TOC values (EPA, ORD, May
  2003).  Values ranged from those of Delaware Bay, with about
  9S percent of its sediments having low TOC values, to those of
  the Chowan River in the Albemarle-Pamlico Estuary with
  65 percent of its sediments having high TOC values (EPA, ORD,
  May 2003). The Chesapeake Bay mainstem had about 65 percent
  of its sediments with low TOC values and about 15 percent with
  high TOC values.
                                                   The Sediment Contamination of Coastal Waters indicator (Chapter
                                                   2, Purer Water) was analyzed in estuaries primarily along the
                                                   Atlantic Coast and Gulf of Mexico as 'part of the EPA EMAP
                                                   Estuaries Program. Results from these a lalyses indicated that
                                                   40 percent of estuarine sediments in th ese areas were enriched in
                                                   metals frorh human sources, 45 percent were enriched in PCBs,
                                                   and 75 percent were enriched in pesticides  (EPA, ORD, OW,     ;
                                                   September 2001). The highest concentrations of all three
                                                   constituents were found in South Florida sediments with
                                                   53 percent, 99 percent, and  93 percent of the sediment area
                                                   enriched in metals, PCBs,  and pesticidels, respectively.

                                                  I The EPA EMAP Estuaries Program, in conjunction with the NOAA
                                                   Status and Trends Program, developed the indicator Sediment
                                                   Toxicity in Estuaries (Chapter 2, Purer Water). The EMAP Estuaries
                                                   Program found that about 10 percent of the sediments in the
                                                   Virginian, Carolinian, Louisianian, West
ndian, and Californian
                                                   Province estuaries were toxic to the marine amphipod Ampelisca
                                                   abdita over a 10-day period (EPA, ORE, OW, September 2001).
                                                   The NOAA Status and Trends Program also used a sea urchin
                                                   fertility test and a microbial test to evaluate chronic toxicity in
                                                   selected estuaries. NOAA found that 4|5 to 62 percent of the
                                                   sediment samples from the selected estuaries showed chronic
                                                   toxicity (EPA, ORD, OW, September 20!01).
                                                 On the following pages, several indicators are introduced for the first
                                                 time in this report that relate to the essehtial ecological attributes of
                                                 landscape condition and biotic condition! of estuaries.
     16 Provinces are biogeographical regions with distinct faunas.
5-56
5.7 What is the Ecological Condition of Coasts and Oceans?           CJnapter 5 - tcological '^.ondition

-------

               txtent of estuaries and coastline - Category 1
   Estuarine areas provide habitat for organisms which contribute.
   significantly to the national economy. These areas also are under
   pressure from the S3 percent of the U.S. population that lives
   within 75 miles of the coast. Estuarine areas and coastline include
   brackish water bays and tidal rivers, which are influenced by the
   mixing of fresh water and ocean salt water in these areas. Extent
   estimates were provided by the coastal states as part of the EPA
   National Water Quality Inventory - 2000 Report (EPA, OW,
   August. 2000).

   What the  Data  Show

   EPA estimates that the U.S. and its territories have  95.9  million
   acres of estuarine surface area and about 58,618 miles of coast-
   line (EPA, OW, August 2002).
                                                              Indicator Gaps and Limitations

                                                              These data were compiled from inventories performed by the
                                                              states. Differences in how each state defines estuaries are likely, so
                                                              the consistency of the inventory is unknown.

                                                              Data Source

                                                              The data source for this indicator was the 2000 National Water
                                                              Quality Inventory, U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, August
                                                              2002. (See Appendix B, page B-45, for more information.)

               Coastal living habitats - Category 2
This indicator provides the acreage of vegetative habitat such as
submerged aquatic vegetation (SAV), mangrove forests, and
coastal 'wetlands. Vegetation not only stabilizes the habitat, but
also provides food, shelter, nursery areas, and refugia for other
aquatic organisms. Loss of coastal habitat is a major contributor
to the loss of both economic and non-marketable aquatic species
(The Heinz Center, 2002).

What the  Data Show
  The USFWS National Wetlands Inventory (NW!) estimates
  more than 5 million acres of coastal wetlands contribute to
  the diversity of coastal habitat (Exhibit 5-33). Wetland
  acreage declined about 8 percent from the mid-1950s to
  the mid-1990s (The Heinz Center, 2002). Out of 5 million
  total acres, 400,000 acres of coastal wetland were lost over
  this period, although the loss rate declined in the 1990s
  (The Heinz Center, 2002).

  Indicator  Gaps and  Limitations

  Data for coral reefs and seagrasses and other SAV are avail-
  able for many areas, but these data have not been integrat-
  ed to produce a national estimate. Different approaches
  have been used  to estimate some of these coastal habitats
  which make make integration difficult. For example, esti-
  mates of the extent of SAV are noted in some regions only
  as presence/absence,  while the area is estimated quantita-
  tively in other regions. Data for vegetated wetlands are
  available for only the East and Gulf Coasts.
                                                                Data Source

                                                                The data source for this indicator was Status and Trends of
                                                                Wetlands in the Conterminous United States 1986 to 1997, Dahl,
                                                                2000, utilizing data from the National Wetlands Inventory.
                                                                (See Appendix B, page B-45, for more information.)
                                                                   Exhibit 5-33 Coastal living habitats, IQ5Os-l990s
                                                          .,, Partial Indicator Data: Coastal Vegetated Wetlands
                                                         -1950
                                                                     1960
                                                                                1970
                                                                                          1980
                                                                                                     1990
2000
                                                        Coverage Atlantic and Gulf Coasts Only
                                                          prce: The Heinz Center The State of the Nation's Ecosystems 2002
                                                          ta from the U S Fish and Wildlife Service
Chapter 5 - Ecological Condition         5.7 What is the Ecological Condition of Coasts and Oceans?
                                                                                                                    5-57

-------
 I  I	     .
 Indicator
Shoreline types - Category 2
  This indicator includes the miles of coastline in different categories,
  such as beaches, mud or sand flats, rock or clay cliffs, and wetlands.
  It also includes coastline that is protected with engineered structures
  such as armoring or riprap. Loss or conversion of shoreline habitat to
  armoring or riprap can eliminate the habitat required by various
  organisms for spawning, gestation, nursery area, feeding, or refugia.

  What the  Data  Show

  Over two-thirds of the mapped shoreline in the south Atlantic,
  southern California, and Pacific Northwest is coastal wetlands,
  with most of the coastal wetlands occurring in the South Atlantic
  (The Heinz Center, 2002) (Exhibit 5-34). Three-quarters of the
  south Atlantic shoreline is wetlands (The Heinz Center, 2002).
  Beaches account for about 33  percent of the shoreline in both
  southern California and the Pacific Northwest. Southern
  California, however, has a much lower percentage of wetlands and
  mud or sand flats than the  Pacific Northwest. Steep shorelines,
  mud flats, and sand flats each make up the smallest portion of the
                                                                                                   .i:_L.
                                                  total in all three regions. Armored shorelines, which inclde bulk-
                                                  heads and rip rap, account for about 11 percent of miles of the
                                                  total coastline.                        :
                                                              i                       :  !    •
                                                  Indicator Gaps and Limitcitions

                                                  Estimates of shoreline types are not available for the entire U.S.,
                                                  including much of the Atlantic and Gulf Coast areas. Some of the
                                                  atlases used to compile this information a -e more than 15 years
                                                  old. Coastal areas are dynamic and change over time, so the accu-
                                                  racy of available estimates is unknown.   !
                                                                                       i
                                                  Data Source
                                                                                       i
                                                  The data source for this indicator was the Environmental
                                                  Sensitivity Index Atlases, National Oceanic and Atmospheric
                                                  Administration (1984-2001). (See Appendix B, page B-46, for
                                                  more information.)
                                      Exhibit 5-34: Coastal shoreline types, 2000
                                                                                          ipmrf"i"J""-JT -fT«"jg
                                          Partial Indicator Data: Shoreline Typ as by Region
                         r
                           :  South Atlantic
                                Southern
                                California
                                 Pacific
                               Northwest
                                                20
                                             ::- Percent of Total Regional Shoreline
                                                                      Steep Sand,
                                                                      Rock, Clay
                                                                      Mud or Sand
                                                                      Flats
                                                                      Beaches
                                                                      Wetlands,
                                                                      mangroves, etc.
                                                                      Armored
                                                                      (bulkheads
                                                                      or riprap)
                                                                         I* *      r
                           M Coverage: Pacific Northwest, Southern California, and ScCth Atlantic Regions only
                           is       •  	., .,         ,      ,       |Lps  t   „   M j
                           is Source: The Heinz Center. The State of the Nation's Ecosystems 2002
                           >t Data from the National Oceanic and Atmospheric Administration
                                                                                     i
                                                                                     i !
5-58
   5.7 What is the Ecological Condition of Coasts and Oceans?       .    Chapter 5 -
Zoological
I Condition

-------

               Benthic Community Index - Category 2
   EMAP Estuaries Program has developed indices of benthic condi-
   tion for estuaries in the conterminous U.S. (Engle and Summers,
   1999; Engle, et al., 1994; Van Dolah, et al., 1999; Weisberg, et al.,
   1997). Benthic macroinvertebrates include annelids, mollusks, and
   crustaceans that inhabit the bottom substrates of estuaries. These
   organisms play a vital role in maintaining sediment and water qual-
   ity, and are an important food source for bottom-feeding fish,
   invertebrates, ducks, and marsh birds. Measures of biodiversity
   and species richness, species composition, and relative abundance
   or productivity of functional groups are among the assemblage
   attributes that can be used to characterize benthic community
   composition and abundance. The Heinz report refers to this indi-
   cator as Condition of Bottom-Dwelling Organisms (The Heinz
   Center, 2002).

   Assemblages of benthic organisms are sensitive to pollutant expo-
   sure (Holland, et al., 1987, 1988; Rhoads, et al., 1978; Pearson
   and Rosenberg, 1978; Sanders, et al., 1980; Boesch and
   Rosenberg, 1981), and they integrate responses to disturbance
   and exposure over relatively long periods of time  (months to
   years). Their sensitivity to pollutant stress is, in part, because
   they live in sediment that accumulates environmental contami-
   nants over time (Nixon, et al., 1986), and because they are rela-
   tively immobile.

   Reference sites were used to calibrate the indices similar to the
   approach used to calibrate fish IBI scores in fresh water ecosys-
   tems. The references cited above describe the approaches used
   for calibration and scoring in various estuarine provinces. These
   indices were calibrated for the respective estuarine province in
   which they were developed.  While the development and calibra-
   tion process was similar among provinces, the specific thresholds
   reflect the estuarine conditions within that province. In general,
   good condition means that less than 10 percent of the coastal
   waters have low benthic index scores. Fair condition means that
   between 10 and 20 percent of the coastal waters have low benthic
   index scores. Poor condition means that greater than 20 percent
   of the coastal waters have low benthic index scores.

   What the Data Show

   Benthic community index scores have been assessed for the
   Northeast, Southeast, and Gulf Coastal Areas. For the Northeast,
   Southeast, and Gulf Coastal areas, 56 percent of the coastal
   waters were assessed in good condition, 22 percent in fair condi-
   tion, and 22 percent in poor condition based on  benthic index
   scores (Exhibit S-3S).
Associations of biological condition with specific stressors indi-
cate that, of the 22 percent of coastal areas with poor benthic
condition, 62 percent had sediment contamination, 11  percent
had low dissolved oxygen concentrations, 7 percent had low light
penetration, and 2 percent showed  sediment toxicity (EPA, ORD,
OW, September 2001).

Indicator Gaps and Limitations

Benthic community index scores have been assessed only for the
Northeast, Southeast, and Gulf Coastal areas. Samples have been
collected in all coastal areas, including Alaska, Hawaii, and Island
Territories, but these data have not  been assessed. A complete
assessment of coastal condition is anticipated in 2003.

Data Source

The data source for this indicator was National Coastal Condition
Report, U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, September 2001,
using data from the Environmental Monitoring and Assessment
Program, Estuaries Program. (See Appendix B, page B-46, for
more information.)
!%~  Exhibit 5-35: Benthic Community Index (BCD
fe*-#     scores for coastal waters in good, fair,
                 or poor condition, 2000
fe-
                     18% No Sediment
                     or Water Contamination
              62% Sediment
              Contamination
11% Low
Dissolved^
Oxygen
Concentrations
                                                7% Light
                                                Penetration
                                                 2%
                                                 Sediment
                                                 Toxicity
     J^lrage: Northeast Sbutrieast, and Gulf Coastal areas
        rlPAj O.fflfe of Rjsearc.ti.and Development and Office of Water
  fNational CogsinlffinJKmjtefioft September 2001
Chapter 5 - Ecological Condition         5.7 What is the Ecological Condition of Coasts and Oceans?
                                                        5-59

-------
 r~pA' ....... any"! ..... R'lin
tTT^s ...... L/rart ....... l\
                                      MC .......... ffifflil$fflXQ6s$&^W&&9* ........ SjS ..... nr^f -^i^l r\-$$g% ..... lilltfe
 IndiciB
                risn diversity - Category 2
  Fish diversity is considered to be an indicator of ecological condi-
  tion because fish integrate effects of environmental stress over
  space and time (EPA, ORD, September 1998). For this indicator,
  fish collected by trawling are identified, enumerated, and meas-
  ured, allowing assessment of native and non-native species, diver-
  sity, abundance, pollution-tolerant/intolerant, and size class
  (e.g., young-of-year and adults).

  This indicator provides data for the mid-Atlantic estuaries.
  Because fish catch data are sensitive to different sampling gear, no
  critical thresholds were established for the mid-Atlantic estuaries.
  High and low diversity were arbitrarily established as: high > 3 fish
  species in a standard trawl; low < 3 fish species in
  a standard trawl (EPA, ORD, May 2003).
                                                                  Data  Source              •   '  j
                                                                                                     '  f
                                                                  The data source for this indicator was the ^/lid-Atlantic Integrated
                                                                  Assessment, MAIA-Estuaries, 1997-1998 Summary Report,
                                                                  U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Ma^ 2003.
                                                                  (See Appendix B, page B-46, for more information.)
                                               i
  What the  Data Show

  In 1998, out of 110 sampling sites selected for
  the mid-Atlantic estuaries in 1998, fish trawls
  were conducted at 80 sites (the others were too
  shallow to trawl). The fish species count ranged
  from 0 to 13, with an average of 4.6 species per
  site (Exhibit 5-36).  For the mid-Atlantic estuaries
  in general, more fish species were found in upper
  Delaware Bay, the coastal bays, and in the upper
  portions of tributaries. Fewer species were evi-
  dent in the Chesapeake Bay rnainstem and lower
  tributaries.

  Indicator Caps and
  Limitations

  The limitations of this indicator include the fol-
  lowing:
  • Fish diversity estimates are available only for
    the mid-Atlantic estuaries.

  • While fish  diversity can be determined for each
    sampling site, currently no context exists for
    interpreting the condition of estuaries from
    fish diversity numbers because there are no
    criteria or  thresholds for relating fish diversity
    estimates to estuarine condition.

  • Fish populations are highly mobile, so caution
    must be used in interpreting low diversity
    estimates for measurements observed at any
    individual site may not be representative of the
    condition  of the estuary.
                                                    Exhibit 5-36: Fish diversity in mid-Atlantic Lays, 1997-1998
                                                p
                                                                                                 Number of Fish Species

                                                                                                 O Low Diversity. < 3 species

                                                                                                 • High Diversity > 3 species
                                                  "Coverage" Ivfictf-Atfanltc oliys ^DelawaTeT Mi
                                                   Source. fi>X, Office o| Research ancf Develop]
                                                   fstuar/es 1997-98, Summary Report May 20f
i Atlantic Ecology DIVI ion Mid Atlantic Integrated Assessment AM/A
5-60
                  5.7 What is the Ecological Condition of Coasts and Oceans?          CJnapter 5 - tcological Condition

-------
i:q^q:a';a.;i

                   JuDmerged aquatic vegetation -.Category 2
        Many estuarine systems contain submerged aquatic vegetation
        (SAV), which provides habitat and refugia for fish and invertebrates,
        helps protect shorelines from erosion, contributes to sediment
        accretion, and provides food for aquatic organisms. The vegetation
        also stabilizes shifting sediments and adds oxygen to the water. SAV
        is sensitive to pollution and shading by turbid water.

        In the mid-Atlantic region, Mid-Atlantic Integrated Assessment
        (MAIA) field crews noted the presence or absence of SAV at their
        sampling stations as an ancillary measurement, but no attempt
        was made to estimate the extent of SAV. For the Chesapeake Bay,
        however, SAV extent is an ecological endpoint, and restoration of
        SAV is one of the goals of the Chesapeake Bay Program (Batiuk,
        etal., 2000),

        What the Data  Show

        Scientists estimated that historically there were about 600,000
        acres of SAV in the Chesapeake Bay. A 1978 aerial survey estimated
        that this SAV acreage had decreased to 41,000 acres, but total
        acreage had increased to  over 69,000 acres by 2000-(Moore, et
        al., 2000). Extent measures are not currently available for the rest
        of the nation's estuarine systems.
Indicator Gaps and  Limitations

The limitations of this indicator include the following:

• SAV estimates have been analyzed and reported only for the
  mid-Atlantic estuaries but not for the entire U.S.

• These SAV estimates are for presence/absence only and do not
  indicate the density or abundance of the vegetation. More
  quantitative approaches using remote sensing are being used,
  but this information is not currently available for the entire U.S.
  coastline.
Data Source

The data sources for these indicators were Chesapeake Bay
Submerged Aquatic Vegetation Water Quality and Habitat-Based
Requirements and Restoration Targets: A Second Technical
Synthesis, U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Chesapeake Bay
Program, 2000; and Mid-Atlantic Integrated Assessment, MAIA-
Estuaries,  1997-1998 Summary Report, U.S. Environmental
Protection Agency, May 2003. (See Appendix B, page B-47, for
more information.)
                   risn abnormalities - Category 2
        External abnormalities in fish can include lumps, growths, ulcers,
        fin rot, gill erosion, and gill discoloration. The cause of an abnor-
        mality is not always chemical contamination—it could also result
        from an injury or disease. A high incidence of such conditions
        could, however, indicate an environmental problem.

        What the Data Show

        The EPA EMAP Estuaries Program examined more than 100,000
        fish from estuaries in the Virginian, Carolinian, Lousianian, and
        West Indian Province estuaries for evidence of disease, parasites,
        tumors and lesions on the skin, malformations of the eyes, gill
        abnormalities, and skeletal curvatures. Of all the fish examined,
        only 0.5  percent (454 fish) had external abnormalities (EPA,
        ORD, OW, September 2001). Of the fish examined, bottom-feed-
        ing fish had the highest incidence of disease, but this incidence
        was still low. There is no criterion for what constitutes a  high or
        low number offish abnormalities.
Indicator Gaps and  Limitations

The limitations of this indicator include the following:
• Fish abnormality estimates are hot available nationally for U.S.
  estuaries.
n Fish abnormalities can result from both natural causes such as
  injury and from chemical contamination, and the cause cannot
  be readily assessed.


Data Source

The data source for this indicator was National Coastal Condition
Report, U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, September 2001,
using data from the Environmental Monitoring and Assessment
Program, Estuaries Program. (See Appendix B, page B-47, for more
information.)
     Chapter 5 - Ecological Condition         5.7 What is the Ecological Condition of Coasts and Oceans?
                                                       5-61

-------

IndicffQi:!
Unusual marine mortalities - Category 2
                                                                                                —!
  Unusual marine mortalities are characterized by an abnormal num-
  ber of dead animals in locations or at times of the year that are
  not typical for that species. For animals such as turtles, whales,
  dolphins, seals, sea lions, or similar vertebrates, where small num-
  bers of deaths can be significant, this indicator reports the actual
  number of dead animals. For other more abundant animals such as
  fish, sea birds, and shellfish, the number of mortality events is
  recorded. The cause of these unusual events might include infec-
  tious disease, toxic algae, pollutants, or natural events.

  What  the Data  Show

  More than 2,500 California sea lions were involved in unusual
  marine mortalities in 1992, which is more than 10 times the num-
  ber of seals, sea lions, sea otters, or manatees lost in similar
  events since 1992 (The Heinz Center, 2002) (Exhibit 5-37). The
  next two largest events were the deaths of 150 manatees off the
  Florida coast in 1996 and the deaths of 185 California sea lions in
  1997 (The Heinz Center, 2002). No causes for these events were
  cited in the Heinz report (The Heinz Center, 2002).
                                                 Indicator Gaps and Limitations

                                                 The limitations of this indicator include the following:
                                                             1                        i
                                                 • This indicator represents only unusual events; it does not
                                                   represent cill observed mortalities of marine organisms.
                                                             i       ,     ,,          'i        M
                                                 • Criteria or thresholds do not exist for assessing the importance
                                                   of unusual mortalities.               i
                                                 • It is not pcissible to determine if the ev^nt was caused by
                                                   natural phenomena such as El Nino or vjras the result of
                                                   anthropogenic influences.
                                                 • The data are not available on a national basis.
                                                  Data Source

                                                  The data source for this indicator was The, State of the Nation's
                                                  Ecosystems, The Heinz Center, 2002, using data from the U.S.
                                                  Department of Commerce, National Odeanic and Atmospheric
                                                  Administration, National Marine Fisheries, Office of Protected
                                                  Resources, Marine Mammal Health, Stranding Response Program,
                                                  CRC Handbook of Marine Mammal Medicine: Health, Disease, and
                                                  Rehabilitatior,, 2nd edition (Dierauf and Culland, eds., 2001).
                                                  (See Appendix B, page  B-47, for more information.)
                                 Exhibit 5-37: Unusual marine mortaliti<£ 1992-2001
                                             quate tor National Keporungj
                               Partial Indicator Data: Marine Mammals
                        2500r
                                                                                        Whales,
                                                                                        Dolphins and
                                                                                        Porpoises
                                                                                        Seals, Sea
                                                                                        Lions, Sea
                                                                                        Otters and
                                                                                        Manatees
                            0
                           1990            1995
                      Coverage: all U.S. waters.
                                               2000
                                                                                                     i
                      Source: The Heinz Center. The State of the Nation's EcbsyslemsT2002.
                      Data from the National Marine Fisheries Service and Dierauf and Culland (2001).
                                                  	'	aiSL_   _-  v,    _   :>,]   -I
5-62
                                                                                    i

    5.7 What is the Ecological Condition of Coasts and Oceans?          CJiapter 5 -| Ecological Condition

-------
Summary:  me Ecological Condition of Coasts and

Oceans

Coasts and oceans are subject to the same pressures as fresh waters,
especially because they represent the endpoint for most fresh water
drainage networks. Problems are exacerbated by the  hydrology of
estuaries, which tends to create conditions ideal for concentration of
pollutants entering from upstream.

Landscape condition
The extent of this resource has been described by EPA and NOAA,
and the landscape composition of much of the nation's coastline is
known, providing a  baseline against which to monitor future changes.
As an example, 400,000 of 5,000,000 acres of coastal wetland
were lost since the  mid-1950s, although the loss rate declined in the
1990s (The Heinz Center, 2002). The baseline information is inade-
quate, however, for coral reefs, shellfish beds, and SAV,  although a
survey in Chesapeake Bay indicates that the acreage of SAV there
increased from 41,000 to 69,000 acres since 1978  (Moore, et al.,
2000). The estuarine. landscape structure and pattern, and their
contribution to ecological condition, remain inadequately measured
or understood.

Biotic condition

The National Coastal Assessment, a joint federal and state
interagency national monitoring program implemented to assess
the ecological condition of the  nation's estuaries, has developed
regional data on several biotic condition indicators, including fish,
benthic communities, and SAV. The program is also monitoring
abnormalities and tissue contaminants. Results from three regions
(Northeast, Southeast, and Gulf) indicate that, on average,
44 percent of the bottom community was in fair or poor condition,
but this number varies among regions. Chlorophyll  concentrations,
which reflect the amount of phytoplankton growing in the water
column, were over the recommended limit of 15 ppm  (to protect
SAV beds) over one-third of the estuarine area in the mid-Atlantic
states. No similar estimates are  yet available nationwide. Of more
than 100,000 fish in random trawls from Maine to  Texas, less than
0.5 percent showed visible evidence of disease, parasites, tumors
or lesions of the skin, malformation  of the eyes or gills, or skeletal
curvature..Fish tissue contamination (other than non-toxic arsenic)
was found in about 4 percent offish.
Chemical and physical characteristics
A number of physical and chemical indicators are being monitored in
estuarine systems to help diagnose and interpret biotic condition
information. Data are available only for estuaries on the Atlantic or
Gulf coasts, but 18 percent of mid-Atlantic estuaries were judged to
have high nitrogen concentrations (which can lead to harmful algal
blooms), and  12  percent had high concentrations of phosphorus.
Twenty percent of Atlantic and Gulf estuaries had low dissolved oxy-
gen concentrations (<5 ppm). On average, 75 percent of the sedi-
ments had elevated pesticide concentrations, and 40 percent had
elevated concentrations of heavy metals, again with significant varia-
tion from region to region. Ten percent of the sediments showed a
positive response to toxicity tests using a marine amphipod. Only
4 percent of the estuaries had poor light penetration.

There were no Category 1 or 2 indicators of ecological processes,
hydrology and geomorphology,  or natural disturbance regimes available
for this report. The dearth of indicators for ecological processes is
likely due, in part, to the fact that these indicators typically require
repeated visits over several days, which makes systematic sampling in
estuaries time-consuming and expensive. Procedures using remote
sensing to assess ecological processes are being developed, but
these are not ready for national or regional implementation.
Hydrologic indicators may be similar to those for fresh water
systems, but are complicated by the complex flows caused by tides
and other phenomena in estuaries. An indicator of sea level change
also may be useful. Storms, hurricanes, and similar disturbances are
monitored globally, nationally, regionally, and locally, but this
information has not been developed in the form of an indicator.

Information on disturbance regimes could also be used to partition
observed estuarine system responses into portions attributable to
natural versus anthropogenic disturbances.
Chapter 5 - tcological Condition         5.7 What is the Ecological Condition of Coasts and Oceans?
                                                         5-63

-------


5.8   What  Is  the
tcological  Condition  of
the  tntire  Nation:
The previous sections asked questions about the ecological condi-
tion of forests, coasts and oceans, fresh water ecosystems, urban
and suburban areas, farmlands, and grasslands and shrublands
nationally. Because ecosystems are hierarchical (O'Neill, et al., 1986)
some important questions about ecological condition cannot be
answered in terms of these land cover classes. Examples of large-
scale issues include the following:
                                             Because EPA's; regulatory programs, both a|lone and in combination,
                                             typically impc.ct many kinds of ecosystems^ such large-scale ques-
                                             tions are an important part of tracking the! overall effectiveness of
                                             these programs in protecting the entire nation.
                                             Exhibit 5-38 shows the indicators for the
                                                                ;ntire nation used in this
                                             report. All seven of the indicators are take i from the core national  '
                                             indicators in Jhe State of the Nation's Ecosystems (The Heinz Center, ';
                                             2002). There are indicators for four of the six essential ecological
                                             attributes with at least regional data, but no indicators on hydrology
                                             and geomorphology or natural disturbance regimes with data avail- ;
                                             able on a national or regional level (The Heinz Center, 2002).
• The relative distribution of
  forests, grasslands, farmlands,
  and urban/suburban areas
  across the entire nation.

• Neotropical migratory birds and
  other species do not depend on
  one ecosystem type, but many,
  often spread over large regions.
• The condition of forest streams,
  and of other low-order streams
  across regions, was considered in
  Section 5.6, but processes in
  very large watersheds (e.g., the
  Mississippi or Columbia  River
  basins) reflect the sum total of
  contributions from many
  ecosystem types.
• Typically, large systems are
  slower to change and to respond
  to management actions (O'Neill,
  etal., 1986; Messer, 1992).
  Global climate change and
  changes in stratospheric ozone
  are examples of stressors of this
  type (Rosswall, et al., 1988).
S-64
                 jEngscape Conaitioti
                  Landscape Composition
                Jj Landscape Pattern/Structure
                                                    At-risk native species
Ecosystems and Communities
                                                    Bird Community Index
Species and Populations
                '_  Organism Condition
                 1 Ecological Processes
                                                    Terrestrial Plant Growth Index
                                                    Movement of nitrogen
                i!  Nutrient Concentrations
                  Other Chemical Parameters
                                                    Chem cal contamination
                  Trace Organic and Inorganic Chemicals
                  Physical Parameters
                  ^VHirnh'i	•	I	i	' 	^	'	'..h llf, •Hi „ I'; "' ^	ni	L
                  Hvdroloev and Geomoroholoev
                  Hydrology and
                  nr "-I!"*''" '•	BW. .mr.s
                                     Surface and Ground Water Flows
                                     Dynamic Structural Conditions
                                     Sediment and Material Transport
5.8 What Is the Ecological Condition of the Entire Nation?
                                                                 .cological Condition

-------

                      ;.-..; :..,.• K- .--.-.. — •   -•  •':-•" .--. - : .-... --.. ::. -  -• .''- '.••; • •  • ,;' •'• '/-!•-;' •  -'-' •''•- ; . •"' :."• '- •- •  •-':. ".•-='-".-' -•" -:?-'•'•' '-.«• ':• •I-V.* •1L'".t;7'1- .'...'•";-:: ^'-^'J1''-'1"^^';^:;*1'-..-,,;^ I.1-!1;'.-' -'V, ••'?•'••' ••-•'''-/ •' -•.•• '. :
                                                                                              '^fs^t^^if^y^^sssf-- >;^^j'^fei;^>!i"*'^i^^^
                 tcosystem extent - (Category 2
   Extent provides basic information on how much of an ecosystem
   exists, where it is, and whether it is changing over time. Changes in
   the extent of various cover types in the U.S. have been driven prima-
   rily by human land and water uses over the past 400 years. The total
   amount and relative distribution of land-cover types at the regional
   and national level are important, because ultimately they affect many
   of the ecological attributes such as biodiversity. For example, not only
   do forest species depend on forests, but many forest species also
   depend on adjacent wetlands or grasslands.

   What the Data  Show

   Estimates show that before European settlement, the U.S. had 1
   billion acres of forests (USDA, FS, 2002), 900 to 1,000 million
   acres of grasslands and shrublands  (Klopatek,  et al.,  1979) and
   221  million acres of wetlands (Dahl, 2000). Today, the U.S. has
   749 million acres of forests (USDA, FS, 2002), 861 million acres
   of grasslands and shrublands (The Heinz  Center, 2002), and 106
   million acres of wetlands  (Dahl, 2000). About 530 million acres
   of croplands (USDA, NRCS, 2000) and 90 million acres of urban
   and suburban land uses (USDA,  NRCS, 2001) have been added.

   The acreage of forest and fresh water wetlands have  each declined
   by about 10 million  acres in the  decades  since the 1950s; the
   acreage of croplands has fluctuated, but it is currently about 35
   million acres less than in the 1950s; and urban areas have grown
   by 40  million  acres during the same period (The Heinz Center,
   2002); (Exhibit 5-39).

   Indicator Gaps  and  Limitations

   According to The Heinz Center (2002.), the National Land Cover
   Database  (NLCD) produced different estimates of area for forests
   and farmlands from those mentioned above, because of differ-
   ences in the definitions of these systems  in the Forest Inventory
   and Analysis (FIA) and the  USDA Economic Research Service
   (ERS). In addition, current  indicators of extent do not provide
   information about fragmentation and landscape patterns.

   Data Sources

   The data.sources for these indicators were Forest Inventory and
   Analysis, U.S.  Department of Agriculture  (1979-1995); National
   Land Cover Database, Multi-Resolution Land Characteristics
   Consortium (1990s); National Wetlands  Inventory, U.S. Fish and
   Wildlife Service (1970-2000); and Economic Research Service,
   U.S. Department of Agriculture (1982-1997).  (See Appendix B,
   page B-48, for more information.)
              -39 C-hange in ecosystem extent, long-term and
                   recent trends, I950s-I990s
  d*t|al Indicator Data Long-term Changes for For Forests, Croplands,
  isslands/Shriiblands, Urban/Suburban
                                                  Grasslands and
                                                  Shrublands
  irttat Indicator Data Recent Trends for Forests, Croplands, Grasstands/Shrubfands,
     '"uburSan, Freshwater Wetlands
          19^0   1970
leverage lower 48 states
                                                    Grassland/
                                                    Shrublands
                                                    (satellite)
                                                    Fdrests
                                                    Forests
                                                    (satellite)
                                                    Croplands
                                                    (satellite)
                                                    Croplands
                                                    Freshwater
                                                    W etfands
                                                    Urban
                                                    Urban/
                                                    Suburban
                                                    (satellite)
                                         2000,
 _..„_ Because these estimates are from different sources, they do not sum to 100%  £
 tf U S land area  Approximately 5% of lands are not accounted for by these data
 Dtirces They include some wetfands, some nan suburban developed areas disturbed Jj
 !n|jjjis such as mines; ancfquames and the like In addition freshwater wetlands
Ibtjrrentry occupy approximateK/S% of the area of the lower 48 states, a reduction of
labput 50% since presettlement times Because they are found within forests
 grasslands and shrublands or croplands, freshwater wetlands from those ecosystems
 ^efshown as aggregated data on the graph Finally, the urban" trend line in this
 ;raphj£ based on a different definition from the one in this report and is presented   J
 gre_to illustrate general trends. Trie definition used in this .report was used to.
jgeneratethe urban/suburban (satellite)" area estimate.    .   ...        , .
^Source 1\]s_HemzCent^.T^ State of the Nation's Ecosystems. 2002.
fEla^ajTom the USDA Forest Service (forests, current area, recent trends), USDA
^Economic Research Service (croplands trends, urban area trends), Multi-Resolution
  rid Characterization Consortium" (MRLC^af) satelite data, including currerit estimate
  'grass/shrub anil u^bTn7suEurban area in, top graph). Presettlement estimates,.are
    Klopateketal 197S.J,"_, ""^ ". '..-^^..'.'.•', -,',,.,"  .,,,n.' „ , ^.,',:,,,V:,'.,-,.;' ,
Chapter 5 - Ecological Condition           5.8 What Is the Ecological Condition of the Entire Nation?
                                                             5-65

-------
El As Draft jNJeport on the Environment 200^3

                                                                            cnca


              At-risR native species - Category 2

  Scientists are engaged in considerable discussion about the
  importance of rare and at-risk species for the sustainability of
  ecosystems (e.g., Grime, 1997; Hodgson, et al., 1998; Naeem, et
  al., 1999; Tilman and Downing, 1994; Wardle, et al., 2000). There
  are at (east 200,000 native plant, animal, and microbial species in
  the U.S., but according to The Heinz Center (2002), "little is
  known about the status and distribution of most of these." This
  indicator represents what is known about 22 species groups,
  including 16,000 plant species and 6,000 animal species. It
  includes all higher plants; all terrestrial and fresh water vertebrates
  (i.e., mammals, birds, reptiles, amphibians, and fish); select inverte-
  brate groups, including fresh water mussels and snails, crayfishes,
  butterflies and skippers; and about 2,000 species of grasshop-
  pers, moths, beetles, and other invertebrates (The Heinz Center,
  2002). The Heinz Center believes that this indicator is a power-
  ful—yet manageable—snapshot of the condition of U.S. species.
  No data are available for marine species, which led The Heinz
  Center to rank this as an indicator equivalent to a
  Category 2. Special groupings of these species have
  been used as indicators in specific ecosystem cate-
  gories. This indicator includes all of them, but The
  Heinz Center has not analyzed species dependent on
  large or multiple ecosystems.
                                                                 Indicator Gaps and  Limitations

                                                                The data are from a census approach that fo.cuses on the location
                                                                and distribution of at-risk species. Therefore] distinguishing trends in
                                                                the indicator is difficult.
                                                                            i                       ;  I    .    .      .

                                                                 Data Source                   ;
                                                                            !          L-              i
                                                                            !                       '  '
                                                                The data for this indicator was The State pflthe Nation's Ecosystems,
                                                                The Heinz Center, 2002, using data from the NatureServe Explorer
                                                                database. (Sets Appendix B, page B-48, fonmore information.)
  What the  Data Show

  One-third of species native species are at risk, and
  1 percent of plant and 3 percent of animal species
  might already be extinct (The Heinz Center, 2002)
  (Exhibit 5-40). Approximately 19 percent of native
  animal species and IS percent of native plant species
  are ranked as imperiled or critically imperiled. There
  are large differences among plant and animal groups
  and among regions. For example, the percentage of at-
  risk fresh water species such as mussels and crayfish is
  much higher than that for birds or mammals, and more
  at-risk species are found in California, Hawaii, the
  southern Appalachians, and Florida than elsewhere
  (Stein, 2002).
                                                               i txnipit S-^tO^/^tris^R landjina Jreikwater^^^^
                                                               .MV«I       IK;.  :sn"'""',. "*     ^ ""~ "tr\r\r\"	
                                                                  plant ang animal native species, /OOO
                                                         3S
                                                              t  Land and FresSwater Plants    Land and Fresh water Animats
                                                                   »  *
                                                           Coverage: all SO
                                                           Source: The Heinz
                                                                                • Critically Imperiled
                                                                              TV l^^lf^ WV'T^^/T ^  -^^ ^ ^    ^   tf*
                                                                              ^•imperiled
                                                                                  All At-Risk
                                                           .2UU4VCV * IWZ 1 Idlt*£. V-dlll-d. I*IC ^tdrte Cg tnC IVflfflOJl S i_s»t^j»js&»nu- JE-VTVI
                                                             |      j-      ^ppntM;L.1*'?!^*1 *Wt .,    ^ fr^^'-"«^-«'^*«'**
                                                      *     Data thorn NatureSente and its Natural Heritage member programs.
                                                      *       *„ sr  n,^  f  -^^HSWfWMWWfc'WW    *<*##a>•fcm^'^ «f9W*| WiWWnBje
                                                                                                            a^jar _
                                                                                                            002,
5-66
                    5.8 What Is the Ecological Condition of the Entire Nation?          Chapter 5 - 'Icdlogical Condition

-------

                Bird Community Index - (Category 2

   The types of birds observed in an area have been shown to serve as
   an indicator of the overall characteristics of the landscape. Species
   vary in their sensitivity to physical, chemical, and biological threats,
   and different species require different habitats for food, shelter, and
   reproduction. Some species need extensive areas of interior forest,
   others prefer the edges between different types of land cover or
   mixed areas, and still others prefer disturbed or highly managed
   areas. Consequently, the composition of the bird community reflects
   the overall mix, pattern, and condition of the mosaic of forest, agri-
   culture, grasslands and shrublands, wetlands, streams, and
   urban/suburban areas that makes up most of the U.S. landscape.
                                   The Bird Community Index (BCI) was developed by O'Connell, et al.
                                   (1998, 2000) for songbirds in the mid-Atlantic states. The index
                                   was developed based on data collected at 34 reference sites, with
                                   bird species classified into 16 functional groups according to the
                                   degree to which they specialized in using the native flora and fauna
                                   in an area (high  BCI scores) versus being generalists and exotic or '
                                   invasive species  (low BCI scores). The BCI then was applied to a
                                   probability sample of bird data from  126 sites across the Mid-
                                   Atlantic Highlands.
                      txhibit 5-UI: Dird species as characteristics or landscape composition and pattern as an indicator or
                                                     landscape condition, 1995-1996
                    Excellent
         Good
Ecological Conditions
         Fair
Poor Rural
Poor Urban
                                 S<
arlet Tanager, American Redstart, Black-and-White War >Ier, Black-Throated Green lyarbler, Hairy Woodpecker,
                  -' ™  • ,".-,".,;',>:M'LV"' '-• r: — ^V^^Uea -—**—•
                American Goldfinch, B -own Thrasher, Common Yel
                                                                                     Ovenbird, Cerulean" Wart
                                          House Sparrow, Hojuse Finch,-Rock Dove'(Pigeon), European Starling
                       iowthroat, Gray Catbird, Re i-Winged Blackbird, Yellow
                                         Shrub Nesters
                                                                       ler, Worm-Eating Warbler...
                                             tVarbler, Indigo Bunting...
                                           'igein),.!
              : 87% Forest Cover
              •• 80 ft. Height
  = 87% Forest Cover
  = 65 ft. Height
  = 47%CanopyC|osure
                         >61 % Non-Woody
                          Plant/Agriculture
                   >29% Residential/
                      Commercial
            Coverage' Mid-Atlantic Highlands (Maryland, Pennsylvania, Virginia, West Virginia)
            Source • EPA, Office of Research and Development. Birds Indicate Ecological Condition of the Mid-Atlantic Highlands June 2000
Chapter 5 - Tlcological Condition           5.8 What is the Ecological Condition of the Entire Nation?
                                                                                               5-67

-------

               Bird Community Index - Category 2 (continued)
                                                                                                      i
                                                                             L	
  What the Data Show

  Good-to-excellent BCI scores (diverse communities of birds charac-
  terized by many specialists and native species) were associated with
  at least 87 percent forest cover and a minimum of 47 percent
  canopy closure. Poor BCI scores (low diversity communities charac-
  terized by generalists and exotic species) were associated with
  either rural agricultural or urban areas where almost 30 percent of
  the landscape was in residential or commercial land use.

  The BCI was calibrated across a range of landscape conditions
  from least disturbed to significantly degraded. Based on this
  calibration, 43 percent of the Mid-Atlantic Highlands was estimat-
  ed to be in good to "excellent" condition (in other words, con-
  taining large tracts of interior forest), 36 percent was estimated to
  be in "fair" condition, and 21 percent (5 percent urban and 16
  percent rural) was estimated to be in "poor" condition (Exhibit 5-
  41). Forested sites in good and excellent condition supported dif-
  ferent bird communities and ground-level vegetation attributes,
  but could not be separated by land cover composition alone. As
  the proportion of the landscape in forested areas  decreased or
  the proportion of canopy closure decreased, so did the BCI
  scores (O'Connell, et al., 1998, 2000).
                                                                                                     7
                                              Indicator Caps and  Limitations

                                              The limitations of this indicator include th£ following:

                                              • This indicator depends on a value judgement common among
                                                ecologists that communities associated [with the native
                                                vegetation of a region are "better" than exotic, generalist
                                                species associated with human modification of the environment.

                                              B The BCI has been calibrated and assessed only for the Mid-
                                                Atlantic Highlands, and may not apply to areas where shoreline
                                                birds or migratory waterfowl are a largef component of the bird
                                                community.                        ;

                                              a The BCI relates primarily to land cover estimates, and does not
                                                explicitly include the condition of any particular land cover type.


                                              Data Source

                                              The data sources for this indicator were A Bird Community Index of
                                              Biotic Integrity for the Mid-Atlantic Highlands, O'Connell, et al.,
                                              1998; and B'rd Guilds as Indicators of Ecological Condition in the
                                              Central Applachians, O'Connell, et al., 2000, using data from U.S.
                                              Environmental Protection Agency Mid-Atlantic Highlands Program
                                              and the  National Land Cover Database;. (See Appendix B,
                                              page B-48, for more information.)       ;
5-68
5.8 What Is the Ecological Condition of the Entire Nation?          C-Kapter 5 • Ecological Condition

-------

                lerrestrial riant Curowtn Index - Category I
   Both the National Research Council and Science Advisory Board
   reports suggest that primary productivity (the amount of solar
   energy captured by plants through photosynthesis) is a key
   indicator of ecosystem function (NRC, 2000; SAB, 2002).
   Generally, ecosystems will maximize their primary productivity
   through adaptation (Odum, 1971), so primary productivity can
   increase under favorable conditions  (e.g., increased nutrients or
   rainfall) ;or decrease under unfavorable conditions (e.g., plant stress
   caused by toxic substances or disease). Changes in primary produc-
   tivity can result in changes in the way ecosystems function, in the
   yield of crops or timber, or in the animal species that live in the
   ecosystems.

   Gross  primary productivity is related to the standing crop of the
   photosynthetic pigment chlorophyll and can be thought of in
   simple terms as plant growth. The Terrestrial Plant Growth Index
   indicator is based on the Normalized Difference Vegetation Index
   (NDVI), which measures the amount of chlorophyll, using satellite
   data (The Heinz Center, 2002). While the standing crop of
   chlorophyll is not identical to primary productivity, EPAs Science
   Advisory Board (EPA, SAB, 2002) lists it as an example of an
   indicator under the ecological processes EEA.

   What  the  Data Show

   No overall trend in plant growth is observed for the 11 -year period
   from 1989 through 2000, for any land cover type or any region of
   the  U.S., although year-to-year measurements can fluctuate by  up
   to 40 percent of the 11 -year average (The Heinz Center, 2002)
   (Exhibit 5-42). Over a sufficiently long period, regional trends in
   NDVI could be an important indicator of increasing or decreasing
   plant growth resulting from changing climate, UV-B exposure, air
   pollution, or other stressors.

   Indicator Caps and Limitations

   There were no calculations for phytoplankton or submerged
   vegetation growth in fresh water or coastal systems.

   Data Source

   The data source for this indicator was The State of the Nation's
   Ecosystems, The Heinz Center, 2002, using data on visible and
   near-infrared wavelengths collected by the National Oceanic and
   Atmospheric Administration's Advanced Very High Resolution
   Radiometer and converted into a Normalized Difference
   Vegetation Index (Reed and Young,  1997). (See Appendix B, page
   B-49, for more information.)
                                                                                                                             ;?',^v.Ma£ig
lExkit.it 5-U2: Flant Growth Index, 1989-2000
       "I errestriai riant\3rowtn Index for lower U8 states
                                                Forests
                                                Grasslands/
                                                Shrublands
                                                Croplands
                                                All Three
                                                Systems
pTJa.rjt S3ro\«tfl Inaex^squ.thwest, rocky mountain, pacific regions
                                                Southwest
                                           	 Rocky
                                                Mountain
                                           ..... Pacific
                                           —— U.S. (lower 48)
  ,*:;:;:•, rlartt.tirpwtn Index: northeast, southeast,_rr|iavvest,regions
                                            .... Northeast/
                                                Mid-Atlantic
                                               ; Southeast
                                            	i.i	 Midwest
                                            — U.S. (lower 48)
                                       20OP..
     ;e: .Lower 4g.srtates. _.:- ....   ,.   •.  .. ..... .              ,       ,g
rp^e;~3ecause of .satellite problems, no.datai are. available for 1994.		     , ^
    ^,Jfie,^ei(r|zi^ep.tec!j,TlieFiStote of the Nation's Ecosystems. 2002.            "
  a_fro,,H)Mthe U,S,-Gie_QipgicaLSurvey; Multi-Resolution Land Characterization Consortium.'[
                                                                                                                                  J
Chapter 5 - Ecological Condition           5.8 What Is the Ecological Condition of the Entire Nation?
                                                       5-69

-------

                                                                            liiiiiiiiiii
  *TarrrH!ir
 Indicator
AAovement of nitrogen - Category

  Nitrogen is a critical nutrient for plants, and "leakage" of nitrogen
  from watersheds can signal a decline in ecosystem function
  (Vltousek, et al., 2002). It also may signal the failure of watershed
  management efforts to control point, non-point, and atmospheric
  sources of nitrogen pollutants, and the resulting nitrogen may
  have "cascading" harmful effects as it moves downstream to
  coastal ecosystems (Galloway and Cowling, 2002). Nitrate
  concentration in streams has served as an indicator of chemical
  condition in the other ecosystems in this section. This indicator,
  however, deals with nitrogen export from large watersheds, and is
  an indicator of ecosystem function.

  What the Data  Show
  Nitrate export from the Mississippi River has been monitored
  since the mid-1950s and from the Susquehanna, St. Lawrence,
  and Columbia Rivers since the 1970s, and is reported in The
  State of the Nation's Ecosystems in tons per year. The load in
  the Mississippi River has fluctuated from year to year, but it has
  increased from approximately 250,000 tons per year in the
  early 1960s to approximately 1,000,000 tons per year during
  the 1980s and 1990s (The Heinz             _ __  _
  Center, 2002)  (Exhibit 5-43).
  The Mississippi River drains the agri-
  cultural "breadbasket" of the nation
  and contains a large percentage of
  the growing population, so the
  increases likely reflect failure to
  control nitrogen pollution, rather than
  a breakdown in ecosystem function
  (e.g., Rabalais and Turner, 2001).
  Nitrate loads in the other three rivers
  have fluctuated around 50,000 tons
  per year since the 1970s, although
  the Columbia River spiked to
  100,000 tons per year in the
  late 1990s.
                                                Indicator Caps and  Limitations
                                                The indicator does not include data from
                                                      numerous coastal water-
                                                sheds whose human populations are rapidly increasing and are
                                                therefore estimated to have high nitrogen
                                                      loss rates (e.g., Valigura,
                                                et al., 2000). It also does not include other forms of nitrogen
                                                besides nitrate, which may constitute a substantial portion of the
                                                nitrogen load.

                                                Data Source                  '

                                                The data source for this indicator was The State of the Nation's
                                                Ecosystems, The Heinz Center, 2002, using data collected by the
                                                U.S. Geological Survey, National Stream Quality Accounting
                                                Network and National Water Quality Assessment Program, and by
                                                the U.S. Army Corps of Engineers. (See Appendix B, page B-49,
                                                for more information.)                >
                          _ ,  ,	   ,    r-        ,         -
                        rexhibit 5-43:  Nitrate load carried  by major rivers, 1970-1999
                                                                                                   t l,
                        fc~o
                        •  +j
                          o
                        ''•
                             2500
                             2000
                             1500
1000
                                            500
                                               0
                                                     r<*»{j
                                                     j-w,fi
                                                  Mississippi
                                                •   1 3    ""   %
                                            —— Susquehanna
                                                  * | 1   -s (i*  i
                                            -•-»- St. Lawrence
                                                   1 1
                                                  Columbia
                                              1950  1960

                                       Coverage: selected major rivers.
                                                          I            HfcS^^ ^  ^I"   *^S ^        I  hf w "* «h  nu ^            £fe
                                       Source: The Heinz Center. The State of the Nation's Ecosystems. 2002.
                                     |Data from the U.S. Geological Surve^NatiSnal Stream Quality Metwork (NA'SQAN),
                                     I National Water Quality Assessment fRlAWQA), and Federal-State Cooperative Program/
                                     e                                  ifch-     "'   -"      -  '  .)   ««   4'te   »  j,Mt ^
5-70
    5.8 What Is the Ecological Condition of the Entire Nation?          Chapter 5 -
                                                       Icologio
al Condition

-------

               CJiemical contamination - Category 2

   This indicator has been discussed for the individual ecosystems,
   but here it is reported for all media, regardless of land-cover type.
   The following is a summary of the key findings; the Heinz report
   (2002) should be consulted for further details.

   What the  Data  Show

   Three-fourths of all streams in the National Water Quality
   Assessment (NAWQA) network had one or more contaminants
   that exceeded guidelines for the protection of aquatic life, and
   one-fourth had four or more contaminants over those levels. One-
   fourth of ground water wells sampled had one or more contami-
   nants above human health standards. One-half of all streams had
   one or, more contaminants in sediments that exceeded wildlife
   protection guidelines  (usually more stringent than criteria to pro-
   tect human health). One-half of all fish tested had one or more
   contaminants that exceeded wildlife protection guidelines.
   Approximately 60 percent of estuarine sediments tested had con-
   centrations of contaminants expected to lead to "possible effects"
   in aquatic life, and 2 percent had concentrations exceeding  levels
   expected to have "likely effects."

   Indicator Gaps  and  Limitations

   The limitations of this indicator include the following:

   • While these data represent a comparison of a standard to the
     respective contaminant concentration, they do not represent
     assessments of risk posed to humans or ecosystems.
   • Different standards also reflect different levels of protection, so
     these data should be interpreted cautiously.

   • Media contamination, such as water or sediment contamination,
     does'not necessarily indicate exposure to the contaminant for
     either humans or other biological populations.
Data Source

The data source for this indicator was The State of the Nation's
Ecosystems, The Heinz Center, 2002, using data from the National
Water Quality Assessment Program and the Environmental
Monitoring and Assessment Program, Estuaries Program.
(See Appendix B, page B-SO, for more information.)
Chapter 5 - £cological Condition          5.8 What Is the Ecological Condition of the Entire Nation?
                                                      5-71

-------

Summary: TKe Ecological Condition of tne Entire Nation       Ecological processes

The idea of monitoring indicators that could include the entire
nation, irrespective of the type of land cover, has not been a main
topic of ecological monitoring. The main idea is that pressures acting
over large areas may have effects that transcend a land cover type,
or may depend on the interaction of land cover types. The issue of
scale has not been well-articulated with  respect to these indicators
(issues of national scope may not operate at national scales).  This is
an area of attention for future reports.

Landscape condition
The National Land Cover Database (NLCD) now provides a consis-
tent national picture of the extent of the various ecosystem types at
30 meter (about 100 foot) resolution (Vogelmann, et al., 2001). A
consortium of federal agencies performs the interpretation of the
satellite data necessary for development of the NLCD. Much of the
data in this indicator come from the Forest Inventory and Analysis
(FIA) or the National Resources Inventory (NRI), which allows trends
to be estimated during periods prior to  the first NLCD coverage.
Unfortunately, these data are not comparable to the NLCD, because
of differences in the definitions of the land cover categories (see
Chapter 3, Better Protected Land).

Blotic condition
With respect to the at-risk native species indicator, the NatureServe
database is an invaluable resource for identifying these species.
Because the resulting data are developed without an underlying
statistical design, however, it will be difficult to determine whether
future trends are the result of more thorough field work and report-
ing by researchers and resource managers, or actual trends in  the
number of at-risk species. An effort has  begun to identify all species
in the Smoky Mountain National Park (Kaiser, 1999), and an
international effort, called  Species 2000, is being developed by a
multinational project team associated with the United Nations (U.N.)
Convention of Biological Diversity. Recent research expanding the
bird diversity index to the entire mid-Atlantic region shows that it
has promise as a national indicator (O'Connell, et al., 2002).
Analysis of the biological data from the  first 20 National Water
Quality Assessment (NAWQA) study units, and similar analyses of
Environmental Monitoring  and Assessment Program (EMAP) data
from the national estuaries and streams in the West and Midwest,
should shed some light on the feasibility of a national indicator for
estuarine and stream benthic communities. Because the plankton
communities of lakes do not exhibit a high degree of biogeographical
variation (independent of natural factors such as hardness or the
presence of organic color), a national plankton index would seem
feasible if the necessary data were collected.
                                               The Terrestrial Plant Growth Index is probably the best example of the
                                               indicator of primary productivity called for by both the NRC (2000)
                                               and SAB (2002). Comparable data exist orj trends for a decade, with
                                               census coverage (at the resolution of the AjVHRR sensor) for the
                                               conterminous U.S. Examination of the trends data for this indicator
                                               in The  Heinz Center (2002) report shows jarge (±40 percent)       '
                                               excursions from the 11 -year average in the Southwest, and ±20 per-
                                               cent excursions in the Pacific  region. The amount of time necessary
                                               to separate changes caused by air pollutants (e.g., ozone, nitrogen
                                               deposition, carbon dioxide) from those caused by natural climatic
                                               factors and insect and disease outbreaks is unknown.
                                               The Movement .of Nitrogen indicator certainly captures trends in this
                                               important nutrient in the nation's largest river basins. The indicator
                                               would be improved if it included total nitrcigen, including an accurate
                                               estimate of nitrogen carried in the bed loa[d of sediments as it moves
                                               into coastal waters, and if it were extended^ to the many smaller
                                               coastal watersheds that are experiencing large increases in popula-
                                               tion. An indicator of sediment runoff potential would be a useful
                                               large-ecosystem indicator if it were extended to non-farmland
                                               ecosystems (see Chapter 3, Better Protected Land).
                                                           '                          i
                                               Chemical and physical characteristics  i

                                               The Chemical Contamination indicator raises a serious question about
                                               how representative the streams in the  NAWQA study units are.
                                               There were 119  NAWQA sites with surface water monitoring data,
                                               located in 201 geographically well-dispersed watersheds across the
                                               U.S. Eventually,  NAWQA plans to expand to 60 such units, and pre-
                                               sumably all will include water sampling. On a national basis, this
                                               might be an adequate  number to represent the range of factors
                                               affecting ecological condition of the streams and watersheds. The
                                               number of streams characterizing forest, farmland, or urban/subur-
                                               ban watersheds seems too small, however, given the very wide  range
                                               of nutrient and contaminant concentrations presented in the Heinz
                                               report.

                                               More important, however, is whether the streams sampled are repre-
                                               sentative of the range  of streams in the entire nation. The ecological
                                               condition of fresh waters (and their watersheds) reflects the sum
                                               total of natural factors (including disturbances), conscious and
                                               unconscious decisions about land-use management (e.g., what crops
                                               to grow, whether and when to cut timber.j urban planning and zon-
                                               ing), and th« presence and control of  pollutants. A particular stream
                                               might be representative of a watershed) with respect to geomorphol-;
                                               ogy and hydrology, and even land use (e.g., corn or tree farming,
                                               urban or suburban). But resource management decisions and the
                                               presence or control of pollutants are particular to a specific water-
                                               shed, and so the streams must be chosen to be representative of the
                                               full range of possibilities, and of their relative frequencies. With
                                               respect to pollution control, assuming that the full set of environ-
                                               mental controls are working as envisioned by EPA is particularly risky.
                                               In fact, this risk is one  of the primary reasons for monitoring
5-72
5.8 What Is the Ecological Condition of the Entire Nation?           C_napter 5 -, tcological C-ondition

-------
      progress toward national goals under GPRA; to determine if the pro-
      grams, as implemented and enforced by the states are really protect-'
    .  ing and restoring the biological integrity of fresh waters. In this con-
      text, identifying representative streams or watersheds is not as rea-
      sonable as identifying representative samples of .streams or water-
      sheds. Until the NAWQA streams can be compared to a statistically
      representative sample of streams, great care must be taken in assum-
     ing that the data accurately reflect the national condition of fresh
     waters and watersheds.

     There were no Category 1 or 2 indicators available for this report
     for hydrology and geomorphology or natural disturbance regimes, but
     developing them does not seem to be a particularly daunting  •
     challenge, given the widely available data on geology, flow, and
     paleological methods to indicate the regional occurrence of climatic
     events and fire.
'Chapter 5 - Ecological Conditi
.ion
              5.8 What Is the Ecological Condition of the Entire Nation?
                                                                                                                             5-73

-------


5.9   CJnallenges  and
DataG
aps
The availability of indicators across ecosystem types is summarized in
Exhibit 5-44. Indicators that currently can provide national informa-
tion on ecological condition are available for only 14 of the possible
126 indicator categories in the framework. More than half of the
Category 1 indicators provide information only on ecosystem extent
and landscape composition, with a few exceptions:
• The Forest Inventory and Analysis (FIA)  and Forest Health
  Monitoring (FHM) programs together have achieved representative
  national coverage for both the present status and historical trends
  in the occurrence of fire, insect damage, and disease for forests.
• Satellite data provide continent-wide status and trends in the
  Normalized Difference Vegetation Index (NDVI), which serves as a
  surrogate for primary productivity, or the amount of energy
  available at the base of the ecosystems.17
• Historical hydrology data were analyzed for The Heinz Center
  report to determine trends in high and low-flows for more than
  800 streams with no specified land cover and more than 500
  forest streams across the U.S., and the number and duration of
  dry periods were calculated for 152 streams in grasslands,
  shrublands, and  dry areas. These analyses could presumably have
  been performed for urban/suburban, agricultural, and very large
  watersheds, but they have not been performed to date.
• The current status and historical trends in the potential for
  sediment transport from farmland can be calculated from existing
  data (though not the  amount of sediment actually lost).


For the rest of the essential ecological attributes, only partial data
exist, at best (e.g., regional data or data for only part of the
resource), for one  or more indicators. For more than one-half of the
major indicator categories in the seven ecosystem iypes, not even
one indicator was identified for this report. For many more, only one
existed, though several would be necessary. This situation will
improve slightly in  the next year or two. A number of active research
programs are collecting and analyzing relevant ecological condition
data at the national or regional level, but the results had not yet met
the criterion for peer review at the time this report was finalized. Two
years from  now, research on indicators from the FIA program, FHM
program, the National Water Quality Assessment (NAWQA) program,
and the Environmental Monitoring and Assessment Program ( EMAP)
Western Streams Pilot should provide new Category 2, and a few
Category 1 indicators, primarily biotic condition and ecological
process indicators. As of now, the gaps are substantial.

     "There is some debate as to whether standing crop chlorophyll can
really be a surrogate  for primary productivity, so this might be more appro-
priate as an ecosystem condition indicator.
What the rWailable Indicators Keveal iabout jome

tcological Issues or Tvecent Concern to tr/x
             :                         i                        :
The introduction to this chapter identifiedjthree reasons to monitor
ecological coridition:
• To establish baselines against which to assess the current and
  future condition of ecosystems.
• To provide ia warning that action may be required.
                                     I .                 -
• To track the outcomes of policies and programs, arid adapt them
  as necessary.                      '• <


This section addresses the question of how well the available
indicators of ecological condition, notwithstanding the gaps evident
in Exhibit 5-44, serve these purposes for some ecological issues that
have been of concern to EPA over the past decade. These do not
reflect all such issues, or signify EPA's priorities, but simply typify a
diverse set of challenges for national ecojogical monitoring:
n Forest dieback

BI Vertebrate deformities               !
n Harmful algal blooms
H Eutrophication
n Loss of biodiversity                 ;
• Non-target organism effects from pesticides and herbicides
• Issues related to ozone, UV-B, mercury, acidic deposition, and
  persistent bioaccumulative toxics (PBjTs)
                                                For the first five issues listed above, biota were harmed before the
                                                cause was known. For the other two, a perceived risk exists, but the
                                                extent of artual harm or exposure is unknown. In either case, data on
                                                the extent or trends in ecological condition is needed to inform how
                                                research is targeted or regulatory programs adjusted. Identifying indi-
                                                cators of the appropriate essential ecolqgical attribute also should help
                                                to identify'some of the factors that mignt be contributing to the  •
                                                extent of and trends in harm to biota and ecosystem function (EPA,
                                                SAB, 2002).                       I
                                                         i                         i
                                                                                  i
                                                Forest dieback

                                                Forest dieback can be exacerbated, if pot caused, by some combina-
                                                tion of acid deposition, air pollution, LJV-B radiation, disease, insects,
                                                and unusual climate events (USDA, FS; 2002). Currently, the  forest   '
                                                indicators; provide a baseline for the extent of poor tree condition in  i
                                                37 states; soon, these indicators will provide a baseline and future
                                                trends for the conterminous U.S. NDVl data are available as a surro-
                                                gate for primary productivity in forests.  FIA program plots are being
                                                examined for indications of harm to ozone-sensitive  species. Relevant
                                                soil data (exchangeable base cations) are being measured, even
 5-74
                 5.9 Challenges and Data Gaps
                       Chapter J5 - tcological Condition

-------

though that indicator cannot yet be reported. A UV-B monitoring
network has been collecting data for less than 2 years, and the data
are currently being evaluated. Data for ozone and acid deposition in
high elevation forests remain poor, as do climate data. Most of these
indicators are being monitored using a probability design, so contin-
ued FIA monitoring can provide a national baseline for assessing the
extent and trends in forest dieback, and some of the EEAs that may
contribute to it.            .      .   -

Vertebrate deformities

The ability of exogenous chemicals to  interfere with normal
endocrine functioning and related processes of an organism has
raised increasing concerns for human health and the environment.
Studies have reported that both synthetic and naturally occurring
compounds interfere with normal endocrine function of inverte-
brates, fish, amphibians, reptiles, birds, and mammals causing effects
such as birth defects, impaired fertility, masculinization of female
organisms, feminization of male organisms, or organisms with both
male and female reproductive organs. Two recent reports summarize
available data from field and laboratory studies and provide an
assessment of the state of the science (EPA, RAF, 1997; IPCS, 2002).
The existing challenge is to further elucidate the cause-and-effect
relationships for the observed adverse effects, determine which
chemicals are of greatest concern, and the extent to which these
chemicals negatively impact populations of fish and/or wildlife.

The only indicator identified in this chapter that tracks the extent or
trends in animal deformities (irrespective of the cause) is a Category
2 indicator, Fish Deformities, collected by EMAP in coast and ocean
ecosystems. Data are being collected on amphibian deformities by
the USGS, using reports from a wide array of sources. A new national
survey, the Amphibian Research and Monitoring Initiative, was estab-
lished by USCS in 2000. However, it may be several years before
USCS and EPA can detect national and/or regional trends from this
initiative. Until there is a better understanding of which chemicals are
of greatest concern, there is also some question about which chemi-
           :ij*"7i^"'.r^i-"ij ,;-,r — '~ ' ••'-'•- -Llf'- -' .' ' s '• T1 — ' — . , _ - •'.,-•,' -••••'.-'..-" .:'.••.'-'•' - - - • ' " " " " ' ' > • .
ifNbte: Numbers correspond to indicator categories presented in this report. : "----'-. •-;.., -,...*« -»»«««-» "••-'•"-'^S^-IT''"'
Ife-^- "• '"';-±- -'•''.
Chapter 5 - Ecological Condition           55.9 Challenges and Data Caps
                                                         5-75

-------
                                                      '        '''•''''•!                          '    !':; 11
ET/AS  Draft Mport oh the Environinent 2QO3 • Technical Document
                     '  rrr       -               .  •    •        •    M  r  ;••••'<•    .      :         •        •/r HI
 cals to monitor in the fish and wildlife habitat. Additional information
 on chemicals will become available once EPA has fully implemented
 an Endocrine Disruptor Screening Program to test a chemical for its
 potential endocrine disruption activity.

 Harmful algal blooms
 Scientists have also been concerned about the condition of the
 nation's estuaries and in particular, about a perceived increase in
 harmful algal blooms (HABs); loss of submerged aquatic vegetation
 (SAV), which serves as habitat for fish; and sediment toxicity, which
 might limit the productivity of an important component of the
 estuarine food chain (Anderson and Garrison, 2000; Gallagher and
 Keay, 1998). EMAP, working with the states, has collected data on the
 condition of SAV, estuarine fish communities, estuarine benthic
 communities, sediment toxicity, and nutrient concentrations that
 should provide representative-status and trends data for these
 indicators. The sampling design does not allow tracking of the
 frequency and extent of HABs or nutrient levels in estuaries, but USGS
 does monitor nutrient loads to coastal systems from four of the largest
 U.S. rivers. Continued monitoring of the estuaries is subject to state-
 by-state availability of funding.

 Eutrophication
 EPA has recently focused substantial attention on the listing by the
 states of their waters that do not meet their designated uses (usually
 expressed in terms of their ability to support aquatic life), and devel-
 oping total maximum daily loads of pollutants that would allow the
 designated use to be achieved. Concern over eutrophication of lakes
 and reservoirs has prompted EPA to begin developing regional stan-
 dards for the nutrients nitrogen and phosphorus. At present, there is
 no indicator monitoring suitable to track progress in reducing the
 number of eutrophic lakes and streams or the condition of the biotic
 communities in rivers and streams at the national or even regional
 level. Indicators monitored by the states are not comparable, the
 same waters are not necessarily sampled over time, and their repre-
 sentativeness is unknown and questionable. NAWQA uses compara-
 ble methods and intends to monitor the same streams over time, but
 the number of such streams in the various ecosystem types is too
 small to adequately represent all the factors that contribute to water
 quality at the national level. While the data are likely to be broadly
 representative of certain types of streams, they cannot be expanded
 to alt streams with known statistical reliability. This fact is particularly
 important if the combination of factors affecting water quality in the
 study units (which depend on a variety of factors, including water
 quality management by the states, national patterns of air pollution
 and acid rain, geology and land use, and climate) is not statistically
 representative of these factors nationally. EMAP  has demonstrated
 regional approaches to statistically representative sampling that
 include both biology and chemistry, but has not yet reported on
 relationships between them, nor is there any long-term commitment
 to repeating the pilot studies or expanding them to other regions.
 EPA is currently working with  the states to rectify this situation, and
 some progress is reported in Chapter 2, Purer Water.
                               toss of biodiversity

                               EPA is concerned generally about biodiversity, and this is one of the
                               primary areas on which EPA comments in Environmental Impact
                               Statements for significant projects involving federal funding under
                               NEPA. The NatureServe indicator reported for many of the ecosys-
                               tems is invaluable in indicating species at risk in the vicinity of such
                               projects. Becapse the database is not based  on a systematic survey
                               of plots over time, however, it is not clear now to interpret data that
                               are not reported. For example, the current data cannot distinguish
                               naturally rare species from species whose numbers have been
                               reduced. It is ;iot clear how to determine whether future trends are
                               the result of better (or less) field work or the actual status of the
                               species in question. The answer likely depends on the species, but at
                               this point the data seem less than ideal for national reporting.

                              . Non-target organism effects from pesticides and herbicides

                               EPA is concerned about non-target organism effects from pesticides
                               and herbicides. Pesticides and herbicides /including those
                               incorporated into the genomes of crops) are registered for use by
                               EPA such thai: their use in accordance with the registration is not
                               expected to pose unnecessary risks to non-target organisms.
                               Nonetheless, neither the models nor the compliance are likely to be
                               perfect, so tracking any residues of such pesticides in non-target
                               organisms would be useful, as would identifying any harm or
                               mortality of organisms that might be caused by improper use of
                               pesticides. There are Category 2 indicators for pesticide application
                               and leaching pesticides in stream biota, and  pesticides in sediment
                               and fish tissue for fresh waters. There are no indicators in The Heinz
                               Center report for pesticides in terrestrial' organisms. Another
                               indicator that might provide presumptive evidence of harm—animal
                               die-off in fresh waters—is adequate for national reporting only for
                               waterfowl.                           :
 5-76
5.9 Challenges and Data Gaps
Chapter 5;- Ecological Condition

-------
                                    I^M
Issues related to ozone, UV-B, mercury, acidic deposition, and
persistent bioaccumulative toxics (PBTs)

In air, a number of pollutants travel regionally or even globally (e.g.,
ozone, acid deposition, PBTs [including mercury], ozone-depleting
substances, greenhouse gases). What do the indicators reveal about
baselines and trends in the levels of these pollutants in various
ecosystems, or possible harm to biota as a result of exposure to
these pollutants or their secondary effects?  The chemical and physi-
cal characteristic EEA in Exhibit 5-44 contains many Category 2
indicators, but no indicators are available that provide a representa-
tive baseline for the nation.

For water, the NAWQA program samples sediment chemistry in more
than 500 streams for many PBTs. Repeated sampling should provide
an invaluable picture of trends, unless the variability is too high or
there are important local sources that make these streams non-rep-
resentative of streams in general. A smaller number of streams have
been sampled for contaminants in fish tissue. A.national monitoring
network for mercury currently exists, with sampling sites primarily on
the East coast and in the upper Midwest (see Chapter 2,  Purer
Water), but it is not adequate for establishing a national baseline for
mercury or other PBTs. Monitoring for UV-B exposure is under devel-
opment by USDA. EMAP has collected fish tissue residues for many
of the PBTs, but there is no commitment to re-sample in the future.

To the extent that these factors affect tree growth, FHM will provide
national trends information in the future, but at this point, there is
no prospect for establishing trends in either exposure or effects for
most of these chemicals.
Future Cnall*
             ,enges
When the indicators available for this report are arrayed against the
essential attributes in Exhibit 5-44, it is clear that indicators and
adequate data are available to address  only a portion of the informa-
tion needed to describe ecological condition for the nation. Data for
a few more indicators have been collected once, or for limited geo-
graphic regions, but the clear message  is that more data are needed
to describe and track ecological condition. This situation will improve
over the  next few years, but most of the gaps in Exhibit 5-44 are
likely to remain for some time to come.

There are several challenges to developing adequate indicators of
ecological condition for the nation:

• Indicators must be tied to conceptual models that capture how
  ecosystems respond to single and multiple stressors at various
  scales.

• Federal, state, and local monitoring organizations must find a way
  to coordinate and integrate their activities to meet multiple,
  potentially conflicting, data needs.
• Mechanisms must be found to ensure long-term commitments to
  measuring selected indicators over long periods and in
  standardized ways, to establish comparable baselines and trends.
• Indicators must simplify complex data in ways that make them
  meaningful and useful to decision-makers and the public.


None of these challenges appear insurmountable, but the gaps in
Exhibit 5-44 indicate the work that remains to allow measurement of
ecological condition at  the national scale.
Chapter 5 - Ecological Condition          5.9 Challenges and Data Caps
                                                         5-77

-------
"t	

-------
    Appendix A:
    Databases
    and Reports
    Clusters of
 Indicators Used in
  the Report with
Links for Additional
   Information

-------
	~	'	'	'   •'•                 •   j   .;     •   .  t  ;:.   ; '.•:-..,   j  . •  '  ..::•.'. • •  .•.:•,•..'.'.'..•• '-- :.'':'!. j J.J.I. I

 EPAs Draft Mpbrt qn the Environrrjent 2.b.6;5  • jlcniiical:'DoC:y:rtil|il|:
                       I  i '  '        '   "     •      •' ;' "I1 • ':|l ;|"'  ' '  • . '•• . I.'.::1!",,;'!;•];: -N:'!;'!.1,!1:''.'';-1"""'.!" " -I'!".1. .-. ',  ..:-' .i :"•,."•.  ••" :V:H:iU:.:i:Wi'i':. .:'•:• I ."ft ;:•!:.I if:
  Appendix A: Databases ana Reports Supporting AAajor

  Clusters of Indicators Used in tne Report with Links for

  Additional  Information

  The databases that serve as the underlying datasets and the reports
  that provide the majority of indicators used in the Draft Report on the
  Environment Technical Document are listed by human health and envi-
  ronmental categories in alphabetical order below.  In the interests of
  providing complete and accurate information, rather than provide sum-
  mary descriptions of the databases, links to the primary home pages of
  the databases are noted as starting points for further investigation by
  interested readers.
  Human Health Databases
  Database:

  Web site:

  Database:

  Web site:

  Database:
           National Center for Health Statistics (NCHS), National
           Health and Nutrition Examination Survey (NHANES)
           http://www.cdc.gov/nchs/nhanes.htm (NHANES)

           National Center for Health Statistics (NCHS), National
           Health Interview Survey (NHIS)
           http://www.cdc.gov/nchs/nhis.htm
           Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Research
           and Development (ORD), National Human Exposure
           Assessment Survey (NHEXAS)
Web sites: http://mrw.epa.gov/nerl/research/nhexas/nhexas.httn
           (NHEXAS) and http://www.epa.gov/heds/ (NHEXAS data
           in EPA's Human Exposure Database System)

Database: Centers for Disease Control and Prevention,
           Epidemiology Program Office, National Notifiable
           Disease Surveillance System
Web sites: http://www.cdc.gov/mmwr/ (Morbidity and Mortality
           Weekly Report) http://www.cdc.gov/epo/dphsi/annsum/
           (Summary of Notifiable Diseases)

Database: National Center for Health Statistics (NCHS), National
           Vital Statistics Systems (NVSS)
Web site:  http://www.cdc.gov/nchs/nvss.htm

Database: National Institutes of Health (NIH), National Cancer
           Institute (NCI), Surveillance, Epidemiology, and End
           Results (SEER) Program
Web site:  http://seer.cancer.gov/                               ,
Environmental Databases and Reports
                                      !
Database:  Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Air and
           Radiation, Aerometric Information Retrieval System (AIRS)
Website:  AIRS and the Air Quality System—
           http://www.epa.gov/ttnairsl/aifsaqs/index.htm

Database:  Environmental Protection Agejicy, Office of Research
           aind Development, Environmental Monitoring and
           Assessment Program (EMAP)
Web site:  http://www.epa.gov/emap/   \

           U.S. Department of Agriculture, U.S. Forest Service,
           Forest Health Monitoring (FHM) Program
           http://www.na.fs.fed.us/spfo/fhm/index.htm

           U.S. Department of Agriculture, U.S. Forest Service,
           Forest Inventory and Analysis( (FIA)
           http://fia.fs.fed.us          I

           Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Air and
           Radiation, Latest Findings on Rational Air Quality: 2001
           Status and Trends     ,    :  j
           http://www.epa.gov/oar/aqtrnd01/

           Multi-Resolution Land Characterization (MLRC)
           Consortium, National Land Cover Dataset  (NLCD)
           MRLC: http://www.epa.gov/mrk/
           NLCD: http://www.epa.goY/nlrlc/nlcd.html
Database:

Web site:

Database:

Web site:

Report:


Web site:

Database:

Web sites:
                                                                    Database: U.S. Department of Agriculture, Natural Resources
                                                                               Conservation Service, National Resources Inventory (NRI)
                                                                    Web site:  http://www.nhq.nrcs.usda.gov/NRl/1997/

                                                                    Database: U.S. Department of the Interior; U.S. Geological Survey, National
Web site:
                                                                               1 Stream Water Quality Accounting Network (NASQAN)
                                                                               http://water.usgs.gov/nasqan/
                                                                    Database: ! .U.S. Department of the Interior, U.S. Geological Survey,
                                                                               i National Water Quality Assessment (NWAQA)
                                                                    Web site:  : http://water.usgs.gov/nawqa/

                                                                    Database: < U.S. Department of the Interior, U.S. Fish and Wildlife
                                                                               Service, National Wetlands Inventory (NWI)
                                                                    Web site:  NWI: http://www.nwi.fws.gov/                     -

                                                                    Database: NatureServe              !'
                                                                    Web site:  http://www.natureserve.org  "

                                                                    Report:   U.S. Department of the Interior, U.S. Fish and Wildlife
                                                                               Service, Status and Trends of Wetlands in the Conterminous
                                                                               United States 1986 to 1997\
                                                                    Website:  http://www.nwi.fws.gov/bha/SandT/SandTReport.html
                                                                                                     •  !   -
                                                                    Report:  ! The H. John Heinz III Center for Science, Economics, and the
                                                                               Environment, The State of the Nation's Ecosystems: Measuring the
                                                                               Lands, Waters, and Living Resources of the United States
                                                                    Web site:  http://www.heinzctr.org/ecosystems
                                                                                                     .  \
                                                                    Database: Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Environmental
                                                                               Information, Toxics Release [inventory (TR1)
                                                                    Web site:  http://www.epa.gov/tri/    ;
  A-2
                       Databases and Reports Supporting Major Clusters of Indicators Used in the Report       /Appendix f\

-------

-------
uPAs  Draft fciport on  the Environment 2003W Technical. Document
                      «                   '       i         '     '-  '  I \ ••'"•'].'  ' •  -•    .    -      '  '• i  M :!;!:!
  lerms  Used  in the


 Indicator  AAetadata


Appendix
Indicator names are those presented in the text report of this.
Indicator type (status or trend) - Indicators are designated status
if the indicator is supported by a single data point or study, a
snapshot in time. Indicators are designated trends if there are at
least three data points.
Indicator category. Indicators were assigned to one of two
categories:
• Category 1 —The indicator has been peer reviewed and is
   supported by national level data coverage for more than one time
   period. The supporting data are comparable across the nation and
   are characterized by sound collection methodologies, data
   management systems, and quality assurance procedures.
• Category 2—The indicator has been peer reviewed, but the
   supporting data are available only for part of the  nation (e.g.,
   multi-state regions or ecoregions), or the indicator has not been
   measured for more than one time period, or the not all the
   parameters of the indicator have been measured (e.g., data has
   been collected for birds, but not for plants or insects). The
   supporting data are comparable across the areas covered, and are
   characterized by sound collection methodologies, data
   management systems, and quality assurance procedures.

All category designations for the indicators and associated data are
relative to the specific associated question.
Spatial coverage is scale and geographic information about where
monitoring and sampling have taken place.
Temporal coverage is the time period in which the data has been
collected and includes information about seasonally of collection  •
activity where relevant
Characterization of supporting data set(s) is descriptive
information about the history of the database and its collection
methodologies, data management systems, and quality assurance
procedures.
Indicator source information, including derivation and web sites,
arc provided for readers who want additional information.
          Chapter  1:  (Cleaner  Air
          Outdoor Air Quality
          Indicator name: Number and percentage of days that metropolitan
          statistical areas: (MSAs) have Air Quality Index (AQI) values greater
          than 100                            ;

          Indicator type (status or trend): Trend  :

          Indicator category (1 and 2): 2        '
                                              r
          Associated question: What is the quality of outdoor air in the
          United States?                       \

          Spatial coverage: National. Based on the measurements, EPA
          designates geographical areas of attainment (meeting standards) and
          nonattainment for specific criteria air pollutants.

          Temporal coverage: 1988-2001.

          Characterization of supporting data set(s): The National Air
          Monitoring Stations (NAMS) and the State and Local Air Monitoring
          Stations network measures air quality at 5,200 monitors operating at
          3,000 sites across the country, mostly in urban areas.
          Measurements, taken on both a daily and continuous basis to assess
          both peak concentrations and overall trends, are reported in the
          Aerometric Information Retrieval Systems (AlRS). Trends are derived
          by averaging direct measurements from the£e monitoring stations on
          a yearly basis. Not all sites monitor all of the six criteria air
          pollutants. The Air Quality System (AQS) database contains
          measurements of criteria air pollutant concentrations in the SO
          United States,! plus the District of Columbia, Puerto Rico, and the
          Virgin Islands.                       >

          EPA uses the AQI for five major air pollutants regulated by the Clean
          Air Act (CAA): ground-level ozone, particujate matter, carbon
          monoxide, sulfur dioxide, and nitrogen dioxide. In large metropolitan
          areas (more than 350,000  people), state and local agencies  are
          required to report the AQI to the public daily. In 1976, EPA
          developed the Pollutant Standards Index (PSI), a consistent and easy
          to understand way of stating air pollutant concentrations and
          associated health implications. In June 2000, EPA updated the index
          and renamed it AQI. PSI and AQI are similar as they both focus on
          health risks of brief exposure to pollutants (a few hours or days);
          involve air pollutants regulated by the CAA (criteria pollutants); use
          the same method to calculate index valuesj and use an index value of
          100 to represent pollutant  concentration at the level of the national
          ambient standard set by EPA National Ambient Air Quality Standards
          (NAAQS). Beginning in 2000, the AQI included new features
          including a new health risk category, unhealthy for sensitive groups;
          two additional pollutants (ozone averagediover 8 hours and fine
          particulate miatter less than 2.5 micrometers in size (PM2.s); and a
          specific color associated with each of the health risk categories.
 B-2
Indicator Metadata
/Appendix D

-------

, Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
 For 1988 through 1991, data were drawn from U.S. Environmental
 Protection Agency, Office of Air Quality Planning and Standards.
 National Air Quality and Emissions Trends Report, 1997. Table A-1S.
 EPA 4S4-R-98-016. Research Triangle Park, NC: EPA. December,
 1998. For 1992 through 2001, data were drawn from U.S.
 Environmental Protection Agency,  Office of Air Quality Planning and
 Standards. Air trends: Metropolitan area trends, Table A-17. 2001.
 (February 25, 2003; http://www.epa.gov/airtrends/metro.html).

 Web sites: AIRS and AQS
 http://www.epa.gov/ttnairs1/airsaqs/index.htm;
 7997 air quality trends report
 http://www.epa.gov/oar/aqtrnd97/tables.html;
 2000 air quality trends tables
 http://www.epa.gov/airtrends/metro.html/;
 AQI background
 http://www.epa.gov/airnow/aqibroch/
 Indicator name: Number of people living in areas with air quality
 levels above the National Ambient Air Quality Standards (NAAQS)
 for particulate matter (PM) and ozone

 Indicator type (status or trend): Trend

 Indicator category (1  and 2): 1

 Associated question: How many people are living in areas with
 particulate matter and ozone levels above the National Ambient Air
 Quality Standards (NAAQS)?

 Spatial coverage: National.  Based  on the measurements, EPA
 designates geographical areas of attainment (meeting standards) and
 nonattainment for specific criteria air pollutants.

 Temporal coverage: 2001

 Characterization of supporting data set(s): The National Air
 Monitoring Stations  (NAMS) and the State and Local Air Monitoring
 Stations (SLAMS) network measure air quality at  5,200 monitors
 operating at 3,000 sites across the country, mostly in urban  areas.
 Measurements, taken- on both a daily and continuous basis to assess
 both peak concentrations and overall trends, are  reported in the
 Aerometric Information Retrieval Systems (AIRS). Trends are derived
 by averaging direct measurements from these monitoring stations on
 a yearly basis. Not all sites monitor all of the six criteria air
 pollutants.

 Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
 Aerometric Information Retrieval System (AIRS), the repository of
 data collected from the NAMS and  the SLAMS is reported in  U.S.
 Environmental Protection Agency, Latest Findings on National Air
 Quality: 2001 Status and Trends, EPA 454-K-02-001, Washington,
 DC: EPA., Office of Air Quality and Standards, September 2002.
           Web sites: AIRS and AQS
           http://www.epa.gov/ttnairs1 /airsaqs/index.htm;
           Air quality trends report http://www.epa.gov/oar/aqtrnd01/
           Indicator name: Ambient concentrations of particulate matter
           (PM2.5 and PM10)

           Indicator type (status or trend): Status

           Indicator category (1 and 2): 1

           Associated question: What are the concentrations of some criteria
           air pollutants: PM2 5, PM-|Q> ozone, and lead?

           Spatial coverage: National. Based on the measurements, EPA desig-
           nates geographical areas of attainment (meeting standards) and
           nonattainment for specific criteria air pollutants.

           Temporal coverage:  1982-2001

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): The National Air
           Monitoring Stations (NAMS) and the State and Local Air Monitoring
           Stations (SLAMS) network measure air quality at 5,200 monitors
           operating at 3,000 sites across the country, mostly in urban  areas.
           Measurements, taken on both a daily and continuous basis to assess
           both peak concentrations and overall trends, are reported in the
           Aerometric Information Retrieval Systems (AIRS). Trends are derived
           by averaging direct measurements from these monitoring stations on
           a yearly basis. Not all sites monitor all of the six criteria air
           pollutants. In 1999, EPA and its state, tribal, and local air pollution
           control agency partners deployed a monitoring network to begin
           measuring PM2 5 concentrations nationwide. The PM2 5 data
           presents was drawn from AIRS as of July 8, 2002.  770 sites have
           sufficient PM10 to assess trends from 1992-2001.

           Indicator derivation  (project, program, organization, report):
           Aerometric Information Retrieval System  (AIRS), the repository of
           data collected from the NAMS and the SLAMS is reported in  U.S.
           Environmental Protection Agency, Latest Findings on National Air
           Quality: 2001 Status and Trends, EPA 454-K-02-001, Washington,
           DC: EPA., Office of Air Quality and Standards, September 2002.

           Web sites: AIRS and AQS
           http://www.epa.gov/ttnairs1/airsaqs/index.htm;
           Air quality trends report http://www.epa.gov/oar/aqtrnd01 /
           Indicator name: Ambient concentrations of ozone, 8-hour and
           1 -hour

           Indicator type (status or trend): Status

           Indicator category (1 and 2): 1

           Associated question: What are the concentrations of some criteria
           air pollutants: PM2 5, PM-jrj, ozone, and lead?
 Appendix u
Indicator Metadata
B-3

-------
                n  p!      ,       ,1    E    .     i       ,  -)r\^\z ''A Tl  1   •    ^1 TV         Hi
             rart Report on the  tnvironrrient 2UUft  •  technical Uocument
Spatial coverage: National. Based on the measurements, EPA desig-
nates geographical areas of attainment (meeting standards) and
nonattainment for specific criteria air pollutants.

Temporal coverage: 1982-2001

Characterization of supporting data set(s): The National Air
Monitoring Stations (NAMS) and the State and Local Air Monitoring
Stations (SLAMS) netwqrk measure air quality at 5,200 monitors
operating at 3,000 sites across the country, mostly in  urban areas.
Measurements, taken on both a daily and continuous basis to assess
both peak concentrations and overall trends, are reported  in the
Aerometric Information Retrieval Systems (AIRS). Trends are derived
by averaging direct  measurements from these monitoring stations on
a yearly basis. Not all sites monitor all of the six criteria air pollu-
tants. 379 sites have sufficient data to assess trends from  1992-
2001 for both 8-hour and 1 -hour measurements.

Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
Aerometric Information Retrieval System (AIRS), the repository of
data collected from the NAMS and the SLAMS is reported in U.S.
Environmental Protection Agency, Latest Findings on National Air
Quality: 2007 Status and Trends, EPA 454-K-02-001, Washington,
DC: EPA., Office of Air Quality and Standards, September 2002.

Web sites: AIRS andAQS
http://www.epa.gov/ttnairs1/airsaqs/index.htm;
Air quality trends report http://www.epa.gov/oar/aqtrnd01 /
Indicator name: Ambient concentrations of lead

Indicator type (status or trend): Trend

Indicator category (1 and 2): 1

Associated question: What are the concentrations of some criteria
air pollutants: PM2.5, PM10, ozone, and lead?

Spatial coverage: National. Based on the measurements, EPA desig-
nates geographical areas of attainment (meeting standards) and
nonattainment for specific criteria air pollutants.

Temporal coverage: 1982-2001

Characterization of supporting data set(s): The National Air
Monitoring Stations  (NAMS) and tfie State and Local Air Monitoring
Stations (SLAMS) network measure air quality at 5,200 monitors
operating at 3,000 sites across the country, mostly in urban areas.
Measurements, taken on both a daily and continuous basis to assess
both peak concentrations and overall trends, are reported  in the
Aerometric Information Retrieval Systems (AIRS). Trends are derived
by averaging direct measurements from these monitoring stations on
a yearly basis. Not all sites monitor all of the six criteria air pollu-
tants. EPA has over 200 lead monitoring sites for lead nationally in
addition to special purpose monitors near smelters and  other lead
emitters. The lead trend is based on 39 monitors that have a full 20
years of complete data.
           Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
           Aerometric Information Retrieval System (AIRS), the repository of
           data collected from the NAMS and the SLA'MS is reported in U.S.
           Environmental Protection Agency, Latest Findings on National Air
           Quality: 2001  Status and Trends, EPA 454-K-02-001, Washington,
           DC: EPA., Office of Air Quality and Standards, September 2002.

           Web sites: AIRS and AQS
           http://www.epia.gov/ttnairs1/airsaqs/index.htm;
           http://www.epia.gov/oar/aqtrnd01 /      ;
           Indicator name: Visibility

           Indicator type (status or trend): Trend

           Indicator category (1 and 2): 1

           Associated question: What are the impacjts of air pollution on visi-
           bility in national parks and  other protected lands?

           Spatial coverage: National. 30 sampling sites located in national
           parks and wilderness areas  through 1999;|110 sites after 2000 in
           the monitoring network with an additional' 20 sites using the moni-
           toring protocol. Applicable to 156 Class I areas, mostly national
           parks and wilderness areas  in the eastern and western U.S.

           Temporal coverage: 1992-1999 and 1990-1999

           Characterization of supporting data se^(s): Data are presented by
           mean visual range as measured in kilometers respectively by worst,
           mid-range, and best visibility. The Interagency Monitoring of
           Protected Visual Environments (IMPROVE) network was established
           in 1987 as a cooperative effort among EPA, states, the National Park
           Service, the U.S. Forest Service, the Bureau of Land Management,
           and the U.S. Fish and Wildlife Service. Data are collected and ana-
           lyzed from this network to determine the type of pollutants primarily
           responsible for reduced visibility and to track progress toward the
           Clean Air Act's national goal.           '

           Indicator derivation (project, program! organization, report):
           U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Latest Findings on National Air
           Quality: 200!  Status and Trends, EPA 454-K-02-001, Washington,
           DC: EPA., Office of Air Quality and Standards,  September 2002.

           Web site: Air quality trends report
           http://www.epa.gov/oar/aqtrnd01/
           Indicator mime: Ambient concentrations of selected air toxics
                                               i
           Indicator type (status or trend): Trend i
                                               j
           Indicator category (1  and 2): 2       j

           Associated question: What are the concentrations of toxic air pollu-
           tants in ambient air?
                                                                            i	
           Spatial coverage: National, but no formpl monitoring network in
           place limiting information.
B-4
Indicator Metadata
Appendix D

-------
                                                                                                                        :?Q6?
Temporal coverage: 1994-2000

Characterization of supporting data set(s): Selected-air toxics
only, not all 188 identified in the Clean Air Act (CAA). Ambient
concentrations are based on annual averages from the reporting
sites. EPA and the states do not maintain an extensive nationwide
monitoring network for air toxics as they do for the criteria air
pollutants. While EPA, states, tribes, and local air regulatory agencies
collect monitoring data for a number of toxic air pollutants, both the
chemicals monitored and the geographic coverage of the monitors
vary from state to state.  Measurements of benzene were taken from
95 urban monitoring sites around the country. These urban areas
generally have higher levels of benzene than other areas of the
country.

Indicator derivation (project, program,  organization, report):
The data come from a combination of several monitoring networks,
including: Photochemical Assessment Monitoring Stations Program;
Urban Air Toxics Monitoring Program; Non-Methane Organic
Compound Monitoring Program; Interagency Monitoring of
Protected Visual Environments (IMPROVE) Network. Reported in U.S.
Environmental Protection Agency, Latest Findings on National Air
Quality: 2001 Status and Trends, EPA 4S4-K-02- 001, Washington,
DC: EPA, Office of Air Quality and Standards, September 2002.

Web site: Air quality trends report
http://www.epa.gov/oar/aqtrnd01 /
Indicator name: Emissions: particulate matter (PM2.5 and PM10),
sulfur dioxide, nitrogen oxides, and volatile organic compounds

Indicator type (status or trend): Trend

Indicator category (1 and 2): 2

Associated question: What are contributors to particulate matter,
ozone, and lead in ambient air?

Spatial coverage: National

Temporal coverage: 1992-2001

Characterization of supporting data set(s): Actual emissions data
are not presented and estimates are used. EPA estimates nationwide
emissions of ambient pollutants and their precursors based on actual
monitored readings or engineering calculations of the amounts and
types of pollutants emitted by vehicles, factories, and other sources.
Emission  estimates  are based on many factors, including the level of
industrial activity, technology developments, fuel consumption, vehi-
cle miles  traveled, and other activities that cause air pollution
(EPA, OAQPS, September 2002). Consistent estimation methods
have been developed to provide trend data. Estimation is particularly
necessary for mobile sources and area-wide sources. The methodol-
ogy for estimating emissions is continually reviewed and is subject to
revision. EPA is currently conducting such an evaluation of emissions
data, and emissions estimates may be updated. Trend data prior to
revisions  must be considered in the context of those changes.
           Emission estimates also reflect changes in air pollution regulations
           and installation of emission controls.

           Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
           The National Emissions Inventory (NEI) for Criteria and Hazardous
           Air Pollutants (HAPs) is a composite of many data sources reported
           in U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Latest Findings on National
           Air Quality: 2001 Status and Trends, EPA 454-K-02-001, Washington,
           DC: EPA, Office of Air Quality and Standards, September 2002. In
           the NEI, EPA divides emissions into four types of sectors: 1) major
           (large industrial) sources; 2) area and other sources, which include
           smaller industrial sources like small dry cleaners and gasoline
           stations, as well as natural sources like wildfires; 3) onroad mobile
           sources, including highway vehicles; and 4) nonroad mobile sources
           like aircraft, locomotives, and construction equipment (EPA, OAQPS,
           September 2002).

           Web site: Air quality trends report
           http://www.epa.gov/oar/aqtrnd01 /
           Indicator name: Lead emissions

           Indicator type (status or trend): Trend          v

           Indicator category (1 and 2): 2

           Associated question: What are contributors to particulate matter,
           ozone, and lead in ambient air?

           Spatial coverage: National

           Temporal coverage: 1982-2001

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): EPA estimates nation-
           wide emissions of ambient pollutants and their precursors based on
           actual monitored readings or engineering calculations of the
           amounts and types of pollutants emitted by vehicles, factories, and
           other sources. Emission estimates are based on many factors, includ-
           ing the level  of industrial activity, technology developments, fuel
           consumption, vehicle miles traveled, and other activities that cause
           air pollution  (EPA, OAQPS, September 2002). Consistent estimation
           methods have been developed to provide trend data. Estimation is
           particularly ne'cessary for mobile sources and area-wide sources. The
           methodology for estimating emissions is continually reviewed and is
           subject to revision.  EPA is currently conducting such an evaluation of
           emissions data, and emissions estimates may be updated. Trend data
           prior to revisions must be considered in the context of those
           changes. Emission estimates also reflect changes in air pollution
           regulations and installation of emission controls.

           Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
           The National Emissions Inventory (NEI) for Criteria and Hazardous
           Air Pollutants (HAPs) is a composite of many data sources reported
           in U.S.  Environmental Protection Agency, Latest Findings on National
           Air Quality: 2001 Status and Trends, EPA 454-K-02-001, Washington,
           DC: EPA., Office of Air Quality and Standards, September 2002.
Appendix 6
Indicator Metadata
B-5

-------
EPAs Draft Report on the Environment 200J3 •  lecnnical Document
Web site: Air quality trends report
http://www.epa.gov/oar/aqtrnd01 /
 Indicator name: Air toxics emissions
 Indicator type (status or trend): Trend
 Indicator category (1 and 2): 2
 Associated question: What are contributors to toxic air pollutants
 in ambient air?
 Spatial coverage: National
 Temporal coverage: 1990-1993,1996
 Characterization of supporting data set(s): Hazardous air pollu-
 tant estimates are currently available for 1990-1993 (a mix of years
 depending on data availability on various source types) and 1996.
 EPA compiles an air toxics inventory as part of the National
 Emissions Inventory (NEI, formerly the National Toxics Inventory) to
 estimate and track national emissions trends for the 188 toxic air ,
 pollutants regulated under the CM. In the NEI, EPA divides emis-
 sions into four types of sectors: 1) major (large industrial) sources;
 2) area and other sources, which include smaller industrial sources
 like small dry cleaners and gasoline stations, as well as natural
 sources like wildfires; 3) onroad mobile sources, including highway
 vehicles; and 4) nonroad mobile sources like aircraft, locomotives,
 and construction equipment. The data presented are based on the
 data in the NEI (EPA, OAQPS, September 2002).
 Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
 The NEI for Criteria and Hazardous Air Pollutants (HAPs) is a com-
 posite of many data sources reported in U.S. Environmental
 Protection Agency, Latest Findings on National Air Quality: 2001
 Status and Trends, EPA 4S4-K-02-001, Washington, DC: EPA., Office
 of Air Quality and Standards, September 2002.
 Web site: Air quality trends report
 http://www,epa.gov/oar/aqtrnd01 /

 Acid  Deposition
 Indicator name: Deposition: wet sulfate arid wet nitrogen
 Indicator type (status or trend): Status comparison
 Indicator category (1 and 2): 2
 Associated question: What are the deposition rates of pollutants
 that cause acid rain?
 Spatial coverage: NADP/NTN consists of over 250 sites in the
 continental U.S., Alaska, Puerto Rico, and the Virgin Islands.
 Temporal coverage: 1989-1991, 1999-2001
 Characterization of supporting data set(s): 1) The data is collect-
 ed by uniform methods/protocol under the National Atmospheric
 Deposition Program (NADP)/National Trends Network (NTN) and
          the Clean Air Status and Trends Network (CASTNet). The NADP is a
          cooperative program among federal and state agencies, universities,
          electric utilities, and other industries that has measured precipitation
          chemistry in the U.S. since 1978. The NADP/NTN is a nationwide
          network of precipitation monitoring sites designed to measure
          regional levels of atmospheric deposition. The NADP/NTN measures
          wet acid deposition that occurs in rain, snow, or sleet) weekly at
          about 250 monitoring stations throughout the U.S. The data are
          subject to strict quality assurance and completeness screening  in the
          field, in the laboratory, and during analysis; 2) Presented total sulfur
          and total nitrogen data are derived from CASTNet, a nationwide
          network of over 70 sites concentrated in the eastern continental U.S.
          that measure ambient air concentrations of pollutants, including
          ozone. CASTNet has not yet completed its expansion into the  Great
          Plains and western states. CASTNet also measures dry deposition
          (the process  through which particles and gases are deposited in the
          absence of precipitation) of acidic compounds. CASTNet data  are
          also subject to strict quality assurance and completeness criteria
          (EPA, OAR, November 2002).

          Indicator derivation (project, program,'organization, report):
          NADP/NTN iand CASTNet data are reported in. U.S.  Environmental
          Protection  Agency, EPA Acid Rain Program:\2001  Progress Report, EPA
          430-R-02-009, Washington, DC: EPA, Office of Air and Radiation,
          November,  2002.                     j

          Web site: NADP/NTN Data Access http://nadp.sws.uiuc.edu/
           Indicator name: Emissions (utility): sulfur dioxide and nitrogen
           oxides

           Indicator type (status or trend): Trend '

           Indicator category (1 and 2): 2      ;

           Associated question: What are the emissions of pollutants that
           form acid rain?                      !

           Spatial coverage: Over 2000 facilities nationally.

           Temporal coverage: 1980, 1985, 1990, 1995, 2000, 2001

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): Data collected by regu-
           lated facilities using certified continuous emissions monitors or equiva-
           lent, beginning in 1994-95 with quarterly and annual totals tabulated
           for each facility and aggregated for plants, states,  and the U.S.

           Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
           U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. EPA Acid  Rain Program: 2007
           Progress Report, EPA 430-R-02-009. Washington, DC: U.S.
           Environmental Protection Agency, Office! °f Air anc' Radiation,
           November 2002. Appendix A: Acid Rain Program - Year 2001  SO2
           Allowance Holdings and Deductions. (April 8, 2003;
           http://www.epa.gov/airinarkets/cmprpt/arp01 /appendixa.pdf) and
           Appendix B1: 2001 Compliance Resultslfor NOX Affected Units.
           (April 8, 2003; http://www.epa.gov/airmarkets/cmprpt/arp01/appen-
           dixbl.pdf).                         ;
           Web site: http://www.epa.gov/airmarkets/emissions/index.html
 B-6
Indicator Metadata
Appendix B

-------
pGUrtiertt ;
                                                                     raft "Report on the /Environment 2005
Indoor Air Quality
Indicator name: U.S. homes above EPA's radon action levels

Indicator type (status or trend): Status

Indicator category (1  and 2): 2

Associated question: What is the quality of the air in buildings in.
the United States?

Spatial coverage: National

Temporal coverage: 1989-1990

Characterization of supporting data set(s): The National Radon
Residential Study of 1989-1990 was a survey of the nation's housing
that estimated that  6 percent of U.S. homes (5.8 million in 1990)
had an annual average radon level greater than 4 picocuries per liter
(pCi/L) in indoor air. Data viability is limited given its age and
subsequent changes as a result of education efforts and new
housing stock.

Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. National Residential Radon
Survey: Summary Report, EPA 402-R-92-011. Washington, DC: EPA,
Office of Air and Radiation, October 1992.

Web site: Report is not available online.
Indicator name: Percentage of homes where young children are
exposed to environmental tobacco smoke

Indicator type (status or trend): Status

Indicator category (1  and 2): 2

Associated question: What is the quality of the air in buildings in
the United States?

Spatial coverage: National

Temporal coverage: The National Center for Health Statistics
(NCHS), National Health Interview Survey (NHIS) has been conduct-
ed continuously since 1957, the content of the survey has been
updated about every 10-15 years. In 1996 a substantially revised
NHIS content began field testing. This new questionnaire, described
in detail below, began in 1997 and improves the ability of the NHIS
to provide important health information. 1998 data is cited.

Characterization of supporting data set(s): The NHIS is a
continuous nationwide survey in which data are collected through
personal household interviews. Self-reported information is obtained
on personal and demographic characteristics, illnesses, injuries,
impairments, chronic conditions, utilization of health resources, and
other health topics. The sample scheduled for each week is
representative of the target population, and the weekly samples are
additive over time. Response rates for special health topics
(supplements)  have generally been lower. Because of the extensive
redesign of the questionnaire in  1997 and introduction of the
                           computer-assisted personal interviewing (CAPI) method of data
                           collection, data from 1997 and later years may not be comparable
                           with earlier years. The indicator numerator was the number of
                          ' children 6 years and under living in households with a resident who
                           smoked inside the home 4 or more days each week. The
                           denominator was the number of households with children ages 6
                           years and under.
                           Indicator source (project, program, organization,  report): U.S.
                           Department of Health and Human Services,  National  Center for
                           Health  Statistics. Healthy People 2000 Final Review, DHHS Publication
                           No. 01 -0256. Hyattsville, MD: Public Health Service,  October 2001.
                           Web site: http://www.cdc.gov/nchs/data/hp2000/hp2k01 .pdf

                           Stratospheric Ozone
                           Indicator name: Ozone levels over North America
                           Indicator type (status or trend): Status (two separate data points,
                           not a trend)
                           Indicator category (1 and 2): 1
                           Associated question: What is the trends in the Earth's ozone layer?
                           Spatial coverage: Daily images of North America.
                           Temporal coverage: Begun in 1978, ongoing with a gap in coverage
                           from December 1994 through June 1996.
                           Characterization of supporting data set(s): High-resolution spec-
                           trographic images taken daily from National Aeronautics and Space
                           Administration  (NASA) satellite platforms.
                           Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
                           National Aeronautics and Space Administration. Ozone  Levels Over
                           North America  - NIMBUS-7/TOMS. March 1979 and March 1994.
                           (January,24, 2003; http://epa.gov/ozone/science/glob_dep,html).
                           Web site: The graphic images referenced by the indicator can be
                           found at http://www.epa.gov.ozone/science/glob_dep.html
                           Indicator name: Worldwide and U.S. production of ozone-depleting
                           substances

                           indicator type (status or trend): Trend

                           Indicator category (1  and 2): 2

                           Associated question: What are causing changes to the ozone layer?

                           Spatial coverage: Global and national

                           Temporal coverage: Worldwide1986 and 1999; U.S.1958-1993

                           Characterization of supporting data set(s): Global—The present
                           report contains additional and updated data on the production and
                           consumption of ozone-depleting substances (ODS), as reported to
                           the United Nations Secretariat during the period 1986-2000, by
                           167 of the 183 parties  to the Montreal Protocol on Substances that
Appendix 6
                Indicator Metadata
B-7

-------
Deplete the Ozone Layer. The Secretariat has arranged the data
provided by the Parties into the groups for which control measures
arc prescribed in the protocol. To calculate the figures for each
group, the quantities in metric tons reported by the parties for
each substance of the group were multiplied by the ozone-
depleting potential (OOP) of that substance and added together.
All the data in this report is therefore presented in OOP tons.
National-Methodology uncertain.

Indicator derivation (project, p'rogram, organization, report):
Global: United Nations Environment Programme. Production and
Consumption of Ozone Depleting Substances under the Montreal
Protocol 1986-2000, Nairobi, Kenya: United Nations Environment
Programme, Secretariat for The Vienna Convention for the
Protection of the Ozone Layer and The Montreal Protocol on
Substances that Deplete the Ozone Layer, April 2002. National:
Historical data (1958-1993) is drawn from the report U.S.
International Trade Commission.  1993. Synthetic Organic Chemicals;
U.S. Production and Sales, Washington DC Government Printing
Office, 1994.
Web site: EPA report http://www.epa.gov/globalwarming/
publications/emissions/index.html;
U.S. ITC report http://www.epa.gov/ozone/science/
Jndicat/index.html
          Web site: WMO report http://www.unep.ch/ozone/sap2002.shtml;
          Global Equivalent Effective Chlorine graphic
          http://www.cmdl.noaa.gov/hats/graphs/graphs
Indicator name: Concentrations of ozone-depleting substances
(equivalent effective chlorine)

Indicator type (status or trend): Trend

Indicator category (1 and 2): 2
Associated question: What are causing changes to the ozone layer?

Spatial coverage: Global  .

Temporal coverage: 1992-2002

Characterization of supporting data set(s): Approximately 250
scientists from many countries of the developed and developing
world participated in the 2002 assessment as lead authors, coau-
thors, contributors, and reviewers.
Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
1) Scientific Assessment Panel of the Montreal Protocol on
Substances that Deplete the Ozone Layer. Scientific Assessment of
Ozone Depletion: 2002, Executive Summary,  Report No. 47. Geneva,
Switzerland: World Meteorological Organization, Global Ozone
Research and Monitoring Project, 2003. 2) Montzka, S.A., J.H. Butler,
J.W. Elkins, T.M. Thompson, A.D. Clarke, and LT. Lock. Present and
future trends in the atmospheric burden of ozone- depleting halo-
gens. Nature 398: 690-694 (1999). 3) National Oceanic and
Atmospheric Administration, Climate Monitoring & Diagnostics
Laboratory. Halocarbons and other Atmospheric Trace Species
 (HATS). 2002. March 18, 2003;
http://www.cmdl.noaa.gov/hats/graphs/graphs.html).
 B-8
Indicator Metadata
Appendix B

-------


Chapter 2:  turer  Water


Waters and  Watersheds
Indicator name: Altered fresh water ecosystems
Indicator type (status or trend): Status
Indicator category (1 or 2): 2
Associated question: What is the condition of fresh surface waters
and watersheds in the U.S.?
Spatial coverage: Lower 48 states. Applies to rivers, streams, lakes,
ponds and reservoirs, and does not account for all types of alter-
ation.1
Temporal coverage: 1992
Characterization of supporting data set(s): 1) The U.S.
Geological Survey's National Hydrography Dataset (NHD) and the
Multi-Resolution Land Characterization (MRLC) Consortium's
National Land Cover Database (NLCD) were used to identify alter-
ation. NLCD uses remote-sensed image data. 2) Data on altered wet-
lands are available through the U.S. Fish and Wildlife Service's
(USFWS): National Wetlands Inventory (NWI). NWI counts all wet-
lands, lakes, reservoirs, and ponds regardless of land ownership, but
recognizes only wetlands that are at least 3 acres, and ponds that
are at least 1 acre/At present, these data are not available in elec-
tronic form for the entire U.S.
Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
1) MRLC Consortium's NLCD and the USGS's NHD, processed by
U.S. Environmental Protection Agency's Office of Research and
Development, National Exposure Research Laboratory, Environmental
Sciences Division plus the 2) USFWS's NWI. Presented in The State
of the Nation's Ecosystems, pages 140 and 247 (The Heinz Center,
2002).
Web site:  NHD http://nhd.usgs.gov/;
NLCD http://www.epa.gov/mrlc/about.html;
NWI http://www.nwi.fws.gov
Indicator name: Lake Trophic State Index

Indicator type (status or trend): Status

Indicator category (1 or 2): 2

Associated question: What is the condition of fresh surface waters
and watersheds in the U.S.?

Spatial coverage: Northeast United States

Temporal coverage: 1991 -1994
           Characterization of supporting data set(s): The EPA
           Environmental Monitoring and Assessment (EMAP) program con-,
           ducted variable probability sampling on 344 lakes throughout the
           northeastern United States. The EMAP trophic state characterization
           is based primarily on the total phosphorus indicator. Descriptions of
           total nitrogen, chlorophyll-a, total suspended solids, and Secchi disk
           transparency were used to support the total phosphorus characteri-
           zation.

           Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
           Peterson, Spencer A., David P. Larsen, Steven G. Paulsen, and N. Scott
           Urquhart. Regional Lake Trophic Patterns in the Northeastern United
           States: Three Approaches. Environmental Management 22  (5):
           789-801 (1999).

           Web site: Full article not available on noncommercial website.
           Indicator name: Wetland extent and change

           Indicator type (status or trend): Status and trends

           Indicator category (T or 2): 1

           Associated question: What is the extent and condition of wetlands?

           Spatial coverage: Lower 48 states

           Temporal coverage: 1950s to 1997 (1954-1974, 1974-1983,
           1986-1997)

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): An interagency group
           of statisticians developed the design for the U.S. Fish and Wildlife
           Service's (USFWS) national status and trends study. The basic sam-
           pling design and study objectives have remained constant for each
           wetland status and trends report. The study design consists of
           4,375 randomly selected  sample plots (4-square-miles in area) that
           are examined and  characterized using aerial imagery provided by the
           National Aerial  Photography Program in combination with field verifi-
           cation to determine wetland change. Estimates of change in wetlands
           were made over a  specific time period. To make the three studies
           used comparable,  the USFWS authors of the 2000 report adjusted
           the estimate of wetland area for the mid-1980s in the 1991  report
           to be in the same  statistical range. Other factors contributing to this
           adjustment were corrections to the wetland data set, and improved
           data capture and measurement techniques (Dahl, 2000).

           Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
           1) Dahl, T.E. Status and Trends of Wetlands in the Conterminous United
           States 1986 to 1997, Washington DC: U.S. Department of the   -
           Interior, U.S. Fish and Wildlife Service, 2000. 2) Frayer, WE., T.J.
           Monahan, D.C.  Bowden, and F.A. Graybill. Status and Trends of
           Wetlands and Deepwater Habitats in the Conterminous United States,
           1950'sto 1970's, Ft. Collins, CO: Colorado State University, 1983.
           3) Dahl, T.E., and  C.E. Johnson. Status and Trends of Wetlands in the
           Conterminous United States, Mid-197Q's to Mid-1980's, Washington
           DC: U.S. Department of the Interior, U.S. Fish and Wildlife
           Service, 1991.
Appendix D
Indicator Metadata
B-9

-------
	          .,                           .                   i ..
 EPAs Draft "RbjDbrt on tne  Environment 20S.fJ:
 Web site: DaM, 2000
 http://wetlands.fws.gov/bha/SandT/SandTReport.html
 Indicator name: Sources of wetland change/loss
 Indicator type (status or trend): Status and trend
 Indicator category (1 or 2): 2
 Associated question: What is the extent and condition of wetlands?
 Spatial coverage: Non-federal lands, lower 48 states, Puerto Rico
 and the Virgin Islands
 Temporal coverage: U.S. Department of Agriculture (USDA),
 National  Resources Inventory (NRI) data are collected every five
 years, 1982-1997.
 Characterization of supporting data set(s): Data collected for the
 1997 NRI were based on a statistical design to sample 800,000
 sample points, using photo-interpretation and other remote sensing
 methods and standards. Data gatherers utilized a variety of ancillary
 materials; extensive use was made of USDA field office records, infor-
 mation provided by local Natural Resources Conservation Service
 (NRCS) field personnel, soil survey and wetland inventory maps and
 reports, and tables and technical guides developed by local field
 office staffs.
 Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
 U.S. Department of Agriculture. Summary Report 1997 National
 Resources Inventory (Revised December 2000), Washington, DC:
 Natural Resources Conservation Service and Ames, Iowa: Iowa State
 University, Statistical Laboratory,  2000.
 Web site:
 http%y/www.nrcs.usda.gov/technical/NRI/1997/summary_report/
 table16.html
 Indicator name: Water clarity in coastal waters
 Indicator type (status or trend): Status
 Indicator category (1 or 2): 2
 Associated question: What is the condition of coastal waters?
 Spatial coverage: U.S. east coast south of Cape Cod, Gulf of
 Mexico, and west coast.
 Temporal coverage: 1990-1997 variable by region
 Characterization of supporting data set(s): Data collected using a
 statistically based random design from estuaries by transmissometer
 at 1  meter below the water surface.
 Geographic location/applicability: U.S. east coast south of Cape
 Cod, Gulf of Mexico, and west coast
           Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
           U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) Environmental
           Monitoring and Assessment Program  (EMAr*) Estuaries database as
           presented in U.S. Environmental Protection1 Agency. National Coastal
           Condition Report, EPA 620-R-01-005. Washington DC: U.S.
           Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Research and
           Development and Office of Water, September 2001.

           Web site: EMAP data
           http://www.epa.gov/emap/html/datal/estuary/data/index.html;
           NCCR http://eipa.gov/owow/oceans/nccr/downloads.html


           Indicator name: Dissolved oxygen in coas :al waters
           Indicator type (status or trend): Status

           Indicator category (1 or 2): 2

           Associated question: What is the condition of coastal waters?

           Spatial coverage: U.S. east coast south of Cape Cod, Gulf of
           Mexico, and west coast

           Temporal coverage: 1990-1997 variable by region

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): Data collected using a
           statistically-based random design from estuaries by point-in-time or
           continuously recording dissolved oxygen meter a 1 meter above the
           bottom.   .                            |

           Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
           U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) Environmental
           Monitoring and Assessment Program  (EMAP) Estuaries database as
           presented in U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. National Coastal
           Condition Report, EPA 620-R-01 -005. Washington DC: EPA, Office of
           Research and Development and Office of Water, September 2001.
                                                i                       ;
           Web site: EMAP data
           http://www.epa.gov/emap/html/datal/estuary/data/index.html;
           NCCR http://epa.gov/owow/oceans/nccr/downloads.htm!
           Indicator name: Total organic carbon in sediments

           Indicator type (status or trend): Status

           Indicator category (1 or 2): 2

           Associated question: What is the condition of coastal waters?

           Spatial coverage: Mid-Atlantic estuaries

           Temporal coverage: 1997-1998

           Characterization of supporting data setj(s): The EPA Mid-Atlantic
           Integrated Assessment (MAIA) Estuaries Siimmary Database contains
           water quality, sediment, benthic community, and fish data collected
           by several partners in MAIA Region estuaries in 1997 and 1998. The
           MAIA program conducted regular fish surveys during the summer of
           1998 to characterize the structure and health of the fish communi-
 B-10
Indicator Metadata
Appendix B

-------
                                   O^
ties. The stations sampled were selected according to a probabilistic
design. These stations were not identical with the stat ons sampled
for water'and sediment quality analyses conducted primarily in 1997;
therefore, it is not possible to directly compare these different
analyses station by station. However, it is statisticallyvalid to
compare results among classes of estuaries, (e.g., large versus small
estuaries, Delaware Estuary versus Chesapeake Estuary).
Indicator source (project, program, organization, report): U.S.
Environmental Protection Agency. Mid-Atlantic Integrated Assessment,
MAIA - Estuaries 1997-98, Summary Report, EPA 620-R-02-003.
Narragansett, Rl: EPA, Office of Research and Development, Atlantic
Ecology Division, May 2003.
Web site: MAIA Estuaries data
http://www.epa.gov/emap/maia/html/data/estuary/9798/xport.html
Indicator name: Chlorophyll concentrations

Indicator type (status or trend): Trend

Indicator category: 2

Associated question: What is the condition of coastal waters?

Spatial coverage: National in scope, selected ocean regions

Temporal coverage: 1998-2000

Characterization of supporting data set(s): Data from the
National Aeronautical and Space Administration's (NASA) Sea
viewing Wide Field-of-view Sensor (Sea WiFS) were analyzed for
nine ocean regions, by the National Ocean Service (NOS),
National Oceanographic and Atmospheric Administration (NOAA).
Reflectance, or light reflected from the sea surface is used to
estimate chlorophyll  concentrations at the surface using a series
of assumptions accepted by the scientific community (The
Heinz Center, 2002).

Indicator derivation (project, program, organization,  report):
NASA Sea WiFS data analyzed by the NOS. Presented in  The State of
the Nation's Ecosystems, pages 80 and 226 (The Heinz Center,
2002).

Web site: http://seawifs.gsfc.nasa.gov
Indicator name: Percent urban land cover in riparian areas

Indicator type (status or trend): Status

Indicator category (1 or 2): 2

Associated question: What are pressures to water quality?

Spatial, coverage: National, excluding Alaska

Temporal coverage: NLCD, 1992 imagery; C-CAP, mid-1990s
imagery; NHD, 1999.
           Characterization of supporting data set(s): Riparian zones defined
           as 30-meter buffer around streams, extent and locations extracted
           from the National Hydrography Dataset (NHD). Urban land cover
           defined as sum of low-intensity residential, high-intensity residential,
           and commercial/industrial/transportation land cover types in
           National Land Cover Database (NLCD) and sum of high-intensity
           developed and low- intensity developed land cover types in the
           Coastal Change Analysis Program (C-CAP). Cover identified by aerial
           imagery.

           Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
           NHD, NLCD,  and C-CAP data processed by the U.S. Environmental
           Protection Agency, Office of Research and Development, National
           Exposure Research Laboratory, Environmental Sciences Division.

           Web sites: NLCD http://www.epa.gov/mrlc/about.html;
           C-CAP http://www.csc.noaa.gov/crs/lca/index.html;
           NHD http://nhd.usgs.gov/index.html;
           HUC http://water.usgs.gov/CIS/huc.html
           Indicator name: Agricultural lands in riparian areas

           Indicator type (status or trend): Status

           Indicator category (1  or 2): 2

           Associated question: What are pressures to water quality?

           Spatial coverage: National, excluding Alaska

           Temporal coverage: NLCD,  1992 imagery; C-CAP, mid-1990s
           imagery; NHD, 1999.

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): Riparian zones
           defined as 30-meter buffer around streams, extent and locations
           extracted from the National  Hydrography Dataset (NHD). Total
           agriculture is defined as the  sum of row crops and pasture land
           cover types in the National Land Cover Database (NLCD) and as
           the amount of cultivated land in  the Coastal Change Analysis
           Program (C-CAP). Cover identified by aerial imagery.

           Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
           NHD, NLCD, and  C-CAP data processed by U.S. EPA National
           Exposure Research Laboratory, Environmental Sciences Division.

           Web sites: NiCD http://www.epa.gov/mrlc/abouthtml;
           C-C4P http://www.csc.noaa.gov/crs/lca/index.html;
           NHD http://nhd.usgs.gov/index.html;
           HUC http://water.usgs.gov/GIS/huc.html
           Indicator name: Population density in coastal areas

           Indicator type (status or trend): Trend

           Indicator category (1  or 2): 2

           Associated question: What are pressures to water quality?

           Spatial coverage: National
Appendix 6
Indicator Metadata
B-ll

-------

Temporal coverage: 1790 to 1994 population data
Characterization of supporting data set(s): Various Bureau of the
Census publications were used in preparing the article. NPA Data
Services, Inc. provided the population projection data for this paper.
The Bureau of the Census, U.S. Department of the Interior, provided
historical information on coastal counties.
Indicator source (project, program, organization, report):
Culliton, Thomas J. "Population: Distribution, Density and Growth."
In NOAA's State of the Coast Report. Silver Spring, MD: National
Oceanic and Atmospheric Administration. 1998. (February 2003;
http://state-of-coast.noaa.gov/bulletins/html/pop_dl/pop.html).
Web site: http://state-of-coastnoaa.gov/bulletins/
html/pop_01 /pop.html
 Indicator name: Changing stream flows
 Indicator type (status or trend): Trend
 Indicator category (1  or 2): 1
 Associated question: What are pressures to water quality?
 Spatial coverage: National
 Temporal coverage: Since end of the 19th century focusing on
 period from 1970s to 1990s
 Characterization of supporting data set(s): Data are from the U.S.
 Geological Survey  (USGS) stream gauge network using standard
 USGS protocols. Data are available in the form of daily streamflow
 values reported as the average volume of water per second over a
 24-hour period. Gauge placement by the USGS is not a random
 process as gauges are generally placed on larger, perennial streams
 and rivers, and changes seen in these larger systems may differ from
 those seen in smaller streams and rivers (The Heinz Center, 2002).
 Indicator source (project, program, organization, report): USGS
 stream gauging network.  Presented in The State of the Nation's
 Ecosystems, pages 142 and 249 (The Heinz Center, 2002).
 Web site: http://www,water.usgs.gov.nwis.discharge
 Indicator name: Number/duration of dry stream flow periods in
 grassland/shrublands
 Indicator type (status or trend): Trend
 Indicator category: 2
 Associated question: What are pressures to water quality?
 Spatial coverage: National
 Temporal coverage: 1950s to 1990s
 Characterization of supporting data set(s): Data are from the U.S.
 Geological Survey (USGS) stream gauge network using standard
USGS protocols. Data are available in the form of daily streamflow
values reported as the average volume of Water per second over a
24-hour period. Gauge placement by the UJSGS is not a random
process as gauges are generally placed on larger, perennial streams
and rivers, and changes seen in these largejr systems may differ from
those seen in smaller streams and rivers (The Heinz Center, 2002).
The number of sites with at least one no-ffow day in a year was
determined for each water year from 1950|to 1999. The correspon-
ding percentage value for that year was also calculated as 100 x
(number of sites/total sites). The percentage values were then aver-
aged over each decade (i.e., 1950s, 1960s1 1970s, 1980s, and
1990s). This procedure was followed for ajl sites with greater than
50% grassland/shrubland cover as well as jfor each ecoregion
(The Heinz Center, 2002).              |
Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
USGS stream gauge network. Presented mjhe State of the Nation's
Ecosystems, pages  166 and 259 (The Heinz Center, 2002).

Web site: http://water.usgs.gov/nwis/discharge
 Indicator name: Sedimentation index   |

 Indicator type (status or trend): Status

 Indicator category (1  or 2): 2

 Associated question: What are pressures to water quality?
                                     !
 Spatial coverage: Statistically selected stream sites in the Mid-
 Atlantic states (parts of Virginia, Maryland, Pennsylvania, and New
 York and all of West Virginia)           ;

 Temporal coverage: 1993-1994 sampling years

 Characterization of supporting data sejt(s): About 450 stream
 reaches were sampled in the Mid-Atlantic] Highlands. To describe the
 condition of all streams within the Highlands without sampling all of
 them EMAP worked with EPA Region 3 and the states to develop a
 regional statistical survey of streams. A sedimentation index was    ;
 developed far streams in the Mid-Atlantic Highlands to assess the
 quality of insitream habitat to support aquatic communities. Stream
 sedimentation was defined as an increase or excess in the amount of
 fine substrate particles (smaller than 16m'm diameter) relative to an
 expected  reference value that is based on the region and the

 Indicator derivation (project, program' organization, report):
 U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Mid-Atlantic Highlands Streams
 Assessment, EiPA 903-R-00-015. Philadelphia, PA: U.S. Environmental
 Protection Agency Region 3, Office of Research  and Development,
 August 2000.                       ;
 Web site: MAIA Report http://www.epa.gov/maia/html/maha.html
 Indicator name: Atmospheric deposition of nitrogen
 Indicator type (status or trend): Status and trend
  B-12
                                                        Indicator Metadata
                                                Appendix B

-------

Indicator category (1 or 2): 2

Associated question: What are pressures to water quality?

Spatial coverage: NADP/NTN consists of over 250 sites in the con-
tinental U.S., Alaska, Puerto Rico, and the Virgin Islands.

Temporal coverage: 2001

Characterization of supporting data set(s):  1) The data is collect-
ed by uniform methods/protocol under the National Atmospheric
Deposition Program (NADP)/National Trends Network (NTN) and
the Clean Air Status and Trends Network (CASTNet). The NADP is a
cooperative program among federal and state agencies, universities,
electric utilities, and other industries that has measured precipitation
chemistry in the U.S. since 1978. The NADP/NTN is a nationwide
network of precipitation monitoring sites designed to measure
regional levels of atmospheric deposition. The NADP/NTN measures
wet acid deposition that occurs in rain, snow, or sleet) weekly at
about 2SO monitoring stations throughout the U.S. The data are
subject to strict quality assurance and completeness screening in
the field,  in the laboratory, and during analysis. 2) CASTNet is a
nationwide network of over 70 sites concentrated in the eastern
continental U.S. that measure ambient air concentrations of pollu-
tants. CASTNet has not yet completed its expansion into the Great
Plains and western states. CASTNet also measures dry deposition
(the process through  which particles and gases are deposited in the
absence of precipitation) of acidic compounds. CASTNet data are
also subject to strict quality assurance and completeness criteria
(EPA, OAR, November 2002).

Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
NADP/NTN and CASTNet

Web site:
http://nadp.sws.uiuc.edu/isopleths/maps2001 Aio3dep.pdf and
http://nadp.sws.uiuc.edu/isopleths/maps2001/nh4dep.pdf
Indicator name: Nitrate in farmland, forested, and urban streams
and ground water

Indicator type (status or trend): Status

Indicator category (1 or 2): 2

Associated question: What are pressures to water quality?

Spatial coverage: National. Major river basins and watersheds
across U.S.

Temporal coverage: 1992-1998

Characterization of supporting data set(s): Nitrate data were col-
lected annually from 105 stream sites and 1,190 wells in agricultural
areas from 36 major river basins in the conterminous U.S. 1992-
1998. The U.S. Geological Survey's (USGS)  National Water Quality
Assessment (NAWQA) program samples watersheds with relatively
homogeneous land use/land cover to better illuminate the effect of
land use on water quality. All sample were collected and analyzed by
           USGS according to the overall NAWQA design. The data are highly
           aggregated and should be interpreted mainly as an indication of
           general national patterns (The Heinz Center, 2002).

           Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
           USGS, NAWQA. Presented in The State of the Nation's Ecosystems,
           pages 95 and 232 (The Heinz Center, 2002)

           Web site:  http://water.usgs.gov/nawqa
           Indicator name: Total nitrogen in coastal waters

           Indicator type (status or trend): Status

           Indicator category (1 or 2): 2

           Associated question: What are pressures to water quality?

           Spatial coverage: Mid-Atlantic estuaries

           Temporal coverage: 1997-1998

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): The EPA Mid-Atlantic
           Integrated Assessment (MAIA) Estuaries Summary Database contains
           water quality, sediment, benthic community, and fish data collected
           by several partners in MAIA Region estuaries in 1997 and 1998. The
           MAIA program conducted regular fish surveys during the summer of
           1998 to characterize the structure and health of the fish communi-
           ties. The stations sampled were selected  according to a probabilistic
           design. These stations were not identical with the stat ons sampled
           for water and sediment quality analyses conducted primarily in 1997;
           therefore, it is not possible to directly compare these different
           analyses station by station. However, it is statistically valid to
           compare results among classes of estuaries,  (e.g., large versus small
           estuaries, Delaware Estuary versus Chesapeake Estuary).

           Indicator source (project, program, organization, report): U.S.
           Environmental Protection Agency. Mid-Atlantic Integrated Assessment,
           MAIA - Estuaries 1997-98, Summary Report,  EPA 620-R-02-003.
           Narragansett, Rl: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of
           Research and Development, Atlantic Ecology Division, May 2003.

           Web site: MAIA Estuaries data
           http://www.epa.gov/emap/maia/html/data/estuary/9798/xport.html
           Indicator name: Phosphorus in farmland, forested, and urban
           streams

           Indicator type (status or trend): Status

           Indicator category (1 or 2): 2

           Associated question: What are pressures to water quality?

           Spatial coverage: National. Major river basins and watersheds
           across U.S.

           Temporal coverage: 1992-1998
Appendix B
Indicator Metadata
B-13

-------
£lT\S Draft "Report on the  Environment 20Q3;
                                   Documera
                                                                          Jit
 Characterization of supporting data set(s): Phosphorus data were
 collected annually from 105 stream sites in agricultural areas from 36
 major river basins in the conterminous U.S. 1992-1998. The U.S.
 Geological Survey's (USCS) National Water Quality Assessment
 (NAWQA) program samples watersheds with relatively homogeneous
 land use/land cover to better illuminate the effect of land use on
 water quality. All sample were collected and analyzed by USCS
 according to the overall NAWQA design. The data are highly aggre-
 gated and should  be interpreted mainly as an indication of general
 national patterns (The Heinz Center, 2002).
 Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
 USCS, NAWQA. Presented in Tfie State of the Nation's Ecosystems,
 pages 96 and 232 (The Heinz Center, 2002)
 Web site: http://water.usgs.gov/nawqa
 Indicator name: Phosphorus in large rivers
 indicator category (1 or 2): 2
 Associated question: What are pressures to water quality?
 Spatial coverage: National. Major river basins and watersheds
 across U.S.
 Temporal coverage: 1992-1998
 Characterization of supporting data set(s): Phosphorus data
 were collected annually from 140 stream sites in agricultural areas
 from 36 major river basins in the conterminous U.S. 1992-1998.
 The U.S. Geological Survey's (USCS) National Water Quality
 Assessment (NAWQA) and National Stream Water Quality
 Accounting Network (NASQAN) program sampling efforts from
 1992 to 1998. NAWQA samples watersheds with relatively homoge-
 neous land use/land cover to better illuminate the effect of land use
 on water quality. All sample were collected and analyzed by USGS
 according to the overall NAWQA design. The data are highly aggre-
 gated and should be  interpreted mainly as an indication of general
 national patterns (The Heinz Center, 2002).
 Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
 USGS, NAWQA.  Presented in , pages 141 and 248 (The Heinz
 Center, 2002)
 Web site: http://water.usgs.gov/nawqa
 Indicator name: Total phosphorus in coastal waters
 Indicator category (1 or 2): 2
 Associated question: What are pressures to water quality?
 Spatial coverage: Mid-Atlantic estuaries
 Temporal coverage: 1997-1998
           Characterization of supporting data set(s): The EPA Mid-Atlantic
           Integrated Assessment (MAIA) Estuaries Summary Database contains
           water quality, sediment, benthic community, and fish data collected
           by several partners in MAIA Region estuaries in 1997 and 1998. The
           MAIA program conducted regular fish surveys during the summer of
           1998 to characterize the structure and health of the fish communi-
           ties. The stations sampled were selected according to a probabilistic
           design. These stations were not identical with the stat ons sampled
           for water and Sediment quality analyses conducted primarily in  1997;
           therefore, it is not possible to directly compare these different
           analyses station by station. However, it is statistically valid to com-
           pare results among classes of estuaries, (e.g., large versus small estu-
           aries, Delaware Estuary versus Chesapeake Estuary).

           Indicator source (project, program, organization, report): U.S.
           Environmental Protection Agency. Mid-Atlantic Integrated Assessment,
           MAIA-Estuarie.> 1997-98, Summary Report, EPA 620-R-02-003.
           Narragansett, Rl: EPA, Office of Research ahd Development, Atlantic
           Ecology Division, May 2003.

           Web site: MAIA Estuaries data          j
           http://www.epa.gov/emap/maia/html/data/estuary/9798/xport.html
           Indicator name: Atmospheric deposition of mercury

           Indicator type (status or trend): Status and trend

           Indicator category (1 or 2): 2         •

           Associated question: What are pressures'to water quality?

           Spatial coverage: National with limited coverage related to mercury
           emission sources

           Temporal coverage: 2001            ' .

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): The National
           Atmospheric Deposition Program (NADP)i Mercury Deposition
           Network (MDN)  is a cooperative program:among federal and state
           agencies, universities, electric utilities, and other industries. Samples
           were collected from SO sites across the UjS. related to mercury
           emissions. The network uses standardizedrmethods for collection
           and analyses. Weekly precipitation sample^ are collected and ana-
           lyzed by cold vapor atomic fluorescence. The MDN provides data
           for total mercury, but also includes methylmercury if desired by a
           site sponsor.

           Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
           NADP, MDN                          !
                                               i
           Website:                           i
           http://nadp.sws.uiuc.edu/mdn/maps/2001 /01 MDNdepo.pdf
           Indicator name: Chemical contamination
           water

           Indicator type (status or trend): Status
n streams and ground
 B-14
Indicator Metadata
         Appendix D

-------
                                                         = -.._.:_-.-.•---..= .--•--•---• 1"  .-._;. ..'... ..,,.:- ;..,.". . -  =. .,.;••••' -••-•- •-•.•'•. •.-"  •. .  ;-
Indicator category (1 or 2): 2

Associated question: What are pressures to water quality?

Spatial coverage: Lower 48 states

Temporal coverage: 1992-1998

Characterization of supporting data set(s): The data for freshwater
streams and ground water were collected and analyzed by the U.S.
Geological Survey's (USGS), National Water Quality Assessment
(NAWQA) in 36 major river basins and aquifers across the U.S.

Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
USGS, NAWQA. Presented in The State of the Nation's Ecosystems,
pages 48-51 and 210 (The Heinz Center, 2002).

Web site: http://water.usgs.gov/nawqa
Indicator name: Pesticides in farmland streams and ground water

Indicator type (status or trend): Status

Indicator category (1 or 2): 2

Associated question: What are pressures to water quality?

Spatial coverage: National in scope, 20 hydrologic basins

Temporal coverage: 1992-1998

Characterization of supporting data set(s): Data collection from
1992-1996 included analyses for 76 pesticides and 7 selected
pesticide degradation products, in 8,200 samples of ground
water/surface water in 20 of the nation's major hydrologic basins.
The U.S. Geological Survey's (USGS) National Water Quality
Assessment (NAWQA) program  samples watersheds with relatively
homogeneous land use/land cover to better illuminate the effect of
land use on water quality. All sample were collected and analyzed
by USGS according to the overall NAWQA design. The data are
highly aggregated and should  be interpreted mainly as an indica-
tion of general national patterns (The Heinz Center, 2002).

Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
USGS, NAWQA. Presented in The State of the Nation's Ecosystems,
pages 97-98 and 234 (The Heinz Center, 2002)

Web site: http://water.usgs.gov/nawqa
Indicator name: Acid sensitivity in lakes and streams

Indicator type (status or trend): Status

Indicator category (1 or 2): 2

Associated question: What are pressures to water quality?

Spatial coverage: Eastern United States

Temporal coverage: 1984-1986
           Characterization of supporting data set(s): In the mid-1980s,
           the U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) and other federal
           agencies commissioned a National Surface Water Survey (NSWS) to
           examine the effect of acid deposition in over 1,000 lakes  1,000
           lakes larger than 10 acres and in thousands of miles of streams
           believed to be sensitive to acidification.

           Indicator source (project, program, organization, report): 1)
           EPA, NSWS and 2) Baker, LA., A. Herlihy, P. Kaufmann, and J. Eilers.
           Acid Lakes and Streams in the United States: the role of acid
           deposition. Science 252:1151-1154 (1991).

           Web site:  NSWS not available online and Baker, et al., not available
           on a noncommercial website.
           Indicator name: Toxic releases to water of mercury, dioxin, lead,
           PCBs, and PBTs

           Indicator type (status or trend): Status

           Indicator category (1 or 2): 2

           Associated question: What are pressures to water quality?

           Spatial coverage: National

           Temporal coverage: 2000

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): The U.S.
           Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) Toxics Release Inventory
           (TR1) database consists of release and other waste management
           information from facilities. EPA requires facilities to use one or
           more of four general approaches to estimating/measuring releases,
           namely, monitoring, emission factors, mass balance, and
           engineering calculations. Facilities report release and other waste
           management information along with information about release
           estimation methods.

           Indicator source (project, program, organization, report): U.S.
           Environmental Protection Agency. 2000 Toxics Release Inventory Public
           Data Release Report, EPA 260-S-02-001. Washington, DC: U.S.
           Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Environmental
           Information, May 2002.

           Web site: http://www.epa.gov/tri/
           Indicator name: Sediment contamination of inland waters
           Indicator type (status or trend): Status

           Indicator category (1 or 2): 2

           Associated question: What are pressures to water quality?

           Spatial coverage: National, generally from sites targeted for con-
           tamination problems

           Temporal coverage:  1980-1999
Appendix D
Indicator Metadata
B-15

-------
                                                                           -q-  -| ;: :;•••=;•:: 1  rV&tit f "'*. f ||t|
                                                                           ;IMn;j1i||l.::U^|g^|M!:
Characterization of supporting data set(s): Data are contained in
the U.S. Environmental Protection Agency's (EPA) National Sediment
Qualify Inventory, comprehensive national survey of data about the
quality of aquatic sediments in the United States mandated by
Congress, and the forthcoming report of this data is an update of a
1997 report. The underlying data primarily are those reported to the
EPA Storage and  Retrieval (STORE!) database. Data are from 19,470
sites evaluated. Limitations of the compiled data include: the mixture
of data sets derived from different sampling strategies; incomplete
sampling coverage; the age and quality of the data; and  missing
information, such as latitude and longitude. The limitations of the
evaluation approach include uncertainties in the tools used to assess
sediment qualify. Because of these limitations, the draft report
assesses locations in the U.S. where there is the probability of
adverse effects to human health and the environment. Since the data
in this report come from non-random sampling and do not cover the
entire country, EPA states that  it is not appropriate to come up with
a national estimate of contaminated sediments. EPA also states that
the results from the trend assessment should not be extrapolated to
areas of the country where data were not available.

Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. The Incidence and Severity of
Sediment Contamination in Surface Waters of the United States,
National Sediment Quality Survey: Second Edition, DRAFT, EPA 823 -R-
01 -01, Washington, DC: EPA, Office of Water, December 2001.

Web site: http://www.epa.gov/waterscience/cs/surveyfs.html       ,
Indicator name: Sediment contamination of coastal waters

Indicator type (status or trend): Status

Indicator category (1 or 2): 2

Associated question: What are pressures to water quality?

Spatial coverage: Eastern U.S. south of Cape Cod and Gulf of
Mexico estuaries

Temporal coverage: 1990-1997

Characterization of supporting data set(s): The data for sedi-
ments and fish contamination in coastal waters were collected and
analyzed by the U.S. Environmental Protection Agency's (EPA)
Environmental Monitoring and Assessment Program (EMAP). The
data were collected in a manner that allows conclusions to be drawn
concerning the majority (approximately 76 percent) of the area of
estuaries in the United States. The list of contaminants targeted in
sediments by EMAP include pesticides, polychlorinated biphenyls .
(PCBs), polycyclic aromatic hydrocarbons (PAHs), and heavy metals.
Samples collected from over 2,000 location for measurement of over
100 contaminants. Sample sites selected based upon  statistically
random design.

Indicator source (project, program, organization, report): EPA's
EMAP Estuaries data set (EPA, 2001) implemented through partner-
           ships with the| National Oceanic and Atmospheric Administration
           (NOAA), the U.S. Geological Survey (USGS), coastal states, and aca-
           demia as reported in U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. National
           Coastal Condition Report, EPA 620-R-01 -005. Washington DC: EPA,
           Office of Research and Development and Office of Water, September
           2001. Presented in The State of the Nation's Ecosystems, 72 and 220
           (The Heinz Center, 2002).

           Web site: EM4P-http://www.epa.gov/emap'/;
           NCCR http://i5pa.gov/owow/oceans/nccr/downloads.html
           Indicator name: Sediment toxicity in estuaries

           Indicator type (status or trend): Status

           Indicator category (1  or 2): 2

           Associated question: What are pressures ito water quality?

           Spatial coverage: Eastern U.S. south of Cape Cod and Gulf of
           Mexico estuaries                       ,

           Temporal coverage: 1990-1997 for EMAP and since 1986 for
           NOAA

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): The data were
           collected and analyzed by the U.S. Environmental Protection
           Agency's (EPA) Environmental Monitoring and Assessment Program
           (EMAP)  and the National Oceanic and Atmospheric Administration
           (NOAA) National Status and Trends (NS&T) Program. 1) The
           EMAP data from over 2,500  location were collected  in a manner
                                                [
           that allows conclusions to be drawn concerning the majority
           (approximately 76 percent) of the area of estuaries in the United
           States. Sample sites selected based upon statistically random
           design. 2) The NOAA NS&.T bioeffects program collected toxicity
           data from 22 major estuaries of the United States.

           Indicator derivation (project, program,[Organization,  report):
           EPA's EMAP Estuaries data set (EPA, 2001 j)  implemented in partner-
           ship with NOAA, as  reported in U.S. Environmental Protection
           Agency. National Coastal Condition Report; EPA 620-R-01 -005.
           Washington DC: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of
           Research and Development and Office of Water, September 2001.
                                                E
           Web site: EMAP http://www.epa.gov/emap/;
           NCCR http://epa.gov/owow/oceans/nccr/downloads.html;
           NOAA http://ccmaserver.nos.noaa.gov/NSandT/New_NSandT.htm!
           Drinking; Water
           Indicator narrie: Population served by community water systems
           that meet all health-based standards     i

           Indicator type (status or trend): Status and trends

           Indicator category (1  or 2): 1
           Associated question: What is the quality

           Spatial coverage: National
if drinking water?
B-16
Indicator Metadata
        Appendix 6

-------

Temporal coverage: 1993-2001

Characterization of supporting data set(s): Community water
systems report monitoring violations quarterly to the states and
data are compiled by the U.S. Environmental Protection Agency
(EPA). The over 55,000 water systems that are required to report
violations serve about 94% of the U.S. population. The Safe
Drinking Water Information System (SDWIS) contains information
about public water systems and their violations of EPA's drinking
water regulations, as reported to  EPA by states and EPA regions in
conformance with reporting requirements established by statute,
regulation and guidance. States report the following information to
EPA:
• Basic information on each water system, including: name, ID
   number, number of people served, type of system (year-round or
   seasonal), and source of water (ground water or surface water);
• Violation information for each water system: whether it has
   followed established monitoring and reporting schedules,  com-
   plied with mandated treatment techniques, or violated any
   Maximum Contaminant Levels (MCLs);
• Enforcement information: what actions states have taken to
   ensure that drinking water systems return to compliance if they
   are in violation of a drinking water regulation;
• Sampling results for unregulated contaminants and for regulated
   contaminants when the monitoring results exceed the MCL

Indicator derivation (project, program,  organization, report):
EPA SDWIS1 Federal version.

Web site: http://www.epa.gov/safewater/sdwisfed/sdwis.htm

Recreation  in and on the Water

Indicator name: Number of beach days that beaches are closed or
under advispry

Indicator type (status or trend): Status

Indicator category (1 or 2): 2

Associated question: What is  the condition of surface waters sup-
porting recreational use?

Scale and coverage: National, coastal

Temporal coverage: 2001 reporting year, collected since 1997

Characterization of supporting data set(s): A questionnaire is
sent to managers (usually health or environmental quality depart-
ments in states, counties, or cities) responsible for monitoring swim-
ming beaches on the coasts or estuaries of the Atlantic Ocean,
Pacific Ocean, and Gulf of Mexico, and the shoreline of the Great
Lakes; information on some inland fresh water beaches has also been
collected. Days that beaches are closed or under advisory are
extracted from the survey and compiled by the U.S. Environmental
Protection Agency (EPA). Respondents numbered 237 in 2001
reporting on 2,445 beaches.
           Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
           U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. EPA's Beach Watch Program:
           2001 Swimming Season, EPA 823-F-02-006. Washington, DC: U.S.
           Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Water, May 2002.
           Web site: http://www.epa.gov/waterscienee/beaches/2001
           surveyfs.pdf

           Consumption of Fish and Shellfish
           Indicator name: Percent of river miles and lake acres under fish con^
           sumption advisories
           Indicator type (status or trend): Status and trend
           Indicator category (1 or 2): 2
           Associated question: What is the condition of waters that support
           consumption offish and shellfish?
           Spatial coverage: National
           Temporal, coverage: 1993-2001
           Characterization of supporting data set(s): The National
           Listing of Fish and Wildlife Advisories (NLFWA) database includes
           all available information describing state-, tribal-, and federally-
           issued fish consumption advisories in the United States for the 50
           States, the District of Columbia, and four U.S. Territories, and in
           Canada for the 12 provinces and territories. The database contains
           information provided to the U.S. Environmental Protection Agency
           (EPA) by the states, tribes, territories and Canada. The EPA has
           compiled these advisory data into a database which lists, among,
           other things, species and size offish or wildlife under advisory,
           chemical contaminants covered by the advisory, location and sur-
           face area of the waterbody under advisory, and population subject
           to the advisory.
           Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
           U.S. Environmental Protection  Agency. Update: National Listing of Fish
           and Wildlife Advisories. EPA 823-F-02-007, Washington, DC: EPA,
           Office of Water, May 2002.
           Web site: http://www.epa.gov/waterscience/fish/advisories/
           factsheet.pdf
           Indicator name: Contaminants in fresh water fish

           Indicator type (status or trend): Status

           Indicator category (1 or 2): 2

           Associated question: What is the condition of waters that support
           consumption offish and shellfish?

           Spatial coverage: Lower 48 states

           Temporal coverage: 1992-1998 (USGS)
Appendix D
Indicator Metadata
B-T7

-------
                     I      -                     '''•[<•        I  '! :'H '
ETTAS Draft feport ori tke Envirohirjent 2005
 Characterization of supporting data set(s): From 1992 to 1998,
 fish samples were collected and analyzed from 223 stream sites by
 the U.S. Geological Survey's (USGS) National Water Quality
 Assessment (NAWQA) program. Tissue composites from whole fish
 were analyzed for polychlorinated biphenyls (PCBs), organochlorine
 pesticides, and trace elements. The stream sites selected were r
 epresentative of a large range of stream sizes, land use practices and
 were not selected to be a statistical representation of U.S. streams
 (The Heinz Center,  2002).

 Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
 USGS, NAWQA; EPA,  EMAP and GLNPO. Presented in The State of
 the Nation's Ecosystems, pages 48-51 and 210 (The Heinz Center,
 2002).

 Web site: NAWQA http://water.usgs.gov/nawqa
 Indicator name: Number of watersheds exceeding health-based
 national water qualify criteria for mercury and PCBs in fish tissue

 Indicator type (status or trend): Status

 Indicator category (1 or 2): 2

 Associated question: What is the condition of waters that support
 consumption offish and shellfish?

 Spatial coverage: National; for mercury, 35 states (West coast and
 eastern two-thirds of the U.S.)

 Temporal coverage: 2001 reporting year, collected 1993-2001

 Characterization of supporting data set(s): The data set is a com-
 pilation offish tissue quality data housed in the U.S. Environmental
 Protection Agency's (EPA) National Listing of Fish and Wildlife
 Advisories (NLFWA) fish tissue database. Mercury data represented
 in 696 watersheds and PCBs in  153 watersheds. Mercury map is
 based on 22,000 records offish tissue mercury concentrations from
 the NLFWA where air deposition is the sole significant source of
 mercury. Watersheds are eliminated from the analysis if they contain
 potentially significant, but unquantified, runoff and effluent loads
 from mercury mines, large-producer gold mines, and mercury-cell
 chlor-alkati  facilities. Watersheds are also eliminated when the total
 screening level effluent load estimates for municipal wastewater
 treatment plants and pulp and paper mills are above five percent of
 the estimated waterbody-delivered air deposition load (EPA, Office
 of Water, November 2001).

 Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
 EPA NLFWA Mercury Fish Tissue Database, June 2001  as presented
 in U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Mercury Maps: Unking Air
 Deposition and Fish  Contamination on a National Scale. EPA 823-F-01 -
 026. Washington, DQ EPA, Office of Water, November 2001.

 Web site: Mercury map
 http://www.epa.gov/watersdence/maps/factsheet.pdf
          C^napter  3:  "Better

          "Protected  Land
          Land Use

          Indicator name: Extent of developed lands

          Indicator type (status or trend): Status jand Trend

          Indicator Category: 1

          Associated question: What is the extent iof developed lands?

          Spatial coverage: National, statistical sample of non-federal lands.
          The U.S. Department of Agriculture (USDA) Natural Resources
          Conservation Service's (NRCS) National Resources Inventory (NRI)
          collects data at the same  800,000 sampling sites every five years in
          all 50 states, Puerto Rico, the U.S. Virgin Islands, and some Pacific
          Basin locations.                      i

          Temporal coverage: At each NRI sample point, information is
          available for 1982, 1987, 1992, and 1997 so that trends and
          changes in land use and resource characteristics over 15 years can
          be examined! and analyzed.            i
                                             [
          Characterization of supporting data set(s): NRI is a statistical
          sampling of over 800,000 locations to collect data on land cover
          and use, soil erosion, prime farmland soils, wetlands, habitat diversity,
          conservation practices,  and related resource attributes. NRI is a com-
          pilation of natural resource information on non-Federal land in the
          U.S.                               ;

          Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
          U.S. Department of Agriculture. Summary Report: 1997 National
          Resources Inventory (Revised December 2000), Washington, DC:
          Natural Resources Conservation Service and Ames, Iowa: Iowa  State
          University, Statistical Laboratory, 2000.

          Web site: http://www.nrcs.usda.gov/tedhnical/NRI/
          Indicator name: Extent of urban and suburban lands

          Indicator type (status or trend): Statjjs

          Indicator Category: 2

          Associated question: What is the extent of developed lands?

          Spatial coverage: Lower 48 states.    ;

          Temporal coverage: 1992 satellite land cover data.

          Characterization of supporting data set(s): The National Land
          Cover Dataset (NLCD), in the 1990s, a federal interagency
 B-18
Indicator Metadata
Appendix 6

-------
                    ilecnnicai 1^

consortium (the Multi-Resolution Land Characterization (MRLC)
consortium) was created to coordinate access to and use of land
cover data from the Landsat 5 Thematic Mapper. Using Landsat data
and a variety of ancillary data, the consortium processed data from a
series of 1992 Landsat images, to create the NLCD on a square grid
covering the lower 48 states. The MRLC NLCD with 21  land cover
classes, was further processed by the USCS for the Heinz Center to
estimate the urban and suburban area coverage for the U.S.

Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Research and
Development. Multi-resolution land characteristics consortium -
national land cover data. 1992. (February 19, 2003;
http://www.epa.gov/mrlc/nlcd.html). Presented in The State of the
Nation's Ecosystems, pages 181 and 264 (The Heinz Center, 2002).

Web site: Data are available from http://www.usgs.gov/mrlcreg.html
Indicator name: Extent of agricultural land uses

Indicator type (status or trend): Status and Trend

Indicator Category: 1

Associated question: What is the extent of farmlands?

Spatial coverage: National, statistical sample of non-federal lands.
The U.S.  Department of Agriculture (USDA) Natural Resources
Conservation Service's (NRCS) National Resources Inventory (NRI)
collects data at the same 800,000 sampling sites every five years in
all 50 states, Puerto Rico, the U.S. Virgin Islands, and some Pacific
Basin locations.

Temporal coverage: At each NRI sample point, information is
available for 1982, 198Z 1992, and  1997 so  that trends and
changes in land use and resource characteristics over 15 years can
be examined and analyzed.

Characterization of supporting data set(s): NRI is a statistical
sampling of over 800,000 locations to collect data on land cover
and use, soil erosion, prime farmland soils, wetlands, habitat diversity,
conservation practices, and related resource attributes. NRI is a
compilation of natural resource information on non-Federal land in
theU.S.    ':

Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
U.S. Department of Agriculture. Summary Report: 1997 National
Resources Inventory (Revised December 2000),  Washington, DC:
Natural Resources Conservation Service and Ames, Iowa: Iowa State
University, Statistical Laboratory,  2000.

Web site: http://www.nrcs.usda.gov/technical/NRI/
Indicator name: The farmland landscape
Indicator type (status or trend): Status
Indicator Category: 2
           Associated question: What is the extent of farmlands?

           Spatial coverage: Lower 48 states.

           Temporal coverage: 1992 satellite land cover data.

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): The National
           Land Cover Dataset (NLCD). In the 1990s, a federal interagency
           consortium (the Multi-Resolution Land Characterization (MRLC)1
           consortium) was created to coordinate access to and use of land
           cover data from the Landsat 5 Thematic Mapper. Using Landsat
           data and a variety of ancillary data, the consortium processed data
           from a series of 1992 Landsat images, to create the NLCD on a
           square grid covering the lower 48 states. The MRLC NLCD  with 21
           land cover classes, was aggregated and reprocessed by the  USCS
           for the Heinz Center to estimate the  farmland landscape coverage
           for the U.S.

           Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
           U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Research and
           Development. Multi-resolution land characteristics consortium -
           national land cover data. 1992. (February 19, 2003;
           http://www.epa.gov/mrlc/nlcd.html). Presented in The State of the
           Nation's Ecosystems, pages 92 and 231 (The Heinz Center, 2002). .

           Web site: Data are available from http://www.usgs.gov/mrlcreg.html
           Indicator name: Extent of grasslands and shrublands

           Indicator type (status or trend): Status

           Indicator Category: 2

           Associated question: What is the extent of grasslands and
           shrublands?

           Spatial coverage: The lower 48 states and Alaska.

           Temporal coverage: 1992 satellite imagery

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): The Multi-Resolution
           Land Characterization (MRLC) Consortium's National Land Cover
           Dataset (NLCD) with 21 land cover classes, was used to estimate the
           area coverage for the U.S. The NLCD is based on remotely sensed
           imagery from the Landsat 5 Thematic Mapper. Data for Alaska were
           estimated from a vegetation map of Alaska by Fleming  (1996) based
           on Advanced Very High Resolution Radiometer (AVHRR) remote-
           sensing images with an approximate resolution of 1 km on a side
           (The Heinz Center, 2002).

           Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
           1) U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Research and
           Development. Multi-resolution land characteristics consortium -
           national land cover data.  1992. (February 19, 2003;
           http://www.epa.gov/mrlc/nlcd.html). 2)  Flemming, M,D. A Statewide
           Vegetation Map of Alaska Using a Phenological Classification of AVHRR
           Data. Anchorage, AK: 1996 Alaska Surveying and Mapping
           Conference, February 1996. Presented in The State of the Nation's
           Ecosystems, pages 161 and 256 (The Heinz Center, 2002).
Appendix D
Indicator Metadata
B-19

-------

                                                                        	i_
Web site: Data are available from http://www.usgs.gov/mrlcreg.html
Indicator name: Extent of forest area, ownership, and management

Indicator type (status or trend): Status and Trend

Indicator Category: 1

Associated question: What is the extent of forest lands?

Spatial coverage: National

Temporal coverage: Data from late 1940s to present. Data since
1953 provided with a reliability of ± 3-10 percent per 1 million
acres (67 percent confidence limit). FIA provides updates of
assessment data every five years.

Characterization of supporting data set(s): The USDA Forest
Service Forest Inventory and Analysis (FIA) program is a survey-
based program that has operated since the late 1940s, collecting
information on a variety of forest characteristics. FIA has used a two-
phase sample (generally, double sampling for stratification) to collect
information on the nation's forests. Phase one establishes a large
number of samples (more than 4 million, roughly every 0.6 miles).
These are selected using aerial photographs or other remote-sensing
images, which are then interpreted for various forest attributes.
Phase two establishes a subset of approximately 450,000 phase-one
points (roughly every 3 miles) for ground sampling. About 125,000
of these samples are permanently established on forest land. The
forest characteristics measured include ownership, protection status,
Species composition, stand age and structure, tree growth,
occurrences of mortality and removals, tree biomass, incidences of
pathogens, natural and human-caused disturbances, and soil
descriptors (The Heinz Center, 2002).

Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
U.S. Department of Agriculture, U.S. Forest Service. Draft Resource
Planning Act assessment tables. August 12, 2002. (September
2003; http://wvfff.ncrs.fs.fed.us/4801 /FIADB/rpaJabler/Draft_RPA_
2002Jrbrest_ResourceJables.pdf). Presented in The State of the
Nation's Ecosystems, pages 117 and 239 (The  Heinz Center, 2002).

Web site: http://www.fia.fs.fed.us/
 Indicator name: Sediment runoff potential from croplands and
 pasturelands

 Indicator type (status or trend): Status

 Indicator Category: 2

 Associated question: What are the ecological effects associated
 with land uses?

 Spatial coverage: National, statistical sample of non-federal lands.
 The U.S. Department of Agriculture (USDA) Natural Resources
 Conservation Service's (NRCS) National Resources Inventory (NRI)
 collects data at the same 800,000 sampling sites every five years in
           all 50 states, F'uerto Rico, the U.S. Virgin Isjands, and some Pacific
           Basin location!;.                        ;

           Temporal coverage: At each NRI sample point, information is avail-
           able for 1982, 1987, 1992, and 1997 so that trends and changes in  '
           land use and resource characteristics over JI5 years can be examined
           and analyzed. NRI is a compilation of natural resource information on
           non-Federal land in the  U.S.             i

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): Data are from
           USDA/NRCS STATSGO Soils Data and NR 1997 data (adjusted in
           2000). The Sioil and Water Assessment Tool (SWAT) is a public
           domain rnodeil actively supported by the USDA Agricultural Research
           Service (ARS) at the Grassland, Soil and Water Research Laboratory
           in Temple, Texas.                      :

           Indicator derivation (project, program; organization, report):
           Walker, Clive. Sediment  Runoff Potential, 1990-1995. Hydrologic
           Unit Modeling of the United States  (HUNJIUS) Project. Temple, TX:
           Texas Agricultural Experiment Station. August 24, 1999.

           Web site: Exhibit source
           http://www.cpa.gOV/iwi/1999sept/iv12c_usmap.html;
           NRI http://www.nrcs.usda.gov/technical/NRI/;
           SWAT http://www.brc.tamus.edu/swat/  '

           Chemicals in the Landscape

           Indicator name: Quantity and type of toxic chemicals released and
           managed                            i

           Indicator type (status or trend): Status

           Indicator Category: 2               [

           Associated question: How much  and what  types of toxics are
           released into the environment?        i

           Spatial coverage: National           '

           Temporal  coverage: 1998-2000      i

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): Th'e U.S.
           Environmental Protection Agency's (EPA) Toxics Release Inventory
           (TRI) database consists of release and other waste management
           information from facilities. EPA requires facilities to use one or
           more of four general approaches to estimating/measuring releases,
           namely, monitoring, emission factors, rnass balance, and engineer-
           ing calculations. Facilities report release and other waste
           management information along with information about release
           estimation methods.               •,

           Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
           U.S. Environmental Protection Agency.j2000 Toxics Release Inventory
           Public Daia Release Report, EPA 260-S-02-001. Washington, DC: U.S:
           Environmental Protection Agency, Office of  Environmental
           Information, May 2002.            j

           Web site: http://www.epa.gov/tri/   |
 B-20
Indicator Metadata
Appendix D

-------



Indicator name: Agricultural pesticide use

Indicator type (status or trend): Status

Indicator Category: 2

Associated question: What is the volume, distribution, and extent
of pesticide use?

Spatial coverage: National

Temporal coverage: 1992 and 1997

Characterization of supporting data set(s): Data are based on the
National Center for Food and Agricultural Policy (NCFAP) Pesticide
Use Database, a database of information on pesticide applications to
cropland for 220 active ingredients.

Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
Data from the NCFAP, a private, non-profit, non-advocacy research
organization, as reported in Gianessi, LR, and M.B. Marcelli. Pesticide
Use in U.S. Crop Production. Washington D.C. November, 2000.

Web site: http://www.ncfap.org/ncfap/nationalsummary1997.pdf
Indicator name: Fertilizer use

Indicator type (status or trend): Status and Trend

Indicator Category: 2

Associated question: What is the volume, distribution, and extent
of fertilizer use?

Spatial coverage: National

Temporal coverage: 1960-1998

Characterization of supporting data set(s): Data in the U.S.
Department of Agriculture's (USDA) Agricultural Resources and -
Environmental Indicators Report is based on a variety of surveys, as
well as the Census of Agriculture and the Natural Resources
Inventory.

Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
Daberkow, S., H. Taylor, and W. Huang. "Agricultural Resources and
Environmental Indicators: Nutrient Use and Management."
September, 2000. In Agricultural Resources and Environmental
Indicators, Agricultural  Handbook No. AH722. U.S. Department of
Agriculture, Economic  Research Service, Washington, DC, February
2003,4.4.1-4.4.49.

Web site: http://www.ers.usda.gov/publications/arei/arei2001 /
Indicator name: Pesticide residues in food

Indicator type (status or trend): Trend

Indicator Category: 1
           Associated question: What is the potential disposition of chemicals
           used on land?

           Scale and coverage: National

           Temporal coverage: 1997-2000

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): The U.S. Department
           of Agriculture's (USDA) Pesticide Data Program (POP) was started by
           USDA in May 1991 to provide data on pesticide dietary exposure,
           food consumption, and pesticide usage. POP data are based on
           samples of approximately SO different commodities tested for more
           than 290 different pesticides.

           Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
           Data from U.S. Department of Agriculture, Agricultural Marketing
           Service. Pesticide Data Program: Annual Summary Calendar Year 2000,
           Washington, DC: U.S. Department of Agriculture, February 2002.
           POP is USDA's program to collect data on pesticide residues in food.

           Web site: http://www.ams.usda.gov/science/pdp/
           Indicator name: Potential pesticide runoff from farm fields

           Indicator type (status or trend): Status

           Indicator Category: 1

           Associated question: What is the potential disposition of chemicals
           used on land?

           Spatial coverage: National, statistical sample of non-federal lands.
           The U.S. Department of Agriculture (USDA) Natural Resources
           Conservation Service's (NRCS) National Resources Inventory (NRI)
           collects data at the same 800,000 sampling sites every five years in
           all 50 states, Puerto Rico, the U.S. Virgin Islands, and some Pacific
           Basin locations.

           Temporal coverage: At each NRI sample point, information is avail-
           able for 1982, 1987, 1992, and 1997 so that trends and changes in
           land use and resource characteristics over 15 years can be examined
           and analyzed. The data used  in this analysis were from 1992.

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): Using national-level
           databases, a simulation was conducted of potential pesticide losses
           from representative farm fields. About 170,000 Natural Resources
           Inventory (NRI) sample points were treated as "representative fields."
           Thirteen crops were included in the simulation: barley, corn, cotton,
           oats, peanuts, potatoes, rice,  sorghum, soybeans, sugar beets, sun- '
           flowers, tobacco,  and wheat. The potential for pesticide loss from
           each "representative field" was estimated using the state average
           pesticide application rate and percent acres treated from the
           National Pesticide Use Database. The maximum percent runoff loss
           over a 20-year simulation  of rainfall from the Pesticide Loss Database
           was imputed to NRI sample points using match-ups by soil
           properties and proximity to 55 climate stations. The total loss of
           pesticides from each "representative field" was estimated by summing
           over the loss estimates for all the pesticides that the National
Appendix 6
Indicator Metadata
B-21

-------
Ef/\s Draft Rteport on the Environment 2QOi$ • Technical Documellt
                       I         '         .       :    i  .•       - i :  !  I'.r ! i  . -   I   :   .    .  •     '    • .-.'•[. I;; I f
Pesticlde Use Database reported for each State and crop. Watershed
scores were determined by averaging the scores for the NRI sample
points within each watershed.

Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
Data are from 1)1) National Resources Inventory, U.S. Department.
of Agriculture, Natural Resources Conservation Service, 1992; 2)
National Pesticide Use Database from Gianessi, Leonard P., and James
Earl Anderson. Pesticide Use in U.S. Crop Production: National Data
Report. National Center for Food and Agricultural Policy, Washington
D.C, February 1995; and 3) Pesticide Loss Database from Don W.
Coss, Texas Agricultural Experiment Station, Temple, Texas.

Web site: http://www.epa.gov/iwi/1999sept/iv12a_usrnap.html
Indicator name: Risk of nitrogen export

Indicator type (status or trend): Status

Indicator Category: 2

Associated question: What is the potential disposition of chemicals
used on land?

Spatial coverage: Lower 48 states

Temporal coverage: 1992 satellite imagery

Characterization of supporting data set(s): The Multi-Resolution
Land Characterization (MRLC) Consortium's National Land Cover
Dataset (NLCD) with 21 land cover classes, was used to estimate the
area coverage for the U.S. The NLCD is based on remotely sensed
imagery from the Landsat 5 Thematic Mapper.

Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
1) U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Research and
Development. Multi-resolution land characteristics consortium -
national land cover data. 1992. (February 19, 2003;
http://www.epa.gov/mrlc/nlcdMml). 2)  Wickham, J.D., K.H. Riitters,
R.V. O'Neill,  K.H. Reckhow, T.G. Wade, and K.B. Jones. Land cover as
a framework for assessing risk of water pollution, journal of the
American Water Resources Association 36 (6): 1-6 (2000).

Web site: Data are available from http://www.usgs.gov/mrlcreg.html
 Indicator name: Risk of phosphorus export

 Indicator type (status or trend): Status

 Indicator Category: 2

 Associated question: What is the potential disposition of chemicals
 used on land?

 Spatial coverage: Lower 48 states

 Temporal coverage: 1992 satellite imagery

 Characterization of supporting data set(s): The Multi-Resolution
 Land Characterization  (MRLC) Consortium's National Land Cover
          Dataset (NLCD) with 21 land cover classes, was used to estimate the
          area coverage for the US. The NLCD is based on remotely sensed
          imagery from 1:he Landsat 5 Thematic Mapper.

          Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
          1) U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Research and-
          Development. Multi-resolution land characteristics consortium -
          national land cover data. 1992. (February 19, 2003;               ,
          http://www.epa.gov/mrk/nlcd.html). 2) Wickiham, J.D., K.H. Riitters,
          R.V. O'Neill, K.H. Reckhow, T.G. Wade, and JK.B. Jones. Land cover as
          a framework for assessing risk of water pollution. Journal of the
          American Water Resources Association 36 (6r. 1 -6  (2000).

          Web site: Data are available from http://www.usgs.gov/mricreg.html

          Waste and  Contaminated Lands
          Indicator name: Quantity of municipal solid waste (MSW) generat-
          ed and managed

          Indicator type (status or trend): Status and Trend

          Indicator Category: 2

          Associated question: How much and what types of waste are
          generated and managed?

          Spatial coverage: National            ;

          Temporal coverage: Trends in MSW mapagement from 1960 to
          1999, including source reduction, recovery for recycling (including .
          composting),  and disposal via combustioji and landfilling.

          Characterization of supporting data set(s): The supporting data
          set addressees MSW in the U.S.  that is ge.nerated, recycled, and
          disposed. More recently, estimates of waste prevention have been
          included as well. Data  are provided both for specific materials
          (glass, plastic, paper, etc.) in MSW and specific products (newspaper,
          aluminum cans, etc.) in MSW.
                                             i
          Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
          Data are from U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Municipal Solid
          Waste in the United States: 2000 Facts and Figures, EPA S30-S-02-
          001. U.S. Environmental Protection Agehcy, Office of Solid Waste
          and Emergency Response, June 2002.  ,

          Web site: http://www.epa.gov/epaoswer/non-hw/muncpl/
          msw99.htm                         :
           Indicator name: Quantity of RCRA hazardous waste generated
           and managed                      ;

           Indicator type (status or trend): Status

           Indicator Category: 2              !

           Associated question: How much and what types of waste are
           generated ;and managed?            j

           Spatial coverage: National          i
 B-22
Indicator Metadata
7 \ppendix "B

-------
                     technical  00£u^
                    ..-..:- •--.:  •-  "-.- ' - '.- ••:' '-- . -.;,.  '  .-' -   I:"...-.,..;..:.	.j.cX.^v^i^: .;/-• ,;..; ::luii IA :^T-;':;':i:3S^

Temporal coverage: Biennial

Characterization of supporting data set(s): Generators,
transporters, treaters, storers, and disposers of hazardous waste
are required to provide information about their activities to state
environmental agencies. These agencies in turn pass on the
information to regional and national EPA offices. This information
is stored in EPA's RCRAInfo database.

Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. The National Biennial RCRA
Hazardous Waste Report, EPA 530-R-01 -009. Washington DC: U.S.
Environmental Protection Agency,. Office of Solid Waste and
Emergency Response, June 2001.

Website:
http://www.epa.gov/epaoswer/hazwaste/data/brs99/index.htm
Indicator name: Quantity of radioactive waste generated and in
inventory

Indicator type (status or trend): Status

Indicator Category: 2

Associated question: How much and what types of waste are
generated and managed?

Spatial coverage: National

Temporal coverage: Fiscal year 2000

Characterization of supporting data set(s): Summary data on the
amounts (vplume/mass) and location of the radioactive waste, spent
nuclear fuel, and contaminated media managed by the U.S.
Department,of Energy (DOE). These data are provided in a publicly-
available report (Summary Data Report) and are based oh data in
the DOE's Environmental Management (EM) Corporate Database
(Central Internet Database).

Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
U.S. Department of Energy, Office of Environmental Management.
Central Internet Database. 2002. (January 2003;
http://cid.em.doe.gov).

Web site: http://cid.em.doe.gov
Indicator name: Number and location of municipal solid waste
(MSW) landfills

Indicator type (status or trend): Status and Trend

Indicator Category: 2    •

Associated question: What is the extent of land used for waste
management?

Spatial coverage: National
           Temporal coverage: Trends in MSW management from 1960 to
           1999, including source reduction, recovery for recycling (including
           composting), and disposal via combustion and landfilling.

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): BioCycle magazine
           collects the MSW landfill data annually through a survey to state
           solid waste officers who relay the total number of landfills in
           each state (as  reported by state agencies, counties, and/or
           municipalities). There is no quality review process for these data
           and there are differences in the ways data is collected and
           reported by the state programs.

           Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
           BioCycle Journal of Composting and Organics Recycling 41  (4), April
           2000 as reprinted in U.S. Environmental Protection Agency.
           Municipal Solid Waste in the United States: 2000 Facts and Figures,
           EPA 530-S-02-001. U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of
           Solid Waste and Emergency Response, June 2002.

           Web site: http://www.epa.gov/epaoswer/non-hw/
           muncpl/msw99.htm
           Indicator name: Number of RCRA hazardous waste management
           facilities

           Indicator type (status or trend): Trend

           Indicator Category: 2

           Associated question: What is the extent of land used for waste
           management?

           Spatial coverage: National

           Temporal coverage: 1999

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): RCRAInfo is
           EPA's comprehensive information system, providing access to data
           supporting the Resource Conservation and Recovery Act (RCRA) of
           1976 and the Hazardous and Solid Waste Amendments (HSWA) of
           1984. RCRAInfo replaces the data recording and reporting abilities
           of the Resource Conservation and Recovery Information System
           (RCRIS) and the Biennial Reporting System  (BRS). The RCRAInfo
           system allows tracking of many types of information about the
           regulated universe of RGRA hazardous waste handlers. RCRAInfo
           characterizes facility status, regulated activities, and compliance
           histories and captures detailed data on the generation of hazardous
           waste from large quantity generators and on waste management
           practices from treatment, storage, and disposal facilities.

           Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
           U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. The National Biennial RCRA
           Hazardous  Waste Report, EPA 530-R-01 -009. Washington DC: U.S.
           Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Solid Waste and
           Emergency Response, June 2001.

           Web site: http://www.epa.gov/epaoswer/hazwaste/data/index.htm
Appendix B
Indicator Metadata
B-23

-------

Indicator name: Number and location of Superfund National
Priorities List sites

Indicator type (status or trend): Status and Trend

Indicator Category: 2

Associated question: What is the extent of contaminated land?

Spatial coverage: National

Temporal coverage: 1990-2002

Characterization of supporting data set(s): CERCLIS is the
Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation, and
Liability Information System. CERCLIS contains information on haz-
ardous waste sites, potential hazardous waste sites, and remedial
activities across the nation, including sites that are on the National
Priorities List (NPL)  or being considered for the NPL CERCLIS is
used by EPA to track activities conducted under its Superfund pro-
gram. Specific information is tracked for  each individual Superfund
site. Sites which come to EPA's attention  because of a potential for
releasing hazardous  substances into the  environment are added to
the CERCLIS inventory.

Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
EPA, Office of Solid Waste and Emergency Response. National
Priorities List Site Totals by Status and Milestone. March 26, 2003.
(April 3, 2003; hltp://mw.epa.gov/superfund/sites/query/
queryhtm/npltotal.htm) and Number of NPL Site Actions and
Milestones by Rscal Year. March 26, 2003.  (April 3, 2003;
htip://ww»f.epa,gov/ superfund/sites/query/queryhtm/nplfy/htm).

Web site: http://www.epa.gov/superfund/sites/cursites/index.htm
           ing of many types of information about th? regulated universe of
           RCRA hazardous waste handlers. RCRAInfo! characterizes facility sta-
           tus, regulated activities, and compliance histories and captures
           detailed data on the generation of hazardous waste from large quan-
           tity generators and on waste management;practices from treatment,
           storage, and (disposal facilities. Currently, EPA believes that there are
           over 6,500 facilities subject to RCRA CA statutory authorities. Of
           these, approximately 3,700 facilities haveiCA already underway or   :
           will need to implement CA as part of the process to obtain a permit
           to treat, store, or dispose of hazardous waste. EPA refers to these
           3,700 facilities as the "corrective action workload." To help prioritize
           resources further, EPA established specific short-term goals for 1,714
           facilities referred to as the RCRA Cleanup! Baseline.

           Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
           U.S. Environmental Protection Agency,  Office of Solid Waste and
           Emergency Response. Corrective action background. October 8,
           2002. (October 15, 2002; http://www.epa.gov/epaoswer/hazwaste/
           ca/backgnd.htm#5).                  [

           Web site: http://www.epa.gov/epaoswer/hazwaste/ca/index.htm
Indicator name: Number and location of RCRA Corrective Action
Sites

Indicator type (status or trend): Status and Trend

Indicator Category: 2

Associated question: What is the extent of contaminated land?  .,

Spatial coverage: National

Temporal coverage: 1997-1999

Characterization of supporting data set(s): Corrective Action
(CA) is the term the Resource Conservation and Recovery Act
(RCRA) program uses to describe the cleanup of sites that
manage hazardous wastes. The EPA Office of Solid Waste and
Emergency Response (OSWER) CA program keeps information on
CA sites in the RCRAInfo database. RCRAInfo is EPA's comprehensive
information system, providing access to data supporting the
Resource Conservation and Recovery Act (RCRA) of 1976 and the
Hazardous and Solid Waste Amendments (HSWA) of 1984. RCRAInfo
replaces the data recording and reporting abilities of the Resource
Conservation and Recovery Information System (RCR1S) and the
Biennial Reporting System (BRS). The RCRAInfo system allows track-
B-24
Indicator Metadata
Appendix B.

-------

 CJnapter  4:   Human


 Health
 Health Status of the United States: Indicators and Trends of Health
 and Disease
 Indicator name: Life expectancy
 Indicator type (status or trend): Trend
 Indicator category (1 or 2):  1
Associated question:  What are the trends for life expectancy?
Spatial coverage: National. Data  are for the SO states and the
 District of Columbia, unless otherwise specified.
Temporal coverage: 1933 to  present.
Characterization of supporting data set(s): National Center for
 Health Statistics (NCHS), through the National Vital Statistics
Systems (NVSS), has collected and published data on births,
deaths, marriages, and divorces in the United States. Virtually all
 births and deaths are  registered.  U.S. Standard Live Birth and
 Death Certificates are revised periodically. Most state certificates
conform closely in content and arrangement to the standard
certificate recommended by NCHS and all certificates contain a
minimum data set specified by NCHS. The mother provides demo-
graphic information on the birth certificate, such as race and
ethnicity, at the time of birth. Medical and  health information is
 based on hospital records. Demographic information on the death
certificate is provided  by the funeral director based on information
supplied by an informant. A physician, medical examiner, or coroner
 provides medical certification  of cause of death.
Indicator source (project, program, organization, report):
NCHS, NVSS
Web site: http://www.cdc.gov/nchs/nvss.htm
Indicator name: Cancer mortality

Indicator type (status or trend): Trend
Indicator category (7 or 2): 1

Associated question: What are the trends for cancer, cardiovascular
disease, chronic obstructive pulmonary disease and asthma?

Spatial coverage: National. Data are for the 50 states and, the
District of Columbia, unless otherwise specified.

Temporal coverage: 1933 to present; 1973-1998 data displayed.

Characterization of supporting data set(s): National Center for
Health Statistics (NCHS),'through the National Vital Statistics
           Systems (NVSS), has collected and published data on births, deaths,
           marriages, and divorces in the United States. Virtually all births and
           deaths are registered. U.S. Standard Live Birth and Death Certificates
           are revised periodically. Most state certificates conform closely in
           content and arrangement to the standard certificate recommended
           by NCHS and all certificates contain a minimum data set specified by
           NCHS. The mother provides demographic information on the birth
           certificate, such as race and ethnicity, at the time of birth. Medical
           and health information is based on hospital records. Demographic
           information on the death certificate is provided by the funeral
           director based on information supplied by an informant. A physician,
           medical examiner, or coroner provides medical certification of
           cause of death.

           Indicator source (project, program, organization, report):
           NCHS, National Vital Statistics Systems (NVSS)

           Web site: http://www.cdc.gov/nchs/nvss.htm
           Indicator name: Cancer incidence

           indicator type (status or trend): Trend

           Indicator category (1 or 2): 2

           Associated question: What are the trends for cancer, cardiovascular
           disease, chronic obstructive pulmonary disease and asthma?

           Spatial coverage: National

           Temporal coverage: 1997-2001

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): The purpose of the
           National Notifiable Disease Surveillance System is primarily to
           provide weekly provisional information on the occurrence of diseases
           defined as notifiable by the Council of State and Territorial
           Epidemiologists (CSTE) and annual summary data. State epidemiolo-
           gists report cases of notifiable diseases to CDC, and CDC tabulates
           and publishes these data in the Morbidity and Mortality Weekly Report
           (MMWR) and the Summary of Notifiable Diseases, United States.
           Policies for reporting notifiable disease cases can vary by disease
           or reporting jurisdiction. CSTE and CDC annually review and recom-
           mend additions or deletions to the list or nationally notifiable
           diseases based on the need to respond to emerging priorities.
           However, reporting nationally notifiable diseases to CDC is voluntary.
           Reporting is currently mandated by law or regulation only at the
           local and state level. Therefore, the list of diseases that are consid-
           ered notifiable varies slightly by state. Notifiable disease data are
           useful for analyzing disease trends and determining relative disease
           burdens. However, these data must be interpreted in light of
           reporting practices. The degree of completeness of data  reporting
           also is influenced by the diagnostic facilities available, the control
           measures in effect, public awareness of a  specific disease, and the
           interests, resources, and priorities of state and local officials respon-
           sible for disease control and public health surveillance, introduction
           of new  diagnostic tests,  or discovery of new disease entities can
Appendix D
Indicator Metadata
B-25

-------
                     y**	*'i*i«^
cause changes in disease reporting that are independent of the true
incidence of disease.
Indicator source (project, program, organization, report):
Centers for Disease Control and Prevention, Epidemiology Program
Office, National Notifiable Disease Surveillance System
Web site: Morbidity and Mortality Weekly Report
http://www.cdc.gov/mmwr/;
Summary of Notifiable Diseases
http://www.cdc.gov/epo/dphsi/annsum/
Indicator name: Cardiovascular disease mortality

Indicator type (status or trend): Trend

Indicator category (1 or 2): 1

Associated question: What are the trends for cancer, cardiovascular
disease, chronic obstructive pulmonary disease and asthma?

Spatial coverage: National. Data are for the SO states and the
District of Columbia, unless otherwise specified.-

Temporal coverage: 1933 to present; 1900-1996 data displayed.

Characterization of supporting data set(s): National Center for
Health Statistics (NCHS), through the National Vital Statistics
Systems (NVSS), has collected and published data on births, deaths,
marriages, and divorces in the United States. Virtually all births and
deaths are registered. U.S. Standard Live Birth and Death Certificates
are revised periodically. Most state certificates  conform closely in
content and arrangement to the  standard  certificate recommended
by NCHS and all certificates contain a  minimum data  set specified by
NCHS. The mother provides demographic information on the birth
certificate, such as race and ethnicity, at the time of birth. Medical
and health information is based on hospital records. Demographic
information on the death certificate is  provided by the funeral
director based on information supplied by an informant. A physician,
medical examiner, or coroner provides medical certification of
cause of death.
Indicator source (project, program,  organization,  report):
NCHS, NVSS
Web site: http://www.cdc.gov/nchs/nvss.htm
Indicator name: Cardiovascular disease prevalence

Indicator type (status or trend): Trend

Indicator category (1 or 2): 1

Associated question: What are the trends for cancer, cardiovascular
disease, chronic obstructive pulmonary disease and asthma?

Spatial coverage: National

Temporal coverage: NHANES  III, 1998-1994
          Characterization of supporting data set(s): The National Health
          and Nutrition Examination Survey (NHANES) is comprised of a
          series of surveys conducted by the Centers for Disease Control's
          (CDC) National Center for Health Statistics (NCHS). The survey is
          designed to collect data on the health of [the United States popu-
          lation, including information about many topics, such as nutrition,
          heart disease, and exposure to chemicals (CDC, 2001). The
          NHANES surveys have been performed over a number of years.
          The first survey, NHANES I, took place from 1971 through 1975;
          NHANES II occurred from  1976-80; NHANES 111 was performed in
          1988 through  1994; and the current NHANES began in 1999 and
          is ongoing. As part of the survey, blood and urine samples were
          collected to measure the amounts of certain chemicals thought to
          be  harmful to people. Because of the extensive work involved with •
          laboratory analyses, some chemicals were measured for all people
          in the survey, while other chemicals wereionly measured for a small
          sample of people in an age group. The current NHANES IV meas-
          ures exposure for 27 chemicals for people in the U.S. In previous
          NHANES, exposure had been assessed via laboratory analysis for
          only three chemicals: lead, cadmium and cotinine.

          Indicator source (project, program, organization, report):
          NHANES III, 1999. The CDC National Replprt on Human Exposure to
          Environmental Chemicals (often referred to| as the "CDC Report
          Card") summarizes chemical exposure data from the 1999 NHANES;

          Web site: http://www.cdc.gov/nchs/nhanes.htm
           Indicator name: Chronic obstructive pulmonary disease mortality

           Indicator type (status or trend): Trend

           Indicator category (1 or 2): 1

           Associated question: What are the trends for cancer, cardiovascular
           disease, chronic obstructive pulmonary disease and asthma?

           Spatial coverage: National. Data are for the 50 states and the
           District of Columbia,  unless otherwise specified.

           Temporal coverage: 1933 to present; 1980-1998 data displayed.

           Characterization of supporting data set(s):  National  Center for
           Health Statistics (NCHS), through the relational Vital Statistics
           Systems (NVSS), has collected and pub ished data on births, deaths,
           marriages, and divorces in the United States. Virtually all births and
           deaths are registered. U.S. Standard Live  Birth  and Death Certificates
           are revised periodically. Most state certificates  conform  closely in
           content and arrangement to the  standard certificate recommended
           by NCHS and all certificates contain a minimum data set specified by
           NCHS. The mother provides demographic information on the birth
           certificate, such as race and ethnicity, at the time of birth. Medical
           and health information is based on hospital records. Demographic
           information on the death certificate is provided by the funeral
           director biased on information supplied by an informant. A physician,
           medical exiaminer, or coroner provides medical  certification of
           cause of death.
 B-26
Indicator Metadata
Appendix 6

-------



Indicator source (project, program, organization, report):
NCHS, NVSS

Web site: http://www.cdc.gov/nchs/nvss.htm
Indicator name: Asthma mortality

indicator type (status or trend): Trend

Indicator category (1 or 2): 1

Associated question: What are the trends for cancer, cardiovascular
disease, chronic obstructive pulmonary disease and asthma?

Spatial coverage: National. Data are for the 50 states and the
District of Columbia, unless otherwise specified.

Temporal coverage: 1933 to present; 1980-1999 data displayed

Characterization of supporting data set(s): National Center for
Health Statistics  (NCHS), through the National Vital Statistics
Systems (NVSS), has collected and published data on births, deaths,
marriages, and divorces in the United States. Virtually all births and
deaths are registered. U.S. Standard Live Birth and Death Certificates
are revised periodically. Most state certificates conform closely in
content and arrangement to the standard certificate recommended
by NCHS and all certificates contain a minimum data set specified by
NCHS. The mother provides demographic information on the birth
certificate, such as race and ethnicity, at the time of birth. Medical
and health information is based on hospital records. Demographic
information on the death certificate is provided by the funeral
director based on information supplied by an informant. A physician,
medical examiner, or coroner provides medical certification of
cause of death.

Indicator source (project, program, organization, report):
NCHS, NVSS

Web site: http://www.cdc.gov/nchs/nvss.htm
Indicator name: Asthma prevalence

Indicator type (status or trend): Trend

Indicator category (1 or 2): 1

Associated question: What are the .trends for cancer, cardiovascular
disease, chronic obstructive pulmonary disease and asthma?

Spatial coverage: National

Temporal coverage: NHIS has been conducted continuously since
195^ the content of the survey has been updated about every 10-
15 years. In 1996 a substantially revised NHIS content began field
testing. This new questionnaire, described in detail below, began in
1997 and improves the ability of the NHIS to provide important
health information. 1980-1996 and 1980-1999 data displayed.
Characterization of supporting data set(s): The National Health
Interview Survey (NHIS) is a continuous nationwide survey in which
data are collected through personal household interviews. Self-
reported information is obtained on personal and demographic
characteristics, illnesses, injuries, impairments, chronic conditions,
utilization of health resources, and other health topics. The sample
scheduled for each week is representative of the target population,
and the weekly samples are additive over time. Response rates for
special health topics (supplements) have generally been lower.
Because of the extensive redesign of the questionnaire in  1997
and introduction  of the computer-assisted personal interviewing
(CAPI) method of data collection, data from 1997 and later years
may not be comparable with earlier years.

Indicator source (project, program, organization, report):
National Center for Health Statistics .(NCHS), National Health
Interview Survey (NHIS)

Web site: http://www.cdc.gov/nchs/nhis.htm
Indicator name: Cholera prevalence

Indicator type (status or trend): Trend

Indicator category (1 or 2): 2

Associated question: What are the trends for gastrointestinal ill-
nesses?

Spatial coverage: National

Temporal coverage: 1997-2001

Characterization of supporting data set(s): The purpose of the
National Notifiable  Disease Surveillance System is primarily to
provide weekly provisional information on the occurrence of dis-
eases defined as notifiable by the Council of State and Territorial
Epidemiologists (CSTE) and annual summary data. State epidemi-
ologists report cases of notifiable diseases to CDC, and CDC tab-
ulates and publishes these data in the Morbidity and Mortality
Weekly Report (MMWR) and the Summary of Notifiable Diseases,
United States. Policies for reporting notifiable disease  cases can
vary by disease or reporting jurisdiction. CSTE and CDC annually
review and recommend additions or deletions to the list or nation-
ally notifiable diseases based on the need to respond to emerging
priorities. However, reporting nationally notifiable diseases to CDC
is voluntary. Reporting is currently mandated by law or regulation
only at the local and state level. Therefore, the list of diseases that
are considered  notifiable varies slightly by state. Notifiable disease
data are useful for analyzing disease trends and determining
relative disease burdens.-However, these data must be interpreted
in light of reporting practices. The degree of completeness of data
reporting also is influenced by the diagnostic facilities available,
the control measures in effect, public awareness of a specific
disease, and the interests, resources, and priorities of state and
local officials responsible for disease control and public health
surveillance, introduction of new diagnostic tests, or discovery of
Appendix D
                                                       Indicator Metadata
                                                        B-27

-------

new disease entities can cause changes in disease reporting that
arc independent of the true incidence of disease.

Indicator source (project, program, organization, report):
Centers for Disease Control and Prevention, Epidemiology Program
Office, National Notifiable Disease Surveillance System
Web site: Morbidity and Mortality Weekly Report
http://wvw.cdc.gov/mmwr/;
Summary of Notifiable Diseases
http://www.cdc.gov/epo/dphsi/annsum/
Indicator name: Cryptosporidiosis prevalence

Indicator type (status or trend): Trend

Indicator category (1  or 2): 2

Associated question: What are the trends for gastrointestinal ill-
nesses?

Spatial coverage: National
Temporal coverage: 1997-2001

Characterization of supporting data set(s): The purpose of
the National Notifiable Disease Surveillance System is primarily to
provide weekly provisional information on the occurrence of
diseases defined as notifiable by the Council of State and Territorial
Epidemiologists (CSTE) and annual summary data. State epidemiol-
ogists report cases  of notifiable diseases to CDC, and CDC tabu-
lates and publishes  these data in the Morbidity and Mortality Weekly
Report (MMWR) and the Summary of Notifiable Diseases, United
States. Policies for reporting notifiable disease cases can vary by
disease or reporting jurisdiction. CSTE and CDC annually review
and recommend additions or deletions to the list or nationally
notifiable diseases based on the need to respond to emerging pri-
orities. However, reporting nationally notifiable diseases to CDC is
voluntary. Reporting is  currently mandated by law or regulation only
at the local and state level. Therefore, the list of diseases that are
considered notifiable varies slightly by state. Notifiable disease  data
are useful for analyzing disease trends and determining relative  dis-
ease burdens. However, these data must be interpreted in light of
reporting practices. The degree of completeness of data reporting
also is influenced by the diagnostic facilities available, the control
measures in effect, public awareness of a specific disease, and the
interests, resources, and priorities of state and local officials
responsible for disease control and public health surveillance,
introduction of new diagnostic tests,  or discovery of new
disease entities can cause changes in disease reporting that are
independent of the true incidence of disease.

Indicator source (project, program, organization, report):
Centers for Disease Control and Prevention, Epidemiology Program
Office, National Notifiable Disease Surveillance System

Web  site: Morbidity and Mortality Weekly Report
http://www.cdc.gov/mmwr/;
           Summary of Notifiable Diseases
           http://www.cdc.gov/epo/dphsi/annsum/
           Indicator name: E. coli 0157:H7 prevalence

           Indicator type (status or trend): Trend

           Indicator category (1 or 2): 2          '
                                                 i
           Associated question: What are the trends for gastrointestinal ill-
           nesses?      ;                          I

           Spatial coverage: National             !

           Temporal coverage: 1997-2001       ;

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): The purpose of
           the National Notifiable Disease Surveillance System is primarily to  .
           provide weekly provisional information on the occurrence of
           diseases defined as notifiable by the Council  of State and Territorial
           Epidemiologists (CSTE) and annual summary data. State .epidemiol-
           ogists report cases of notifiable diseases to CDC, and CDC
           tabulates and publishes these data in the Morbidity and Mortality
           Weekly Report (MMWR) and the Summary of Notifiable Diseases,
           United Status. Policies for reporting notifiable disease cases can vary
           by disease or reporting jurisdiction. CSTE and CDC annually review
           and recommend additions or deletions to the list or nationally noti-
           fiable diseases based on the need to reispond to emerging priorities.
           However, reporting nationally notifiable' diseases to CDC is volun-
           tary. Reporting is currently mandated by law or  regulation  only at
           the local and state level. Therefore, the list of diseases that are
           considered notifiable varies slightly by Istate.  Notifiable disease data
           are useful for analyzing disease trends and  determining relative dis-
           ease burdens. However, these data must be interpreted in light of
           reporting practices. The  degree of completeness of data reporting
           also is influenced by the diagnostic facilities available, the control
           measures in effect, public awareness of a specific disease, and the
           interests, resources, and priorities of state and local officials
           responsible for disease control and pdblic health surveillance,
           introduction of new diagnostic tests, or discovery of new'
           disease entities can cause changes in disease reporting that are
           independent of the true incidence of jdisease.

           Indicator source (project, program,!organization, report):
           Centers for Disease Control and Prevention, Epidemiology Program
           Office, National Notifiable Disease Surveillance System

           Web site: Morbidity and  Mortality Wet kly Report
           http://www.cdc.gov/mmwr/;         !                            :
           Summary of Notifiable Diseases     ,  •
           http://www.cdc.gov/epo/dphsi/annsCim/
           Indicator name: Hepatitis A prevalence

           Indicator type (status or trend): Trend

           Indicator category (1  or 2): 2    ;
B-28
Indicator Metadata
Appendix B

-------
Associated question: What are the trends for gastrointestinal
illnesses?

Spatial coverage: National

Temporal coverage: 1997-2001

Characterization of supporting data set(s): The purpose of the
National Notifiable Disease Surveillance System is primarily to
provide weekly provisional information on the occurrence of diseases
defined as notifiable by the Council of State and Territorial
Epidemiologists (CSTE) and annual summary data. State
epidemiologists report cases of notifiable diseases to CDC, and CDC
tabulates and publishes these data in  the Morbidity and Mortality
Weekly Report (MMWR) and the Summary of Notifiable Diseases,
United States. Policies for reporting notifiable disease cases can vary
by disease or reporting jurisdiction. CSTE and CDC annually review
and recommend additions or deletions to the list or nationally
notifiable diseases based on the need to respond to emerging
priorities. However, reporting nationally notifiable diseases to CDC is
voluntary. Reporting is currently mandated by law or regulation only
at the local and state level. Therefore, the list of diseases that are
considered notifiable varies slightly by state. Notifiable disease data
are useful for analyzing disease trends and determining relative
disease burdens. However, these data  must be interpreted in light of
reporting practices. The  degree of completeness of data reporting
also is influenced by the diagnostic facilities available, the control
measures in effect, public awareness of a specific disease, and the
interests, resources, and  priorities of state and local officials
responsible for disease control and public health surveillance,
introduction of new diagnostic tests, or discovery of new disease
entities can cause changes in disease  reporting that are independent
of the true incidence of disease.

Indicator source (project, program, organization, report):
Centers for Disease Control and Prevention, Epidemiology Program
Office, National Notifiable Disease Surveillance System

Web site: Morbidity and  Mortality Weekly Report
http://www.cdc.gov/mmwr/;
Summary of Notifiable Diseases
http://www.cdc.gov/epo/dphsi/annsum/
Indicator name: Salmonellosis prevalence '

Indicator type (status or trend): Trend

Indicator category (1 or 2): 2

Associated question: What are the trends for gastrointestinal
illnesses?

Spatial coverage: National

Temporal coverage: 1997-2001"

Characterization of supporting data set(s): The purpose of the
National Notifiable Disease Surveillance System is primarily to
           provide weekly provisional information on the occurrence of diseases
           defined as notifiable by the Council of State and Territorial
           Epidemiologists (CSTE) and annual summary data. State
           epidemiologists report cases of notifiable diseases to CDC, and CDC
           tabulates and publishes these data in the Morbidity and Mortality
           Weekly Report (MMWR) and the Summary of Notifiable Diseases,
           United States. Policies for reporting notifiable disease cases can vary
           by disease or reporting jurisdiction. CSTE and CDC annually review
           and recommend additions or deletions to the list or nationally
           notifiable diseases based on the need to respond to emerging
           priorities. However, reporting nationally notifiable diseases to CDC is
           voluntary. Reporting is currently mandated by law or regulation only
           at the local and state level. Therefore, the list of diseases that are
           considered notifiable varies slightly by state. Notifiable disease data
           are useful for analyzing disease trends and determining relative
           disease burdens. However, these data must be interpreted in light of
           reporting practices. The degree of completeness of data reporting
           also is influenced by the diagnostic facilities available, the control
           measures in effect, public awareness of a specific disease, and the
           interests, resources, and priorities of state and local officials
           responsible for disease control and public health surveillance,
           introduction  of new diagnostic tests,  or discovery of new disease
           entities can cause changes in disease reporting that are independent
           of the true incidence of disease.

           Indicator source (project, program, organization, report):
           Centers for Disease Control and Prevention, Epidemiology Program
           Office, National Notifiable Disease Surveillance System

           Web site: Morbidity and Mortality Weekly Report
           http://www.cdc.gov/mmwr/;
           Summary of Notifiable Diseases
           http://www.cdc.gov/epo/dphsi/annsum/
           Indicator name: Shigellosis prevalence

           Indicator type (status or trend): Trend

           Indicator category (1  or 2): 2

           Associated question: What are the trends for gastrointestinal ill-
           nesses?

           Spatial coverage: National

           Temporal coverage: 1997-20Q1

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): The purpose of the
           National Notifiable Disease Surveillance System is primarily to
           provide weekly provisional information on the occurrence of diseases
           defined as notifiable by the Council of State and Territorial
           Epidemiologists (CSTE) and annual summary data. State
           epidemiologists report  cases of notifiable diseases to CDC, and CDC
           tabulates and publishes these data in  the Morbidity and Mortality
           Weekly Report (MMWR)  and the Summary of Notifiable Diseases,
           United States. Policies for reporting notifiable disease cases can vary
           by disease or reporting jurisdiction. CSTE and CDC annually review
Appendix B
Indicator Metadata
B-29

-------
                                                                             Tefctirlteal Ddcflminfe
and recommend additions or deletions to the list or nationally
notifiable diseases based on the need to respond to emerging
priorities. However, reporting nationally notifiable diseases to CDC is
voluntary. Reporting is currently mandated by law or regulation only
at the local and state level. Therefore, the list of diseases that are
considered notifiable varies slightly by state. Notifiable disease  data
are useful for analyzing disease trends and determining relative
disease burdens. However, these data must be interpreted in light of
reporting practices. The degree of completeness of data reporting
also is influenced by the diagnostic facilities available, the control
measures in effect, public awareness of a specific disease, and the
interests, resources, and priorities of state and local officials
responsible for disease control and public health surveillance,
introduction of new diagnostic tests, or discovery of new disease
entities can cause changes in disease reporting that are independent
of the true incidence of disease.

Indicator source (project, program, organization, report):
Centers for Disease Control and Prevention, Epidemiology Program
Office, National Notifiable Disease Surveillance System

Web site: Morbidity and Mortality Weekly Report
http://www.cdc.gov/mmwr/;
Summary of Notifiable Diseases
http://www.cdc.gov/epo/dphsi/annsum/
Indicator name: Typhoid fever prevalence

Indicator type (status or trend): Trend

Indicator category (1  or 2): 2

Associated question: What are the trends for gastrointestinal ill-
nesses?

Spatial coverage: National

Temporal coverage: 1997-2001

Characterization of supporting data set(s): The purpose of the
National Notifiable Disease Surveillance System is primarily to
provide weekly provisional information on the occurrence of diseases
defined as notifiable by the Council of State and Territorial
Epidemiologists (CSTE) and annual summary data. State
epidemiologists report cases of notifiable diseases to CDC, and CDC
tabulates and publishes these data in the Morbidity and Mortality
Weekly Report (MMWR) and the Summary of Notifiable Diseases,
United States. Policies for reporting notifiable disease cases can vary
by disease or reporting jurisdiction. CSTE and CDC annually review
and recommend additions or deletions to the list or nationally
notifiable diseases based on the need to respond to emerging
priorities. However, reporting nationally notifiable diseases to CDC is
voluntary. Reporting is currently mandated  by law or regulation only
at the local and state level. Therefore, the list of diseases that are
considered notifiable varies slightly by state. Notifiable disease data
are useful for analyzing disease trends and  determining relative
disease burdens. However, these data must be interpreted in  light of
           reporting practices. The degree of completeness of data reporting
           also is influenced by the diagnostic facilities available, the control
           measures in effect, public awareness of a specific disease, and the
           interests, resources, and priorities of state and local officials
           responsible for disease control and public rjealth surveillance,
           introduction of new diagnostic tests, or disfcovery of new disease
           entities can cause changes in disease reporting that are independent
           of the true incidence of disease.

           Indicator source (project, program, organization, report):
           Centers for Disease Control and Prevention, Epidemiology Program
           Office, National Notifiable Disease Surveillance System

           Web site: Morbidity and Mortality Weekly Report
           http://www.cdc.gov/mmwr/;
           Summary of Notifiable Diseases            '
           http://www.ciJc.gov/epo/dphsi/annsum/  :
           Indicator name: Infant mortality

           Indicator type (status or trend): Trend

           Indicator category (1 or 2): 1

           Associated (question: What are the trends for children's environ-
           mental health issues?

           Spatial coverage: National. Data  are for the 50 states and the
           District of Columbia, unless otherwise specified.

           Temporal coverage: 1933 to present; 1999 data displayed

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): National Center for
           Health Statistics (NCHS), through the National Vital Statistics
           Systems (NVSS), has collected and published data on births, deaths,
           marriages, and divorces in the United States. Virtually all births and
           deaths are registered. U.S. Standard Live Birth and Death Certificates
           are revised periodically. Most state certificates conform closely in
           content and arrangement to the standard certificate recommended
           by NCHS and all certificates contain a minimum data set specified by
           NCHS. The mother provides demographic information on the birth
           certificate, such as race and ethnicity, at the time of birth. Medical
           and health information is based on hospital records. Demographic
           information on the  death certificate is provided by the funeral
           director based on information supplied by an informant. A physician,
           medical examiner, or coroner provides medical certification of cause
           of death.   -                        :

           Indicator  source (project, program, organization, report):
           National Center for Health Statistics (NCHS), National Vital
           Statistics Systems (NVSS)

           Web site: http://www.cdc.gov/nchs/nvss.htm
           Indicator name: Low birthweight incidence

           Indicator type (status or trend): Trend
B-30
Indicator Metadata
Appendix D

-------
                                       cj^


Indicator category (1 or 2): 1

Associated question: What are the trends for children's
environmental health issues?

Spatial coverage: National. Data are for the 50 states and the
District of Columbia, unless otherwise specified.

Temporal coverage: 1933 to present; 1991-2000 data displayed.

Characterization of supporting data set(s): National Center for
Health Statistics (NCHS), through the National Vital Statistics
Systems (NVSS), has collected and published data on births, deaths,
marriages; and divorces in the United States. Virtually all births and
deaths are registered. U.S. Standard Live Birth and Death Certificates
are revised periodically. Most state certificates conform closely in
content and arrangement to the standard certificate recommended
by NCHS and all certificates contain a minimum data set specified by
NCHS. The mother provides demographic information on the birth
certificate, such as race and ethnicity, at the time of birth. Medical
and health information is based on hospital records. Demographic
information on the death certificate is provided by the funeral
director based on information supplied by an informant. A physician,
medical examiner, or coroner provides medical certification of cause
of death.  :

Indicator source (project, program, organization, report):
National Center for Health Statistics (NCHS); National Vital
Statistics Systems (NVSS)

Web site: http://www.cdc.gov/nchs/nvss/htm
Indicator name: Childhood cancer mortality

Indicator type (status or trend): Trend

Indicator category (1 or 2): 1

Associated question: What are the trends for children's environ-
mental health issues?

Spatial coverage: National. Data are for the 50 states and the
District of Columbia, unless otherwise specified.

Temporal coverage: 1933 to present; 1994-1998 data displayed.

Characterization of supporting data set(s): National Center for
Health Statistics  (NCHS), through the National Vital Statistics
Systems (NVSS), has collected and published data on births, deaths,
marriages, and divorces in the United States. Virtually all births and
deaths are registered. U.S. Standard Live Birth and Death Certificates
are revised periodically. Most state certificates conform closely in
content and arrangement to the standard certificate recommended
by NCHS and all  certificates contain a minimum data set specified by
NCHS. The mother provides demographic information on the birth
certificate, such as race and ethnicity, at the time of birth. Medical
and health information is based on hospital records. Demographic
information on the death certificate is provided by the funeral
director based on information supplied by an informant. A physician,
           medical examiner, or coroner provides medical certification of cause
           of death.
           Indicator source (project, program, organization, report):
           National Center for Health Statistics (NCHS), National'Vital
           Statistics Systems (NVSS)
           Web site: http://www.cdc.gov/nchs/nvss.htm
           Indicator name: Childhood cancer incidence

           Indicator type (status or trend): Trend

           Indicator category (1 or.2): 2

           Associated question: What are the trends for children's environ-
           mental health issues?

           Spatial coverage: Eleven Standard Metropolitan Statistical Areas
           (SMSAs) amounting to fourteen percent of the U.S. population.

           Temporal coverage: 1973 to present; 1975-1998 data displayed.

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): The Surveillance,
           Epidemiology, and End Results (SEER) Program of the National
           Cancer Institute is a source of information on cancer incidence and
           survival in the United States. The SEER Program began on January 1,
           1973. NCI contracts with 11 population-based registries that cover
           eleven SMSAs (and three supplemental registries) within the United
           States to provide data on all residents diagnosed with cancer during
           each year and to provide current followup information on all
           previously diagnosed patients. The SEER Program covers
           approximately 14 percent of the U.S. population. The SEER Program
           is the only comprehensive source of population-based information in
           the United States that includes stage of cancer at the time of
           diagnosis and survival rates within each stage.

           Indicator source (project, program, organization, report):
           National Institutes of Health (NIH), NCI, SEER

           Web site: http://seer.cancer.gov
           Indicator name: Childhood asthma mortality

           Indicator type (status or trend): Trend

           Indicator category (1 or 2): 1

           Associated question: What are the trends for children's
           environmental health issues?

           Spatial coverage: National. Data are for the 50 states and the
           District of Columbia, unless otherwise specified.

           Temporal coverage: 1933 to present

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): National Center for
           Health Statistics  (NCHS), through the National Vital Statistics
           Systems (NVSS), has collected and published data on births, deaths,
/Appendix D
Indicator Metadata
B-31

-------
                                            	IKTOSfsaBRSf	«=»w;
marriages, and divorces in the United States. Virtually all births and
deaths are registered. U.S. Standard Live Birth and Death Certificates
are revised periodically. Most state certificates conform closely in
content and arrangement to the standard certificate recommended
by NCHS and all certificates contain a minimum data set specified by
NCHS. The mother provides demographic information on the birth
certificate, such as race and ethnicity, at the time of birth. Medical
and health information is based on hospital records. Demographic
information on the death certificate is provided by the funeral
director based on information supplied by an informant. A physician,
medical examiner, or coroner provides medical certification of cause
of death.
Indicator source (project, program, organization, report):
National Center for Health Statistics (NCHS), National Vital
Statistics Systems (NVSS)
Web site: http://vww.cdc.gov/nchs/nvss.htm
Indicator name: Childhood asthma prevalence

Indicator type (status or trend): Trend

Indicator category (1  or 2): 1

Associated question: What are the trends for children's
environmental health issues?

Spatial coverage: National

Temporal coverage: NHIS has been conducted continuously since
19S7, the content of the survey has been updated about every 10-
15 years. In 1996 a substantially revised NHIS content began field
testing. This new questionnaire, described in detail below, began in
1997 and improves the ability of the NHIS to provide important
health information. 1980-2001 data displayed.

Characterization of supporting data set(s): The National Health
Interview Survey (NHIS) is a continuous nationwide survey in which
data are  collected through personal household interviews. Self-
reported information is obtained on personal and demographic
characteristics, illnesses, injuries, impairments, chronic conditions,
utilization of health resources, and other health topics. The sample
scheduled for each week is representative of the target population,
and the weekly samples are additive over time. Response rates for
special health topics (supplements) have generally been lower.
Because  of the extensive redesign of the questionnaire in 1997 and
introduction of the computer-assisted personal interviewing (CAPI)
method of data collection, data from 1997 and later years may not
be comparable with earlier years.

Indicator source (project, program, organization, report):
National  Center for Health Statistics (NCHS), National Health
Interview Survey (NHIS)

Web site: http://wvw.cdc.gov/nchs/nhis.htm
           Indicator name: Deaths due to birth defeqts
                                                 I
           Indicator type (status or trend): Trend  •

           Indicator category (1 or 2): 1          |

           Associated question: What are the trends for children's
           environmental health issues?

           Spatial coverage: National. Data are for the 50 states and the
           District of Columbia, unless otherwise specified.

           Temporal coverage:  1933 to present.

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): National Center for
           Health Statistics (NCHS), through the National Vital Statistics
           Systems (NVSS), has collected and published data on births, deaths,
           marriages, and divorces in the United States. Virtually all births and
           deaths are registered. U.S. Standard Live Birth and Death Certificates
           are revised periodically. Most state certificates  conform closely in
           content and arrangement to the standard [certificate recommended
           by NCHS and all certificates contain a  minimum data set specified by
           NCHS. The mother provides demographic; information on the birth
           certificate, such as race and ethnicity, at the time of birth. Medical
           and health iriformation is based on hospital records. Demographic
           information on the death certificate is provided by the funeral
           director based on information supplied by an informant. A physician,
           medical examiner, or coroner provides medical certification of cause
           of death.                  •          '

           Indicator sciurce (project, program, organization, report):
           National Center for Health Statistics (NCHS), National Vital
           Statistics Systems (NVSS)             '
           Web site: http://www.cdc.gov/nchs/nvss.htm
           Indicator name: Birth defect incidence

           Indicator type (status or trend): Trent

           Indicator category (1 or 2): 1        i

           Associated question: What are the trends for children's
           environmental health issues?           ;

           Spatial coverage: National. Data are for the 50 states and the
           District of Columbia, unless otherwise specified.

           Temporal coverage: 1933 to present; 2000 data displayed.

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): National Center for
           Health Statistics (NCHS), through the National Vital Statistics   ;
           Systems (NVSS), has collected and published data on births, deaths,
           marriages, and divorces in the United States. Virtually all births and
           deaths are registered. U.S. Standard Livje Birth and Death Certificates
           are revised periodically. Most state certificates conform closely in
           content arid arrangement to the  standard certificate recommended
           by NCHS and all certificates contain a minimum data set specified by
           NCHS. The mother provides demographic information on the birth
           certificate, such as race and ethnicity, at the time  of birth. Medical
B-32
Indicator Metadata
Appendix D

-------

and health information is based on hospital records. Demographic
information on the death certificate is provided by the funeral
director based on information supplied by an informant. A physician,
medical examiner, or coroner provides medical certification of cause
of death.

Indicator source (project, program, organization, report):
National Center for Health Statistics (NCHS), National Vital
Statistics Systems (NVSS)

Web site: http://www.cdc.gov/nchs/nvss.htm

Measuring Exposure to Environmental
Pollution: Indicators and Trends

Indicator name: Blood lead level

Indicator type (status or trend): Trend

Indicator category (1 or 2): 1

Associated question: What is the level of exposure  to heavy metals?

Spatial coverage: National

Temporal coverage: NHANES 1999-2000

Characterization of supporting data set(s): The National Health
and Nutrition Examination Survey (NHANES) is comprised of a series
of surveys conducted by the Centers for Disease Control's (CDC)
National Center for Health Statistics (NCHS). The survey is
designed to collect data  on1 the health of the United States
population, including information about many topics, such as
nutrition, heart disease, and exposure to chemicals (CDC, 2001).
The NHANES surveys have been  performed over a number of years.
The first survey, NHANES I, took place from 1971 through 1975;
NHANES II occurred from 1976-80; NHANES III was performed in
1988 through 1994; and the current NHANES began in 1999 and is
ongoing. As part of the survey, blood and urine samples were
collected to measure the amounts of certain chemicals thought to be
harmful to  people. Because  of the extensive work involved with
laboratory analyses, some chemicals were measured for all people in
the survey, while other chemicals were only measured for a small
sample of people in an age group. The current NHANES IV measures
exposure for 27 chemicals for people in the U.S. In previous
NHANES, exposure had been assessed via laboratory analysis for
only three chemicals: lead, cadmium and cotinine.

Indicator source (project, program, organization, report):
National Health and Nutrition Examination  Survey (NHANES),  1999.
The CDC National Report on Human Exposure to Environmental
Chemicals (often referred to as the "CDC Report Card") summarizes
chemical exposure data from the 1999 NHANES.

Web site: http://www.cdc.gov/nchs/nhanes.htm
Indicator name: Urine arsenic level
           Indicator type (status or trend): Trend

           Indicator category (1 or 2): 2

           Associated question: What is the level of exposure to.heavy metals?

           Spatial coverage: NHEXAS-Region 5

           Temporal coverage: 1999

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): The National Human
           Exposure Assessment Survey (NHEXAS) was developed by the Office
           of Research and Development (ORD) of the U.S. Environmental
           Protection Agency (EPA) early in the 1990s to provide critical
           information about multipathway, multimedia population exposure
           distribution to chemical classes. Phase 1 of NHEXAS consisted of
           demonstration and scoping studies in Maryland, Phoenix, Arizona,
           and ERA Region 5 using probability- based sampling designs.
           Although the study was conducted in three different regions of the
           U.S., it was not designed to be nationally representative. The Region
           S study was conducted in Ohio, Michigan, Illinois, Indiana,
           Wisconsin, and Minnesota, and measured metals and volatile organic
           chemicals (VOCs).

           Indicator source (project, program, organization, report):
           1) NHEXAS-Region 5; 2) National Research Council. Arsenic in
           Drinking Water. Washington, DC: National Academies Press, 1999.

           Web site: NHEXAS
           http://www.epa.gov/nerl/research/nhexas/nhexas.htm;
           NHEXAS data in EPA's Human Exposure Database System
           http://www.epa.gov/heds/
           Indicator name: Blood mercury level

           Indicator type (status or trend): Trend

          . Indicator category (1 or 2): 1

           Associated question: What is the level of exposure to heavy metals?

           Spatial coverage: National

           Temporal coverage: NHANES, 1999-2000

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): The National Health
           and Nutrition Examination Survey (NHANES) is comprised of a series
           of surveys conducted by the Centers for Disease Control's (CDC)
           National Center for Health Statistics (NCHS). The survey is
           designed to collect data on the health of the United States
           population, including  information about many topics, such as
           nutrition, heart disease, and exposure to chemicals (CDC, 2001).
           The NHANES surveys have been performed over a number of years.
           The first survey, NHANES I, took place from 1971 through 1975;
           NHANES II occurred from  1976-80; NHANES III was performed in
           1988 through  1994; and the current NHANES began in  1999 and is
           ongoing. As part of the survey, blood and urine samples  were
           collected to measure the amounts of certain chemicals thought to be
           harmful to people. Because of the extensive work involved with
Appendix D
Indicator Metadata
B-33

-------


laboratory analyses, some chemicals were measured for all people in
the survey, while other chemicals were only measured for a small
sample of people in an age group. The current NHANES IV measures
exposure for 27 chemicals for people in the U.S. In previous
NHANES, exposure had been assessed via laboratory analysis for
only three chemicals: lead, cadmium and cotinine.

Indicator source (project, program, organization, report):
National Health and Nutrition Examination Survey (NHANES), 1999.
The CDC National Report on Human Exposure to Environmental
Chemicals (often referred to as the "CDC Report Card") summarizes
chemical  exposure data from the 1999 NHANES.

Web site: http://www.cdc.gov/nchs/nhanes.htm
Indicator name: Blood cadmium level

Indicator type (status or trend): Trend

Indicator category (1 or 2): 1

Associated question: What is the level of exposure to heavy metals?

Spatial coverage: National

Temporal coverage: NHANES, 1999-2000

Characterization of supporting data set(s): The National Health
and Nutrition Examination Survey (NHANES) is comprised of a series
of surveys conducted by the Centers for Disease Control's (CDC)
National Center for Health Statistics (NCHS). The survey is
designed to collect data on the health of the United States
population, including information about many topics, such as
nutrition, heart disease, and exposure to chemicals (CDC, 2001).
The NHANES surveys have been performed over a number of years.
The first survey, NHANES I, took place from 1971 through 1975;
NHANES II occurred from 1976-80; NHANES III was performed in
1988 through 1994; and the current NHANES began in 1999 and is
ongoing. As part of the survey, blood and urine samples were
collected to measure the amounts of certain chemicals thought to be
harmful to people. Because of the extensive work involved with
laboratory analyses, some chemicals were measured for all people in
the survey, while other chemicals were only measured for a small
sample of people in an age group. The current NHANES IV measures
exposure for 27 chemicals for people in the U.S. In previous
NHANES, exposure had been assessed via laboratory analysis for
only three chemicals: lead, cadmium and cotinine.

Indicator source (project, program, organization,  report):
National Health and Nutrition Examination Survey (NHANES),  1999.
The CDC National Report on Human Exposure to Environmental
Chemicals (often referred to as the "CDC Report Card") summarizes
chemical exposure data from the 1999 NHANES.

Web site: http://www.cdc.gov/nchs/nhanes.htm
Indicator name: Blood cotinine level
          Indicator type (status or trend): Trend

          Indicator category (1 or 2): 1

          Associated question: What is the level of exposure to cotinine?

          Spatial coverage: National

          Temporal coverage: NHANES, 1999-2000

          Characterization of supporting data set(s): The National Health
          and Nutrition Examination Survey (NHANES) is comprised of a series
          of surveys conducted by the Centers for Djsease Control's (CDC)
          National  Center for Health Statistics (NChjS). The survey is
          designed to collect data on the health of tpe United States
          population, including information about many topics, such as
          nutrition, heart disease, and exposure to chemicals (CDC, 2001).
          The NHANES surveys have been performed over a number of years.
          The first  survey, NHANES I, took place from 1971 through 1975;
          NHANES II occurred from 1976-80; NHANES III was performed in
          1988 through 1994; and the current NHANES began in 1999 and is
          ongoing. As part of the survey, blood and urine samples were
          collected to measure the amounts of certain chemicals thought to be
          harmful to people. Because  of the extensive work involved with
          laboratory analyses, some chemicals were measured for all people in
          the survey, while other chemicals were only measured for a small
          sample of people in an age group. The current NHANES IV measures
          exposure for 127 chemicals for people in the U.S. In previous
          NHANES, exposure had been assessed via'laboratory analysis for
          only three chemicals: lead, cadmium and cbtinine.

          Indicator source (project, program, organization,  report):
          National  Health and Nutrition Examination Survey (NHANES)
                                             1  I
          Web site: http://www.cdc.gov/nchs/nhanes.htm
           Indicator name: Blood volatile organic compound levels

           Indicator type (status or trend): "

           Indicator category (1 or 2): 1

           Associated question: What is the level of exposure to volatile
           organic compounds?

           Spatial coverage: National

           Temporal coverage: NHANES 111 (1988-1994)

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): The National Health
           and Nutrition Examination Survey (NHANES) is comprised of a series
           of surveys conducted by the Centers for Disease Control's (CDC)
           National  Center for Health Statistics (NCHS). The survey is
           designed to collect data on the health of the United States
           population, including  information about many topics, such as
           nutrition, heart disease, and exposure to Chemicals (CDC, 2001).
           The NHANES surveys have been performed over a number of years.
           The first  survey, NHANES I, took place from 1971 through 1975;
           NHANES II occurred from  1976-80; NHANES III was performed in
B-34
Indicator Metadata
Appendix D

-------

 1988 through 1994; and the current NHANES began in 1999 and is
 ongoing. As part of the survey, blood and urine samples were
 collected to measure the amounts of certain chemicals thought to be
 harmful to people. Because of the extensive work involved with
 laboratory analyses, some chemicals were measured for all people in
 the survey, while other chemicals were only measured for a small
 sample of people in an age group. The current NHANES IV measures
 exposure for 27 chemicals for people in the U.S. In previous
 NHANES, exposure had been assessed via laboratory analysis for
 only three chemicals: lead, cadmium and cotinine.

 Indicator source (project, program, organization, report):
 National Health and Nutrition Examination Survey (NHANES), 1999.
 The CDC National Report on Human Exposure to Environmental
 Chemicals (often referred to as the "CDC Report Card")  summarizes
 chemical exposure data from the 1999 NHANES.

 Web site: http://www.cdc.gov/nchs/nhanes.htm
Indicator name: Urine organophosphate levels to indicate pesticides

Indicator type (status or trend): Trend

Indicator category (1 or 2): 1

Associated question: What is the level of exposure to pesticides?

Spatial coverage: National

Temporal coverage: NHANES, 1999-2000

Characterization of supporting data set(s): The National Health
and Nutrition Examination Survey (NHANES) is comprised of a series
of surveys conducted by the Centers for Disease Control's (CDC)
National Center for Health Statistics (NCHS). The survey is
designed to collect data on the health of the United States
population, including information about many topics, such as
nutrition, heart disease, and exposure to chemicals (CDC, 2001).
The NHANES surveys have been performed over a number of years.
The first survey, NHANES I, took place from 1971 through 1975;
NHANES II occurred from 1976-80; NHANES III was performed in
1988 through 1994; and the current NHANES began in 1999 and is
ongoing. As part of the survey, blood and urine samples were
collected to measure the amounts of certain chemicals thought to be
harmful to people. Because  of the extensive work involved with
laboratory analyses, some chemicals were measured for all people in
the survey, while other chemicals were only measured for a small
sample of people in an age group. The current NHANES IV measures
exposure for 27 chemicals for people in  the U.S. In previous
NHANES, exposure had been assessed via laboratory analysis for
only three chemicals: lead, cadmium and cotinine.

Indicator source (project, program, organization, report):
National Health and Nutrition Examination Survey (NHANES), 1999.
The CDC National Report on Human Exposure to Environmental
Chemicals (often referred to as the "CDC Report Card") summarizes
chemical exposure data from the 1999 NHANES.
           Web site: http://www.cdc.gov/nchs/nhanes.htm


           Indicator name: Blood lead level in children
           Indicator type (status or trend): Trend
           Indicator category (1 or 2): 1
           Associated question: What are the trends in exposure to environ-
           mental contaminants for children?
           Spatial coverage: National
           Temporal coverage: NHANES, 1999-2000
           Characterization of supporting data set(s): The National Health
           and Nutrition Examination Survey (NHANES) is comprised of a series
           of surveys conducted by the Centers for Disease Control's (CDC)
           National Center for Health Statistics (NCHS). The survey is
           designed to collect data  on the health of the United States
           population, including information about many topics, such as
           nutrition, heart disease, and exposure to chemicals (CDC, 2001).
           The NHANES surveys have been  performed over a number of years. •
           The first survey, NHANES I, took place from 1971 through 1975;
           NHANES II occurred from 1976-80; NHANES III was performed in
           1988 through 1994; and the current NHANES began in 1999 and is
           ongoing. As part of the survey, blood and urine samples were
           collected to measure the amounts of certain chemicals thought to be
           harmful to people. Because of the extensive work involved with
           laboratory analyses, some chemicals were measured for all people in
           the survey, while other chemicals were only measured for a small
           sample of people in an age group. The current NHANES IV measures
           exposure for 27 chemicals for people in the U.S. In previous
           NHANES, exposure had been assessed via laboratory analysis for
           only three chemicals: lead, cadmium and cotinine.
           Indicator source (project, program, organization, report):
           National Health and Nutrition Examination Survey (NHANES), 1999.
           The CDC National Report on Human Exposure to Environmental
           Chemicals (often referred to as the "CDC Report Card") summarizes
           chemical exposure data from the 1999 NHANES.
           Web site: http://www.cdc.gov/nchs/nhanes.htm
           Indicator name: Blood mercury level in children
           Indicator type (status or trend): Trend
           Indicator category (1 or 2): 1
           Associated question: What are the trends in exposure to environ-
           mental contaminants for children?
           Spatial coverage: National
           Temporal coverage: NHANES, 1999-2000
           Characterization of supporting data set(s): The National Health
           and Nutrition Examination Survey (NHANES) is comprised of a series
Appendix D
Indicator Metadata
B-35

-------
of surveys conducted by the Centers for Disease Control's (CDC)
National Center for Health Statistics (NCHS). The survey is
designed to collect data on the health of the United States
population, including information about many topics, such as
nutrition, heart disease, and exposure to chemicals (CDC, 2001).
The NHANES surveys have been performed over a number of years.
The first survey, NHANES I, took place from 1971 through 1975;
NHANES II occurred from 1976-80; NHANES III was performed in
1988 through 1994; and the current NHANES began in 1999 and is
ongoing. As part of the survey, blood and urine samples were
collected to measure the amounts of certain chemicals thought to be
harmful to people. Because of the extensive work involved with
laboratory analyses, some chemicals were measured for all people in
the survey, while other chemicals were only measured for a small
sample of people in an age group. The current NHANES IV measures
exposure for 27 chemicals for people in the U.S. In previous
NHANES, exposure had been assessed via laboratory analysis for
only three chemicals: lead, cadmium and cotinine.

Indicator source (project, program, organization, report):
National Health and Nutrition Examination Survey (NHANES),  1999.
The CDC National Report on Human Exposure to Environmental
Chemicals (often referred to as the "CDC Report Card") summarizes
chemical exposure data from the 1999 NHANES.

Web site: http://www.cdc.gov/nchs/nhanes.htm
                                                                                                   "1"
          exposure for 2,7 chemicals for people in the U.S. In previous
          NHANES, exposure had been assessed via laboratory analysis for
          only three chemicals: lead, cadmium and cotinine.

          Indicator source (project, program, organization, report):
          National Health and Nutrition Examination Survey (NHANES)

          Web site: http://www.cdc.gov/nchs/nhanes.htm
Indicator name: Blood cotinine level in children

Indicator type (status or trend): Trend

Indicator category (1 or 2): 1

Associated question: What are the trends in exposure to
environmental contaminants for children?

Spatial coverage: National

Temporal coverage: NHANES, 1999-2000

Characterization of supporting data set(s): 1) The National
Health and Nutrition Examination Survey (NHANES) is comprised of
a series of surveys conducted by the Centers for Disease Control's
(CDC) National Center for Health Statistics (NCHS). The survey is
designed to collect data on the health of the United States
population, including information about many topics, such as
nutrition, heart disease, and exposure to chemicals (CDC, 2001).
The NHANES surveys have been performed over a number of years.
The first survey, NHANES I, took place from 1971 through 1975;
NHANES II occurred from 1976-80; NHANES III was performed in
1988 through 1994; and the current NHANES began in 1999 and is
ongoing. As part of the survey, blood and urine samples were
collected to measure the amounts of certain chemicals thought to be
harmful to people. Because  of the extensive work involved with
laboratory analyses, some chemicals were measured for all people in
the survey, while other chemicals were only measured for a small
sample of people in an age group. The current NHANES IV measures
B-36
Indicator Metadata
/Appendix 13

-------
                                        ^
                                                                                                       SmMSffiTa^^^ySw^^a^^
                                                         ^^:yfefafrUy&rt^
Chapter  5:  tcologica
(Condition
Forests

Indicator name: Extent of area by forest type

Indicator type (status or trend): Status

Indicator Category: 1

Associated question:  What is the ecological condition of forests?

Spatial coverage: Lower 48 states

Temporal coverage: 1963-1997. Data from late 1940s to present.
Data since 1953 provided with a reliability of ± 3-10 percent per 1
million acres (67 percent confidence limit). FIA provides updates of
assessment data every  five years.

Characterization of supporting data set(s): The USDA Forest
Service Forest Inventory and Analysis  (FIA)  program is a survey-
based program that has operated since the late 1940s, collecting
information on a variety of forest characteristics. FIA has used a two-
phase sample (generally, double sampling for stratification) to collect
information on the nation's forests. Phase one establishes a large
number of samples (more than 4 million, roughly every 0.6 miles).
These are selected using aerial photographs or other remote-sensing
images, which are then interpreted for various forest attributes.
Phase two establishes a subset of approximately 450,000 phase-one
points (roughly every 3 miles) for ground sampling. About 125,000
of these samples are permanently established on forest land. The
forest characteristics measured include ownership, protection status,
species composition, stand age and structure, tree growth,
occurrences of mortality and removals, tree biomass, incidences of
pathogens,  natural and human-caused disturbances, and soil
descriptors  (The Heinz Center, 2002).

Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
Smith, W.B., J.S. Vissage, D.R. Darr, and R.M. Sheffield. Forest Statistics
of the United States, 1997, General Technical Report NC-219. St.
Paul, MN: U.S. Department of Agriculture Forest Service, North •
Central Research Station, 2001. Presented in The State of the
Nation's Ecosystems, pages 118 and 240 (The Heinz Center, 2002).

Web site: http://fia.fs.fed.us
Indicator name: Forest age class

Indicator type (status or trend): Status

Indicator Category: 2
           Associated question: What is the ecological condition of forests?

           Spatial coverage: National, all 50 states

           Temporal coverage: 1997. Data from late 1940s to present. Data
           since 1953 provided with a reliability of ± 3-10 percent per 1 million
           acres (67 percent confidence limit). FIA provides updates of assess-
           ment data every five years.

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): The USDA Forest
           Service Forest Inventory and Analysis (FIA) program is a survey-
           based program that has operated since the late 1940s, collecting
           information on a variety of forest characteristics. FIA has used a two-
           phase sample (generally, double sampling for stratification) to collect
           information on the nation's forests. Phase one establishes a large
           number of samples (more than 4 million, roughly every 0.6 miles).
           These are selected using aerial photographs  or other remote-sensing
           images, which are then interpreted for various forest attributes.
           Phase two establishes a subset of approximately 450,000 phase-one
           points (roughly every 3 miles) for ground sampling. About 125,000
           of these samples are permanently established on forest land. The
           forest characteristics measured include ownership, protection status,
           species composition, stand age and structure, tree growth,
           occurrences of mortality and removals, tree biomass, incidences of
           pathogens, natural and human-caused disturbances, and soil
           descriptors (The Heinz Center, 2002).

           Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
           Smith, W.B., J. Vissage, D. Darr, and R. Sheffield. Forest Statistics of the
           United States, 1997. U.S. Department of Agriculture, U.S. Forest
           Service, General Technical Report NC-219. St. Paul, MN: USDA,
           Forest Service. 2001. Presented in The State  of the Nation's
           Ecosystems, pages 126 and 242 (The Heinz Center, 2002).

           Web site: http://fia.fs.fed.us
           Indicator name: Forest pattern and fragmentation

           Indicator type (status or trend): Status

           Indicator Category: 2

           Associated question: What is the ecological condition of forests?

           Spatial coverage: Lower 48 states

           Temporal coverage: 1992 satellite imagery and data from late
           1940s to present.  Data since 1953 provided with a reliability of ± 3-
           10 percent per 1 million acres (67 percent confidence limit). FIA
           provides updates of assessment data every five years.

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): 1) The Multi-
           Resolution Land Characterization (MRLC) Consortium's National
           Land Cover Dataset (NLCD) provides a consistent, uniform, spatially
           explicit description of general land cover/land use across the
           continental U.S. at a 30-meter resolution.  It does not contain
           habitat types. 2) The USDA Forest Service Forest Inventory and
           Analysis  (FIA) program is a survey-based program that has operated ,
Appendix D
Indicator Metadata
B-37

-------
                      ^^
since the late 1940s, collecting information on a variety of forest
characteristics. F1A has used a two-phase sample (generally, double
sampling for stratification) to collect information on the nation's
forests. Phase one establishes a large number of samples (more than
4 million, roughly every 0.6 miles). These are selected using aerial
photographs or other remote-sensing images, which are then
interpreted for various forest attributes. Phase two establishes a
subset of approximately 450,000 phase-one points (roughly every 3
miles) for ground sampling. About 125,000 of these samples are
permanently established on forest land. The forest characteristics
measured include ownership, protection status, species composition,
stand age and structure, tree growth, occurrences of mortality and
removals, tree biomass, incidences of pathogens, natural and human-
caused disturbances, and soil descriptors (The Heinz Center, 2002).

Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
1)Multi-Resolution Land Characterization Consortium  (MRLC) -
National Land Cover Data (NLCD); 2) Conkling, B., J. Coulston, and
M. Ambrose (eds.). Forest Health Monitoring National Technical Report
1991 "1999, Asheville, NC: U.S. Department of Agriculture Forest
Service, Southern Research Station, 2002; 3) Riiters, K.H., J.D.
Wickham, R.V. O'Neill, K.B. Jones, E.R. Smith, J.W. Coulston, T.G.
Wade, and J.H. Smith. Fragmentation of Continental United States
Forests. Ecosystems 5: 815-822 (2002). Presented in The State of the
Nation's Ecosystems, pages 120-121 and 240 (The Heinz Center,
2002).
Web sites: MRLC http://www.epa.gov/mrlc/;
NLCD http://www.epa.gov/mrlc/nkd.html;
Riitlers, et at.  material http://www.srs.fs.usda.gov/4803/landscapes/
Indicator name: At-risk native forest species

Indicator type (status or trend): Status

Indicator Category: 2

Associated question: What is the ecological condition of forests?

Spatial coverage: Natural Heritage programs in all 50 states.

Temporal coverage: 2000. Data managed consistently since 1974.

Characterization of supporting data set(s): NatureServe is an
independent nonprofit organization whose research biologists
gather, review, integrate, and record available information about
species taxonomy, status, and use of different habitats or ecological
system types. They are assisted in this work by scientists in the
network of Natural Heritage programs as well as by contracted
experts for different invertebrate taxa. NatureServe staff and
collaborators assign a conservation status by using standard
Heritage ranking criteria. The Heritage ranking process considers five
major status ranks: critically imperiled (G1),  imperiled (G2),
vulnerable (G3), apparently secure (G4), and demonstrably
widespread, abundant, and  secure (G5). In addition, separate ranks
are assigned for species regarded as presumed extinct (GX) or
possibly extinct (GH).
           Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
           NatureServe and its member programs in the network of Natural
           Heritage programs develop and maintain information on species at
           risk. Presented in The State of the Nation's Ecosystems, pages 124 and
           214 (The Heinz Center, 2002).

           Web site: http://www.natureserve.org
           Indicator name: Populations of representative forest species

           Indicator type (status or trend): Status and Trend

           Indicator Category: 2

           Associated question:  What is the ecological condition of forests?
                                                 !
           Spatial coverage: National data for birdsy 37 states for trees

           Temporal coverage: 1970-2002. FIA data date from late 1940s to
           present. Data since 1953 provided with ateliability oft 3-10 per:
           cent per 1 million acres (67 percent confidence limit). FIA provides
           updates of assessment data every five years. BBS was initiated in
           1966.                                ;

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): 1) The North American
           Breeding Bird Survey (BBS) is a long-term, large-scale international
           avian monitoring program intended to track the status and trends of
           North American bird populations. Today there are  approximately
           3700 active BBS routes across the continental U.S. and Canada of
           which 2900 are surveyed each year (Saufer, et al., 2001). 2) The
           USDA Forest Service Forest Inventory and Analysis (FIA) program is a
           survey-based program  that has operated since the  late 1940s,
           collecting information  on a variety of forest characteristics.  FIA has
           used a two-phase sample (generally, double sampling for stratifica-
           tion) to collect information on the nation's forests. Phase one estab-
           lishes a largo number of samples (more than 4 million, roughly every
           0.6 miles). These are selected using aerial photographs or other
           remote-sensing images, which are then interpreted for various forest
           attributes. Phase two establishes a subset of approximately 450,000
           phase-one points (roughly every 3- miles) for ground sampling.
           About 125,000 of these samples are permanently  established on
           forest land. The forest characteristics measured include ownership,
           protection status, species composition, stand age and structure, tree
           growth, occurrences of mortality and removals, tree biomass, inci-
           dences of pathogens, natural and human-caused disturbances, and
           soil descriptors (The Heinz Center, 2002).

           Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
           Bird data are from the  U.S. Geological Survey's North American
           Breeding Bird Survey (BBS), and tree data are from the U.S. Forest
           Service, Draft Resource Planning and Assessment Tables,  August
           2002. Reported  in U.S. Department of Agriculture. National Report
           on Sustainable Forests - 2003, Final Draft, Washington, DC: U.S.
           Department of Agriculture, Forest Service, 2002. This indicator was
           based on the final review draft of the Sustainable Forests report
           (USDA, FS, 2002) and the website for corresponding technical sup-
           port material is provided below. The final version of the report and
B-38
Indicator Metadata
Appendix B

-------
            '


supporting technical material will be found at
http://www.fs.fed.us/research/sustain/.
Web site: Sustainable Forests Report
http://www.fs.fed.us/research/sustain/data.htm (Indicator 9);
RPA tables http://www.ncrs.fs.fed.us/4801 /FIADB/rpaJabler/
Draft_RPA_2002_Forest_Resource_Tables.pdf;
BBS http://www.mp2-pwrc.usgs.gov/bbs/
Indicator name: Forest disturbance: fire, insects, and disease

Indicator type (status or trend): Trend

Indicator Category: 1

Associated question: What is the ecological condition of forests?

Spatial coverage: National, all 50 states

Temporal coverage: 1979-2000. FIA data date from late 1940s to
present. Data since 1953 provided with a reliability of ± 3-10 per-
cent per 1 million acres (67 percent confidence limit). FIA provides
updates of assessment data every five years.

Characterization of supporting data set(s): The USDA Forest
Service Forest Inventory and Analysis (FIA) program  is a survey-
based program that has operated since the late 1940s, collecting
information on a variety of forest characteristics. FIA has used a two-
phase sample (generally, double sampling for stratification) to collect
information on the nation's  forests. Phase one establishes a large
number of samples (more than 4 million, roughly every 0.6 miles).
These are selected using aerial photographs  or other remote-sensing
images, which are then interpreted for various forest attributes.
Phase two establishes a subset of approximately 450,000 phase-one
points  (roughly every 3 miles) for ground sampling.  About 125,000
of these samples are permanently established on forest land. The
forest characteristics measured include ownership, protection status,
species composition, stand  age and structure, tree growth,
occurrences of mortality and removals, tree biomass, incidences of
pathogens, natural and human-caused disturbances, and soil
descriptors (The Heinz Center, 2002). Data  on  insects and disease
are based on a probability sample that represents unbiased
estimates of both public and private forests in the U.S.

Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
Data on fires are from  1)  U.S. General Accounting Office. Western
National Forests: Nearby Communities Are Increasingly  Threatened by
Catastrophic Wildfires, GAO/T-RCED-99-79.  Washington, DC: U.S.
General Accounting Office,  1999 and 2) National Interagency Fire
Center. Wildland Fire Statistics. 2002. (May  2003;
http://www.nifc.gov/stats/wildlandfirestats.html).; data on insects
and disease are from Conkling, B., J. Coulston, and M. Ambrose
(eds.).  Forest Health Monitoring National Technical Report 1991 -1999,
Asheville, NC: U.S. Department of Agriculture Forest Service,
Southern Research Station,  2002. Presented in  The State of the
Nation's Ecosystems, pages 127 and 242 (The Heinz Center, 2002).
           Web site: FHM http://www.na.fs.fed.us/spfo/fhm/index.htm;
           NIFC http://www.nifc.gov/stats/wildlandfirestats.html
            Indicator name: Tree condition

            Indicator type (status or trend): Status

            Indicator Category: 2

            Associated question: What is the ecological condition of forests?

            Spatial coverage: 32 states; more than half of the South and Rocky
            Mountain regions had insufficient or no data.

            Temporal coverage: 1990-1999

            Characterization of supporting data set(s): Available national
            data relates almost exclusively to trees, not the entire suite of forest
            biota. Three metrics are used to determine tree condition: tree mor-
            tality, tree crown condition, and fire condition class. National scale
            data is lacking on many components of forest ecosystems. Available
            data coverages are incomplete. Fundamental research linking biologi-
            cal components to ecological processes is lacking (USFS, FS, 2002).

            Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
            1) Conkling, B., J. Coulston and M. Ambrose (eds). Forest Health
            Monitoring National Technical Report,  1991-1999. Asheville, NC:
            USDA Forest Service, Forest Health Monitoring (FHM) Program,
            Southern Research Station. 2002; 2) U.S. Department of
            Agriculture. National Report on Sustainable Forests - 2003, Final Draft,
            Washington, DC: U.S. Department of Agriculture, Forest Service,
            2002. This indicator was based on the final review draft of the
            Sustainable Forests report (USDA, FS, 2002) and the website for
            corresponding technical support material is provided below. The final
            version of the report and supporting technical material will be found
            at http://www.fs.fed.us/research/sustain/.

            Web site: FHM http://www.na.fs.fed.us/spfo/fhm/index.htm;
            Sustainable Forest Report
            http://www.fs.fed.us/ research/sustain/data.htm  (Indicator 17)
           Indicator name: Ozone injury to trees

           Indicator type (status or trend): Status

           Indicator Category: 2

           Associated question: What is the ecological condition of forests?

           Spatial coverage: 32 states

           Temporal coverage: 1994-2000

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): The USDA Forest
           Service Forest Health Monitoring (FHM) Program collects informa-
           tion about ozone air quality on a network of biomonitoring plots
           using ozone sensitive bioindicator plants (trees, woody shrubs, and
           non-woody herb species). In 2000, there were 918 biomonitoring
           sites in 32 states.
/Appendix D
Indicator Metadata
B-39

-------

Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report): 1)
Conkling, B., J. Coulston, and M. Ambrose (eds.). Forest Health
Monitoring National Technical Report 1991-1999, Asheville, NC: U.S.
Department of Agriculture Forest Service, Southern Research
Station, 2002; 2) U.S. Department of Agriculture. National Report on
Sustainable Forests - 2003, Final Draft, Washington, DC: U.S.
Department of Agriculture, Forest Service, 2002. This indicator was
based on the final review draft of the Sustainable Forests report
(USDA, FS, 2002)  and the website for corresponding technical sup-
port material is provided below. The final version of the report and
supporting technical material will be found at
http:XAvww.fs.fed.us/research/sustain/.
Web site; Sustainable Forest Report
http://www.fs.fed.us/research/sustain/data.htm (Indicator 16);
FHM http://www.na.fs.fed.us/spfo/fhm/index.htm
Indicator name: Carbon storage
Indicator type (status or trend): Trend
Indicator Category: 2
Associated question: What is the ecological condition of forests?
Spatial coverage: National. Data for Alaska and Hawaii are not
included in this data series.
Temporal coverage: 1953-1996. Volume, area, and other forest
characteristics are compiled in Smith, et al., 2001 for the years
1953,1963,1977,1987, and 1997. The inventory years begin on the
first calendar day of each year. More detailed data are available in
databases for 1997 (USDA, FS, 2002).
Characterization of supporting data set(s): All carbon pools, with
the exception of soil carbon, are estimated  using USDA Forest
Service Forest Inventory and Analysis (FIA)  measured data or imput-
ed data, along with inventory-to-carbon relationships, developed
with information from ecological studies (USDA, 2003). Carbon
storage is estimated by the  FIA program using on-the ground meas-
urements  of tree trunk size from many  forest sites and statistical
models that show the relationship between trunk size and the weight
of branches, leaves, coarse roots (>0.1  inch in diameter), and forest
floor litter. Such data are combined with estimates of forest land area
obtained from aerial photographs and satellite imagery. Forest floor
litter includes all dead organic matter above the mineral soil horizons,
including litter, humus, small twigs, and coarse woody debris (branch-
es and logs greater than 1.0 inches in diameter lying on the forest
floor). Note that there are 1.1 English  tons per metric ton. In most
international discussions, carbon storage is reported in metric tons.
Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
1) Smith, W.B., J.S. Vissage,  D.R. Darr, and R.M. Sheffield. Forest
Statistics o/Oie United States, 1997, General Technical  Report NC-
219. St. Paul, MN: U.S. Department of Agriculture Forest Service,
North Central Research Station, 2001. 2) U.S. Department of
Agriculture. National Report on Sustainable Forests - 2003, Final Draft,
           Washington, DC: U.S. Department of Agriculture, Forest Service,
           2002. This indicator was based on the final review draft of the
           Sustainable Forests report (USDA, FS, 2002) and the website for
           corresponding technical support material is provided below. The final
           version of the report and supporting technical material will be found
           at http://www.fs.fed.us/research/sustain/.>

           Web site: FIA http://fia.fs.fed.us;        '
           Sustainable Forests Report               '
           http://www.f5.fed.us/research/sustain/data.htm (primarily Indicator
           27 with reference to Indicators 26 and 28)
           Indicator name: Soil compaction

           Indicator type (status or trend): Status

           Indicator Category: 2                !

           Associated question: What is the ecological condition of forests?

           Spatial coverage: 37 states (mostly east of the Mississippi, Rocky
           Mountains and Pacific Coast); STATSGO data are available for the
           conterminous U.S., Alaska, Hawaii, and Puerto Rico.

           Temporal coverage: 1998-2000

           Characterization  of supporting data set(s):
           1) Forest Health Monitoring (FHM) Program data collected on a rep-
           resentative sample of 2006 plots, a subset of the Forest Inventory
           Analysis (FIA) plot network (USDA, FS, J2003). The FIA soil  indicator
           program is in the implementation phase and plots have not yet been
           established in all states. Analysis from the program is limited in
           scope. Da':a used for this indicator are based on visual inspection
           and state soil maps.  No measurements !were made regarding the
           intensity of compaction and physical disturbances that are not readi-
           ly visible from the  surface may be underreported. Compaction data
           from FIA/FHM are intended only to provide a "presence/absence"
           index of the occurrence of disturbed sbils across the landscape
           (USDA, FS, 2003). 2) State Soil Geographic Database (STATSGO)
           consists of state general soil maps made by generalizing the detailed
           soil survey data. The level of mapping is designed to  be used for
           broad planning and management uses covering state, regional, and
           multi-state areas. STATSGO data are designed for use in a
           Geographic Information System (CIS). The mapping scale for STATS-
           GO map is  1:250,000 (with the exception of Alaska, which is
           1:1,000,000). Each STATSGO map is linked to the Soil
           Interpretations Record (SIR) attribute data base. The attribute data
           base gives the proportionate extent of the component soils and
           their properties for each map unit. The STATSGO map units consist '
           of 1 to 21 components each. The Soil Interpretations Record data
           base includes over 25 physical and chemical soil properties, interpreH
           tations, and productivity. Examples of information that can be
           queried from the data base are available water capacity, soil reaction,
           salinity, flooding, water table, bedrock, and interpretations for engi-  ,
           neering uses,  cropland, woodland,; ra'ngeland, pastureland, wildlife,
           and recreation development.      \                              •
B-40
Indicator Metadata
Appendix D :

-------


Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
1) U.S. Department of Agriculture. National Report on Sustainable
Forests - 2003, Washington, DC: U.S. Department of Agriculture,
Forest Service, Forthcoming, 2003. This indicator was based on
finalized portions of the forthcoming report referenced above that
were provided to EPA for this report. The report, including technical
support material for this indicator can be found at the website listed
below. 2) STATSGO.

Web site: Sustainable Forests Report
http://www.fs.fed.us/research/sustain/; •
STATSCO http://www.ftw.nrcs.usda.gov/stat_data.html
Indicator name: Soil erosion

Indicator type (status or trend): Status

Indicator Category: 2

Associated question: What is the ecological condition of forests?-

Spatial coverage: 37 states (mostly east of the Mississippi, Rocky
Mountains and Pacific Coast); STATSCO data are available for the
conterminous U.S., Alaska, Hawaii, and Puerto Rico.

Temporal coverage: 1998-2000

Characterization of supporting data set(s): 1) Forest Health
Monitoring (FHM) Program measured erosion rates on plots and
modeled the data using the Water Erosion Prediction Project
(WEPP). Erosion estimates are limited by model assumptions and
aggregate estimates of soil erosion often have little meaning in and
of themselves due to natural variability in soil erosion (USDA, FS,
2003). 2) State Soil Geographic Database (STATSGO) consists of
state general soil maps made by generalizing the detailed soil survey
data. The level of mapping is designed to be used for broad planning
and management uses covering state, regional, and multi-state areas.
STATSGO data are designed for use in a Geographic Information
System (CIS). The mapping scale for STATSGO map is 1:250,000
(with the exception of Alaska, which is 1:1,000,000). Each STATS-
GO map is linked to the Soil Interpretations Record (SIR) attribute
data base. The attribute data base gives the proportionate extent of
the component soils and their properties for each map unit. The
STATSGO map units consist of 1 to 21  components each. The Soil
Interpretations Record data base includes over 25 physical and
chemical soil properties, interpretations, and productivity. Examples
of information that can be queried from the data base are available
water capacity, soil reaction, saliniiy, flooding, water table, bedrock,
and interpretations for engineering uses, cropland, woodland,
rangeland, pastureland, wildlife,  and recreation development.

Indicator derivation (project,  program, organization, report):
U.S. Department of Agriculture. National Report on Sustainable
Forests  - 2003, Washington, DC: U.S. Department of Agriculture,
Forest Service, Forthcoming, 2003. This indicator was based on final-
ized portions of the  forthcoming report referenced above that were
provided to EPA for this report. The report, including technical
           support material for this indicator can be found at the website listed
           below. 2) STATSGO.
           Web site: Sustainable Forests Report—
           http://www.fs.fed.us/research/sustain/; STATSGO—
           http://www.ftw.nrcs.usda.gov/stat_data.html
           Indicator name: Processes beyond the range of historic variation

           Indicator type (status or trend): Trend

           Indicator category (1  or 2): 2

           Associated question: What is the ecological condition of forests?

           Spatial coverage: National

           Temporal coverage: Effects during 1800-1850 (historic or baseline
           time period) were compared with the 1996-2000 (current time
           period) and beyond the range of recent variation (using data from
           the past 20-80 years) the effects of the recent past, e.g. 1979-
           1995, were compared with those during the current time period
           (USDA, FS, 2002).

           Characterization of supporting data  set(s): Primarily anecdotal
           data.

           Indicator source (project, program, organization, report): U.S.
           Department of Agriculture. National Report on Sustainable Forests -
           2003,  Final Draft, Washington, DC: U.S. Department of Agriculture,
           Forest Service, 2002. This indicator was based on the final  review
           draft of the Sustainable Forests, report  (USDA,  FS, 2002) and the
           website for corresponding technical support material is provided
           below. The final version of the report and supporting technical
           material will be found at http://www.fs.fed.us/research/sustain/.

           Web site: Sustainable Forests Report—
           http://www.fs.fed.us/research/sustain/data.htm (Indicator 15)

           Farmlands

           Indicator name: Pesticide leaching potential

           Indicator type (status or trend): Status

           Indicator category (1 or 2): 2

           Associated question: What is the ecological condition  of farm-
           lands?

           Spatial coverage: Agricultural lands covering 5.5 million hectares in
           six mid-Atlantic states

           Temporal coverage: 1994 and 1995

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): EPA's Environmental
           Monitoring and Assessment Program (EMAP) used the National
           Agricultural Statistics Service (NASS) probability area sampling frame
           in the Mid-Atlantic region to select 122 sites in 1994 and 152 sites
           in 1995. The sites were sampled during the NASS Fall Survey. Soil
Appendix D
Indicator Metadata
B-4T

-------

samples and questionnaire data were collected from a random sam-
ple of 293 sites. Indicators addressed productivity, management at
the agroecosystem scale, and management for the landscape scale
on annual crop land. Crop yields were almost 30% higher than those
of the 1980s, with a mean observed to expected yield index of 1.27.
The mean soil qualify index showed moderate quality for supporting
plant growth. Non-tilted sites, which were mostly hay,  had greater
microbial biomass than tilled sites, just over half of the annual crop
land was covered by rotation plans; hay fields accounted for most of
the land where one crop was grown- continuously. Hay showed a
lower use of applied nitrogen than seed crops. Integrated pest man-
agement was practiced on less than 20% of annual crop land.
Twenty-seven different annual crops were grown in the region, with
hay (all types) the dominant crop. Less than 20% of the land where
pesticides were applied had high to moderately high potential for
pesticides leaching into groundwater. This information provides a
baseline for long-term monitoring of agricultural lands in the region
(Hellkamp. et al. 2000).
Indicator source (project, program, organization, report):
Hellkamp, A.S., J.M. Bay, CL Campbell, K.N. Easterling, D.A. Fiscus,
G.R. Hess, B.F. McQuaid, M.J. Munster, G.L Olson, S.L. Peck, S.R.
Shafer, K. Sidik,  and M.B. Tooley. Assessment of the condition of
agricultural lands in six mid-Atlantic states. Journal of Environmental
Quality 29: 79-804 (2000).

Web site: Paper abstract—
httpv'/oaspub.epa.gov/emap/bib.print_abstract?pub_id_in=1284
Indicator name: Soil quality index

Indicator type (status or trend): Status

Indicator category (1  or 2): 2

Associated question: What is the ecological condition of farm-
lands?
Spatial coverage: Mid-Atlantic states

Temporal coverage: 1994-1995

Characterization of supporting data set(s): EPA's Environmental
Monitoring and Assessment Program (EMAP) used the National
Agricultural Statistics Service (NASS) probability area sampling frame
in the Mid-Atlantic region to select 122 sites in 1994 and 152 sites
in 1995. The sites were sampled during the NASS Fall Survey. Soil
samples and questionnaire data were collected from a random
sample of 293 sites. Indicators addressed productivity, management
at the agroecosystem scale, and management for the landscape scale
on annual crop land. Crop yields were almost 30% higher than those
of the 1980s, with a mean observed to expected yield index of 1.27.
The mean soil quality index showed moderate quality for supporting
plant growth. Non-tilled sites, which were mostly hay, had greater
microbial biomass than tilled sites. Just over half of the annual crop
land was covered by rotation plans; hay fields accounted for most of
the land where one crop was grown continuously. Hay showed a
          lower use of applied nitrogen than seed crops. Integrated pest
          management viras practiced on less than 20% of annual crop land.
          Twenty-seven different annual crops were grown in the region, with
          hay (all types) the dominant crop. Less than 20% of the land where
          pesticides were applied had high to moderately high potential for
          pesticides leaching into groundwater. This information provides a
          baseline for long-term monitoring of agricultural lands in the region
          (Hellkamp, etal. 2000).                '.

          Indicator source (project, program, organization,  report): Data
          are available from the EPA Mid- Atlantic Integrated Assessment
          (MAIA) initiative and the index is described in Hellkamp, A.S., J.M.
          Bay, CL Campbell, K.N. Easterling, D.A. Fiscus, C.R. Hess, B.F.
          McQuaid, M.J. Munster, G.L. Olson, S.L. Peck, S.R. Shafer, K. Sidik,
          and M.B. Tooley. Assessment of the condition of agricultural lands in
          six mid-Atlantic states. Journal of Environmental Quality 29: 79-804
          (2000).                              ;

          Web site: Paper abstract              ,
          http://oaspub.epa.gov/emap/bib.print_abstract?pub_id_in=1284
           Indicator name: Soil erosion

           Indicator type (status or trend): Status

           Indicator category: 2

           Associated question: What is the ecological condition of farmlands?

           Spatial coverage: National

           Temporal coverage: At each Natural Resources Inventory (NRI)
           sample point, information is available for 1982, 1987, 1992, and
           1997 so that trends and changes in land use and resource character-
           istics over 15 years can be examined and analyzed.

           Characterization of supporting data set(s):  1) The NRI is a statis-
           tical sampling of over 800,000 locations to collect data on land
           cover and use, soil erosion, prime farmland soils, wetlands, habitat
           diversity, conservation practices, and related resource attributes on
           non-federal land in the U.S. 2) Soil erosion estimates were calculated
           using the USGS watersheds,  NRI  soils data, and the Universal Soil
           Loss Equation (Renard et al., 1997) and the Wind Erosion Equation
           (Bondy et al., 1980; Skidmore and Woodruff, 1968). 3) Soil parame-
           ters were obtained from the USDA Natural Resources Conservation
           Service (NRCS) soils database. The State Soil Geographic Database
           (STATSGO) consists of state general soil maps made by generalizing
           the detailed soil survey data. The level of mapping is designed to be
           used for broad planning and management uses covering state,
           regional, and multi-state areas. STATSGO data are designed for use
           in a Geographic Information  System (CIS). The mapping scale for
           STATSGO map is 1:250,000 (with the exception of Alaska,  which is
           1:1,000,000). Each STATSGO map is linked to the Soil
           Interpretations Record (SIR) attribute data base. The attribute data
           base giveis the proportionate extent of the component soils and
           their properties for each map unit. The STATSGO map units consist
           of 1 to .21 components each. The Soil Interpretations Record data
 B-42
Indicator Metadata
Appendix D

-------

base includes over 25 physical and chemical soil properties, interpre-
tations, and productivity. Examples of information that can be
queried from the data base are available water capacity, soil reaction,
salinity, flooding, water table, bedrock, and interpretations for engi-
neering uses, cropland, woodland, rangeland, pastureland, wildlife,
and recreation development.

Indicator derivation (project, program, organization,, report):
Data are from 1) USDA, NRCS STATSGO soils data and 2)
USDA, NRCS NRI 1997 data (adjusted in 2000). Presented in The
State of the Nation's Ecosystems, pages 100 and 235 (The Heinz
Center, 2002).

Web site: NRI http://www.nrcs.usda.gov/technical/NRl/;
STATSCO http://www.ftw.nrcs.usda.gov/stat_data.html

Grasslands and Shrublands

Indicator name: At-risk native grasslands and shrublands species

Indicator type (status or trend): Status

Indicator category: 2

Associated question: What is the ecological condition of grasslands
and shrublands?

Spatial coverage: National

Spatial coverage: Natural Heritage programs in all 50 states.

Temporal coverage: 2000. Data managed consistently since 1974.

Characterization of supporting data set(s): NatureServe is an
independent nonprofit organization whose research biologists
gather, review, integrate, and record available information about
species taxonomy, status, and use of different habitats or ecological
system types. They are assisted in this work by scientists in the
network of Natural Heritage programs as well as by contracted
experts for different invertebrate taxa. NatureServe staff and
collaborators assign a conservation status by using standard
Heritage ranking  criteria. The Heritage ranking process considers five
major status ranks: critically imperiled (G1),  imperiled (G2),
vulnerable (G3),  apparently secure (G4), and demonstrably
widespread, abundant, and secure (G5). In addition, separate ranks '
are assigned for species regarded as presumed extinct (GX) or
possibly extinct  (GH).

Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
NatureServe and its member programs in the network of Natural
Heritage programs develop and maintain information  on species at
risk. Presented in The State of the Nation's Ecosystems, pages 168 and
214 (The Heinz Center, 2002).

Web site: http://www.natureserve.org
Indicator name: Population trends in invasive and native non-inva-
sive bird species
           Indicator type (status or trend): Trend

           Indicator category: 1

           Associated question: What is the ecological condition of grasslands
           and shrublands?

           Spatial coverage: National

           Temporal coverage: Data were analyzed in seven 5-year intervals
           from 1966 to 2000.

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): The North American
           Breeding Bird Survey (BBS) is a long- term, large-scale international
           avian monitoring program intended to track the status and trends of
           North American bird populations. Today there are approximately
           3700 active BBS routes across the continental U.S. and Canada of
           which 2900 are surveyed each year (Sauer, et al., 2001).

           Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
           U.S. Geological Survey's Biological Resources Division, Breeding Bird
           Survey. Presented in The State of the Nation's Ecosystems, pages 170
           and 262 (The Heinz Center, 2002).

           Web site: BBS
           http://www.tnbr-pwrc.usgs.gov/bbs/introbbs.html and
           http://www.mp2- pwrc.usgs.gov/bbs/;
           Sauer, et al. http://www.mbr-pwrc.usgs.gov/bbs/trend/tfmb.html

           Urban  and Suburban Lands

           Indicator name: Patches of forest, grassland, shrubland, and wetland
           in urban/suburban areas

           Indicator type (status or trend): Status

           Indicator category: 2

           Associated question: What is the ecological condition of urban and
           suburban areas?

           Spatial coverage: Lower 48 states

           Temporal coverage: 1992 satellite imagery

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): NLCD provides a
           consistent, uniform, spatially explicit description of general land
           cover/land use across the continental U.S. at a 30-meter resolution.
           It does not contain habitat types. Eight of the 21 NLCD classifica-
           tions were defined as "natural" for this analysis, including three class-
           es of forest, three types considered grasslands/shrublands, and two
           wetlands types (The Heinz Center, 2002).

           Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
           Multi-Resolution Land Characterization Consortium (MRLC) -
           National Land Characterization Data (NLCD). Data analyses were
           undertaken by the U.S. Geological Survey's Earth Resources
           Observations Systems (EROS) Data Center. Presented in The State
           of the Nation's Ecosystems, pages 183 and 266 (The Heinz
           Center, 2002).
/Appendix u
Indicator Metadata
B-43

-------

                                                                                      iiik'SsiT .• r>ii
                                                                                      icilulc
Web sites: MRLC http://www.epa.gov/mrlc/;
EROS Data Center "raw" data (requiring "considerable computing
power" (The Heinz Center, 2002) http://edcwww.cr.usgs.gov/prb-
gram/lccp/mrlcreg.html

Fresh Waters
Indicator name: Extent of ponds, lakes, and reservoirs
Indicator type (status or trend): Trend
Indicator category (1  or 2): 1
Associated question: What is the ecological condition of fresh waters?
Spatial coverage: Lower 48 states. Lake area does not include
the Great Lakes, which cover about 60.2 million acres within the
United States.
Temporal coverage: 1950s-1990s
Characterization of supporting data set(s): The U.S. Fish and
Wildlife Service's National Wetlands Inventory (NWI) counts all lakes,
reservoirs, and ponds regardless of land ownership. A permanent
study design is used, based initially on stratification of the 48 con-
terminous states by state boundaries and 35  physiographic subdivi-
sions. Within these subdivisions are 4375 randomly selected sample
plots that are examined with the use of aerial imagery of varying
scale and type. Ponds include the category of open- water ponds
and non-vegetated palustrine wetlands (mud flats and shorelines of
ponds) generally less than six feet deep and less than 20 acres in
size. Lakes and reservoirs are generally larger than 20 acres and
deeper than six feet (The Heinz Center, 2002).
Indicator source (project, program, organization, report): Data
for lakes, reservoirs, and ponds come from 1) Dahl, T.E. Status and
Trends  of Wetlands in ifie Conterminous United States 1986 to 1997,
Washington, DC: U.S. Department of the Interior, U.S. Fish and
Wildlife Service, 2000; 2) Dahl, T.E., and C.E. Johnson. Status and
Trends  of Wetlands in the Conterminous United States, Mid-1970's to
Mid-1980's, Washington, DC: U.S. Department of the Interior, U.S.
Rsh and Wildlife Service,  1991; 3) Prayer, WE., T.J. Monaha'n, D.C.
Bowden,  and FA Graybill. Status and Trends of Wetlands and
Deepwater Habitats in tl\e Conterminous United States, 19SO's to
1970's, Fort Collins, CO: Colorado State University, Department of
Forest and Wood Sciences, 1983; and 4) unpublished data from the
U.S. Rsh  and Wildlife Service (The Heinz Center, 2002). Presented in
The State of the Nation's Ecosystems, pages  139 and 246 (The Heinz
Center, 2002).
Web site: Dahl, 2000
http://wetlands.fws.gov/bha/SandT/SandTReport.html
Indicator name: At-risk native fresh water species
Indicator type (status or trend): Status
Indicator category: 2
           Associated question: What is the ecological condition of fresh
           waters?                                |
                                                 i
           Spatial coverage: Natural Heritage programs in all 50 states.

           Temporal coverage: 2000. Data managed consistently since 1974.

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): NatureServe is an
           independent nonprofit organization whose' research biologists
           gather, review, integrate, and record available information about
           species taxonomy, status, and use of different habitats or ecological
           system types. They are assisted in this work by scientists in the
           network of Natural Heritage programs as well as by contracted
           experts for different invertebrate taxa. NatureServe staff and
           collaborators assign a conservation status by using standard
           Heritage ranking criteria. The Heritage ranking process considers five
           major status ranks: critically imperiled (G1), imperiled (G2),
           vulnerable (G3), apparently secure (G4), and demonstrably
           widespread, abundant, and secure (G5). In addition, separate ranks
           are assigned for species regarded as presurned  extinct (GX) or
           possibly extinct (GH).                  |

           Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
           NatureServe aind its member programs in the network of Natural
           Heritage programs develop and maintain information on species at
           rislc Presented in The State of the Nation's Ecosystems, pages 144 and
           214 (The Heinz Center, 2002).

           Web site: http://www.natureserve.org/explorer
           Indicator name: Non-native fresh water species

           Indicator type (status or trend): Status

           Indicator category: 2

           Associated question: What is the condition of fresh waters?

           Spatial coverage: Lower 48 states

           Temporal coverage: 2000. An expansive spatial database underlies
           the Nonindigenous Aquatic Species (NAS) program, which was
           created in 1978 and continues to be updated and revised.

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): Roughly 90 percent
           of the data in the U.S. Geological Survey's NAS database are derived
           from the published literature. Data are collected for the most part by
           federal and state biologists, although the public does contribute by
           reporting sightings (The Heinz Center, 2002). NAS is a repository
           for accurate and spatially referenced biogeographic accounts of
           nonindigenous aquatic species. Provided are scientific reports,
           online/realtime queries, spatial data sets, regional contact lists, and
           general information. The data is made available for use by biologists,
           interagency groups, and the general public.

           Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
           U.S. Geological Survey, Biological Resources Division (BRD), NAS
           Database. Presented in The State of the Nation's Ecosystems, pages
           145 and 251 (The Heinz Center, 2002).
B-44
Indicator Metadata
Appendix D

-------
 Web site: http://nas.er.usgs.gov/
  Indicator name: Animal deaths and deformities

  Indicator type (status or trend): Status

  Indicator category: 2

  Associated question: What is the ecological condition of fresh
  waters?

  Spatial coverage: National. Database covers all 50 states, Puerto
  Rico, and the U.S. Virgin Islands

  Temporal coverage:  1985-1999

  Characterization of supporting data set(s): The National Wildlife
  Health Center (NWHC) maintains a database that contains wildlife
  disease and mortality  events information on avian, mammalian, and
  amphibian mortality events. Information in the database is provided
  by various sources, such as state and federal personnel, diagnostic
  laboratories, wildlife refuges, and published reports (The Heinz
  Center, 2002).

  Indicator derivation  (project, program, organization, report):
  U.S. Geological Survey, Biological Resource Division (BRD), NWHC.
  Presented :in The State of the Nation's Ecosystems, pages 146 and 252
  (The Heinz Center, 2002).

  Web site:  http://www/mwhc.usgs.gov/pub_metadata/ qrt_mortali-
  ty_report.html
  Indicator name: At-risk fresh water plant communities

  Indicator type (status or trend): Status

  Indicator category: 2

  Associated question: What is the ecological condition of fresh
  waters?
  Spatial coverage: Natural Heritage programs in all 50 states, but
  this coverage excludes Alaska

- Temporal coverage: 2000. Data managed consistently since 1974.

  Characterization of supporting data set(s): NatureServe is an
  independent nonprofit organization whose research biologists
  gather, review, integrate, and record available information about
  species taxonomy, status, and use of different habitats or ecological
  system types. They are assisted in this work by scientists in the net-
  work of Natural  Heritage programs as well as by contracted experts
  for different invertebrate taxa. NatureServe staff and collaborators
  assign a conservation status by using standard  Heritage ranking
  criteria. The Heritage ranking process considers five major status
  ranks: critically imperiled (G1), imperiled (G2), vulnerable (G3),
  apparently secure (G4), and demonstrably widespread, abundant,
  and secure (G5). In addition, separate ranks are assigned for species
  regarded as presumed extinct (GX) or possibly extinct (GH).
          Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
          NatureServe and its member programs in the network of Natural
          Heritage programs develop and maintain information on species at
          risk. Presented in The State of the Nation's Ecosystems,  148 and 253
          (The Heinz Center, 2002).

          Web site: http://www.natureserve.org
          Indicator name: Fish Index of Biotic Integrity (IBI) in streams

          Indicator type (status or trend): Status

          Indicator category: 2

          Associated question: What is the ecological condition of fresh
          waters?

          Spatial coverage: Statistically selected stream sites in the Mid-
          Atlantic Highlands (parts of Virginia, Maryland, Pennsylvania, and
          New York and all of West Virginia)

          Temporal coverage: 1993-1994 sampling years

          Characterization of supporting data set(s): About 450 stream
          reaches were sampled in the Mid-Atlantic Highlands. To describe the
          condition of all streams within the Highlands without sampling all of
          them EMAP worked with EPA Region 3 and the states to develop a
          regional statistical survey of streams. Examples offish metrics
          measured were: the number offish species present in the stream who
          cannot tolerate pollution; the proportion of individuals present that
          require clean gravel for spawning; and the number of bottom versus
          water column species present. Each metric was scored against the
          researchers expectations of what value was possible for each stream
          based on reference conditions.
          Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
           1 )Mid-Atlantic Integrated Assessment (MAIA), Environmental
          Monitoring and Assessment Program (EMAP), U.S. Environmental
          Protection Agency, Mid-Atlantic Highlands Streams Assessment,
          EPA/903/R-00/015, August 2000.  2) McCormick, F.H., R.M.
          Hughes, P.R. Kaufmann, D.V. Peck, J.L Stoddard, and A.T. Herlihy.
          Development of an index of biotic integrity for the Mid-Atlantic
          Highlands Region. Transactions of the American Fisheries Society 130:
           857-877 (2001).
          Web site: MAIA Report http://www.epa.gov/maia/html/maha.html
           Indicator name: Macroinvertebrate Biotic Integrity Index (MBII) for
           streams
           Indicator type (status or trend): Status

           Indicator category: 2
           Associated question: What is the condition of fresh waters?
  Appendix 6
Indicator Metadata
B-45

-------
 • T i JD" ..... "f" i : "*:f '•$• •'•]' ; -'I" '•' i  iP ' ' |:"':' ' !•'••"' ';t •'• ; ""/'• Pl-'rf^' .....
rcirt meport 6fi  the  tZnvirbnifient 2Q03
      II                                            ;
                                                                              ecntlKa
                                                                                      '
                                                                            JESS:
Spatial coverage: Statistically selected stream sites in the Mid-
Atlantic Highlands (parts of Virginia, Maryland, Pennsylvania, and
New York and all of West Virginia)

Temporal coverage: 1993-1994 sampling years

Characterization of supporting data set(s): About 450 stream
reaches were sampled in the Mid-Atlantic Highlands. To describe the
condition of all streams within the Highlands without sampling all of
them EMAP worked with EPA Region 3 and the states to develop a
regional statistical survey of streams. One aquatic insect index, EPT,
has been used extensively to evaluate stream condition throughout
the United  States and was used in the Highlands. It is calculated
from the number of species that are found in three orders of aquatic
insects-mayflies (Ephemeoptera), stoneflies (Plecoptera), and caddis-
flies (JHchoptera) and gets its name from the first initials of these
three orders (EPT). Many of the species in these three orders are
sensitive to pollution and other stream disturbances, and the total
number of species is a good gauge of how disturbed any given
stream may be. EPT scores from least-disturbed Highland streams
were used to set expectations. Expectations were set separately for
streams with fast-moving sections or "riffles" (the vast majority of
Highland streams) and slow-moving streams where "pools" dominate,
because fewer EPT species naturally occur in pools.

Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
1) Klemm, D.J., KA Blocksom, FA Fulk, AT. Herlihy, R.M. Hughes,
P.R. Kaufmann, D.V. Peck, J.L Stoddard, W.T. Thoeny, M.B. Griffith,
and W.S. Davis. Development and Evaluation of a Macroinvertebrate
Biotic Integrity Index (MBit) for Regionally Assessing Mid-Atlantic
Highlands Streams. Environmental Management 31 (5): 656-669
(2003). 2) Mid-Atlantic Integrated Assessment (MAIA),
Environmental Monitoring and Assessment Program (EMAP), U.S.
Environmental Protection Agency, Mid-Atlantic Highlands  Streams
Assessment,  EPA/903/R-00/015, August 2000.

Web site: MAIA Report http://www.epa.gov/maia/html/maha.html

Coasts  and Oceans

Indicator name: Extent of estuaries and coastline

Indicator type (status or trend): Status

Indicator category (1 or 2): 1

Associated question: What is the ecological condition of coasts
and oceans?

Spatial coverage: National, all 50 states and territories

Temporal coverage: 1996-1998

Characterization of supporting data set(s): Data were submitted
by the states and territories to EPA's Office of Water which  compiled
a national report. Data were collected using different methodologies,
definitions,  and assumptions, so the  data is unlikely to be consistent.

Indicator source (project, program, organization, report): U.S.
Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Water, 2000  National
                                                    Water Quality Inventory, EPA 841 -R-02-001, August 2002, Table C-1
                                                    Total Estuarine and Ocean Shoreline Waters in the Nation.

                                                    Web site: http://www.epa.gov/305b/2000report/appendixc.pdf
                                                     Indicator name: Coastal living habitats

                                                     Indicator type (status or trend): Trend

                                                     Indicator category: 2

                                                     Associated question: What is the ecological condition of coasts
                                                     and oceans?

                                                     Spatial coverage: National

                                                     Temporal coverage: 1950s to 1990s

                                                     Characterization of supporting data set(s): While data gaps are
                                                     reported for the coral reef, seagrasses, and shellfish beds compo-
                                                     nents of the indicator (The Heinz  Center, 2002), the wetlands
                                                     component ii> supported by U.S. Fish and Wildlife Service's (USFWS)
                                                     recent report. The Status and Trend of Wetlands in the Conterminous
                                                     United States 1986-1997. The report utilizes National Wetlands
                                                     Inventory (NWI) and other wetland data. NWI counts all wetlands,
                                                     regardless of land ownership, but recognizes only wetlands that are
                                                     at least three acres. To ensure adequate coverage of coastal  •
                                                     wetlands, supplemental sampling along the Atlantic and Gulf coast
                                                     fringes was added (The Heinz Center, 2002).

                                                     Indicator source (project, program, organization, report): Dahl,
                                                     T.E. Status and Trends of Wetlands in the Conterminous United States
                                                     1986 to 1997, Washington, DC: U.S. Department of the Interior, U.S.
                                                     Fish and Wildlife Service, 2000. Presented in The State of the Nation's
                                                     Ecosystems, pages 69 and 218 (The Heinz ;Center, 2002).

                                                     Web site: htl:p://wetlands.fws.gov/bha/SandT/SandTReport.html
                                                    Indicator naime: Shoreline types

                                                    Indicator type (status or trend): Status

                                                    Indicator category: 2

                                                    Associated question: What is the ecological condition of coasts
                                                    and oceans?

                                                    Spatial coverage: National in scope; Pacific Northwest, Southern
                                                    California, and South Atlantic regions only

                                                    Temporal coverage: 1984-2001

                                                    Characterization of supporting data set(s): Data were extracted
                                                    from Environmental Sensitivity Index (ESI) atlases, a product of the
                                                    National Oceanic and Atmospheric Administration's (NOAA), Office
                                                    of Response and Restoration (ORR). The ESI method provides a
                                                    standardized mapping approach for coastal geomorphology as well
                                                    as biological and human use elements. Data from multiple atlases
B-46
                                         Indicator Metadata
Appendix D

-------

were aggregated into the regions used. Some of the data atlases
utilized were more than 15 years old (The Heinz Center, 2002).

Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
NOAA, ORR, Hazardous Materials Response Division, ESI atlases.
Presented in The State  of the Nation's Ecosystems, pages 70 and 219
(The Heinz Center, 2002).

Web site: Some NOAA ESI data are available at
http://response.restoration.noaa.gov/esi/esiintro.html
Indicator name: Benthic Community Index

Indicator type (status or trend): Status

Indicator category: 2

Associated question: What is the ecological condition of coasts
and oceans?

Spatial coverage: National in scope, 24 coastal states

Temporal coverage: Stations on the west coast were sampled in
1999. The entire U.S. coast, including the Gulf of Maine, was sam-
pled in 2000.

Characterization of supporting data set(s): In 2000,  EPA, NOAA,
and USCS, in cooperation with all 24 U.S. coastal states, initiated
the National Coastal Assessment. Using a compatible, probabilistic
design and a common set of survey indicators, each state conducted
the survey and independently assessed the condition of their coastal
resources. While the complete assessment of national coastal waters
is scheduled for publication in 2003, a preliminary assessment of
selected estuaries was published by EPA in 2001. The EPA
Environmental Monitoring and Assessment Program (EMAP)
National Coastal Database contains estuarine and coastal data that
EMAP and Regional-EMAP have collected since 1990 from hundreds
of stations between Cape Cod and the Mexican border. These
include water column data, sediment chemistry and toxicity data,
demersal fish and invertebrate community and contaminant data
and benthic invertebrate community data.

Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
1.) EMAP National Coastal Database; 2) U.S. Environmental
Protection Agency. National Coastal Condition Report, EPA 620-R-01 -
005. Washington DC: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office
of Research and Development and Office of Water, September 2001.

Web site: NCCR
http://epa.gov/owow/oceans/nccr/downloads.html;
National Coastal Database
http://www.epa.gov/emap/nca/html/data/index.html
Indicator name: Fish diversity

Indicator type (status or trend): Status

Indicator category: 2
           Associated question: What is the ecological condition of coasts
           and oceans?

           Spatial coverage: Mid-Atlantic estuaries

           Temporal coverage: 1997-1998

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): The EPA Mid-Atlantic
           Integrated Assessment  (MAIA) Estuaries Summary Database contains
           water quality, sediment, benthic community, and fish data collected
           by several partners in MAIA Region estuaries in 1997 and 1998. The
           MAIA program conducted regular fish surveys during the summer of
           1998 to characterize the structure and health of the fish communi-
           ties. The stations sampled were selected according to a probabilistic
           design. These stations were not identical with the stations sampled
           for water and sediment quality analyses conducted primarily in 1997;
           therefore, it is not "possible to directly compare these different   f
           analyses station by station. However, it is statistically valid to com-
           pare results among classes of estuaries, (e.g., large versus small  estu-
           aries, Delaware Estuary versus Chesapeake Estuary).

           Indicator source (project, program, organization, report): U.S.
           Environmental Protection Agency. Mid- Atlantic Integrated Assessment,
           MAIA - Estuaries 1997-98, Summary Report, EPA 620-R-02-003.
           Narragansett, RI: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of
           Research  and Development, Atlantic Ecology Division, May 2003.

           Web site: MAIA data http://www.epa.gov/emap/maia/html/data/
           estuary/9798/xport.html
           Indicator name: Submerged aquatic vegetation

           Indicator type (status or trend): Status

           Indicator category: 2

           Associated question: What is the ecological condition of coasts
           and oceans?

           Spatial coverage: Mid-Atlantic estuaries, Chesapeake Bay

           Temporal coverage: 1985-1998

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): The Chesapeake
           Bay Program's second submerged aquatic vegetation (SAV) Technical
           Synthesis revises and updates the first synthesis published in 1992,
           by providing new light requirements for SAV through the water
           column and at the leaf surface, providing diagnostic tools for their
           application and interpretation, and  identifying preliminary sets of
           physical, chemical, and other biological habitat requirements. An
           algorithm was applied to analyze SAV habitat suitability for some 50
           sites in Chesapeake Bay and its tidal tributaries using data collected
           over 14 years (1985-1998) of environmental monitoring (EPA, CBP,
           2000). 2) Mid-Atlantic Integrated Assessment (MAIA) field crews
           noted the  presence or absence of SAV at their sampling stations as
           an ancillary measurement. No attempt was made to estimate the
           extent of SAV the MAIA region. The MAIA database contains water
           quality, sediment, benthic community, and fish data collected by
Appendix D
Indicator Metadata
B-47

-------


                                                                            IE;
several partners in MAIA Region estuaries in 1997 and 1998. The
MAIA program conducted regular fish surveys during the summer of
1998 to characterize the structure and health of the fish communi-
ties. The stations sampled were selected according to a probabilistic
design. These stations were not identical with the stations sampled
for water and sediment qualify analyses conducted primarily in
1997; therefore, it is not possible to directly compare these different
analyses station by station. However, it is statistically valid to
compare results among classes of estuaries, (e.g., large versus small
estuaries, Delaware Estuary versus Chesapeake Estuary).

Indicator source (project, program, organization, report):
1) Batiuk, RA, P. Bergstrom, M. Kemp, E. Koch, L Murray, J.C.
Stevenson, R. Bartleson, V. Carter, N.B. Rybicki, J.M.  Landwehr, C.
Callegos, L Karrh, M. Naylor, D. Wilcox, K.A. Moore, S. Ailstock, and
M. Teichberg. Chesapeake Bay Submerged Aquatic Vegetation Water
Qualify and Habitat-Based Requirements and Restoration Targets: A
Second Technical Synthesis, CBP-TRS 245-00, EPA 903-R-00-014.
Annapolis, MD: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Chesapeake
Bay Program, 2000; 2) U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Mid-
Atlantic Integrated Assessment, MAIA - Estuaries  1997-98, Summary
Report, EPA 620-R-02-003. Narragansett, Rl: U.S. Environmental
Protection Agency,  Office of Research and Development, Atlantic
Ecology Division, May 2003.

Web site: CBP report
http://www.chesapeakebay.net/pubs/sav/index.html
Indicator name: Rsh abnormalities

Indicator type (status or trend): Status

Indicator category: 2

Associated question: What is the ecological condition of coasts
and oceans?

Spatial coverage: National assessment, data presented for Gulf of
Mexico to Cape Cod, Great Lakes excluded

Temporal coverage: Data collected in 2000, available in 2002 for
Pacific Coast

Characterization of supporting data set(s): U.S. Environmental
Protection Agency Environmental Monitoring and Assessment
Program (EMAP) data on fish pathologies by estuarine province.

Indicator source (project, program, organization, report): U.S.
Environmental Protection Agency. National Coastal Condition Report,
EPA 620-R-01 -005. Washington DC: U.S. Environmental Protection
Agency, Office of Research and Development and Office of Water,
September 2001.

Web site: NCCR http://epa.gov/owow/oceans/nccr/downloads.html
Indicator name: Unusual marine mortalities
           Indicator type (status or trend): Status

           Indicator category: 2

           Associated question:. What is the ecological condition of coasts
           and oceans?

           Spatial coverage: National in scope for marine mammals

           Temporal coverage: 1992-2001

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): Data is available for
           whales, dolphins, porpoises, seals, sea lions, sea otters, and mana-
           tees. Data is not available for turtle, seabjrd, fish, and shellfish
           mortality. The 2001  data for two unusual mortality events and the
           total number of gray whales lost in the 19,99-2001 unusual mortality
           event were obtained directly from National Marine Fisheries Service
           (NMFS). All other unusual mortality event data were obtained from
           Dierauf and Gulland, (2001) (The Heinz Center, 2002).

           Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
           1) U.S. Department of Commerce, NOAA, NMFS,  Office of Protected
           Resources, Marine Mammal Health and Stranding Response Program;
           2) Dierauf, LA., and F.M.D. Gulland (eds.) CRC Handbook of Marine
           Mammal Medicine: Health, Disease, and Rehabilitation, 2nd Edition,
           Boca Raton,  FL: CRC Press, Inc., 2001. Presented in The State of the
           Nation's Ecosystems, pages 77 and 223 (The Heinz Center, 2002).

           Web site: NMFS data                  ]
           http://www.nmfs.noaa.gov/prot_res/PR2/Health_and_Stranding_
           Response_Program/WGUMMME.html

           The  Entire Nation

           Indicator name: Ecosystem extent       ;

           Indicator type (status or trend): Status and Trend

           Indicator category (1 or 2): 2

           Associated (question: What is the ecological condition of the
           entire nation?

           Spatial coverage: National in all cases   ;

           Temporal coverage: 1950s-1990s.
                                                i
           Characterization of supporting data set(s): 1) For cropland, the
           data source is the USDA Economic Research Service (ERS) relying
           on data from the National Agricultural Statistics Service and a variety
           of other sources to  provide an estimate of extent.  2) For forests, the
           data source is the USDA Forest Service Forest Inventory and Analysis
           (FIA) program, a survey-based program that has operated since the
           late 1940s, collecting information on a variety of forest characteris-
           tics. 3) For fresh water wetlands, the data source is the U.S. Fish and
           Wildlife Service's National Wetlands Inventory as reported in the
           most recent wetlands status and trends report (Dahl, 2000). 4) For
           grasslands and shrublands, the data source is the National Land
           Cover Datassit (NLCD). In the 1990s, a federal interagency consor-
           tium (the Multi- Resolution Land  Characterization  (MRLC)
           Consortium) was created to coordinate access to and use of land
B-48
Indicator Metadata
Appendix D

-------
cover data from the Landsat 5 Thematic Mapper. Using Landsat data
and a variety of ancillary data, the consortium processed data from a
series of 1992 Landsat images, to create the NLCD on a square grid
covering the lower 48 states. The MRLC NLCD with 21  land cover
classes, was used to estimate the area coverage for the U.S. 5) For
urban/suburban, the data source is the NLCD.

Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
1) ERS; 2) FIA; 3)  Dahl, T.E. Status and Trends of Wetlands in the
Conterminous United States 1986 to 1997, Washington, DC: U.S.
Department of the Interior, U.S. Fish and Wildlife Service, 2000;
4) NLCD; 5)  NLCD. Presented in The State of the Nation's Ecosystems,
pages 41 -43  and 207 (The Heinz Center,  2002).

Web site: ERS
http://www.ers.usda.gov/Emphases/Harmony/issues/arei2000/;
FIA http://fia.fs.fed.us;
Dahl, 2000 http://wetlands.fws.gov/bha/SandT/SandTReport.html;
NLCD http://www.usgs.gov/mrlcreg.html
Indicator name: At-risk native species

Indicator type (status or trend): Status

Indicator Category: 2

Associated question: What is the ecological condition of the entire
nation?

Spatial coverage: Natural Heritage programs in all SO states.

Temporal coverage: 2000. Data managed consistently since 1974.

Characterization of supporting data set(s): NatureServe is an
independent nonprofit organization whose research biologists
gather, review, integrate, and record available information about
species taxonomy, status, and  use of different habitats or ecological
system types. They are assisted in this work by scientists in the
network of Natural Heritage programs as well as by contracted
experts for different invertebrate taxa. NatureServe staff and  collabo-
rators assign a conservation status by using standard Heritage rank-
ing criteria. The Heritage  ranking process considers five major status
ranks: critically imperiled (Cl), imperiled (G2), vulnerable (G3),
apparently secure (C4), and demonstrably widespread, abundant,
and secure (C5). In addition, separate ranks are assigned for species
regarded as presumed extinct  (CX) or possibly extinct (CH).

Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):
NatureServe and its member programs in the network of Natural
Heritage programs develop and maintain information  on species at
risk. Presented in The State of the Nation's Ecosystems, pages 52-53
and 214  (The Heinz Center, 2002).

Web site: http://www.natureserve.org
Indicator name: Bird Community Index
           Indicator type (status or trend): Status

           Indicator Category: 2

           Associated question: What is the ecological condition of the
           entire nation?

           Spatial coverage: Mid-Atlantic Highlands (parts of Virginia,
           Maryland, Pennsylvania, and New York and all of West Virginia)

           Temporal coverage: 1995-1996 data

           Characterization of supporting data set(s): Birds and vegetation
           were surveyed across the entire Mid-Atlantic highlands within sites
           sufficiently large (200 acres) to represent most of the habitat
           elements that are required by breeding birds. Use of EPA's
           Environmental Monitoring and Assessment Program (EMAP) survey
           design guaranteed that data from the 126 sample sites were
           representative of the entire highlands area. Sixteen specific groups of
           bird species, such as omnivores, bark probers, residents, migrants,
           shrub nesters, etc., were ultimately selected as representative of the
           mostly forested Mid-Atlantic Highlands'area. Of the 16  groups, nine
           were "specialists" and seven were "generalists"; for example,
           insectivores are specialists and omnivores are generalists.  Placement
           of specific bird species within each group was based on a  review of
           scientific publications. Species may be assigned to several groups as
           well as to both specialist and generalist groups simultaneously. In
           general, a high proportion of birds with specialized requirements
           indicates healthy natural habitat that provides ecological benefits at
           local and larger scales (EPA, 2000).

           Indicator derivation (project, program, organization, report):1
           1) O'Connell, T.J., L.E. Jackson, and R.P. Brooks. Bird guilds as indica-
           tors of ecological condition in the central Appalachians. Ecological
           Applications 10: 1706-1721  (2000). 2) U.S. Environmental
           Protection Agency. MAIA Project Summary: Birds Indicate Ecological
           Condition of the Mid-Atlantic Highlands. EPA 620-R-000-003.
           Washington, DC: EPA, Office of Research  and Development, June
           2000.

           Web site: MAIA summary http://www.epa.gov/maia/html/bird.htrh;
           Full research report http://www.wetlands.cas.psu.edu
           Indicator name: Terrestrial Plant Growth Index

           Indicator type (status or trend): Status and Trend

           Indicator Category: 1

           Associated question: What is the ecological condition of the entire
           nation?

           Spatial coverage: Lower 48 states

           Temporal coverage: 1989-2000, except for 1994 when the
           satellite failed. The Normalized Difference Vegetation Index (NDVI) is
           calculated at two-week intervals and summed throughout the grow-
           ing season; only values that exceed non-growing-season, background
           NDVI are included. Growing season dates, end dates, and back-
Appendix 8
Indicator Metadata
B-49

-------
                                        !pi	m	ISIlIil	3	IM/iWfl	||jOT.:Mw
-------
 Appendix C:
  •  •   i  .. .  •

Atronyhfis and
 I     I  ..
Abbreviations

-------

                           A

                BRAC: base realignment and closure facilities

                BRD: Biological Resources Division
TNAP:1-napthol

AFO: animal feeding operation

AHA: American Heart Association

AHEF: Atmospheric and Health Effects Framework

AIRS: Aerometric Information Retrieval System

AM: atrazine mercapturate

ANC: acid-neutralizing capacity

APCs: areas of probable concern

AQI: Air Quality Index

AQS: Air Quality System

AREAL: Atmospheric Research and Exposure Assessment Laboratory

ARS: Agricultural Research Center

ATSDR: Agency for Toxic Substances and Disease Registry

AVHRR: advanced veiy high resolution radiometer

AVS: acid volatile sulfide
                                           c
                            6
BASE: Building Assessment Survey and Evaluation

BBS: Breeding Bird Survey

BCI: Bird Community Index

BEACH: Beaches Environmental Assessment and Coastal Health
Program

BEIR VI: Biological Effects of Ionizing Radiation

BLM:  Bureau of Land Management
                C&I: criteria and indicators

                CAA: Clean Air Act                   ;

                CAFOs: confined animal feeding operations

                CAPI: computer-assisted personal interviewing

                CASTNet: Clean Air Status and Trends Network

                CBP: Chespeake Bay Program

                CCA: chromate copper arsenate

                C-CAP: Coastal Change Analysis Program

                CDC: Centeirs for Disease Control and Prevention

                CDDS: California Department of Developmental Services

                CEMS: continuous emissions monitors

                CENR: Council on the Environment and Natural Resources

                CERCLA: Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation,
                and Liability Act

                CERCLIS: Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation,
                and Liability Information System

                CESQCs: conditionally exempt small quantity generators

                CFCs: chloroflourocarbons

                CHD: coronary heart disease

                cm: centimeter

                CMSAs: consolidated metropolitan statistical areas

                CO: carbon monoxide
C-2
Acronyms and Abbreviations
Appendix C

-------
COHb: carboxyhemoglobin





COPD: chronic obstructive pulmonary disease





COS: carbonyl sulfide





CPI: Consumer Price Index





CPSC: Consumer Product Safety Commission





CRA: comparative risk assessment





CRP: Conservation Reserve Program





CSO: combined sewer overflow





CSTE: Council of State and Territorial Epidemiologists





CVD: cardiovascular disease





CWA: Clean Water Act





CWS: community water system
                            D
DBPs: disinfection byproducts





DDE: dichlorodiphenyldichloroethylene





DDT: dichlorodiphenltrichloroethane





DO: dissolved oxygen





DOC: dissolved organic carbon





DOE: U.S. Department of Energy





DOI: U.S. Department of the Interior





DSS: decision support systems





DU: Dobson Units"
EBD: environmental burden of disease





ECAO: Environmental Criteria and Assessment Office





ECI: Employee Cost Index





EDC: endocrine-disrupting compounds





EEA: essential ecological attribute





EECL: equivalent effective chlorine





EEZ: U.S. Exclusive Economic Zone





EMAP: Environmental Monitoring and Assessment Program





ENSO: El Nino-Southern  Oscillation





EPA: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency





STAR: Science to Achieve Results





EPCRA: Emergency Planning and Community Right-to-Know Act





EPHI:  environmental public health indicators





EPO: Epidemiology Program Office





EPT: Ephemeoptera, Plecoptera, and Trichoptera Index





ERL: effects range low





ERM: effects range medium





EROS: Earth's Resources Observation System





ESC: Equilibrium Partitioning Sediment Guidelines





ESI: Environmental Sensitivity Index





ESRD: end stage renal disease





ETS: environmental tobacco smoke
Appendix
                                                 Acronyms and Abbreviations
                                                        C-3

-------

                                                                          lechrim
                            F
FDA: Food and Drug Administration

FHM: Forest Health Monitoring Program

FIA; Forest Inventory and Analysis

FQPA: Food Quality Protection Act

FS: Forest Service

FY: fiscal year
                           G
CAO: General Accounting Office

GBD: global burden of disease

GDP: gross domestic product

GI: gastrointestinal illness

CIS: geographic information systems

GLEAMS: groundwater loading effects of agricultural management

GPRA: Government Performance Results Act
                           H
HABs: harmful algal blooms

HCB: hexachlorobenzene

HCFCs: hydrochlorofiuorocarbons

HFCs: hydrofluorocarbons

HHS: Department of Health and Human Services

HHW: household hazardous waste
                HUG: hydrol ogic unit code

                HUMUS: hydrologic unit modeling of the United States
                                           1-1
                IAQ: indoor air quality

                IBI: index of biotic integrity

                ICCC: international classification of childhood cancer

                ICTDRN: International Center for Tropical Disease Research
                Network   :                        ;

                IDEM: India'na Department of Environmental Management

                IMP: integrated pest management

                IMPROVE: Interagency Monitoring of Protected Visual Environments

                IPCS: International Programme on Chemical Safety

                IQ: intelligence quotient

                IRIS: Integrated Risk Information System

                IWI: Index of Watershed Indicators
                                                                                         K-L
                Ibs: pounds

                LDC: least distributed condition

                LQGs: large quantity generators

                LTER: long-term ecological research

                LUST: leaking underground storage tanks

                km: kilometers
C-4
Acronyms and Abbreviations
Append
x

-------
                           M
MA: metropolitan area





MAD: malathion dicarboxylic acid





MAIA: Mid-Atlantic Integrated Assessment





MBII: Macroinvertebrate Biotic Integrity Index





MCL: maximum contaminant levels





MDC: minimally distributed condition





MDN: Mercury Deposition Network





|J/m3: micrograms per cubic meter





|J/dl: micrograms per deciliter





|J/L: micrograms per liter





MRLC: Multi-Resolution Land Characteristics





MSAs: metropolitan statistical areas
                           N
N2: nitrogen





NAAQS: National Ambient Air Quality Standards





NADP: National Atmospheric Deposition Program





NAE: National Academy of Engineering





NAMS: national air monitoring stations





NAO: North Atlantic Oscillation





NAPAP: National Acid Precipitation Assessment Program





NAS: Nonindigenous Aquatic Species





NASA: National Aeronautics and Space Administration





NASQAN: National Stream Quality Accounting Network
                NASS: National Agricultural Statistics Service





                NAWQA: National Water Qualiiy Assessment Program





                NCEA: National Center for Environmental Assessment





                NCES: National Center for Education Strategies





                NCEH: National Center for Environmental Health





                NCFAP: National Center for Food and Agricultural Policy





                NCHS: National Center for Health Statistics





                NCI: National Cancer Institute





                NCS: National Children's Study





                NDVI: Normalized Difference Vegetation Index





                NEI: National Emissions Inventory





                NEP: National Estuary Program





                NEPA: National Environmental Policy Act





                NERRS:  National'Estuarine Research Reserve System





                ng/mL: nanograms per milliliter





                NHANES:  National Health and Nutrition Examination Survey





                NHATS: National Human Adipose Tissue Survey





                NHj: ammonia





                NHD: National Hydrography Dataset





                NHEXAS: National Human Exposure Assessment Survey





                NHIS: National Health Interview Survey





                NHLBI: National Heart, Lung, and Blood Institute





                NIH: National Institutes of Health





                NINDS:  National  Institute of Neurological Disorders and Stroke





                NLCD: National Land Cover Data





                NLFWA: National Listing of Fish and Wildlife Advisories
Appendix C.
Acronyms and Abbreviations
C-5

-------
    	'	'	_r	'"	'		•	'	•	•"	••	':"^^T'	"	'	'	;	ila*llli'a*l•llal^^*Sl¥S^!t*4Jl^^i^SB;fiSE^S6^lll^K!
                                                                           II	
NLV: Norwalk-like virus

nm: nanometers

NMI: Nematode Maturity Index

MMWR: Morbidity and Mortality Weekly Report

NMVOCs: non-methane volatile organic compounds

NOjs nitrogen dioxide

NO,, nitrogen oxides

NOAA: National Oceanic and Atmospheric Administration

NOPES: Nonoccupational Pesticide Exposure Study

NPb National Priorities List

NPP: Net Primary Production

NRC: National Research Council

NRCS: Natural Resources Conservation Service

NRI: National Resources Inventory

NSF: National Science Foundation

NSh National Sediment Inventory

NSSP: National Sanitary Survey Program

NS&.T: National Status and Trends Program

NTN: National Trends Network

NVSS: National Vital Statistics System

NWHC: National Wildlife Health Center

NWI: National Wetlands Inventory
                                          o
                 j: ozone
               OAQPS: Office of Air Quality Planning and Standards
                                                 .  !
               OAR: Office of Air and Radiation       !

               OCFO: Office of the Chief Financial Officer

               OCHP: Office of Children's Health Protection

               OCIR: Office of Congressional and Intergovernmental Relations

               OECA: Office of Enforcement and Compliance Assurance

               OEI: Office of Environmental Information

               OOP: ozone-depleting potential

               ODS: ozone-depleting substance

               OE: Office of Enforcement

               OECD: Organization for Economic Cooperation and Development

               OPEI: Office of Policy, Economics, and Innovation

               OPs: organophosphate pesticides     '

               OPP: Office of Pesticide Programs

               OPPE: Office of Policy, Planning, and  Evaluation

               OPPT: Office of Pollution Prevention  and Toxics

               OPPTS: Office of Prevention, Pesticides, and Toxic Substances

               ORD: Office of Research and Development

               OSWER: Office of Solid Waste and Emergency Response

               OW: Office  of Water
 C-6
Acronyms and Abbreviations
/Appendix (_-  :

-------

P: phosphorus

PAH: polycyclic aromatic hydrocarbons

Pb: lead

PBTs: persistent bioaccumulative toxics

PCBs: polychlorinated biphenyls

PCC: poison control centers

PCDD: pojychlorinated dibenzo-dioxin

PCDF: polychlorinated dibenzo-furan

pCi/L: picocuries per liter

PDO: Pacific Decadal Oscillation

POP: Pesticides Data Program

PECDF: pentachlorodibenzofuran

PERC: chloroform tetrachloroethylene

PFCs: perflourinated carbons

PIBI: Periphyton Index of Biotic Integrity

PM: particulate matter

PMiQr PM2.s: particulate matter 10, 2.5 micrometers (coarse, fine)

PMSAs: primary metropolitan statistical areas

POPs: persistent organic pollutants

POTW:  publicly owned treatment works

PPI: Producer Price Index

PSR: pressure-state-response framework

PSR/E: pressure-state-response-effects framework

PWS: public water system
                                                                                          Q-R
                QA/QC: quality assurance/quality control

                RB meter: Robertson-Berger meter

                RCRA: Resource Conservation and Recovery Act

                RCRAInfo: Resource Conservation and Recovery Act Information
                System

                ReVA: Regional Vulnerability Assessment Program

                RMSF: rocky mountain spotted fever

                ROE: EPA's Report on the Environment

                ElPA: Resource Planning Act

                RUSLE: revised universal soil loss equation
                                             s
                SiAB: Science Advisory Board

                SARA: Superfund Amendment and Reauthorization Act

                SAV: submerged aquatic vegetation

                SDWA: Safe Drinking Water Act

                SDWIS: Safe Drinking Water Information System

                SDWIS/FED: Safe Drinking Water Information System/Federal
                version

                SeaWiFS: sea viewing wide field-of-view sonar

               . SiEER: Surveillance, Epidemiology, and End Results Program

                Si EM: simultaneously extracted metals

                SF6: sulfur hexafluoride                    x

                SIC: standard industrial classification

                SIDS: sudden infant death syndrome
Appendix C
Acronyms and Abbreviations
C-7

-------
                   \  ' I       If  .;•'•   .      ..   !     I ' j .        ;  '.  : '! : 1M
                                                                               '
SLAMS: state/local air monitoring stations

SMSA: Standard Metropolitan Statistical Area

SO2: sulfur dioxide

SOLEC: State of the Great Lakes Ecosystem Conference

SQI: Soil Quality Index

SPARROW: SPAtially-Referenced Regression On Watershed
Attributes

SQCs: small quantify generators

SSO: sanitary sewer overflow

SST: sea surface temperature

STATSGO: State Soil Geographic Database

STORET: STORage and RETrieval Database

SWAT: Soil and Water Assessment Tool
                            T
TBP: theoretical bioaccumulation potential

TCEs trichloroethylene

TDCF: tetrachlorodibenzofuran

TESS: Toxic Exposure Surveillance System

THMs: trihalomethanes

TIME: temporally integrated monitoring of ecosystems

TMDL: total maximum daily load

TN: total nitrogen

TOO total organic carbon

TOMS: total ozone mapping spectrometer

TP: total phosphorus
               TRI: Toxics Release Inventory

               TD: Technical Document for EPA's Report on the Environment

               TSDs: treatrhent, storage, and disposal facilities

               TYPY: 3,5,6'-trichloro-2-pyridinol
                                        U-Z
                UAs: urbanised areas

                UCs: urban clusters

                UN: United Nations

                UNEP: United Nations Environment Programme

                USDA: U.S. Department of Agriculture

                USFWS: U.S. Fish and Wildlife Service

                USCS: U.S. Geological Survey

                UST: underground storage tanks

                UV: ultraviolet

                UV-A: ultraviolet A

                UV-B: ultraviolet B

                VMT: vehicle miles traveled

                VOCs: volatile organic compounds

                WBDO: Waterborne disease outbreak

                WHO: World Health Organization

                WMO: World Meteorological Organization

                WMPC: waste minimization priority chemicals
C-8
Acronyms and Abbreviations
Appendix C.

-------
Appendix D

    Ci
    • ^^k ^ £* **%•' VM JF
    ioss3rv
 :     ^ ! '   J


 .1 of Tetrnris..

-------
         •	|• "™	["	'	'	•	'"	•	"«:	"	'	Still	IHlllf	    .   	'^W.^^:l:'J>wi:^ .'^^g^^HlMlKKifl^
                             A
accretion: The gradual build-up of sediment along the bank or
shore of a river or stream.

acid deposition: A complex chemical and atmospheric phenomenon,
that occurs when emissions of sulfur and nitrogen compounds are
transformed by chemical processes in the atmosphere and then
deposited on earth in either wet or dry form. The wet forms, often
called "acid rain," can fall to earth as rain, snow, or fog. The dry
forms are acidic gases or particulate matter.

adipose tissue: Fatty tissue.

advisory:  A nonregulatory document that communicates risk
information to those who may have to make risk management
decisions.  (EPA, December 1997)

aerosol: 1. Small droplets or particles suspended in the
atmosphere, typically containing sulfur. They are emitted naturally
(e.g., in volcanic eruptions) and as a result of human activities
(c.g. burning fossil fuels). 2. The pressurized gas used to propel
substances out of a container. (EPA, December 1997)

agricultural waste:  Byproducts generated by the rearing of animals
and the production and harvest of crops or trees. Animal waste, a
large component of agricultural waste, includes waste (e.g., feed
waste, bedding and litter, and feedlqt and paddock runoff) from
livestock, dairy, and other animal-related  agricultural and farming
practices.

air pollutant: Any substance in air that  could, in high enough
concentration, harm man, other animals, vegetation, or material.
Pollutants may include almost any natural or artificial composition of
airborne matter capable of being airborne. They may be in the form
of solid particles, liquid droplets, gases, or in combination thereof.
Generally,  they fall into two main groups: (1) those emitted directly
from identifiable sources and (2) those produced in the air by
interaction between two or more primary pollutants, or by reaction
with normal  atmospheric constituents, with or without
photoactivation. Exclusive of pollen, fog,  and dust, which are of
natural origin, about 100 contaminants have been identified. Air
pollutants are often grouped in categories for ease in classification;
some of he categories are: solids, sulfur compounds, volatile organic
compounds, particulate  matter, nitrogen compounds, oxygen
compounds, halogen compounds, radioactive compounds, and
odors. (EPA, December 1997)

air pollution: The presence of contaminants or pollutant
substances in the air that interfere with human health or welfare or
produce other harmful environmental effects. (EPA, December 1997)
           air quality criteria: The levels of pollution and lengths of exposure
           above which harmful health and welfare effects may occur.
           (EPA, December 1997)

           air quality standards: The level of pollutants prescribed by
           regulations that are not to be exceeded during a given time in a
           defined area. (EPA, December 1997)
                      '        '.    •'	   i i •   •    ;       i         ,..
           air toxics:  Air pollutants that cause or may cause cancer or other
           serious health effects,  such as reproductive effects or birth defects,
           or adverse environmental and ecological effects. Examples of toxic air
           pollutants include benzene, found in gasoline; perchloroethylene,
           emitted from some dry cleaning facilities; and methylene chloride,
           used as a solvent by a number of industries.

           algal blooms:  Sudden spurts of algal growth, which can degrade
           water quality and indicate potentially  hazardous changes in local
           water chemistry. (EPA,  December 1997)

           ambient air: Any unconfined portion of the atmosphere; open air,
           surrounding air. (EPA, December 1997)

           ambient aiir quality standards:  See  criteria pollutants and National
           Ambient Air Quality Standards.

           animal waiste:  Byproducts that result from livestock, diary, and
           other animal-related agricultural practices.

           anthropogenic: Originating from humans, not naturally occurring,
           (EPA, MAIA, August 2002)

           aquatic ecosystems:  Salt water or fresh water ecosystems, includes
           rivers, streams,  lakes, wetlands, estuaries and coral reefs.

           aquifer:  An underground geological formation, or group of
           formation:;, containing water; source of. ground water for wells and
           springs. (USCS, 1996)

           arsenic:  A silvery, nonmetallic element that occurs naturally in rocks
           and soil, water,  air, and plants and animals. It can be released into the
           environment through natural activities such as. volcanic action,
           erosion of rocks, and forest fires or through human actions.
           Approximately 90 percent of industrial arsenic in the U.S. is used as
           a wood preservative, but arsenic is also used in paints, dyes, metals,
           drugs,  sojips, and semiconductors. Agricultural applications (used in
           rodent poisons and some herbicides), mining, and smelting also
           contribute to arsenic releases in the environment. It is a known
           human carcinogen.

           arterioscjerosis:  Hardening of the arteries.

           asbestos:: Naturally occurring strong, flexible fibers that can be
           separated into thin threads and woven. These fibers resist heat and
D-2
Glossary of Terms
Appendix D

-------

chemicals and do not conduct electricity. Asbestos is used for
insulation, making automobile brake and clutch parts, and many
other products. These fibers break easily and form a dust composed
of tiny particles that are light and sticky. When inhaled or swallowed
they can cause health  problems. (NCI, 2001)

assemblage: The association of interacting populations of
organisms in a selected habitat.
                              6
basal cell carcinoma: A type of skin cancer, usually curable if
treated in time.

beach day: A day that a beach would normally be open to the
public.    :

benthic:  Occurring at or near the bottom of a body of water.

benthic organisms:  The worms, clams, crustaceans,  and other
organisms that live at the bottom of the estuaries and the sea.

benthos: In fresh water and marine ecosystems, organisms attached
to, resting on,  or burrowed into bottom sediments.

bioaccumulation:  A process whereby chemicals (e.g., DDT, PCBs)
are retained by plants and animals and increase in concentration
over time. Uptake can occur through feeding or direct absorption
from water or sediments. (EPA, MAIA, August 2002)

biodiversity:  The  variety and variability among living organisms and
the ecological  complexes in which they occur. Diversity can be
defined as the number of different items and their relative
frequencies. The term encompasses three basic levels of biodiversity:
ecosystems, species, and genes.

biological diversity:  See biodiversity.

biomarker: 1. A parameter that can be used to identify a toxic
effect in  an individual organism and can be used in extrapolation
between  species. 2. An indicator signaling an event or condition in a
biological system or sample and giving a measure of exposure, effect,
or susceptibility. (International Union of Pure and Applied Chemistry,
1993)

biomass: All of the living material in a given area; often refers to
vegetation. (EPA; December 1997)

biomonitoring: Use of a living organism or biological entity as a
detector and its response as a measure to determine environmental
           conditions. Ambient biological surveys and toxicity tests are common
           biological monitoring methods.

           biotic: Refers to living organisms.

           biotic condition: The state of living things.

           biotic integrity: The ability to support and maintain balanced,
           integrated functionality in the natural habitat of a given region.

           body burden: The amount of various contaminants retained in a
           person's tissues.

           bog: A type of wetland that accumulates appreciable peat deposits.
           Bogs depend  primarily on precipitation for their water source and
           are usually acidic and rich in plant residue, with a conspicuous mat
           of living green moss. (EPA, December 1997)

           brownfield:  Real property, the expansion, redevelopment or reuse
           of which may  be complicated by the presence or potential presence
           of a hazardous substance, pollutant, or contaminant.
                                        c
           cadmium: A metal found in natural deposits as ores containing
           other elements. The greatest use of cadmium is primarily for metal
           plating and coating operations, including transportation equipment,
           machinery and baking enamels, photography, and television
           phosphors. It is also used in nickel-cadmium and solar batteries and
           in pigments.  (EPA, OGWDW, September 2002)

           carcinogen:  An agent that causes cancer.

           cerebrovascular disease:  A category of diseases, including stroke,
           related to blood vessels supplying the brain.

           chlorination:  The application of chlorine to drinking water, sewage,
           or industrial  waste to disinfect or to oxidize undesirable compounds.
           (EPA, December 1997)

           chlorine: A greenish-yellow gas that is slightly soluble in water.
           Chlorine is often used in disinfection of water and treatment of
           sewage effluent as well as in the manufacture of products such as
           antifreeze, rubber, and cleaning agents.

           chromium:  A heavy metal that occurs naturally in rocks, plants, soil,
           and volcanic dust and gases. It is tasteless  and odorless. It can
           damage living things at low concentrations and tends to accumulate
           in the food chain.
Appendix D
Glossary of Terms
D-3

-------
                                                                               ecnnica
chronic exposure:  Multiple exposures occurring over an extended
period of time or over a significant fraction of an animal's or human's
lifetime (usually seven years to a lifetime).  (EPA, December 1997)

Class I area: Under the Clean Air Act, a Class I area is one in which
visibility is protected more stringently than under the national
ambient air quality standards; includes national  parks, wilderness
areas, monuments, and other areas of special national and cultural
significance.  (EPA, December 1997)

cleanup: Action taken to deal  with a release or threat of release of a
hazardous substance that could affect humans,  the environment, or
both. The term "cleanup" is sometimes used interchangeably with
the terms "remedial action," "removal action," "response action," or
"corrective action."

coastal and ocean ecosystem: An ecosystem that consists
primarily of estuaries and ocean waters under U.S. jurisdiction. U.S.  •
waters extend to the boundaries of the U.S. Exclusive Economic
Zone, 200 miles from the U.S.  coast. (The Heinz Center, 2002)
(This report focuses on waters  within 25 miles of the coast.)

coastal wetland: Ecosystem generally found along the Atlantic,
Pacific, Alaskan, and Gulf coasts and closely linked to the nation's
estuaries, where sea water mixes with fresh water to form an
environment of varying salinities. The plants in coastal wetlands have
adapted to changing fluctuating water levels and salinities to create
tidal salt marshes, mangrove swamps, and tidal fresh water wetlands,
which form beyond the upper edges of tidal salt marshes where the
influence of salt water ends. Fresh water coastal wetlands can also be
found adjacent to the Great Lakes.

community water system: A public water system that serves at least
15 service connections used by year-round residents or regularly
serves at least 25 year-round residents. (EPA, December 1997)

composting: The controlled biological decomposition of organic
material in the presence of air to form a humus-like material.
Controlled methods of composting include mechanical mixing and
aerating, ventilating the materials by dropping them through a
vertical series of aerated chambers, and placing the them in piles out
In the open air and mixing it or turning it periodically.

congenital anomalies: Birth defects.

construction and demolition debris: Waste generated during
building, renovation, and wrecking projects. This type of waste
generally consists of materials such as wood, concrete, steel, brick,
and gypsum.
           contaminant: Any physical, chemical, biological, or radiological
           substance or matter that has an adverse effect on air, water, or soil.
           (EPA, December 1997)

           contaminated land: Ground that has been polluted with hazardous
           materials and requires cleanup or remediation. Contaminated sites
           may contain both polluted objects (e.g., buildings, machinery) and
           land (e.g. soil, sediments, and plants).

           contaminated media: Materials such as soil, sediment, water, and
           sludge that are polluted at levels requiring cleanup or further
           assessment.

           contamination: Introduction into water,-air, or soil of
           microorganisms,  chemicals, toxic substances, wastes, or waste water
           in a concentration that makes the medium unfit for its next intended
           use. Also applies to surfaces of objects, buildings, and various
           household and agricultural use products. ;(EPA, December 1997)

           conterminous:  Enclosed within one common boundary (e.g., the
           48 conterminous states).

           cotinine: A breakdown product (metabolite) of nicotine that can  be
           measured in urine.

           criteria air pollutants:  A group of six widespread and common air
           pollutants regulated by the  EPA on the basis of standards set to
           protect public health or environmental effects of pollution. These six
           criteria pollutants are carbon monoxide, lead, nitrogen dioxide,
           ozone, particulate matter, and sulfur dioxide.

           cropland:  A National Resources Inventory land cover/use category
           that includes areas used for the production of adapted crops for
           harvest. Two subcategories of cropland are  recognized:  cultivated
           and noncultivated. Cultivated cropland comprises land in row crops
           or close-grown crops and also other cultivated cropland, for
           example, hayland or pastureland that is in a rotation with row or
           close-grown brops. Noncultivated cropland  includes permanent
           hayland and horticultural cropland. (USDA, NRCS, 2000)
                                        D
           depuration:  The process of reducing the number of pathogenic
           organisms that may be present in shellfish by using a controlled
           aquatic environment as the treatment process. (FDA, 2000)
D-4
Glossary of Terms
/Appendix U

-------
                                                         ^^::^' yM^^'-?'&'$ft*yt%i&?&-&M$Mb i '•l-MT^-.^^^^j^j^^tf^&i!^^-,
dermal absorption:  The process by which a chemical penetrates
the skin and enters the body as an internal dose. (EPA, December
1997)                              _.       •    .

designated uses: Those wate'r uses identified in state water quality
standards that must be achieved and maintained as required under
the Clean Water Act. Uses can include fishing, shellfish harvesting,
public water supply, swimming, boating, and irrigation. (EPA,
December 1997)

developed land: A combination of National Resource Inventory
land cover/use categories: large urban and built-up areas, small built-
up areas, and rural transportation land. (USDA, NRCS, 2000)

dioxin: A group of chemically similar compounds, known chemically
as dibenzo-p-dioxins,  that are created inadvertently during
combustion, chlorine  bleaching of pulp and paper, and some types of
chemical  manufacturing. Tests on laboratory animals indicate that it
is one of the more toxic anthropogenic (manmade) compounds.

disinfection byproduct: A compound formed  by the reaction of a
disinfectant such as chlorine with organic material in the water
supply; a chemical byproduct of the disinfection process. (EPA,
December 1997)

Dobson unit (DU): A measurement of ozone in the atmosphere. If,
for example, 100 DU  of ozone were brought to earth's surface, they
would form a layer one millimeter thick. (EPA, December 1997)

dose:  1. The actual quantity of a chemical administered to an
organism or to which  it is exposed. 2. The amount of a substance
that reaches a specific tissue (e.g., the liver). 3. The amount of a
substance available for interaction with metabolic processes after
crossing the outer boundary of an organism. (EPA, December 1997)

dry deposition:  The settling of gases and particles out of the
atmosphere. Dry deposition is a  type of acid deposition, more
commonly referred to as "acid rain." (EPA, Clean Air Markets Division,
October 2002).
           ecological processes: The metabolic functions of ecosystems—
           energy flow, elemental cycling, and the production, consumption,
           and decomposition of organic matter, (EPA, SAB, 2002)

           ecology: The study of the structure and function of nature; the
           totality of relations between organisms and their environment.
           (Odum,  1971)

           ecoregions: Areas within which ecosystems with similar
           characteristics are likely to occur with predictable patterns; variables
           include such things as landform, vegetation, soils, and fauna.

           ecosystem: 1. The interacting system of a biological community and
           its nonliving environmental surroundings. 2. A geographic area
           including all living organisms (people, plants, animals, and
           microorganisms), their physical surroundings (such as soil, water and
           air), and the natural cycles that sustain them.

           ecotone: A habitat created by the juxtaposition of distinctly
           different habitats; an edge habitat; or an ecological zone or
           boundary where two or more  ecosystems meet. (EPA, December
           1997)

           emissions standard: The maximum amount of air-polluting
           discharge legally allowed from a single source, mobile or stationary.
           (EPA, December 1997)

           endangered species: Animals, birds, fish, plants, or other living
           organisms threatened with extinction by anthropogenic
           (human-caused) or natural changes in their environment.
           Requirements for declaring a species "endangered" are contained in
           the Endangered Species Act.  (EPA, December 1997)

           endocrine disrupters:  Chemicals that interfere with the endocrine
           systems, leading to adverse effects. Some chemicals do this  by
           binding to receptors, such as  the estrogen and androgen receptors.

           endocrine system: The components of the body that produce
           hormones that regulate reproductive and developmental functions.
           Major endocrine glands include' the pituitary, thyroid, adrenal glands,
           testes, and ovaries.
ecological indicators:  Measurable characteristics related to the
structure, composition, or functioning of ecological systems (EPA,
SAB, 2002); a measure, an index of measures, or a model that
characterizes an ecosystem or one of its critical components
(Jackson et.al, 2000); any expression of the environment that
quantitatively estimates the condition of ecological resources, the
magnitude of stress, the exposure of biological components to
stress, or the amount of change in condition. (Barber, 1994)
           enrichment: The addition of nutrients (e.g. nitrogen, phosphorus,
           carbon compounds) from sewage effluent, agricultural or urban
           runoff, or other sources to surface water. Enrichment greatly
           increases the growth potential for algae and other aquatic plants.
           (EPA, December 1997)

           environmental burden of disease: The proportion of diseases,
           disability, and injury caused by factors in the environment: chemical
           pollutants, infectious microorganisms, and radiation.
Appendix D
Glossary of Terms
D-5

-------

environmental exposure: Human exposure to pollutants in their
surroundings. Low-level chronic exposure to pollutants is one of the
most common forms of environmental exposure (see threshold level).
(EPA, December 1997)

environmental indicators: Scientific measurements that help
measure over time the state of air, water, and land resources,
                                          *•
pressures on those resources, and resulting effects on ecological and
human health. Indicators show progress in making the air cleaner and
the water purer and in protecting land.

environmental risk: The potential for adverse effects on living
organisms associated with pollution of the environment by effluents,
emissions, wastes, or accidental chemical releases; energy use, or the
depletion of natural resources. (EPA, December 1997)

environmental risk factor: An exposure to something in the
environment that, based on evidence, is known to be associated with
health-related conditions and considered important to prevent.
(Green, 1999)

environmental tobacco smoke: A mixture of smoke exhaled by a
smoker and the smoke from the burning end of a smoker's cigarette,
pipe, or cigar. Also known as second hand smoke.

epidemiology:  The study of how diseases occur in a  population
or area.

epiphyte: A plant, fungus, or microbe sustained entirely by
nutrients and water received, by means other than a parasite, from
within the canopy in which it resides. (Moffett, 2000)

erosion: The wearing away of land surface by wind or water,
intensified by land-clearing practices related to farming,
residential or industrial development, road building, or logging.
(EPA, December 1997)

estuaries: Partially enclosed bodies of water (this term includes
bays, sounds, lagoons, and fjords); they are generally considered to
begin at the upper end of tidal or saltwater influence and end where
they meet the ocean. (The Heinz Center, 2002)

cutrophic:  Pertaining to a lake or other body of water
characterized by large nutrient concentrations, resulting in high
productivity of algae.

eutrophication: The slow aging process during which a lake,
estuary, or bay evolves into a bog or marsh and eventually
disappears. During the later stages of this process, the water body is
choked by abundant plant life that result from higher levels of
nutritive compounds such as nitrogen and phosphorus.  Human
activities can accelerate the process. (EPA, December 1997)
           exotic species: A species that is not indigenous to a region. (EPA,
           December 1997)

           exposure: The amount of radiation or pollutant present in a given
           environment that represents a potential health threat to living
           organisms. (I:PA, December 1997)

           exposure pathway:  The path from sources of pollutants via, soil,
           water, or food to humans and other species. (EPA, December 1997)

           exposure route:  The way a chemical or pollutant enters an
           organism after contact; i.e. by ingestion, inhalation, or dermal
           absorption. (EPA, December 1997)

           extraction waste: Byproducts produced as a  result of mining
           practices.
                                         F
           farmlands:  include both croplands-lands used for production of
           annual and perennial crops and livestock-and surrounding landscape,
           such as field borders and windbreaks, small woodlots, grassland or
           shrubland areas, wetlands, farmsteads, small villages and other built-
           up areas, and similar areas within and adjacent to croplands. (The
           Heinz Center, 2002)

           fauna: Animal life.

           fertilizers: Supplements to improve plant growth that are commonly
           used on agricultural lands, as well as in urban, industrial, and
           residential settings.

           fish kill:  A large-scale die-off of fish caused by factors such as
           pollution, noxious algae, harmful bacteria, and hypoxic conditions.

           floodplain:  Any land area susceptible to being inundated by water
           from any source.

           flora:  Plant or bacterial life.

           forage: Food for animals especially when taken by browsing or grazing.

           forests:  Lands at least 10 percent covered by trees of any size, at
           least one acre in extent. This includes areas in which trees are
           intermingled with other cover, such as chaparral and pinyon, juniper
           areas in the Southwest, and  both naturally regenerating forests and
           areas planted for future harvest (plantations or "tree farms"). (The
           Heinz Center, 2002)
D-6
Glossary of Terms
Appendix D

-------
forest fragmentation: The division of a formerly healthy forest into
patches, usually as a result of conversion to agricultural or residential
land. (EPA, August 2002)

forest land:  Land that is at least 10 percent stocked by forest
trees of any size, including land that formerly had tree cover and
that will be naturally or artificially regenerated. The minimum area
for classification of forest land is one acre. (USDA, Forest Service,
April 2001)

fresh water systems: Include:
• Rivers and streams, including those that flow only part of the year
• Lakes, ponds, and reservoirs, from small farm ponds to the Great "
   Lakes
• Ground water, which is  often directly connected to rivers, streams,
   lakes, and wetlands
• Fresh water wetlands, including forested, shrub, and emergent wet-
   lands (marshes), and open water ponds
• Riparian areas-they usually vegetated  margins of streams and
   rivers (although this term can also apply to lake margins).
   (The Heinz Center, 2002)
           ground water:  Subsurface water that occurs beneath the water
           table in soils and geologic formations that are fully saturated.
                             G
geomorphology: The scientific study of the nature and origin of
the landforms on the surface of earth and other planets.

giardiasis: The illness resulting from infection of the gastrointestinal
tract with Giardia lamblia. The symptoms of giardiasis include gastric
pain, fatigue, extreme diarrhea, fever, chills, and nausea. The most
acute symptoms typically last only a few days (Garcia, 1999).

global burden of disease: The overall impact of disease related to
all causes.' It takes into account the burden represented  by years of
life lived with illness or disability.

grasslands and shrublands: Lands in which the dominant
vegetation is grasses and other nonwoody vegetation, or where
shrubs (with  or without scattered trees) are the norm  (also called
rangelands); includes bare-rock deserts, alpine meadows, arctic
tundra, pastures, and haylands  (an overlap with the farmland
system). Less-managed pastures and haylands fit well within the
grassland/shrubland system; more heavily managed ones fit well as
part of the farmlands system. (The Heinz Center, 2002)

gross primary production: Total energy captured in units of
carbon gain.

ground-level ozone: See ozone.
                                        H
           habitat:  The place where a population (e.g., human, animal, plant,
           microorganism) lives and its surroundings, both living and nonliving.
           (EPA, December 1997)

           habitat fragmentation: The division of large areas of natural
           habitat into smaller sections through conversion of the natural
           habitat to other uses (e.g., roads, development), resulting in
           populations of plants and animals becoming isolated from each other
           and potentially threatening their survival.

           habitat loss:  The destruction of habitat by natural disasters
           (hurricanes, fires, flooding, etc.) and human activity (clearing land for
           agricultural, industrial, and residential development; clear-cut
           harvesting of timber; oil spills; and war).

           halogens: Compounds that contain atoms of chlorine, bromine, or
           fluorine.

           hardwood: The wood of an angiospermous tree as distinguished
           from that of a coniferous tree; a tree that yields hardwood.

           hazardous waste:  Byproducts of society that can pose a
           substantial or potential threat to human health  or the environment
           when improperly managed. Hazardous waste possesses at least one
           of four characteristics: ignitability, corrosivity, reactivity, ortoxicity.

           health outcomes:  An outcome measured by the  quality of life,
           likelihood of disease, life expectancy, and overall health of individuals
           or communities. (HIC, 2000-2001)

           heavy metals:  Metallic elements with high atomic weights
           (e.g., mercury,  chromium, cadmium, arsenic, lead); can damage' living
           things at low concentrations and tend to accumulate in the  food
           chain. (EPA, December 1997)

           herbicide:  A form of pesticide used to control weeds that limit or
           inhibit the growth of the desired crop.

           high-level radioactive waste: Highly radioactive waste material from
           the chemical processing of spent fuel. It includes spent fuel, liquid
           waste, and highly radioactive solid waste from the liquid. High-level
           radioactive waste contains elements that decay very slowly and
           remain radioactive for thousands of years.  (DOE, 1997)
Appendix D
Glossary of Terms
D-7

-------
CDA'	iffi	HOT	rfWPfPWI3«8£I!	SWfllPW	liiiff
tr/^s Pratt ixepsft ort
                        r      *••'•!•   !     	•      •  T •••]•".•   ' -" '•-•• ;t •'
 household hazardous waste: Hazardous products used and
 disposed of by residential rather than industrial consumers. It
 includes paints, stains, varnishes, solvents, pesticides, and other
 materials or products containing volatile chemicals that can catch
 fire, react, or explode, or are corrosive or toxic.

 human exposure to contaminants: The contact of a chemical
 contacting and the outer boundary of a human. (EPA, ORD,
 March 1998)

 hydrologic cycle: Movement or exchange of water between the
 atmosphere and earth. (EPA, December 1997)

 hydrologic unit code (HUC): An eight-digit code that is used to
 classify watersheds in the U.S. This code uniquely identifies each of
 four levels of watershed classification within four two-digit fields. The
 first two digits of the code identify the water-resources region; the
 first four digits identify the sub-region; the first six digits identify the
 accounting unit; and the final two digits identify the cataloging unit.
 For example, in hydrologic unit code (HUC) 01080204,  01 identifies
 the region; 0108 identifies the sub-region; 010802 identifies the
 accounting unit; and 01080204 identifies the cataloging unit.

 hydrology:  The geology of ground water, with particular emphasis
 on the chemistry and movement of water. (EPA, December 1997)

 hypertrophic: Pertaining to a lake or other body of water
 characterized by excessive nutrient concentrations, resulting high
 productivity.

 hypoxia/hypoxic waters:  Waters with low levels of dissolved
 oxygen concentrations, typically less than two ppm, the  level
 generally accepted as the minimum required for most marine life to
 survive and reproduce. (EPA, December 1997).
           incidence rate of disease: The number of new cases of a disease or
           condition in a given period of time in a specified population.

           indoor air: The breathable air inside a habitable structure or
           conveyance. (EPA,  December 1997)

           indoor air pollution: Chemical, physical, or biological contaminants
           in indoor air. (EPA, December 1997)

           industrial waste:  Process waste associated with manufacturing.
           This waste u<;ually is not classified as either municipal waste or
           RCRA hazardous waste by federal or state laws.  (EPA, OSWER,
           October 1988)

           industrial non-hazardous waste: Process waste associated with
           generation of electric power and manufacture of materials such as
           pulp and paper, iron and steel, glass, and concrete. This waste
           usually is not classified as either municipal waste or hazardous waste
           by federal  or state laws.

           infant mortality:  The death of children in the first year of life.

           inland wetlands:  Wetlands that include marshes, wet meadows, and
           swamps. These areas are often dry one or more seasons every year.
           In the arid West of the U.S., they may be wet only periodically.

           integrated pest management:  The coordinated use of available
           pest-control methods to prevent unacceptable levels of pest damage
           by the most eiconomical means and with the least possible hazard to
           people, property, and the environment.

           invasive species/invasive nuisance species:  See nonnative species.

           inversion: The condition that occurs when warm air is trapped near
           the ground and normal temperature gradients don't permit air to
           flow into the atmosphere. (Nadakavukaren, 2000).
impervious surface: A hard surface area that either prevents or
retards the entry of water into the soil mantle or causes water to run
off the surface in greater quantities  or at an increased rate of flow.
Common impervious surfaces include, but are not limited to,
rooftops, walkways, patios, driveways, parking lots, storage areas,
concrete or asphalt paving, and gravel roads. (Washington
Department of Ecology, 1992).

impounded: Refers to a body of water such as a pond, lake, or river
that has been confined by a dam, dike, floodgate, or other barrier.
(Texas Environmental Center, 1991)
           Julian day (JO): A Julian day is a continuous count of days
           beginning witjh January 1, 4713 BC. Julian days are often used by
           astronomers and sometimes used by historians to provide a precise
           date for an event, independent of all calendar systems. The date
           4713 BC was chosen for the start of the count because this was
           earlier than all known historical records and happened to be a
           convenient starting point for several chronological and astronomical
           cycles. The length of the year in the Julian calendar is exactly
           365.25 Julian days.
D-8
Glossary of Terms
Appendix U

-------

                             K
keystone species: A species that interacts with a large number of
other species in a community. Because of the interactions, the
removal of this species can cause widespread changes to community
structure. (Pidwirny, 2000-2001)
                              L
lagoons (for waste treatment):  Water impoundments in which
organic wastes are stored, stabilized, or both. A shallow, artificial
treatment pond where sunlight, bacterial action, and oxygen work to
purify wastewater; a stabilization pond. An aerated lagoon is a
treatment pond that uses oxygen to speed up the natural process of
biological decomposition of organic wastes. (EPA, August 2002)

land cover: The ecological status and physical structure of the
vegetation on the land surface. (NRC, 2000)

land use:  Describes how a piece of land is managed or used by
humans. The degree to which the land reflects  human activities (e.g.,
residential and industrial development, roads, mining, timber
harvesting, agriculture, grazing, etc.).

landfills: 1. Sanitary landfills:  Disposal sites for nonhazardous solid
wastes spread in layers, compacted to the  smallest practical volume,
and covered by material applied at the end of each operating day.  2.
Secure chemical landfills: Disposal sites for hazardous waste, selected
and designed to minimize the chance of release of hazardous
substances into the environment.

landscape: The traits, patterns, and structure  of a specific
geographic area, including its biological composition, its physical
environment, and its anthropogenic or social patterns. An area where
interacting ecosystems are grouped and repeated in similar form.
(EPA, December 1997)

landscape condition: The extent, composition, and patterns of
habitats in a landscape.

landscape pattern: The spatial distribution of the land use/land
cover types, the arrangement of patches, connectivity among
patches, and corridors for movement.

large urban and built-up areas: A National Resources Inventory
land cover/use category composed of developed tracts of at least
10 acres, meeting the definition of urban and built-up areas. (USDA,
NRCS, 2000)
           large-quantity generators: Businesses that generate substantial
           "RCRA hazardous waste" as a part of their regular activities.

           leaching:  The process by which soluble materials in the soil, such as
           nutrients, pesticide chemicals, or contaminants, are washed into a
           lower layer of soil or are dissolved and carried away by water. (Texas
           Environmental Center, 1991)

           lead: A heavy metal used in many materials and products. It is a
           natural element and does not break down in the environment. When
           absorbed into the body, it can be highly toxic to many organs and
           systems.

           levee: A natural or manmade earthen barrier along the edge of a
           stream, lake, or river. Land alongside rivers can be protected from
           flooding by levees.

           lichen: Any of numerous complex thallophytic plants made up of an
           alga and a fungus growing in symbiotic association on a solid surface
           (e.g., a rock).

           life expectancy:  The probable number of years (or other time
           period) that members of a particular age class of a population are
           expected to live, based on statistical studies of similar populations in
           similar environments.

           life expectancy (at birth): The average number of years that a
           group or cohort of infants born in the same year are expected to live.

           low birthweight:  Refers to children born weighing less than 2,500
           grams (5.5 pounds).

           low-level waste: Radioactive waste, including accelerator-produced
           waste, that is not high-level radioactive waste, spent nuclear fuel,
           transuranic waste, byproduct material (as defined in the Atomic
           Energy Act of 1954), or naturally occurring radioactive material.
                                      M
           macroinvertebrate:  An organism that lacks a backbone and can be
           seen with the naked eye. (EPA, OW, November 2002).

           malignant melanoma:  A type of skin cancer, more often fatal than
           other types of skin cancer.

           media:  Specific environments—air, water, soil—that are the subject
           of regulatory concern and activities. (EPA, December 1997)
Appendix D
Glossary of Terms
D-9

-------

medical waste: Any solid waste generated during the diagnosis,
treatment, or immunization of human beings or animals, in research,
production, or testing.

mercury:  Mercury is a metallic element that occurs in  many forms
and in combination with other elements. When combined with
carbon, which readily occurs in water, it forms more-bioavailable
organic mercury compounds (e.g., methylmercury).

mesotrophic: Pertaining to a lake or other body of water
characterized by moderate nutrient concentrations and moderate
productivity in terms of aquatic animal and plant life.

metabolic rate:  The rate at which the body can turn food into
energy.

metabolites: Compound that result from human digestion
(metabolism) of contaminants and that serve as a biomarkers of
exposure.

metadata: Information about data. It describes the content, quality,
condition, and other characteristics of data.

methemoglobinemia: A rare but potentially fatal condition in
infants that results from interferences in the blood's ability to carry
oxygen. Nitrates in drinking water are associated with
methemoglobinemia (also known as "blue baby syndrome").

metropolitan area: A Metropolitan Area (MA) is a U.S. Census
Bureau construct that consists of an area comprising a  core with a
large population nucleus, together with adjacent communities that
have a high degree of economic and social integration with that core.
Each MA must contain either a place with a minimum population of
50,000 or a Census Bureau-defined urbanized area and a total MA
population of at least 100,000 (75,000  in New England). The area
is defined by county boundaries. (U.S. Census Bureau, 2001)

microorganisms:  Tiny life forms that can be seen only with the aid
of a microscope. Some microorganisms can cause acute health
problems when consumed; also known as  microbes. (EPA, OGWDW,
November 2002)

Mid-Atlantic Highlands: A region that encompass 79,000 square
miles and extends  east to west from the Blue Ridge Mountains in
Virginia to the Ohio  River, and north to south from the  Catskill
Mountains to the North Carolina-Tennessee-Virginia border

mixed low-level waste: Low-level radioactive waste that also
contains hazardous constituents. (DOE, December 1999)

mobile sources: Moving objects that release pollution from
combustion of fossil fuels, such as cars, trucks, buses, planes, trains,
lawn mowers, construction equipment, and snowmobiles. Some
           mobile sources, such as some construction equipment or movable
           diesel generators,- are called nonroad sources, because they are
           usually operated off road.

           Monte Carlo analysis: A computer-based statistical tool—drawing
           on various probabilistic techniques—that is used to help quantify
           variability and uncertainty inherent to risk assessment.

           morbidity: Sickness, illness, or disease that does not result in
           death.

           mortality: Death; death  rate, the proportion of the population who
           die of a diseeise, often expressed as a number per 100,000.

           municipal solid waste: Waste discarded by households,
           hotels/motels, and commercial, institutional, and industrial sources.
           It typically consists of everyday items such as product packaging,
           grass clippings, furniture, clothing, bottles, food scraps, newspapers,
           appliances, paint, and batteries. It does not include waste water.
                                       N
           National Ambient Air Quality Standards: Standards established
           by EPA under the Clean Air Act that apply to outdoor air throughout
           the country (see criteria pollutants).  (EPA, December 1997)

           nematodes: Simple worms consisting of an elongate stomach and
           reproduction system inside a resistant outer cuticle (outer skin).
           (USDA, 2001)

           net primary production: Gross primary production minus all
           sources of plant respiration. Represents the carbon or biomass that
           is available to other organisms, providing the base of the food web.

           nitrate: The primary chemical form of nitrogen in most aquatic
           systems; occurs naturally; a plant nutrient and fertilizer; can be
           harmful to humans and aninmals.

           nitric oxide (NO): A gas formed by combustion under high
           temperature and high pressure in an internal combustion engine; it is
           converted by sunlight and photochemical processes in ambient  air to
           nitrogen oxide. NO is a precursor of ground-level ozone pollution, or
           smog. (EPA, December 1997)

           nitrogen dioxide (NO2): The result of nitric oxide combining with
           oxygen in the atmosphere; major component of photochemical
           smog. (EPA, December 1997)
D-10
Glossary of Terms
Appendix D

-------

nitrogen export: The annual quantity of total nitrogen produced
by nitrogen sources in a watershed that leaves the watershed
through a river or stream that connects to other watersheds
downstream

nitrogen oxide (IMOX): The result of photochemical reactions of
nitric oxide in ambient air; major component of photochemical smog.
Product of combustion from transportation and stationary sources
and a major contributor to the formation of ozone in the
troposphere and to acid deposition. (EPA, December, 1997)

noncommunity water system: A public water system that is not a
community water system. Nontransient noncommunity water systems
are those that regularly supply water to at least 25 of the same
people at least six months per year but not year-round (e.g.,
schools, factories, office buildings, and  hospitals that have their own
water systems).  Transient noncommunity water systems provide water
in a place where people do not remain for long periods of time (e.g.,
a gas station or campground).

nonhazardous waste: See solid waste.

nonisolated intermediaries: An intermediate compound in a
chemical manufacturing process that can  be a by-product or can be
released as a result of the process.

nonnative species: A species that  has been introduced by human
action, either intentionally or by accident, into areas outside its
natural geographical range. Other names for these species include.
alien, exotic, introduced, and nonindigenous.

nonpoint source pollution:  Pollution that occurs when rainfall,
snowmelt, or irrigation water runs over land or through the ground,
picks up pollutants, and deposits them into rivers, lakes, coastal
waters, or ground water. Types of pollution include sediments,
nutrients, pesticides, pathogens (bacteria and viruses), toxic
chemicals, heavy metals that runoff from agricultural land, urban
development, and roads.

noxious algae:  Toxic algae commonly associated with harmful algae
blooms such as  red tides.

nutrient:  Any substance assimilated by living things that promotes
growth. The term is generally applied to nitrogen and phosphorus,
but is also applied to other essential and trace elements.

nutrient enrichment: See eutrophication.
                                       o
           oil and gas production wastes:  Drilling fluids, produced waters,
           and other wastes associated with the exploration, development, and
           production of crude oil or natural gas that are conditionally
           exempted from regulation as hazardous wastes.
                                          >
           oligotrophic: Pertaining to a lake or other body of water
           characterized by extremely low nutrient concentrations, often with
           very limited plant growth but with high dissolved-oxygen levels.

           organic matter: Plant and animal material that is in the process of
           decomposing. When it has fully decomposed, it is called "humus."
           This humus is important for soil structure because it holds individual
           mineral particles together in clusters. (USDA, NRCS, 2000)

           organophosphate: Pesticides that contain phosphorus; short-lived,
           but some can be toxic when first applied. (EPA, December, 1997)

           outer boundary:  In reference to the body, includes skin and body
           openings.

           ozone (O3):  A very reactive form of oxygen that is a bluish
           irritating gas of pungent odor. It is formed naturally in the
           atmosphere by a photochemical reaction and is a beneficial
           component of the upper atmosphere. It is also a major air pollutant
           .in the lower atmosphere, where it can form by photochemical
           reactions when there are conditions of air pollutants, bright sunlight,
           and stagnant weather.

           ozone depletion:  Destruction of the stratospheric ozone layer,
           which shields earth from ultraviolet radiation harmful to life. This
           destruction of ozone is caused by the breakdown of certain
           compounds that contain chlorine, bromine, or both
           (chlorofluorocarbons or halons), which occurs when they reach the
           stratosphere and then  catalytically destroy ozone molecules. (EPA,
           December 1997)

           ozone hole:  A  well-defined, large-scale area of significant thinning
           of the ozone layer. It occurs over Antarctica each spring.

           ozone layer: The protective stratum in the atmosphere, about 15
           miles above the ground, that absorbs some of the sun's ultraviolet
           rays, thereby reducing the amount of potentially harmful radiation
           that reaches earth's surface. (EPA, December 1997)

           ozone precursors: Chemicals that  contribute to the formation
           of ozone.
Appendix D
Glossary of Terms
D-n

-------
EFAs  Draft Mportpti the
                       ecnmca
 particulate matter: Solid particles or liquid droplets suspended
 or carried in the air (e.g., soot, dust, fumes, mist). (EPA, OAR,
 October 2002)

 passive smoking:  Exposure to tobacco smoke, or the chemicals in
 tobacco smoke, without actually smoking. It usually refers to a
 situation where a nonsmoker inhales smoke emitted into the
 environment by other people smoking. This smoke is known as
 "environmental tobacco smoke" (ETS). (National Public Health
 Partnership, 2000)

 pastureland:  A National Resources Inventory land cover/use
 category of land managed primarily for the production of introduced
 forage plants for livestock grazing. Pastureland cover may consist of a
 single species in a pure stand, a grass mixture, or a grass-legume
 mixture. For the NRI, it includes land that has a vegetative cover of
 grasses, legumes, and/or forbs, regardless of whether or not it is
 being grazed by livestock. (USDA, NRCS, 2000).

 pathogen:  Microorganism (e.g.,  bacteria, viruses, or parasites)
 that can cause disease in humans, animals, and plants. (EPA,
 December 1997)

 pcriphyton: Microscopic underwater plants and animals that are
 firmly attached to solid surfaces such as rocks, logs, and pilings.
 (EPA, December 1997)

 persistent organic pollutants:  Chemicals that endure in the
 environment and bioaccumulate as they move up trough the food
 chain. They  include organochlorine pesticides, polychlorinated
 biphenyls (PCBs), dioxins, and furans.

 pesticides:  Any substance or mixture  of substances intended to
 prevent, destroy, repel, or mitigate any pest. Pests can be insects,
 mice and other animals, unwanted plants (weeds), fungi, or
 microorganisms such as bacteria and viruses. Though often
 misunderstood to refer only to insecticides, the term "pesticide" also
 applies to herbicides, fungicides, and various other substances used
 to control pests. Under U.S. law, a pesticide is also any substance or
 mixture of substances intended for use as a plant regulator, defoliant,
 or desiccant.

 phosphorus:  An essential chemical food element that can
 contribute to the eutrophication of lakes and other, water bodies.
 Increased phosphorus levels result from discharge of
 phosphorus-containing materials into surface waters. (EPA,
 December 1997)

 photosynthesis: The manufacture by plants of carbohydrates and
 oxygen from carbon dioxide mediated by chlorophyll in the presence
 of sunlight. (EPA, December 1997)
           phytoplankton: That portion of the plankton community composed
           of tiny plants (e.g. algae, diatoms). (EPA, December 1997)

           playas:  Areas at the bottom of undrained desert basins that are
           sometimes covered with water. (EPA, OWOW, July 2002)

           PM2.s:  Fine particles that are less than or equal to 2.5 micrometers
           in diameter.

           PM-i0: Particles less than or equal to 10 micrometers in diameter.

           point source pollution: Effluent or discharges directly from a
           pipe into a waterway (e.g., from many industries and sewage
           treatment plants).
                      I

           pollutant: Generally, any substance introduced into the  environment
           that adversely affects the usefulness of a resource or the  health of
           humans, animals, or ecosystems.  (EPA, December 1997)

           pollution: Generally, the presence of a substance in the  environment
           that, because of its chemical composition or quantity, prevents the
           .functioning of natural processes and produces undesirable
           environmental and health effects. Under the Clean Water Act, for
           example, the term has been defined as the manmade or man-induced
           alteration of the physical, biological, chemical, and radiological integrity
           of water andi other media. (EPA, December 1997)

           polychlorinated biphenyls (PCBs):  A group of synthetic chemicals
           that can exist as oily liquids and waxy solids. Due to their
           non-flammability, chemical stability, high boiling point and electrical
           insulating properties, PCBs were used in hundreds of industrial and
           commercial applications including electrical, heat transfer, and
           hydraulic equipment; as plasticizers in paints, plastics and rubber
           products; in pigments, dyes and carbonless copy paper, and many
           other applications. PCBs can produce toxic effects and  are probable
           carcinogen. (EPA, OPPT, February 2003)

           pressure: 5>ee stressor.

           prevalence of disease: That part of the total population affected
           by a condition or disease.

           prevalence rate: The total number of persons with a given disease
           or condition in a specified population at a specified period of time.

           production capacity:  Chlorophyll per unit area for terrestrial
           ecosystems (including wetlands and riparian areas) and  per unit
           volume for aquatic ecosystems.

           productivity: The rate at which ecosystems use energy (principally
           solar energy) to fix atmospheric carbon dioxide.  (NRC, 2000)
 D-12
Glossary of Terms
Appendix D

-------


                              R
radioactive waste: Garbage, refuse, sludge, and other discarded
material, including solid, liquid, semisolid, or contained gaseous
material that must be managed for its radioactive content (DOE, July
1999). Types of radioactive waste include high-level waste, spent
nuclear fuel, transuranic waste, low-level waste, mixed low-level waste,
and contaminated media.

radon (Rn-222):  A naturally occurring radioactive gas that has no
color, odor, or taste and is chemically inert. Radon comes from the
radioactive decay of uranium in soil, rock, and ground water and is
found all over the U.S. It has a half-life of 3.8 days, emitting ionizing
radiation (alpha particles) during its radioactive decay to several
radioactive isotopes known as "radon decay products." It gets into
indoor air primarily from soil under homes and other buildings.
Radon is a known human lung carcinogen and represents the largest
fraction of the public's exposure to natural radiation.

rangelands: A National Resources Inventory land  cover/use
category on which the climax or potential plant cover is composed
principally of native grasses, grasslike plants, forbs or shrubs
suitable for grazing and browsing, and introduced forage species
that are managed like rangeland. This would include areas where
introduced hardy and persistent grasses, such as crested
wheatgrass, are planted and such practices as deferred grazing,
burning, chaining, and  rotational grazing are used, with little or no
chemicals  or fertilizer being applied. Grasslands, savannas, many
wetlands,  some deserts, and tundra are considered to be
rangeland. Certain communities of low forbs and shrubs, such as
mesquite,  chaparral, mountain shrub, and pinyon-juniper, are also
included as rangeland. (USDA, NRCS, 2000).

rare and at-risk species:  Rare species are those that are
particularly vulnerable to both human-induced threats and natural
fluctuations and hazards. At-risk species are those classified by the
Association for Biodiversity Information as vulnerable or more rare.

RCRA hazardous waste: Applies to certain types of hazardous
wastes that appear on EPA's regulatory listing (RCRA) or that exhibit
specific characteristics of ignitability, corrosiveness, reactivity, or
excessive toxicity.

red tide:  A common name for the phenomenon where certain
phytoplankton species contain reddish pigments and "bloom" such
that the water appears to be colored red.

regional and continental  areas:  Heterogeneous areas at regional
(e.g, Southeast) and continental scales composed of a cluster or
mosaic of interacting ecosystems.  Regional and continental
ecosystems are not characterized primarily by a dominant land cover
type such  as forests, farmlands, grasslands or urban  areas, but rather
           include many or all these ecosystems at these larger spatial scales.
           Regional and continental ecosystems reflect the underlying
           landscape patterns at these larger scales.

           relative risk: A measurement of the chance of contracting a disease
           in those who have been exposed to a risk factor compared with the
           risk for those who have not been exposed.

           remediation: Cleanup or other methods used to remove or contain
           a toxic spill or hazardous materials from a contaminated site.

           reserved forest land: Forested land withdrawn from timber
           utilization through statute, administrative regulation, or designation.
           (USDA, Forest Service, April 2001)

           richness:  A measure of species diversity, which usually decreases
           with impairment. It is based on the number of distinct taxa (at a level
           selected to identify, e.g., order, family, species); can be the total
           number of taxa, or the number in an identified group (e.g., number
           of mayfly taxa).

           rill:  A small channel eroded into the soil by surface runoff; can be
           easily smoothed out or obliterated by normal tillage. (EPA,
           December 1997)

           riparian area:  The area adjacent to streams and rivers, important as
           buffers to runoff. Many riparian areas include wetlands.

           riparian wetland:  A wetland along a stream or river.

           riparian zone:  A 30-meter buffer on each side of a stream or river.

           risk: The probability that a health problem, injury, or disease
           will occur.

           risk factor:  A characteristic (e.g., race, sex, age, obesity) or variable
           (e.g., smoking, occupational exposure level) associated with
           increased probability of an adverse effect.  (EPA, December 1997)

           runoff: That part of precipitation, snowmelt, or irrigation water that
           runs off the land into streams or other surface water. It can carry
           pollutants from the air and land into receiving waters.  (EPA,
           December 1997)

           rural transportation land: A National Resources Inventory land
           cover/use category that consists of all  highways, roads, railroads,
           and associated  right-of-ways outside urban and built-up areas;
           including private roads to farmsteads or ranch headquarters,
           logging roads, and other private roads, except field lanes. (USDA,
           NRCS, 2000)
Appendix D
Glossary of Terms
D-13

-------

                              s
secondhand smoke: See  environmental tobacco smoke.

sediment transport: The movement of sediment in rivers and
streams.

sedimentation: the process of forming or depositing sediment;
letting solids settle out of wastewater by gravity during treatment.

self-supplied water: Water not drawn from the public water supply.

silica: An inorganic compound mined from the earth; has been
found to be associated with lung cancer (Steenland, 1997). Silica is
used in foundries, pottery making, brick making, and sand blasting.

silviculture: The science of producing and tending a forest; the
theory and practice of control/ing forest establishment, composition,
and growth. (Matthews, 1989)

sludge:  Solid, semisolid, or liquid waste generated from a municipal,
commercial, or industrial waste water facility.

small built-up areas: A National Resources Inventory land
cover/use category consisting of developed land units of 0.25 to
10 acres, which meet the definition of urban and built-up areas.
(USDA, NRCS, 2000)

smart growth: The management of "urbanization"' that seeks to
serve the economy, the community, and the environment. Smart
growth seeks to foster healthy communities, a clean environment,
economic development and jobs, and strong neighborhoods with a
range of housing options.

softwood:  Coniferous trees, usually evergreen, that have needles or
scale-like leaves. (USDA, Forest Service, November 2002)

solid waste: Nonliquid, nonsoluble materials ranging from municipal
garbage to  industrial wastes that contain complex and sometimes
hazardous substances. Solid wastes also include sewage sludge,
agricultural refuse, demolition wastes, mining residues, and liquids
and gases in containers. (EPA, December 1997)

species richness: The absolute  number of species in an assemblage
or community.

spent nuclear fuel: Nuclear reactor fuel that has been used to the
extent that it can no longer effectively sustain a chafn reaction. (EPA,
December 2002)
           spray drift: The physical movement of a pesticide through air at the
           time of application, or soon thereafter, to any site other than that
           intended for application.

           sprawl:  See urban sprawl.

           squamous cell carcinoma: A type of skin cancer, usually curable if
           treated in time.

           stationary source: A place or object from which pollutants are
           released and that stays in one place. These sources include many
           types  of facilities, including power plants, gas stations, dry cleaners,
           incinerators, factories, and houses.

           stressor: A physical, chemical, or biological entity that can induce
           adverse effects on ecosystems or human health. (EPA, December 1997)

           submerged aquatic vegetation (SAV): Rooted vegetation that
           grows under water in shallow zones where light penetrates. (EPA,
           CBP, October 2002)

           Superfund:  The program operated under the legislative authority of
           the Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation, and
           Liability'Act (CERCLA) and the Superfund Amendments and
           Reauthorization Act (SARA) that funds and carries out EPA solid
           waste  emergency and long-term removal and remedial activities.
           These activities include establishing the National Priorities List,
           investigating sites for inclusion on the list, determining their priority,
           and conducting and/or supervising cleanup and other remedial
           actions. (EPA, December 1997)

           Superfund site:  Any land in the U.S. that has been contaminated
           by hazardous waste and identified by EPA as a candidate for cleanup
           because it poses a risk to human health, the environment, or both.

           surface eythemal:  Sun-burning UV radiation at earth=s surface.

           surface water: Water in rivers, streams, lakes, ponds, reservoirs,
           estuaries, and wetlands (found at the surface, in contrast to
           ground water).

           sustainability: Long-term management of ecosystems to meet the
           needs of present human populations without interruption,
           weakening, or loss of the resource base for future generations.
           (Environment Canada, 1997)
D-14
Glossary of Terms
Appendix U

-------

                              T
           troposphere: The layer of the atmosphere closest to the earth's
           surface. (EPA, December 1997)
thermoelectric water use: Use of water for cooling in the
generation of electric power.

threatened and endangered species: Those species that are in
danger of extinction throughout all or a significant portion of their
range or are likely to become endangered in the future. (Crondahl,
etal, July 1997)

threshold:  1 .The lowest dose of a chemical at which a specified
measurable effect is observed and  below which it is not observed.
2.The dose or exposure level below which a significant adverse effect
is not expected. (EPA, December 1997)

timber land:  Forest land that is capable of producing crops of
industrial wood (at least 20 cubic feet  per acre per year in natural
stands) and not withdrawn from timber use by statute or
administrative  regulation. (USDA, Forest Service, April 2001)

total off-site releases: The total annual amount (in pounds) of a
toxic chemical  transferred from a facility to publicly owned treatment
works (POTW) or to an off-site location (non-POTW). (EPA, TRI,
November 2002)

total on-site releases: The total annual release quantities (in
pounds) of a chemical to air, water, on-site land, and underground
injection wejls. (EPA, TRI, November 2002)

Toxics Release Inventory (TRI): A publicly available EPA database
that contains information on toxic  chemical releases and other waste
management activities reported annually by certain covered
industries and federal facilities. TRI was established under the
Emergency Planning and Community Right-to-Know Act of 1986
(EPCRA) and expanded by the Pollution Prevention Act of 1990.   -
(EPA, TRI, December 2002)

toxic substance:  Any substance that presents a significant risk of
injury to health or the environment through exposure.

toxic waste: A waste that can produce injury if inhaled, swallowed,
or absorbed through the skin. (EPA, December 1997)

transuranic waste: A category of radioactive waste. It contains
elements that have atomic numbers higher than uranium (92), such
as plutonium; results primarily from past nuclear weapons production
and cleanup of nuclear weapons facilities.

trophic status: Classification of a lake or water body as eutrophic,
oligotrophic, mesotrophic, or hypertrophic.
                                        U
           ultraviolet (UV) radiation  Radiation from the sun that can be
           useful or potentially harmful. UV radiation from one part of the
           spectrum (UV-A) enhance plant life. UV radiation from other parts of
           the spectrum (UV-B) can cause skin cancer or other tissue damage.
           The ozone layer in the atmosphere partly shields earth from UV
           radiation reaching the surface. (EPA, December 1997)

           underground storage tanks: Tanks and their underground piping
           that have at least 10 percent of their combined volume underground.

           urban and built-up areas:  A National Resources Inventory land
           cover/use category consisting of residential/ industrial, commercial,
           and institutional land construction sites; public administrative sites;
           railroad yards; cemeteries; airports; golf courses; sanitary structures
           and spillways; small parks (less than 10 acres) within urban and
           built-up areas; and highways, railroads, and other transportation
           facilities if they are surrounded by urban areas. Also included are
           tracts of less than 10 acres that do not meet the above definition
           but are completely surrounded by urban and built-up land. (USDA,
           NRCS, 2000)

           urbanized areas (UAs) and urban clusters (UCs):  Densely settled
           areas consisting of core census block groups that have a population
           density of at least 1,000 people per square mile and other
           surrounding census blocks that have an overall density of at least
           500 people per square mile. UAs contain 50,000 or more people;
           UCs contain at least 2,500  people but fewer than 50,000. (U.S.
           Census Bureau,  2001)

           urban and suburban areas: Places where the land is primarily
           devoted to buildings, houses, roads, concrete, grassy lawns, and
           other elements of human use and construction. .Urban and suburban
           areas, in which about three-fourths of all Americans live, span a
           range of density, from the city center-characterized by high-rise
           buildings and little green space-to the suburban fringe-where
           development thins to a rural landscape. This definition does not
           include all developed lands,  for example, small residential zones, the
           area of rural interstate highways, farmsteads, and the like, which are
           "developed but are not sufficiently built up to be considered "urban
           or suburban." (The Heinz Center, 2002)

           urbanization: The concentration of development in relatively small
           areas (cities and suburbs). The U.S. Census Bureau defines "urban"
           as areas with densities of people above 1.5  people per acre.
Appendix D
Glossary of Terms
D-15

-------
                                   	  •    •   • ••<••    ..•,  .-'.:: :.,.i,;: :
                         V-Z
vehicle miles traveled:  A measure of the extent of motor vehicle
operation; the total number of vehicle miles traveled by all vehicles
within a specific geographic area over a given period of time. Vehicle
miles traveled and other variables are used to estimate air pollutant
emissions.
           wetland ecosystems:  Areas that are inundated or saturated by
           surface or ground water at a frequency and duration sufficient to
           support, and that under normal circumstances do support, a
           prevalence of vegetation typically adapted for life in saturated soil
           conditions. Wetlands generally include swamps, marshes, bogs and
           similar areas.
vernal pools:  Seasonal wetlands that occur under the
Mediterranean climate conditions of the West Coast. They are
covered by shallow water for variable periods from winter to spring
but may be completely dry for most of the summer and fall. These
wetlands range in size from small puddles to shallow lakes and are
usually found in a gently sloping plain of grassland. Beneath vernal
pools lies either bedrock or a hard clay layer in the soil that helps
keep water in the pool.

volatile organic compounds: Chemicals, such as gasoline and
perthloroethylene (a dry cleaning solvent) that contain carbon and
vaporize readily.

waste minimization priority chemicals: A group of 30
chemicals—3  metals (lead,  mercury, and cadmium) and 27 organic
compounds—identified as the highest priority for reduction in
industrial and hazardous waste.

water clarity:  A measure of how clear a body of water is; measured
In the distance light penetrates into the water.

water quality  criteria: Levels of water quality expected to render a
body of water  suitable for its designated use. Criteria are based on
specific levels of pollutants that would make the water harmful if
used for drinking, swimming, irrigation, fish production, or industrial
processes.  (EPA, December  1997)

water qualify  standards: State-adopted and EPA-approved ambient
standards for water bodies.  The standards define the water quality
goals of a water body by designating the uses of the water and
setting criteria to protect those uses. The standards protect public
health and  welfare, enhance the quality of the water, and provide the
baseline for surface water protection under the Clean Water Act.

waterborne disease outbreak:  is defined as an event in which (1)
more than two persons have experienced an  illness after either the
ingestion of drinking water or exposure to water encountered in
recreational or occupational settings, and (2) epidemiologic
evidence implicates water as the probable source of illness.

watershed: An area of land from which all water that drains from it
flows to a single water body.
D-16
Glossary of Terms
Appendix D

-------
Appendix E
 References

-------

                   Chapter  1:
                 CJeaner  Air
CNN.com. "Asian Brown Cloud" poses global threat. August 12,
2002 (August 12, 2002; http://mm.cnn.com/2002/WORLD/
asiapcf/south/08/12/asia.haze.glb/index.html).

Centers for Disease Control. Blood lead levels in young children -
United States and selected states, 1996-1999. Morbidity and
Mortality Weekly Report 49 (SO): 1133 (2000).

Centers for Disease Control, National Center for Health Statistics.
Asthma prevalence, health care use and mortality, 2000-2001.
January 28, 2003. (February 14, 2003; http://www.cdc.gov/nchs/
products/pubs/pubd/hestats/asthma/asthma.htm).

DcMora, S, S. Demers, and M. Vemet The Effects ofUV Radiation in the
Marine Environment, Cambridge, UK: Cambridge University Press, 2000.

Friedman, Michael S., K.E. Powell, L Hutwagner, LM. Graham, and
W.G. Teague. Impacts of changes in transportation and commuting
behaviors during the 1996 Summer Olympics Games in Atlanta on
air qualify and childhood asthma. The Journal of the American Medical
Association 285 (7): 897-905  (2001).

Hackshaw, A.K. Lung cancer and passive smoking. Statistical Methods
in Medical Research 7 (2): 119-136 (1998).

Mannino, D.M,, J.E. Moorman, B. Ingsley, D. Rose, and J. Repace.
Health effects related to environmental tobacco smoke exposure in
children in the United States: data from the third National Health
and Nutritional Examination Survey. Archives ofPediatric and
Adolescent Medicine 155 (1): 36- 41 (2001).

McConnell, R.K. Berhane, F. Gilliland, S.J. London, T. Islam, W.
Gauderman, A, James, M. Edward, H.G. Margolis, and J.M. Peters.
Asthma in exercising children exposed to ozone: a cohort study. The
lancet 359: 386-391  (2002).

Montzka, S A, J.H. Butler, J.W. Elkins, T.M. Thompson, A.D. Clarke,
and L.T. Lock. Present and future trends in the atmospheric burden
of ozone-depleting halogens. Nature 398: 690-694 (1999).

National Acid Precipitation Assessment Program. Acid Deposition: State
of Science and Technology. Volume  II. Aquatic Processes and Effects,
Washington, DO National Acid Precipitation Assessment Program, 1991.
       National Aeronautics and Space Administration. Ozone Levels Over
       North America - NIMBUS- 7/TOMS. March 1979 and March 1994.
       (January 24, 2003; http://epa.gov/ozone/science/glob_dep.htm\).

       National Aeronautics and Space Administration, Advanced
       Supercomputing Division. August 14, 2002. (August 14, 2002;
       http://www.nas.nasa.gov/About/Education/Ozone.html).

       National Research Council. Health Effects of Exposure to Radon: BEIR
       VI; Sixth Committee on Biological Effects of Ionizing Radiation,
       Washington, DC: National Academies Press, 1998.

       Northeast Slates for Coordinated Air Use Management (NESCAUM).
       Why clean air? 2003. (August, 2002; http://www.nescaum.org/
       cleanair.html).

       Pope, C.A., III, R.T. Burnett, M.J. Thun, E.E. Calle, D. Krewski, K. Ito,
       and G.D. Thurston. Lung cancer, cardiopulmonary mortality, and
       long-term exposure to fine particulate air pollution. Journal of
       American Medical Association 287: 1132-1141  (2002).

       Scientific Assessment Panel of the Montreal Protocol on Substances
       that Deplete the Ozone Layer. Scientific Assessment of Ozone
       Depletion: 2002, Executive Summary, Report No. 47. Geneva,
       Switzerland: World Meteorological Organization, Global Ozone
       Research and Monitoring Project, 2003.

       The H. John Heinz III Center for Science, Economics, and the
       Environment. The State of the Nation's Ecosystems: Measuring the
       Lands, Waters, and Living Resources of the United States, New York, NY:
       Cambridge University Press, September  2002.

       National Oceanic and Atmospheric administration, Climate
       Monitoring &. Diagnostics Laboratory. Haolcarbons and other
       Atmospheric Trace Species (HATS). 2002. March 18, 2003;
       http://www.emdl.noaa.gov/hats/graphs/graphs.html).

       United Nations Environment Programme. Environmental Effects of
       Ozone Depletion: 1994 Assessment, Nairobi, Kenya: United Nations
       Environment Programme, Secretariat for The Vienna Convention for
       the Protection of the Ozone Layer and The Montreal Protocol on
       Substances that Deplete the Ozone Layer, November 1994.

       United Nations Environment Programme. Production and Consumption
       of Ozone Depleting Substances under the Montreal Protocol 1986-
       2000, Nairobi, Kenya: United Nations Environment Programme,
       Secretariat for The Vienna Convention for the Protection of the
       Ozone Layeir and The Montreal Protocol on Substances that Deplete
       the Ozone Layer, April 2002.

       United States-Canada Air Quality Committee. Ground-Level Ozone:
       Occurrence and Transport in Eastern North America; A Report by the
       United States-Canada Air Quality Committee; Subcommittee 1: Program
E-2
References
Appendix t

-------
Monitoring and Reporting, Washington, DC and Ottawa, Ontario:
International Joint Commission, March 1999.

United States  Code. Clean Air Act, as amended in 1990, Title 1: Air
Pollution Prevention and Control. 42 U.S.C 7408 and 7409.

U.S. Department of Agriculture. National Report on Sustainable
Forests - 2003, Final Draft, Washington, DC: U.S. Department of
Agriculture,  Forest Service, 2002.

U.S. Department of Education, National Center for Education
Statistics. Condition of America's Public School Facilities: 1999, NCES
2000-032. June 2000.

U.S. Department of Health and Human Services, National Center for
Health Statistics. Healthy People 2000 Final Review, DHHS Publication
No. 01 -0256.  Hyattsville, MD: Public Health Service, October 2001.

U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Air Quality Criteria for
Particulate Matter and Sulfur Oxides, EPA 600-P-82-020a-c. Research
Triangle Park, NC: U.S. Environmental  Protection Agency, Office of
Research and Development, Environmental Criteria and Assessment
Office, 1982.

U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Second Addendum to the Air
Quality Criteria for Particulate Matter and Sulfur Oxides (T982):
Assessment of Newly Available Health Effects Information, EPA-4SO- 5-
86-012. Research Triangle Park, NC: U.S. Environmental Protection
Agency, Office of Research and Development, Environmental Criteria
and Assessment  Office, 1986.

U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Regulatory Impact Analysis:
Protection of Stratospheric Ozone, Washington, DC: U.S. Environmental
Protection Agency, Stratospheric Protection Program, Office of
Program Development, Office  of Air and Radiation, August 1988.

U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Non-occupational Pesticide
Exposure Study, EPA-600-3-90-003. Research Triangle Park, NC: U.S.
Environmental  Protection Agency, Atmospheric Research and
Exposure Assessment Laboratory, January 1990.

U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. National Residential Radon
Survey: Summary  Report, EPA-402-  R-92-011. Washington, DC: U.S.
Environmental  Protection Agency, Office of Air and Radiation,
October 1992.

U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Respiratory Health Effects of
Passive Smoking: Lung Cancer and Other Disorders, EPA 600-6-90-
006 F. Washington, DC: U.S. Environmental  Protection Agency, Office
of Research  and  Development, Office of Health and Environmental
Assessment, December 1992.

U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Air Quality Criteria for Oxides of
Nitrogen, EPA 600-8-91 - 049aF-cF Research Triangle Park, NC: U.S.
        Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Research and Development,
        Environmental Criteria and Assessment Office, August 1993.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Map of radon zones. EPA
        402-F-93-013. September 1993. http://www.epa.gov/iaq/
        radon/zonemap.html).

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. A Standardized EPA Protocol.for
        Characterizing Indoor Air Quality in Large Office Buildings, Washington,
        DC: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Research and
        Development and Office of Air and Radiation, June 1994.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Supplement to the Second
        Addendum (1986) to the Air Quality Criteria for Particulate Matter and
        Sulfur Oxides (1982): Assessment of New Findings on Sulfur Dioxide
        Acute Exposure Health Effects in Asthmatic Individuals, EPA 600-FP-93-
        002. Research Triangle Park, NC: U.S. Environmental Protection
        Agency, Office of Research and  Development, Office of Health and
        Environmental Assessment, Environmental Criteria and Assessment
        Office, August 1994.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Regulatory Impact Analysis for
        the Petroleum Refinery-NESHAP, EPA 452-R-9S-004. Research Triangle
        Park, NC: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Air Quality
        Planning and Standards, July 1995.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Air Quality Criteria for
        Particulate Matter, EPA  600-P-95- 001 aF-cF.3v. Research Triangle
        Park, NC: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Research
        and Development, National Center for Environmental Assessment,
        April 1996.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Air Quality Criteria for Ozone
        and Related Photochemical Oxidants, EPA 600-P-93-004aF-cF.
        Research Triangle Park, NC: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency,
        Office of Research and Development, National Center for
        Environmental Assessment July  1996.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Regulatory Impact Analysis for
        the Particulate Matter and Ozone National Ambient Air Quality
        Standards and Proposed Regional Haze Rule, Research Triangle Park,
        NC: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Air Quality
        Planning and Standards, July 1997.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Mercury Study Report to
        Congress, EPA-452-R-97-003. Research Triangle Park, NC: U.S.
        Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Air Quality Planning and
        Standards and Office of Research and Development, December 1997.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. 40 CFR Part 50: National
        ambient air quality standards for particulate matter; final rule. Federal
        Register 62 (138): 2-102 (1997).
Appendix £
References
E-3

-------
U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. National Air Qualify and
Emissions Trends Reports, 1997, EPA 454-R-98-016. Research Triangle
Park, NC: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Air Quality
Planning and Standards, December 1998.

U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. The Benefits and Costs of the
Chan AirAci: 1990 to 2010. final Report to Congress, EPA 410-R-99-
001. Washington, DC: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office
of Air and Radiation, Office of Policy, November 1999.

U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Air Quality Criteria for Carbon
Monoxide, EPA 600-P-99-001F. Research Triangle Park, NC: U.S:
Environmental Protection Agency, Office Research and Development,
National Center for Environmental Assessment. June 2000.

U.S, Environmental Protection Agency. National Air Quality and
Emissions Trends Report, 1999, EPA 454-R-01 -004. Research Triangle
Park, NC: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Air Quality •
Planning and Standards, March 2001.

U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Latest Findings on National Air
Quality: 2000 Status and Trends, EPA 454-K-01 -002. Research
Triangle Park, NC: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of
Air Qualify Planning and Standards, September 2001.

U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Air Trends: Metropolitan area
trends, Table A-17. 2001. (February 25, 2003; http://www.epa.gov/
airtrends/metro.html).

U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Air Quality Criteria for
Pariiculate Matter, Third External Review Draft, Volume II, EPA 600-P-
99-002bC Research Triangle Park, NC: U.S. Environmental
Protection Agency, Office of Research and Development, National
Center for Environmental Assessment, April 2002.

U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Inventory of U.S. Greenhouse
Cos Emissions and Sinks: 1990- 2000, EPA 430-R-02-003.
Washington, DC: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of
Atmospheric Programs, April 2002.
       U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Air and Radiation,
       Technology Transfer Network. National air toxic assessment:
       summary of results. September 18, 2002 (January 27, 2003;
       http://www.epa.gov/ttn/atw/nata/risksum.html).

       U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Latest Findings on National Air
       Quality: 200) Status and Trends, EPA 4S4-K-02-001. Research
       Triangle Park,  NC: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of
       Air Quality Planning and Standards, September 2002.

       U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. EPA Acid Rain Program: 2001
       Progress Report, EPA 430-R-02- 009. Washington, DC: U.S.
       Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Air and Radiation,
       November 2002.

       U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. 40 CFR Part 50: National
       ambient air quality standards for ozone:  final response to remand;
       final rule. Federal Register 68 (3): 614-645 (2003).

       U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Response of Surface Water
       Chemistry to the Clean Air Act Amendments of 1990, EPA 620-R-03-
       001. Research Triangle Park, NC: U.S. Environmental Protection
       Agency, Office of Research and Development, National Health and
       Environmental Effects Research Laboratory, January 2003.

       U.S. General Accounting Office. Pesticides: Use, Effects, and
       Alternatives to Pesticides in Schools, CAO/RCED-00-17. Washington,
       DC: U.S.  General Accounting Office, Resources, Community, and
       Economic Development Division, 1999.

       U.S. Institute of Medicine, Committee on the Health Effects of
       Indoor Allergens. Indoor Allergens: Assessing and Controlling Adverse
       Health Effects, Washington, DC: National Academy Press, 1993.

       U.S. Institute of Medicine, Committee on the Assessment of Asthma
       and Indoor Air. Clearing the Air: Asthma and Indoor Air Exposures,
       Executive  Summary, Washington, DC: National Academy Press,  2000.
E-4
References
Appendix E

-------
                                        ^

U.S. International Trade Commission. 7993. Synthetic Organic
chemicals; U.S. Production and Sales, Washington DC: Government
Printing Office, 1994.

Wingo, Phyllis A., Ries, Lynn A.C., Giovino, Gary A., et al. Annual
report to the nation on the status of cancer, 1973-1996, with a
special section on lung cancer and tobacco smoking. Journal of the
National Cancer Institute 91 (8): 675-690 (1999).
                          (Chapter 2:
                         "Purer  Water
       Alley, W.M., T.E. Reilly, and O.L. Franke. Sustainabilify of Ground-water
       Resources, U.S. Geological Survey Circular 1186. Denver, CO: U.S.
       Geological Survey, 1999.

       Baker, L.A., A. Herlihy, P. Kaufmann, and J. Eilers. Acid lakes and
       streams in the United States: the role of acid deposition. Science
       252:1151-1154(1991).

       Batiuk, R.A., P. Bergstrom, M. Kemp, E. Koch, L. Murray, J.C.
       Stevenson,  R. Bartleson, V. Carter, N.B. Rybicki, J.M. Landwehr, C.
       Gallegos, L. Karrh, M. Naylor, D. Wilcox, K.A. Moore, S. Ailstock, and
       M. Teichberg. Chesapeake Bay Submerged Aquatic Vegetation Water
       Quality and Habitat- Based Requirements and Restoration Targets: A
       Second Technical Synthesis, CBP-TRS 245-00, EPA 903-R-00-014.
       Annapolis, MD: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Chesapeake
       Bay Program,  2000.

       Boesch, D.F., R.B. Brinsfield,  and R.E. Magnien. Chesapeake Bay
       eutrophication: scientific understanding, ecosystem restoration, and
       challenges for agriculture. Journal of Environmental Quality 30: 303-
       320 (2001).

       Bricker, S.B., C.G. Clement, D.E. Pirhalla, S.P. Orlando, and D.R.G.
       Farrow. National Estuarine Eutrophication Assessment Effects of
       Nutrient Enrichment in the Nation's Estuaries, Silver Spring, MD:
       National Oceanic and Atmospheric Administration, National Ocean
       Service, Special Projects Office and the National Centers for Coastal
       Ocean Science, 1999.

       Chapman, P.M., R.N. Dexter,  and E.R. Long. Synoptic measures of
       sediment contamination, toxicity, and infaunal community
       composition (the sediment quality triad) in San Francisco Bay.
       Marine Ecology Progress Series 37: 75-96 (1987).

       Committee  on Environment and Natural Resources of the National
       Science and Technology Council. Integrated Assessment ofHypoxia in
       the Northern Gulf of Mexico, Washington, DC:  National Science and
       Technology Council Committee on Environment and Natural
       Resources, 2000.

       Council for Agricultural Science and Technology. Gulf of Mexico
       Hypoxia: Land and Sea Interactions, Report 134. Ames,  IA: Council  for
       Agricultural Science and Technology, June 1999.
Appendix
References
E-5

-------

Cowardin, LM., V. Garten EC. Golet, and E.T. LaRoe. Classification of
Wetlands and Deepwater Habitats of the United States, FW/OBS-
79/31. Washington, DO U.S. Fish and Wildlife Service, 1979.

Dahl, T.E. Status and Trends of Wetlands in the Conterminous United
States 1986 to 1997, Washington, DC: U.S. Department of the
Interior, U.S. Fish and Wildlife Service, 2000.

Dahl, T.E. Wetland Losses in the United States 1780's to 1980's.
Washington, DC: U.S. Department of the Interior, Fish and Wildlife
Service, 1990.

Dahl, T.E., and C.E. Johnson. Status and Trends of Wetlands in the
Conterminous United States, Mid-1970s to Mid-1980, Washington, DC:
U.S. Department of the Interior, U.S. Fish and Wildlife Service, 1991.

Danielson, T. J. Wetland Bioassessment Fact Sheets,  EPA 843-F-98-
001 a-j. Washington, DC:  U.S. Environmental Protection Agency,
Office of Wetlands, Oceans, and Watersheds, Wetlands Division,
July 1998.

Davis, D.G. North American Birds - A Rough Assessment of Wetland
Dependency., unpublished. Preparation for a presentation given at
the Wetlands, Migratory Birds, and Ecotourism Workshop in
Newburyport, Massachusetts, October 24, 2000.

Day Boylan, K. and D.R. Maclean. Linking species loss with wetland
loss. National Wetlands Newsletter 19 (6), (Nov/Dec 1997).

Diaz, RJ. and R. Rosenberg. Marine benthic hypoxia: a review of its
ecological effects and  the behavioural responses of benthic
macrofauna. Oceanography and Marine Biology Annual Review 33:
245-303 (1995).

Duda, A.M. Municipal point source and agricultural nortpoint source
contributions to coastal eutrophication. Water Resources Bulletin 18:
397-407 (1982).

Environment Canada and U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. The
Great Lakes, An Environmental Atlas and Resource Book, Toronto, Ont:
Government of Canada and Chicago, IL: United States Environmental
Protection Agency, Great Lakes National Program Office, 1995.

Fisher, S.G. Stream ecosystems of the western United States. In
C.E. Gushing, K.W. Cummings, G.W. Minshall (eds.), River and
Stream Ecosystems, Ecosystems of the World 22, New York, NY:
Elsevier Press, 1995.

Prayer, W.E., TJ. Monahan, D.C. Bowden, and RA. Graybill. Status and
Trends of Wetlands and Deepwater Habitats in the Conterminous United
States, WSO's to 1970's,  Fort Collins, CO: Colorado State University,
Department of Forest and Wood Sciences,  1983.
        Gilliom, R.J., D.K. Mueller, J.S. Zogorski, and SJ. Ryker. A national look
        at water quality. Water Resources Impact 4: 12-16 (2002).

        Houser, L.S. a'nd F.J. Silva. National Register of Shellfish Production
        Areas, PHS Publication No. 1500. Washington, DC: U.S. Department
        of Health, Education, and Welfare, Public Health Service, Division of
        Environmental! Engineering and Food Protection, Shellfish Sanitation
        Branch, 1966.

        Hoxie, N.J., J.P. Davis, J.M. Vergeront, R.D. Nashold, and K.A. Blair.
        Cryptosporicliosis - associated mortality following a massive
        waterborne outbreak in Milwaukee, Wl. American Journal of Public
        Health 87 (12): 2032-2035 (1997).

        Kaufmann, PR., P. Levine, E.G. Robison, C.  Seeliger, and D.V. Peck.
        Surface waters: Quantifying Physical Habitat in Wadeable Streams, EPA
        620-R-99-003. Washington, DC: U.S. Environmental Protection
        Agency, Office of Research and Development, July 1999.

        National Atmospheric Deposition Program, Mercury Deposition
        Network. Total Mercury Wet Deposition, 2001. 2001. (March 25,
        2003; http://nadp.sws.uiuc.edu/mdn/maps/2001/01 MDNdepo.pdf)

        National Atmopheric Deposition Program, National Trends Network.
        Nitrate ion wet deposition, 2001. 2001. (March 25, 2003;
        http://nadp.swsMiuc.edu/isopleths/maps2001/no3dep.pdf)

        National Atmopheric Deposition Program, National Trends Network.
        Ammonium ion wet deposition, 2001. 2001. (March 25, 2003;
        http://nadp.sws.uiuc.edu/isopleths/maps20.01/hh4dep.pdf)

        National Oceanic and Atmospheric Administration. The 1990
        National Shellfish Register of Classified Estuarine Waters, Rockville, MD:
        ORCA Strategic Environmental Assessments Division, 1991.

        National Oceanic and Atmospheric Administration. The 1995
        National Shellfish Register of Classified Crowing Waters, Silver Spring,
        MD: ORCA, Office of Ocean Resources Conservation and
        Assessment, Strategic Environmental Assessments Division, 1997.

        National Oceanic and Atmospheric Administration. Population:
        distribution, density and growth,  NOAA's State of the Coast Report.
        Silver Spring, MD. 1998.  (February 2003; http://state-of-coast
        noaa.gov/bulletins/html/pop_01/pop.html).

        National Research Council. Clean Coastal Waters: Understanding and
        Reducing the Effects of Nutrient Pollution, Washington, DC: National
        Academies Press, 2000.               '    " _    .

        Nixon, S.W. Coastal marine eutrophication: a definition, social
        causes, and future concerns. Ophelia 41: 199-219 (1995).
E-6
References
Appendix t

-------
                                       'ocurnem

Paul, J.F., J.H. Gentile, K.J. Scott, S.C Schimmel, D.E. Campbell, and
R.W. Latimer. EMAP - Virginian Province Four-year Assessment Report
(1990-1993), EPA 620-R-99-004. Narragansett, Rl: U.S.
Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Research and
Development,  Atlantic Ecology Division. October 1999.

Peierls, B.L., N.F. Caraco, M.L. Pace, and JJ. Cole.  Human influence on
river nitrogen. Nature 350: 386-387  (1991).

Peterson, S.A., N.S. Urquhart, and E.B. Welch. Sample representativeness:
a must for reliable regional lake condition  estimates. Environmental Science
and Technology  33 (10): 1559-1565 (1999).

Rippey, S.R. Infectious diseases associated with molluscan shellfish
consumption.  Clinical Microbiology Review 7 (4): 419-425 (1994).

Schindler, D.W. Evolution of phosphorus limitation in lakes. Science
179: 260-262 (1977).

Schlesinger, W.H. Biogeochemistry: An Analysis ofClobal Change, San
Diego, CA: Academic Press, 1997.

Solley, W.B., R.R. Pierce, and H.A. Perlman. Estimated Use of Water in
the United States in  1995, U.S. Geological Survey Circular 1200.
Denver, CO: U.S. Geological Survey, 1998.

Smith, R.A., G.E. Schwarz, and R.B. Alexander. Regional interpretation
of water-quality monitoring data. Water Resources Research 33:
2781-2798 (1997).

Stoddard, J. L, A. D. Newell,  N. S. Urquhart, and  D. Kugler. The TIME
project design: II. Detection  of regional acidification trends. Water
Resources Research 32: 2529-2538 (1996).

Stoddard, J. L, C. T. Driscoll, S. Kahl, and J. Kellogg. Can site-specific
trends be extrapolated to a region? An acidification example for the
Northeast. Ecological Applications 8: 288-299 (1998).

The H. John Heinz  III Center for Science, Economics, and the
Environment. The State of the Nation's Ecosystems: Measuring the
Lands, Waters,  and Living Resources of the United States, New York, NY:
Cambridge University Press, September 2002.

Thrush, W.J., S.M. McBain, and  L.B. Leopold. Attributes of an alluvial
river and their relation to water policy and management. Proceedings
of the National Academy of Sciences 97 (22): 11858-11863 (2000)
Turner, R.E. and N.N. Rabalais. Changes in Mississippi River water
quality this century, implications for coastal food webs. BioScience
41:140-147(1991).
        U.S. Department of Agriculture, Natural Resources Conservation
        Service. Summary Report: 1997 National Resources Inventory (Revised
        December 2000), Washington, DC: Natural Resources Conservation
        Service and Ames, IA: Iowa State University, Statistical Laboratory,
        December 1999, revised December 2000.

        U.S. Department of Commerce and U.S. Department of Health and
        Human Services.  1985 National Shellfish Register of Classified Estuarine
       .Waters, Rockville, MD: National Oceanic and Atmospheric
        Administration, Ocean Assessments Division and Kingstown, Rl: Food
        and Drug Administration, Shellfish Sanitation Branch, 1985.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. National Shellfish Register of
        Classified Estuarine Waters, 1974,  Denver, CO: U.S. Environmental
        Protection Agency, Office of Enforcement, National Enforcement
        Investigations Center, 1975.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Quality Criteria for Water -
        1986, EPA 440-5-86-001. Washington, DC: U.S. Environmental
        Protection Agency, Office of Water, November 1986.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. America's Wetlands: Our Vital
        Link Between Land and Water, EPA 843-K-95-001. Washington, DC:
        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Wetlands, Oceans
        and Watersheds, December 1995.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Guidelines for Preparation of
        the Comprehensive State Water Quality Assessments (305(b) Reports)
        and Electronic Updates, Report Contents and Supplement, EPA 841 -B-
        97-002A and EPA 841-B-97-002B. Washington, DC: U.S.
        Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Water, September 1997.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Mercury Report to Congress,
        Volume I, Washington, DC: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency,
        Office of Water, December 1997.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, National Strategy for the
        Development of Regional Nutrient Criteria, EPA 822-R-98-002.
        Washington, DC: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of
        Water, June 1998.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Action Plan for Beaches and
        Recreational Waters, EPA  600- R-98-079. Washington, DC: U.S.
        Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Research and
        Development and Office of Water, March 1999.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. 25 Years of the Safe Drinking Water
       Act: History and Trends, EPA 816-R-99-007. Washington, DC: U.S.
        Environmental Protection  Agency, Office of Water, December 1999.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Deposition of Air Pollutants to
        the Great Waters. Third Report to Congress, EPA 453-R-00-005.
Appendix ;t
References
E-7

-------

Research Triangle Park, NC: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency,
Office of Air Quality Planning and Standards, June 2000.

U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Mid-Atlantic Highlands Streams
Assessment, EPA 903-R-OO- 015. Philadelphia, PA: U.S. Environmental
Protection Agency, Office of Research and Development, Region 3,
August 2000.

U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Ambient Water Quality Criteria
for Dissolved Oxygen (Saltwater): Cape Cod to Cape Hatteras, EPA
822-R-00-012. Washington, DC: U.S. Environmental Protection
Agency, Office of Water, October 2000.

U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. National Listing of Fish and
Wildlife Advisories (NLFWA). June 2001.

U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Water. National
listing of Fish and Wildlife Advisories (NLFWA) Mercury Fish Tissue
Database. June 2001.

U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. National Coastal Condition
Report, EPA 620-R-01-005. Washington DC: U.S. Environmental
Protection Agency, Office of Research and Development and Office
of Water, September 2001.

U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Mercury Maps: Linking Air
Deposition and Fish Contamination on a National Scale, EPA 823-F-01 -
026. Washington, DC: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office
of Water, November 2001.

U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. The Incidence and Severity of
Sediment Contamination in Surface Waters of the United States,
National Sediment Quality Survey: Second Edition, DRAFT, EPA 823-R-
01 -01. Washington, DC: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency,
Office of Water, December 2001.

U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Function and Values of Wetlands
fact Sheet, EPA 843-F-01 -002c. Washington, DC: U.S. Environmental
Protection Agency, Office of Water, Office of Wetlands, Oceans, and
Watersheds, March 2002.

U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. 2001 National Listing of Fish and
WiWfe Advisories, EPA 823-F-02-010. Washington, DC: U.S.
Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Water, May 2002. 2002b

U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Update: National Listing of Fish
and Wildlife Advisories, EPA 823-F-02-007. Washington, DC: U.S.
Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Water, May 2002. 2002a

U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. 2000 Toxics Release Inventory
Public Data Release Report, EPA 260-S-02-001. Washington, DC: U.S.
Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Environmental
Information, May 2002.
       U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. EPA's Beach Watch Program:
       2001 Swimming Season, EPA 823-F-02-006. Washington, DC: U.S.
       Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Water, May 2002.

       U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Consolidated Assessment and
       Listing Methodology-Toward a Compendium of Best Practices,  First
       Edition, Washington, DC: U.S. Environmental  Protection Agency,
       Office of Water, July 2002.

       U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Response of Surface Water
       Chemistry to the Clean Air Act Amendments of 1990, EPA 620-R-03-
       001. Research Triangle Park, NC: U.S. Environmental Protection
       Agency, Office of Research and Development, National Health and
       Environmentcil Effects Research Laboratory, January 2003.

       U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Water. National
       Section 303(d) List Fact Sheet. March 10, 2003. (February 14,
       2003; http://oaspub.epa.gov/waters/national_rept.control).

       U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Mid-Atlantic Integrated Assessment,
       MAIA - Estuafies 1997- 98, Summary Report, EPA 620-R-02-003.
       Narragansett, Rl: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of
       Research and Development, Atlantic Ecology Division, May 2003.

       U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Water. Safe Drinking
       Water Information System/Federal Version (SDWIS/FED). 2003.

       U.S. Fish ami Wildlife Service. 2007 National Survey of Fishing,
       Hunting, and Wildlife-Associated Recreation, National Overview,
       Washington, DC: U.S. Department of the Interior, U.S. Fish and
       Wildlife Service and U.S. Department of Commerce, October 2002.

       U.S. Food aind Drug Administration. 1971 National Shellfish Register of
       Classified Estuarine Waters, Davisville, Rl: Public Health Service,
       Shellfish Sanitation Branch,  Northeast Technical Services Unit, 1971.

       U.S. Food and Drug Administration. National Shellfish Sanitation
       Program Manual of Operations: Part I, Sanitation of Shellfish  Crowing
       Areas, 1993 Revision, Washington, DC: Center for Food Safety and
       Applied Nutrition, 1993.

       U.S. Geological Survey. Strategic Directions for the U.S. Geological
       Survey Ground-Water Resources Program: A Report to Congress. Reston,
       VA: U.S. Geological Survey,  November 30, 1998.

       U.S. Geological Survey. The  Qualify of Our Nation's Water, U.S.
       Geological Survey Fact Sheet 116-99. Reston, VA: U.S. Geological
       Survey, 1999.

       U.S. Geological Survey. Report to Congress, Concepts for National
       Assessment of Water Availability and Use, U.S. Geological Survey
       Circular 1223. Reston, VA: U.S. Geological Survey, 2002.
 E-8
References
Appendix t

-------

                  CJnapter  3:
      "Better  "Protected  Land:
Agency of Toxic Substances and Disease Registry. CERCLA priority
list of hazardous substances. 2001. (September 2002;
http://www.atsdr.cdc.gov/clist.html).

Alaska  Department of Natural Resources. Fact Sheet: Land
Ownership in Alaska. March, 2000. (September 2002;
http://www. dnr.state. ak. us/mlw/factsht/land_own.pdf).

Amdur, M.O., J. Doull and C.D. Klassen (Eds.). Toxicology: the Basic
Science of Poisons.  NY: Pergamon Press, 1996, 1033

Battaglin  W. A., and D.A. Coolsby. Spatial Data in Geographic
Information System Format on Agricultural Chemical Use, Land Use, and
Cropping Practices in the United States, Water Resources Investigations
Report 94-4176. Lakewood, CO: U.S. Geological Survey, 1994.

Beaulac, M.N. and K.H. Reckhow. An examination of land use-nutrient
relationships. Water Resources Bulletin 18 (6):  1013-1024 (1982).

Blondell, J.M. Updated Review of Rodenticide Incident Reports Primarily
Concerning Children, Memorandum to Dennis Deziel and Michael
McDavit, June 3, 1999.

Brewer, Cynthia A. and Trudy A. Suchan. Mapping Census 2000: The
Geography of U.S. Diversity. U.S. Census Bureau, Census Special
Reports, Series CENSR/01 -1. Washington, DC: U.S. Government
Printing Office. June 2001.

California Department of Pesticide Regulation. Pesticide Use
Reporting: An Overview of California's Unique Full Reporting System,
Sacramento, California:  California Department of Pesticide
Regulation, May, 2000. (March 12, 2003; http://www.cdpr.ca.gov/
docs/pur/purovrvw/tabofcon.htm)

Calvert, G.M., Barnett, M., Blondell, J.M., Mehler, LN. and Sanderson,
W.T. "Surveillance of pesticide- related illness and injury in humans."
In Krieger, R. (ed.), Handbook of Pesticide Toxicology. 2nd edition. San
Diego, CA: Academic Press, 1999.

Council on Environmental Quality. The 24th Annual Report of the
Council on Environmental Quality, 1993. (May 21, 2003;
http://ceq.eh.doe/gov/nepa/reports/1993/toc.htm)
       Daberkow, S., H. Taylor, and W. Huang. "Agricultural Resources and
       Environmental Indicators: Nutrient Use and Management."
       September, 2000. In Agricultural Resources and Environmental
       Indicators, Agricultural Handbook No. AH722. U.S. Department of
       Agriculture, Economic Research Service, Washington, DC, February
       2003, 4.4.1 -4.4.49.

       Flemming, M.D. A Statewide Vegetation Map of Alaska Using a
       Phenological Classification ofAVHRR Data, Anchorage, AK: 1996
       Alaska Surveying and Mapping Conference, February 1996.

       General Accounting Office^ Superfund: Extent of Nation's Potential
       Hazardous Waste Problem Still Unknown, GAO/RCED-88-44.
       Washington, DC: General Accounting Office,  December 1, 1987.

       General Services Administration. "Summary report on real property
       owned by the United States throughout the world." 1999. In
       Statistical Abstract of the United States 2001: The National Data Book,
       Washington, DC: U.S. Census Bureau, 2001.

       Gianessi, L.P., and J.E. Anderson. Pesticide Use in US Crop Production:
       National Data Report, Washington, DC: National Center for Food and
       Agricultural Policy, February 1995.

       Gianessi, L.P., and M.B. Marcelli. Pesticide Use in U.S. Crop Production:
       1997, National Summary Report, Washington,  DC: National Center for
       Food and Agricultural Policy, November 2000.

       Goebel, J.J. "The National Resources Inventory and its role in U.S.
       agriculture." In Proceedings of the Conference on Agricultural Statistics
       Organized by the National Agricultural Statistics Service of the U.S.
       Department of Agriculture, Under the Auspices of the International
       Statistical Institute,  1998.

       Goldstein, N. 12th annual Biocycle nationwide survey: the state of
       garbage in America. Biocycle journal of Composting and Organics
       Recycling 41 (4): 30-40 (April 2000).

       Goss, D.W. Pesticide Runoff Potential,1990-1995. Pesticide Loss
       Database. Temple, TX: Texas Agricultural Experiment  Station. August
       24, 1999. (September 2002; http://www.epa.gov/iwi/1999sept/
       ivl2a_usmap.html).

      ' Hellkamp, A.S., S.R. Shafer, C.L Campbell, J.M. Bay, D.A. Fiscus, G.R.
       Hess, B.F. McQuaid, MJ. Munster, G.L Olson, S.L  Peck, K.N.
       Easterling, K. Sidik, and M.B. Tooley. Assessment of the condition of
       agricultural lands in five mid-Atlantic states. Environmental Monitoring
       and Assessment 51: 317-324 (1998).

       Klopatek, J.M., R.J. Olson, C.J. Emerson, and J.L. Jones. Land-use
       conflicts with natural vegetation in the United States. Environmental
       Conservation 6:  191-199 (1979).
Appendix £
References
E-9

-------

Kniscl, W.G. (ed.). GLEAMS: Gnaundwater Loading Effects of Agricultural
Management Systems, Version 2.JO, Publication No. 5. Tifton, CA:
Biological and Agricultural Engineering Department, 1993.

Smith, W.B., J.S. Vissage, D.R. Darr, and R.M. Sheffield. Forest Statistics
of the United States, 7997, General Technical Report NC-219. St.
Paul, MN: U.S. Department of Agriculture Forest Service, North
Central Research Station, 2001,191.

The H. John Heinz III Center for Science, Economics and the
Environment The State of the Nation's Ecosystems: Measuring the
lands, Wafers, and Living Resources of the United States, New York, NY:
Cambridge University Press, September 2002.

U.S. Census Bureau. Statistical Abstract of the United States 2001:
The National Data Book, Washington, DC: U.S. Census Bureau, 2001.

U.S. Census Bureau. Census 2000: redistricting data (PL 94-171)
summary file. March 1, 2001. (February 26, 2003; http://www.census.
gov/clo/www/redis tricting. html).

U.S. Census Bureau. Corrected  Lists of Urbanized Areas and Urban
Clusters. November 25, 2002.  (March 2003; http://vfww.census.gov/
geo/www/ua/ua_state_corKtxt and http://Vfww.census.gov/geo/wvw/ua/
ttc_ftate_corr.txt)

U.S. Congress. Small Business Liability Relief and Brownfields
RevHalbalion Act, Public Law 107-  118 (H.R. 2869),Washington, DC:
January, 2002.

U.S. Department of Agriculture, Natural Resources Conservation
Service. National Resources Inventory, Washington, DC: Natural
Resources Conservation Service and Ames, Iowa: Iowa State
University, Statistical Laboratory. 1992.

U.S. Department of Agriculture, Natural Resources Conservation
Service. America's Private Land: A Geography of Hope, Washington, DC:
U.S. Department of Agriculture, June 1997.

U.S. Department of Agriculture, Natural Resources Conservation
Service. Summary Report: 1997 National Resources Inventory (Revised
December 2000), Washington, DC: Natural Resources Conservation
Service and Ames, IA: Iowa State University, Statistical Laboratory,
December 1999, revised December 2000. 2000a

U.S. Department of Agriculture, Natural Resources Conservation
Service. National Resources Inventory 1997, revised December 2000:
Change in Average Annual Soil  Erosion by Water on Cropland and
CRP Land,  1982-1997.  2000  (January 2003;
ht(p://www.nrcs.usda.gov/technical/land/meta/m5060.html).  2000f.
       U.S. Department of Agriculture, Natural Resources Conservation
       Service. National Resources Inventory 1997, revised December
       2000: Total Wind and Water Erosion, 1997.  2000 (January 2003;
       http://www.nrcs.usda.gov/technical/land/meta/m5083.html). 2000g.

       U.S. Department of Agriculture, Natural Resources Conservation
       Service. Natural Resources Inventory, 1997, revised December 2000:
       Percent Change in Cropland Area, 1982-1997. December 2000b.
       (January 2003; http://www.nrcs.usda.gov/
       land/meta/mS874.html).200Qe

       U.S. Department of Agriculture, Natural Resources Conservation
       Service. National Resources Inventory, 1997, revised December
       2000: Acres of Non-Federal Developed Land, 1997. December
       2000c. (January 2003;
       http://www.nKS.usda.gov/technical/land/meta/m4974.html). 2000b

       U.S. Department of Agriculture, National Resources Conservation
       Service. Natural Resources Inventory, 1997, revised December 2000:
       Acres of Cropland. December 2000d. (January 2003;
       http://www.nrcs.usda.gov/ technical/land/meta/m4964.html).2QQOd

       U.S. Department of Agriculture, Natural Resources Conservation
       Service. National Resources Inventory, 1997, revised December
       2000: Land Development, 1982-1997. December 2000e.
       (January 2003;
       http://www.ii rcs.usda.gov/technical/land/meta/m5009.html). 2000c
                  i                •                    \
       U.S. Department of Agriculture, Natural Resources Conservation
       Service. 1997 National Resources Inventory Highlights. January
       2001. (February 2003; http://www.nrcs.usda.gov/technical/land/
       pubs/97highlights.pdf).

       U.S. Department of Agriculture, Forest Service. U.S. Forest Facts and
       Historical Trends,  Brochure #FS-696. Washington, DC: U.S.
       Department of Agriculture, April 2001.

       U.S. Department of Agriculture, Agricultural Marketing Service.
       Pesticide Data Program: Annual Summary Calendar Year 2000,
       Washington, DC: U.S. Department of Agriculture, February 2002.

       U.S. Department of Agriculture, Forest Service. Draft Resource
       Planning and Assessment Tables. August 12, 2002. (September
       2002; http://www.ncrs.fs.fed.us/4801 /FIADB/rpaJabler/
       Draft_RPA_2002_Forest_Resource_Tables.pdf).
E-10
References
Appendix E

-------
                                      'ocumer
                                                            3551

 U.S. Department of Commerce, Bureau of Economic Analysis. GDP
 and Other Major NIPA Series, 1929-2002.  2002.  (February 2003;
 http://www.bea.doc.gov/bea/ARTICLES/2002/08August/0802GDP_&
 Other_Major_NIPAs-.pdf)

 U.S. Department of Defense. Fiscal Year 2001 Defense
 Environmental Restoration Program Annual Report to Congress.
 2001. (November 2002; http://63.88.245.60/derparcjy01/
 derp/irtdexTen. htm).

 U.S. Department of Energy. Status Report on Paths to Closure, DOE
 EM-0526. U.S. Department of Energy, Office of Environmental
 Management, March 2000.

 U.S. Department of Energy, Office of Environmental Management
 and Office-of Long-Term Stewardship. A Report to  Congress on Long-
 term Stewardship Volume I - Summary Report,  DOE  EM-OS63. January
 2001.

 U.S. Department of Energy, Office of Environmental Management.
 Summary Data on the Radioactive Waste, Spent Nuclear Fuel, and
 Contaminated Media Managed by the U.S. Department of Energy,
 April 2001.

 U.S. Department of Energy, Energy Information Administration.
 United States country analysis brief. November 2002. (January
 2003; http://www.eia.doe.gov/emeu/cabs/usa.html).

 U.S. Department of Energy, Office of Environmental Management.
 Central Internet Database. 2002.  (January 2003; http://cid.em.doe.gov).

 U.S. Department of the Interior. Rangeland Reform '94, Draft
 Environmental Impact Statement, Washington, DC: Bureau of Land
 Management, 1994.

 U.S. Department of the Interior, Bureau of Land Management.
 Frequently asked questions on the Abandoned Mine Lands Cleanup
 Program. August 9, 2002. (January, 2003; http://wwMblm.gov/aml/
faqs.htm).

 U.S. Environmental  Protection Agency. EPA Report to Congress, Solid
 Waste Disposal in the United States, Volumes l-ll, EPA 530-SW-88-
 011 (B). Washington, DC: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency,
 Office of Solid Waste and Emergency Response, October 1988.

 U.S. Environmental  Protection Agency, Office of Research and
 Development. Multi-Resolution Land Characteristics Consortium -
 National Land Cover Data. 1992. (February  19, 2003;
 http://www.epa.gov/mrlc/nlcd.html)

 U.S. Environmental  Protection Agency. National Water Quality 1994
 Inventory Report to Congress: Ground Water and Drinking Water
 Chapters, EPA 813-R-96-001. Washington, DC: U.S. Environmental
 Protection Agency,  Office of Water, June 1996.
        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. National Water Quality
        Inventory: 1996 Report to Congress (305(b)), EPA 841 -R-97-008.
        Washington DC: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of
        Water, December 1997.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Solid Waste and
        Emergency Response. Number of NPL Site Actions and Milestones by
        Fiscal Year. March 26, 2003 (April 3, 2003;
        http://www.epa.gov/superfund/sites/query/queryhtm/nplfy/htm)

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Wetlands, Oceans,
        and Watersheds. Pesticide Runoff Potential  - 1990-1995.  August
        24, 1999.  (September 2002;
        http://www.epa.gov/iwi/! 999sept/ivl2a_usamap.html)

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Water. Sediment
        runoff potential-1990-1995. August 24, 1999.  (September, 2002;
        http://www.epa.gov/iwi/!999sept/iv12c_usmap.html)

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Persistent bioaccumulative
        toxic (PBT) chemicals; final rule. 40 CFR Part 372: Federal Register 64
        (209), October 29, 1999.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. RCRA Orientation Manual, EPA
        S30-R-0-006. U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Solid
        Waste and Emergency Response, June 2000.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. National Water Quality 1998
        Inventory Report to Congress: Ground Water and Drinking Water
        Chapters, EPA 816-R-00-013. Washington, DC: U.S. Environmental
        Protection Agency, Office of Water, August 2000.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Industrial  Surface
        Impoundments in the United States, EPA 530-R-01 -DOS. Washington,
        DC: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Solid Waste and
        Emergency Response, March 2001.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. The National Biennial RCRA
        Hazardous Waste Report, EPA 530-R-01 -009. Washington DC: U.S.
        Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Solid Waste and
        Emergency Response, June 2001.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Pesticide Industry Sales and
        Usage 1998 and 1999 Market Estimates, Washington, DC: U.S.
        Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Prevention, Pesticides,
        and Toxic Substances, August 2002.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of  Pesticide Programs.
        Biopesticides registration action document:  Bacillus thuringiensis
        plant-incorporated protectants. October 16, 2001. (January 2003;
        http://www. epa.gov/pesticides/biopesticides/pips/bt_brad. htm).
Appendix E
References
E-11

-------
£fAs Draft Report 
-------

                   Chapter  4:
              Human Health
 Adams, P., G.E. Hendershot,  and M. Maraho. Current estimates from
 the National Health Interview Survey. 1996. Vital and Health Statistics
 10: 82, 92, 94 (1999).

 Agency for Toxic Substances and Disease Registry. Public health
 statement for chromium. 2000. (February 27, 2003;
 http://www.atsdr.cdc.gov/interactionsprofiles/ps7.html).

 Agency for Toxic Substances and Disease Registry, Centers for
 Disease Control. ToxFAQ's: chromium. 2001. (April 21, 2003;;
 http://www.atsdr.cdc.gov/tfacts7.html).

 Akinbami, L.J. and K.C. Schoendorf. Trends in Childhood Asthma:
 Prevalence, Health Care Utilization and Mortality. Pediatrics 110: 315-
 332 (2002).   ,

 American Conference of Governmental Industrial Hygienists.
• Documentation of the Threshold Limit Values and Biological Exposure
 Indices, 6th Edition, Cincinnati, OH: ACGIH. 1991.

 American Heart Association. 2007 Heart and Stroke Statistical
 Update, Dallas, TX: American Heart Association, 2001, 5-9, 13-16.

 American Lung Association. Breathless, in America: background on
 COPD. 2001. (April 5, 2002; http://www.lungusa.org/'press/lung_dis/
 asn_copdback.html).

 American Lung Association, U.S. Environmental Protection Agency,
 Consumer Product Safety Commission, and The American Medical
 Association. Indoor Air Pollution: An Introduction for Health
 Professionals, Publication No. 1994-523-217/81. Washington, DC:
 U.S. Government Printing Office, 1994.

 Anderson, R.N. Deaths: Leading causes for 1999. National Vital
 Statistics Report 49 (11): 8 (2001).

 California Department of Developmental Services. Changes in the
 population of persons with autism and pervasive developmental
 disorders in California's developmental services system: 1987
 through 1988: a report to  the legislature. 1999. (April 13, 2002;
 http://www.cahwnet.gov/autism/pdf7autism_report_1999.pdf).

 Caraballo, R.S., G.A. Giovino, T.F. Pechacek, P.O. Mowery, RA. Richter,
 W.J. Strauss, et al. Racial and ethnic differences in serum cotinine
 levels of cigarette smokers: third national health and nutrition
        examination survey. 1988-1991. Journal of the American Medical
        Association 280: 135-139 (1998).

        Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. Preventing lead
        poisoning in young children. 1991. (April 12, 2002; http://aepo-xdv-
        www.epo.cdc.gov/wonder/prevguid/p0000029/p0000029.asp).

        Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. Current trends in
        autopsy frequency—United States, 1980- 1985. Morbidity and
        Mortality Weekly Report 37 (12): 191-194 (1998). 1998a.

        Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. Gastrointestinal
        infections.  1998. (March 27, 2002; http://www.cdc.gov/ncidod/hip/
        INFECT/gi_excerpt.htm). 1998b.

        Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. Notice to readers: final
        1997 reports of notifiable diseases. Morbidity and Mortality Weekly
        Report 47 (34): 717-718 (1998). 1998c.    .

        Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. Decline in Deaths from
        Heart Disease and Stroke, United States, 1990-1999,  Washington,
        DC: Centers for Disease Control, 1999. 1999a.

        Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. Notice to readers: final
        1998 reports of notifiable diseases. Morbidity and Mortality Weekly
        Report 48 (36): 804-805, 815-822 (1999). 1999b.

        Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. Chronic diseases and
        their risk factors: the nation's leading causes of death (1999), Atlanta,
        GA: NCCDHP, 2000. 2000a.

        Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. Consequences of delayed
        diagnosis of Rocky Mountain spotted fever in children-West Virginia,
        Michigan, Tennessee, and Oklahoma, May-July 2000. Morbidity and
        Mortality Weekly Report 49 (39): 885-888 (2000). 2000b.

        Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. Notice to readers: final
        1999 reports of notifiable diseases. Morbidity and Mortality Weekly
        Report 49 (37): 841 (2000). 2000c.

        Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. Update: West Nile virus
        activity—Eastern United States, 2000. Morbidity and Mortality
        Weekly Report 49 (46): 1044-1047 (2000). 2000d.

        Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. Cholera. 2001.
        (November 19,  2002;  http://www.cdc.gov/ncidod/dbmd/
       . diseaseinfo/cholera_g.htm). 2001 a.

        Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. Escherichia coli
        O157:H7. 2001. (November 19, 2002; http://www.cdc.gov/ncidod/
        dbmd/diseaseinfo/escherichiacoli_g.htm). 2001 b.
Append
          x
References
                                                                                                                          E-13

-------

                                                                             _Jt	   	
Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. National Report on
Human Exposure to Environmental Chemicals. 2001. (May 21, 2002;
http://www.cdc.gov/nceh/dls/report/PDF/CompleteReport.pdf). 2001 c.

Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. Notice to readers: final
2000 reports of notifiable diseases. Morbidity and Mortality Weekly
Report 50 (33): 712 (2001). 2001 d.

Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. Prevalence of disabilities and
associated health conditions among adults—United States, 1999.
Morbidity and Mortality Weekly Report SO: 120-125 (2001). 2001 e.

Centers for Disease Control and Prevention, Salmonellosis.  2001.
(November 19, 2002; http://wvfw.cdc.gov/ncidod/dbmd/diseaseinfo/
salmoneltosK_g.htm). 2001 f.

Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. Shigellosis. 2001.
(November 19, 2002; http://www.cdc.gov/ncidod/dbmd/diseaseinfo/
shigelhsis_g.htm). 2001 g.

Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. Typhoid fever. 2001.
(November 19, 2002; http://www.cdc.gov/ncidod/dbmd/diseaseinfo/
typhoidfever_g,htm). 2001 h.

Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. National diabetes fact
sheet 2002. (February 26 2002; http://www.cdc.gov/diabetes/
pubs/cstimatesMm). 2002a.

Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. Notice to readers: final
2001 reports of notifiable diseases. Morbidity and Mortality Weekly
Report 51  (32): 710 (2002). 2002b.

Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. Rocky Mountain spotted
fever, epidemiology. 2002 (June 6,  2002; http://www.cdc.gov/ncidod/
dvrd/rmsf/epidemlology.htm). 2002c.

Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. Viral hepatitis.  2002.
(November 19, 2002; http://www.cdc.gov/ncedod/diseases/
hepaUth/index-htm). 2002d.

Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. Viral hepatitis
surveillance: disease burden from hepatitis A, B, and C in the United
States. 2002. (November 19, 2002: http://www.cdc.gov/ncidod/
diseases/hepatitis/resource/dz_burden02.htm) 2002e.

Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. West Nile virus update:
current case count, 2002. 2002. (November 14, 2002:
http://wwvf.cdc.gov/od/oc/media/wncount.htm). 2002f.

Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. Asthma's impact on
children and adolescents. 2002. (March 25, 2002;
http;//www.cdc,gov/nceh/airpollution/asthma/children.htm). 2002g.
        Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. Second National Report
        on Human Exposure to Environmental Chemicals, NCEH Publication No.
        03-0022. Atlanta, CA: Centers for Disease Control and Prevention,
        January 2003. 2003a.

        Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. Asthma prevalence,
        health care use and mortality, 2000-2001. 2003. (April 21, 2003;
        http://vfiHw.cdc.gov/nchs/producis/pubs/pubd/hesiats/asthma/
        asthma.htm). 2003 b.                   '.

        Centers for Disease Control and Prevention. Birth defects. Undated.
        (April 21, 2003; http://www.cdc.gov/ncbddd/bd). 2003c.

        Centers for Disease Control. Radiation facts. (May 17, 2003;
        http://www.btcdc.gov/radiation/facts.asp). 2003d.

        Checkoway, H. and Nelson, L. Epidemiologic approaches to the study
        of Parkinson's disease etiology. Epidemiology 10: 327-336 (1999).

        Churchill,}., and W. Kaye. Recent chemical exposures and blood
        volatile organic compound levels in a large population-based sample.
        Archives of Environmental Health 56 (2): 157-166 (2001).

        Clayton, CA., E.D, Pellizzari, R.W. Whitmore, R.L Perritt, and J.J.
        Quackenboss. National Human Exposure Assessment Survey
        (NHEXAS): distributions and associations of lead, arsenic and
        volatile organic compounds  in  EPA region 5. Journal of Exposure
        Analysis and Environmental Epidemiology 9: 381 -392 (1999).

        Craun, G.F. "Chapter 5:  Statistics of Waterborne Outbreaks in the
        U.S. (1920-1980)" In G.F. Craun, (ed.) Waterborne Diseases  in the
        United States, Boca Raton: FL, CRC Press, Inc., 1986, 74-155.

        Craun, G.F. and R.L Calderon. "Waterborne Outbreaks in the United
        States,  1971 -2000." In Frederick W. Pontius (ed.), Drinking Water
        Regulation and Health, New York, NY: John Wiley & Sons, 2003,
        40- 56.

        Crinnion, W.J. Environmental medicine, part one: the human burden
        of environmental toxins and  their common health effects. Alternative
        Medicine Review 5 (1): 52-63 (2000).

        Dockery D.W. and Pope, C.A. "Outdoor Air I: Particulates." In K.
        Steenland and D.A. Savitz (eds.), Topics in Environmental Epidemiology,
        New York, NY: Oxford.University Press, 1997, '

        Doll, R., and R. Peto. The Causes of Cancer: Quantitative Estimates of
        Avoidable Risks of Cancer in the United States Today, New York: Oxford
        University Press, 1981.

        Eberhardt, M.S., D.D. Ingram, D.M. Makuc, et al. Health, United
        States, 2001: With Urban and Rural Health Chartbook, Hyattsville,
        MD: Natiorial Center for Health Statistics, 2001,161-163.
E-14
References
Appendix £

-------
eqn n i cat
l ocu rneii
                                                                                  pG ti ron
Eiseman, E., and S. Haga. A National Resource of Human Tissue
Samples, ISBN 0-8330-2766-2. Arlington, VA: RAND,  1999.

Fombonne, E. Is there an epidemic of autism? Pediatrics 107:
411 -412 (2001).

Fox, K. National Risk Management Research Laboratory, personal
communication, 2003.

Franzen, C, and A. Muller. Cryptosporidia and microsporidia—
waterborne diseases in the immunocompromised host. Diagnostic
Microbiology and Infectious Disease 34: 245-262 (1999).

Friis, R.H. and T.A. Sellers, Epidemiology for Public Health Practice,
Second Edition. Gaithersburg, MD: Aspen Publishers, Inc., 1999.

Gayle, A. and E. Ringdahl. Tick-borne diseases. American Family
Physician 64:  461 -466 (2001).

GLOBOCAN 2000. Cancer Incidence, Mortality and Prevalence
Worldwide, Version 1.0., IARC CancerBase No. J. [Computer software.]
Lyon: IARC Press, 2001.

Guerrant, R.L. Cryptosporidiosis: an emerging, highly infectious
threat. Emerging Infectious Diseases 3 (1):-51-57 (1997).

Hanzlick, R. National autopsy data dropped from the National
Center for Health Statistics Database. Journal of the American Medical
Association  280 (10): 886 (1998).

Holman, R.C, CD. Paddock, A.T. Curns, J.W. Krebs, J.H. McQuiston,
and J.E. Childs. Analysis of risk factors for fatal Rocky Mountain
Spotted Fever: evidence for  superiority of tetracyclines for therapy.
Journal of Infectious Diseases 184: 1437-1444 (2001).

Horga, M. A. and A. Fine. West Nile virus. Pediatric Infectious Diseases
Journal 20:  801 -802 (2001).

Hoyert, D.L. and H.M. Rosenberg. Mortality from Alzheimer's disease:
an update.National Vital Statistics Report 47: 5 (1999).

Hoyert, D.L, E. Arias, B.L Smith, S.L Murphy, and K.D. Kochanek.  Deaths:
Final Data for 1999. National Vital Statistics Report 49: 6-9 (2001).

International  Center for Tropical Disease Research Network. 10th
Anniversary: tropical diseases. 2002. (November 19, 2002;
http://www.niaid.nih.gov/dmid/pdf/factsheet.pdf).

International  Programme on Chemical Safety. Global Assessment of the
State-of-the-Science of Endocrine Disrupters, WHO/PCS/EDC/02.2.
Geneva: World Health Organization, International Programme on
Chemical Safety, 2002.
                             Iversen, P. Autism: what does the future hold for, what can we learn
                             from the past, and what can we do right now? California Pediatrician
                             Fall: 1 -3  (2000).

                             Kay, D., A. Pruss, and C Corvalan. Methodology for assessment of
                             environmental burden of disease; report on the ISEE session on
                             environmental burden of disease, Buffalo, August 22, 2000. (May
                             19, 2002; http://www.who.int/peh/burden/methodohgyhtm.htm).

                             Kramarow, E., H. Lentzner, R. Rooks, J. Weeks, S. Saydah. Health,
                             United States, 1999: With Health and Aging Chartbook, Hyattsville,
                             MD: National Center for Health Statistics, 1999.

                             Macintosh, D.L, L.L. Needham, K.A. Hammerstrom, and RB. Ryan. A
                             longitudinal investigation of selected pesticide metabolites in urine.
                             Journal of Exposure Analysis and Environmental Epidemiology 9:
                             494-501 (1999).

                             Mannino, A.M., and B.L Smith. Deaths: preliminary data for 2000.
                             National Vital Statistics  Report 53 (49): 3 (2001).

                             .Mannino, D.M, D.M. Huma, L.J. Akinbami, et al. Surveillance for
                             asthma - United States, 1980-1999. Morbidity and Mortality Weekly
                             Report Surveillance Summaries 51  (SS-1): 8, 9, 13 (2002).

                             Martin, J.A., B.E. Hamilton, S.J. Ventura, F. Menacker, and M.M. Park.
                             Births: Final data for 2000. National Vital Statistics Report 50 (5):
                             16,79 (2002).

                             Moore, G.W., J.J. Berman, R.L. Hanzlick, J.J. Buchino, and G.M.
                             Hutchins. A prototype internet autopsy database: 1625 consecutive
                             fetal and neonatal autopsy facesheets spanning twenty years. 1996.
                             (March 1, 2002; http://www.autopsydb.org/protoiad.htm).

                             Nadakavukaren, A. Our Clobal Environment: a Health Perspective,  Fifth
                             Edition, Prospect Heights, IL: Waveland  Press, Inc, 2000.

                             National Academy of Engineering. Greatest engineering achievements
                             of the  20th century. 2000. (February 28, 2003;
                             http://greatachievements.org).

                             National Research Council. Risk Assessment in the Federal Government:
                             Managing the Process, Washington, DC: National Academies Press,
                             1983.

                             National Research Council. Measuring Lead Exposure in infants,
                             Children, and Other Sensitive Populations, Washington DC: National
                             Academies Press,  1993.

                             National Research Council. Arsenic in Drinking Water. Washington, DC:
                             National Academies Press, 1999.
Appendix EL
                      References
                                                                                                       E-15

-------
                                                                               lecnnica
                                                                              JSL
National Research Council. Toxkological Effects of Methylmercury,
Washington, DC: National Academy of Sciences, 2000.

National Cancer Institute. Health disparities. 2002. (January 30,
2003; fittp://surveillance.cancer.gov/disparities).

National Cancer Institute. Dictionary. Undated. (April 18, 2003;,
http://cancer.gov/dictionary).

National Center for Educational Statistics. Digest of education
statistics. 2001. (February, 18, 2003; http://nces.ed.gov/
pubs2002/digest2001 /tables/dt052.asp).

National Center for Environmental Health. CDC's lead poisoning
prevention program. 1998. (April 12, 2002; http://www.cdc.gov/
nceh/Lead/fadsheeis/leadfacts.pdf).

National Center for Health Statistics. Healthy People 2000 Final
Review, PHS 2001 -0256 ed. Hyattsville, MD:  Department of Health
and Human Services, Centers for Disease Control and Prevention,
National Center for Health Statistics, 2001.

National Heart, Lung and Blood Institute. Particulate air pollution
and cardiovascular morbidity. 2000. (April 3, 2002;
hUp://wvm.arb,ca.gov/research/cardio/cardio.htm).

National Institute of Diabetes and Digestive and Kidney Diseases.
Kidney and urologic diseases statistics for the United States. 2001.
(April 5, 2002; http://wwv.niddk.nih.gov/health/kidney/pubs/kustats/
kustats.htm).

National Institute of Neurological Disorders and Stroke. Parkinson's
disease backgrounder. 2002. (May 13, 2002; http://www.ninds.nih.
gov/health_and_medical/pubs/parkinson's_disease_backgrounder.htm).

Orban, J.E., J.S. Stanley, J.G. Schwemberger, and J.C. Remmers. Dioxins
and dibenzofurans in adipose tissue of the general U.S. population
and selected subpopufations. American Journal of Public Health 84:
439-445 (1994).

Orloski, KA, E.B. Hayes, G.L. Campbell, and D.T. Dennis. Surveillance
for Lyme disease-United States, 1992-1998.  Morbidity and Mortality
Weekly Report Surveillance Summaries 49 (SS-1): 4 (2002).

Paddock, C. D., P.W. Greer, T.L  Ferebee, J. Jr. Singleton, D.B.
McKechnie, TA Treadwell, et al. Hidden mortality attributable to
Rocky Mountain spotted fever: immunohistochemical detection of
fatal, serologically unconfirmed disease. Journal of Infectious Diseases
179:1469-1476 (1999).

Pastor, P.N., D.M. Makuc, C. Reuben, and H. Xia, et al. Chartbook on
Trends in tiie Health of Americans. Health, United States, 2002,
Hyattsville, MD: National Center for Health Statistics, 2002.
        Pellizzari, E.D1., R. Fernando, G.M. Cramer, G.M. Meaburn, and K.
        Bangerter. Analysis of mercury in hair of EPA region V population.
        Journal of Exposure Analysis and Environmental Epidemiology 9:
        393-401 (1999).

        Peterson, C.A. and R.L Calderon. Trends in enteric disease as a cause
        of death in the United States, 1989-1996. American Journal of
        Epidemiology 57: 58-65 (2003).

        Pirkle, J.L, K.M. Flegal, J.T. Bernert, D.J. Brady, R.A. Etzel, and K.R.
        Maurer.  Exposure of the U.S.  population to environmental tobacco
        smoke: The Third National Health and Nutrition Examination Survey,
        1988 to 19S1 .Journal of the American Medical Association 275: 1233-
        1240 (1996).

        Pirkle, J.L, R.B. Kaufmann, D.J. Brody, T. Hickman, E.W. Gunter, and
        D.C Pashal. Exposure of the U.S. population to lead: 1991-1994.
        Environmental Health Perspectives 106: 745-50 (1998).

        Pruss, A., C.F. Corvalan, H. Pastides, and A.E. De Hollander.
        Methodologic considerations in estimating burden of disease from
        environmental risk factors at national and global levels. International
        Journal of Occupational Medicine and Environmental Health 7: 58-67
        (2001).

        Rappole, J. H., S.R. Derrickson, and Z. Hubalek. Migratory birds and
        spread of West Nile virus in the Western Hemisphere. Emerging
        Infectious Diseases 6: 319-328 (2000).

        Ries, L.A.G., M.P. Eisner, C.L. Kosary,  et al., eds. SEER Cancer Statistics
        Review, 1973-1998. Bethesda, MD: National Cancer Institute, 2001.

        Rom, W.N. Environmental and Occupational Medicine, 2nd Edition,
        Boston,  MA: Little, Brown and Company. 1992

        Schmidt, C. W. Poisoning young minds. Environmental Health
        Perspectives 107: A302-A307 (1999).

        Shapiro, E. D. and M.A. Gerber. Lyme disease. Clinical Infectious
        Diseases 31: 533-542 (2000).

        Smith, K.R., Corvalan, C.F., and Kfellstrom, T. How much global ill
        health is attributable to environmental factors? Epidemiology 10:
        573-584 (1999).

        The Pew Environmental Health Commission, The Johns Hopkins
        University School of Public Health. Transition report to the new
        administration: Strengthening our public health defense against
        environmental threats. 2001. (May 27, 2002;
        http://pewenvirohealth.jhsph.edU/html/reports/5 Pager.pdf).
E-16
References
Appendix t

-------
                     Teen ft icy  Do^
 United Nations. Demographic Yearbook 1999, New York: United
 Nations, 2001,479-506.
        Washington, DC: Environmental Protection Agency,  Office of
        Children's Health Protection,. December 2000. 2000c.
 U.S. Department of Housing and Urban Development. Eliminating
 childhood lead poisoning: a federal strategy targeting lead paint
 hazards. 2000. (February 20, 2003; http://www.hud.gov/offices/lead/
 reports/fedstrategy2000.pdf).

 U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Regulation of fuels and fuel
 additives: control of lead additives in gasoline. Federal Register 38
 (234): 33733-33741 (December, 6 1973).

 U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Air Quality Criteria for Lead.
 EPA 600-8-83-028aF. Research Triangle Park, NC: U.S.
 Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Research and
 Development, Environmental Criteria and Assessment Office, 1986.

 U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Respiratory Health Effects of
 Passive Smoking: Lung Cancer and Other Disorders, EPA 600-6-90-
 006 F. Washington, DC:  U.S. Environmental Protection Agency,
 Office of Research and Development, Office of Health  and
 Environmental Assessment, December 1992.

 U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. EPA's report on  environmental
 health threats to children. 1996. (May 23, 2002; http://www.epa.gov/
 epadocs/child.htm).

 U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Research Plan  for Microbial
 Pathogens and Disinfection Byproducts In Drinking Water, EPA 600-R-
 97-122. Washington, DC: U.S. Environmental  Protection Agency,
 Office of Research and Development, November 1997.

 U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. EPA's Children's Environmental
 Health Yearbook, Washington, DC: U.S. Environmental Protection
 Agency, Office of Children's Health Protection. June  1998.

 U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. February 10-12, 1999,
 M/DBP (microbial/disinfection byproducts) stage 2  FACA: health
 effects workshop meeting summary. 1999. (November 21, 2002;
 http://www. epa.gov/safewater/mdbp/st2feb99 .html).

 U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Radiation: risks  & realities -
 what is radiation? 2000. (June 2, 2002; http://www.epa.gov/
 radiation/docs/risksandrealities/rrpage2.html). 2000a.

 U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Air Quality Criteria for Carbon
 Monoxide, EPA 600-P-99-001 F. Research Triangle Park, NC: U.S.
 Environmental Protection Agency, Office Research and Development,
 National Center for Environmental Assessment. June 2000. 2000b.

 U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, America's Children  and the
 Environment - a First View of Available Measures, EPA 240-R-00-006.
        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Handbook of Croundwater
        Policies for RCRA Corrective Action (updated 4/20/2000), EPA 530-
        D-00-001. Washington, DC: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency,
        April 2000d.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Fact sheet: drinking water
        standard for arsenic, EPA 815-F-OO- 015. 2001. (November 24, 2002;
        http://wwwepa.gov/safewater/ars/ars_mle_fadsheet.html). 2001 a.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Pesticides: regulating
        pesticides—Persistent organic pollutants (POPs). 2001. (May 21,
        2002; http://www.epa.gov/oppfead1/international/pops.htm). 2001 b.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Drinking Water Priority
        Rulemaking: Microbial and Disinfection Byproduct Rules, EPA 816-F-01 -
        012. Washington, DC: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office
        of Water, June 2001 a.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. National Air Quality and
        Emissions Trends Report, 1999, EPA 454-R-01 -004. Research Triangle
        Park, NC: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Air Quality
        Planning and Standards, March 2001.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Ionizing radiation. 2002.
        (February 18, 2003; http://www.epa.gov/earth1r6/6pd/
        radon/radon.htm). 2002a.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Region 6. Radon. 2002. ()une 6,
        2002; http://www.epa.gov/earth1r6/6pd/radon/radon.htm). 2002b.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Drinking water contaminants:
        disinfection by-products. 2002. (November 21, 2002;
        http://www.epa.gov/safewater/hfacts.html). 2002c.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Air Quality Criteria for
        Particulate Matter, Third External Review Draft, Volume II, EPA 600-P-
        99-002bC Research Triangle Park, NC: U.S. Environmental
        Protection Agency, Office of Research and Development, National
        Center for Environmental Assessment, April 2002. 2002d.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Current Drinking Water
        Standards, EPA 816-F-02-013. Washington, DC: U.S. Environmental
        Protection Agency, July 2002. 2002e.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. National Recommended Water
        Quality Criteria: 2002, EPA 822- R-02-047. Washington, DC: U.S.
        Environmental Protection Agency, November 2002f.
Appendix t
References
E-17

-------
.r*.n.A^iF*\ •§	r	'-"J?"!!^^
 U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Consumer factsheet on
 hexachlorobenzene. 2002. (May 8, 2003; http://www.epa.gov/
 safewater/dwh/c-soc/hexachh.html). 2002g.

 U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Radiation information:
 common questions, clear answers. (May 17, 2003;
 hUpt//www.epa.gov/radiatfan/faqs.htm). 2002h.

 US. Environmental Protection Agency. Understanding radiation:  _
 ionizing and non-ionizing radiation. (May 17, 2003;
 bllp;//wvw.epa.gov/radiation/understand/ionize_nonionize.htm). 20021

 U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Understanding radiation:
 health effects. (May 17, 2003; http://www.epa.gov/radiation/
 undentand/healthjsffectsMm). 2002).

 U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Understanding radiation:
 exposure pathways. (May 17, 2003; http://www.epa.gov/radiation/
 undmtand/pathwaysMm). 2002k.

  U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, America's Children and the
  Environment - Measures of Contaminants, Body Burdens, and Illnesses,
  Second Edition, EPA 240-R-03-001. Washington, DC: Environmental
  Protection Agency, Office of Children's Health Protection, National
  Center for Environmental Economics, Office of Policy, Economics and
  Innovation, February 2003.  2003a.

  U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Hexachlorobenzene. 2003. (May
  8,2003; hUp://wwY.epa,gov/ttn/atw/hlthef/hexa-ben.htmI). 2003b.

  U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Hexachlorobenzene. 2003.
  (May 8, 2003; http://www.epa.gov/opptintr/pbt/hexa.htm). 2003 c.
 U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. EPA map of radon zones.
 2003. (February 27, 2003; http://www.epa.gov/iaq/
 radon/zonemap.html). 2003d.

 U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Framework for Cumulative Risk
 Assessment, EPA-630-P-02- 001 F. Washington, DC: Risk Assessment
- Forum, 2003, (Available online at http://cfpub.epa.gov/ncea/raf/
 recordisplay.cfm?deid=54944)  2003e.

 Walker, D. H. tick-transmitted infectious diseases in the United
 States. Annual Review of Public Health  19: 237-269 (1998).

 Whipple G.C. Influence of Public Water-Supplies on the Typhoid fever
 Death-Rates of Cities.  In Typhoid Fever - Its Causation, Transmission and
 Prevention, John Wiley and Sons, Inc., 1908, 228-270.

 World Health Organization. Typhoid  fever, 1997. Fact sheet N149.
  (February 1, 2003; http://www.who.int/inf-fs/en/factl49.html)

  World Health Organization. Environmental burden of disease. 2002.
  (April 11, 2002; http://www.who.int/peh/burden/burdenindex.htm).

  World Resources Institute, United Nations Environment Programme,
  United Nations Development Programme, and World  Bank. World
  Resources 1998-99, London: Oxford University Press, 1998, 10.

  Yazbak, F.E. Autism 99: a national emergency. 1999. (April 13, 2002;
  http://www.garynull.com/Documents/autism_99.htm).
    E-18
                                                               References
                                                   Appendix t

-------An error occurred while trying to OCR this image.

-------

Ef/\s  Draft "Rifaprt oil the Ehvirbrirnent 20(3-3 II  Tlcnnical  Docurnefit
                      1 "I  : "      .  M .  '  ,    . i   i   '  • I   'II   :     ' « '111   i  a-ti;  •. •   ;...'•. ;  :'••'••  • .  '.,..:;';.  : ..;   i:N 1
 Forman, T.T. and M. Godron. Landscape Ecology, New York:
 Wiley, 1986.

 Frayer, W.E., T.J. Monahan, D.C. Bowden, and F.A. Craybill. Status and
 Trends of Wetlands and Deepwater Habitats in the Conterminous United
 States,  WSO's io 7970's,  Fort Collins, CO: Colorado State University,
 Department of Forest and Wood Sciences, 1983.

 Gallagher, E., and K. Keay. "Organism sediment contaminant in
 Boston Harbor." In K. Stolzenbach and E. Adams (eds.). Contaminated
 Sediment in Boston Harbor, Boston, MA: MIT Sea Grant Press, 1998.

 Galloway,]., and E. Cowling. Reactive nitrogen and the world: 200
 years of change. Ambio 31: 64-71 (2002).

 Grime, J.P. Biodiversity and ecosystem function: the debate deepens.
 Science 277:1260-1261 (1997).

 Grimm, N.B., L Baker, and D. Hope. "An ecosystem approach to
 understanding cities: familiar foundations and uncharted frontiers."
 In A.R. Berkowitz, K.S. Hollweg, and C.H. Nilon (eds.). Understanding
 Urban Ecosystems: A New Frontier for Science and Education, Springer-
 Verlag: New York, 2002,95-114.

 Hadidian, J., J. Sauer, C. Swarth, R Handly, S. Droege, C. Williams, J.
 Huff, and G. Didden. A citywide breeding bird survey for Washington,
 DC Urban Ecosystems 1: 87-102 (1997).

 Hellkamp, AS., J.M. Bay, C.L Campbell, K.N. Easterling, D.A. Fiscus,
 G.R. Hess, B.F. McQuaid, M.J. Munster, G.L. Olson, S.L. Peck, S.R.
 Shafer, K. Sidik, and M.B. Tooley. Assessment of the condition of
 agricultural  lands in six mid-Atlantic states. Journal of Environmental
 Quality 29:  79-804 (2000).

 Herlihy, A.T., D. Larsen, S. Paulsen, N. Urquhart, and B. Rosenbaum.
 Designing a spatially balanced, randomized site selection process for
 regional stream surveys: the EMAP mid-Atlantic pilot study.
 Environmental Monitoring Assessment 63: 95-113 (2000).

 Hess, G.R., A.S. Hellkamp, S.R. Shafer, B.F. McQuaid, M.J. Munster, S.L.
 Peck, and C.L Campbell. A conceptual model and indicators for
 assessing the ecological condition of agricultural lands. Journal of
 Environmental Quality 29 (3):  728-737 (2000).

 Hodgson, J.G., K. Thompson, P.J. Wilson, and A. Bogaard. Does
 biodiversity determine ecosystem function? The  Ecotron experiment
 reconsidered. Functional Ecology 12: 843-848  (1998).

 Holland, A.F., A. Shaughnessey, and M.H. Heigel.  Long-term variation
 in mesohaline Chesapeake Bay benthos: spatial and temporal
 patterns. Estuaries 10: 227-245 (1987).
        Holland, A.F., A.T. Shaughnessey, LC. Scott, V.A. Dickens, J.A.
        Ranasinghe, and J.K. Summers. Progress Report: Long-term Benthic
        Monitoring and Assessment Program for the Maryland Portion of the
        Chesapeake Bay (July 1986-Octoberl987), Maryland Power Plant
        Research Program and Maryland Department of the Environment,
        Office of Environmental Programs PPRP-LTB/EST-88-1. Columbia,
        MD: Versar Inc.,  ESM Operations, 1988.

        International Programme on Chemical Safety. Global Assessment of the
        State-of-the-Science of Endocrine Disrupters, WHO/PCS/EDC/02.2.
        Geneva: World Health Organization, International Programme on
        Chemical Safety, 2002.

        Judy, R.D., Jr., P. Seeley, T. Murray, S. Svirsky, M. Whitworth, and L.
        Ischiger. 7982 National Fisheries Survey, FWS/OBS-84/06.
        Washington, DC: U.S. Fish and Wildlife Service, 1984.

        Kaiser, J. Great Smokies species census underway. Science 284
        (5421): 1747-1748 (1999).

        Karr, J.R., K.D. Fausch, P.L Angermeier, P.R. Yant, and I.J. Schlosser.
        Assessing Biological Integrity in Running Waters, A Method and Its
        Rationale, Special Publication No. 5. Champaign, IL: Illinois Natural
        History Survey, 1986.

        Karr, J.R., L.S, Fore, and E.W. Chu. Making Biological Monitoring More
        Effective: Integrating Biological Sampling with Analysis and Interpretation,
        Washington DC: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office  of
        Policy Planning and Evaluation, 1997.

        Kaufmann, RR., A.T. Herlihy, M.E. Mitch, and W.S. Overton. Chemical
        characteristics of streams in the Eastern United States: I: Synoptic
        survey desig;n, acid-base status and regional chemical patterns. Water
        Resources Research 27: 611-627 (1991).

        Kaufmann, FIR., P. Levine, E.G. Robison, C. Seeliger, and D.V. Peck.
        Surface Waters: Quantifying Physical Habitat in Wadeable Streams,  EPA
        620-R-99-003. Washington, DC: U.S. Environmental Protection
        Agency, Office of Research and Development, July 1999.

        Kinzig, A.P. and J.M. Grove. "Urban-suburban ecology." In S. Levin
        (ed.). The Encyclopedia of Biodiversity, New York, NY: Academic Press,
        2001, 733-746.

        Klemm, D.J., K.A. Blocksom, W.T. Thoeny, F.A. Fulk, A.T. Herlihy, P.R.
        Kaufmann, I5.M. Cormier. Methods development and use of
        macroinvertebrates as indicators of ecological conditions for streams
        in the mid-Atlantic Highlands region.  Environmental Monitoring and
        Assessment 78 (2): 169-212 (2002).

        Klemm, D.J., K.A. Blocksom, F.A. Fulk, A.T. Herlihy, R.M. Hughes, P.R.
        Kaufmann, D.V. Peck, J.L Stoddard, W.T. Thoeny, M.B. Griffith,  and
        W.S. Davis. Development and evaluation of a Macroinvertebrate
 E-20
References
Appendi
                                                                                                                             x

-------


 Biotic Integrity Index (MBII) for regionally assessing Mid-Atlantic
 Highlands streams. Environmental Management 31 (5): 656-669
 (2003).

 Klopatek, J.M., R.J. Olson, CJ. Emerson, and J.L. Joness. Land-use
 conflicts with natural vegetation in the United States. Environmental
 Conservation 6: 191 -199 (1979).

 Knight, R. and P. Landres. (eds.). Stewardship Across Boundaries,
 Washington, DC: Island Press. 1998.

 Landers, D.H., W. S. Overon, R.  Linthurst, and D. Brakke. Eastern lake
 survey - regional estimates of lake chemistry. Environmental Science
 Technology 22: 128-135 (1988).

 Lindenmeyer, D.B., C Margules, and D. Botkin. Indicators of
 biodiversity for ecologically sustainable forest management.
 Conservation Biology 10: 941-950 (2000).

 Linthurst, R.A., D.H. Landers, J.M. Eilers, RE. Kellar, D.F. Brakke, W.S.
 Overton, R. Crowe, E.P. Meier, P. Kanciruk, and D.S. Jefferies. Region
 chemical characteristics of lakes in  North America - II: eastern United
 States. Water, Air, and Soil Pollution  31: 123-129 (1986).

 Liu, B.Y., M.A. Hearing, C. Baffaut, and J.C. Ascough II. The WEPP
 watershed model: III. Comparisons to measured data  from small,
 watersheds. Transactions of the American Society of Agricultural
 Engineers, 40(4):945-951 (1997),

 Matson, PA, W.}. Parton, A.C., Power, and M.J. Swift. Agricultural
 intensification and ecosystem properties. Science 277: 504-509 (1997).

 McCormick, FH., R.M. Hughes, P.R. Kaufmann, D.V. Peck, J.L
 Stoddard, and A.T.  Herlihy. Development of an index  of biotic
 integrity for the mid-Atlantic Highlands region. Transactions of the
American Fisheries Society 130: 857-877 (2001).

 McQuaid, B.F., and  Olson, G.L "Indices of Piedmont soils under
 different management systems." In R. Lai et al. (eds.), Advances in Soil
Science - Soil Processes and the Carbon Cycle, Boca Raton, FL: CRC
 Press, 1998, 427-434.

 Messer, J.J. "Indicators in regional ecological monitoring and risk
 assessment." In D. H. McKenzie et al. (eds.), Ecological Indicators,
 Volume 1, Essex, England: Elsevier Science, 1992, 135-146.

Messer, J.J., D.H. Landers, R.A. Linthurst, and W.S. Overton. Critical
design and interpretive aspects of the National Surface Water Survey.
Journal of Lake Reservoir Management 3: 463-469 (1986).

Messer, J.J., C.W. Ariss, J.R. Baker, S.K. Drouse, K.N. Eshlemann, A.J.
 Kinney, W.S. Overton, J.J. Sale, and  R.D. Schonbrod. Stream  chemistry
in the southern Blue Ridge: feasibility of a regional synoptic stream
sampling approach. Water Resource Bulletin 24: 821 -829 (1988).
        Moore, K.A., DJ. Wilcox, and R.J. Orth. Analysis of the abundance of
        submersed aquatic vegetation communities in the Chesapeake Bay.
        Estuaries 23 (1): 115-127 (2000).

        Naeem, S., D. Byers, S.F. Tjossem, C. Bristow, and S. Li. Plant
        neighborhood diversity and production. Ecoscience 6: 355-365 (1999).

        Naiman, R.J. and M.G. Turner. A future perspective on North
        America's fresh water ecosystems. Ecological Applications 10: 958-
        970 (2000).

        National Acid Precipitation Assessment Program. Acid Deposition: State of
        Science and Technology. Volume II. Aquatic Processes and Effects, Washington,
        DC: National Acid Precipitation Assessment Program, 1991.

        National Research Council. Striking a Balance: Improving Stewardship
        of Marine Areas, Washington, DC: National Academies Press, 1997.

        National Research Council. Our Common Journey: A Transition Toward
        Sustainability, Washington DC: National Academies Press, 1999.

        National Research Council. Ecological Indicators for the Nation,
        Washington, DC: National Academies Press, 2000.

        MatureServe. NatureServe Explorer, an online encyclopedia of life.
        2002. (February 2003; http://www.natureserve.org/explorer/).

        Nixon, S.W., Hunt, C.D., and Nowicki, B.L. "The  retention of nutrients
        (C, N, P), heavy metals (Mn, Cd, Pb, Cu), and petroleum
        hydrocarbons by Narragansett Bay." In P. Lasserre and J.M. Martin
        (eds.), Biogeochemical Processes at the Land-Sea Boundary, New York,
        NY: Elsevier, 1986, 99-122.

        Noss, R.F., and A.Y. Cooperrider. Saving Nature's Legacy: Protecting and
        Restoring Biodiversity, Washington, DC: Island Press, 1994.

        Nowak, D., K. Civerelo, S.T. Rao, G. Sistla, C.,Luley, and D.  Crane. A
        modeling study of the impact of urban trees on ozone. Atmospheric
       • Environment 34: 1601 -1613 (2000).

        O'Connell, T.J., L.E. Jackson, and R.P. Brooks. A bird community index
        of biotic integrity for the mid- Atlantic Highlands. Environmental
        Monitoring and Assessment 51: 145-156 (1998).

        O'Connell, T.J., L.E. Jackson, and R.P. Brooks. Bird guilds as indicators
        of ecological condition in the central Appalachians. Ecological
        Applications 10:  1706-1721  (2000).

        O'Connell, T.J., J.A. Bishop, and R.R Brooks. The North American
        Breeding Bird Survey as Source Data for Assessments of Ecological
        Condition with the Bird Community Index,  Final Report to the U.S.
        Geological Survey - Patuxent Wildlife Research  Center Report No.
        2002-03. University Park, PA: Penn State Cooperative Wetlands
        Center, 2002.
Appendix t
References
E-21

-------
"T~7:™r  .  ;  !   El"  :,'    '~!l:i!	'•,**:•	;:;;:	'•'''•••	'|:|	>'*-f*t**&te.s,&t	laMs	law	|:,:.^j;...'}-.•:.:.;,•,j': .;•;£;!; ;; ...&£:
 Odum, E.P. Fundamentals of Ecology, Third Edition, Philadelphia, PA:
 W,B. Saunders Company, 1971.

 Olsen, A.R., J. Sedransk, D. Edwards, C.A. Gotway, W. Liggett, S.
 Rathbun, K.H. Reckhow, and LJ. Young, Statistical issues for
 monitoring ecological and natural resources in the United States.
 Environmental Monitoring and Assessment 54:1-45 (1999).

 O'Neill, R.V., T.f. Allen, and D.L Deangelis. A Hierarchical Concept of
 Ecosystems, Princeton, Nj: Princeton Press. 1986.

 Paul, J.F., J.H. Gentile, K.J. Scott, S.C. Schimmel, D.E. Campbell, and
 R.W. Latimer. EMAP - Virginian Province Four-year Assessment Report
 (1990-1993), EPA 620-R-99-004. Narragansett, Rl: U.S.
 Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Research and
 Development, Atlantic Ecology Division, October 1999.

 Pearson, T.H., and R. Rosenberg. Macrobenthic succession in relation
 to organic enrichment and pollution of the marine environment.
 Oceanography and Marine Biology Annual Review 16: 229-311 (1978).

 Peterson, SA, D.P. Larsen, S.G. Paulsen, and N.S. Urquhart. Regional
 lake trophic patterns in the northeastern United States: three
 approaches. Environmental Management 22 (5): 789-801  (1998).

 Pickett,  S.T.A., M.L Cadenasso, J.M. Grove, C.H. Nilon, R.V. Pouyat,
 W.C. Zipperer, and R. Costanza. Urban ecological systems: linking
 terrestrial ecology, physical, and socioeconomic components of
 metropolitan areas. Annual Review of Ecology and Systematics 32:
 127-157 (2001).

 Rabalais, N.N., and R.E. Turner, (eds). Coastal Hypoxia: Consequences
 for Living Resources and Ecosystems, Coastal and Estuarine Studies 58.
 Washington DO American Geophysical Union, 2001 :

 Reed, R.C. and L Young. Seasonal vegetation characteristics of the
 United States. Ceocarto International 12: 65-71 (1997).

 Renard,  K.G, G.R. Foster, GA Weesies, O.K. McCool, and D.C Yoder.
 Predicting Soil Erosion by Water: A Guide to Conservation Planning with the
 Raised Universal Soil Loss Equation (RUSLE), Agriculture Handbook No.
 703. Washington DC: U.S. Department of Agriculture, 1997.

 Rhoads, D.C, RL McCall, and J.Y. Yingst. Disturbance and
 production on the estuarine sea floor. American Scientist 66:
 577-586  (1978).

 Riiters, K.H., J.D. Wickham, R.V. O'Neill, K.B. Jones, E.R. Smith, J.W.
 Coulston, T.G. Wade, and J.H. Smith. Fragmentation of Continental
 United States Forests. Ecosystems 5: 815-822 (2002).
        Rosswall, T., Ft. Woodmansee, and P. Risser. Scales and Global Change:
        Spatial and Temporal Variability in Biospheric and Geospheric Processes,
        Scope 35. New York City, NY: John Wiley, 1988.

        Sanders, H.L., J.F. Grassle, G.R. Hampson, L.S. Morse, S. Garner-Price,
        and C.C. Jones. Anatomy of an oil spill: long-term effects from the
        grounding of the barge Florida off West Falmouth, Massachusetts.
        Journal of Marine Research 38: 265-380 (1980).

        Skelly, J.M., D.D. Davis, W. Merrill, E.A. Cameron, H.D. Brown, D.B.
        Drummond, and L.S. Dochinger. Diagnosing Injury to Eastern Forest
        Trees'™, University Park, PA: U.S. Department of Agriculture Forest
        Service and Penn State University,  1987.

        Skidmore, E.L., and N.P. Woodruff. Wind Erosion  Forces in the United
        States and Their Use in Predicting Soil Loss, Agriculture Handbook No.
        346. Washington DC: U.S. Department of Agriculture, 1968, 42.

        Smith, W.B., J.S. Vissage, D.R. Darr, and R.M. Sheffield. Forest Statistics
        of the United States, 1997, General Technical Report NC-219. St.
        Paul, MN: U.S. Department of Agriculture Forest Service, North
        Central Research Station, 2001, 191.

        Stein, B.A. States of the Union: Ranking America's Biodiversity,
        Arlington, VA: NatureServe, 2002.

        Stoddard, J, L, A. D. Newell, N. S. Urquhart, and D. Kugler. The TIME
        project design: II. Detection of regional acidification trends. Water
        Resources Research 32: 2529-2538 (1996).

        Stoddard, J. L, C. T. Driscoll, S. Kahl, and J. Kellogg. Can site-specific
        trends be extrapolated to a region? An acidification example for the
        Northeast. Ecological Applications 8:  288-299 (1998).

        Stoddard, J.L,  D.S. Jeffries, A. Lukewille, T.A. Clair, P.J. Dillon, C.T.
        Driscoll, M. Forsius, M. Johannessen, J.S. Kahl, J.H. Kellogg, A. Kemp,
        J. Mannip, D. Monteith, P.S. Murdoch, S. Patrick, A. Rebsdorf, B.L
        Skjelkvale, M. Stainton, T.S. Traaen, H. van Dam, K.E. Webster, J.
        Wieting, arid A. Wilander. Regional trends in aquatic recovery from
        acidification in North America and Europe. Nature 401 (6753):
        575-8 (1999).

        Stoddard J.L., T.S. Traaen, B.L. Skjelkvale, and M. Johannessen.
        Assessment of nitrogen leaching at UN/ECE ICP-Waters sites
        (Europe and North America). Water, Air, and Soil Pollution 130:
        781-86(2001).

        Stolte, K., B. Conkling, S. Campbell, and A. Gillespie. Forest Health
        Indicators - Forest Inventory and Analysis Program, FS-746. Research
        Triangle Park, NC: U.S. Department of Agriculture,  Forest Service,
        October 2002.
                                                                      Suter, G.W. Ecological Risk Assessment, Chelsea, Ml: Lewis Publishers, 1993.
 E-22
References
Appendix t

-------
Sutton, R.F. So/7 Properties and Root Development in Forest Trees: A
Review, Information Report O- X-413. Sault Ste. Marie, Ont: Forestry
Canada, Great Lakes Forestry Centre, 1991.

The H. John Heinz 111 Center for Science, Economics, and the
Environment. The State of the Nation's Ecosystems: Measuring the
Lands, Waters, and Living Resources of the United States, New York, NY:
Cambridge University Press, September 2002.

Tilman, D. and J.A. Downing. Biodiversity and stability in grasslands.
Nature 367: 363-365  (1994).

Turner, M.G. Landscape Ecology: The effect of pattern on process.
Annual Review of Ecology and Systematics 20: 171 -197  (1989).

U.S. Census Bureau. 2000 Census of Population and Housing
Characteristics, PCH-1 -1. Washington DC: U.S. Census Bureau, 2002.

U.S. Department of Agriculture, Natural Resources Conservation
Service. Summary Report: 1997 National Resources Inventory (Revised
December 2000), Washington, DC: Natural Resources Conservation
Service and Ames, IA: Iowa State University, Statistical Laboratory,
December 1999, revised December 2000.

U.S. Department of Agriculture. National Resources Inventory:
Highlights, Washington, DC: U.S. Department of Agriculture, Natural
Resources Conservation Service, January 2001.

U.S. Department of Agriculture, Forest Service. U.S. Forest Facts and
Historical Trends, Brochure #FS-696. Washington, DC: U.S.
Department of Agriculture, April 2001.

U.S. Department of Agriculture, Forest Service. Draft Resource
Planning and Assessment Tables. August 12, 2002. (September
2002; http://www.ncrs.fs.fed.us/4801 /FIADB/rpaJabler/
Draft_RPA_2002_Forest_Resource_Tables.pdf).

U.S. Department of Agriculture. National Report on Sustainable
Forests - 2003, Final Draft, Washington, DC: U.S. Department of
Agriculture, Forest Service, November 2002.

U.S. Department of Agriculture. National Report on Sustainable
Forests - 2003, Washington, DC: U.S. Department of Agriculture,
Forest Service, Forthcoming, 2003.

U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. The Quality of our Nation's Waters,
A Summary of the National Water Quality Inventory: 1998 Report to
Congress, EPA 841 -S-00-001. Washington, DC: U.S. Environmental
Protection Agency, Office of Water, June 2000.

U.S. Environmental Protection Agency.  Quality Criteria for Water -
1986, EPA 440-S-86-001. Washington DC: U.S. Environmental
Protection Agency, Office of Water, November 1986.
        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Air Quality Criteria for Ozone
        and Related Photochemical Oxidants, EPA 600-P-93-004aF-cF.
        Research Triangle Park, NC: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency,
        Office of Research and Development, National Center for
        Environmental Assessment. July 1996.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Special Report on
        Environmental Endocrine Disruption: An Effects Assessment and Analysis,
        EPA 630-R-96-012. Washington, DC: U.S. Environmental Protection
        Agency, Risk Assessment Forum, December 1997.

        U.S. Environmental  Protection Agency.  Condition of the Mid-Atlantic
        Estuaries, EPA 600-R-98-147. Washington DC: U.S. Environmental
        Protection Agency,  Office of Research and Development,
        September 1998.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Birds Indicate Ecological
        Condition of the Mid-Atlantic Highlands, EPA 620-R-00-003.
        Washington, DC: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of
        Research and Development, June 2000.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Mid-Atlantic Highlands Streams
        Assessment, EPA 903-R-OO- 015. Philadelphia, PA:  U.S.
        Environmental Protection Agency Region 3, Office of Research and
        Development, August 2000.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. National Coastal Condition
        Report, EPA 620-R-01 -005. Washington DC: U.S. Environmental
        Protection Agency, Office of Research and Development and Office
        of Water, September 2001.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. A Framework for Assessing and
        Reporting on Ecological Condition, EPA-SAB-EPEC-02-009.
        Washington, DC: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Science
        Advisory Board, June 2002.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. National Water Quality
        Inventory - 2000 Report, EPA 841 -R- 02-001. Washington DC: U.S.
        Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Water, August 2002.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Response of Surface Water
        Chemistry to the Clean Air Act Amendments of 1990, EPA 620-R-03-
        001. Research Triangle Park, NC: U.S. Environmental Protection
        Agency, Office of Research and Development, National Health and
        Environmental Effects Research Laboratory, January 2003.

        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Mid-Atlantic Integrated Assessment,
        MAIA - Estuaries 1997- 98, Summary Report, EPA 620-R-02-003.
        Narragansett, Rl: U.S. Environmental  Protection Agency, Office of
        Research and Development, Atlantic Ecology Division, May 2003.
/Appendix t
References
E-23

-------


U.S. General Accounting Office. Western National Forests: Nearby
Communities Are Increasingly Threatened by Catastrophic Wildfires,
GAO/T-RCED-99-79. Washington, DC: U.S. General Accounting
Office, 1999.

U.S. General Accounting Office. Water Quality: Key EPA and State
Decisions limited by Inconsistent and Incomplete Data, GAO/RCED-00-
54. Washington, DC: U.S. General Accounting Office, 2000.

U.S. Geological Survey. National Water-Quality Assessment
(NAWQA) Program, national synthesis. 2002. (February 2003;
hUp://water.usgs.gov/nawcia/natsyn.html).

Valigura R., R. Alexander, M. Castro, T. Meyers, H. Paerl, P. Stacey,
and R. Turner (eds.) Nitrogen Loading in Coastal Water Bodies - An
Atmospheric Perspective, Washington, DC: American Geophysical
Union, 2000.

Van Dolah, R.F., J.L Hyland, A.F. Holland, J.S. Rosen, and T.R. Snoots.
A benthic index of biological integrity for assessing habitat quality in
estuaries of the southeastern United  States. Marine Environmental
Research 48:269-283 (1999).

Vitousek, P., H. Mooney, J. Lubchenco, and J. Melillo. Human
domination of Earth's ecosystems. Science 277: 494-499 (1997).

Vitousek, P., S. Hattenschwiller, L Olander, and S. Allison. Nitrogen
and nature. Ambio 31: 97-101 (2002).

Vogelmann, J., S.M. Howard, L Yang, C.R. Larson, B.K. Wylie, and N.V.
Driel. Completion of the 1990s national land cover data set for the
conterminous United States from Landsat Thematic Mapper data and
ancillary data sources. Photogrammetric Engineering and Remote
Sensing 67  (6): 650-662 (2001).
        Wardle, D.A., M.A. Huston, J.P. Grime, F. Berendse, E. Gamier, W.K.
        Lauenroth, H. Setala, and S.D. Wilson. Biodiversity and ecosystem
        function: an hisue in ecology. Bulletin of the Ecological Society of
        America. 81: 235-239 (2000).

        Weathers, K.C., M.L Cadenasso, and S.T.A. Pickett. Forest edges as
        nutrient and pollutant concentrators: potential synergisms between
        fragmentation, forest canopies,  and the atmosphere. Conservation
        Biology 15: 1506-1514 (2001).

        Weisberg, S.B., J.A. Ranasinghe,  D.M. Dauer, L.C. Schaffner, R.J. Diaz,
        and J.B. Frith<;en. An estuarine benthic index of biotic  integrity (B-
        IBI) for Chesapeake Bay. Estuaries 20: 149-158 (1997).

        Wickham, J.D,, R.V. O'Neill, K.H. Riitters, E.R. Smith, T.G. Wade, and
        K.B. Jones. Geographic targeting of increases in nutrient export due
        to future urbanization. Ecological Applications 12 (I): 93-106 (2002).

        Winter, T.C. The concept of hydrologic landscapes. Journal American
        Water Resources Association 37: 335-349 (2001).

        World Resources Institute. World Resources 2000-2007  People and
        Ecosystems: the Fraying Web of Life, Washington, DC: World Resources
        Institute, 2000.

        Yoccoz, N.G., j.D. Nichols, and T. Bouliner. Monitoring biological
        diversity in space and time. Trends in Ecology and Evolution 16: 446-
        453 (2001)._
E-24
References
Appendix E

-------
Techri tal Document
                                                                        Jt feport orv the  Ehvijronrnent 2003
                                                                       - ', -  :-"• "  I  '-".''"'. '"-'• "-;":' .". ';.  ':'. ..'-• : "'. :•..-.''":-  "-" :: "•-<'.-..--".-..  -" -
                      erences  ror
                    fc
 Appendix  U:  Culossary  of
                         lerms
Atomic Energy Act of 19*54, Public Law 83-703.

Barber, M.C., (ed.). The Environmental Monitoring and Assessment
Program: Indicator Development Strategy, EPA 620-R-94-022. Athens,
GA: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Research and
Development, Environmental Research Laboratory, March 1994.

chained dollars - A measure used to adjust for the effects of inflation
in the U.S. currency from year to year, such that a consistent
monetary value can be understood over time. A chained dollar is
based on the average weights of the cost of goods and services in
successive pairs of years. It is "chained" because the second year in
each pair, with its weights, becomes the first year of the next pair.
(DOE, 2001) Ref: U.S. Department of Energy,  Energy Information
Administration. Annual Energy Review 1999 - Chained Dollars.
February 8, 2001. (June 2, 2003;
http://www.eia.doe.gov/emeu/consumptionbriefs/recs/natgas/chained.html).

Environment Canada and U.S. Environmental Protection Agency.
State of the Great Lakes 1997. October 27,  1998. (August 13, 2002;
http://www. epa.gov/docs/grtlakes/solec/96/stofgl/mdex. htm).

Garcia, L.S.  Flagellates and ciliates. Clinics in Laboratory Medicine 19:
vii, 621 -638 (1999).

Green, L. W. and Kreuter, M. S. Health promotion planning: An
educational  and ecological approach. (3rd edition), Mountain View, CA:
Mayfield Publishing Co, 1999.

Grondahl, C. and Martin, K. North Dakota's endangered and
threatened  species. North Dakota State Game  and  Fish
Department's Nongame Program, Version 16JUL97.  July  1997.
(February 3, 2003; http://www.npwrc.usgs.gov/resource/distr/others/
endanger/endanger.htm).

Health Insurance Commission. HIC annual report 2000-1 glossary.
2000-2001. (February 24, 2003; http://www.hic.gov.au/annualreport/
glossary.htm).

Intergovernmental Panel on Climate Change. Climate Change 2001:
The Scientific Basis A Contribution of Working Croup I to the Third
Assessment Report-of the IPCC, Cambridge, UK and New York, NY:
Cambridge  University Press, 2001.
International Union pf Pure and Applied Chemistry, Clinical
Chemistry Division Commission on Toxicology. Glossary for
Chemists of Terms Used In Toxicology. 1993. (March 6, 2003;
h tip://www. sis.nlm. nih.gov/Clossary/main.html).

Jackson, Laura E., J.C. Kurtz, and W.S. Fisher. Evaluation Guidelines for
Ecological Indicators,  EPA 620-R-99-005. Washington, DC: U.S.
Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Research and
Development, May 2000.

Matthews, John D., Silvicultural Systems, Oxford, UK: Oxford
University Press, 1989.

Moffett, M. W. What's "up"? A critical look at the basic terms of
canopy biology. Biotropica 32:569-596 (2000).

Nadakavukaren, A. Our Global Environment: A Health Perspective,  Fifth
Edition, Prospect  Heights, IL: Waveland Press, Inc., 2000.

National Cancer Institute. Asbestos exposure: questions and
answers. 2001. (April 5, 2002; http://cis.nci.nih.gOV/fact/3_21 .htm).

National Public Health Partnership. National response to passive
smoking in enclosed public places and workplaces: a background
paper (Commonwealth of Australia). 2000. (November 1, 2002;
http://www. dhs. vic.gov. au/nphp/legtools/smoking/passive/section2 .htm).

National Research Council. Ecological Indicators for the Nation,
Washington, DC: National Academies Press, 2000.

Odum, E.P. Fundamentals of Ecology, Third Edition, Philadelphia, PA:
W.B. Saunders Company, 1971.

Pidwirny, Michael. Fundamentals of physical geography,
online glossary of terms. 1999-2001. (August 13,  2002;
http://www.geog. ouc. be. ca/physgeog/physgeoglos/glossary. html).

Schneider, D. and N. Freeman. Children's environmental health risks:
a state-of-the-art conference. Archives of Environmental Health  56:
103-110(2001).

Steenland, K. and L. Stayner. Silica, asbestos, man-made mineral
fibers, and cancer. Cancer Causes Control 8: 491 -503 (1997).

Texas Environmental Center. Encyclopedia of water terms. 1991.
(November 25, 2002; http://www.tec.org/tec/terms2.html).

The H.John Heinz III Center for Science, Economics and the
Environment. The State of the Nation's Ecosystems: Measuring the
Lands, Waters, and Living Resources of the United States,  New York, NY:
Cambridge University Press, September 2002.
Appendix t
                                      References
                                                       E-25

-------

U.S. Census Bureau. Statistical Abstract of the United States 2007:
The National Data Book, Washington, DC: U.S. Census Bureau, 2001.

U.S. Census Bureau, Geography Division. Cartographic boundary
files: geographic area description. July 2001. (August 13, 2002;
bltp://www.census,gov/geo/www/cob/ma_metadata.html#ma).

U.S. Department of Agriculture, Natural  Resources Conservation
Service. Summary Report: 1997 National  Resources Inventory (Revised
December 2000), Washington, DC: Natural Resources Conservation
Service and Ames, IA: Iowa State University, Statistical Laboratory,
December 1999, revised December 2000.

U.S. Department of Agriculture, Forest Service. U.S. Forest Facts and
Historical Trends, Brochure #FS-696. Washington, DC: U.S.
Department of Agriculture, April 2001.

U.S. Department of Agriculture, Nematology Lab. Nematode basics.
June 5, 2001. (August 13, 2002; http://www.barc.usda.gov/
psi/nem/what-nem.htm).

U.S. Department of Agriculture, Forest Service, Southern '
Research Station, Forest Inventory and Analysis. Forest inventory -
definition of terms. November 12, 2002. (December 3, 2002;
hUp://www.srsfia.usfs.msstate.edu/fidef2.htm).

U.S. Department of Energy, Office of Environmental Management.
Environmental Management manages four types of radioactive waste.
November 10,1997. (March, 7 2003: http://www.em.doe.gov/
empr!mer/emws2.html).

U.S. Department of Energy (DOE).  Radioactive Waste Management.
Order 435.1. July, 1999.

U.S. Department of Energy, Office of Environmental Management.
Fact Sheet: Department of Energy Announces Its Preferred
Alternatives for Disposal of Low-Level and Mixed Low-Level
Radioactive Waste. December 10,1999. (March, 7 2003;
http://www.em.doe.gov/emprimer/emws2, html).

U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Terms of Environment: Glossary,
Abbreviations, and Acronyms, EPA 175-B-97-001. Washington, DC:
U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Communications,
Education, and Public Affairs, Revised December 1997.

U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Exposure Factors Handbook,
Washington, DC: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency,  Office  of
Research and Development, National Center for Environmental
Assessment  March 1998.

U.S, Environmental Protection Agency. EPA Report to Congress, Solid
Waste Disposal in the United States,  Volumes l-ll, EPA 530-SW-88-
       011 (B). Washington, DC: U.S. Environmental Protection Agency,
       Office of Solid Waste and Emergency Response, October 1988.

       U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Science Advisory Board. A
       Framework for Assessing and Reporting on Ecological Condition,  EPA
       SAB-EPEC-02-009. Washington, DC: U.S. Environmental Protection
       Agency, Science Advisory Board, June 2002.

       U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Wetlands, Oceans
       and Watersheds. Wetlands: Section 404 of the Clean Water Act: Now
       wetlands are defined and identified. July 2, 2002. (August 13,
       2002; http://www.epa.gov/owow/wetlands/facts/factn.html).

       U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Mid-Atlantic Integrated
       Assessment: glossary.  August 8, 2002.. (August 13, 2002;
       http://www. epa.gov/maia/html/glossary. html).

       U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. National primary drinking
       water regulations; consumer fact sheet on: Cadmium. September 23,
       2002. (August 13, 2002; http://www.epa.gov/OGWDW/dwh/c-ioc/
       cadmium.htm\).

       U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Air and Radiation.
       Global warming site: glossary of climate change terms. October 8,
       2002. (November 25, 2002; http://yosemite.epa.gov/oar/
       globalwarming.nsf/content/glossary.html).

       U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Chesapeake  Bay Program
       Office. Glossary of terms. October 25, 2002. (February 24, 2003;
       http://chesapeakebay. net/glossary, htm).

       U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Clean Air Markets Division.
       Glossary. October 29, 2002. (August 13, 2002;
       http://www. epa.gov/airmarkets/glossary. html).

       U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. TRI Explorer: releases reports
       metadata.  November 12, 2002.  (December 9, 2002;
       http://yosentitel .epa.gov/oiaa/explorers_fe.nsf/7c77bcd2e66feb048S2
       S677b006ae6cf/871 c6234f2 bd8ab3852S69SO,OOS231 df
       ?OpenDocument).

       U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Water. What is up
       with our nation's waters? Technically speaking - glossary of terms.
       November 2:0, 2002. (December 3, 2002; http://www.epa.gov/
       owow/'monitoring/'nationswaters/'glossary, html).

       U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Groundwater
       Drinking Water. Groundwater and drinking water: drinking water
       glossary. November 26, 2002. (December 3, 2002;
       http://www.epa.gov/safewater/glossary.htm).
E-26
References
Appendix t

-------

U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Radiation information:
radiation terms. December 3, 2002. (December 3, 2002;
http://www.epa.gov/radiation/terms/index.html).

U.S. Environmental Protection Agency. Toxic Release Inventory (TRI)
Program.; What is TRI? December 9, 2002. (December 9, 2002;
http://www.epa.gov/tri/).

U.S. Environmental Protection Agency, Office of Pollution Prevention
and Toxics. PCBs Home Page.  February 3, 2003. (March 7, 2003;
http://www.epa.gov/opptintr/pcb/).
        U.S. Environmental Protection Agency; Mid-Atlantic Integrated
        Assessment: habitat loss. 2003.  (August 13, 2002;
        http://www. epa.gov/maia/html/habitat. html).

        U. S. Food and Drug Administration, Center for Food Safety and
        Applied Nutrition, Office of Seafood. National Shellfish Sanitation
        Program Model Ordinance, 1999 revision. November 3, 2000.
        (August 13, 2002; http://vm.cfsan.fda.gov/flear/nssporpd.html).

        U.S. Geological Survey. Estimated use of water in the United States
        in 1990, glossary of water - use terminology. April  10, 1996.
        (November 25, 2002; http://water.usgs.gov/watuse/wuglossary.html).
Appendix £
References
E-27

-------

-------
  Appendix P:  I
/ .; .-••;• • • : '• - •'.:•• • I '.• ;-. ' , -.' '; '!' . : •: '' ."•'•" '".:;^ '•' '••;-'"!:-'-t;
Background amf

-------
——.	„	—i—--— ^- ~"~"        •               .i    i   _.	i«^^^^^^     	rW^PiiPi
  On November 13, 2001, Administrator Christine Todd Whitman
  directed the U.S. Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) to
  undertake an Environmental Indicators Initiative (Ell), bringing
  together national, regional, and program office indicator efforts to
  produce a Draft Report on the Environment (ROE)and a Draft
  Report on the Environment Technical Document (ROE TD). This
  report is the first step In a multi-year process to identify indicators
  indicators to measure progress toward environmental and human
  health goals, to identify data gaps and discuss challenges in filling
  those gaps, and to ensure the Agency's accountability to the public
  The ROETD contains the scientific and technical information  from
  which the ROE was developed.
   Report leadership/Partnerships

   Administrator Whitman's chief of staff assembled and chaired a
   steering committee, comprising senior career officials from EPA
   program, support, and regional offices, to guide the report
   development. The Offices of Environmental Information (OEI) and
   Research and Development (ORD) were charged with leading an
   integrated process to produce the ROE and the ROE TD. Key staff
   representatives acted as "theme" or chapter leads, serving as liaisons
   with subject matter experts throughout EPA. Other federal agencies
   and tribal  and state governments also assisted in reviewing the
   report and draft development.

   Report Foundation-Trie Questions

   The process began with  a concerted effort across EPA to identify
    significant environmental questions both of interest to the public
    and fundamental to EPA's mission to protect the environment and
    human health. A series of six workshops was held in early 2002
    across EPA program and regional offices for six themes: human
    health, ecological condition, air, water, land, and global issues. The
    workshops identified key questions and proposed indicators (both
    those supported by existing data and potential future indicators),
    and noted challenges to implementation and limitations of the
    indicators.

    The questions focused on "outcomes" - actual environmental results
    such as the quality of outdoor air - rather than on more process-
    oriented "outputs" such as numbers of permits written. The
    questions included in this report represent a first set that  can be
     refined and expanded. For some questions, one to several indicators
     were identified; for other questions, there were no indicators
     available or recommended.
-Indicator Selection

 By May 2002, the process had identified key questions and
 associated indicators to address them. The questions were organized
 into five report chapters: Cleaner Air, Purer Water, Better Protected
 Land, Human Health, and Ecological Condition. Indicators to
 respond to the questions were recommended from across EPA,
 states, tribes, and other federal agencies. The indicators and their
 supporting data sets were documented in accordance with a
 standard  format, which is allowed for technical review of data quality,
 sampling design, coverage, data analysis, and data accessibility.
 An example of the' quality review form is presented in Appendix C.
 For the national indicators that were identified, there was a wide
 ' variation in the availability of data, as the lack of data was a major
 challenge and limitation in writing the chapters.

 An expert review was held to review and assess the potential
 indicators.  External EPA experts were invited to participate in a two-
 day workshop,'in .mid-June 2002 in the  Washington, D.C. area, to
 discuss and record their assessments of the Indicators: The reviewers
 were asked to evaluate the quality review forms for the proposed
  indicators in advance of the workshop and then to discuss their
  assessments in small groups of other reviewers  at the workshop (an
  expert review evaluation form is presented in Appendix H).

  Guidance was given to the expert reviewers asking that they review
  the proposed indicators to evaluate:

  a Quality of the data set supporting the indicator;

   • Scientific basis for the use of the indicator as a measure of the
     quality of the environment;
   • Utility of the indicator in measuring the quality of the
     environment; and
   m Limitations in using the indicator to measure the quality of the
     environment.
      F-2
                                                       Background and Chronology
                                                                                                                      Appendix F

-------
                                                      .^^M'-^^f^-^!'-i^f:^'":-&.-i-4-.!:"i:/i'i':'-^../t' '•••>::'!.•':-. "i:,:..;; ;.'::'?.:t'.;:".K:X-.: ••'-.; :•'•<••'.•'

 Draft Report Development and Review

 After determining a set of indicators, EPA developed and refined
 several drafts of the report. In November 2002, EPA shared a draft
 with federal and state agencies and the Environmental Council of
 States (ECOS) and took their comments into consideration in
 developing the content of the ROE technical document. That draft
 was the basis for final review and comment by the Council on
 Environmental Quality (CEQ) and the Office of Management and
 Budget (OMB).

 This current draft report is now available to the public.
Chronology of jignificant Events for Document

Development

A chronology of significant milestones in the development of the
draft Report on the Environment Technical Document is presented
below.
November 200T
Administrator's Memo Launching the
Environmental Indicators Initiative
January-February 2002 ' Theme Workshop Meetings - Initial
                       Identification of Questions and
                       Potential Indicators
March-April 2002

April 2002  .„.


May 2002

June 2002

July 2002-May 2003
Development of Report Outlines

ECOS-Sponsored Meeting with
Interested States

Quality Review Process

External Expert Review Workshop

Drafting of ROE and ROE Technical
Document
Nov. 2002-May 2003   State/Federal Interagency/OMB/CEQ
                       Review Meetings
June 2003
Release of Draft ROE and ROE
Technical Document
Appendix r
                        Background and Chronology
F-3

-------

-------
Appendix G:
Review Form

-------
                  i                                   ,                               I
ErAs Draft Report on tne Envjrpnment 200J  • Technical Document
                                                               1C
 /v      vDeneral Background
 1.  What is the theme this indicator is part of (e.g., land, water, air, global change, human health, ecological health)?
 2.  What is the name of the Indicator/data set?
 3.  What is the question the indicator set is being proposed to address?
 4.   How does this indicator address the questions? (conceptual relevance)
 5.   Does this indicator/data set require additional processing to optimally address this question and if so, what?
 6.  Has this indicator previously been peer reviewed? If so, please provide details. This question has been moved from1 Data Processing
    and Analysis section.
 G-2
Indicator Quality Review Form
Appendix G

-------
                   Teem


 D.       Data  Quality
 1.   What is the known quality of the entire data set?
2.   Has any standard data documentation, such as FCDC metadata, been developed to support these data?
     (If yes, please provide reference or source.)
3.  Why were the data originally collected (e.g., what is being measured or monitored)?
4.  Were data collected under a single program or were data from multiple programs combined? If multiple data sets were combined
    please address the quality for each data set independently.
5.  What was (were) the program or programs under which the data were collected?
6.  Did these programs have quality assurance plans to verify, corroborate, ground truth or otherwise assess the accuracy of the data?
Appendix
                                              Indicator Quality Review Form
G-3

-------


7.  If yes, are the quality assurance program plans available (and where)?
8.  Were the quality assurance plans followed?
9.   Were the analytical methods used consistent throughout the data set?
10.  If not what effects could the different analytical methods have on the indicator results?
11. Are you aware of any sources of error that may affect the findings developed from these data? Error types could include errors of
     omission, commission, mis-classification, incorrect georeferencing, mis-documentation or mistakes in the processing of data.
     This question is revised from "What are some of the uncertainties of the data and on the findings."
G-4
Indicator Quality Review Form
Appendix'

-------
fchhical  Document
            '     "'         "'
                                                                    ralt l\e^
                                                                     /•:.,.:•:• • .;..;• •'•'.( .-:..-.- "•,,:"-:•<•" •.;::•••":':. rXv>:- S:^2^S;%;'.i:i*(::i ..... i'SSS" -.>];•.;:•:• ::v: -.
      .       jample  Design
1.  Generally describe how the data are/were collected (Research, general monitoring, compliance monitoring, regulatory requirement)?
    If collected under a regulatory requirement, please specify the regulation and links to the regulation and associated guidance.
2.  What was the sample design or the monitoring plan?
3.  Were any specific strata omitted from the sampling plan (e.g., small systems not in the sampling plan, roads less than 2 miles long,
    habitat types less than 20 acres)?
4.  Which of the processes below was used to select the sites where information is/was collected?
  a) Sites selected using a statistical design that enables generalization to entire resource (e.g., probability survey design to select sample of
    lakes or streams for the United States, such as NRI, NASS, FHM, FIA)

  b) Sites determined to meet administrative or regulatory requirements such as sources of or water supply systems.

  c) Sites chosen to address suspected or known problems (e.g., Hot spots).

  d) Randomly selected sites.

  e) Sites selected in unknown way.
Append
         ix
                             Indicator .Quality Review Form
C-5

-------
oAs Draft "Report on the tnvironhient 2Q03 •  Iqcnnical Document
                   rr '             -   '   • i '  i  •• •   .•     •:. ...:']•'!  i.;Ti'i'  •. -  '    "        . . •.  •  i.ii:"j
 5.  When did the monitoring begin?
 6.  When did the monitoring end?
 7.  What was the periodicity of the sample (yearly, seasonally, quarterly, monthly, weekly, daily, etc.)?
 8.  Were there any major gaps in the data either spatially or temporally (please explain)
 G-6
Indicator Quality Review Form
Appendix G

-------
                                       Q^^
                                       ' -~  "'  •'-.'-- --"--. --- --,:-- -.'-..-, 	•. •-i-.r:'..- -v.A.v-:- <.'•'... . *.' :-:-: ••:--'.* -.--.•'• '-••'•'. ..' ':'•". '•'•';- -.- •"-.'-' ^.'.,.^ .••••/, .'•". .-•-..; 'f:.-. ,••--'- -:, .,.,-:. •'" ••". '• -  •'•

 D.       C
overage
 1.   Is there uniform national coverage of information for this indicator?
2.   Were data collected in some areas but not others?
3.   Was the data collected using remote sensing?  If yes please specify the sensor, date and the resolution of the data.
4.   If the data are derived from mapped information, what was the original map scale or resolution?
Appendix G
                               Indicator Quality Review Form
C-7

-------
                  -fenr—-—.—ns~
t.     Data "Processing  and  Analyses
1.  What kinds of analyses have been performed on the data? Please explain.
2.  Are the values used in the indicator raw data? Aggregated data? Calculated data? Inferred data? Last sentence deleted,
    redundant with 1.
3.  Are these analyses standard methods? Please reference.
4.  Were these results published? If yes please give reference or link.
5.  Were these results peer reviewed? If yes by whom? Give references.
6.  How were the values calculated or determined?
C-8
Indicator Quality Review Form
Append
ix

-------
                      lechlilca!  L}^
                     •-.•.-.-••-• -:••'  -  •"• -'  -   ' ,- -  -•".:;."•."	 --	,..« .•.-:•.<;••.:.-• .•!]•.,.,'., v: ;•••;. ••:.•• •.-':; Kv'v .I.-'-..:/.-. ;:- 5 . IV;.. •• ... '. ;•: .   .:•'... •'•.. • i :: ' ••• ....'.'-' :"•• :.••:•..•>..  •." •.

 7   .Please describe the basis of the classification scheme? Why was this scheme chosen?
 8. , How are the values interpreted?
9.   Are there established ranges that indicate the state of the environment? If yes how were these values established?  Are the values

     consistent across the spatial extent of the data set?
10. Is the Indicator developed based on a model?  If so, what is this model?
11. Has the model been published?
12. Has the model been peer reviewed?
13. How are data gaps handled when the model is applied?
14. What is the scientific inference process used to generalize from site-specific information to the national coverage?
Appendix G
Indicator Quality Review Form
C-9

-------
                                                ]                                                    i
tlAs Draft Mport on the tnvjronment 20OS  •  lacnnical Document
                     !r                        I .  :             •   : ..  : I    1                       I   : •
 15. Which of the following was used to generalize or portray data beyond the specific sampling points?
   a) Defensible statistical survey analysis inference procedures used to generalize to entire United States,  (e.g., current OW National Lake
      Fish tissue contaminant survey, FIA, FHM, NRI)

   b) Defensible statistical model inference procedures used to generalize to entire United States (e.g., generation of wet deposition maps
      for US or generation of air quality information using kriging).

   c) Semi-empirical environmental/ecological model predictions,  (e.g., USGS use of SPARROW model to predict nutrients in rivers based on
      statistical relationships and simple hydrologic flow models)

   d) Generalization is restricted to sites visited and it is possible to give a well- defined, meaningful definition of the portion of the ecological
      resource covered.

   e) No generalization possible and no meaningful way to identify the subset of the ecological resource represented by the collection of sites.
 G-10
Indicator Quality Review Form
Append
                                                                                                                      x

-------
                technical 13^                    Draft Report on  the Environment 2O03
r.      Uata  Accessibility
1.   Are the data readily available? If yes, please give reference, link or contact.
2.  Are the summary reports available? If yes, please give reference, link or contact.
3.   Have these results been published? If yes, please give reference.
Appendix G
Indicator Quality Review Form
G-1 1

-------
   EPAs Draft Report on tne Envij-oijirtient 200 j
                         Documdrtt
'	PI	!	
                                                   Jib.
    CD.     AAessage or  Interpretation
    1.  Are the messages or answers to the questions appropriate, sound, and understandable?
    G-12
Indicator Quality Review Form
Append:
                                                                              x

-------
  Appendix H:
EPA Draft Report
     on the
  Envirohment
 Expert Review
   Workishop
Evaluation Form

-------
tPAs Draft "Report on the Tlnvirbhrnent 2003
                1       •      :''!;•'    I '' : 'I ' '• :•'
                 lecnnica
                                                 	4	;	
\ r\ :: - 'Ml
1 LJocurrMnfc
  EFA Draft Report on the Environment txpert "Review
                      Workshop Evaluation Form
Name of Theme:
Name of Indicator.
Associated Question:
Reviewer Name:
Please provide brief answers of one to three paragraphs for each question in the following sections. Under the "Primary Questions" section,
please provide a summary evaluation of the indicator's data quality and coverage, suitability, and fit. Evaluations shall be based on a scale from
1 to S (Excellent - 5; Adequate - 3; Poor = 1).
"Primary Questions
Data Quality and Coverage
                                                          .
1. Do the indicator and the supporting data provide adequate geographic coverage for national reporting?
H-2
Workshop Evaluation Form
               Appendix H

-------
                 lecnnical L^dcLimeht  •  t-Tvlis Drart Txeport on the tnvfrdnrnent 2O03
2. What is the quality of the data set supporting the indicator? What is known about the quality? (In your response, please address the ade-
quacy of the data to support the indicator; whether there is uniform national coverage, quality assurance/quality control issues, documenta-
tion, consistent analytical methods, and sample design issues.)
*Summary Evaluation of Data Quality and Coverage (Excellent = 5; Adequate = 3; Poor = 1):
juitability or Indicator

3. Is there a credible scientific basis for this indicator?
Appendix H
Workshop Evaluation Form
H-3

-------

4. What are the limitations of this indicator?  (e.g., guidance relevant to using the data supporting the indicator, including challenges and
gaps)
•Summary Evaluation of Suitability of Indicator (Excellent = 5; Adequate - 3; Poor - 1):
Question and Indicator Fit

S. How well does the indicator answer or fit the associated questions?
 'Summary Evaluation of Question and Indicator Fit (Excellent=S; Adequate=3; Poor="l):
 H-4
Workshop Evaluation Form
Appendix H

-------
                                
-------
8. Are there other questions and associated indicators that better address the issue?  (Please use draft document outline as the basis for
developing a short answer.)
H-6
Workshop Evaluation Form
Appendix H

-------
  Appendix I:
Summary Tables
  of Questions
   Indicators

-------

                                                                HjlF
                        CJnapter 1: CJeaner Air - Cj>)uestiora and Indicators
                                           Outdoor Air Quality  t.
i 	 • 	 • 	
What is the quality of outdoor air in the United States?
(See also following four questions)
- How many people are living in areas with particulate matter
and ozone levels above the National Ambient Air Quality
Standards (NAAQS)?
- What are the concentrations of some criteria air
pollutants: PMjj, PM10, ozone, and lead?
- What are the impacts of air pollution on visibility in
national parks and other protected lands?
— What are the concentrations of toxic air pollutants in
ambient air?
What contributes to outdoor air pollution?
(See also following three questions)
— What are contributors to particulate matter,
ozone, and lead in ambient air?
- What arc contributors to toxic air pollutants in
ambient air?
- To what extent is U.S. air quality the result of pollution
from other countries, and to what extent does U.S. air
pollution affect other countries?
What human health effects are associated with
outdoor air pollution?
What ecological effects are associated with outdoor
1 air pollution?
Number and percentage of days that metropolitan
statistical areas (MSAs) have Air Quality Index (AQI) values
greater than 1 00
Number of people living in iareas with air quality levels
above the NAAQS for particulate matter (PM) and ozone
Ambient concentrations of particulate matter: PM2 5 and
PM10
Ambient concentrations of ozone: 8-hour and 1 -hour
Ambient concentrations of lead
Visibility
Ambient concentrations of selected air toxics
See emissions indicators
Emissions: particulate matter (PM2.5 and PM10)
sulfur dioxide, nitrogen oxides, and
volatile organic compounds
Lead emissions
Air toxics emissions
No Category 1 or 2 indicators identified
No Category 1 or 2 indicators identified
Also see Human Health chapter
No Category 1 or 2 indicators identified
Also see Ecological Condition chapter
2
1
1
1
1
1
2

2
2
2



1.1.1
1.1.1.3
1.1 .1.b
1,1 .l.b
1.1. l.b
1.1. l.c
1.1 .1.d
1.1.2
1 .1 .2.3
1.1.2.3
1.1 .2.b
1 .1 .2.c
1.1.3
1.1.4
                                             Acid Deposition

What are the deposition rates of pollutants that cause
acid rain?
What are the emissions of pollutants that form acid rain?
What ecological effects are associated with
acid deposition?

Deposition: wet sulfate and wet nitrogen
Emissions (utility): sulfur dioxide and nitrogen oxides
No Category 1 or 2 indicators identified
Also see Ecological Condition chapter
2
2

1 .2.1
1.2.2
1.2.3
1-2
Summary Tables of Questions and Indicators
Appendix I

-------
                  L-hapter 1: (-leaner/\ir —- wuestions and Indicators (continued)
                                            Indoor Air (Duality

What is the quality of the air in buildings in the United States?
What contributes to indoor air pollution?
What human health effects are associated with
indoor air pollution?
HgBiliiM^Wffl^MsiJiiiHMB8eSiisJISg!g!i$ff^WgBgteMJ^^ ^"W^*s^*"*^"p"'Mw^LW1Ifrrft-'a^**?31
U.S. homes above EPA's radon action levels
Percentage of homes where young children are
exposed to environmental tobacco smoke
No Category 1 or 2 indicators identified
Also see Human Health chapter
No Category 1 or 2 indicators identified
Also see Human Health chapter
2
2


1.3.1
1.3.1
1.3.2
1.3.3
                                            jtratospneric Ozone
":"^:t:;v'::^
What are the trends in the Earth's ozone layer?
What is causing changes to the ozone layer?
What human health effects are associated
with stratospheric ozone depletion?
What ecological effects are associated with stratospheric
ozone depletion?
Ozone levels over North America
Worldwide and U.S. production of ozone-depleting
substances (ODSs)
Concentrations of ozone-depleting substances (effective
equivalent chlorine)
No Category 1 or 2 indicators identified
No Category 1 or 2 indicators identified
1
2
2


1.4.1
1.4.2
1.4.2
1.4.3
1.4.4
fell	•_
Appendix I
Summary Tables of Questions and Indicators
1-3

-------
ElAs Draft "Report on the Envirpnment 2003 • Technical Document
ILxniDit 2-1: Water - Questions and! Indicators
                             1    11  ,,

                             i
                                     Waters and Watersheds
     i	
     i	
     F"
     t	
     •
     I
     i	
     t
What is the condition of fresh surface waters and
watersheds in the U.S.?
What are the extent and condition of wetlands?
What is the condition of coastal waters?
What are pressures to water quality?
What ecological effects are associated
with impaired waters?
Altered fresh water ecosystems
Lake Trophic State Index
Wetland extent and change
Sources of wetland change/loss
Water clarity in coastal waters
Dissolved oxygen in coastal waters
Total organic carbon in sediment:.
Chlorophyll concentrations
General pressures
Percent urban land cover in riparian areas
Agricultural lands in riparian areas
Population density in coastal areas
Changing stream flows
Number/duration of dry stream flow periods in
grassland/shrublands
Sedimentation index
Nutrient pressures
Atmospheric deposition of nitrogen
Nitrate in farmland, forested, and urban streams and
ground water
Total nitrogen in coastal waters
Phosphorus in farmland, forested, and urban streams
Phosphorus in large rivers
Total phosphorus in coastal waters
Chemical Pressures
Atmospheric deposition of mercury
Chemical contamination in streams and ground water
Pesticides in farmland streams and ground water
Acid sensitivity in lakes and streams
Toxic releases to water of mercury, dioxin, lead, PCBs,
and PBTs
Sediment contamination of inland waters
Sediment contamination of coastal waters
Sediment toxicity in estuaries
Fish Index of Biotic Integrity in streams
Also see Ecological Condition chapter
Macroinvertebrate Biotic Integrity index for streams
Also see Ecological Condition chapter
Benthic Community Index for coastal waters
Also see Ecological Condition chapter
2
2
1
2
2
2
2
2

2
2
2
1
2
2

2
2
2
2
2
2

2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2.2.1
2.2.1
2.2.2
2.2.2
2.2.3
2.2.3!
2.2.3
2.2.3

2.2.4.a
2.2.4.a
2.2.4.a
2.2.4.a
2.2.4.a
2.2A.3

2.2.4.b
2.2.4.b
2.2.4.b
2.2.4.b
2.2.4.b
2.2.4.b

2.2.4.C
2.2.4.C
2.2.4.C
2.2.4.C
2.2.4.C
2.2.4.C
2.2.4-c
2.2.4.C
2.2.5
2.2.5
2.2.5
 1-4
    Summary Tables of Questions and Indicators
Appendix I

-------
                    technical  Document ||fcr7^ Draft Report on the environment 2003
                                                     Drinking Water
       su
          What is the quality of drinking water?
             Population served by community water systems
             that meets all health-based standards
                                                                                                         2.3.1
          What are sources of drinking water contamination?
             No Category 1 or 2 indicators identified
                                                                                                         2.3.2
          What human health effects are associated .with drinking
          contaminated water?
             No Category 1 or 2 indicators identified
             Also see Human Health chapter
2.3.3
                                               Recreation in and on the Water
. !_'.._. .".-... 	 	 ;.,Laussti8d./>':Cm'^';;im?3^ .''•»'- ~'.':,i;L"L.,,:XM?i^^£$<$&$
What is the condition of waters that support consumption
offish and shellfish?
What are contaminants in fish and shellfish, and where
do they originate?
What human health effects are associated with consuming
contaminated fish and shellfish?
Percent of river miles and lake acres under fish
consumption advisories
Contaminants in fresh water fish
Number of watersheds exceeding health-based
national water quality criteria for mercury and PCBs
in fish tissue
No Category 1 or 2 indicators identified
No Category 1 or 2 indicators identified
Also see Human Health chapter
2
2
2


2.5.1
2.5.1
2.5.1
2.5.2
2.5.3

Appendix I
Summary Tables of Questions and Indicators
            1-5

-------

                  Chapter 3: Better T rotected Land - (.Questions and Indicators
                                              Land Use

••plPi11!111 '! I1 ^'^^^^^ J4 ii; HJIIlilll!.'.^ l^g^iew 	 ''fiili'iiTBl 	 " w«s**w**«2uestions and Indicators (continued)
Waste and Contaminated Lands ... ..
^•4 •'• " ' '. • - Question- -raaMffisasassa^
t
e
t-~
i
f
i
1
i
i
How much and what types of waste are generated and
managed ?
What is the extent of land used for waste management?
What is the extent of contaminated lands?
What human health effects are associated with waste
management and contaminated lands?
What ecological effects are associated with waste
management and contaminated lands?
Quantity of municipal solid waste (MSW) generated and managed
Quantity of RCRA hazardous waste 'generated and managed
Quantity of radioactive waste generated and in inventory
Number and location of municipal solid waste (MSW) landfills
Number and location of RCRA hazardous waste management facilities
Number and location of Superfund National Priorities List (NPL) sites
Number and location of RCRA Corrective Action sites
No Category 1 or 2 indicator identified
No Category 1 or 2 indicator identified
2
2
2
2
2
2
2


3.3.1
3.3.1
3.3.1
3.3.2
3.3.2
3.3.3
3.3.3
3.3.4
3.3.5
.-. • • , - -, ..,:•.'- 	 .. - -„ 	 v .»,,„.-;.,„=, -•-.- ;-..-.-„ 	 ,-.„. ,~-- 	 ,......-
                                                                                                                 .si
Appendix I
Summary Tables of Questions and Indicators
1-7

-------
                          '                      -                                    ,

EPAs Draft "Report  on the Environment  2003
                What are the trends for life expectancy?
                What are the trends for cancer, cardiovascular disease,
                  chronic obstructive pulmonary disease and asthma?
                What are the trends for gastrointestinal illness?
                What are the trends for children's environmental health issues?
                                                                         Cancer mortality
                                                                         Cancer incidence
                                                                         Cardiovascular disease mortality
                 Cardiovascular disease prevalence
                                                                         Chronic obstructive pulmonary disease mortality
                                                                         Asthma mortality
                                                                         Asthma prevalence
                                                                         Cholera prevalence
                                                                         Cryptosporidiosis prevalence
                                                                         E. coli O1S7:H7 prevalence
                 Hepatitis A prevalence
                                                                         Salmonellosis prevalence
                                                                         Shigellosis prevalence
                                                                         Typhoid fever prevalence
                                                                          Infant mortality
                                                                          Low birthweight incidence
                                                                         Childhood cancer mortality
                                                                         Childhood cancer incidence
                                                                         Childhood asthma mortality
                                                                         Childhood asthma prevalence
                                                                         Deaths due to birth defects
                                                                          Birth defect incidence
                                                                                                   .               ,
                                                      txosure to tnvironmentai Tollultion: Indicators and  trend
                 What is the level of exposure to heavy metals?
                What Is the level of exposure to cotinine?
                What is the level of exposure to volatile organic compounds?
                What is the level of exposure to pesticides?
                What is the level of exposure to persistent
                  organic pollutants?
                 What art; the trends in exposure to environmental
                   pollutants for children?
                  What is the level of exposure to radiation?
                  What is the level of exposure to air pollutants?
                  What is the level of exposure to biological pollutants?
                  What is the level of exposure to disinfection by-products?
                                                                          Indicator Name,
                                                                         Blood lead level
                                                                         Urine arsenic level
                                                                         Blood mercury level
                                                                         Blood cadmium level
                                                                         Blood cotinine level
                 Blood volatile organic compound levels
                 Urine organophosphate levels to indicate pesticides
                                                                         No Category 1 or 2 indicators identified
                                                                         Blood lead level in children
                 Blood mercury level in children
                                                                         Blood cotinine level in children
                 No Category 1 or 2 indicators identified
                 No Category 1 or 2 indicators identified
                 Also see Cleaner Air chapter <
                 No Category 1 or 2 indicators identified
                 No Category 1 or 2 indicators identified
                                                                                                                                        4.3.2
                                                                                                                                        4.3.2
                                                                                                                                        4.3.2
                                                                                4.3.2
                                                                                                                                        4.3.2
                                                                                                                                        4.3.2
                                                                                                                                        4.3.2
                                                                                                                                        4.3.3
                                                                                                                                        4.3.3
                                                                                                                                        4.3.3
                                                                                                                                        .4.3.3
                                                                                                                                        4.3.3
                                                                                                                                        4.3.3
                                                                                                                                        4.3.3
                                                                                                                                        4.3.4
                                                                                                                                        4.3.4
                                                                                                                                        4.3.4
                                                                                                                                        4.3.4
                                                                                                                                        4.3.4
                                                                                4.3.4
                                                                                                                                        4.3.4
                                                                                                                                        4.3.4
                                                                                                                                         4.4.3
                                                                                                                                         4.4.3
                                                                                                                                         4.4.3
                                                                                                                                         4.4.3
                                                                                                                                         4.4.4
                                                                                                                                         4.4.5
                                                                                                                                         4.4.6
                                                                                                                                         4.4,7
                                                                                                                                         4.4.8
                                                                                4.4.8
                                                                                                                                         4.4.8
                                                                                                                                         4.4.9
                                                                                                                                         4.4.9
                                                                                                                                         4.4.9
                                                                                                                                         4.4.9

      Appendix 1
Summary Tables of Questions and Indicators
1-8

-------
S Question J
t
i
5
3 :
^
1
i
j What is the ecological condition of forests?
«
1
1

3
i
i
j
8?"^ " , ,..
Indicator Name
Extent afforest area, ownership, and management - .
Nitrate in farmland, forested, and urban ftreams and ground water
Deposition: wet sulfate and wet nitrogen
Changing stream flows . -
Extent of area by forest type : •. •
Forest age class . , . . i '•
Forest pattern and fragmentation
At-risk native forest species , .
Populations of representative forest species
Forest disturbance: fire, insects, and disease
Tree condition , j
Ozone injury to trees . | . - - . -
Carbon storage . .
Soil compaction •
Soil erosion ' .
Processes beyond the range of historic variation
' , - *, -«-,**- ,*.^^'~
Category
7
. 2
2
7
1
2
2
2
2
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
-
Section
S.I. 4
2.2.4.b
7.2.2
2.2.4.a
S.2
5.2
5.2 ,
5.2
5.2
5.2
S.2
5.2
5.2
5.2
5.2
5.2

        IP
                          Oiapter 5: tcological C-onaition • Questions ana InaicatQrs
                               1           •         • >

                                           > *          Forests
                                                      rarmianos
» -•- Question .'[-•-. . indicator Name Category - Section
%
•i
"i
I What is the ecological condition of farmlands?
af
3
i
^
Extent of agricultural land uses ,
The farmland landscape , .
Nitrate in farmland, forested, and urban streams and ground water
Phosphorus in farmland, forested and urban streams . . \
Pesticides in farmland streams and ground water
Potential pesticide runoff from farm fields
Sediment runoff potential from croplands and pasturelands
Pesticide leaching potential ^ i
Soil quality index , , . T '
Soil erosion
• 7
7
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
3.7.2
3.7.2
2.2.4.fc
2.2.4.i
2.2.4.C
3.2.4
3.7.6
S.3
5.3
5.3
e^t=- & / l -* J
W -r 'H «- Ci-
                                               tlrassiancls and jhruDianas
Question '
" - ' ; , • :.!..(.'-

•
and shrublands?

Iridicatdl- Name . :
- • . • • . ' ' ••.-.•If:',
Extent of grasslands and shrublands : . . , .
Number/duration of dry stream flow periods in grasslands and shrublands
At-risk native grassland and shrubland species
Population trends of invasive and native non-invasive bird species
Category
7
2
2
1
Section
3.7.3
2.2.4.0
5.4
5.4
1-9
Summary Tables of Questions and Indicators
Appendix I

-------

        1	1	
 -_.            PI       1  /^"     I     "    S~\   —	^^f?l^^T7*^e*i'^f?.^i<''if!fi#!&i>&ifff^
Chapter 5: tcological  Condition - Cyuestiort| and Indicators tcontinued)

                                  Urban and Suburban Lanas

                                                  Extent of urban and suburban lands
                                                 Ambient concentrations of ozone 8-hour and 1-hour
           What is the ecological condition of urban
           and suburban areas?
                                                  Nitrate in farmland, forested and urban streams, and ground water
                                                  Phosphorus in farmland, forested, and urban streams
                                                  Chemical contamination in urban streams and ground water
                                                  Patches of forest, grassland, shrubland, and wetland in urban/suburban areas
                                                                                                                           7.1.7.1)
                                                                                                                           2.2.4.B
                                                                                                                           2.2 4 b
                                                                                                                           2.2.4 c
                                                                                                                            5.5
                                                                Fresn Waters

What is the ecological condition of fresh waters?
Wetland extent and change
Altered fresh water ecosystems ll! ' ' ni1
Contaminants in fresh water fish '
Phosphorus in large rivers '' '•
Lake Trophic State Index
Chemical contamination in streams and ground water '' !
Acid sensitivity in lakes and streams ' ! ": "•"
Changing stream flows i j
Sedimentation index ; 	 	 l"1"""'"' 	 	 ' 	 ' 	 1"""11'1
Extent of ponds, lakes, and reservoirs \ ' ' '•
At-risk native fresh water species , .
Non-native fresh water species , !
Animal deaths and deformities : '
At-risk fresh .water plant communities !
Fish Index of Biotic Integrity in streams
Macroinvertebrate Biotic Integrity Index for streams
i
2
. 2
2
2
2
2
1
2
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
2.2.2
2.2.1
2.5.7
2.2.4.b
2.2.1
2.2.4.C
2.2.4.C
2.2.4.0
2.2.4.0
5.6
5.6
5.6
5.6
5.6
5.6
5.6
                                                                                                                                 ttflif

• 	 ' j^fEtiHf^P^ 	 ji 	 »^^^







What Is the ecological condition of coasts








f~ i x-x • W^f'-^-^'ViiAK^K'.^^^^,
L-oasts and wceaiiis ' ; ' ;•;; '•_' '• '"_'••"• •'••'•• • • "••"ii •'•••••'••••'•

Chlorophyll concentrations
Water clarity in coastal waters '
Total nitrogen in coastal waters i
Total phosphorus in coastal waters
Dissolved oxygen in coastal waters . '
Total organic carbon in sediments
Sediment contamination of coastal waters
Sediment toxtciiy in estuaries
Extent of estuaries and coastline
Coastal living habitats
	 T'l 	 i" " "'
Shoreline types
Benthic Community Index
Fish diversity,
Submerged aquatic vegetation ' ''
Fish abnormalities
Unusual marine mortalities
SS'li!:

2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
1
2
2
2'
2
2
2
2
?3*S$»;

2.23|
2.2.3
2.2.4.fc
2.2.4.b
2.2.3
2.2.3
2.2.4.C
2.2.4.C
5.7
5.7
5.7
5.7
5.7
5.7
5.7
5.7
        js/ote: Italicized indicators are presented in other chapters.
Appendix 1
                       Summary Tables of Questions and Indicators
MO

-------

                                                                        I, ^aj
                                                                      E^_^J'
             Cnapter 5: Ecological Condition - Questions and Indicators (continued)
                                            The Entire Nation
fe


What is the ecological condition of the
entire nation?
Nntfl' \\fi\\r\70A \inAir-fi4-f\vr- «•*„ .... 	 j. j
	 — •— 	 , 	 ^^ 	 ^ 	 ^^^BJBTOP^
-------

-------

-------
^	i -»
                                                 ,,,.,,.,,,.„.,„.
                                                 •••a^	-s

-------